Sei sulla pagina 1di 501

Airplane

Design

Manual

FREDERICK K^TEICHMANN

Professor of Aeronautical Engineering

Assistant Dean, Day Division

College of Engineering, New York University

FOURTH EDITION

PITMAN PUBLISHING CORPORATION

NEW YORK TORONTO LONDON


Airplane
Design
Manual
+

FREDERICK ~ TEICHMANN
Professor of Aeronautical Engineering
Assistant Dean, Da.y Division
College of Engineering, New York University
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FOURTH EDITION
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

PITMAN PUBLISHING CORPORATION


NEW YORK TORONTO LONDON

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Engin. Library

Engin. Library
TL

G7/.2

3 SB Copyrioht, 1939, 1942, 1950, 1958


TL
..., I ')
BT
~ I 1 ' ~
PITMAN PUBLISHING CORPORATION

All rights reserved. No part of this book

may be reproduced in any form without

the written permission of the publisher.


COPYRIGHT, 1939, 1942, 1950, 1958
4.1

BY
cop. 2.

Associated Companies PITMAN PUBLISHING CORPORATION


Sir Isaac Pitman a Sons, Ltd.

London Melbourne Johannesburg


All rights reserved. No part of this book
Sir Isaac Pitman & Sons (Canada), Ltd.

may be reproduced in any form without


Toronto

Printed in the United States of America


the written permission of the publisher.

4.1

Associated Companies
SIR ISAAC PITMAN • SONS, LTD.
London Melbourne Johannesburg
SIR ISAAC PITMAN & SONS (CANADA), LTD.
Toronto
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

PRINTED IN THE UNITED 8TATl:8 OF Alo:RICA

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Preface to the Fourth Edition

This book grew out of notes prepared for airplane design courses at the

Daniel Guggenheim School of Aeronautics, College of Engineering, New

York University more than twenty years ago. The field of airplane design

has undergone enormous changes in these years and will continue to do so.

Thus the book has been expanded to encompass recent developments,

thereby making it more effective and meaningful to the present-day

student.

In addition, an attempt has been made in this revision to amplify the

analytical approach to design problems as well as the purely empirical

approach. The student of airplane design is in this way offered a deeper

appreciation of the interplay of aerodynamics, structural analysis, human

considerations, and other such factors.

Although practical necessity restricts the treatment that can be given

to each of the various fields, it is hoped that the student may be stimulated

to refer to literature that is available elsewhere.


Prefaee to the Fourth Edldon
The objectives of aircraft design work in the college classroom are:

(1) To offer an integration of or focal point for applying the various

principles included in aerodynamics, structural design, installation require-

ments, and application of materials. If time permits, economics, perform-

ance calculations, and allied problems continue the understanding of the


This book grew out of notes prepared for airplane design courses at the
design concept.

(2) To afford a basis for stress analyses.


Daniel Guggenheim School of Aeronautics, College of Engineering, New
(3) To provide some drafting experience.
York University more than twenty years ago. The field of airplane design
(4) To develop an "engineering sense" in the student, enabling him to

has undergone enormous changes in these years and will continue to do so.
evaluate various requirements, judge the necessity of compromise, and

know the amount of time needed to achieve a given objective.


Thus the book has been expanded to encompass recent developments,
This book has been designed to aid both the teacher and student of
thereby making it more effective and meaningful to the present-day
airplane design to effectively meet and fulfill these important goals.

Frederick K. TeichmaHn
student.
vii
In addition, an attempt has been made in this revision to amplify the
analytical approach to design problems as well as the purely empirical
approach. The student of airplane design is in this way offered a deeper
appreciation of the interplay of aerodynamics, structural analysis, human
considerations, and other such factors.
Although practical necessity restricts the treatment that can be given
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

to each of the various fields, it is hoped that the student may be stimulated
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

to refer to literature that is available elsewhere.


The objectives of aircraft design work in the college classroom are:
(1) To offer an integration of or focal point for applying the various
principles included in aerodynamics, structural design, installation require-
ments, and application of materials. If time permits, economics, perform-
ance calculations, and allied problems continue the understanding of the
design concept.
(2) To afford a basis for stress analyses.
(3) To provide some drafting experience.
(4) To develop an "engineering sense" in the student, enabling him to
evaluate various requirements, judge the necessity of compromise, and
know the amount of time needed to achieve a given objective.
This book has been designed to aid both the teacher and student of
airplane design to effectively meet and fulfill these important goals.

FREDERICK K. TEICHMANN
vii

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
Vlll AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
viii

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Preface to the Third Edition

Although airplane design has progressed tremendously since this book

was first published, the fundamental approach to the problem of airplane

design has not changed. However, the possibility of attaining transonic

and supersonic speeds with aircraft, a hope seemingly very remote only a
Prefaee to the Third Edition
few years ago, has introduced additional considerations in designing even

the smallest detail. The student may not find all the needed answers in

the new edition but the way to his desired goal is indicated. It is up to

him to make the best use of material at hand, either in this book or col-

lateral reading.

Although airplane design has progressed tremendously since this book


The author greatly appreciates the work in redrawing and preparing

new sketches done by Messrs. Dong, Waxman, and Wood, his former

students.
was first published, the fundamental approach to the problem of airplane
Frederick K. Teichmann

Preface to the First Edition


design has not changed. However, the possibility of attaining transonic
This book has been written to fill what appears to the author to be a
and supersonic speeds with aircraft, a hope seemingly very remote only a
gap in aeronautical literature, an introduction to the art of airplane de-

few years ago, has introduced additional considerations in designing even


sign, with the needs of the student, the young engineer, the draftsman and

the student working on his own especially in view. While aerodynamics,


the smallest detail. The student may not find all the needed answers in
stress analysis and other aspects of airplane design have been covered many
the new edition but the way to his desired goal is indicated. It is up to
times, experience in dealing with senior aeronautical students has shown

that such men experience considerable difficulty in coordinating their


him to make the best use of material at hand, either in this book or col-
knowledge and efforts in approaching the difficult problem of actually
lateral reading.
beginning the design of a new machine, and carrying on the work system-

The author greatly appreciates the work in redrawing and preparing


atically. From time to time notes have been prepared for student use

and these have gradually evolved into the present work.


new sketches done by Messrs. Dong, Waxman, and Wood, his former
students.
FREDERICK K. TEICHMANN
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Prefaee to the First Edition


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

This book has been written to fill what appears to the author to be a
gap in aeronautical literature, an introduction to the art of airplane de-
sign, with the needs of the student, the young engineer, the draftsman and
the student working on his own especially in view. While aerodynamics,
stress analysis and other aspects of airplane design have been covered many
times, experience in dealing with senior aeronautical students has shown
that such men experience considerable difficulty in coordinating their
knowledge and efforts in approaching the difficult problem of actually
beginning the design of a new machine, and carrying on the work system-
atically. From time to time notes have been prepared for student use
and these have gradually evolved into the present work.

· Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
PREFACE IX

PREFACE

ix In view of the rapid growth and complexity of the subject, it is too much
In view of the rapid growth and complexity of the subject, it is too much

to hope that the entire field has been adequately covered; still teaching
to hope that the entire field has been adequately covered; still teaching

experience indicates that such a manual is helpful to instructors and stu-


experience indicates that such a manual is helpful to instructors and stu-
dents alike.
dents alike.
It is of course expected that the student shall supplement the present

text by investigations of his own, by studying the latest designs at the


It is of course expected that the student shall supplement the present
airport, or from descriptions in the technical press, or by study of the
text by investigations of his own, by studying the latest designs at the
numerous research publications published by the Government Printing

airport, or from descriptions in the technical press, or by study of the


numerous research publications published by the Government Printing
Office and the great engineering societies, even though an attempt has

been made to make each chapter of the book as complete in itself as

possible.
Office and the great engineering societies, even though an attempt has
The author wishes to thank the following companies (among others) for

permission to use illustrations: The Pratt & Whitney Aircraft Co., Pioneer
been made to make each chapter of the book as complete in itself as
Instrument Co., R.C.A. Manufacturing Co., Inc., The Cleveland Pneu-
possible.
matic Tool Co., The Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co., The B. F. Goodrich

The author wishes to thank the following companies (among others) for
permission to use illustrations: The Pratt & Whitney Aircraft Co., Pioneer
Rubber Co., The Firestone Tire & Rubber Co., Bendix Products Corpora-

tion, Harrison Radiator Corporation, Eclipse Aviation Corporation, Kolls-

man Instrument Co.


Instrument Co., R.C.A. Manufacturing Co., Inc., The Cleveland Pneu-
Thanks are also due to Mr. Robert Boyer and Mr. Leonard Mihalov-

sky, N.Y.U.'37, who kindly permitted the use of their class designs, and
matic Tool Co., The Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co., The B. F. Goodrich
to Professor Alexander Klemin, who established the course in airplane de-
Rubber Co., The Firestone Tire & Rubber Co., Bendix Products Corpora-
sign in 1924, in a form which has stood the test of time, for many valuable

tion, Harrison Radiator Corporation, Eclipse Aviation Corporation, Kolls-


man Instrument Co.
suggestions and criticisms.

Frederick K. Teichmann

June, 1939
Thanks are also due to Mr. Robert Boyer and Mr. Leonard Mihalov-
sky, N.Y.U.'37, who kindly permitted the use of their class designs, and
to Professor Alexander Klemin, who established the course in airplane de-
sign in 1924, in a form which has stood the test of time, for many valuable
suggestions and criticisms.
FREDERICK K. TEICHMANN

June, 1939
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
D1 ze b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
Contents

Prefaces

, Chapter I. Procedure in Design

Selecting Type of Airplane .


Contents
Power Plant

Payload and Crew

Performance Requirements

Step-by-Step Procedure .

Nomenclature
PREFACES vu
References

i Chapter II. Types of Airplanes


~chapterI. Procedure in Design 3
The Biplane

Selecting Type of Airplane 3


Power Plant
The Sesquiplane

The Multiwing Airplane .


4
The High-Wing Monoplane .
Payload and Crew . 5
The Low-Wing Monoplane
Performance Requirements 6
Special-Purpose Airplanes

Factors Affecting Choice


Step-by-Step Procedure 6
Performance
Nomenclature . 7
Landing-Gear Retraction .
References . 9
Structure

Special Features
' Chapter TI. Types of Airplanes 10
Sample Airplane Data Sheets

Empirical Data
The Biplane 10
Airplane Data
The Sesquiplane 11
8 Chapter HI. Airfoil Selection . The Multiwing Airplane . 11
The Airplane in Rectilinear Flight

The High-Wing Monoplane 12


Horizontal Flight

Gliding Flight
The Low-Wing Monoplane 16
The Dive
Special-Purpose Airplanes 17
The Climb
Factors Affecting Choice 18
Range

Performance . 18
Landing-Gear Retraction 18
Other Airfoil Characteristics

Structural Considerations

Recapitulation
Structure 18
Aspect Ratio Corrections
Special Features . 19
Aerodynamic Section Characteristics .

Sample Airplane Data Sheets 19


Generated on 2012-05-30 00:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

26
Airfoil Construction

Sweepback for High-Speed Airplanes


Empirical Data
Airplane Data . 26
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Laminar-Flow Airfoils .

Compressible-Flow Airfoils

xi
J Chapter III. Airfoil Selection 29
The Airplane in Rectilinear Flight 29
Horizontal Flight . 31
Gliding Flight 33
The Dive 34
The Climb 34
Range 36
Other Airfoil Characteristics 36
Structural Considerations 38
Recapitulation 38
Aspect Ratio Corrections 38
Aerodynamic Section Characteristics 41
Airfoil Construction 45
Sweepback for High-Speed Airplanes 46
Laminar-Flow Airfoils . 48
Compressible-Flow Airfoils 48
xi

Dr ize b Original from


UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Xll AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

,50
xii AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Chapter IV. External Loads on an Airplane in Flight .... 50


Chapter IV. External Loads on an Airplane in Flight .
Load Factor 50

Load Factor 50
J'he Airplane in a Maneuver . 51
The Airplane in a Maneuver 51

The Airplane in a Gust 52

Experimental Determination of the Load Factor .... 55


The Airplane in a Gust . 52
Airplane Categories 57
Experimental Determination of the Load Factor 55
Empirical Load Factors 57

Airplane Categories . 57
57
The Flight Envelope 58

Reference Axes 59
Empirical Load Factors
Generalized System of Forces 61 The Flight Envelope 58
Other Dynamic Loads 63

Reference Axes . 59
Chapter V. Materials of Construction 64

Application of Available Materials 64


Generalized System of Forces 61
Aluminum and Aluminum Alloys 65
Other Dynamic Loads 63
Classification and Nomenclature 66

Sheet 67

Chapter V. Materials of Construction 64


64
Tubing 68

Extruded Shapes 68
Application of Available Materials
Forgings 68 Aluminum and Aluminum Alloys . 65
Castings 70

Classification and Nomenclature 66


Wire, Rod, and Bar 70

Rivets and Screw-Machine Products 70


Sheet 67
Airframe Fabrication 71
Tubing . 68
Cutting and Blanking 72
Extruded Shapes 68
Forming 72

Forgings 68
Castings. 70
Magnesium Alloys 74

Castings 74

Forgings 74 Wire, Rod, and Bar 70


Extrusions 74

Rivets and Screw-Machine Products 70


Sheet 74

Steel 74
Airframe Fabrication 71
Titanium Alloys 75
Cutting and Blanking . 72 I

Hardware and Other Items 76


Forming. 72
Chapter VI. Detail Design Considerations 81

Magnesium Alloys 74
Design Philosophies 81

Margin of Safety 81
Castings. 74
Forgings 74
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Maintenance Requirements 82

Fool-Proof Operation 82

Extrusions 74
Sheet 74
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The "Fail-Safe" Principle 82

74
Safety 82

The "One-Horse Shay" Principle 83


Steel .
Strength of Metal Aircraft Elements 84 Titanium Alloys 75
Structural Behavior . . 84

Hardware and Other Items 76


Stiffeners or Stringers 86

Chapter VI. Detail Design Considerations 81


Panels under Load 88

Design Philosophies . 81
Margin of Safety . 81
Maintenance Requirements 82
Fool-Proof Operation . 82
The "Fail-Safe" Principle . 82
Safety 82
The "One-Horse Shay" Principle 83
Strength of Metal Aircraft Elements 84
Structural Behavior . 84
Stiffeners or Stringers 86
Panels under Load . 88

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
CONTENTS Xlll

CONTENTS xiii

Panel Sizes 89
Panel Sizes 89
Strength of Sheet-Stringer Combinations 92
Strength of Sheet-Stringer Combinations 92
Equivalent Structure 93

Equivalent Structure 93
Cut-Outs '94

Riveted and Bolted Joints 95


Cut-Outs . ·94
Fittings 97
Riveted and Bolted Joints 95
Determining Bolt Diameter 99

Fittings 97
Determining Thickness of Fitting Lug 99

Determining Value of R 99
Determining Bolt Diameter 99
Checking whether Dimension R is Sufficient 99
Determining Thickness of Fitting Lug 99
Sandwich Materials 99
Determining Value of R 99
Flooring 100

Checking whether Dimension R is Sufficient 99


Sandwich Materials . 99
Thermal Problems 102

Miscellaneous 103

Lightening Holes 105


Flooring 100
Beading 105
Thermal Problems 102
Stiffeners 105

Chapter VII. The Three-View 113 >


Miscellaneous . 103
Steps in Assembling Preliminary Data for Three-View .114
Lightening Holes 105
Estimation of Gross Weight 114 Beading . 105
Estimation of Wing Area 116

Stiffeners 105
Determining Length of Span 117

113 j
Drawing Up the Wing Planform 118

Determination of the Mean Aerodynamic Chord . .118


Chapter VII. The Three-View .
Determining Length of Airplane 118

Steps in Assembling Preliminary Data for Three-View 114


Locating the Engines 119

Planform of Horizontal Tail Surfaces 120


Estimation of Gross Weight 114
Completing the Top View 120
Estimation of Wing Area . 116
Completing the Side View 121
Determining Length of Span 117
Completing the Front View 121

Drawing Up the Wing Planform 118


Determination of the Mean Aerodynamic Chord 118
General Notes for Three-View 121

Engineering Studies 122

Final Three-View 122


Determining Length of Airplane 118
Chapter VIII. Preliminary Weight Estimate 124
Locating the Engines . 119
General Procedure 124

Planform of Horizontal Tail Surfaces 120


Completing the Top View . 120
Estimated Weights 126
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Calculated Weights .126

Actual Weights 127 Completing the Side View . 121


Completing the Front View 121
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Alternate Loads 127

Estimating the Gross Weight 127

Estimation of Structural Weight 128


General Notes for Three-View 121
Recapitulations 128
Engineering Studies 122
Form for Preliminary Weight Estimate 128
Final Three-View 122
Variables Affecting Weight Estimation 132

Wing Weight Estimates 132

Chapter VIII. Preliminary Weight Estimate 124


General Procedure . 124
Estimated Weights . 126
Calculated Weights . 126
Actual Weights 127
Alternate Loads 127
Estimating the Gross Weight 127
Estimation of Structural Weight 128
Recapitulations 128
Form for Preliminary Weight Estimate 128
Variables Affecting Weight Estimation 132
Wing Weight Estimates 132

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
XIV AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
xiv

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Fuselage Weight Estimates 136
Fuselage Weight Estimates 136
Control Surface Weight Estimates 137
Control Surface Weight Estimates 137

Landing-Gear Weight Estimates 138


Power Plant and Power-Plant Nacelle Weight Estimates 138
Landing-Gear Weight Estimates 138

Power Plant and Power-Plant Nacelle Weight Estimates . . 138

Weight Data Sources 139


Weight Data Sources . 139
Design Control of Weight 139
Design Control of Weight . 139
Empirical Formulas and Data 139

Wing Weight 139


Empirical Formulas and Data 139
Tail Surfaces 141
Wing Weight 139
Fuselage Weight 142
Tail Surfaces 141
Landing Gear 143

Fuselage Weight 142


Total Fabricated Components 145

Weight Empty 146


Landing Gear 143
Engine Nacelles 146
Total Fabricated Components 145
Fuel Weight 147
Weight Empty 146
Oil Weight 147

Engine Nacelles . 146


Fuel Weight . 147
Power Plant Weights 147

Gross Weight 148

Miscellaneous Weights 149


Oil Weight 147
Propeller Weights 149

Power Plant Weights 147


Chapter IX. The Balance Diagram 155

General Procedure 155


Gross Weight 148
Center of Gravity Location 157
:Miscellaneous Weights 149
Practical Solution 160 Propeller Weights 149
Center of Gravity Movement 160

The Fuselage and Its Contents 161


Chapter IX. The Balance Diagram. 155
The Wing and the Landing Gear 164

General Procedure . 155


Supplementary Calculations 168

Ballast 169
Center of Gravity Location . 157
Centers of Gravity of Individual Items ....... 169
Practical Solution 160
Center of Gravity Estimation 170
Center of Gravity Movement 160
Error in Balance Calculations 171

The Fuselage and Its Contents 161


The Wing and the Landing Gear 164
Chapter X. The Cockpit 172

Suggested Procedure in Design 174

General Requirements 175


Supplementary Calculations . 168
Ballast 169
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Windows and Windshields 176

Characteristics of Glass 180

Centers of Gravity of Individual Items 169


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Vision and Visibility 182

Canopies 183
Center of Gravity Estimation 170
Seating 183 Error in Balance Calculations 171
Exits 186

Protection for the Pilot 186


Chapter X. The Cockpit . 172
Ejection Equipment 187

Suggested Procedure in Design 174


General Requirements 175
Parachutes 188

Controls 188

Instrument Board 189


Windows and Windshields 176
Characteristics of Glass 180
Vision and Visibility 182
Canopies 183
Seating 183
Exits . 186
Protection for the Pilot 186
Ejection Equipment 187
Parachutes 188
Controls 188
Instrument Board 189

Original from
D1 ize b UNI ERSITY OF MICHIG N
CONTENTS xv
CONTENTS xv

Chapter XI. Instruments and Equipment 191


Chapter XI. Instruments and Equipment 191
Instrument Board 193

Instrument Board 193


Location
Location 194

Grouping 194
194
Variety of Instruments 194
Grouping 194
Selection of Instruments • 197

Variety of Instruments 194


Electrical Equipment 198

Safety Equipment 199


Selection of Instruments 197
De-Icing and Anti-Icing 199
Electrical Equipment 198
Chapter XII. The Passenger Cabin 202 Safety Equipment . 199
General Considerations 202

De-Icing and Anti-Icing . 199


Comfort Factors 203

Chapter XII. The Passenger Cabin . 202


Cabin Dimensions 203

Passenger Seats 205

Seating Arrangements 206


General Considerations 202
Headroom for Small Airplanes 207

Comfort Factors 203


203
Headroom for Large Airplanes 209

Leg Room 209


Cabin Dimensions .
Side-by-Side Arrangements 213 Passenger Seats 205
Staggered Arrangements 213

Seating Arrangements 206


Back-to-Back Arrangements 213

Seating Facing Rearward 214


Headroom for Small Airplanes 207
Vision 215
Headroom for Large Airplanes 209
Seating Comfort 215
Leg Room 209
Seating Accessibility 215

Side-by-Side Arrangements 213


Staggered Arrangements 213
Center of Gravity Considerations 216

Windows 216

Doors and Exits 217


Back-to-Back Arrangements 213
Sleeping Accommodations 218

Seating Facing Rearward 214


Lighting .218

Vision . 215
215
Furnishings 218

Provision for Airsickness 218


Seating Comfort
Flooring 219 Seating Accessibility 215
Toilets 219

Center of Gravity Considerations . 216


Refreshments 220

Baggage Compartment 220


Windows 216
Doors and Exits 217
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Chapter XIII. Air Conditioning 221

Physiological and Psychological Considerations 221


Sleeping Accommodations 218
Lighting 218
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Air Movement for Comfort 222

218
Air Requirements 223

Pressure Considerations 224


Furnishings
Design Temperature Limits 226
Provision for Airsickness 218
Physical Conditions 226
Flooring 219
Air Ducts 227

Boilers and Radiators 229


Toilets 219
Refreshments 220
Baggage Compartment 220
Chapter XIII. Air Conditioning 221
Physiological and Psychological Considerations . 221
Air Movement for Comfort 222
Air Requirements 223
Pressure Considerations . 224
Design Temperature Limits 226
Physical Conditions . 226
Air Ducts . . . 227
Boilers and Radiators 229

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
XVl AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
xvi AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Heat Sources 229


. Heat Sources 229
Pressure Cabin Equipment 229
Pressure Cabin Equipment 229
Calculations 230

Calculations 230
Heating Surface 232
Heating Surface 232

Air Conditioning Problems at High Speeds 233

Chapter XIV. Soundproofing 235


Air Conditioning Problems at High Speeds 233
Measure of Noise 235

Sources of Noise 236


Chapter XIV. Soundproofing 235
Effect of Frequency on Soundproofing 236

Measure of Noise 235


Soundproofing Materials 237

Application of Materials 237


Sources of Noise 236
Noise Due to Jet Engines 239
Effect of Frequency on Soundproofing . 236
V Chapter XV. The Propeller 241 Soundproofing Materials 237
General Propeller Characteristics 241

Application of Materials . 237


Aerodynamic Effects of Propeller 243

Gyroscopic Effect 243


Noise Due to Jet Engines 239
\

~ Chapter XV. The Propeller 241


Propeller Pitch 244

Number of Blades 245

Propeller Influence on Aircraft Configuration 247


General Propeller Characteristics 241
Propeller Clearance 247

Aerodynamic Effects of Propeller . 243


Gyroscopic Effect 243
Asymmetrical Conditions 249

Effect of Engine Torque 250

Tandem Engines 251


Propeller Pitch . 244
Pusher Installations 252
Number of Blades 245
Tail Installation 253

Propeller Influence on Aircraft Configuration 247


Propeller Clearance . 247
Spinners and Cuffs 254

Propeller Selection 254

Empirical Formulas 258 Asymmetrical Conditions 249


Chapter XVI. The Power Plant 263

Effect of Engine Torque . 250


General Considerations 263

Location 264
Tandem Engines 251
Submerged Engines 264
Pusher Installations 252
Number of Engines 265
Tail Installation 253
Engine Rating 267

Spinners and Cuffs . 254


Engine Selection 268

Engine Nacelles 268


Propeller Selection . 254
Empirical Formulas . 258
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:43 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Fuel Consumption 268

Engine Mount—Non-Jet Engines 269

Chapter XVI. The Power Plant 263


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Firewall 272

Cowling • 273

General Considerations 263


Exhaust Manifolds—Reciprocating Engines 276

Carburetor Scoop Design 277


Location 264
Fuel Systems 278
Submerged Engines . 264
Pumps 279
Number of Engines 265
Tanks 279

Engine Rating . 267


Engine Selection 268
Engine Nacelles 268
Fuel Consumption 268
Engine Mount-Non-Jet Engines. 269
Firewall 272
Cowling 273
Exhaust Manifolds-Reciprocating Engines 276
Carburetor Scoop Design 277
Fuel Systems 278
Pumps 279
Tanks 279

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
CONTENTS xvn
CONTENTS xvii

Lubricating Systems 280 Lubricating Systems 280


Tanks 281

Tanks 281
Air Inlet System—Turboprop Engines 281

Induction System Configuration 281


Air Inlet System-Turboprop Engines 281
Design Considerations 281
Induction System Configuration 281
Inlet Losses during Ground Operations 286

Engine Inlet Anti-Icing Provision 286


Design Considerations 281
Anti-Icing Water Runback into Engine Inlet 286 Inlet Losses during Ground Operations 286
Air Inlet Systems—Turbo-Jet Engines 287

Engine Inlet Anti-Icing Provision 286


The Wing-Root Inlet 289

Nose Inlet in the Fuselage or Nacelle 290


Anti-Icing Water Runback into Engine Inlet . 286
The Nacelle or Pod-Type Installation 290
Air Inlet Systems-Turbo-Jet Engines 287
The Annular Inlet 292

The External Scoop 292


The Wing-Root Inlet . 289
The Flush Inlet 294
~ ose Inlet in the Fuselage or Nacelle 290
Rockets .298

Chapter XVII. Design of the Wing 299 1


The Nacelle or Pod-Type Installation 290
General Considerations 303
The Annular Inlet 292
Wing Layout Procedure 304
The External Scoop 292
Mean Geometric Chord 306

Planforms and Taper Ratios 310


The Flush Inlet 294
Sweepback for High-Speed Airplanes 313
Rockets 298
Effect of Wing Sweepback 317

Dihedral 317

Combination Dihedral and Sweepback 318


Chapter XVII. Design of the Wing 299
Angle of Incidence 319

Wing Loading 320


General Considerations 303
Aspect Ratios 320
Wing Layout Procedure . 304
Airfoil Thickness and Thickness Ratios 321

.Mean Geometric Chord . 306


Planforms and Taper Ratios 310
Wing-Fuselage Configurations 323

Metal Wing Construction 323

Spars and Their Location 327 Sweepback for High-Speed Airplanes 313
Spanwise Stringers and Their Location • 330

Ribs and Their Location 331


Effect of Wing Sweepback . 317
Wing-Fuselage Attachments 334
Dihedral 317
Fabric-Covered Wing Construction 337
Combination Dihedral and Sweepback 318
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:43 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Ailerons 341

Lift-Increase Devices and Spoilers 347


Angle of Incidence 319
Wing Loading . 320
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Wing Fences 354

Effect of Wing Mass Distribution 354

Aspect Ratios . 320


321
Effect of Wing Loading 355

Flutter Prevention 355


Airfoil Thickness and Thickness Ratios
Wing-Fuselage Configurations 323
Metal Wing Construction 323
Spars and Their Location 327
Spanwise Stringers and Their Location 330
Ribs and Their Location 331
Wing-Fuselage Attachments . 334
Fabric-Covered Wing Construction 337
Ailerons 341
Lift-Increase Devices and Spoilers 347
Wing Fences 354
Effect of Wing Mass Distribution 354
Effect of Wing Loading 355
Flutter Prevention . 355

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
xvm AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
xviii AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Chapter XVIII. The Landing Gear 357 Chapter XVIII. The Landing Gear. 35i
General Considerations 357

Dynamic Loads 358


General Considerations . 357
Means for Landing-Speed Reduction 359
Dynamic Loads 358
Dissipation of Energy 361
Means for Landing-Speed Reduction 359
Shock Absorbers 362

Dissipation of Energy 361


Shock Absorbers 362
Classification by Landing Contact 364

One-Point Contact 364

Two-Point Contact 364 Classification by Landing Contact 364


Three-Point Contact 365

One-Point Contact 364


Four-Point Contact 365

Landing Gear—Tail-Wheel Type 365


Two-Point Contact 364
Landing Gear—Nose-Wheel Type 367
Three-Point Contact 365
Track-Type Landing Gear 370
Four-Point Contact 365
Tandem Gear 371

Landing Gear-Tail-Wheel Type 365


Landing Gear-Nose-Wheel Type 367
Cross-Wind Landing Gear 371

Shimmy and Shimmy Dampers 373

Tread 375
Track-Type Landing Gear 370
Wheel and Tire Size 375
Tandem Gear . 371
Size of Tail or Nose Wheel 376

Cross-Wind Landing Gear 371


Shimmy and Shimmy Dampers 373
Wheel Position 376

Retraction of Landing Gear 376

Special Problems 380 Tread . 375


Chapter XIX. Tail Surfaces 382

Wheel and Tire Size 375


Longitudinal Stability Considerations 382

Definitions 382
Size of Tail or Nose Wheel 376
Preliminary Calculations for Static Longitudinal Stability . . 384
Wheel Position . 376
Adequacy of Static Stability 384
Retraction of Landing Gear. 376
Flight Criteria for Stability and Controls 385

Special Problems 380


Longitudinal Stability and Control 385

General Requirements 386

Control Surfaces 387


Chapter XIX. Tail Surfaces 382
Airfoil Sections 388

Longitudinal Stability Considerations 382


Aerodynamic Balance 389

Trailing-Edge Tabs and Other Devices 391


Definitions 382
Static Balance 391
Preliminary Calculations for Static Longitudinal Stability 384
Adequacy of Static Stability . 384
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:44 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Dynamic Balance 392

Flight Criteria for Stability and Controls 385


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Flutter Prevention 393

Construction 394
Longitudinal Stability and Control 385
Horizontal Tail Surfaces 395
General Requirements 386
Location 395
Control Surfaces 387
Angular Deflection 397

Airfoil Sections . 388


Aerodynamic Balance
Adjustable Stabilizer 397

Aspect Ratio 398


389
Angle of Incidence 398 Trailing-Edge Tabs and Other Devices 391
Sweepback 400

Static Balance . 391


Dynamic Balance 392
Flutter Prevention 393
Construction 394
Horizontal Tail Surfaces . 395
Location 395
Angular Deflection 397
Adjustable Stabilizer 397
Aspect Ratio . 398
Angle of Incidence 398
Sweepback 400

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CONTENTS XIX
CONTENTS xix

Dihedral 401
Dihedral 401
Area 401

Area 401
Construction . 401
Construction 401

Planform .401

Other Solutions 402


Planform 401
Clearances 403

Other Solutions 402


Vertical Tail Surfaces . . - 403

Directional Stability and Control 404


Clearances 403
Location 405
Vertical Tail Surfaces . 403
Angular Deflection 406
Directional Stability and Control 404
Aspect Ratio 406

Location 405
Area 407

Planform 408
Angular Deflection 406
Sweepback 408
Aspect Ratio . 406
Tail Length 409
Area 407
Butterfly or Vee Tail 409

Planform 408
408
Chapter XX. Control Systems 412

Typical Systems 412


Sweepback
Pulleys 414 Tail Length 409
Cables 414

Butterfly or Vee Tail 409


Fairleads 415

412
Stops 415

Differential Ailerons 419


Chapter XX. Control Systems .
Adjustable Stabilizer 419

Typical Systems 412


Tab Controls 420

Flap Controls 420


Pulleys 414
Wing Flaps 422
Cables 414
Tabs 422
Fairleads 415
Hinges 422

Stops . 415
419
Flap- and Tab-Control Loads 423

Hydraulic and Pneumatic Systems 423


Differential Ailerons
Travel of Controls 425 Adjustable Stabilizer 419
Irreversible Controls 426

Tab Controls 420


Detail Requirements 427

Flap Controls 420


422
Controls 427

Engine Controls 427


Wing Flaps
Tabs . 422
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:44 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Electrical Systems 429

Chapter XXI. The Fuselage 430

Hinges . . 422
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Flap- and Tab-Control Loads 423


General Considerations 430

Wing-Fuselage Considerations 430

Shape of Fuselage 432


Hydraulic and Pneumatic Systems 423
Fuselage Length 435

Travel of Controls . 425


Determining Fuselage Lines 435

Irreversible Controls 426


427
Use of the Mockup 436

Analytical Studies of Fuselage Structure 437


Detail Requirements
Controls . 427
Engine Controls . 427
Electrical Systems . 429
Chapter XXI. The Fuselage 430
General Considerations . . 430
Wing-Fuselage Considerations 430
Shape of Fuselage 432
Fuselage Length . . . 435
Determining Fuselage Lines . 435
r se or the Mockup . . . . . 436
Analytical Studies of Fuselage Structure 437

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
xx AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
XX

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Frames and Their Location . 440
Frames and Their Location 440

Longitudinal Stringers and Their Location . 444


Fuselage Skin . 446
Longitudinal Stringers and Their Location 444

Fuselage Skin 446

Windows 447
Windows . 447
Pressurized Cabins 447

Pressurized Cabins 447


Flooring 449

Doors and Exits 449


Flooring 449
Access Doors 449
Doors and Exits 449
Baggage Compartments 450
Acee~ Doors 449
Twin Fuselages 450

Baggage Compartments 450


Twin Fuselages 450
Tail Booms 450

Alternate Type Structures 451

Effect of Fuselage Mass Distribution 453


Tail Booms 450
Chapter XXII. Preliminary Performance Calculations. . 454
Alternate Type Structures 451
Source of Data 454

Calculations for Horsepower Required 455


Effect of Fuselage Mass Distribution 453
Altitude Corrections 459

Arbitrary Standard Atmosphere 459


Chapter XXII. Preliminary Performance Calculations. 454
Parasite Resistance Data 460

The Engine 461


Source of Data . 454
Horsepower Available 462
Calculations for Horsepower Required 455
Maximum Speed 466

Altitude Corrections . 459


Arbitrary Standard Atmosphere 459
Rate of Climb 468

Absolute and Service Ceilings 468

Range 468 Parasite Resistance Data 460


Performance Requirements 470

The Engine 461


Take-off Performance with All Engines Functioning Normally . 470

Performance in Air with All Engines Functioning Normally . 471


Horsepower Available . 462
Performance in Air with One Engine Dead 472
Maximum Speed 466
Landing 473
Rate of Climb . 468
Empirical Formulas 474

Absolute and Service Ceilings . 468


R~~ 4~
Maximum Speed 474

Minimum or Stalling Speed 475

Rate of Climb at Sea Level 475


Performance Requirements 470
Absolute Ceiling 476
Take-off Performance with All Engines Functioning Normally 470
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:45 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Range 476

Index 479
Performance in Air with All Engines Functioning Normally 471
Performance in Air with One Engine Dead 472
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Landing . 473
Empirical Formulas . 474
Maximum Speed . 474
Minimum or Stalling Speed 475
Rate of Climb at Sea Level 475
Absolute Ceiling 476
Range 476
INDEX 479

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:45 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Dig iz
b
AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Original from
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER I

Procedure in Design

No task can be intelligently executed unless a definite goal has been set

and a line of attack or orderly form of procedure has been adopted. There

may be different ways of obtaining the same objective, but mistakes and

unnecessary work will be avoided if a definite plan is made before any real

work starts.

The responsibilities of the designer are many. Not only must he meet

the structural requirements, but also, by proper design, the operational

and performance specifications, and he must be able to produce an air-


CHAPTER I
plane that is economical and safe. For example, it is claimed that two

thirds of the responsibility for aircraft accident prevention lies within the

job of the aircraft designer. Such responsibilities require constant vig-

ilance in checking all phases of the design and in keeping abreast of all

the latest developments.

SELECTING TYPE OF AIRPLANE


Procedure In Design
It is not sufficient to say "Let's build an airplane." The question is:

What kind of airplane—an open or a closed type, a sleek racing mono-

plane, or a large flying boat? The first thing to be done is to write down

a set of such definite specifications that any designer who receives them

may be able to design an airplane which meets the original design pro-

poser's intentions. The procedure is much the same as that of buying a

No ta.sk can be intelligently executed unless a definite goal has been set
family car. The term "family car" immediately sets one specification:

the buyer knows that he is not going to get a truck, or a roadster, or a

racing car. The price that the buyer can meet will set another specifica-

and a line of attack or orderly form of procedure has been adopted. There
tion automatically, and so it goes.

Specifications for an airplane are far more comprehensive. Consider,


may be different ways of obtaining the same objective, but mistakes and
for example, the type of airplane it may be. The airplane to be designed unnecessary work will be avoided if a definite plan is made before any real
may be one of two conventional types, a monoplane or a biplane. If it is

work starts.
3

The responsibilities of the designer are many. Not only must he meet
the structural requirements, but also, by proper design, the operational
and performance specifications, and he must be able to produce an air-
plane that is economical and safe. For example, it is claimed that two
thirds of the responsibility for aircraft accident prevention lies within the
job of the aircraft designer. Such responsibilities require constant vig-
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ilance in checking all phases of the design and in keeping abreast of all
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the latest developments.


SELECTING TYPE OF AIRPLANE
It is not sufficient to say "Let's build an airplane." The question is:
What kind of airplane-an open or a. closed type, a sleek racing mono-
plane, or a large flying boat? The first thing to be done is to write down
a set of such definite specifications that any designer who receives them
may be able to design an airplane which meets the original design pro-
poser's intentions. The procedure is much the same as that of buying a
family car. The term "family car" immediately sets one specification:
the buyer knows that he is not going to get a truck, or a roadster, or a
racing car. The price that the buyer can meet will set another specifica-
tion automatically, and so it goes.
Specifications for an airplane are far more comprehensive. Consider,
for example, the type of airplane it may be. The airplane to be designed
may be one of two conventional types, a monoplane or a biplane. If it is
3
Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
4 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
4

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


a. monoplane, the wing may be unsupported externally, in which case it
a monoplane, the wing may be unsupported externally, in which case it

is known as a full cantilever monoplane; or the wing may be externally sup-


is known a.s a. f uZZ cantilever monoplane; or the wing may be externally sup-
ported either by struts or by wires, in which case it is known as a semi- ported either by struts or by wires, in which case it is known as a. semi-
cantilever monoplane. Moreover, the wing may be placed at the bottom

cantilever monoplane. Moreover, the wing may be placed at the bottom


of the fuselage, when it is known as a low-wing monoplane; or the wing may
of the fuselage, when it is known as a low-wing monoplane; or the wing may

be placed halfway between the top and bottom of the fuselage, so that the

airplane is a midwing monoplane; or again, the wing may be at the top or


be placed halfway between the top and bottom of the fuselage, so that the
above the fuselage, in which case the airplane is known as a high-wing or a

parasol monoplane, respectively.


airplane is a midwing monoplane; or again, the wing may be at the top or
The same variables apply to a biplane. The two wings may not have
above the fuselage, in which case the airplane is known a.s a high-wing or a
the same areas, or the same planform, or the same airfoil. There may be

parasol monoplane, respectively.


large forward or positive stagger of the upper wing relative to the lower,

and perhaps more dihedral for one wing than for the other. The com- The same variables apply to a biplane. The two wings may not have
binations are almost infinite especially when one considers that changes

may be made in structure, in materials, in planform, in stagger, in angle


the same areas, or the same planform, or the same airfoil. There may be
of incidence, in airfoil sections, in decalage, in gap-chord ratios, in wing
large forward or positive stagger of the upper wing relative to the lower,
placement relative to the fuselage, in distribution of wing areas, and a host

and perhaps more dihedral for one wing than for the other. The com-
of other variables.

The variables just noted apply only to the wing. Consider the fuselage.
binations are almost infinite especially when one considers that changes
It may be round, oval, square, elliptical, rectangular, or a combination of may be made in structure, in materials, in planform, in stagger, in angle
these cross sections. It may be shallow or deep; it may be wide or nar-

of incidence, in airfoil sections, in decalage, in gap-chord ratios, in wing


row; it may have an open cockpit or an enclosed cabin; it may be con-

structed of almost any material and in an infinite number of ways. For


placement relative to the fuselage, in distribution of wing areas, and a host
each material and specific function, there is a definite, desirable shape of
of other variables.
fuselage.

The landing gear also offers enormous latitude in design. It may em-
The variables just noted apply only to the wing. Consider the fuselage.
ploy a landing gear having two wheels forward with a tail wheel rearward; It may be round, oval, square, elliptical, rectangular, or a combination of
or the reverse order with a front or nose wheel and two wheels slightly

these cross sections. It may be shallow or deep; it may be wide or nar-


rearward, popularly known as the "tricycle" landing gear. The landing

gear may have a through-axle of the type used during the early period of
row; it may have an open cockpit or an enclosed cabin; it may be con-
airplane design, or a split-axle type developed later. Moreover, it may
structed of almost any material and in an infinite number of ways. For
be nonretractable or retractable.

These are just a few indications of what the design trend might be.
each material and specific function, there is a definite, desirable shape of
Familiarity with different types of airplanes will help the potential designer
fuselage.
in determining the type best suited to a specific duty. The designer will

The landing gear also offers enormous latitude in aesign. It may em-
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ploy a landing gear having two wheels forward with a tail wheel rearward;
find it decidedly advantageous to read as widely as possible in the various

technical aeronautical publications and to collect, study, and correlate

or the reverse order with a front or nose wheel and two wheels slightly
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

design details. Thereby his facility in adaptation will be improved.

POWER PLANT

The power plant will be discussed in detail in a subsequent chapter.


rearward, popularly known as the "tricycle" landing gear. The landing
However, a brief discussion of the place the power plant takes in the origi-
gear may have a through-axle of the type used during the early period of
nal specifications may not be amiss here. In many cases, operating com-

airplane design, or a split-axle type developed later. Moreover, it may


be nonretractable or retractable.
These are just a few indications of what the design trend might be.
Familiarity with different types of airplanes will help the potential desi~er
in determining the type best suited to a specific duty. The designer will
find it decidedly advantageous to read as widely as possible in the various
technical aeronautical publications and to collect, study, and correlate
design details. Thereby his facility in adaptation will be improved.

POWER PLANT
The power plant will be discussed in detail in a subsequent chapter.
However, a brief discussion of the place the power plant takes in the origi-
nal specifications may not be amiss here. In many cases, operating com-

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
PROCEDURE IN DESIGN 5
PROCEDURE IN DESIGN

5
panies of aircraft may specify the type and number of engines--either be-
panies of aircraft may specify the type and number of engines—either be-
cause of known fuel economy, or efficiency and dependability under certain
cause of known fuel economy, or efficiency and dependability under certain

operating conditions, or because of possible interchangeability with exist-


operating conditions, or because of possible interchangeability with exist-
ing equipment.
ing equipment.
An airline accustomed to maintaining and operating radial air-cooled

An airline accustomed to maintaining and operating radial air-cooled


engines will be loath to use turboprop engines, for example, since its

personnel may not be trained or sufficiently experienced to handle the


engines will be loath to use turboprop engines, for example, since its
new type of engine.

personnel may not be trained or sufficiently experienced to handle the


The reasons for choosing a certain engine may be many, and the section

on power plants should be studied before writing the specifications. The'


new type of engine.
specifications may designate a particular engine, although it is more likely

The reasons for choosing a certain engine may be many, and the section
that the number of engines will be designated, for it is quite possible to

obtain one engine or two engines delivering the same total horsepower.
on power plants should be studied before writing the specifications. The ··
PAYLOAD AND CREW
specifications may designate a particular engine, although it is more likely
The payload includes all load from which revenue is obtained. It in-

that the number of engines will be designated, for it is quite possible to


cludes passengers, mail, baggage, and express. The crew includes pilot,

co-pilot, mechanics, navigators, radio men, stewards, and any other em-
obtain one engine or two engines delivering the same total horsepower.
ployee required for specialized work.

Military airplanes have a different type of payload, usually called fixed

PAYLOAD AND CREW


equipment or disposable load, as the case may be. This consists of guns,

ammunition, bombs, and other military equipment. Special provision The payload includes all load from which revenue is obtained. It in-
must be made for these; therefore, these items have a definite bearing on

cludes passengers, mail, baggage, and express. The crew includes pilot,
the airplane type as well as the weight permitted.

The gross weight of the airplane is largely dependent upon the require-
co-pilot, mechanics, navigators, radio men, stewards, and any other em-
ments for payload and crew. It should be quite obvious that if a crew of
ployee required for specialized work.
three (a pilot, a co-pilot and a radio man, for example) is required, some

provision must be made for it, and such provision will affect the size of
Military airplanes have a different type of payload, usually called fixed
the cockpit as well as the fuselage and eventually the gross weight. Like-
equipment or disposable load, as the case may be. This consists of guns,
wise, provision for mail and express will be entirely different from provi-

ammunition, bombs, and other military equipment. Special provision


sion for passengers.

The larger the aircraft becomes, the larger the crew is likely to be.
must be made for these; therefore, these items have a definite bearing on
Some indication of the eventual size of the airplane to be designed can be
the airplane type as well as the weight permitted.
gained by looking at the size of crew required. In the same way, the

number of passengers carried has a direct bearing on the size of the fuse-
The gross weight of the airplane is largely dependent upon the require-
lage and the gross weight: the greater the number of passengers to be car-
ments for payload and crew. It should be quite obvious that if a crew of
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ried, the larger and wider and higher the cabin, and therefore the fuselage

three (a pilot, a co-pilot and a radio man, for example) is required, some
will be larger. Not only does the increased number of passengers increase

provision must be made for it, and such provision will affect the size of
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the weight, but the structure will also weigh more because of increased size.

Actually, the gross weight of the airplane can be estimated if the weight
the cockpit as well as the fuselage and eventually the gross weight. Like-
of the payload, crew, fuel, and oil are known since an analysis of a large

class of airplanes shows that there is a definite relationship between the


wise, provision for mail and express will be entirely different from provi-
two weights.
sion for passengers.
The larger the aircraft becomes, the larger the crew is likely to be.
Some indication of the eventual size of the airplane to be designed can be
gained by looking at the size of crew required. In the same way, the
number of passengers carried has a direct bearing on the size of the fuse-
lage and the gross weight: the greater the number of passengers to be car-
ried, the larger and wider and higher the cabin, and therefore the fuselage
will be larger. Not only does the increased number of pas~engers increase
the weight, but the structure will also weigh more because of increased size.
Actually, the gross weight of the airplane can be estimated if the weight
of the payload, crew, fuel, and oil are known since an analysis of a large
cl~ of airplanes shows that there is a definite relationship between the
two weights.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
6 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
6

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


It is very important to know as much as possible about the load the
It is very important to know as much as possible about the load the

airplane is to carry because these are the items for which the designer has
to make proper provision although he may have little or no control over
airplane is to carry because these are the items for which the designer has

to make proper provision although he may have little or no control over

their weight, size, or location in the airplane.


their weight, size, or location in the airplane.
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS

PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
Unless the airplane is designed for private use, the performance require-

ments are set by the ultimate purchaser. It takes but little thought to

realize that the keen competition among American airlines requires the

Unless the airplane is designed for private use, the performance require-
ments are set by the ultimate purchaser. It takes but little thought to
speed of the airplane to be as high as possible in order to obtain attractive

schedules. But where there is less competition, a far slower airplane

may be desirable because of the smaller horsepower and less fuel required
realize that the keen competition among American airlines requires the
to carry practically the same load.

Likewise, an airplane operating over mountainous territory will need a


speed of the airplane to be as high as possible in order to obtain attractive
high service ceiling in order to clear the mountains, whereas a low service
schedules. But where there is less competition, a far slower airplane
ceiling would do over low level country.

may be desirable because of the smaller horsepower and less fuel required
The performance required for the airplane will have a direct bearing on

the number, type, and horsepower of the engines, as well as the type and
to carry practically the same load.
design of wing, fuselage, and perhaps landing gear. The ultimate criterion

of a good airplane is its performance in relation to the load carried and the
Likewise, an airplane operating over mountainous territory will need a
conditions to be met.
high service ceiling in order to clear the mountains, whereas a low service
STEP-BY-STEP PROCEDURE

The foregoing discussion deals with specifications which are only part
ceiling would do over low level country.
of the work to be considered in designing the airplane. From the moment The performance required for the airplane will have a direct bearing on
a new design is contemplated until the final drawing leaves the drawing

the number, type, and horsepower of the engines, as well as the type and
design of wing, fuselage, and perhaps landing gear. The ultimate criterion
board, a definite plan is followed in evolving the design. The individual

steps of the plan may not always be clear-cut, and sometimes several

phases are carried along in parallel sequence. The following procedure


of a good airplane is its performance in relation to the load carried and the
may be gainfully employed.

1. Study of specifications to fix the more important items having im-


conditions to be met.
mediate import in the preliminary design steps.

2. Study of similar purpose airplanes to determine the possible types


STEP-BY-STEP PROCEDURE
which may be considered as meeting the over-all specifications.

3. Power plant survey for the selection of the likely engine or engines
The foregoing discussion deals with specifications which are only part
to be used in the design.
of the work to be considered in designing the airplane. From the moment
4. Preliminary three-view, or views, to narrow down the number of

a new design is contemplated until the final drawing leaves the drawing
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

board, a definite plan is followed in evolving the design. The individual


possible solutions and to present a framework on which the work that fol-

lows will depend.

steps of the plan may not always be clear-cut, and sometimes several
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

5. Preliminary weight estimate based upon the data and information

obtained in the first four steps.

6. Airfoil selection to obtain the ultimate performance desired.


phases are carried along in parallel sequence. The following procedure
may be gainfully employed.
1. Study of specifications to fix the more important items having im-
mediate import in the preliminary design steps.
2. Study of similar purpose airplanes to determine the possible types
which may be considered as meeting the over-all specifications.
3. Power plant survey for the selection of the likely engine or engines
to be used in the design.
4. Preliminary three-view, or views, to narrow down the number of
possible solutions and to present a framework on which the work that fol-
lows will depend.
5. Preliminary weight estimate based upon the data and information
obtained in the first four steps.
6. Airfoil selection to obtain the ultimate performance desired.

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PROCEDURE IN DESIGN 7
PROCEDURE IN DESIGN

7 7. Balance diagram to fix the items of equipment and structure in


7. Balance diagram to fix the items of equipment and structure in

proper relation to each other for purposes of design, stability, and effec-
proper relation to each other for purposes of design, stability, and effec-

tiveness.
tiveness.
8. Inboard profile to check upon installation of equipment and to pro-
8. Inboard profile to check upon installation of equipment and to pro-
vide studies of interior arrangement.

9. Structural layout (work on the various units usually carried on


vide studies of interior arrangement.
simultaneously in order to take proper care of the interrelation of the 9. Structural layout (work on the various units usually carried on
component parts) somewhat in the following order.

simultaneously in order to take proper care of the interrelation of the


(a) Wing with reference to fuselage.

(b) Landing gear with reference to wing or fuselage.


component parts) somewhat in the following order.
(c) Tail surfaces with reference to fuselage.
(a) Wing with reference to fuselage.
(b) Landing gear with reference to wing or fuselage.
(d) Fuselage.

(e) Power plant with reference to wing or fuselage, or both.

10. Final three-view from data obtained in the course of working on (c) Tail surfaces with reference to fuselage.
balance diagram, inboard profile, and structural layouts.

(d) Fuselage.
11. Preliminary longitudinal, directional, and lateral stability calcula-

tions performed at time of airfoil selection, balance calculations, and three-


(e) Power plant with reference to wing or fuselage, or both.
view conception.
10. Final three-view from data obtained in the course of working on
12. Preliminary control calculations made along with preliminary sta-

bility calculations.
balance diagram, inboard profile, and structural layouts.
13. PreUminary performance calculations carried along simultaneously 11. Preliminary longitudinal, directional, and lateral stability calcula-
with other calculations.

14. Preliminary stress analysis according to military or civil require-


tions performed at time of airfoil selection, balance calculations, and three-
ments.
view conception.
15. Revised structural drawings with added information for the prepa-

12. Preliminary control calculations made along with preliminary sta-


ration of detailed design drawings.

16. Check all parts of the design and revise where necessary.
bility calculations.
These steps are discussed in considerable detail in subsequent chapters. 13. Preliminary performance calculations carried along simultaneously
More familiarity with the problem of airplane design will often suggest

alternative procedures.
with other calculations.
In practice, practically all these steps are carried along simultaneously
14. Preliminary stress analysis according to military or civil require-
because a number of men may be employed on the project, but even so the

ments.
initial work is usually done by one man. In practice, too, a mock-up of

the proposed design is made so that many design studies may be made on
15. Revised structural drawings with added information for the prepa-
the mock-up rather than on paper. In the classroom, suitable compro- ration of detailed design drawings.
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

mises must be made.

16. Check all parts of the design and revise where necessary.
NOMENCLATURE

These steps are discussed in considerable detail in subsequent chapters.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

In any discussion, it is necessary to understand the words used. Ordi-

narily, it would be assumed that the student is familiar with the names of

all the parts of the airplane; certainly he should be reasonably well in-
More familiarity with the problem of airplane de~ign will often suggest
formed on matters dealing with aerodynamics and the internal-combustion

alternative procedures.
In practice, practically all these steps are carried along simultaneously
because a number of men may be employed on the project, but even so the
initial work is usually done by one man. In practice, too, a mock-up of
the proposed design is made so that many design studies may be made on
the mock-up rather than on paper. In the classroom, suitable compro-
mises must be made.
NOMENCLATURE
In any discussion, it is necessary to understand the words used. Ordi-
narily, it would be assumed that the student is familiar with the names of
all the parts of the airplane; certainly he should be reasonably well in-
formed on matters dealing with aerodynamics and the internal-combustion

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

00
c

~ Stablliz~r
()
0 ::a..
~
&
-
~ ------.
~
::a..
~
~
~
~
c=
:z
< \
SB o
~ --
\
~
:< '9' ~
o~ ~
:c a3
"T'1 -

t1
I""'* ~

:c
~
z

FIGURJl 1-1. A three-quarter view of a twin-engine monoplane with the main component.a named.
PROCEDURE IN DESIGN 9
PROCEDURE IN DESIGN

engine. However, it may be that he is not too well informed on names of


structural details. Figure I-1 will be useful for reference and in establish-
engine. However, it may be that he is not too well informed on names of

structural details. Figure 1-1 will be useful for reference and in establish-

ing some standardization of terms. ing some standardization of terms.


REFERENCES

Much research and design material may be found in technical reports,

REFERENCES
memoranda, and notes issued by the National Advisory Committee for

Aeronautics (NACA) and published by the Government Printing Office Much research and design material may be found in technical reports,
in Washington, D. C.

Young engineers should become familiar with the current literature to


memoranda, and notes issued by the National Advisory Committee for
be found in various trade journals of the industry and in the journals of
Aeronautics (NACA) and published by the Government Printing Office
the several engineering societies.

in Washington, D. C.
Young engineers should become familiar with the current literature to
Much of airplane design is empirical, at least in the project stage, so that

all the research that may be brought to bear on the design will be particu-

larly fruitful. be found in various trade journals of the industry and in the journals of
the several engineering societies.
Much of airplane design is empirical, at least in the project stage, so that
all the research that may be brought to bear on the design will be particu-
larly fruitful.
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig IZ
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
CHAPTER II

Types of Airplanes

Many considerations enter into the selection of a particular type of

airplane to meet a given specification, and, therefore, it is well to know

the characteristics of each type before deciding definitely on any one type.

Airplanes may be classified in various ways, according to structure, meth-

od of construction, number of engines, type of landing gear, weight,


CHAPTER II
purpose, and any other variation which an airplane may have.

In the specific descriptions given here, it should be borne in mind that

the advantages and disadvantages indicated for the various types have to

be properly evaluated since, in all, certain compromises must be made.

In some cases the advantages, when properly considered, are more impor-

tant than any possible disadvantage. In many cases, the general "eye
Types of Airplanes
appeal" is also a deciding factor in the selection of the final design. Any

statements made in the discussion that follows should not, therefore, be

applied immediately to any existing design.

THE BIPLANE

Historically the multibay biplane was favored because the art of aero-

dynamics had not yet progressed to the point where the thick airfoil was

favored, much less visualized. Economical and light design indicated the

truss as the most convenient type of structure, although the multibay lift
Many considerations enter into the selection of a particular type of
truss eventually gave way to the single-bay lift truss. In a few cases, even

the bracing between the upper and lower wing became more and more sim-
airplane to meet a given specification, and, therefore, it is well to know
plified so that either only the interplane strut remained or none at all.
the characteristics of each type before deciding definitely on any one type.
The biplane lift truss makes for efficient structural design, small over-all

Airplanes may be classified in various ways, according to structure, meth-


od of construction, number of engines, type of landing gear, weight,
dimensions, and lends itself to a variety of solutions as well as permitting

the use of relatively thin airfoil sections.

Even though the braced biplane may permit use of thinner and lower purpose, and any other variation which an airplane may have.
In the specific descriptions given here, it should be borne in mind that
drag airfoils, still the resistance offered by the additional bracing and in-

terferences may more than offset the lesser wing drag.

10
the advantages and disadvantages indicated for the various types have to
be properly evaluated since, in all, certain compromises must be made.
In some cases the advantages, when properly considered, are more impor-
tant than any possible disadvantage. In many cases, the general "eye
appeal" is also a deciding factor in the selection of the final design. Any
statements made in the discussion that follows should not, therefore, be
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

applied immediately to any existing design.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

THE BIPLANE
Historically the multibay biplane was favored because the art of aero-
dynamics had not yet progressed to the point where the thick airfoil was
favored, much less visualized. Economical and light design indicated the
truss as the most convenient type of structure, although the multibay lift
truss eventually gave way to the single-bay lift truss. In a few cases, even
the bracing between the upper and lower wing became more and more sim-
plified so that either only the interplane strut remained or none at all.
The biplane lift truss makes for efficient structural design, small over-all
dimensions, and lends Itself to a variety of solutions as well as permitting
the use of relatively thin airfoil sections.
Even though the braced biplane may permit use of thinner and lower
drag airfoils, still the resistance offered by the additional bracing and in-
terferences may more than offset the lesser wing drag.
10

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 11
TYPES OF AIRPLANES

11 The biplane is open to an almost infinite number of variations since any


The biplane is open to an almost infinite number of variations since any

or all of the following geometric arrangements are possible.


or all of the following geometric arrangements are possible.
1. Different airfoils for the upper and lower wings.

1. Difierent airfoils for the upper and lower wings.


2. Varying decalage, that is, the upper wing at a different angle of in-
2. Varying decalage, that is, the upper wing at a different angle of in-

cidence than the lower.

3. Different dihedral for the upper and lower wings.


cidence than the lower.
4. Different aspect ratios for the two wings.

5. Any degree of positive or negative stagger.


3. Difierent dihedral for the upper and lower wings.
6. Varying gap-chord ratios.
4. Different aspect ratios for the two wings.
7. Different planforms for the two wings.

5. Any degree of positive or negative stagger.


6. Varying gap-chord ratios.
8. Ailerons on either upper or lower wing, or on both.

9. Different sweepback for the two wings.

10. Various possible bracing arrangements. 7. Different planforms for the two wings.
Figure I1-1. A typical biplane is shown. The crossed single lines represent the

lift and landing wires. The over-all dimensions of the airplane are smaller than for
8. Ailerons on either upper or lower wing, or on both.
the monoplane and there are more design variables to consider. Generally, the biplane
9. Difierent sweepback for the two wings.
has more parasite and interference drag than a monoplane designed for the same purpose

10. Various possible bracing arrangements.


All these variations, however, can also introduce a great amount of

work in preparing the design and in the process of manufacture, so that

the more variations the design has, the more expensive it is likely to be.

THE SESQUIPLANE

A biplane that has a lower wing considerably smaller than the upper

is called a sesquiplane. The reverse order in the size of the two wings

has also been used. Such a design may be resorted to in order to provide

adequate landing-gear attachments and to afford an opportunity to in-

crease the tread of the wheels. Bracing between wings may be employed.

Such a design may be of particular usefulness in rugged terrain where

FIGURE 11-1. A typical biplane is shown. The crossed single lines represent the
ground stability in landing and taxying is particularly important, and

where the high wing will be out of the way of underbrush and other
lift a.nd landing wires. The over-all dimensions of the airplane a.re smaller than for
obstructions.
the monoplane and there are more design variables to consider. Generally, the biplane
THE MULTIWTNG AIRPLANE
has more parasite and interference drag than a monoplane designed for the same purpose
As the number of wings is increased, the less aerodynamically efficient

the airplane becomes. Although multiwing airplanes, such as triplanes,


All these variations, however, can also introduce a great amount of
have been built, they may be considered as curiosities rather than as sound
work in preparing the design and in the process of manufacture, so that
designs to be critically considered.

the more variations the design has, the more expensive it is likely to be.
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

THE SESQUIPLANE
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

A biplane that has a lower wing considerably smaller than the upper
is called a sesquiplane. The reverse order in the size of the two wings
has also been used. Such a design may be resorted to in order to provide
adequate landing-gear attachments and to afford an opportunity to in-
crease the tread of the wheels. Bracing between wings may be employed.
Such a design may be of particular usefulness in rugged terrain where
groWld stability in landing and taxying is particularly important, and
where the high wing will be out of the way of underbrush and other
obstructions. '
THE MULTIWING AIRPLANE
As the number of wings is increased, the less aerodynamically efficient
the airplane becomes. Although multiwing airplanes, such as triplanes;
have been built, they may be considered as curiosities rather than as sound
designs to be critically considered.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
12 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
12

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


THE IIlGH-WING MONOPLANE
THE HIGH-WING MONOPLANE

The design that became popular after the biplane was the externally
The design that became popular after the biplane was the externally
braced high-wing monoplane. When externally braced, the wing is said
braced high-wing monoplane. When externally braced, the wing is said
to be semicantilever. (See Figure II-2.) The lift strut supports the

to be semicantilever. (See Figure Il-2.) The lift strut supports the


wing and thereby reduces the bending moments sufficiently to make for a
wing and thereby reduces the bending moments sufficiently to make for a

lighter structure. A thin airfoil, although somewhat thicker than an air-

foil employed on a biplane, still offers less resistance and permits reason- lighter structure. A thin airfoil, although somewhat thicker than an air-
ably high-speed performance.

foil employed on a biplane, still offers less resistance and permits reason-
The struts are attached (as all external bracing should be) by a single

bolt at each end (with the head of the bolt facing forward), so that the
ably high-speed performance.
normal loads, acting either upward or downward, will impose bending
The struts are attached (as all external bracing should be) by a single
moments and shear on the wing structure proper but induce only axial

loads in the struts or wires.


bolt at each end (with the head of the bolt facing forward), so that the
Fig. II-2 Fiq. II-3
normal loads, acting either upward or downward, will impose bending
Figure II-2. A semicantilever high-wing monoplane braced by a V strut. This

moments and shear on the wing structure proper but induce only axial
loads in the struts or wires.
arrangement permits a simplified fitting design at the apex of the V. The arrangements

of the struts may be varied. Such bracing permits use of thinner airfoils and efficient

structural configurations.

Figure I1-3. A full cantilever high-wing design with a power-plant installation in

the tail where the effect of propeller interference and slip stream do not affect the

aerodynamic qualities of the wing.

In order to reduce the column length of the external struts, so-called

jury struts are interposed between the wing and the lift strut, just below

the upper end of the lift strut. The juncture of the jury and the lift strut

is a hinge or pin joint, and the upper end of the jury strut is also a pin-

connected fitting attached to the wing spar.

The chord loads are applied to the internal drag structure of the wing

and are assumed not to act on the lift bracing.

The lift struts may be placed parallel to each other in the most common Fig. 11-2 FIG. 11-3
arrangement, although carrying the lift struts down to the fuselage to

form a V is often done to eliminate one fitting and perhaps to offer better
FIGURE 11-2. A semicantilever high-wing monoplane braced by a V strut. This
access to the door which may be located at the rear strut.
arrangement permits a simplified fitting design at the apex of the V. The arrangements
The V may be so arranged also that the apex of the V is at the rear-
of the struts may be varied. Such bracing permits use of thinner airfoils and efficient
strut fitting instead of the front-strut fitting. There are also other pos-
structural configurations.
FIGURE 11-3. A full cantilever high-wing design with a power-plant installation in
sible variations with the struts both carried farther forward to a point of
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the tail where the effect of propeller interference and slip stream do not affect the
aerodynamic qualities of the wing.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

In order to reduce the column length of the external struts, so-called


jury struts are interposed between the wing and the lift strut, just below
the upper end of the lift strut. The juncture of the jury and the lift strut
is a hinge or pin joint, and the upper end of the jury strut is also a pin.-
connected fitting attached to the wing spar.
The chord loads are applied to the internal dra.g structure of the wing
and are assumed not to act on the lift bracing.
The lift struts may be placed parallel to each other in the most common
arrangement, although carrying the lift struts down to the fuselage to
form a Vis often done to eliminate one fitting and perhaps to offer better
access to the door which may be located at the rear strut.
The V may be so arranged also that the apex of the Vis at the rear-
strut fitting instead of the front-strut fitting. There are also other pos-
sible variations with the struts both carried farther forward to a point of

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 13
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 13

attachment on the fuselage. The advantage of this arrangement lies in

attachment on the fuselage. The advantage of this arrangement lies in


the possibility of combining lift-strut fittings with landing-gear strut fit-
the possibility of combining lift-strut fittings with landing-gear strut fit-

tings, or in the possibility of applying reactions to the wing-drag truss to

counteract the chord force components exerted on the drag truss.


tings, or in the possibility of applying reactions to the wing-drag truss to
Fig. II-6 Fig. II-7

Fiqure II-4. A low-wing monoplane with a twin vertical tail surface arrangement
counteract the chord force components exerted on the drag truss.
which may be used to reduce the over-all height of the airplane; or, to operate more

effectively in the slip stream of a twin-engine design; or, to avoid the "blanketing"

effect of the fuselage. Twin vertical tail surfaces may help to increase the "apparent"

aspect ratio of the horizontal tail surfaces.

Figure II-5. A midwing design with a jet-engine installation. The dihedral in-

corporated in the horizontal tail surfaces installation brings these surfaces into a more

uniform downwash distribution across the span. The air scoops of the jet engines are

in the jet engine nacelle, with the exhaust in the rear.

Fiqube II-6. A so-called butterfly tail combines the functions of the vertical and

horizontal tail surfaces in this midwing monoplane, thereby simplifying the empennage

structure.

Fiqube II-7. The inverted gull wing designed to raise the propeller axis of the

centrally located engine while still bringing the wing down to permit a landing gear

with short members suitable for retraction. Acute angles are also avoided at the inter-
Fig. II-4 Fig. 11-5
section of the wing with the fuselage, thus eliminating need for fillets. The dotted lines

show the position of the wing when partially folded for stowage purposes.

The cross sections of these lift struts are usually symmetrical airfoils of

small thickness ratio and large fineness ratio. It is possible to envelop

both lift struts in an airfoil in order to add to the lift, but such additional

lift is comparatively small in usual designs.

Fig. II-6 Fig. 11-7


FIGURE II-4. A low-wing monoplane with a. twin vertical tail surface arrangement
which may be used to reduce the over-all height of the airplane; or, to operate more
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

effectively in the slip stream of a. twin-engine design; or, to avoid the "blanketing"
effect of the fuselage. Twin vertical tail surfaces may help to increase the "apparent"
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

aspect ratio of the horizontal tail surfaces.


FIGURE II-5. A midwing design with a jet-engine installation. The dihedral in-
corporated in the horizontal tail surfaces installation brings these surfaces into a more
uniform downwash distribution a.cross the span. The air scoops of the jet engines are
in the jet engine nacelle, with the exhaust in the rear.
FIGURE Il-6. A so-called butterfly tail combines the functions of the vertical and
horizontal tail surfaces in this midwing monoplane, thereby simplifying the empennage
structure.
FIGURE II-7. The inverted gull wing designed to raise the propeller axis of the
centrally located engine while still bringing the wing down to permit a landing gear
with short members suitable for retraction. Acute angles are also a.voided at the inter-
section of the wing with the fuselage, thus eliminating need for fillets. The dotted line15
show the position of the wing when partially folded for stowage purposes.

The cross sections of these lift struts are usually symmetrical airfoils of
small thickness ratio and large fineness ratio. It is possible to envelop
both lift struts in an airfoil in order to add to the lift, but such additional
lift is comparatively small in usual designs.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
14 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
14

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


FIGURE II-8. A jet engine design
Figure II-8. A jet engine design with air inlets along the fuselage. A
with air inlets along the fuselage. A single nose inlet in the fuselage is also
single nose inlet in the fuselage is also
used. The exhaust is in the extreme
used. The exhaust is in the extreme
end of the fuselage tail. The wing-tip
end of the fuselage tail. The wing-tip
fuel tanks are droppable although their
fuel tanks are droppable although their

expense may prohibit such procedure,


expense may prohibit such procedure,

and are so located to reduce aerody-


and are so located to reduce aerody-

namic resistance; they may affect the


namic resistance; they may affect the

stability of the airplane because of in-


stability of the airplane because of in-

creased moments of inertia about the


creased moments of inertia about the

axes of the airplane.


axes of the airplane.

Figure II-9. A high-wing mono-

plane with a pusher-type engine install-

ation designed to reduce noise in the

cabin, to obtain a more favorable center


FIGURE II-9. A high-wing mono-
of gravity location for certain designs,
plane with a pusher-type engine install-
and, perhaps primarily, to afford the
ation designed to reduce noise in the
best possible view forward.
cabin, to obtain a more favorable center
Figure 11-10. A small pusher air-
of gravity location for certain designs,
plane with twin booms supporting the
and, perhaps primarily, to afford the
tail surfaces. The booms help to iso- best possible view forward.
late the engine but are brought about

primarily by the engine location.

FIGURE 11-10. A small pusher air-


Figure 11-11. A canard pusher-

plane with twin booms supporting the


type airplane of unusual design with

tail surfaces. The booms help to iso-


the horizontal tail surfaces ahead of

the wing and the vertical tail surfaces

at the wing tips.


late the engine but are brought about
The high-wing monoplane affords excellent vision downward, which is
primarily by the engine location.
v especially useful in landing. Vision upward and toward the sides is, of

course, impeded.

It is difficult to obtain a wide tread for the landing gear unless a long
FIGURE II-11. A canard pusher-
supporting strut is carried to the wing, or a sturdy structure is built to

type airplane of unusual design with


support the landing gear.

the horizontal tail surfaces ahead of


Generated on 2012-05-30 00:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The retraction of the landing gear becomes particularly difficult in this

the wing and the vertical tail surfaces


type of design because the wheels cannot easily be retracted into wells

at the wing tips.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

located in the fuselage. It is even more difficult if the landing gear is

retracted into the wings because the struts would have to be retracted as

well.

The incorporation of flaps and, in general, various lift-increase devices

is made easier in the high-wing design since ground clearance with de-

The high-wing monoplane affords excellent vision downward, which is


especially useful in landing. Vision upward and toward the sides is, of
course, impeded.
It is difficult to obtain a wide tread for the landing gear unless a long
supporting strut is carried to the wing, or a sturdy structure is built to
support the landing gear.
The retraction of the landing gear becomes particularly difficult in this
type of design because the wheels cannot easily be retracted into wells
located in the fuselage. It is even more difficult if the landing gear is
retracted into the wings because the struts would have to be retracted as
well.
The incorporation of flaps and, in general, various lift-increase devices
is made easier in the high-wing design since ground clearance with de-

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 15
TYPES OF AIRPLANES

FIGURE 11-12. A proposed design


15

Figure 11-12. A proposed design

with a jet actuated propeller. Since


with a jet actuated propeller. Since

the blade tips operate at rather high


speeds, a jet engine may attain a rea-
the blade tips operate at rather high

sonable efficiency at the propeller tip


speeds, a jet engine may attain a rea-

sonable efficiency at the propeller tip

location. The air scoops for the jet


location. The air scoops for the jet
engine are in the leading edge of the
engine are in the leading edge of the
root section of the wing.
root section of the wing.
Figure 11-13. A multi-engine

FIGURE 11-13. A multi-engine


monoplane incorporating a triple ver-

tical tail surface arrangement in order

monoplane incorporating a triple ver-


to obtain the necessary directional con-

tical tail surface arrangement in order


to obtain the necessary directional con-
trol, especially when one or more en-

gines fail.

Figure 11-14. This multi-engine


trol, e,specia.lly when one or more en-
design uses a pusher installation in or-
gines fail.
der to obtain a more favorable center

of gravity location, to keep the plane


FIGURE Il-14. This multi-engine
of propeller rotation clear of personnel
design uses a pusher installation in or-
in the cabin, to simplify the engine der to obtain a more favorable center
nacelle construction and engine ar- of gravity location, to keep the plane
rangement by placing the units in a
of propeller rotation clear of personnel
straight row, and to move the control
in the ca.bin, to simplify the engine
cabin as far forward as possible for
nacelle construction and engine ar-
visibility.

rangement by placing the units in a


fleeted or extended flap does not become one of the primary design con-

straight row, and to move the control


siderations.

cabin as far forward as possible for


As far as wing locations on the fuselage are considered, the high wing is

visibility.
aercdynamically superior, for it has both greater lift and less aerodynamic

resistance than if the same wing were placed at the bottom of the fuselage.

While the internally braced wing or full cantilever wing is aerody-


fleeted or extended flap does not become one of the primary design con-
namically better because of the absence of lift struts (see Figure 11-13), the

landing gear offers a special problem in obtaining an adequate tread and


siderations.
suitable shock-absorbing qualities. A wide tread would mean long land-
AB far as wing locations on the fuselage are considered, the high wing is
ing-gear struts at a shallow angle to the ground so that the shock-absorbing

aerodynamically superior, for it has both greater lift and less aerodynamic --!-
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

resistance than if the same wing were placed at the bottom of the fuselage.
medium is likely to function unsatisfactorily.

Struts may be carried from the landing gear to the wing to serve merely

While the internally braced wing or full cantilever wing is aerody-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

as a support for the gear in order to obtain a reasonably wide tread.

Another variation of the high-wing monoplane is the parasol type where

the open cabane is interposed between the fuselage and the wing. Such
namically better because of the absence of lift struts (see Figure Il-13), the
an arrangement is particularly suitable for an open cockpit airplane where
landing gear offers a special problem in obtaining an adequate tread and
vision forward for the pilot, especially if he happens to be seated quite far

suitable shock-absorbing qualities. A wide tread would mean long land-


ing-gear struts at a shallow angle to the ground so that the shock-absorbing
back, is desired.

Open cockpit airplanes do not have the general all-weather utility that

enclosed cockpits have and so are seldom seen, although there is a place medium is likely to function unsatisfactorily.
for them for special purposes.

Struts may be carried from the landing gear to the wing to serve merely
as & support for the gear in order to obtain a reasonably wide tread.
Another variation of the high-wing monoplane is the parasol type where
the open ca.bane is interposed between the fuselage and the wing. Such
an arrangement is particularly suitable for an open cockpit airplane where
vision forward for the pilot, especially if he happens to be seated quite far
back, is desired.
Open cockpit airplanes do not have the general all-weather utility that
enclosed cockpits have and so are seldom seen, although there is a place
for them for special purposes.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
16 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
16

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Fig. 11-15

Fig. 11-17

Fig. 11-16

Fig. 11-18

Figure 11-15. A cargo airplane with twin booms supporting the tail surfaces high

and clear of the rear loading area of the fuselage.

Figure 11-16. A twin fuselage monoplane which makes use of twin-engine nacelles

and twin booms. It also suggests the possibility of coupling two monoplanes. Such

a design permits separate functions in the two fuselages without interference.

Figure 11-17. A twin fuselage design with a special compartment for personnel.

Fig. 11-15 Fig. 11-17


Figure 11-18. A monoplane with an unusually wide fuselage of airfoil cross section

designed to obtain certain flying wing advantages with more or less conventional air-

plane design.

The low-wing monoplane has variations similar to the high-wing mono-

plane. The design is excellent for short landing-gear structures, and also

affords a ready means for landing-gear retraction. Vision upward and

toward the sides is excellent, but poor down at the sides. It is often

claimed that low-wing monoplanes are not so stable as high-wing mono-

planes, but a properly designed airplane always has sufficient stability.

Struts may be replaced by wires but this requires a set above and below
Fig. 11-16 Fig. 11-18
the wing. In some racing designs for low-horsepower engines, such de-

signs have been used since the use of thin airfoils would offset, to some
FIGURE 11-15. A cargo airplane with twin booms supporting the tail surfaces high
degree, the resistance of the wires which offer less resistance than struts
and clear of the rear loading area of the fuselage.
do. The wires, of course, cause complications in rigging and mainte-

nance, and, therefore, are not considered favorably by the private flyer.
FIGURE 11-16. A twin fuselage monoplane which makes use of twin-engine nacelles
In general, external bracing, whether used for a biplane or a monoplane, and twin booms. It also suggests the possibility of coupling two monoplanes. Such
should not form too acute an angle at the intersection with the top or bot- a. design permits separate functions in the two fuselages without interference.
tom surface of the wing since it not only offers more aerodynamic re-

sistance when so located, but also is likely to affect adversely the airflow
FIGURE 11-17. A twin fuselage design with a special compartment for personnel.
FIGURE 11-18. A monoplane with an unusually wide fuselage of airfoil cross section
THE LOW-WING MONOPLANE

designed to obtain certain flying wing advantages with more or less conventional air-
plane design.

THE LOW-WING MONOPLANE


Generated on 2012-05-30 00:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The low-wing monoplane has variations similar to the high-wing mono-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

' plane. The design is excellent for short landing-gear structures, and also
t- affords a ready means for landing-gear retraction. Vision upward and
toward the sides is excellent, but poor down at the sides. It is often
claimed that low-wing monoplanes are not so stable as high-wing mono-
planes, but a properly designed airplane always ha~ ~ufficient stability.
Struts may be replaced by wires but this requires a set above and below
the wing. In some racing designs for low-horsepower engines, such de-
signs have been used since the use of thin airfoils would offset, to some
degree, the resistance of the wires which offer less resistance than struts
do. The wires, of course, cause complications in rigging and mainte-
nance, and, therefore, are not considered favorably by the private flyer.
In general, external bracing, whether used for a biplane or a monoplane,
should not form too acute an angle at the intersection with the top or bot-
tom surface of the wing since it not only offers more aerodynamic re-
sistance when so located, but also is likely to affect adversely the airflow

Original from
D191 iz by
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 17
TYPES OF AIRPLANES

over the wing and may, therefore, affect the longitudinal control and sta-
17

over the wing and may, therefore, affect the longitudinal control and sta-

bility of the airplane. bility of the airplane.


To reduce the aerodynamic resistance resulting from the configuration

offered by the juncture of the wing and the fuselage, filleting is resorted to
To reduce the aerodynamic resistance resulting from the configuration
in certain cases. However, filleting increases production complexity and
offered by the juncture of the wing and the fuselage, filleting is resorted to
costs. Another solution to this problem is the so-called inverted gull
in certain cases. However, filleting increases production complexity and
costs. Another solution to this problem is the so-called inverted gull
wing.

A gull-wing monoplane is one that has the root section of the wing

inclined at an angle to the fuselage so that the outer panels of the wing
wmg.
are raised above the fuselage. (See Figure II-7 for example.)

The gull wing eliminates acute angles of intersection between the wing A gull-wing monoplane is one that has the root section of the wing
and the fuselage and thus helps to reduce the parasite resistance. How-

inclined at an angle to the fuselage so that the outer panels of the wing
are raised above the fuselage. (See Figure II-7 for example.)
ever, the design has some structural difficulties in that the construction

of the spars becomes complicated. Such a design improves the vision

upward and sideward over that of the conventional high-wing mono-


The gull wing eliminates acute angles of intersection between the wing
plane. In the case of multi-engine designs, when used for seaplanes and

flying boats, the wing is sufficiently raised to obtain propeller clearances.


and the fuselage and thus helps to reduce the parasite resistance. How-
For the low-wing monoplane, the inverted gull wing permits the fuselage ever, the design has some structural difficulties in that the construction
to be raised above the ground for a single-engine design in order to pro-

of the spars becomes complicated. Such a design improves the vision


vide propeller clearance with the ground. This solution also has the

advantage of reducing the length of landing-gear supports so that re-


upward and sideward over that of the conventional high-wing mono-
traction of the landing gear becomes unnecessary.
plane. In the case of multi-engine designs, when used for seaplanes and
The midwing arrangement for the monoplane has definite aerodynamic

advantages in that its aerodynamic resistance is usually the lowest of the


flying boats, the wing is sufficiently raised to obtain propeller clearances.
various possible wing and fuselage arrangements. Structurally the design For the low-wing monoplane, the inverted gull wing permits the fuselage
offers complications because the spars should have "carry-through" mem-

to be raised above the ground for a single-engine design in order to pro-


bers in the fuselage. Such members interfere with the internal arrange-

ments. This design may also be braced externally, but because the
vide propeller clearance with the ground. This solution also has the
shallow angle between external struts and the wing causes large axial
advantage of reducing the length of landing-gear supports so that re-
loads in the spars, such bracing is usually not considered very desirable.

SPECIAL-PURPOSE AIRPLANES
traction of the landing gear becomes unnecessary.
The midwing arrangement for the monoplane has definite aerodynamic
Recent efforts have been directed toward developing aircraft requiring

short take-off and landing runs. Such aircraft are known as VTOL (for

vertical take-off and landing) and STOL (short take-off and landing). advantages in that its aerodynamic resistance is usually the lowest of the
VTOL aircraft must get off the ground without any roll and clear a 50

various possible wing and fuselage arrangements. Structurally the design


Generated on 2012-05-30 00:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

foot obstacle in 250 feet. STOL aircraft are allowed ground roll, but

must be able to clear a 50 foot obstacle 500 feet from the starting point.
offers complications because the spars should have "carry-through" mem-
bers in the fuselage. Such members interfere with the internal arrange-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Designs known as convertiplanes employ such means as (1) the com-

ments. This design may also be braced externally, but because the
bination of helicopter rotors and normal wings, (2) tiltable wings with

counter-rotating propellers, (3) multi- or "Venetian-blind" flaps and

powerful slipstream effects, and (4) multi-purpose wings which when shallow angle between external struts and the wing causes large axial
loads in the spars, such bracing is usually not considered very desirable.

SPECIAL-PURPOSE AIRPLANES
Recent efforts have been directed toward developing aircraft requiring
short take-off and landing runs. Such aircraft are known as VTOL (for
vertical take-off and landing) and STOL (short take-off and landing).
VTOL aircraft must get off the ground without any roll and clear a 50
foot obstacle in 250 feet. STOL aircraft are allowed ground roll, but
must be able to clear a 50 foot obstacle 500 feet from the starting point.
Designs known as convertiplanes employ such means as (1) the com-
bination of helicopter rotors and normal wings, (2) tiltable wings with
counter-rotating propellers, (3) multi- or "Venetian-blind" flaps and
powerful slipstream effects, and (4) multi-purpose wings which when

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
18 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
18

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

rotating act as a helicopter and when stationary act as ordinary wings.


rotating act as a helicopter and when stationary act as ordinary wings.

There are special craft such as "piggy-back," parasite, drone, and


There are special craft such as "piggy-back," parasite, drone, and
towing, the names of which designate their respective functions.
towing, the names of which designate their respective functions.
FACTORS AFFECTING CHOICE

The discussion thus far has been primarily with reference to the lift truss

FACTORS AFFECTING CHOICE


of the airplane because it is usually the first in the list of considerations in

choosing the type of airplane. However, the discussion has been general.
The discussion thus far has been primarily with reference to the lift truss
of the airplane because it is usually the first in the list of considerations in
The student should not overlook the specific considerations entering in the

choice and in the design of the power plant, the landing gear, the fuselage

structure, the interior arrangements, and the wing. Each of these may choosing the type of airplane. However, the discussion has been general.
have a bearing on the whole.

The student should not overlook the specific considerations entering in the
In determining a suitable type of airplane, the factors affecting the final

design should be listed and then carefully considered with reference to per-
choice and in the design of the power plant, the landing gear, the fuselage
tinent parts of the airplane. Some of these factors will now be considered.
structure, the interior arrangements, and the wing. Each of these may
have a bearing on the whole.
Performance

A high speed requires an aerodynamically "clean" airplane with the

minimum of struts and lifting surfaces. A monoplane seems to be the


In determining a suitable type of airplane, the factors affecting the final
answer.

A rapid-climbing airplane requires either a relatively lowipower or low-


design should be listed and then carefully considered with reference to per-
> thrust loading, or wing loading, or both. If a low-power loading—is.se- tinent parts of the airplane. Some of these factors will now be considered.
lected, then an externally-braced monoplane or biplane is desirable.

High ceiling may be obtained by a low-wing loading and a high aspect

Performance
ratio. A semicantilever monoplane may be the solution.

^ Low landing speeds may be obtained by means of low-wing loading or a A high speed requires an aerodynamically "clean" airplane with the
high maximum lift coefficient, or both. The lift coefficient may be con-

minimum of struts and lifting surfaces. A monoplane seems to be the


siderably increased by means of flaps or other lift-increase devices. A

high-wing monoplane can incorporate these better than a low-wing mono-


answer.
A rapid-~.!i!!ibinK airplane. requires either a relatively low.:J>.Qwer or low-
plane, but a low-wing monoplane may be a better solution in spite of that,

because of other considerations.

Landing-Gear Retraction
"- thrust loading, or wing loading, or both. If a low-power Joa.ding is..se-
If the landing gear is to be retracted, an internally braced, low-wing de-

sign offers the best solution. The struts are shorter, the mechanisms sim-
lected, then an externally-braced monoplane or biplane is desirable.
pler, and in case of a forced landing due to impossibility of lowering the

High ceiling may be obtained by a low-wing loading and a high aspect


ratio. A semica.ntilever monoplane may be the solution.
landing gear caused by some mechanical difficulty, the low wing offers the

best protection.

.:k Low landing speeds may be obtained by means of low-wing loading or a


Generated on 2012-05-30 00:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Structure

^ Some types of structures are better adapted to one kind of airplane than

high maximum lift coefficient, or both. The lift coefficient may be con-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

to another. A tubular steel fuselage is more efficient structurally for a

small airplane than for a very large one. A fabric covering may be satis-
siderably increased by means of flaps or other lift-increase devices. A
high-wing monoplane can incorporate these better than a low-wing mono-
plane, but a low-wing monoplane may be a better solution in spite of that,
because of other considerations.
Landing-Gear Retraction
If the landing gear is to be retracted, an internally braced, low-wing de-
sign offers the best solution. The struts are shorter, the mechanisms sim-
pler, and in case of a forced landing due to impossibility of lowering the
landing gear caused by some mechanical difficulty, the low wing offers the
best protection.
Structure
Some types of structures are better adapted to one kind of airplane than
to another. A tubular steel fuselage is more efficient structurally for a
small airplane than for a very large one. A fabric covering may be satis-

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 19
TYPES OF AIRPLANES

19

factory for externally braced wings and for wings of airplanes whose top
factory for externally braced wings and for wings of airplanes whose top
speed is not much greater than 150 miles per hour.

speed is not much greater than 150 miles per hour.


Special Features

To help in deciding what type is best suited for your design, it is well to

Special Features
list the special features the airplane may have, and then study them in the

light of a particular design being considered. Such features might be: To help in deciding what type is best suited for your design, it is well to
Engines

list the special features the airplane may have, and then study them in the
Air cooled or liquid cooled Pod installation

Radial or in-line Tractor or tandem


light of a particular design being considered. Such features might be:
Single or multiple Cowled or concealed

Jet-propulsion type Maintenance requirements


Engines
Landing gear

Conventional or tricycle Fully cowled, partially cowled,


Air cooled or liquid cooled Pod installation
Retractable or nonretractable or uncowled
Radial or in-line Tractor or tandem
Full cantilever, split axle, or other Land or water type

Single or multiple Cowled or concealed


Type of tires Maintenance requirements

Fuselage
Jet-propulsion type Maintenance requirements
Open cockpit or cabin Location of doors

Reinforced monocoque or tubular Type of cargo


Landing gear
steel Maintenance requirements

Conventional or tricycle Fully cowled, partially cowled,


Retractable or nonretractable or uncowled
Wing

Performance requirements Space for landing gear

Fabric or metal covered Location of engine nacelles


Full cantilever, split axle, or other Land or water type
Wood or metal spars High or low aspect ratio

Internally or externally braced Thickness ratio of airfoil


Type of tires Maintenance requirements
Lift-increase devices Maintenance requirements

Space for fuel tanks


Fuselage
Tail surfaces

Single or multiple surfaces Operating controls


Open cockpit or cabin Location of doors
Location above or below fuselage Maintenance Requirements
Reinforced monocoque or tubular Type of cargo
Tab controls

steel Maintenance requirements


SAMPLE AIRPLANE DATA SHEETS

Wing
The design of airplanes is largely empirical. Thus it is advisable to

study as many airplanes as possible, catalog them under different cate-

gories, and collect as much data as possible on performance, weights,

Performance requirements Space for landing gear


Generated on 2012-05-30 00:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Fabric or metal covered Location of engine nacelles


structure, power, and all other items that may be useful as reference

material in future work. Data collected for a number of airplanes in the

Wood or metal spars High or low aspect ratio


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Internally or externally braced Thickness ratio of airfoil


Lift-increase devices Maintenance requirements
Space for fuel tanks
Tail surfaces
Single or multiple surfaces Operating controls
Location above or below fusela'ge Maintenance .requirements
Tab controls
SAMPLE AIRPLANE DATA SHEETS
The design of airplanes is largely empirical. Thus it is advisable to
study as many airplanes as possible, catalog them under different cate-
gories, and collect as much data as possible on performance, weights,
structure, power, and all other items that may be useful as reference
material in future work. Data collected for a number of airplanes in the

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
20 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
20

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


same category may then be averaged to give empirical values for de-
same category may then be averaged to give empirical values for de-

termining ratios of power or thrust loadings, wing loadings, etc.


termining ratios of power or thrust loadings, wing loadings, etc.
The following condensed airplane data sheet may be taken as a guide

The following condensed airplane data sheet may be taken as a guide


to the type of information that should be collected. It may be expanded

to suit individual needs.


to the type of information that should be collected. It may be expanded
Airplane Data Sheet
to suit individual needs.
Name of Company:

Name of Type:

Price:
Airplane Data Sheet
Name of Company:··························--·---·······-····-···----·------·-----·----------------------------
1. Power Plant

Engine: Horsepower: Rev. per min.: Altitude:

Starter:

Name of Type: ------------------·----------------------------------------------------·-----------·-----------------


Design of exhaust:

Other engine accessories:.

Price: ---------···---·--------··---------·---·-----------------------···----·--------·----------·-- -------------------------


Fuel, gallons:.—

Oil, gallons: — 1. Power Plant


Horsepower: ________ Rev. per min.: ________ Altitude: ________
Location of tanks: -

Type of engine controls:


Engine:
Propeller—Make:

Material:
Starter: -----------·-------------------------------·--·----·-·----·------··--·----·-···---·------··----·-----·--···
Type:

Diameter:
Design of exhaust: ------·-----·-····-·-··--·---·-·--·--·---···--·----·----·-·······-·---·-----··--·-------
Other engine accessories: -·-·--·------·-----·-·-···------·-----·-------------·-···---------------------
Number of blades:

Angular range:

2. Wing1

Airfoil section—Root:
Fuel, gallons: _____ ·-·-·-------·····-------·------· ·---·-------·----------------· ----·---·-··--·-------_·----·--
Midspan:

Oil, gallons: __ ---··----------·-··----------------·--------------------·-------·----·-------·-... _--------·--··-


Tip:

Wing area (including ailerons), Sw:

Location of tanks=--·---------------·---------------------------·--·-·----··-····---·-··------·--·--····----
Span, b:

Chord—Root, Cr\ Type of engine controls: ___ ___ _ ______ __ ____ _ __ ___ -- ------- ------ -- ------------- ---- -------····
Propeller-Make: ___ _______ .___ __ .__.. _____ .. __ ____ ___ ._____ ________.. ___ .____ __ ___....______ .____ ......__
'If biplane statistics are to be listed, repeat these entries for lower wing.

Material: ____ __ ___ ____ _---------· __.. ______________ ---···----- ____ -·------ .. _______________ __
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Type : ._.. __ .__ __ _----.. ___ ....... --..... -- -- ---. -------.. ------.----- --- -- ---------- -- ----.----
Diameter: _____________ ._. ____ .________________ .. .__ ._..._______________ .. ________ .. ___..... _.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Number of blades: -------- -- ---------------------------------------------------- ---- .


Angular range: ___ _______ _.. ____ .. _____ _____ ________ __ .__ ._________ ____ __________ .________ _

2. Wing 1
Airfoil section- Root: ______ ____ _____ _______ ___ _____ __________ _____ __ .-------- ------ ------ --------------
Midspan:. __ .. ___ ______ __ ___________ ________________ _. _____ ___.___ ___ .. _________ ..____ _
Tip: _____________ .____ ____ _.__ __ ......._._____...__ ___ __ ___ .__ ___.___ _... __.__.. ___ ...... .
Wing area (including ailerons), Sw: -------------------------- ------ ----- ----·-------------····
Span, b :.. __________ ________________ ._________________________________ . _____ __ .___ . __.. __ __ .. _.____ .___ ... __......
Chord-Root, CR: __ .. __ _____ ____ ____ ___ __ ____ __ __. ______ ___ ___ __ __ ____ __ __ __ ___ __ .. -- ----- ------------ ----·

1If biplane statistics are to be listed, repeat these entries for lower wing.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 21
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 21

~'ip, CT: ............................................·................................................


Tip, CT: p

Taper ratio, RT:

Aspect ratio, AR:

Mean aerodynamic chord, MAC:


T aper ratio,
. Rr: ..... ....................................................................................... .
Aspect ratio, AR: .... ................... .................................................................
Dihedral:

Sweepback:

Incidence—Root:

Midspan:'
Mean aerodynamic chord, MAC: ...... ....... ........................ .......................... .
Tip:

Length of cantilever tip:


Dihedral:................................................................. .........................................
Length of outer bay:

Sw·eepback: ........................................................................................... ........ .


Length of inner bay:

Length of center section:


Incidence--Root: .......................................................................... ........... ... .
Location of wing spars in per cent of chord—Front:

Rear: Midspan: ......................... .....................................'. ...........


Maximum rib spacing: —-

Aileron area, Sa:


Tip: .. ................................................................................
Flap area, S/r.

Location of center of gravity when fully loaded, in per cent of mean


Length of cantilever tip: ..................... ....... ............... ............ .......... .
Length of outer bay: .............................................. ..... ...... ..... .. ............ ... .
aerodynamic chord: .'

3. Tail surfaces

Stabilizer area, S,:

Elevator area, Sr:


Length of inner bay: ....................................... .................. .. ............. ........
Total horizontal tail surface area, Sh:

Length of center section: ....... .................. ............ . .


Distance from center of gravity loaded to elevator hinge:

Fin area, S/:


Location of wing spars in per cent of chord- Front: .. ..
Rudder area, <Sr:

Total vertical tail surface area, Sv: Rear: .


Distance from center of gravity loaded to rudder hinge: —

Equivalent fin area ahead of center of gravity loaded:


Maximum rib spacing: ................................. ............... .... .
Stabilizer setting with reference to propeller axis:

Aileron area, Sa: .............................. .. .. .. ..... . .. ... .. ... . ...


Flap area, S11: ..............................................................................................
Location of center of gravity when fully loaded, _in per cent of mean
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

aerodynamic chord: ................................................ :.................................


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

3. Tail surfaces

Stabilizer area, S,: ...... ..................................................................................


Elevator area, S,: ......................................................................................... .
Total horizontal tail surface area, Sh: ................................................... .
Distance from center of gravity loaded to elevator hinge: ....................
Fin area, S1: ..................................................................................................
Rudder area, S,: ............................................................................................
Total vertical tail surface area, Sv: ........................................................
Distance from center of gravity loaded to rudder hinge: ........................
Equivalent fin area ahead of center of gravity loaded: ..........................
Stabilizer setting with reference to propeller axis: .... ..............................

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
22 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
22

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

4. Passenger accommodations
4. Passenger accommodat1'.ons
Dimensions of cabin:

Finish:
Dimensions of cabin: -----···---·------------------------------·--------·-------------------------------
Seating (type and weight, size, spacing):....

Finish: ______ ---·-·--------··---- .······-----·---------------------------------------------------------------------


Aisle width:

Aisle height:
Seating (type and weight, size, spacing): ------------------------------------------------··
Windows (type):

Doors and steps (emergency, etc.):


Aisle width: ---·-·-·-··· ··-·-·······-····-·--····----·---·······---·-··--·-·-·--------···--·---····-·-----------
Heating:

Ventilation: Aisle height: ··-··--·----·····--·-····-----·-····------··--·-····-·--···-·----·---·--····----·-···-·-·-··-···---·


Lighting:

Baggage accommodation:
Windows (type): -·-·----··-· --------------·--------·-··-----------------·-···-·----··--------------·-------
Doors and steps (emergency, etc.): ---------·------··--·····-·····--······-··-·-·-------··-·---
Toilets:

5. Pilot's cockpit

Single or dual controls:

Releasable controls:
Heating: --·····--···-··--·····-·-·············----···-····-··-··-····-···············-··-·--·-····-····-----·-----
Angles of vision—Upward:
Ventilation: .. __ .. _._____ --·-·--· ___ .. _______________ ...... ---· .. __ .. ____ ---·- ________ _............ _________ ....
Downward:

Sideward: Lighting: ._.. ____ .__________ ...... _... __________ ...... ____ .. _. ________________ ··--------· ... ___ ----·-------------
Windows and their construction:.

Windshield:
Baggage accommodation: -···-··--·----·-·······-·····--··-··-··--·-·········--·--·-··---------------
Arrangement of seats:

Are seats adjustable? Toilets: ----·········-·--·--·- -·-······-·········--··-···--·-----·----··--·--------·-·······---------·--------------


5. Pilot's cockpit
Are rudder bars adjustable?

Instrument board:

Single or dual controls: ··--··-·····----··---·-···-···-····-----····-----··-···--··-----··-·---------··-


Door (separate for pilot):

6. Auxiliary equipment and accessories

Releasable controls:--······--··-··----···-···············-····-··-·-··-------···-·············-··----··--
Night flying—radio:.

Direction finding:

Navigation instruments, etc.:

Special equipment:
Angles of vision-Upward: --····--·-····-·-····----·····----···--·------------------···----------·--
7. Angles

Downward: __ .. __ --·-·---·-·-·-----------------------------·-··----------------
Landing angle of airplane:

Sideward: -··---------------------·-··---·-·············--···----- .... -·-······--·-


Windows and their construction: --·-------------------------------········-·····--·------------
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Windshield : ______ ------------··-········-··--------·--------·--....... ___________ --·---·····--------------___ ..


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Arrangement of seats : ____ -·-----------------------------------___ ---------------------------------·-···


Are seats adj ustable? ___________ -----------____ --------_________ --------__ ----------------------------···
Are rudder bars adjustable? ························--------------·----------·--····--------········
Instrument board: ········-······-········-····-------------·-----------------------·-············--······
Door (separate for pilot): --------····----·····---------------------------------------··············-·
6. Auxiliary equipment and accessories
Night flying-radio: -----------------------···--·-···········-----------------·-----------------·········
Direction finding: ---·----·---·····--------------·-----·----------------------------------------------------
Navigation instruments, etc.: ---·-----------------------------------·-······--------------·-···--
Special equipment: ---·--······-··-····---·-·-----·-------------------------------·------------------------
7. Angles
Landing angle of airplane: ---------------------------------------- ---------------------------------- ·

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOF ICHIGAN
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 23
TYPES OF AIRPLANES

23

Angle in side elevation between vertical through axle and line connect-
ing center of gravity and axle: _________ ______________________ _____________ _____ _____________ ___ _
Angle in side elevation between vertical through axle and line connect-

ing center of gravity and axle:.

Angle in front elevation between vertical and line joining the center of

gravity and the point of contact with the ground at the outer wheel:
Angle in front elevation between vertical and line joining the center of
Angle between the ground and a line from the point of tangency of the

wheel with the ground to the wing tip on the same side of the plane
gravity and the point of contact with the ground at the outer wheel:
of symmetry of the airplane as the wheel:

Angle between the ground and a line joining the point of contact with

the ground of the deflected tail skid to the tip of the horizontal tail
Angle between the ground and a line from the point of tangency of the
surfaces:

wheel with the ground to the wing tip on the same side of the plane
of symmetry of the airplane as the wheel: ········-·················-···--·-·········-
8. Performance Sea Level Rated Altitude

High speed in mph:

Cruising speed in mph:

Landing speed in mph:


Angle between the ground and a line joining the point of contact with
Climb in fpm: the ground of the deflected tail skid to the tip of the horizontal tail
Climb to 10,000 ft in min:

surfaces : .... ________ -·····-··..........···----····-----_____ ... ···--___________........... _.............__ ... .


Normal range in miles:

Service ceiling in ft:


8. Performance Sea Level Rated Altitude
Fuel capacity in gal:

Normal fuel consumption at


High speed in mph:
cruising speed gal per hr:

9. Miscellaneous
Cruising speed in mph:
Distance from front or rear face of propeller flange to center of gravity
Landing speed in mph:
Climb in f pm:
of airplane loaded:

Type of fuselage construction:

Nose or tail wheel construction:

Climb to 10,000 ft in min:


Type of chassis construction:

Design load f actors—Gust:.


_Normal range in miles:
Service ceiling in ft:
Maneuvering:

Landing:.

Special Conditions:.

Fuel capacity in gal:


Normal fuel consumption at
10. Weights

Weight empty (lb) with liquid if liquid-cooled engine is used:

Payload (lb):.— cruising speed gal per hr:


Disposable load (lb):

9. M·iscellaneous
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Distance from front or rear face of propeller flange to center of gravity


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of airplane loaded: ················-··-······-············--···········-·······-·····-·········---·····


Type of fuselage construction: ·······-···-····-··----------------·····-----·-----···········-··-··
Nose or tail wheel construction: ···-·-----···-···············--·································
Type of chassis construction: -·-····--····-·····-········-·····-··-··-·······-·--···-···-·········-
Design load factors-Gust: --······-·-··----······-·····-·················--··-·-···-···············
Maneuvering: ·····-··········-·······························-·········
Landing: ................................................................... .
Special Conditions: ·-------------------------······-----------------
10. Weights
Weight empty (lb) with liquid if liquid-cooled engine is used: ----------------
Payload (lb): ···-····-····-----------------------····---------------···---------------·············-······-··-·
Disposable load (lb): ··············----····-··············--·-··-··············-····-----·········--·····

Original from
D191 iz by
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
24 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
24 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Normal gross weight loaded (lb): -----·················--··-··-----···-----··---·······-·····


Normal gross weight loaded (lb):

11. Over-all dimensions

11. Over-all dimensions


Span, b:

Length, L:

Height, H:

Tread, T:
Span, b: ····-··················--·-·······--············---··············---·-····--··············-·······-·······
12. Ratios

Weight empty to gross weight (Wb/Wo) •


J.,ength, L: ··--·····--·······--·············································--···-·········--···-----············
Payload to gross weight (Wp/Wo) : —

Height, H : ............................ -----·-·······----····--___________ ._____ ......_______ ... _______ ------· ...


Disposable load to gross weight (Wd/Wo) •

Wing loading (WJSW):

Tread, T: ·························-···························---·-------·-------··--------------------·-··--·-··
Power loading (WJP):.

or

12. Ratios
Thrust loading (WJT):

Aileron area to wing area (Sa/Sw):

Weight empty to gross weight (WB/Wo): .... ---------·-······--··----····---------------


Vertical tail surface area to wing area (Sv/Sw):

Fin to vertical tail surface area (S//Sv):

Payload to gross weight (WP/W o): ··--···-·····------------------··------------·------------·


Horizontal tail surface area to wing area OS*/Sw):

Elevator area to horizontal tail area (Se/Sh): Disposable load to gross weight (WD/Wo): ---------------------·---·-·-····------------·
Wing loading (Wt1! Sw): ------················---····-···----·-··-----------------·------·········--·
Flap area to wing area 0S/i/jS„):

Tab area to aileron area (Si/Sa):

Power loading (W0/P): ·-·------········------······-···-·--··--···---··--··-········-··------------··


Tab area to rudder area (Si/ST):

Tab area to elevator area (St/Sc):

or
Thrust loading ( W t1! T) : -·-·······---------········-·········--·---------·---·------------·-------·---
Tread to span (T/b):

Length to span (L/b):

Aileron area to wing area (Sa/ Sw) : ---·······--····----······---------·····------·-······-·-···


Height to span (H/b):

Sometimes, it may be preferable to prepare a graph on which are plotted:

power and wing loadings versus gross weight; ratio of weight empty to gross

weight versus gross weight; ratio of control surface area to wing area versus
Vertical tail surface area to wing area (Sv/ Sw): -··-··············-·--·-··········----
wing loading. From such graphs, the designer may select for his own de-

Fin to vertical tail surface area (Sr/ Sv): ··················-······················-·····-··


sign the information that will help him in developing the general details of

his design configuration and thus be reasonably assured of obtaining a


Horizontal tail surface area to wing area (Sh/ Sw): ...... -·--·······-----------····
successful airplane. Of course, refinements are made after careful aero-

Elevator area to horizontal tail area (S./ Sh): --- -- -----·--·-----···-·--------------·-


Flap area to wing area (Sri/ Sw): ···················--·-·-······-·······--················-····
Generated on 2012-05-30 00:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Tab area to aileron area (S,/Sa): --·-----·--------·--------------·--·-·-···-·-----------------·


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Tab area to rudder area (S,/8,): ---·· ·---------------- ---------· · ··-·-- ··-·--· ------ ------·-
Tab area to elevator area (St/Sr) : ------- -··-----·- ----·--------- -------···· -·---·- ---- --·--··
Tread to span (T /b): --·-·--·····-·-·----------- ·-·-·····-··-·-········-----·--··---------·-·-··---······
Length to span (L/b): -----------------------·········-··--····-----······ ···--·---- --------------------
Height to span (H / b): ···--------·····-·------·--·-···-···------------··--- ____ ___ ____ _____________ ___

Sometimes, it may be preferable to prepare a graph on which are plotted:


power and wing loadings versus gross weight; ratio of weight empty to gross
weight versus gross weight; ratio of control surface area to wing area versus
wing loading. From such graphs, the designer may select for his own de-
sign the information that will help him in developing the general details of
his design configuration and thus be reasonably assured of obtaining a
successful airplane. Of course, refinements are made after careful aero-

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 25
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 25

dynamic, performance, structural, and other careful analyses have been


dynamic, performance, structural, and other careful analyses have been

made.

Fig. 11-21 Fig. 11-22 made.


Figure 11-19. A design for a hypothetical 1,350 mph plane, prepared at NACA's

Flight Propulsion Laboratory. It relies on after-burner to double basic engine thrust,

thus allowing for small nacelles.


,,,-- ......._,,
Figure 11-20. An aircraft capable of vertical take-off and landing, converting to

horizontal flight when sufficient altitude has been reached. The landing gear, consisting
/ \
of four casters, is located at the tips of the delta wing and fins. A contra-rotating
\
propeller is used to eliminate engine torque effects upon the flight characteristics at

I
I
take-off. The static thrust of the power plant has to be greater than the weight of the

airplane for take-off and attaining climb.

I
"- --- /
Figure 11-21. A jet-powered flying wing design. The flaps act in the dual capacity

of a lift-increase device and elevators. The ailerons can function differentially as

ailerons, or nondifferentially as flaps or elevators. Where ailerons and elevators are

combined in function, they are called "elevans." The air inlet is located in the leading

edge of the wing at the root close to the fuselage.

Fig. 11-19 Fig. 11-20


Figure 11-22. A supersonic airplane. Note the wing fences used to prevent the

drifting of the boundary layer spanwise. Note also the application of the "area-rule"

to the fuselage configuration.

Fig. 11-21 Fig. 11-22

FIGURE 11-19. A design for a hypothetical 1,350 mph plane, prepared at NACA's
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Flight Propulsion Laboratory. lt relies on after-burner to double basic engine thrust,


thus allowing for small nacelles.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE 11-20. An aircraft capable of vertical take-off and landing, converting to


horizontal flight when sufficient altitude has been reached. The landing gear, consisting
of four casters, is located at the tips of the delta wing and fins. A contra-rotating
propeller is used to eliminate engine torque effects upon the flight characteristics at
take-off. The static thrust of the power plant has to be greater than the weight of the
airplane for take-off and attaining climb.

FIGURE 11-21. A jet-powered flying wing design. The flaps act in the dual capacity
of a lift-increase device and elevators. The ailerons can function differentially as
ailerons, or nondifferentially as flaps or elevators. Where ailerons and elevators are
combined in function, they are called "elevans." The air inlet is located in the leading
edge of the wing at the root close to the fuselage.

FIGURE 11-22. A supersonic airplane. Note the wing fences used to prevent the
drifting of the boundary layer spanwise. Note also the application of the "area-rule"
to the fuselage configuration.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
26 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
26

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

EMPIRICAL DATA
EMPIRICAL DATA

The preceding Airplane Data Sheet has been used to list data on cur-

rent airplanes, and this information has been used to calculate the various
The preceding Airplane Data Sheet has been used to list data on cur-
ratios which form part of the empirical data useful in projecting a new
rent airplanes, and this information has been used to calculate the various
design.
ratios which form part of the empirical data useful in projecting a new
The empirical data are used, for example, in arriving at a preliminary

weight estimate and subsequent values for areas and dimensions necessary
design.
in drawing up the preliminary three-view, from which a corrected weight The empirical data are used, for example, in arriving at a preliminary
estimate and initial structural drawings may be made.

weight estimate and subsequent values for areas and dimensions necessary
AIRPLANE DATA

Tables II-1 to II-4 list important data for a number of airplanes which
in drawing up the preliminary three-view, from which a corrected weight
are identified merely by reference numbers. Many of these airplanes have
estimate and initial structural drawings may be made.
been in production, whereas a few are projected designs. The student

may derive his own empirical data by determining the average wing load-

ings, power loadings, and ratios of control surface areas to wing areas

which fall within each single category of airplane. Such averages are usu-
AIRPLANE DATA
ally obtained for the same horsepower range: for example, for airplanes

powered with engines delivering horsepower from 65 to 100; another group


Tables II-1 to II-4 list important data for a number of airplanes which
or category from 150 to 225; still another from 1500 to 2000.
are identified merely by reference numbers. Many of these airplanes have
Table II-1. Airplane data: power plant.

been in production, whereas a few are projected designs. The student


may derive his own empirical data by determining the average wing load-
Airplane identification

Power plant

Rated
ings, power loadings, and ratios of control surface areas to wing areas
At

Propeller
which fall within each single category of airplane. Such averages are usu~
Fuel
ally obtained for the same horsepower range: for example, for airplanes
Ref.

powered with engines delivering horsepower from 65 to 100; another group


or category from 150 to 225; still another from 1500 to 2000.
No. of

No.

hp

altitude

diameter,

TABLJD 11-1. Airplane data: power plant.


capacity

no.

Typef

Airplane identification Power plant


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

seats

of engines

Rated At Propeller Fuel


Ref. No. of No. hp altitude diameter, ca{g!city
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

each, P

(ft.)
no. Typef seats of engines each, P (ft.) D (in.) gal.)
D(in.)

(gal.)
1 CLM 2 1 65 SL 72 15
1
2 CLM 2 1 65 SL 72 23
CLM
3 CLM 2 1 85 SL 74 22
4 CLM 2 1 85 SL 74 25
1 75 74
2

5 CLM 2 SL 23
6 CLM 4 1 175 SL 86 60
1

65

SL

7 CLM 2 1 85 SL - 20
72

8 CLM 2 1 125 SL - 30
15

9 CAM 3 1 145 - - 30
2

10 CLM 2 1 130 SL - 24
CLM
11 CLM 2 1 65 SL 76 14
2
12 CLM 2 1 85 2,000 76 28
1

65

SL
t CLM-Cabin, low-wing, monoplane. CAM-Cabint amphibian, monoplane.
72
OLM~pen cockpit, low-wing, monoplane. SL-Sea level, standard atmosphere.
23

CLM

85

SL

Original from
74

22
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
4

CLM

2
TYPES OF AIRPLANES 27
TYPES OF AIRPLANES

27

TABLE II-2. Airplane data: dimensions and construction.


Table II-2. Airplane data: dimensions and construction.

Dimensions

Landing gear

Wings*

Ref.
Dimensions Landing gear Wings•
Ref. Span, Length, Height, Wheel Cov- Hull or
Span,

Length,

no. b L H Type• size Spar Ribs ering fuselage•


Height,

--
Wheel

1 35' 21' 6" 9' 1" Fx 6.00 x6 w M F WldStF


Cov-

2 36' 20' 10" 9' 1" Fx 6.00 x6 w M F WldStF


Hull or
3 28' 8" 20' 7' 4" FxTri - A A A MSerniMo
no.
4 33' 22' 8' 6" FxTri 6.00 x 6 A A A MSemiMo
6 5 30' 20'9" 5' 11" FxTri 6.00 x 6 A A F MMo
L 6 36' 4" 25' 10" 7' 8" Fx 6.50 x 10 s s F WldStF
s s
Type*

7 35' 20' l" 6' 1" Fx 6.00 x 6 F WldStF


-
size

8 29' 20' 10" 6' l" Re A A A M


-
Spar

9 36' 26' 9' 4" Re M M F M


Ribs

10 33' 21' 5" 7' 8" Fx 6.00 x6 L w MF WldStF


ering

11 35' 20' 5' 10" Fx 6.00 x6 A A A MSemiMo


fuselage*

1
12 35' 20' 5' 10" Fx 6.00 x6 A A A MSerniMo
35'

21' 6"
• W-wood. A-Aluminum alloy. M-Metal. LW-Laminated wood. P-Ply-
9' 1"
wood. &-Spruce. F-Fabric. WldSt-Welded steel truss. SemiMo-Scmimono-
Fx
coque. Fx-Fixed. Tri-Tricycle. Re-Retractable.
6.00 X 6

WldStF

36'

20' 10"

9' 1" TABLE II-3. Airplane data: weights and surface areas.
Fx
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

6.00 X 6

AreM (sq ft.) Weights


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

WldStF
Wing Gross Empty Wing Power
(including Ailerons Stabi- weight, weight, load- load-
Ref. ailerons), (total),
S

Fin, Rudder, lizers, Elevator, lh, lh, ing ing


28' 8"
no. s s,. s, s. s. s. w Wg Wis W/p
20'
-r--- --
7' 4"
l 170 15.52 5.51 6.8 13.66 1.54 1,220 710 7.2 18.8
2 175 15.52 5.51 6 .8 13.66 1.54 1,250 740 7.4 19.2
- -
FxTri

3 140 8.15 6.68 2.73 11.86 8.10 1,400 860


—

4 140 15 8.5 3.5 11 6 1,450 900 10.2 17


A
5 142.6 16.8 3 .3 6 10.2 9.4 1,260 7 50 8.8 16.8
A 6 193.3 21 6.1 10.2 21.9 13.5 2,562 1,650 13.3 14.6
A

7 168.6 11.5 4.5 6.94 15.2 10 1,350 870 8 18


MSemiMo

8 131.6 9.3 3.6 5.53 13.1 7.12 1.570 - - -


4

9 - -
-
- - - - 2,200 1,4.50 - -
33' 10 156 - - - - 1,800 1,236 11 .5 13.8
22'
11 140 14.8 4.9 5.65 13 8.75 1,200 720 8.6 18 .5
8' 6"
12 140 14.8 4.~ 5.65 13 8.75 1,400 850 10 16.5
FxTri

6.00 X 6

MSemiMo

30'

20' 9"

Original from
5' 11"

FxTri
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
6.00 X 6

A
28 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
28

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

TABLE 11-4. Airplane performance data.


Table II-4. Airplane performance data.

Performance

High

Cruising

Performance
Stalling

Normal

High Cruising Stalling


speed,

Normal speed, At speed, At speed, Climb Service


At

Ref. range mph, altitude mih, altitude (mph) (fpm) ceiling


speed,
no. (miles) v,.,..,. (ft) er (ft) v. R (ft)
At

speed, 1 270 100 SL 90 SL 38 500 10,000


Climb
2 420 100 SL 90 SL 38 500 10,000
Service
3 400 118 SL 108 SL 49 610 11,000
Ref.
4 500 125 SL 115 SL 50 750 14,000
range
5 500 127 SL 110 SL 48 750 14,000
mph,
6 620 133 SL 118 SL 53 650 14,000
altitude

7 350 112 SL 100 SL 37 800 15,000


mph,

8 600 153 SL 140 SL 43 800 16,000


altitude

9 400 125 - 110 - 55 650 12,000


(mph)

10 500 140 SL 125 SL 50 1,150 19,000


(fpm)
11 400 115 SL 104 SL 45 650 15,000
ceiling
12 550 133 2,000 115 2,000 52 750 15,000
no.

(miles)

(ft)

Vcr

(ft)

V.

(ft)

270

100

SL

90
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

SL

38
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

500

10,000

420

100

SL

90

SL

38

500

10,000

400

118

SL

108

SL

49

610

11,000

500

125

SL

115

SL

Original from
50

750
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY.OF ICHIGAN
14,000

500
CHAPTER

Airfoil Selection

In selecting a suitable airfoil or a combination of airfoils for the wing

of an airplane, it is necessary to study carefully both the aerodynamic

and structural characteristics required for the airplane. Typical aero-

dynamic data are shown in the curves presented. No attempt will be

made here to discuss in detail all the aerodynamic characteristics, but in

order to indicate the importance and the significance of some of these

characteristics in airplane design, elementary consideration of the airplane


CHAPTER III
in flight will be studied.

THE AIRPLANE IN RECTILINEAR FLIGHT

Figure III-JL shows the forces acting on the airplane along any flight

path through space in still air. The line of action of the relative wind is

along the flight path opposite to the direction of motion of the airplane.

Resolving forces perpendicular and parallel to the line of action of the


Airfoil Seleetion
relative wind, the following equations result for the summation of forces,

since the airplane is in equilibrium.

For Sy = 0,

T sin (i + a) + Lw + Lt - W cos (8 = 0; (1)

For = 0,

-T cos (t + a) + Dp + Dw - W sin 0 = 0; (2)

In selecting a suitable airfoil or a combinatlon of airfoils for the wing


For 2Me.„. = 0,

Ma.e. + LwViC sin a + LwXiC cos a — DwyiC sin a +

DwXiC sin a — L<x2C cos at — Lty2C sin a, —


of an airplane, it is necessary to study carefully both the aerodynamic
TysC cos (i + a) + Tx»C sin (i + a) = 0. (3)

29
and structural characteristics required for the airplane. Typical aero-
dynamic data are shown in the curves presented. No attempt will be
made here to discuss in detail all the aerodynamic characteristics, but in
order to indicate the importance and the significance of some of these
characteristics in airplane design, elementary consideration of the airplane
in filght will be studied.

THE AIRPLANE IN RECTILINEAR FLIGHT


Figure III-1 shows the forces acting on the airplane along any flight
path through space in still air. The line of action of the relative wind is
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

along the flight path opposite to the direction of motion of the airplane.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Resolving forces perpendicular and parallel to the line of action of the


relative wind, the following equations result for the summation of forces,
since the airplane is in equilibrium.
For };Y = 0,
T sin (i +a) + Lw + L, - W cos {3 = O; (1)
For };X = 0,

-T cos (i +a)+ DP+ Dw - W sin {3 = O; (2)

For "I.Mc.u. = 0,
Mo.c. + LwY1C sin a+ Lwx1C cos a - Dwy1C sin a+
Dwx1C sin a - L1x2C cos a, - L1Y2C sin a, -
TyaC cos (i + a) + TxaC sin (i + a) = 0. (3)
29

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
30 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

In the foregoing:
x1C = distance between the aerodynamic center of the wing and
the center of gravity of the airplane.
x2C = distance between the assumed center of pressure (usually
considered at 20 per cent of the mean geometric chord) of
the horizontal ta.ii surfaces and the center of gravity of the
airplane.
xaC = distance between the intersection, of the propeller's plane of
rotation and its thrust line, and the center of gravity of the
airplane.
y1C, y2C, and yaC = the vertical ordinates of x1C,x2C, and x,C with
reference to the center of gravity of the airplane.
T = thrust, in pounds, exerted by the propeller or jet engine.
L.,, = lift, in pounds, of the wings.
L, = lift of the horizontal ta.ii surfaces. Its drag is considered
part of the para.site drag.
D,,, = drag, in pounds, of the wings.
DP = parasite drag, in pounds; includes the drag of tail surfaces.
Here, for simplicity, the vector DP is assumed to act through
the center of gravity.
M "· •. = "ing moment, in foot-pounds, a.bout the aerodynamic center
of the mean aerodynamic chord of wing to which the lift and
drag forces of the wing have been referred.
M o. 0 • = moment, in foot-pounds, about the center of gravity of the
airplane, due to a.II the forces and moments acting on its
component parts.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

L,,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

---../

/J
----+-C

w
FxoURJC 111- 1. Forces on the airplane in rectilinear flight.

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
AIRFOIL SELECTION 31

fl
AIRFOIL SELECTION

31 = angle between the line of flight and the horizon. (Still-air


Also,

conditions are always assumed.)


j8 = angle between the line of flight and the horizon. (Still-air

conditions are always assumed.)


a = angle of attack; angle included between the line of flight and
a — angle of attack; angle included between the line of flight and
the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing.
the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing.

i = angle of incidence, angle included between the line of thrust,


i = angle of incidence, angle included between the line of thrust,
and the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing. and the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing.
at = angle of attack of the horizontal tail surfaces; usually Lt sin at

a, = angle of attack of the horizontal tail surfaces; usually L, sin a,


is considered negligible with reference to Lw sin a, so that this
is considered negligible with reference to L„ sin a, so that this

term is neglected. Likewise, it may be assumed that

cos a, = 1.
term is neglected. Likewise, it may be assumed that
L = MpCLSv* and D = MpCdSv*,

where L = lift, in pounds;


cos O'.i = 1.
D = drag, in pounds;
Also,
p = mass density of air, in slugs per cubic foot, which is 0.002378

L = 7'2pCLSv2 and
for standard air at sea level;

S = wing area in square feet;

e; = speed in feet per second along the flight path of the airplane;
where L = lift, in pounds;
and
D = drag, in pounds;
Cl and Cd are nondimensional lift and drag coefficients.

p = mass density of air, in slugs per cubic foot, which is 0.002378


for standard air at sea level;
Case 1. Horizontal Flight. In horizontal flight the angle /3 is zero, and

since in normal flight attitudes a is small, the sine of (i + a) may be con-

sidered equal to zero (for example, even for a = 16°, sin a is only 0.17), S = wing area in square feet;
so that equation (1) becomes

Lw + L• - W = 0. (la)
v = speed in feet per second along the flight path of the airplane;
Usually the load on the horizontal tail surfaces is also small compared with
and
the load on the wing in horizontal flight, so that Lw = W. In other words,
CL and CD are nondimensional lift and drag coefficients.
the lift of wings in horizontal flight may be assumed to be equal to the

· Case 1. Horizontal Flight. In horizontal flight the angle fl is zero, and


since in normal flight attitudes a is small, the sine of (i + a) may be con-
gross weight of the airplane. This is the relationship which is useful in

determining the speed in horizontal flight since

Lw = tCJ3 - W = WClS, (4)

so that
sidered equal to zero (for example, even for a = 16°, sin a is only 0.17),
-4
so that equation (1) becomes
Lw + L, - W
w

y2pcLs
= 0. (la)
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

(4a)'

Minimum speed is then fixed by Cl*., for a given wing loading, W/S. Usually the load on the horizontal tail surfaces is also small compared with
the load on the wing in horizontal flight, so that Lw = W. In other words,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The higher the wing loading for a given Cl«„, the greater the minimum

or stalling speed. For all practical purposes this stalling speed is con-

sidered the landing speed. If the stalling speed is fixed and if the gross
the lift of wings in horizontal flight may be assumed to be equal to the
weight of the airplane is fixed as well, then that airplane which had the
gross weight of the airplane. This is the relationship which is useful in
highest value of Cl^ would have the least wing area.

determining the speed in horizontal flight since


(4)
so that

= ~Y2P~LS 0
(4a) -
V

Minimum speed is then fixed by CL... for a given wing loading, W / S.


The higher the wing loading for a given Cr,..., the greater the minimum
or stalling speed. For all practical purposes ·this stalling speed is con-
sidered the landing speed. If the stalling speed is fixed and if the gross
weight of the airplane is fixed as well, then that airplane which had the
highest value of Cr,... would have the least wing area.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
32 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
32

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


It is, therefore, desirable to compare values of Ci... for a group of air-
It is, therefore, desirable to compare values of Cl_, for a group of air-

foils. However, if lift-increase devices are used, then the maximum lift
foils. However, if lift-increase devices are used, then the maximum lift
coefficient of the basic airfoil is not so important since any airfoil with the
coefficient of the basic airfoil is not so important since any airfoil with the
proper lift-increase device may attain the desired value of Ci^.,.

proper lift-increase device may attain the desired value of Ci_•.


The maximum speed is determined by the maximum amount of horse-

power or thrust delivered by the propeller-engine combination or jet


The maximum speed is determined by the maximum amount of horse-
engine at maximum speed. The horsepower required is equal to the
power or thrust delivered by the propeller-engine combination or jet
engiii.e at maximum speed. The horsepower required is equB.l to the
horsepower available..

The power required is

PT = (/>. + DP)00^; (5) horsepower available ..


The power available is

The power required is


Pa = 77BHP; (5a)

and since at maximum speed,

Pa = Pr (5b)
(5)
or,

rjBHP = (Z>„ + DP)00^0 0 (5c)

This relationship can be obtained from equation (2), for, again assuming
The power available is
(a + 1) small and |3 = 0, then

Pa= 17BHP; (5a)


- T + Dp + Dw = 0, (2a)

°r' T = DP + Dw (2b)

and since at maximum speed,


and multiplying both sides by v/550,

But, TV/550 is the thrust horsepower available, or


Pa= Pr (5b)
«S> = "bhp (6a)

where r) is the efficiency of the propeller and BHP is the brake horsepower
or,
v
of the engine delivered to the propeller at the given airplane speed, and

the power required is given in equation (5) as


17BHP = (Dw + Dp) 550 . (5c)
Pr = (DP + IWJL,

but
This relationship can be obtained from equation (2), for, again assuming
(a + i) small and {j = 0, then
Dw = yiPv2cDs

Dp = y2Pv2cDrs,

where Co is the drag coefficient of the wing,

- T +DP + Dw = 0, (2a)
or,
T =DP+ Dw (2b)

and multiplying both sides by v/550,


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Tv v (6)
550 = (DP+ Dw)550.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

But, Tv/550 is the thrust horsepower available, or


Tv
550 = 17BHP (6a.)

where 17 is the efficiency of the propeller and BHP is the brake horsepower
of the engine delivered to the propeller at the given airplane speed, and
the power required is given in equation (5) as
v
Pr= (Dp + Dw) 550 ,

but
Dw = Y2pv2CDS
DP = ~pv2 CDps,

where CD is the drag coefficient of the wing,

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
AIRFOIL SELECTION 33
AIRFOIL SELECTION

33

CDp is the parasite resistance coefficient of the airplane (less the


CDp is the parasite resistance coefficient of the airplane (less the
wing) referred to the wing area.
wing) referred to the wing area.
Then,

Then,
Pr = P0 = „BHP = (CD + GDp), (7) .

pvas
or, \

T = p-f- (CD + CDp), (7a) V


Pr = P0 = 11BHP = llOO (CD + Cvr), (7) .
and for any given lift coefficient the speed v can be determined from equa-

tion (3), the corresponding Cd of the wing will be known and the Cd, for or,
pv2S
2 + cDp), (7a) \ .
the airplane may be calculated,1 so that the horsepower required of the

engine-propeller combination can be determined. Then, if the horsepower


T = (CD
available is a certain value, it is obvious that the maximum speed that can

be obtained for a given airplane (whose Cd, is fixed) is one whose wing air-

and for any given lift coefficient the speed v can be determined from equa-
foil has a minimum value of Cd0 0 It is important, therefore, to compare

the minimum values of the drag coefficients of a series of airfoils.


tion (3), the corresponding Cv of the wing will be known and the CDP for
Since the range of speeds obtainable is determined by the values of the
the airplane may be calculated, 1 so that the horsepower required of the
maximum value of Cl (minimum speed) and of the minimum value of Cd

(maximum speed), then the ratio of CLm., to Co,,, is of importance and is


engine-propeller combination can be determined. Then, if the horsepower
known as the speed range ratio. available is a certain value, it is obvious that the maximum speed that can
Case 2. Gliding Flight. Again, assuming that the lift on the horizon-

be obtained for a given airplane (whose Cvp is fixed) is one whose wing air-
foil has a Minimum value of CD· It is important, therefore, to compare
tal tail surfaces is small and the angle (a + i) small, but that 0 is not un-

appreciable, equation (1) becomes Lw = W cos 0, and equation (2) be-

comes Dt — T = W sin 0.


the minimum values of the drag coefficients of a series of airfoils.
Dividing the first equation by the second,

^Ty = cOt 0, (8)


- Since- the range of speeds obtainable is determined by the values of the
when there is no thrust (that is, when the engine fails)
maximum value of CL (minimum speed) and of the minimum value of CD
cot 0 - ^. (8a)

(maximum speed), then the ratio of Ci_.. to CD.;,. is of importance and is


known as the speed range ratio.
or the angle of glide is a function of the aerodynamic characteristics of the

airplane. This relationship may be rewritten

Lw qClS Cl Cl . a ,suN ('


Case 2. Gliding Flight. Again, assuming that the lift on the horizon-
-d• = WnTs = c7, = cTfcZ = cot * (8b) A

Again, considering an airplane for which the parasite resistance can be


tal tail surfaces is small and the angle (a + i) small, but that (3 is not un-
assumed constant for any angle of attack, the angle of glide /? will be
appreciable, equation (1) becomes Lw = W cos (3, and equation (2) be-
flattest for that airplane whose L/D for the airfoil alone is the largest.

comes D, - T = W sin (3.


Dividing the first equation by the second,
1 See Chapter X XII, Preliminary Performance Calculations.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Lw f.l
(8)
D, _ T = cot tJ,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

when there is no thrust (that is, when the engine fails)

cot R
tJ
Lw
= -, (8a)
D,

or the angle of glide is a function of the aerodynamic characteristics of the


airplane. This relationship may be rewritten

(8b) \

Again, considering an airplane for which the parasite resistance can be


assumed constant for any angle of attack, the angle of glide {3 will be
flattest for that airplane whose L / D for the airfoil alone is the largest.
1 See Chapter X XII, Preliminary Performance Calculations.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
34 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
34

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Also, the circle determined from


Also, the circle determined from
K = ffcot0 = ff(^. (9)

where R is the radius of the circle, and H the altitude from which the

glide takes place, is largest for the largest value of cot 13. The airfoils
R = H cot {j = H ( t) • (9)
should, therefore, be compared on the basis of the maximum L/D.

Case 3. The Dive. In this case, the angle /3 becomes 90 degrees, so


where R is the radius of the circle, and H the altitude from which the
that equation (1) now becomes Lw + Lt = 0, assuming (i + a) is small.

glide takes place, is largest for the largest value of cot {j. The airfoih;
should, therefore, be compared on the basis of the maximum L/D.
Equation (2) becomes

- T + Dp + Dw - W = 0

when there is no thrust,

Case 3. The Dive. In this case, the angle {3 becomes 90 degrees, so


that equation (1) now becomes Lw +LT = 0, assuming (i +a) is small.
Dt = W

where

DP + DW = Dt! Equation (2) becomes


+ Dp + Dw -
or

WCDJ5 = W,
- T W = 0
from which

/W
when there is no thrust,
v V HpCdJS'

The maximum speed will then be obtained in the dive, unless the drag
D, = W
coefficient is unusually large, and will be determined by the minimum

total drag coefficient of the airplane. This speed is of importance in con-


where
sidering local pressures on engine cowls and windshields which may be

pulled off the airplane by the "suction" pressure. The leading edge of
Dp+Dw = D,,
the wing would then be subjected to enormous pressure that would tend
or
~pv2 CD,S =
to buckle it. Also, the highest load factor in flight is encountered when

pulling out of a dive. The higher the diving speed, the higher the load
W,
factor encountered in the pull-out. (See Chapter IV, External Loads on

from which
Airplane in Flight.) If the speed were to be limited, then means would

V ~ ~;;D,s· (10)
have to be provided to increase the drag.

Case 4. The Climb. In the case of the climb, equation (2), as derived

=
for the general case, is of importance. The angle /3 is now a negative

The maximum speed will then be obtained in the dive, unless the drag
angle and the equation in question becomes, upon making the same as-

sumptions as to a and i,

T - Dt = W sin 0. (11)
coefficient is unusually large, and will be determined by the minimum
But, sin /3 = a/v where v is the velocity along the flight path and a is

total drag coefficient of the airplane. This speed is of importance in con-


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the vertical component of this velocity, or the rate of climb in feet per

second.
sidering local pressures on engine cowls and windshields which may be
pulled off the airplane by the "suction" pressure. The leading edge of
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(10)

the wing would then be subjected to enormous pressure that would tend
to buckle it. Also, the highest load factor in flight is encountered when
pulling out of a dive. The higher the diving speed, the higher the load
factor encountered in the pull-out. (See Chapter IV, External Loads on
Airplane in Flight.) If the speed were to be limited, then means would
have to be provided to increase the drag.
Case 4. The Climb. In the case of the climb, equation (2), as derived
for the general case, is of importance. The angle {3 is now a negative
angle and the equation in question becomes, upon making the same as-
sumptions as to a and i,
T - D 1 = W sin {3. (11)
But, sin {3 = a/v where v is the velocity along the flight path and a is
the vertical component of this velocity, or the rate of climb in feet per
second.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
AIRFOIL SELECTION 35
AIRFOIL SELECTION

Then, equation (11) becomes T - Di = W(a/v), and by multiplying both


35

Then, equation (11) becomes T — Dt = W(a/v), and by multiplying both

sides of the equation by v/550,


sides of the equation by v/550,
550 550 550' 1 J

But !Ty/550 = horsepower delivered by the propeller, or the horsepower

Tv D,v Wa
available = Pa. Therefore Tv/550 = 17 BHP where t] is the propeller effi-

550 - 550 = 550· (lla)


ciency and BHP is the brake horsepower of the engine. Dtv/550 is the

horsepower required to overcome the total drag of the airplane at ve-

locity v and may be designated PT.


But Tv/550 = horsepower delivered by the propeller, or the horsepower
Rearranging terms
available = Pa. Therefore Tv/550 = 1J BHP where 'f/ is the propeller effi-
550(Pa - PT)

a= W'
ciency and BHP is the brake horsepower of the engine. D,v/550 is the
W cos 0 = Lw = y2pv?SCL
horsepower required to overcome the total drag of the airplane at ve-
or

locity v and may be designated Pr.


Rearranging terms
(lib)

4.

y2pscL {10)

550(Pa - P,) (llb)


where ve is the velocity along the climb path.

Examination of equation (lib) indicates that the airplane which requires


a= w '
the least amount of horsepower to overcome aerodynamic resistance will

have the greater climb. Since

Pr = (Dw + DP)(»/550),

then if the parasite resistance is kept constant, Pr is piimarily a function


or
/W cos (j
of Dwv, but

Dwv = (y2PcDSv*)v = y2pcDSv\

and since

Ve = "J V2pSCL (llc)


so that

or

Dwv
where Ve is the velocity along the climb path.
cD
Examination of equation (llb) indicates that the airplane which requires
Clw'

the least amount of horsepower to overcome aerodynamic resistance will


have the greater climb. Since
CD

Clw

also Cd/Cl*12 should be a minimum, or Clw/Cd a maximum in order to

maintain PT at a minimum. This ratio is sometimes called a "power co-


P, = (Dw + Dp)(v/550),
efficient" for the airfoil and is calculated for those angles of attack in the

then if the parasite resistance is kept constant, Pr is p1imarily a function


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

region where the minimum drag coefficient Cj> and the maximum L/D of

the airfoil occur.

of Dwv, but
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

and since

(12)
so that

or
Cn
Pr,....., CL3J2'
also Cn/CL3 12 should be a minimum, or CL3' 2 /Cn a maximum in order to
maintain P, at a minimum. This ratio is sometimes called a "power co-
efficient" for the airfoil and is calculated for those angles of attack in the
region where the minimum drag coefficient Cn and the maximum L/D of
the airfoil occur.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
36 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
36

Case 6. Range. One of the simpler formulas for determining the range
AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Case 5. Range. One of the simpler formulas for determining the range

of an airplane is the so-called Breguet's formula for weight with respect to


of an airplane is the so-called Breguet's formula for weight with respect to
distance, which is derived from the differential expression,

dW = - TVc ± - WVc (13)


distance, which is derived from the differential expression,
dt 375tj 375(L/D)i7'

dW - TVc . - WVc (13)


which, integrated between the limits of Wo and W„ gives

4*to*.S (13a)
dt = 375?7 = 375(L/ D)?J 1
which, integrated between the limits of Wo and We, gives
where

R, range in miles = 863 ^ - logw

= 863 ~ ~ log10 ~:'


L Cl Cl

D CD, Cd + Cdf

R, range in miles (13a)


r) = average propeller efficiency at cruising,

c = average fuel consumption in pounds per brake horsepower per

hour for the average cruising rpm,


where
Wo = gross weight in pounds at start of flight,

L CL CL
-=-= '
Cn + Cn,.
We = weight at end of flight after fuel has been consumed.

It will be noted that, all other things being equal, the higher the value of
D Cn,
71 = average propeller efficiency at cruising,
the L/D, the longer the range. Therefore, if the parasite resistance of the

airplane is constant, the maximum value of the L/D = Cl/Cd of the airfoil

would be of interest. c = average fuel consumption in pounds per brake horsepower per
This formula can be made to apply to jet engines by dropping the term

7j for propeller efficiency and considering c as the average fuel consumption


hour for the average cruising rpm,
in pounds per pound of thrust per hour for cruising conditions.
Wo = gross weight in pounds at start of flight,
Other Airfoil Characteristics

We = weight at end of flight after fuel has been consumed.


It will be noted that, all other things being equal, the higher the value of
The slope of the lift curve, dCiJda, is one of the more important quan-

tities to know since it has an important bearing on the stability of the

airplane. the L/ D, the longer the range. Therefore, if the parasite resistance of the
The angle at which zero lift curve occurs is also important since the

airplane is constant, the maximum value of the L/ D = CL/Cn of the airfoil


diving speed occurs very close to this angle.

The center of pressure movement over the normal flying range, between
would be of interest.
This formula can be made to apply to jet engines by dropping the term
the angle at which the minimum drag coefficients occur and the angle at

which the maximum lift coefficient occurs, is usually of interest since the

greater the movement the greater the load that will fall on the front spar
71for propeller efficiency and considering c as the average fuel consumption
at high angle of attack, with very little load on the rear spar; the condi-

tions are reversed at low angle of attack.


in pounds per pound of thrust per hour for cruising conditions.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Some data may not include the center of pressure but may give the mo-

ment coefficient, Cm., about the aerodynamic center instead. In such a


Other Airfoil Characteristics
The slope of the lift curve, dCL/da, is one of the more important quan-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

case a small value of Cm, is considered desirable, since

CP = a - ^
tities to know since it has an important bearing on the stability of the
CV (14)

airplane.
The angle at which zero lift curve occurs is also important since the
diving speed occurs very close to this angle.
The center of pressure movement over the normal flying range, between
the angle at which the minimum drag coefficients occur and the angle at
which the maximum lift coefficient occurs, is usually of interest since the
greater the movement the greater the load that will fall on the front spar
at high angle of attack, with very little load on the rear spar; the condi-
tions are reversed at low angle of attack.
Some data may not include the center of pressure but may give the mo-
ment coefficient, CM., about the aerodynamic center instead. In such a
case a small value of CM. is considered desirable, since

CP = a- g:· (14)

Dig iz b
Original from
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN j
AIRFOIL SELECTION 37
AIRFOIL SELECTION

37

oc
v.
1-20-
"I

o=C =

-20=, I I I 1 I I I I I I
©

16

*.
0 0 20 40 60 80 100
ft
~
Ill:)
Per cent of chord
.,,"'
"I

cl 1.6
a

Ill:)
4 +.020

~ v
i\
00

-.020

ae

....
0 v 1.4
420-

I/
~
..... ...
-
0=

~2°— | | I I I | | I I | I

..... I 1.2 ~ .24


....·~ " ~
0 20 40 60 80 100

., j

v
Per cent of chord

::::<b I l. .20
\.
"\ 1.0
cL

20
CP.

0 I / /FiJ
vC.P. ·~
L-

4 8 12 16 20
16 "'
..... '( I
f\j
v ['\ I
0.8
25
./6
-=
'Ill..
Anqle of attack

(in degrees)
<b
I!
/ ~
0.6 .12
12 I

~"
1.4 o

~
j
%
L- S5
I/ ~v '""" ID 0.4 .08
1.2 \ .24

8 v
00

I ~ """"' 45
I/.,.
10 $.20

'" 0.2
%

4 +.020 .04
0.8

16
v ,_..... v
25

0 0
0.6

. ,___
v
.12

CA ,,
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

35

0.4
-.020
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

.08

45

~ 16 20
0.2

.04
4 8 12
ft 2

I A nq/e of aftack
rag eoeffieiem

1:
I (in degrees)
<» v.

, ft
I
-J Vi

Figure III-2. Representative curves of aerodynamic properties of an airfoil.

where CP = the center of pressure in fraction of the chord from the


FIGURE III-2. Representative curves of aerodynamic properties of an airfoil.
leading edge,

a = the aerodynamic center expressed as a fraction of the chord


where GP = the center of pressure in fraction of the chord from the
from the leading edge,
leading edge,
Cm. = the moment coefficient, a constant, about the aerodynamic

a = the aerodynamic center expressed as a fraction of the chord


from the leading edge)
center, and

Cn = the normal force coefficient equal to (Cl cos a + Cd sin a)

CM. = the moment coefficient, a constant, about the aerodynamic


center, and
CN = the normal force coefficient equal to (CL cos a + CD sin a)

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
38 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
38

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


and for small angles of attack, practically equivalent to CL.
and for small angles of attack, practically equivalent to CL.

Thus, for small values of CM., the center of pressure will not vary much
Thus, for small values of Cm., the center of pressure will not vary much

from the aerodynamic center position.


from the aerodynamic center position.
STRUCTURAL CONSIDERATIONS

In selecting a suitable airfoil for a given design it is necessary to consider


STRUCTURAL CONSIDERATIONS
the structural and aerodynamic characteristics required for the airplane.

A racing airplane, for example, will have an entirely different wing from a
In selecting a suitable airfoil for a given design it is necessary to consider
transport airplane.
the structural and aerodynamic characteristics required for the airplane.
A full-cantilever wing, with an aspect ratio from 6 to 10, requires a thick-

A racing airplane, for example, will have an entirely different wing from a
transport airplane.
ness ratio of at least 18 per cent for the root section. The larger the aspect

ratio, the greater the thickness ratio of the root section should be. It is

not desirable to use the same thickness ratio from root to tip, but to de-

A full-cantilever wing, with an aspect ratio from 6 to 10, requires a thick-


crease it linearly to not less than 9 per cent at the tip.

A semicantilever wing, with an aspect ratio from 6 to 8, requires a thick-


ness ratio of at least 18 per cent for the root section. The larger the aspect
ness ratio of at least 12 per cent for the root section. Again, the larger the
ratio, the greater the thickness ratio of the root section should be. It is
aspect ratio for the wing, the greater must be the thickness ratio of the

root section. The wing should be decreased linearly to about 6 per cent
not desirable to use the same thickness ratio from root to tip, but to de-
thickness ratio for the tip chord. crease it linearly to not less than 9 per cent at the tip.
A semicantilever wing, with an aspect ratio from 6 to 8, requires a thick-
A biplane would probably use an airfoil of thickness ratio from 6 to 9

per cent and use the same airfoil from root to tip.

The student should refer to Chapter XVII, Design of the Wing, for ness ratio of at least 12 per cent for the root section. Again, the larger the
further information.

Recapitulation
aspect ratio for the wing, the greater must be the thickness ratio of the
i When the thickness ratio for the airfoil has been tentatively established,
root section. The wing should be decreased linearly to about 6 per cent
it is then desirable to compare a group of airfoils to determine which has

thickness ratio for the tip chord.


A biplane would probably use an airfoil of thickness ratio from 6 to 9
the best all-round characteristics.

Care should be taken when two airfoils are selected to choose two from

the same general family, since it may be difficult otherwise to avoid serious per cent and use the same airfoil from root to tip.
double curvatures in the development of the skin. A concave lower sur-

face for one airfoil and a convex lower surface for another when used for a The student should refer to Chapter XVII, Design of the Wing, for
wing of a tapered planform would usually not be desirable.

further information.
All comparisons should be made preferably for airfoils tested at the same

Reynolds or Mach numbers, in the same wind tunnel, and for the same Recapitulation
··, When the thickness ratio for the airfoil has been tentatively established,
aspect ratio in order to eliminate, or at least reduce, certain experimental

variables. The characteristics of the airfoils to be compared have already

it is then desirable to compare a group of airfoils to determine which has


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

been discussed briefly. Table III-1 is a recapitulation of the quantities

mentioned in the discussions above.

the best all-round characteristics.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ASPECT RATIO CORRECTIONS

With few exceptions, wind-tunnel tests of airfoils are presented for a


Care should be taken when two airfoils are selected to choose two from
standard aspect ratio of infinity; but since the wing used for the design

the same general family, since it may be difficult otherwise to avoid serious
double curvatures in the development of the skin. A concave lower sur-
face for one airfoil and a convex lower surface for another when used for a
wing of a tapered planform would usually not be desirable.
All comparisons should be made preferably for airfoils tested at the same
Reynolds or Mach numbers, in the same wind tunnel, and for the same
aspect ratio in order to eliminate, or at least reduce, certain experimental
variables. The characteristics of the airfoils to be compared have already
been discussed briefly. Table 111-1 is a recapitulation of the quantities
mentioned in the discussions above.

ASPECT RATIO CORRECTIONS


With few exceptions, wind-tunnel tests of airfoils are presented for a
standard aspect ratio of infinity; but since the wing used for the design

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TABLJJ III- 1. Airfoil criteria.

No. Item Usual symbol Remarks


1 Airfoil section .
2 Tested at Data obtained from the same
wind tunnel better for compari-
son
3 Aspect ratio Ror AR Compare all data for same as-
pcct ratio
4 Reynolds number RS Compare all data at same Reyn-
olds number
5 Slope of lift curve (dCL)l(da) The greater the slope, the better
for stabiii ty
6 Angle of attack for CL - 0 Ci. For aerodynamic twist consider-
ations
7 Angle of attack for CL-· "c~. Determines attitude of airplane
for three-point landing
8 Maximum CL CL-z Indicative of wing area required
9 Minimum CD CD.m Indicative of top speed
10 Angle of attack for minimum CD "cD• .., Probable wing incidence
11 Maximum LID (LID)_. Indicative of cruising speed and
range
12 Angle of attack at maximum Indicative of cruising angle
LID
13 LID at% maximum ('L
~ For good climb and cruising
characteristics
14 LID at Yi maximum CL For medium high-speed craft
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

15 LID at~ Claximum CL Of interest for transport air-


planes for be~t cruising
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

16 LID at 3" maximum CL Of interest for modert.tely hi~h-


speed airplanes-range at high
speed
17 L ID at~ maximum CL For high-speed airplanes-range
at high speed
18 Maximum value of cLal•ICD ~ For best rate of climb
19 Cr-.ICD~1. Speed range ratio
20 Spar depth at 15, 20, 60, and The deeper the spar, the lighter
70% -¥ the structure
21 Most forward pcl<li ti on of center Smallest movement gives most
of pressure at max CL efficient structure
22 Most rearward position of cen- Smallest movement gives most
ter of pressure at min Co efficient structure
23 CM. .
-

39

Original from
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
40 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

very seldom has this ratio, it is necessary to correct the airfoil charac-
teristics for the proper aspect ratio.
The aspect ratio of a wing is determined from the ratio
(span)2 b2
area = s·
The span is measured from tip to tip. The area of the wing includes that
area covered by the fuselage and shown as the shaded portion in Figure
111- 3. It should be noted here that the area covered by the fuselage is
used only for aspect ratio calculations. For all subsequent calculations,
such as effective area for calculation of landing speed or in performance

FIGURE 111-3. Wing area for aspect-ratio calculations.

calculations, it is not included unless it is unobstructed both above and


below.
The drag coefficient may be corrected for the new aspect ratio by means
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

TABLE 111- 2. Computation of airfoil characteristics.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

00 ~ IN IN ~ 00 C! C"! ~ ~ OC! 0 IN

1. CL
C!
..... 0 '°
0 0 0 0 0 '°0 0 .... .... .... ..... .... ~ c;i
I' I I I I
2. "'00
- - - - - - - - - - - - - -
3. Aa = 18.24 K CL
-
- - - - - -
- - - - - - -
4. a = (2) + (3)
- -
- - - - - - - - - - - - -
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
5. CDoo = CD.
2
- - - - - - - - - - - - - -
6. ACD; = 0.318KCL
- - - - - - - - - - - - - -
7. CDR = (5) + (6)
8. C.P.
- - - - - - - - - - - - - -
9. CM0
- - - - - - - -
- 1- - - - -

N = 57·3 = 18.24; K = _!_ - R


_ l; ! = 0.318.
1r 00 1r

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
.....
AIRFOIL SELECTION 41
AIRFOIL SELECTION

41 of the formula
of the formula

CL2
CD= CD0 +CD,= Coo+ 1rR'
Ci}

Cb = Cd, + Cd{ = Cd, +

where Cj> is the total drag coefficient for the airfoil used, while Cd, is the

profile drag, independent of the aspect ratio and constant for the airfoil. where CD is the total drag coefficient for the airfoil used, while CD, is the
The induced drag is expressed

€..-%. . CM)
profile drag, independent of the aspect ratio and constant for the airfoil.
As an example, to calculate the drag coefficient for aspect ratio 8 when
The induced drag is expressed
the characteristics for aspect ratio 6 are known, the following formula may

be derived:
(15)
where R = 8. Corrections for low values of d may be ignored. The

angle of attack must be corrected also for aspect ratio

= (16)

As an example, to calculate the drag coefficient for aspect ratio 8 when


where clr and ao are in radians; or

57.3 Cl/1
the characteristics for aspect ratio 6 are known, the following formula may
where aK and a6 are in degrees and the known characteristics are for aspect
be derived:

+ ~:2(~ - ~}
ratio 6. If the known characteristics are for infinite aspect ratio, then 6

is replaced by oo and l/oo becomes equal to zero. The lift coefficient, the

CDa = CD, (15a)


center of pressure, and the corrected drag coefficient correspond to the

corrected angle of attack. Table III-2 has been set up to expedite the

aspect ratio calculations. The various terms are self-explanatory. The

where R = 8. Corrections for low values of CL may be ignored. The


angle of attack must be corrected also for aspect ratio
calculations are usually carried out in the form of such a table.

When an airfoil section used for the tip of a wing is different from that

used at the root, it is necessary to make wind-tunnel tests on a model of

the actual wing. Reasonably close approximation for preliminary cal-

(16)
culations may be obtained by averaging the characteristics of the root and

tip airfoils.

where aR and ao are in radians; or


+ 57.3 CL(! _ 1)
AERODYNAMIC SECTION CHARACTERISTICS

aR = ae
At the present time, much of the airfoil data such as the lift, drag, and

(16a)
R 6
moment coefficients, the angle of attack, and the center of pressure, are

presented corrected to infinite aspect ratio. Such data are referred to as


7r

where aR and a 6 are in degrees and the known characteristics are for aspect
section coefficients for infinite aspect ratio. To distinguish them from

similar coefficients obtained or given for airfoils of finite aspect ratio, the

ratio 6. If the known characteristics are for infinite aspect ratio, then 6
is replaced by oo and 1/ oo becomes equal to zero. The lift coefficient, the
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

center of pressure, and the corrected drag coefficient correspond to the


corrected angle of attack. Table III-2 has been set up to expedite the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

aspect ratio calculations. The various terms are self-explanatory. The


calculations are usually carried out in the form of such a table.
When an airfoil section used for the tip of a wing is different from that
used at the root, it is necessary to make wind-tunnel tests on a model of
the actual wing. Reasonably close approximation for preliminary cal-
culations may be obtained by averaging the characteristics of the root and
tip airfoils.

AERODYNAMIC SECTION CHARACTERISTICS


At the present time, much of the airfoil data such as the lift, drag, and
moment coefficients, the angle of attack, and the center of pressure, are
presented corrected to infinite aspect ratio. Such data are referred to as
section coefficients for infinite aspect ratio. To distinguish them from
similar coefficients obtained or given for airfoils of finite aspect ratio, the

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
42 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
42

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


coefficients are designated with lower-case letters (c 1, c4, Cm. .•. , etc.) for
coefficients are designated with lower-case letters (cj, ca, Cm..,., etc.) for

the infinite aspect ratio case and the upper-case letters (Cl, Cd, Cm...., Cd„
" the infinite aspect ratio case and the upper-case letters (CL, CD, C,,.. .•.1 CD"
etc.) for finite aspect ratio.
etc.) for finite aspect ratio.
These section characteristics are particularly useful in obtaining the

These section characteristics are particularly useful in obtaining the


spanwise lift distribution as outlined in ANC-1 (1) Spanwise Airload
spanwise lift distribution as outlined in ANC-1 (1) Spanwise Airload

Distribution, a small volume obtainable from the U. S. Government Print-

ing Office, Washington, D. C. It is beyond the scope of this book to


Distribution, a small volume obtainable from the U. S. Government Print-
discuss or to indicate the procedure in calculating the spanwise lift distri-

bution. However, for stress analysis purposes, and for more refined calcu-
ing Office, Washington, D. C. It is beyond the scope of this book to
lation of performance, the spanwise as well as the chordwise distribution
discuss or to indicate the procedure in calculating the spanwise lift distri-
(the latter especially for wings equipped with flaps) should be carefully

bution. However, for stress analysis purposes, and for more refined calcu-
lation of performance, the span.wise as well as the chordwise distribution
calculated.

To obtain the necessary data for preliminary design purposes, the fol-

lowing discussion will indicate a practical procedure. When the design


(the latter especially for wings equipped with flaps) should be carefully
of the wing is well advanced, more elaborate and refined calculations as

set forth in a number of textbooks on aerodynamics should be made.


calculated.
The pertinent data of use at this stage are the variation of the lift and To obtain the necessary data for preliminary design purposes, the fol-
drag coefficients with the angle of attack, and the moment coefficient re-

lowing discussion will indicate a practical procedure. When the design


ferred to the aerodynamic center of the mean aerodynamic chord. As

pointed out elsewhere, the mean geometric chord may be taken as the
of the wing is well advanced, more elaborate and refined calculations as
mean aerodynamic chord for practical purposes.
set forth in a number of textbooks on aerodynamics should be made.
A wing having no aerodynamic twist2 would have its section angles for

zero lift arranged so that all sections would have no lift when the root sec-
The pertinent data of use at this stage are the variation of the lift and
tion was at zero lift. If aerodynamic twist were not zero, then the angles
drag coefficients with the angle of attack, and the moment coefficient re-
of zero lift for the various sections spanwise would not be the same as for

ferred to the aerodynamic center of the mean aerodynamic chord. As


pointed out elsewhere, the mean geometric chord may be taken as the
the root. The root section is usually selected for reference. In order to

obtain its position when the lift coefficient of the wing is zero, it will be

necessary to determine when mean aerodynamic chord for practical purposes.


The section angles corresponding to the section lift coefficients will then

make it possible to find the value of am for the root section.


A wing having no aerodynamic twist 2 would have its section angles for
To simplify the discussion and the presentation, a wing of zero aero-
zero lift arranged so that all sections would have no lift when the root sec-
dynamic twist will be considered. It is a comparatively easy matter to

tion was at zero lift. If aerodynamic twist were not zero, then the angles
of zero lift for the various sections span.wise would not be the same as for
work out the procedure for a wing with aerodynamic twist.

The equation of the lift curve (Cl versus a) at low values of the lift co-

efficient is
the root. The root section is usually selected for reference. In order to
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

where the various terms have the significance indicated as follows:

Ci = the lift coefficient of the wing of finite aspect ratio, or may be


obtain its position when the lift coefficient of the wing is zero, it will be
necessary to determine when
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

assumed equal for a wing of zero aerodynamic twist, as the aver-

~C,Cdy =
age of the section lift coefficients, for the tip and root airfoils,

* For definition of this term, see under Airfoil Construction in this chapter.
l. 0. (17)
ZCiCdy = 0.

(17)
The section angles corresponding to the section lift coefficients will then
CL = a(aR — ecu), make it possible to find the value of aio for the root section.
(18)

To simplify the discussion and the presentation, a wing of zero aero-


dynamic twist will be considered. It is a comparatively easy matter to
work out the procedure for a wing with aerodynamic twist.
The equation of the lift curve (CL versus a) at low values of the lift co-
efficient is
(18)
where the various terms have the significance indicated as follows:
CL = the lift coefficient of the wing of finite aspect ratio, or may be
assumed equal for a wing of zero aerodynamic twist, as the aver-
age of the section lift coefficients, for the tip and root airfoils,
1 For definition of this term, see under Airfoil Construction in this chapter.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
AIRFOIL SELECTION 43
AIRFOIL SELECTION

a = the slope of the finite aspect-ratio wing,


43

a = the slope of the finite aspect-ratio wing,

«k = the angle of attack in degrees of the finite aspect-ratio wing at <XR = the angle of attack in degrees of the finite aspect-ratio wing at
which the lift coefficient Cl occurs,

which the lift coefficient CL occurs,


aLo = the angle of zero lift for the finite aspect-ratio wing; or may be
c*lo — the angle of zero lift for the finite aspect-ratio wing; or may be

assumed equal to the average of the section zero-lift angles or

to the average for the root and tip airfoil; or may be determined
assumed equal to the average of the section zero-lift angles or
for the mean geometric chord assuming a linear variation span wise

of the section zero-lift angles.


to the average for the root and tip airfoil; or may be determined
The lift coefficient is usually considered the independent variable, and for the mean geometric chord assuming a linear variation spanwise
the angle of attack as the dependent variable. It would, therefore, be

of the section zero-lift angles.


The lift coefficient is usually considered the independent variable, and
easier to use equation (18) in the form

aR = + (18a)

= KCL + «lo. (18b) the angle of attack as the dependent variable. It would, therefore, be
The slope a may be calculated from

easier to use equation (18) in the form


a = i= 9.KB + 3)' (19)

where R is the aspect ratio of the wing and the other constants account for

planform and wing-tip corrections. These corrections vary for each type
(18a)
of planform and wing tip, but the values given are sufficiently accurate

for preliminary work.

The maximum lift coefficient is not so easy to predict for the finite
= KCL + az.o. (18b)
aspect-ratio wing, but it may be assumed to be about the same as for in-

The slope a may be calculated from


finite aspect ratio without incurring an error of more than from 3 to 7

per cent.

1 R (19)
To determine the desired drag coefficient Cd for the corresponding lift

coefficient Cl, the following relationship is useful:


a = K = 9.l(R + 3)'
Ci}

Cd = Cd° + «00«(lp.5 - 0.322) (20) v


where R is the aspect ratio of the wing and the other constants account for
= CD, + KiCi? (20a)
planform and wing-tip corrections. These corrections vary for each type
where Cb0 is the average spanwise of the section drag coefficients Cd, or,

of planform and wing tip, but the values given are sufficiently accurate
for preliminary work.
for a wing of zero aerodynamic twist, may be assumed to be the average

of the section drag coefficients of the tip and root airfoils. To make the

calculated values agree with experiment, the factor (10.5 — 0.3i?) has The maximum lift coefficient is not so easy to predict for the finite
been introduced to allow for planform variation and for tip effects.

aspect-ratio wing, but it may be assumed to be about the same as for in-
The moment coefficient about the aerodynamic center of the mean aero-

dynamic chord may be calculated by means of the following equation:


finite aspect ratio without incurring an error of more than from 3 to 7
per cent.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Cm. = tt^ 2(cm.c2dy + ciXa.c.cdy), (21)

To determine the desired drag coefficient Cn for the corresponding lift


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

coefficient CL, the following relationship is useful:


CL2
Cn = Cn. + 7rR(10.5 - 0.3R) (20)
I

(20a)
where Cn0 is the average spanwise of the section drag coefficients ca, or,
for a wing of zero aerodynamic twist, may be assumed to be the average
of the section drag coefficients of the tip and root airfoils. To make the
calculated values agree with experiment, the factor (10.5 - 0.3R) has
been introduced to allow for planform variation and for tip effects.
The moment coefficient about the aerodynamic center of the mean aero-
dynamic chord may be calculated by means of the following equation:
1
C,,.. = C,,.uS"'l;(c..._c2dy + C1Xa.c.cdy), (21)

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
44 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
44

where the various terms have the significance indicated as follows:


AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

where the various terms have the significance indicated as follows:

Cm.„. = theoretically, the mean aerodynamic chord, but for practical Cm.u. = theoretically, the mean aerodynamic chord, but for practical
purposes, the mean geometric chord (preferably stated in

purposes, the mean geometric chord (preferably stated in


inches);

S = wing area, in square inches if the linear dimensions are expressed


inches);
in inches;

S = wing area, in square inches if the linear dimensions are expressed


C = chord, in inches, of the section under consideration;

dy = the span, in inches (usually one inch) of the section under con-
in inches;
sideration; C = chord, in inches, of the section under consideration; ·
Ci = the section-lift coefficient;

dy = the span, in inches (usually one inch) of the section under con-
xa.c. = the distance, in inches, of the aerodynamic center behind the

leading edge of the section.


sideration;
Instead of the aerodynamic center, the quarter-point on the chord may
Ci = the section-lift coefficient;
Xa. c. = the distance, in inches, of the aerodynamic center behind the
be used, in which case the moment coefficients are about the quarter-point

of the chord.

Table III-3.
leading edge of the section.
Section characteristics

Instead of the aerodynamic center, the quarter-point on the chord may


Airfoil (or wing) characteristics

Root section
be used, in which case the moment coefficients are about the quarter-point
Tip section
of the chord.
<*Lo - (<*lo) root uelion

(1)

(2)
TABLE III-3.
C,

(3)
Section characteristics Airfoil (or wing) characteristics
Cd

(4) Root section Tip section CXLo = (aio) root 11ction


aio

(5)
(1) (2) (7)
(3) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12)
(4) (5) (13)
(6)
a14 C1 Cd
CL CDo KCL
a10 aR CL2 K1CL 2 CD
C1 Cd
- - - -- -- -- - - - - - - - - -- -- -
Ci

(6)

_40 -60
(7)

Cl
-
-20
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - -- -- - - - - - - -
_40
(8)

- - - - - - - - - -- - - - - - - - - - - - - -- -
(9)
oo -20
- - - - - -- - - - - - - - - - - - - -
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

KCl

(10)
20 oo
-40- - - - - -20- - - - - - -- - - - - -
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(11)

(12)

KlC,?
- - - -- -- - - - - - - -- - - - - -
(13)
60 40
- -- - - - - - - -- - - - - - - - - -
CD

go 60
-100- - -- - -go--- - - -- - - -- - -
-4°

-6°

- - - -- - - - - -- - - - - - - - - -- - - - - -
Cdq

OR

12° 100
Cl1

- - - -- -- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
-2°

14° 12°
-4°

- -- -- -- -- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
0°

16° 14°
-2°

2°

Root Station Tip Station


Airfoil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N ACA xxxx NACAxxxx
0°

4°

Angle of zero lift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0 degrees -2 degrees


2°

Chord. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - inches - inches


6°

Test conditions: Laboratory, Reynolds no., etc.


+
4°

8° Aspect ratio: . 9.l(R 3) _ 1


6°
Factors. K = R K1 - rR(l0.5 - 0.3R)
10°

8°

12°

10°

Original from
14°

12°
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
16°

14°

Airfoil
AIRFOIL SELECTION 45
AIRFOIL SELECTION

45

Table III-3 has been set up to illustrate the type of calculations required
Table III-3 has been set up to illustrate the type of calculations required
for a wing having the wing-tip airfoil set at minus two degrees with refer-
for a wing having the wing-tip airfoil set at minus two degrees with refer-
ence to the root airfoil in order to obtain zero aerodynamic twist (assum-

ence to the root airfoil in order to obtain zero aerodynamic twist (assum-
ing linear spanwise variation of all section characteristics).
ing linear span wise variation of all section characteristics).

Column 7 lists the average values of the section-lift coefficients given in

columns 2 and 5. Column 8 lists the average values of the section-drag


Column 7 lists the average values of the section-lift coefficients given in
coefficients given in columns 3 and 6. Column 10 lists the values obtained

by adding values of column 9 to aLo. The angle ckb is referred to the root
columns 2 and 5. Column 8 lists the average values of the section-drag
airfoil in the calculations indicated, that is aa = (ttio) root sectionp The lift
coefficients given in columns 3 and 6. Column 10 lists the values obtained
coefficients in column 7, plotted against the values of aR in column 10, will

by adding values of column 9 to aLO. The angle aR is referred to the root


airfoil in the calculations indicated, that is Cl'.LO = (a ro) root aection• The lift
give the lift curve for the wing of finite aspect ratio R. Column 12 lists

the values of the drag coefficients of the wing obtained by adding the

values of KiC]}, listed in column 11, to the values of Ceo in column 8. coefficients in column 7, plotted against the values of aR in column 10, will
A summary of airfoil data is available in NACA Report No. 824. Subse-

quent reports should be consulted for airfoil data useful for transonic and
give the lift curve for the wing of finite aspect ratio R. Column 12 lists
supersonic conditions. Some typical airfoil characteristics are shown in
the values of the drag coefficients of the wing obtained by adding the
Table III-4.

values of K 1 CL2, listed in column 11, to the values of Cvo in column 8.


The wing characteristics are affected by the fuselage, engine nacelles,

and other aerodynamic bodies that may be attached to the wing. Such
A summary of airfoil data is available in NACA Report No. 824. Subse-
effects will have to be accounted for if more precise calculations are

quent reports should be consulted for airfoil data useful for transonic and
supersonic conditions. Some typical airfoil characteristics are shown in
desired.

A small amount of wash-out, about 1 or 2 degrees, is usually desirable

to help in avoiding tip stall. Table IIl-4.


The ordinates of an airfoil are given in percentages of the chord so that

it is an easy matter to determine the depth of a section of a wing when the


The wing characteristics are affected by the fuselage, engine nacelles,
airfoil and chord length are known.
and other aerodynamic bodies that may be attached to the wing. Such
When the wing employs a different airfoil at the tip than at the root, it

effects will have to be accounted for if more precise calculations are


is possible to determine the ordinates of intermediate wing sections from

the known geometric relationships.


desired.
For example, it is desired to determine the ordinates of a section of a
A small amount of wash-out, about 1 or 2 degrees, is usually desirable
wing, tapered in planform as well as in thickness, a distance x from the

root. (See Chapter XVII, Design of the Wing.) Corresponding stations


to help in avoiding tip stall.
AIRFOIL CONSTRUCTION
would then be connected by straight lines so that the ordinate for the

upper camber for chord C would be

AIRFOIL CONSTRUCTION

The ordinates of an airfoil are given in percentages of the chord so that


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

it is an easy matter to determine the depth of a section of a wing when the


(22)

and the ordinate of the lower camber would be

airfoil and chord length are known.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(22a)

When the wing employs a different airfoil at the tip than at the root, it
is possible to determine the ordinates of intermediate wing sections from
the known geometric relationships.
For example, it is desired to determine the ordinates of a section of a
wing, tapered in planform as well as in thickness, a distance x from the
root. (See Chapter XVII, Design of the Wing.) Corresponding stations
would then be connected by straight lines so that the ordinate for the
upper camber for chord C would be

[hlu -
(h1u - h2u)
b Y
J 1
(22)

and the ordinate of the lower camber would be

[hll -
(hu - hu)
b
J
y '
(22a)

Original from
D191 iz by
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
46 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
46

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

where hiu = upper ordinate for the root airfoil,

hu — lower ordinate for the root airfoil,


where h1,. = upper ordinate for the root airfoil,
h2u = upper ordinate for the tip airfoil, hu = lower ordinate for the root airfoil,
hu = lower ordinate for the tip airfoil,

h2,. = upper ordinate for the tip airfoil,


h: 1 = lower ordinate for the tip airfoil,
b = distance in feet or inches between the root and tip airfoil,

y = distance in feet or inches between the root airfoil and the

airfoil at station y.
b = distance in feet or inches between the root and tip airfoil,
It is necessary to calculate the ordinate for each station along the chord

since the same relationship does not necessarily exist for all the stations
y = distance in feet or inches between the root airfoil and the
except in a few particular cases. airfoil at station y.
In general, it is undesirable to use a radically different airfoil at the tip

It is necessary to calculate the ordinate for each station along the chord
from that at the root because of the inherent structural difficulties.

Sweepback for High-Speed Airplanes


since the same relationship does not necessarily exist for all the stations
In a number of NACA technical notes (see TN 1032 and 1033) the plan-
except in a few particular cases.
forms of a number of wings designed for subsonic or supersonic speeds are

discussed. It is brought out that in case of an airfoil of infinite aspect


In general, it is undesirable to use a radically different airfoil at the tip
ratio moving at an angle of sideslip, the pressure distribution over the wing

from that at the root because of the inherent structural difficulties.


is determined solely by the component of motion whose direction is normal

Sweepback for High-Speed Airplanes


to the leading edge. From this fact it is further deduced that the pressure

drag of an airfoil may be reduced if the planforms utilize sweepback angles

greater than the Mach angle (the angle that the plane waves make with

In a number of N ACA technical notes (see TN 1032 and 1033) the plan-
forms of a number of wings designed for subsonic or supersonic speeds are
the airfoil at sonic or supersonic speeds).

If j8 represents the angle of sweepback, then the velocity causing the

pressure distribution over the airfoil for an airplane flying at velocity V


discussed. It is brought out that in case of an airfoil of infinite aspect
would be V cos /J. If V cos /3 is less than the sound velocity Vc, then the

flow and distribution would be similar to those occurring in an incompres-


ratio moving at an angle of sideslip, the pressure distribution over the wing
sible fluid or for subsonic speeds.
is determined solely by the component of motion whose direction is normal
The section characteristics for the speeds where M% = [(V cos j8)/Fc]J

to the leading edge. From this fact it is further deduced that the pressure
drag of an airfoil may be reduced if the planforms utilize sweepback angles
is less than 1 (that is, the lift, drag, and moment coefficients obtained for

low speeds) can be corrected to apply for speeds of V of the aircraft. The

following expressions permit calculating the corrections required:


greater than the Mach angle (the angle that the plane waves make with
ti .

VI - M2
the airfoil at sonic or supersonic speeds).
to give the new lift coefficient;
If {3 represents the angle of sweepback, then the velocity causing the
a=

pressure distribution over the airfoil for an airplane flying at velocity V


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

would be V cos {3. If V cos {3 is less than the sound velocity V c, then the
Vl - M2

to give the new slope of the lift curve. The subscript 0 refers to the sub-

flow and distribution would be similar to those occurring in an incompres-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

sonic tests.

The drag coefficient has to be found for an equivalent airfoil having a

sible fluid or for subsonic speeds.


change in the thickness and the camber. The new equivalent "thickness"

is
m
The section characteristics for the speeds where M 2 = [ (v cos Iv c];l
is less than 1 (that is, the lift, drag, and moment coefficients obtained for
low speeds) can be corrected to apply for speeds of V of the aircraft. The
following expressions permit calculating the corrections required:
C _ C10
I -v
- -,:.1===
M=2
to give the new lift coefficient;
ao
a = -v-::1==M=2
to give the new slope of the lift curve. The subscript 0 refers to the sub-
sonic tests.
The drag coefficient has to be found for an equivalent airfoil having a
change in the thickness and the camber. The new equivalent "thickness"
IS

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
0

8fT0

Op

9*"T0

OY\\

90OZ

92pOT

9OT0

WW

2O8

OOOT

*8*T

Of-OT

O00

00

s0000

%0Z

JO

00OT

0000

9f9

OT9

*TOT

00 OT

f00

20000

O00

OO9T

OO

000

OOT

9O9

OO

00T

0000

*O9

O0

s0000

%O

JO

8SZ

00OTs

00Ol

fOO

WO

2OO

pO

2O0

OO-

W20

99'00

90000

2Ol

9O00

90000

2OTs

9f9

O8

s00qs

%O

p00bj ^pađs« 00j wj«s !V0VN J° sauajuioqvj sjaij tefiuvj %v mu s^sa? HV «

'»OTO = «*

-" aajSas jp ađo[s '.tu = treisuj jp e00ojs .'g


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

TABLE 111-4. Typical airfoil characteristics.•

0
Slope,

.....
;;::i" Airfoil
section
Reynolds
number
m, of
lift
curve
a
degrees
Ill
Most
forward
position
am
degrees
a in
degrees CL_.
Depth at

C'"• CL_. CD...;.


per for of cen- for for CD.au.
O" of test 15% 20% 60% 70%
'"<: NACA CL= 0 ter of Ci_. CD....
radian, of of of of
R = 6 pressure chord chord chord chord
--
0006 3.21 x 106 4.28 -0.1 -0.002 0.25 0.88 13 0.0065 0 23.8 5.35 5.74 4.56 3.66 ~
0009 3.21 x 109 4.28 0.00 -0.003 0.25 1.27 14 0.0074 -1 22.9 8.02 8.60 6.84 5.49 ~
3.23 x 166

~
0012 4.32 0.00 -0.002 0.25 1.53 17 0.0083 -1 22.2 10.69 11.47 9.12 7.32
0015 3.2 x 106 4.24 0.00 -0.000 0.25 1.53 17 0.0093 0 21.2 13.36 14.34 11.40 9.16
0018 3.15 x 106 4.20 0.00 -0.002 0.24 1.49 17 0.0108 0 19.8 16.04 17.20 13.69 10.99
2509 3.06 x 106 4.31 -2.0 -0.052 0.29 1.38 13 0.0083 -1 22.9 8.04 8.62 6.85 5.50 tr.I
3.08 x 106
~
2512 4.28 -2.1 -0.054 0.28 1.62 17 0.0091 -1 22.3 10.70 11.46 9.12 7.32
2515 3.08 x 108 4.18 -2.0 -0.049 0.28 1.53 16 0.0104 -1 20.4 13.38 14.35 11.40 9.16
2518
2521
3.09 x 108
3.13 x 109
4.07
4.04
-2.0
-1.8
-0.047
-0.043
0.28
0.28
1.48
1.38
16
16
0.0113
0.0126
-1
-1
19.1
17.7
16.07
18.72
17.25
20.09
13.69 10.99
15.97 12.84
~
~
c::::
:z: 21012 8.37 x 106 4.32 -0.6 -0.001 0.25 1.67 15 0.0070 0 22.0 10.69 11.47 9.13 7.33
< 22012 8.32 x 106 4.34 -0.9 -0.005 0.25 1.66 16 0.0073 0 22.8 10.69 11.49 9.12 7.33
590 23012 8.48 x 106 4.34 -1.2 -0.005 0.26 1.67 16 0.0070 0 23.0 10.69 11.47 9.14 7.36
V"1 ... 24012 8.26 x 106 4.34 -1.5 -0.013 0.26 1.65 16 0.0073 -1 22.3 10.71 11.48 9.14 7.32
-i IC" 25012 8.24 x 108 4.34 -1.6 -0.019 0.27 1.61 15 0.0077 -1 21.9 10.72 11.51 9.14 7.34
-< -·

- 8.55 x 109
:::I
0 DI 22112 4.34 -0.8 -0.001 0.25 1.58 15 0.0073 0 22.1 10.69 11.48 9.13 7.34
-,,- 23112 8.21 x 109 4.34 -0.8 0.002 0.25 1.67 16 0.0075 -1 22.3 10.69 11.48 9.15 7.31
_a
n3-
:::::c
24112
25112
8.00 x 106
8.24 x 109
4.34
4.34
-0.9
-1.2
0.00
0.002
I 0.25
0.27
1.61
1.56
16
15
0.0075
0.0075
-1
0
22.3
22.3
10.71
10.73
11.47
11.48
9.13 7.32
9.13 7.33
~
>
z •All tests run at the Langley Field Laboratories of NACA; all data for aspect ratio = 6; slope per radian = m; slope per degree ... a;
m = 57.3a.
~
48 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
48

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

t= to
I to

Vl - M2'
v1 -M 2

For a cambered airfoil, the camber changes by the same ratio 1/Vl — M2.

The pitching moment coefficient Cma.c also changes by the same ratio.
For a cambered airfoil, the camber changes by the same ratio 1/Vl - M 2 •
In order to obtain aerodynamic characteristics at high speeds which
The pitching moment coefficient Cm a.c. also changes by the same ratio.
compare favorably with those at subsonic velocities, it is desirable to in-

In order to obtain aerodynamic characteristics at high speeds which


compare favorably with those at subsonic velocities, it is desirable to in-
troduce sweepback for the wing.

The section characteristics for an airfoil operating at supersonic speed

may be approximated for small angles of attack from subsonic data as in-
troduce sweepback for the wing.
dicated in the following equations.

Under supersonic conditions, the Mach number M of the free stream is


The section characteristics for an airfoil operating at supersonic speed
greater than 1, and the following relationships obtain:
may be approximated for small angles of attack from subsonic data as in-
C = 4a

dicated in the following equations.


'Vm2 - 1

and
Under supersonic conditions, the Mach number M of the free stream is
4a2
greater than 1, and the following relationships obtain:
Cd =

VM2 - 1

C = 4a ,
where a is small, is expressed in radians, and is measured with reference to

a line connecting the leading and trailing edges of the airfoil.


I VM2 - 1
These equations may be applied to thin airfoils of moderate camber.

Laminar-Flow Airfoils
and
It can be shown (consult a good book on aerodynamics) that if the
4a2
boundary layer could be maintained as laminar (nonturbulent) flow over
Cd= ,
the airfoil, then the drag coefficients of the airfoil would be lower than for
vM2 -1
airfoils not designed for maintaining laminar flow. While, theoretically,

laminar flow can be maintained, practically difficulties arise due to surface


where a is small, is expressed in radians, and is measured with reference to
irregularities, cut-outs, gaps in front of ailerons and flaps, and propeller
a line connecting the leading and trailing edges of the airfoil.
These equa~ns may be applied to thin u.irfoils of moderate camber.
slipstream.

The commonly used laminar-flow airfoils have been the NACA 24 series

(NACA 2409, 2412, etc.), the NACA 44 series (NACA 4409, 4415, 4418),

and the NACA 230 series (NACA 23009, 23015, etc.). For an excellent
Laminar-Flow Airfoils
compendium of airfoil data see NACA Report No. 824 entitled "Summary

It can be shown (consult a good book on aerodynamics) that if the


of Airfoil Data."

Compressible-Flow Airfoils
boundary layer could be maintained as laminar (nonturbulent) flow over
the airfoil, then the drag coefficients of the airfoil would be lower than for
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

A series of airfoils were developed by NACA which attempted to prevent

airfoils not designed for maintaining laminar flow. While, theoretically,


local speeds of the airflow over the airfoil from exceeding the local speed
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of sound. These airfoils are the NACA 16 series (NACA 16-009, 16-109,

16-209, etc.). The mean camber lines of these airfoils were designed to laminar flow can be maintained, practically difficulties arise due to surface
irregularities, cut-outs, gaps in front of ailerons and flaps, and propeller
slipstream.
The commonly used laminar-flow airfoils have been the NACA 24 series
(NACA 2409, 2412, etc.), the NACA 44 series (NACA 4409, 4415, 4418),
and the NACA 230 series (NACA 23009, 23015, etc.). For an excellent
compendium of airfoil data see N ACA Report No. 824 entitled "Summary
of Airfoil Data."
Compressible-Flow Airfoils
A series of airfoils were developed by N ACA which attempted to prevent
local speeds of the airflow over the airfoil from exceeding the local speed
of sound. These airfoils are the NACA 16 series (NACA 16-009, 16-109,
16- 209, etc.). The mean camber lines of these airfoils were designed to

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
AIRFOIL SELECTION 49
AIRFOIL SELECTION 49

obtain uniform chordwise distribution. Then the thickness ordinates


obtain uniform chordwise distribution. Then the thickness ordinates
were plotted perpendicular to the camber line.

The commonly used airfoils (NACA 24009, for example) had their maxi-
were plotted perpendicular to the camber line.
mum ordinate at about 30 per cent of the chord, whereas the NACA The commonly used airfoils (NACA 24009, for example) had their maxi-
16-009 had its maximum thickness at about 50 per cent of the chord.

mum ordinate at about 30 per cent of the chord, whereas the N ACA
16-009 had its maximum thickness at about 50 per cent of the chord.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
CHAPTER IV

External Loads on an Airplane in Flight

The forces that normally act on the airplane—lift, thrust, drag, and

gravitational forces—are of importance in the calculation of the perform-

ance parameters of the airplane in rectilinear flight. However, these

forces are not of such magnitude that the structure would have to be

designed to withstand them; rather the structure is designed to with-

stand the loads incurred in accelerated flight. It is obvious, also, that

an airplane used for acrobatics will encounter greater loads than one
CHAPTER IV
designed for cargo transportation. The designer must therefore be aware

of the nature and magnitude of such forces since the greater the forces

encountered, the greater the weight of the structure. It is not the pur-

External Loads on an Airplane in Flight


pose of this book to give a full exposition of stress analysis methods or

the complete load determination required for such an analysis, but some

insight into the subject will be offered.

LOAD FACTOR

There are various ways of defining the load factor. It is the ratio of

the applied load to the weight of the airplane. More technically, it may

be described as the multiplying factor by which the steady flight forces

are multiplied to obtain equivalent static effect of dynamic forces acting

during the acceleration of the airplane. In common parlance, it is cus-

tomary to speak of the load factor as the number of <7's, where g refers to

The forces that normally act on the airplane-lift, thrust, drag, and
the acceleration due to gravity.

The duration of the maximum dynamic loads on the airplane seldom


gravitational forces-are of importance in the calculation of the perform-
exceeds three seconds.

ance parameters of the airplane in rectiline.ar flight. However, these


forces are not of such magnitude that the structure would have to be
Strength requirements for aircraft stress analysis are specified in terms

of limit and ultimate loads. Limit loads are the maximum loads antici-

pated in service. Ultimate loads are equal to the limit loads multiplied designed to withstand them; rather the structure is designed to with-
by the factor of safety.

stand the loads incurred in accelerated flight. It is obvious, also, that


50

an airplane used for acrobatics will encounter greater loads than one
designed for cargo transportation. The designer must therefore be aware
of the nature and magnitude of such forces since the greater the forces
encountered, the greater the weight of the structure. It is not the pur-
pose of this book to give a full exposition of stress analysis methods or
the complete load determination required for such an analysis, but some
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:05 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

insight into the subject will be offered.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

LOAD FACTOR
There are various ways of defining the load factor. It is the ratio of
the applied load to the weight of the airplane. More technically, it may
be described as the multiplying factor by which the steady flight forces
are multiplied to obtain equivalent static effect of dynamic forces acting
during the acceleration of the airplane. In common parlance, it is cus-
tomary to speak of the load factor as the number of g's, where g refers to
the acceleration due to gravity.
The duration of the maximum dynamic loads on the airplane seldom
exceeds three seconds.
Strength requirements for aircraft stress analysis are specified in terms
of limit and ultimate loads. Limit loads are the maximum loads antici-
pated in service. Ultimate loads are equal to the limit loads multiplied
by the factor of safety.
50

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 51
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 51

In considering dynamic loads on the airplane for flight conditions, it is


In considering dynamic loads on the airplane for flight conditions, it is
assumed that steady flight conditions prevailed just before the particular assumed that steady flight conditions prevailed just before the particular
maneuver or gust occurred. This assumption will then, usually, indicate

maneuver or gust occurred. This assumption will then, usually, indicate


that some forces, such as thrust, will not have changed during the very

short time the critical condition is assumed to act. By the same token,
that some forces, such as thrust, will not have changed during the very
the speed of the aircraft will not have changed radically during the history
short time the critical condition is assumed to act. By the same token,
of a particular maneuver or gust condition.

THE AIRPLANE IN A MANEUVER


the speed of the aircraft will not have changed radically during the history
Some of the most severe loads encountered by the airplane in flight of a particular maneuver or gust condition.
occur in maneuvers, such as coming out of even a shallow dive.

THE AIRPLANE IN A MANEUVER


Theoretically, the worst load condition should occur when the airplane

comes out of a vertical dive instantaneously. During the maneuver, the

airplane would change its angle of attack from one at which the lift co-
Some of the most severe loads encountered by the airplane in flight
efficient was practically zero to an angle of attack where the lift coefficient

was maximum. The pertinent equations of interest are:


occur in maneuvers, such as coming out of even a shallow dive.
l = w = y2PvKin cLmaz s, Theoretically, the worst load condition should occur when the airplane
in horizontal flight at maximum lift coefficient; in the vertical dive

comes out of a vertical dive instantaneously. During the maneuver, the


d = w = y2Pv^cDmins.

Immediately upon coming out of the dive, as in a sharp pull-out, the


airplane would change its angle of attack from one at which the lift co-
speed would not have diminished and the maximum lift coefficient could
efficient was practically zero to an angle of attack where the lift coefficient
be attained. The lift on the airplane under this condition may be ex-

pressed as:
was maximum. The pertinent equations of interest are:
U = nW = y2Pv? cLmax s.

From these three relationships, it can be deduced that the load factor n
L = W = Yzpv2min CLma:e S,
can be expressed in terms of the following ratios:

L1 CLmaz
in horizontal flight at maximum lift coefficient; in the vertical dive
n = t — —

L V% mi„ Cd min
D = W = Yzpv,? CDmin S.
By assuming possible values for CLmax and Cx>mi„, we can gain some idea

of what magnitude such a load factor might have if other conditions did Immediately upon coming out of the dive, as in a sharp pull-out, the
not obtain. For example, 1.8 is a reasonable assumption for the value of

speed would not have diminished and the maximum lift coefficient could
Cl max, and .025 is possible for the value of Cflm,„; then the load factor

under these circumstances could be:


be attained. The lift on the airplane under this condition may be ex-
» = S = 720
pressed as:
Ll = nW = Yzµv,? CLma:e S.
0

However, the value is obviously fantastic. In the first place, the pilot
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:05 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

From these three relationships, it can be deduced that the load factor n
would probably not survive; and if the aircraft were designed for such a

load factor, it would be so heavy that, in all likelihood, it would never

can be expressed in terms of the following ratios:


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

get off the ground.

L1 v,? CLma:e
n = - = --= --·
L v2 min CD min
By assuming possible values for CL"'°"' and C Dmin, we can gain some idea
of what magnitude such a load factor might have if other conditions did
not obtain. For example, 1.8 is a reasonable assumption for the value of
CLma:ei and .025 is possible for the value of CDmin; then the load factor
under these circumstances could be:
1.8 72
n = .025 = ·
However, the value is obviously fantastic. In the first place, the pilot
would probably not survive; and if the aircraft were designed for such a
load factor, it would be so heavy that, in all likelihood, it would never
get off the ground.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
52 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
52

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


In actuality, the inertia of the airplane, as well as the air resistance,
In actuality, the inertia of the airplane, as well as the air resistance,
prevent instantaneous reaction. Furthermore, the pilot's delay, caused
prevent instantaneous reaction. Furthermore, the pilot's delay, caused

by his own psychological reaction, would prevent such an abrupt pull-out.


It is desirable to have a stick load that tends to resist the pilot's attempts
by his own psychological reaction, would prevent such an abrupt pull-out.

It is desirable to have a stick load that tends to resist the pilot's attempts

at a quick elevator pull-up.


at a quick elevator pull-up.
The system of forces and moments acting on the airplane when coming

out of a dive is illustrated in Figure IV-I.


The system of forces and moments acting on the airplane when coming
Figure IV-1. Forces acting on an airplane as it comes out of a dive.
out of a dive is illustrated in Figure IV-I.
THE AIRPLANE IN A GUST

Another flight situation that may produce extreme loads on the air-

plane occurs when an airplane encounters a vertical gust while in hori-

zontal flight. There is an immediate increase in the angle of attack,

which means there is also an increase in the lift coefficient and therefore

Flight path
the lift. The resultant airplane speed is also increased. Referring to

Figure IV-2, it may be seen that the lift would be:

Li = L + AL = y2pD? (CL + ACL) S

when the gust struck the airplane, and

l = w = yfat cL s
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:05 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

N
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE IV-1. Forces acting on an airplane as it comes out of a dive.

THE AIRPLANE IN A GUST


Another flight situation that may produce extreme loads on the air-
plane occurs when an airplane encounters a vertical gust while in hori-
zontal flight. There is an immediate increase in the angle of attack,
which means there is also an increase in the lift coefficient and therefore
the lift. The resultant airplane speed is also increased. Referring to
Figure IV-2, it may be seen that the lift would be:
LI = L + !1L = Yzpv,2 (CL + !1CL) S
when the gust struck the airplane, and
L = W = Yzpv 2 CL S

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
EXTERN AL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 53
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 53

just before the gust. Since even a vertical gust of about 50 per cent of

just before the gust. Since even a vertical gust of about 50 per cent of
the aircraft speed would cause only a change of about 12 per cent in the

resultant velocity, vr may be assumed equal to v. Thus the load factor


the aircraft speed would cause only a change of about 12 per cent in the
expressed as the ratios of the two lifts would be:
resultant velocity, Vr may be assumed equal to v. Thus the load factor
Z,i L + AL _ CL + ACL _ ACL

X = -^- 1 + An—n CT~ = 1+ CT


expressed as the ratios of the two lifts would be:
HyH

Figure IV-2. Velocity and angle relationships at the time an airplane encounters
LI = L + dL = 1 + dn = n = CL + dCL = 1 + dC L.
a vertical upward gust.
L L ~ ~
But since

C-W,

L y2psv*

and tan a = a radians = —'

and ACl — mAa Ta&um»

where m is the slope of the lift curve, it follows that:

11/ i / W i i pmuv

n = 1 + m- Ty-sr> = 1 +

MpSv* a 1 2(W/S)

Since the gust encountered is seldom sharp-edged (i.e., the gust in-

tensity varies from a minimum to a maximum over a finite distance),

and since the aircraft is a flexible rather than a rigid structure, the gust

load factor is somewhat modified and may be written:

KmuV

n = 1 ±

575 (W/S)

FIGURE IV-2. Velocity and angle relationships at the time an airplane encounters
a vertical upward gust.

·But since
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:05 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

u
and tan a = a radianB = -•
v
and dCL = mda radiarur

where m is the slope of the lift curve, it follows that:

n = 1 + (m ~) / Yz:Svz = 1 + 2 (;~~) ·
Since the gust encountered is seldom sharp-edged (i.e., the gust in-
tensity varies from a minimum to a maximum over a finite distance),
and since the aircraft is a flexible rather than a rigid structure, the gust
load factor is somewhat modified and may be written:
KmuV
n = 1 ± 575 (W /S)'

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
54 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
54 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

(since the vertical gust may act in either direction)


(since the vertical gust may act in either direction)
where V is in miles per hour,

u is in feet per second,

where V is in miles per hour,


u is in feet per second,
K is a function of the wing loading (See Figure IV-3),

1.467p _ J_

2 575' K is a function of the wing loading (See Figure IV-3),


1.4

1.2
l.467p 1
1.0 - 2 - = 575'
tO.8

1.4
O

^ 0.6

(a
-
1.2
0.4

v---- ~
0.2

0 10 20 30 40 50 60

Wing loading- j?, lb/ft*


-
Fioubb IV-3. Graph for determining gust load factor.

1. 0 /

/
Examination of the formula reveals that, all other factors remaining

-
the same, the load factor increases with:

I
1. increase in the aspect ratio of the wing,

2. increase in forward speed, V, of the aircraft,


\,,

~ 0.8

-/I
3. intensity of the gust, u,

4. decrease in the wing loading, W/S.


~
n =I+ lln
Since for any given design, the slope of the lift curve is determined once

....
~ =l t:. l!IJ..'l.5..to.
and for all upon selection of the airfoil and the aspect ratio, the wing
575W
-
.... 0.6
Cl)
-

~
(.!)
n * 1 + Ln

- / f KUVSm

575W

0.4
-/

-
-
1

0.2
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:05 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

I I I I I I

0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Wing loading - : , lb/ff 1

FrnuRE IV-3. Graph for determining gust load factor.

Examination of the formula reveals that, all other factors remaining


the same, the load factor increases with:
1. increase in the aspect ratio of the wing,
2. increase in forward speed, V, of the aircraft,
3. intensity of the gust, u,
4. decrease in the wing loading, W / S.
Since for any given design, the slope of the lift curve is determined once
and for all upon selection of the airfoil and the aspect ratio, the wing

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
EXTERN AL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 55
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 55

loading is also fixed. The load factor attained by an airplane would loading is also fixed. The load factor attained by an airplane would
then be dependent upon the factors u and V. In order not to reach

excessive load factors, the airplane would either have to avoid severe
then be dependent upon the factors u and V. In order not to reach
gust disturbances, or slow down when a gust was expected, as when
excessive load factors, the airplane would either have to avoid severe
flying through a line storm.

gust disturbances, or slow down when a gust was expected, as when


flying through a line storm.
The relative intensities and the altitudes at which gusts have been

encountered may be appreciated by examining the data given below.1

Velocity of gust, in

The relative intensities and the altitudes at which gusts have been
encountered may be appreciated by examining the data given below.I
feet per second

Altitude limit,

in feet

Line Squalls

and Thunderstorms
Line Squalls Obstructional Convection
40 to 120
and Thunderstorms Interferences Currents
20,000 or more feet

Obstructional
Velocity of gust, in
Interferences
feet per second 40 to 120 10 to 30 5 to 30
10 to 30

varies with Altitude limit, 20,000 or more feet varies with 4000
type of

in feet type of
obstruction

Convection
obstruction
Currents

5 to 30

4000
These gusts are usually vertical and may act either up or down, although
These gusts are usually vertical and may act either up or down, although gusts may act in any direction, depending upon their provocation.
gusts may act in any direction, depending upon their provocation.

EXPERIMENTAL DETERMINATION OF THE LOAD FACTOR

Load factors are usually presented in an empirical form, but the student

EXPERIMENTAL DETERMINATION OF THE LOAD FACTOR


should know the bases for the determination of these factors. In order

to ensure the structural integrity of the design, it is necessary to know


Load factors are usually presented in an empirical form, but the student
the magnitude of the load factors encountered under various conditions of

should know the bases for the determination of these factors. In order
to ensure the structural integrity of the design, it is necessary to know
flight. For this purpose, airplanes used for flight tests are equipped with

instruments designed to obtain the pertinent data that engineers evaluate

and synthesize for the designers.


the magnitude of the load factors encountered under various conditions of
Restraining

flight. For this purpose, airplanes used for flight tests are equipped with
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

spring

Smoked glass
instruments designed to obtain the pertinent data that engineers evaluate
and synthesize for the designers.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

target

Figure IV-4. A schematic diagram of a mechanically-operated accelerometer.

'The figures are approximate.

Pi tot
tube
Stylus
Restraining
spring

FIGURE IV-4. A schematic diagram of a mechanically-operated accelerometer.

1The figures a.re approximate.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
56 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
56

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Loads in flight are recorded by means of a special accelerometer-also
Loads in flight are recorded by means of a special accelerometer—also

called a V-g recorder—which is shown schematically in Figure


called a V -g recorder-which is shown schematically in Figure IV-4.
This recorder keeps a record of the velocity and the acceleration, and
This recorder keeps a record of the velocity and the acceleration, and
when supplemented by the pilot's record, supplies a full history. A

when supplemented by the pilot's record, supplies a full history. A


calibrated grid (see Figure IV-5) is placed over the smoked-glass record
calibrated grid (see Figure IV-5) is placed over the smoked-glass record

so that values of g, or the acceleration, may be read for corresponding

velocities. When removed from the recorder, the smoke film is fixed so that values of g, or the acceleration, may be read for corresponding
with a thin fixing lacquer that protects it from damages.

velocities. When removed from the recorder, the smoke film is fixed
Figure IV-5. A sketch of the calibration grid placed over the smoked-glass target.

The full scale deflection is of the order of three quarters of an inch. The horizontal
with a thin fixing lacquer that protects it from damages.
scale is in miles per hour; the vertical is in number of g'a or load factor.

By studying the data acquired in this manner, it is possible from time

to time to adjust the empirical formulas so that reasonable load factors

can be calculated mathematically.

This V-g recorder is usually placed at the center of gravity of the air-

plane and measures the vertical component of the acceleration of the

airplane. The horizontal component could also be measured, if desired,

by another accelerometer in which the mass is restrained vertically but

not horizontally. The horizontal and vertical axes here referred to are

those of the airplane.

It is usually necessary to measure only one component—the vertical or

normal component of the acceleration—since, with this value known, the

horizontal component can be determined from the aerodynamic charac-

teristics of the airplane.

Correlation of the data will result in the necessary correction factor to

be applied in the theoretical formula evolved for the gust condition, for

example, or it may lead to either arbitrary assignment of load factors

for certain maneuvering conditions or even to empirical formulas using

various parameters such as. power loading, wing loading, or gross weight.
FIGURE IV-5. A sketch of the calibration grid placed over the smoked-glass target.
The full scale deflection is of the order of three quarters of an inch. The horizontal
scale is in miles per hour; the vertical is in number of g's or load factor.

By studying the data acquired in this manner, it is possible from time


to time to adjust the empirical formulas so that reasonable load factors
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

can be calculated mathematically.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

This V-g recorder is usually placed at the center of gravity of the air-
plane and measures the vertical component of the acceleration of the
airplane. The horizontal component could also be measured, if desired,
by another accelerometer in which the mass is restrained vertically but
not horizontally. The horizontal and vertical axes here referred to are
those of the airplane.
It is usually necessary to measure only one component-the vertical or
normal component of the acceleration- since, with this value known, the
horizontal component can be determined from the aerodynamic charac-
teristics of the airplane.
Correlation of the data will result in the necessary correction factor to
be applied in the theoretical formula evolved for the gust condition, for
example, or it may lead to either arbitrary assignment of load factors
for certain maneuvering conditions or even to empirical formulas using
various parameters such as power loading, wing loading, or gross weight.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
EXTERN AL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 57
AIRPLANE CATEGORIES
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 57

AIRPLANE CATEGORIES

Not every airplane must be designed for the same conditions since not

Not every airplane must be designed for the same conditions since not
all airplanes are likely to be subjected to the same maneuvers. For the

purpose of stress analysis, airplanes are divided into certain categories.


all airplanes are likely to be subjected to the same maneuvers. For the
The Civil Aeronautics Board establishes the regulations governing the
purpose of stress analysis, airplanes are divided into certain categories.
structural integrity as well as the airworthiness of the civil airplane.

These regulations may be obtained from the U. S. Government Printing


The Civil Aeronautics Board establishes the regulations governing the
Office, Washington 25, D. C.
structural integrity as well as the airworthiness of the civil airplane.
The categories of airplanes are generally listed as follows:

These regulations may be obtained from the U. S. Government Printing


Office, Washington 25, D. C.
1. Normal. Non-acrobatic, non-scheduled passenger, and non-sched-

uled cargo operation airplanes are included in this category.

2. Utility. This refers to airplanes used in normal operations and

The categories of airplanes are generally listed as follows:


limited acrobatic maneuvers such as steep turns, spins, stalls, lazy eights,

and chandelles, but not snap or inverted maneuvers, or whip stalls.


1. Normal. Non-acrobatic, non-scheduled passenger, and non-sched-
3. Acrobatic. These have no specific restrictions as to type of maneu-

uled cargo operation airplanes are included in this category.


ver unless flight tests indicate certain limitations. The specified load

factors are highest for this category.


2. Utility. This refers to airplanes used in normal operations and
4. Transport. These are airplanes to be used in scheduled passenger
limited acrobatic maneuvers such as steep turns, spins, stalls, lazy eights,
and/or cargo operations.

5. Restricted. This includes any airplane not covered by any other


and chandelles, but not snap or inverted maneuvers, or whip stalls.
specified category.
3. Acrobatic. These have no specific restrictions as to type of maneu-
EMPIRICAL LOAD FACTORS

ver unless flight tests indicate certain limitations. The specified load
The maneuvering load factor for the air-transport airplane may be

found from the following empirical formula. It applies to power loadings


factors are highest for this category.
between 12 and 24 pounds per horsepower, provided the value of the load
4. Transport. These are airplanes to be used in scheduled passenger
factor does not exceed 4.33 or is less than 1.5.

n = 1 + An
and/or cargo operations.
_ [ 32,000 1 / [ 3.25 1
5. Restricted. This includes any airplane not covered by any other
71 |^U.77 + w + g200j I | 0.435 J

specified category.
For the other categories, the maneuvering load factors are specified

EMPIRICAL LOAD FACTORS


as follows:

XT 1 Ol 1 24000

Normal n = 2.1 +

The maneuvering load factor for the air-transport airplane may be


found from the following empirical formula. It applies to power loadings
W + 10,000

but n need not be greater than 3.8, and shall not be less than 2.5;

Utility n = 4.4; between 12 and 24 pounds per horsepower, provided the value of the load
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Acrobatic n = 6.0.

The gust velocities of ±30 feet per second are specified for speeds up
factor does not exceed 4.33 or is less than 1.5.
n = 1 + ~n
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

to cruising speed, and ±15 feet per second for speeds up to the design

dive speed.

n = [ o.77 + w3~C:oo] j [cw ~;~o.4as}


For the other categories, the maneuvermg load factors are specified
as follows:
24000
Normal n = 2.1+W+10,000'

but n need not be greater than 3.8, and shall not be less than 2.5;
Utility n = 4.4;
Acrobatic n = 6.0.
The gust velocities of ±30 feet per second are specified for speeds up
to cruising speed, and ± 15 feet per second for speeds up to the design
dive speed.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
58 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
58

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

-I

-2 1

^4QV 80 120^160

c
N

|200 240 --28jp Speed,

in mph <f 2 ~-+---*""'""=-':i-


Maneuver Gust
-u
~
11
- Combined

Figure IV-6. A typical envelope for an airplane in the utility category. The con-

ditions indicated by the small circle are the ones usually investigated. In the illustration
....
o.,...---~..._..+-:.,.__......;...-1-__;~--==-+--,-!+....:~
shown, the gust conditions happen not to be critical.

The loads calculated for the maneuvering and gust load factors are

Speed,
considered to be limit loads.

in mph
THE FLIGHT ENVELOPE

The flight envelope (V-n and V-g diagram are alternate names) estab-

lishes the relationships of limit load factors and airplane speeds. (See

Figure IV-6.) It represents, in empirical form, data similar to that

obtained in experimental flight tests from the record on the target plate

- - - Maneuver -·-Gust - - Combined


of the accelerometer.

While the limit load factor may be the same for several speeds and the

FIGURE IV-6. A typical envelope for an airplane in the utility category. The con-
negative limit load factors may be numerically less, it must be remembered

ditions indicated by the small circle are the ones usually investigated. In the illustration
that not only the magnitude of the applied forces, but their distribution

shown, the gust conditions happen not to be critical.


c,

Figure IV-7. Aerodynamic coefficients (forces) referred from the wind axes to the

geometric axis.

The loads calculated for the maneuvering and gust load factors are
considered to be limit loads.

THE FLIGHT ENVELOPE


The flight envelope (V-n and V-g diagram are alternate names) estab-
lishes the relationships of limit load factors and airplane speeds. (See
Figure IV-6.) It represents, in empirical form, data similar to that
obtained in experimental flight tests from the record on the target plate
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

of the accelerometer.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

While the limit load factor may be the same for several speeds and the
negative limit load factors may be numerically less, it must be remembered
that not only the magnitude of the applied forces, but their distribution
c,

FIGURE IV- 7. Aerodynamic coefficients (forces) referred from the wind axes to the
geometric axis.

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 59

will affect the design of some part of the airplane structure. It is con-
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 59

will affect the design of some part of the airplane structure. It is con-

ceivable that the front spar of the wing might be designed for one load ceivable that the front spar of the wing might be designed for one load
factor when the flaps, for example, are neutral, but the rear spar might

be designed for another but a lower load factor when the flaps are de-
factor when the flaps, for example, are neutral, but the rear spar might
flected. Again, while some flight loads may design no part of the wing,
be designed for another but a lower load factor when the flaps are de-
certain parts of the fuselage or empennage may be affected by the

flected. Again, while some flight loads may design no part of the wing,
certain parts of the fuselage or empennage may be affected by the
design loads.

REFERENCE AXES

For the aerodynamicist, it is usually convenient to use a set of so-called design loads.
"wind axes" where the line of action of the relative wind usually repre-

REFERENCE AXES
sents the abscissa. For the stress analyst, whose work concerns the

Table IV-1. Correcting aerodynamic coefficients for aspect ratio Ri.

1. Cl

For the aerodynamicist, it is usually convenient to use a set of so-called


"wind axes" where the line of action of the relative wind usually repre-
-.6

-.4

-.2 sents the abscissa. For the stress analyst, whose work concerns the
0

.2

.4

.6
TABLE IV-1. Correcting aerodynamic coefficients for aspect ratio R1.
-

2.2

1. CL -.6 -.4 -.2 0 .2 .4 .6 - 2.2


- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -
2. a Ro

3. Aa = ^ K Cl

2. a Ro
- -- - - -- -- - - - - - - -
4. «Rl = (2) + (3)

5. CoiorRo

7. CdBi = (5) + (6)


3. Aa - -
_ 57.3 KCL
8. cos a = cos (4)
1r
9. sin a = sin (4)

-57.3
= - - L
c
10. Cl cos a = (1) x (8)

1rR
11. Cd sin a = (7) x (9)

- - - - - - - - -- - - - - - -
12. Cn = (10) + (11)
4. aR, = (2) + (3)
13. Cl sin a = (1) x (9)
- - - - - -- -- -- -- - - -
14. Cd cos a = (7) x (8) 5. CD for Ro
15. Cc = (14) - (13) - -- - - - - - - - - - - -
AC _ KCL'
16. Cm.

6. D · - 'II"
--
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

K = - ir = W when Ro = 00

- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -
+ (6)
ill tt0 xli

7. CDR,= (5)
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

- -- - - - - - - - - -- -
8. COB a = COB (4)
- -- -- - - - - - - - - -
9. sin a = ein (4)
- -- - - - - - - - - - - -
10. CL COB a = (1) x (8)
- - - - - - - - - - - -- -
11. CD ein a = (7) x (9)
- - - - - - - - - - - -- -
12. CN = (10) + (11)
- -- - - - - - - - - - - -
13. CL ein a -- (1) x (9)
-- - - - - - -- - - - - -
14. CD COB a = (7) x (8)
- -- -- -- - - -- -- -- -
15. Cc= (14) - (13)
16. c...
---- -1-
----- - --

1 1 1
K = - - - = - when R 0 = oo
R1 R. R1

Original from
D1 iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
60 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

geometric configuration of the structure where the reference line may be


60

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

geometric configuration of the structure where the reference line may be the chord line, the thrust line, an axis of symmetry, or some other, it is
the chord line, the thrust line, an axis of symmetry, or some other, it is

more convenient to use a geometric set of axes.


more convenient to use a geometric set of axes.

It is not difficult to transfer a set of aerodynamic coefficients from one


It is not difficult to transfer a set of aerodynamic coefficients from one
set of axes to another. Referring to Figure IV-7, it may be seen that,
set of axes to another. Referring to Figure IV-7, it may be seen that,
using the chord line as the abscissa of the new set of geometry axes,

Cn = Cl cos a + Cd sin a,
using the chord line as the abscissa of the new set of geometry axes,
and

Cc = —Cl sin a + Cd cos a,


CN = CL cos a + CD sin a,
where Cn is referred to as the normal force coefficient or beam component,
and
and Cc as the chord force coefficient or chord component. The calcula-
Cc = - CL sin a + CD cos a,
tions may be carried out in tabular form, as in Table IV-1, and presented

where C N is referred to as the normal force coefficient or beam component,


graphically, as shown for a typical case in Figure IV-8.

It should be noted that except for low angles of attack, the chord force

is towards the leading edge, not the reverse. This does not mean that and Cc as the chord force coefficient or chord component. The calcula-
the local pressures, as at the nose of the airfoil, are negative, for such is

tions may be carried out in tabular form, as in Table IV-1, and presented
graphically, as shown for a typical case in Figure IV-8.
It should be noted that except for low angles of attack, the chord force
is towards the leading edge, not the reverse. This does not mean that
the local pressures, as at the nose of the airfoil, are negative, for such is

1.8 ,
/
1.6 •
1.4
./
yv
1.2
/"
1.0 v
/
0.8
v
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

~
0.6
~v
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

0.4
0.2 0.04 /
v
./ 7 ...... """""
0 0 0
-oy "/ 0
I"
0.4 ..... ~.8 1.2 1.6
-0.2 -0.04 -0.02
-0.4 -0.08 -0.04 -/ /
-0.6 -0.12 -0.06
-0.8 -0.16 -0.08 ,
-1.0-0.20 -0.10
_I
f} - II
,,1

"' ' ,,
\.


--~

CN Cc CM 0
\
FIGURE IV-8. The beam and chord components of the lift and drag coefficients of
the airfoil in a typical case.

Original from
D1 iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 61

not the case. However, it does mean that the chord component of the
resultant of the lift and drag forces on the wing is forward.

GENERALIZED SYSTEM OF FORCES


The various forces acting on the airplane in accelerated flight may be
represented as shown in Figure IV-9, where all forces of aerodynamic
origin have been referred to the geometric axes rather than to the wind
axes. The representation shown is known as a "generalized system of
forces," from the three equilibrium equations:

l;Y = 0 n1W + n2W + naW = O,


n1 + n2 + na = 0;
l;X = O n,.,W + n.,.w + n,.,W = 0 or n,., + n,., + n.,, = O;
10M = 0 n,.,W(y4C - y,C) + M + n1Wz2C - n,.,WyiC
- naW(xaC) = O, na = n,.,(y, - Y2) + m + n1x2 - n,.,y,,
qCC ...,.s qC ...,.s
where m = WC = --w--·
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Flaum: IV-9. Diagram of generalized system of forces and moments acting on an


airplane.

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
62 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

These forces may be either specified in terms of load factors or evaluated


62

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

These forces may be either specified in terms of load factors or evaluated


from other relationships, as follows:
from other relationships, as follows:

1. niW = applied limit load, 1. n1W = applied limit load,


= qCrfS,

where ni is the specified vertical component of the limit load factor for
= qCNS,
the appropriate gust or maneuvering condition for a given speed. CN

can therefore be calculated.


where n1 is the specified vertical component of the limit load factor for
2. nxlW = qCJS,
the appropriate gust or maneuvering condition for a given speed. C N
where nxl is the horizontal component of the limit load factor. Cc cor-

can therefore be calculated.


responds to the same angle of attack as the Cn value above, so that when

Cn has been found, Cc can be found and nxl determined.


2.
3. nx,W = -Tor - ^^-r-

where T or PT is the thrust or power required to fly at velocity V for which where n.,, is the horizontal component of the limit load factor. Cc cor-
the limit load factor has been specified.

responds to the same angle of attack as the C N value above, so that when
CN has been found, Cc can be found and n,., determined.
4. n3W

is the tail balancing load and can be determined for the particular force

system.

5. n2W and nxlW

3. n.,,W = -Tor - 550VP.. ,


are the components of the inertia forces required to satisfy the equilibrium

conditions and can now be calculated from the equations satisfying

SF = 0 and SX = 0.
where Tor P,. is the thrust or power required to fly at velocity V for which
Since the forces may act in various directions and may have any magni-

tude, depending upon the conditions to be considered, it is convenient


the limit load factor has been specified.
to consider all forces and moments acting in the positive direction. By

substitution of the known or specified values with the proper sign (plus
4.
or negative as the case may be), the unknowns may then be accordingly

evaluated as to magnitude and sign.


is the tail balancing load and can be determined for the particular force
Comparing the force diagram for the airplane in a maneuver (Figure
system.
IV-1) with the generalized system of forces (Figure IV-9), it will be

noted that some assumptions have been made. These may be explained
5. n2W and n,.tW
as follows:

1. The drag of the tail surfaces, the fuselage, etc., is usually considered
are the components of the inertia forces required to satisfy the equilibrium
negligible for smaller airplanes, but some allowances should be made for

conditions and can now be calculated from the equations satisfying


l':Y = 0 and l':X = 0.
these forces for large airplanes.

2. The moment of inertia due to the angular acceleration is omitted for


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

many conditions since its magnitude is usually insignificant. If it is

specified, an additional term appears in the equation for SAf = 0.


Since the forces may act in various directions and may have any magni-
tude, depending upon the conditions to be considered, it is convenient
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

to consider all forces and moments acting in the positive direction. By


substitution of the known or specified values with the proper sign (plus
or negative as the case may be), the unknowns may then be accordingly
evaluated as to magnitude and sign.
Comparing the force diagram for the airplane in a maneuver (Figure
IV-1) with the generalized system of forces (Figure IV-9), it will be
noted that some assumptions have been made. These may be explained
as follows:
1. The drag of the tail surfaces, the fuselage, etc., is usually considered
negligible for smaller airplanes, but some allowances should be made for
these forces for large airplanes.
2. The moment of inertia due to the angular acceleration is omitted for
many conditions since its magnitude is usually insignificant. If it is
specified, an additional term appears in the equation for l':M = 0.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 63
EXTERNAL LOADS ON AN AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT 63

The term n is called a load factor, for which the specific definitions are:
The term n is called a load factor, for which the specific definitions are:
The load factor or acceleration factor n is then the ratio of a load to the
The load factor or acceleration factor n is then the ratio of a load to the

design weight—generally the gross weight of the airplane. When the

load in question represents the net external load acting on the airplane
design weight-generally the gross weight of the airplane. When the
in a given direction, n represents the acceleration factor in that direction.

The limit load is a load (or load factor, or pressure) that, assumed
load in question represents the net external load acting on the airplane
or known, may be safely experienced but may not be exceeded in opera-
in a given direction, n represents the acceleration factor in that direction.
tion. The factors wi and nxl are usually designated as the components

of the limit load factor.


The limit load is a load (or load factor, or pressure) that, assumed
The factors n2 and nxi are the components of the inertia load factor.
or known, may be safely experienced but may not be exceeded in opera-
The factor n3 is known as the net tail load factor or tail balancing load.

OTHER DYNAMIC LOADS


tion. The factors n1 and nz 1 are usually designated as the components
The discussions so far have dealt primarily with flight loads. There
of the limit load factor.
are many conditions, other than maneuvering or gust, that may impose

loads upon the structure.


The factors n 2 and nz, are the components of the inertia load factor.
The factor n 3 is known as the net tail load factor or tail balancing load.

OTHER DYNAMIC LOADS


The discussions so far have dealt primarily with flight loads. There
are many conditions, other than maneuvering or gust, that may impose
loads upon the structure.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER V

Materials of Construction

APPLICATION OF AVAILABLE MATERIALS

Many structural materials have been used for building airplanes. Early

designs were built up primarily of wood elements with steel fittings and

wires, and the whole covered with doped fabric. It was not long, how-

ever, before tubular steel was used for the truss-type fuselage and landing
CHAPTER V
gears. The wing construction, however, was made of wood and fabric.

As the airplanes became larger, the old methods of construction were

not very economical, and it also became difficult to get the material in the

large sizes required. Reinforced monocoque, making use of aluminum

Materials of Construetion
alloy sheet, was a natural evolution and is the most common form of con-

struction today.

Small airplanes, carrying from 1 to 5 passengers, may still employ a

wing with wooden spars, aluminum alloy ribs, steel wire drag bracing, all

enveloped in a doped fabric covering to give the structure the final airfoil

shape. The fuselage of such airplanes is generally a tubular steel truss-

type, with possibly wooden former strips to fair the lines, and the whole

covered with doped fabric.

The larger the airplane becomes, the more likely that all the structure,

the wing, fuselage, and tail surfaces, is composed of aluminum alloy sheet
APPLICATION OF AVAILABLE MATERIALS
and extrusions.

Another material that may be extensively used, especially for very large
Many structural materials have been used for building airplanes. Early
airplanes where sizes are determined by allowable stresses rather than by
designs were built up primarily of wood elements with steel fittings and
minimums established by fabrication or maintenance practice, is stainless

steel. Comparatively few airplanes have been made of this material to


wires, and the whole covered with doped fabric. It was not long, how-
date. ever, before tubular steel was used for the truss-type fuselage and landing
Wood, in the form of plywood, has been used for gliders and for air-

gears. The wing construction, however, was made of wood and fabric.
AB the airplanes became larger, the old methods of construction were
planes when strategic materials were lacking. However, the fabrication of

wooden structures of this type, while successful, still cause maintenance

and inspection difficulties so that deterioration due to extremes in tem-


not very economical, and it also became difficult to get the material in the
64

large sizes required. Reinforced monocoque, making use of aluminum


alloy sheet, was a natural evolution and is the most common form of con-
struction today.
Small airplanes, carrying from 1 to 5 passengers, may still employ a
wing with wooden spars, aluminum alloy ribs, steel wire drag bracing, all
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

enveloped in a doped fabric covering to give the structure the final airfoil
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

shape. The fuselage of such airplanes is generally a tubular steel truss-


type, with possibly wooden former strips to fair the lines, and the whole
covered with doped fabric.
The larger the airplane becomes, the more likely that all the structure,
the wing, fuselage, and tail surfaces, is composed of aluminum alloy sheet
and extrusions.
Another material that may be extensively used, especially for very large
airplanes where sizes are determined by allowable stresses rather than by
minimums established by fabrication or maintenance practice, is stainless
steel. Comparatively few airplanes have been made of this material to
date.
Wood, in the form of plywood, has been used for gliders and for air-
planes when strategic materials were lacking. However, the fabrication of
wooden structures of this type, while successful, still cause maintenance
and inspection difficulties so that deterioration due to extremes in tem-
64

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 65
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION

65

perature, bacteria, moisture, and the like have not encouraged extensive
perature, bacteria, moisture, and the like have not encouraged extensive
exploitation of this material.
exploitation of this material.
Magnesium alloy may be used in place of aluminum alloy to some extent,

Magnesium alloy may be used in place of aluminum alloy to some extent,


but as yet its use has been limited.

Experimental designs using glass fibers held together with synthetic


but as yet its use has been limited.
resins and impregnated fibers have been built and test flown. Although Experimental designs using glass fibers held together with synthetic
these materials have certain merits, the wide use of a material depends

resins and impregnated fibers have been built and test flown. Although
largely upon:

1. Availability of the raw material.


these materials have certain merits, the wide use of a material depends
2. Manufacturing facilities for fabricating sheet, extrusions, and billets.
largely upon:
3. Cost.

4. Ease in fabrication of the final structure with the specific material.

1. Availability of the raw material.


2. Manufacturing facilities for fabricating sheet., extrusions, and billets.
5. Reliability of the mechanical properties of the material.

6. Ease of maintenance of the final product.

7. Susceptibility to deterioration due to moisture, chemicals, tempera- 3. Cost.


ture, etc.

Magnesium alloys are particularly suitable for instrument casings, en-


4. Ease in fabrication of the final structure with the specific material.
gine housings, and the like.
5. Reliability of the mechanical properties of the material.
Chrome molybdenum and chrome vanadium steels, and some low-carbon
6. Ease of maintenance of the final product.
steels are used for fittings, struts, and some hardware.

Stainless steels are suitable for exhaust stacks, heating units, firewalls,
7. Susceptibility to deterioration due to moisture, chemicals, tempera-
and other specialized uses. ture, etc.
ALUMINUM AND ALUMINUM ALLOYS

The information listed here on aluminum and aluminum alloys is quoted Magnesium alloys are particularly suitable for instrument casings, en-
from various publications of the Aluminum Company of America.

Commercially pure aluminum has a minimum aluminum content of 99


gine housings, and the like.
per cent, the balance being other metals normally present, mainly iron
Chrome molybdenum and chrome vanadium steels, and some low-carbon
and silicon. It has a high degree of resistance to corrosion and can be
steels are used for fittings, struts, and some hardware.
Stainless steels are suitable for exhaust stacks, heating units, firewalls,
easily formed into intricate shapes. It is relatively low in strength, how-

ever, having a tensile strength of about 12,000 pounds per square inch in

its soft or annealed state. The pure metal, therefore, does not have the and other specialized uses.
strength required for structural airplane parts.

Higher strengths may be obtained by the process of alloying, that is, by

ALUMINUM AND ALUMINUM ALLOYS


adding small amounts of one or more other metals to the aluminum. The

resulting alloys are less easily formed and, with some exceptions, they
The information listed here on aluminum and aluminum alloys is quoted
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

have lower resistance to corrosion than the commercially pure metal.

from various publications of the Aluminum Company of America.


Commercially pure aluminum has a minimum aluminum content of 99
Alloying is not the only way of increasing the strength of aluminum.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Like copper, brass, steel, and other metals, aluminum becomes stronger

and harder as it is rolled, formed, or otherwise cold-worked. Since the


per cent, the balance being other metals normally present, mainly iron
hardness depends on the amount of cold work done, some of the wrought

aluminum alloys are available in several work-hardened tempers. As the


and silicon. It has a high degree of resistance to corrosion and can be
easily formed into intricate shapes. It is relatively low in strength, how-
ever, having a tensile strength of about 12,000 pounds per square inch in
its soft or annealed state. The pure metal, therefore, does not have the
strength required for structural airplane parts.
Higher strengths may be obtained by the process of alloying, that is, by
adding small amounts of one or more other metals to the aluminum. The
resulting alloys are less easily formed and, with some exceptions, they
have lower resistance to corrosion than the commercially pure metal.
Alloying is not the only way of increasing the strength of aluminum.
Like copper, brass, steel, and other metals, aluminum becomes stronger
and harder as it is rolled, formed, or otherwise cold-worked. Since the
hardness depends on the amount of cold work done, some of the wrought
aluminum alloys are available in several work-hardened tempers. As the

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
66 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
66

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


strengths are increased, there is some sacrifice in the metal's ability to be
strengths are increased, there is some sacrifice in the metal's ability to be

worked easily and successfully into intricate commercial forms.


Heat treatment provides another means of increasing the strength of
worked easily and successfully into intricate commercial forms.

Heat treatment provides another means of increasing the strength of

some of the aluminum alloys. With but minor exceptions, the aluminum
some of the aluminum alloys. With but minor exceptions, the aluminum
alloys used for structural parts in aircraft are those which can be heat

treated to obtain higher strengths. When finally installed in the airplane,


alloys used for structural parts in aircraft are those which can be heat
such materials must be in the heat-treated condition.
treated to obtain higher strengths. When finally installed in the airplane,
Classification and Nomenclature

such materials must be in the heat-treated condition.


Aluminum alloys are obtainable in either cast or wrought forms. They

may be further classed as nonheat-treatable and heat-treatable alloys.

The different alloy compositions are distinguished by alloy numbers.


Classification and Nomenclature
Wrought alloys are distinguished from cast alloys by the letter "S" fol-
Aluminum alloys are obtainable in either cast or wrought forms. They
lowing this number.

An alloy in the heat-treated temper (such as 24S-T) may be further


may be further classed as nonheat-treatable and heat-treatable alloys.
cold-worked, such as by rolling, to obtain still greater strengths. It is then The different alloy compositions are distinguished by alloy numbers.
said to be in the "RT" temper. Although this further rolling reduces the

Wrought alloys are distinguished from cast alloys by the letter "S" fol-
elongation and workability, 24S and Alclad 24S in the "RT" temper are

Table V-l. Temper designations.


lowing this number.
Type
An alloy in the heat-treated temper (such as 24S-T) may be further
Description

Temper
cold-worked, such as by rolling, to obtain still greater strengths. It is then
designation said to be in the "RT" temper. Although this further rolling reduces the
Example

elongation and workability, 248 and Alclad 248 in the "RT" temper are
Annealed condition

24S-0
TABLE V-1. Temper designations.
Heat treated and quenched but

not aged completely

Temper
W*

Type Description .ieRignation Example


61S-W

Heat-

Annealed condition 0 248-0


treatable

alloys

Heat treated and quenched but


Wrought

Full heat-treated condition


not aged completely w• 618-W
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

24S-T
Heat- Full heat-treated condition T 248-T
treatable Wrought
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Heat treated and subsequently cold

worked a prescribed amount


alloys Heat treated and subsequently cold
RT
worked a prescribed amount RT 248-RT
24S-RT

Cast
Specific tempers attained by differ-
Specific tempers attained by differ-
Ce.st ent heat treatments are indi- T4, T6, 195-T4
ent heat treatments are indi-
cated by number etc. 195-T6
cated by number

T4, T6, Annealed condition 0 38-0


etc.

195-T4 Intermediate tempers produced by XH HH 538-XH


195-T6
cold working various amounts %H
Annealed condition
Nonheat- Wrought
0
treatable Full he.rd temper obtained by max-
3S-0
alloys imum commercial degree of cold
Nonheat-

working H 28-H
Wrought

Intermediate tempers produced by

Ce.st No temper designation 43


cold working various amounts

• W temper is applied only to those alloys that require an artificial aging treatment
#H Y2H.

to produce the fully heat-treated T condition.


%H

53S-KH

treatable

alloys

Full hard temper obtained by max-

imum commercial degree of cold

Original from
working

Dig iz b
H
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
2&-H

Cast

No temper designation
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 67
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION

67 regularly corrugated and formed into other aircraft parts. Temper


regularly corrugated and formed into other aircraft parts. Temper

designations for alloys are shown in Table V-l.


designations for alloys are shown in Table V-1.
Sheet

A large percentage of the material in the modern airplane is aluminum

Sheet
alloy sheet, used for the outer covering or skin and for various other struc-

tural parts. Since most of this sheet is subject to high stresses under some
A large percentage of the material in the modern airplane is aluminum
flight conditions, high-strength alloy 24S-T is almost universally used.

alloy sheet, used for the outer covering or skin and for various other struc-
tural parts. Since most of this sheet is subject to high stresses under some
(Since the war, most new designs are making use of 75S.) Nonstructural

parts are sometimes made from the alloys that are not heat-treated or

from one of the lower strength heat-treated alloys.


flight conditions, high-strength alloy 248-T is almost universally used.
Approximately three-fourths of the 24S and 75S sheet used in aircraft is

in the form of Alclad sheet. This material has a high-strength core cov-
(Since the war, most new designs are making use of 758.) Nonstructural
ered on each side with a coating of relatively pure aluminum which has a
parts are sometimes made from the alloys that are not heat-treated or
high resistance to corrosion. This coating protects the core in two ways.

from one of the lower strength heat-treated alloys.


Approximately three-fourths of the 248 and 758 sheet used in aircraft is
It not only covers most of the core and prevents contact with corrosive

agents, but also protects the core electrolytically. This electrolytic pro-

tection is given to the cut edges, to areas where the coating is abraded in the form of Alclad sheet. This material has a high-strength core cov-
away, and even to rivet heads.

Annealed coiled sheet is used for blanking out small parts which are
ered on each side with a coating of relatively pure aluminum which has a
subsequently heat treated.
high resistance to corrosion. This coating protects the core in two ways.
Table V-2. Flat sheet and plate (Alcoa standard sizes).
It not only covers most of the core and prevents contact with corrosive
agents, but also protects the core electrolytically. This electrolytic pro-
Thickness

(in.)

61S-T tection is given to the cut edges, to areas where the coating is abraded
24S

away, and even to rivet heads.


O and T

Alclad 24S
Annealed coiled sheet is used for blanking out small parts which are
OandT
subsequently heat treated.
Alclad 75S

O and T

0.012

TABLE V-2. Flat sheet and plate (Alcoa standard sizes).


0.016

24 X

36 X
Thickness 248 Alclad 248 Alclad 758
120
(in.) 618-T 0 and T 0 and T 0 and T
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

144

36 X 144

0.012 . . .... .. .. . . . . .. 24 x 120 ..... ...


0.016 . .. ... . . ........ 36 x 144 36 x 144
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

0.020

36 X

0.020 .... .... 36 x 144 36 x 144 36 x 144


144

0.025 36 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144 36 x 144


36 X

0.032 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144


144

0.040 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144


36 X 144

0.051 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144


0.064 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144
0.025

x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 x 144


36 X 144

0.072 48
x 144 48 x 144 x 144 48 x 144
48 X

0.081 48 48
x 144 48 x 144 x 144 48 x 144
144

0.091 48 48
x 144 48 x 144 x 144 48 x 144
48 X

0.102 48 48
x 144 48 x 144 x 144 48 x 144
144

0.125 48 48
x 144 48 x 144 x 144 48 x 144
36 X 144

0.156 48 48
x 144 48 x 144 x 144 48 x 144
0.032

0.188 48 48
x 144
48 X 144

0.250 48 x 144 48 x 144 48 . . ..... .


........
48 X

144
0.312 . . . . ... . 48 x 144 . . .. . .. .
0.375 48 x 144 24 x 72 . . .. . . . . ..... ...
. . .. . . . . ........
48 X

. . .. .. .. 48 x 144
. . .. . . . .
144

0.500 48 x 144 24 x 72 ..... ...


.... ... . ........
48 X 144

0.040
. . . . .. . . 48 x 144
48 X 144

48 X

144

48 X

144

Original from
48 X 144

0.051
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOF ICHIGAN
48 X 144

48 X

144
68 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
68

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL Tubing


Tubing

Tubing is used in aircraft construction for fuel, oil, and other liquid lines;
Tubing is used in aircraft construction for fuel, oil, and other liquid lines;
instrument lines; and structural parts, either in the airframe itself or in instrument lines; and structural parts, either in the airframe itself or in
places such as the control system or power plant.

places such as the control system or power plant.


Extruded Shapes

An extruded shape is produced by forcing hot (but not molten) metal

through a die in which there is an opening corresponding in shape to the


Extruded Shapes
desired cross section. This process frequently provides more efficient

utilization of metal than rolled shapes, and it permits production of many


An extruded shape is produced by forcing hot (but not molten) metal
shapes that cannot be rolled.
through a die in which there is an opening corresponding in shape to the
Extruded shapes are used as stringers and other important structural

desired cross section. This process frequently provides more efficient


parts of the airframe, and provide easy assembly as well as maximum

structural usefulness. The alloy 14S, which has been used extensively
utilization of metal than rolled shapes, and it permits production of many
for several years in forgings, has lately become available for extrusions in shapes that cannot be rolled.
thicknesses of inch and greater. Extrusions of this alloy, in general,

are significantly stronger than those of 24S alloy, which has been most ex-
Extruded shapes are used as stringers and other important structural
tensively used up to the present for structural members of airframes.
parts of the airframe, and provide easy assembly as well as maximum
(Again, new designs are making use of 75S, which is the strongest alumi-
structural usefulness. The alloy 148, which has been used extensively
num alloy available.) Extruded shapes not requiring high strength are

for several years in forgings, has lately become available for extrusions in
thicknesses of Ys inch and greater. Extrusions of this alloy, in general,
sometimes made from 63S or 61S in a suitable temper, or from 2S or 3S.

These last two alloys are used in the "as-extruded" condition which is very

slightly work-hardened, and not in a specific temper.

are significantly stronger than those of 248 alloy, which has been most ex-
tensively used up to the present for structural members of airframes.
Table V-3. (Refer to Figure V-l.)

B&S

Thickness,
(Again, new designs are making use of 758, which is the strongest alumi-
Range of dimension,

Sheet Gage
num alloy available.) Extruded shapes not requiring high strength are
in inches
sometimes made from 638 or 618 in a suitable temper, or from 28 or 38.
in inches

These last two alloys are used in the "as-extruded" condition which is very
slightly work-hardened, and not in a specific temper.
A

28-21

.012-.028
TABLE V-3. (Refer to Figure V-1.)
Vs-IH
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

20-18

.032-.040
B&S Thickness, Range of dimension,
Sheet Gage in inches in inches
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

V2-VA

17-16

.045-.051

1 -3
A B c
Vs-2

15-14
28-21 .012-.028 %-1% %-lU ;<a-U
.057-.064
20-18 .032-.040 ~-2 72-172 u-~
13-12
17-16 .045-.051 1 -3 %-2 ~&-%
.072-.081
15-14 .057-.064 lU-372 %-272 %-'!{5
1^-4
13-12 .072-.081 1%-4 1 -3 ?16-72
1 -3
11-10 .091-.102 2 -5 2 -372 72-?{6
11-10
R for all thick-
I
.091-.102 nesses ..... ... 72 to% I
2 -5

2 -3^

R for all thick-


Forgings
nesses
Forgings make up a relatively small percentage of the total weight of an
Forgings

Forgings make up a relatively small percentage of the total weight of an


airframe, but they serve a most important function as structural and other
airframe, but they serve a most important function as structural and other
fittings in addition to their well-known uses for making engine parts and
fittings in addition to their well-known uses for making engine parts and

propeller blades. Most forgings are made in dies on hammers, but some
propeller blades. Most forgings are made in dies on hammers, but some

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 69
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION

69

Formed or drawn sections

Extruded sections

:rct81-t
Figure V-l. Typical formed, drawn, and extruded sections used in the aircraft

structure.

TA f
A T

--
----- -----

==-= ===
. c;j

Tw
8
lJ
----
~A-j

'
---------
----

'
Formed or drawn sections
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Extruded sections

FIGURE V-1. Typical formed, drawn, and extruded sections used in the aircraft
structure.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
70 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
70

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


are pressed rather than struck. These are called press forgings. The
are pressed rather than struck. These are called press forgings. The

latter require less "draft" than hammer forgings and permit somewhat
latter require less "draft" than hammer forgings and permit somewhat

closer tolerances. Many forgings are made from alloy A51S-T, whereas
closer tolerances. Many forgings are made from alloy A51S-T, whereas
14S-T is usually employed for highly stressed forged fittings. Alloy
148-T is usually employed for highly stressed forged fittings. Alloy
75S-T forgings are also available, and are being used in several new de-

signs.
758-T forgings are also available, and are being used in several new de-
Castings
signs.
Aluminum castings are more extensively used in the airplane engine and

for accessories than in the airframe itself. Depending on the quantities

Castings
and properties required, such castings are produced by one of three basic

methods: sand, permanent-mold, or die. Sand castings are adaptable to Aluminum castings are more extensively used in the airplane engine and
a wide range of products from the smallest to the largest. Permanent-

for accessories than in the airframe itself. Depending on the quantities


mold castings are used in order to obtain higher mechanical properties,

better surfaces, or more accurate dimensions. Die castings find applica-


and properties required, such castings are produced by one of three basic
tion in cases where relatively large production of a given part is involved,
methods: sand, permanent-mold, or die. Sand castings are adaptable to
since this will distribute the die costs over a large number of units, and at

the same time reduce machining costs because of closer tolerances and
a wide range of products from the smallest to the largest. Permanent-
better finish. mold castings are used in order to obtain higher mechanical properties,
Any shape which can be forged can also be produced as a casting. While

better surfaces, or more accurate dimensions. Die castings find applica-


forgings are sometimes preferred because of their greater strength and

homogeneity, it may be necessary to produce complicated shapes as cast-


tion in cases where relatively large production of a given part is involved,
ings. Many castings are furnished "as-cast," but some alloys are heat-
since this will distribute the die costs over a large number of units, and at
treated to obtain increased strength.

Wire, Rod, and Bar


the same time reduce machining costs because of closer tolerances and
The products in the group known as "Wire, Rod, and Bar" find their better finish.
application in aircraft principally in the form of structural fittings ma-

Any shape which can be forged can also be produced as a casting. While
chined from rod or bar, usually 24S-T or 75S-T. Other uses include

screw-machine products. Rivets are made from special rivet wire.


forgings are sometimes preferred because of their greater strength and
Rivets and Screw-Machine Products
homogeneity, it may be necessary to produce complicated shapes as cast-
The most widely used rivet alloy is A17S-T. Joints requiring higher

strength are made with 17S-T or 24S-T rivets.


ings. Many castings are furnished "as-cast," but some alloys are heat-
Nuts, bolts, screws, and various special screw-machine products for air-
treated to obtain increased strength.
craft use are made almost exclusively from 24S-T and 17S-T.

Bolts, rivets, and other types of fasteners used in aircraft structures

have been standardized by the military services. The drawings and


Wire, Rod, and Bar
The products in the group known as "Wire, Rod, and Bar" find their
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

specifications for these parts are available in the AN Standard Aircraft

Parts book or in pertinent Federal Specifications. The designer may

application in aircraft principally in the form of structural fittings ma-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

therefore call for any of the standard parts simply by listing the AN

number on his drawing, rather than having to detail each feature of the
chined from rod or bar, usually 248-T or 758-T. Other uses include
part.

screw-machine products. Rivets are made from special rivet wire.

Rivets and Screw-Machine Products


The most widely used rivet alloy is A17S-T. Joints requiring higher
strength are made with 178-T or 248-T rivets.
Nuts, bolts, screws, and various special screw-machine products for air-
craft use are made almost exclusively from 248-T and 178-T.
Bolts, rivets, and other types of fasteners used in aircraft structures
have been standardized by the military services. The drawings and
specifications for these parts are available in the AN Standard Aircraft
Parts book or in pertinent Federal Specifications. The designer may
therefore call for any of the standard parts simply by listing the AN
number on his drawing, rather than having to detail each feature of the
part.

Original from
D191 iz by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 71
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION

71

AN bolts are coded for length by inches and eighths of an inch, s.nd for
diameter by sixteenths of an inch. For all lengths below one inc,h, the
AN bolts are coded for length by inches and eighths of an inch, and for

diameter by sixteenths of an inch. For all lengths below one inch, the

single figure means the number of eighths; above one inch, the firsi num- single figure means the number of eighths; above one inch, the first num-
ber of two digits indicates the number of inches and the second di^it the

ber of two digits indicates the number of inches and the second di;~it the
number of eighths.

Example: Aluminum Alloy Bolt


number of eighths.
AN 5 DD — 6 Indicates aluminum alloy aircraft bolt:

5/16 in. dia.; 6/8 in. long.


Example: Aluminum Alloy Bolt
AN 5 DD 6 Indicates aluminum alloy aircraft boU:
length in eighths of inches

aluminum alloy

diameter in sixteenths 5/16 in. dia.; 6/8 in. long .


Army and Navy Standard Part

When the letters DD are omitted, the bolt is made of heat-treated nickel

steel with a minimum tensile strength of 125,000 psi.


. . . . . length in eighths of inches
Rivets are similarly coded, as shown by the following example:

... . ... ..... aluminum alloy


Example: Rivet

AN 426 D 6 — 14

length in sixteenths of an inch

diameter in thirty-seconds of an inch

... . .. . ........... .. . diameter in sixteenths


alloy used

indicates type of head

Army and Navy standard part

. ....... . .... . ... .. . . ...... .. Army and Navy Standard Part


Steel bolts smaller than %-inch diameter or aluminum alloy bolts

smaller than 34-inch diameter are not used in the primary structure of When the letters DD are omitted, the bolt is made of heat-treated nickel
an airplane.

1:1teel with a minimum tensile strength of 125,000 psi.


In general, rivets, bolts, and other pins should be subjected primarily

to bearing and shear rather than tension; and pinned connections, whether Rivets are similarly coded, as shown by the following example:
rivet, bolt, or other devices, should be designed to fail in shear of the pin.

AIRFRAME FABRICATION
Example: Rivet
Aluminum alloys can be fabricated on the machinery and equipment

normally employed for other metals. The details of methods, tools, and
AN 426 D 6 14

.. ... length in sixteenths of au inch


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

......... . ... diameter in thirty-seconds of an inch


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

. . ..... .. . ...... alloy used

. ...... . . ... ...... . . . . . indicates type of head

. . .. . . .. . .. ... ... .. .......... Army and Navy standard part


Steel bolts smaller than %i-inch diameter or aluminum alloy bolts
smaller than 7,l'-inch diameter are not used in the primary structure of
an airplane.
In general, rivets, bolts, and other pins should be imbjected primarily
to bearing and shear rather than tension; and pinned connections, whether
rivet, bolt, or other devices, should be designed. to fail in shear of the pin.
AIRFRAME FABRICATION
Aluminum alloys can be fabricated on the machinery and equipment
normally employed for other metals. The details of methods, tools, and

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
72 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
72

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


dies depend on the particular alloy and temper, the quantity of identical
dies depend on the particular alloy and temper, the quantity of identical

parts involved, and the nature of the parts themselves.


parts involved, and the nature of the parts themselves.
Many of the manufacturing methods developed by the aircraft industry
Many of the manufacturing methods developed by the aircraft industry
have been the result of conditions peculiar to the industry itself, not to the

have been the result of conditions peculiar to the industry itself, not to the
materials used. For example, aluminum alloys can be formed successfully
materials used. For example, aluminum alloys can be formed successfully

on the large mechanical presses which are so common in the automotive

field. However, the quantities involved in the aircraft industry have not.
on the large mechanical presses which are so common in the automotive
until recently, warranted investment in the tools and dies required by

these presses.
field. However, the quantities involved in the aircraft industry have not:
Cutting and Blanking
until recently, warranted investment in the tools and dies required by
One of the first fabricating operations involves the cutting of rectangular

these presses.
sheets of metal into the sizes and shapes required for the individual parts

of the airframe. The methods used can be classified as shearing or cut-

ting.
Cutting and Blanking
Equipment for shearing includes guillotine shears (either power- or foot-

One of the first fabricating operations involves the cutting of rectangular


sheets of metal into the sizes and shapes required for the individual parts
operated) for making straight cuts; roll shears for curves; male and female

blanking dies; and a variety of modifications of the foregoing. To obtain

sheared edges with a minimum of burr, the cutting edges must be smooth
of the airframe. The methods used can be classified as shearing or cut-
and sharp and set with a clearance equal to about 7 per cent to 10 per cent

ting.
of the thickness of the metal being cut. The use of metal dies and rubber

pads for blanking sheet metal was very popular in the aircraft industry
Equipment for shearing includes guillotine shears (either power- or foot-
before the present war because the tool cost was low and the small quanti-

operated) for making straight cuts; roll shears for curves; male and female
blanking dies; and a variety of modifications of the foregoing. To obtain
ties did not justify the cost of male and female blanking dies.

Two types of cutting are used for sheet stock; sawing and milling (or

routing). Band saws are sometimes used for cutting stacks of sheet-metal sheared edges with a minimum of burr, the cutting edges must be smooth
blanks, and of course, both band and circular saws are used for miscella-

neous work on sheet and extruded sections. High blade speeds (5000 feet
and sharp and set with a clearance equal to about 7 per cent to 10 per cent
per minute for band saws and 10,000 feet per minute for circular saws) are
of the thickness of the metal being cut. The use of metal dies and rubber
desirable for best results. Saw teeth should be fairly coarse with a slight
pads for blanking sheet metal was very popular in the aircraft industry
before the present war because the tool cost was low and the small quanti-
set.and front rake. A more recent method for cutting stacks of sheet-

metal blanks involves the use of routers. The cutter is a small-diameter

milling tool which turns at high speed on a vertical axis. It is guided by ties did not justify the cost of male and female blanking dies.
a template clamped to the work and cuts a path all around the blanks

Two types of cutting are used for sheet stock; sawing and milling (or
equal in width to the diameter of the cutter. This method leaves the

edges of the blanks in a smoother condition than when the metal is sawed.
routing). Band saws are sometimes used for cutting stacks of sheet-metal
blanks, and of course, both band and circular saws are used for miscella-
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The versatility of these machines and the speed with which templates for

neous work on sheet and extruded sections. High blade speeds (5000 feet
new or altered shapes can be provided have made routing the standard
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

method for cutting dd-shaped blanks in many aircraft plants.

Forming per minute for band saws and 10,000 feet per minute for circular saws) are
Most of the forming work in the aircraft industry is done on sheet. In

desirable for best results. Saw teeth should be fairly coarse with a slight
general, the equipment consists of basic machines that are fitted with spe-

set. and front rake. A more recent method for cutting stacks of sheet-
metal blanks involves the use of routers. The cutter is a small-diameter
milling tool which turns at high speed on a vertical axis. It is guided by
a template clamped to the work and cuts a path all around the blanks
equal in width to the diameter of the cutter. This method leaves the
edges of the blanks in a smoother condition than when the metal is sawed.
The versatility of these machines and the speed with which templates for
new or altered shapes can be provided have made routing the standard
method for cutting dd-shaped blanks in many aircraft plants.

Forming
Most of the forming work in the aircraft industry is done on sheet. In
general, the equipment consists of basic machines that are fitted with spe-

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 73
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION

73 cial tools or dies for each part they are to process. Thus a double-action
cial tools or dies for each part they are to process. Thus a double-action

mechanical press (of which there is an increasing number in the aircraft


mechanical press (of which there is an increasing number in the aircraft

industry) is usually equipped with a number of sets of punches, dies, and


indu:;;try) is usually equipped with a number of sets of punches, dies, and
blankholders. The cost of such tools for large parts led the industry to
blankholders. The cost of such tools for large parts led the industry to
seek other methods prior to the war.

Single-action presses, usually hydraulic when large in size, are used ex-
seek other methods prior to the war.
tensively. The large hydraulic presses are usually fitted with a rubber Single-action presses, usually hydraulic when large in size, are used ex-
pad on the ram, both for blanking and forming. Because there is no tend-

tensively. The large hydraulic presses are usually fitted with a rubber
ency to "iron" or draw out wrinkles when metal is formed over the edge

of a flat die (metal, wood, or synthetic material) with a rubber pad, it is


pad on the ram, both for blanking and forming. Because there is no tend-
common practice to notch the flange and also to provide flutes or scallops
ency to "iron" or draw out wrinkles when metal is formed over the edge
in the flange to use up the excess metal. Parts formed by this method

usually have a more or less flat surface surrounded by a flange (as, for
of a flat die (metal, wood, or synthetic material) with a rubber pad, it is
example, a curved channel), a wing rib, or a flanged bulkhead. Mechan-
common practice to notch the flange and also to provide flutes or scallops
ical presses equipped with metal dies are used for a number of forming

in the flange to use up the excess metal. Parts formed by this method
operations and simple draws, usually on small parts.

Drop hammers, using zinc or zinc alloy dies and lead punches cast in the
usually have a more or less flat surface surrounded by a flange (as, for
die cavity, are very extensively used. Many of the parts produced in this
example, a curved channel), a wing rib, or a flanged bulkhead. Mechan-
manner could be drawn on a double-action press at a lower unit cost, but

a large number of parts is required to justify the higher cost of steel dies.
ical presses equipped with metal dies are used for a number of forming
Sheet panels for wing tips, fins, and control surfaces as well as fairings and
operations and simple draws, usually on small parts.
fillets are made by this method.

Drop hammers, using zinc or zinc alloy dies and lead punches cast in the
Sheet panels having very slight double curvature are sometimes formed

by stretching them over a metal or hardwood form. The sheet is wrapped


die cavity, are very extensively used. Many of the parts produced in this
over the form and is clamped along two opposite edges. The form is then
manner could be dravm on a double-action press at a lower unit cost, but
raised so that the sheet becomes tight over the higher parts. Further

motion of the form stretches the tight parts until the panel fits the form
a large number of parts is required to justify the higher cost of steel dies.
at all points.
Sheet panels for wing tips, fins, and control surfaces as well as fairings and
Apron brakes, folders, cornice presses, rolls, and draw-benches are used

fillets are made by this method.


Sheet panels having very slight double curvature are sometimes formed
in making the endless variety of parts requiring bends that are not curved.

These include corrugated sheet and sheet molding for structural uses in

the airframe. This equipment and its operation is typical of that used by
by stretching them over a metal or hardwood form. The sheet is wrapped
the better class sheet-metal shops fabricating other materials as well as

aluminum.
over the form and is clamped along two opposite edges. The form is then
Considerable handwork is used in forming aircraft parts. Some of this
raised so that the sheet becomes tight over the higher parts. Further
motion of the form stretches the tight parts until the panel fits the form
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

work is done by skilled power-hammer men who form sheet panels to ob-

at all points.
tain the necessary curvature or crown. Other parts are made by ham-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

mering over or into various wood forms. Even in production work where

tools have been provided, some hand straightening and adjusting may be
Apron brakes, folders, cornice presses, rolls, and draw-benches are used
necessary. In general, larger quantities justify more nearly perfect tools

which, in turn, reduce or eliminate handwork. Experimental airplanes


in making the endless variety of parts requiring bends that are not curved.
sometimes warrant very little tooling.
These include corrugated sheet and sheet molding for structural uses in
the airframe. This equipment and its operation is typical of that used by
the better class sheet-metal shops fabricating other materials as well as
aluminum.
Considerable handwork is used in forming aircraft parts. Some of this
work is done by skilled power-hammer men who form sheet panels to ob-
tain the necessary curvature or crown. Other parts are made by ham-
mering over or into various wood forms. Even in production work where
tools have been provided, some hand straightening and adjusting may be
necessary. In general, larger quantities justify more nearly perfect tools
which, in turn, reduce or eliminate handwork. Experimental airplanes
sometimes warrant very little tooling.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
74 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
74

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


MAGNESIUM ALLOYS
MAGNESIUM ALLOYS

Magnesium alloys have been found useful for a number of applications


Magnesium alloys have been found useful for a number of applications
in the aircraft structure. The following information has been obtained
in the aircraft structure. The following information has been obtained
from publications of the Dow Chemical Company.

from publications of the Dow Chemical Company.


Castings

Magnesium alloy castings are used where light weight, high strength,

resistance to shock, and good machinability are desired. Magnesium


Castings
castings find widespread usage in aircraft engines and aircraft landing

Magnesium alloy castings are used where light weight, high strength,
resistance to shock, and good machinability are desired. Magnesium
wheels. Magnesium alloy permanent-mold castings are being used for

such parts as nose pieces on aircraft engines, fittings, wheel flanges, pis

tons, brackets, and various types of instrument and accessory housings. castings find widespread usage in aircraft engines and aircraft landing
Forgings

wheels. Magnesium alloy permanent-mold castings are being used for


Magnesium alloy forgings include aircraft engine bearing-caps, bearing

housings, rocker arm supports, door and aileron hinges, engine mountings,
such parts as nose pieces on aircraft engines, fittings, wheel flanges, pis
valve and pump bodies, hydraulic cylinders, miscellaneous control levers,
tons, brackets, and various types of instrument and accessory housings.
brackets, and fittings.

Extrusions

Magnesium extrusions include such applications as stiffener elements in


Forgings
aircraft structures, floor beams, and moldings.

Magnesium alloy forgings include aircraft engine bearing-caps, bearing


housings, rocker arm supports, door and aileron hinges, engine mountings,
Sheet

Magnesium sheet and plate have been used for such parts as aircraft

wings, wing tips, ailerons, fairings, fuel and oil tanks, cases, floor plates, valve and pump bodies, hydraulic cylinders, miscellaneous control levers,
ducts, and seats.

brackets, and fittings.


STEEL

The steel numbering system commonly used in the United States is that

of the Society of Automotive Engineers, which offers the following ex-


Extrusions
planation of the system:

A numeral index system is used to identify the compositions of the S.A.E.


Magnesium extrusions include such applications as stiffener elements in
steels, which make it possible to use numerals on shop drawings and blueprints
aircraft structures, floor beams, and moldings.
Sheet
that are partially descriptive of the composition of material covered by such

numbers. The first digit indicates the type to which the steel belongs; thus

indicates a carbon steel; "2-" a nickel steel and "3-" a nickel chromium steel.

Magnesium sheet and plate have been used for such parts as aircraft
wings, wing tips, ailerons, fairings, fuel and oil tanks, cases, floor plates.
In the case of the simple alloy steels the second digit generally indicates the ap-

proximate percentage of the predominant alloying element. Usually the last two

or three digits indicate the average carbon content in "points," or hundredths of


ducts, and seats.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1 per cent. Thus "2340" indicates a nickel steel of approximately 3 per cent

nickel (3.25 to 3.75) and 0.40 per cent carbon (0.35 to 0.45); and "71360" indicates
STEEL
The steel numbering system commonly used in the United States is that
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

a tungsten steel of about 13 per cent tungsten (12 to 15) and 0.60 per cent carbon

(0.50 to 0.70).

of the Society of Automotive Engineers, which offers the following ex-


In some instances, in order to avoid confusion it has been found necessary to

depart from this system of identifying the approximate alloy composition of a


planation of the system:
steel by varying the second and third digits of the number. An instance of such
A numeral index system is used to identify the compositions of the S.A.E.
steels, which make it possible to use numerals on shop drawings and blueprints
that are partially descriptive of the composition of material covered by such
numbers. The first digit indicates the type to which the steel belongs; thus "1-"
indicates a carbon steel; "2-" a nickel steel and "3-" a nickel chromium steel.
In the case of the simple alloy steels the second digit generally indicates the ap-
proximate percentage of the predominant alloying element. Usually the last two
or three digits indicate the average carbon content in "points," or hundredths of
1 per cent. Thus "2340" indicates a nickel steel of approximately 3 per cent
nickel (3.25 to 3.75) and 0.40 per cent carbon (0.35 to 0.45); and "71360" indicates
a tungsten steel of about 13 per cent tungsten (12 to 15) and 0.60 per cent carbon
(0.50 to 0.70).
In some instances, in order to avoid confusion it has been found necessary to
depart from this system of identifying the approximate alloy composition of a
steel by varying the second and third digits of the number. An instance of such

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 75

departure is the steel numbers selected for several of the corrosion and heat-
resisting alloys.
Prefixes. The prefix "X" is used in several instances to denote variations in the
range of manganese, sulphur or chromium.
The prefix "T" is used with the Manganese Steels (1300 Series) to avoid con-
fusion with steels of somewhat different manganese range that have been identified
by the same numerals but without the prefix.

TABLE V-4. S.A.E. Steel Numbering System.


Type of Steel Numeral$ (and Digits)
Carbon Steels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . lxxx
Plain Carbon..................................... lOxx
Free Cutting (Screw Stock). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . l lxx
Free Cutting, Manganese.......................... Xl3xx
High Manganese. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tl3xx
Nickel Steels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2xxx
0.50 Per Cent Nickel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20xx
1.50 Per Cent Nickel.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2lxx
3.50 Per Cent Nickel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23xx
5.00 Per Cent Nickel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25xx
Nickel Chromium Steels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3xxx
1.25 Per Cent Nickel, 0.60 Per Cent Chromium. . . . . . 3Ixx
1.75 Per Cent Nickel, 1.00 Per Cent Chromium...... 32xx
3.50 Per Cent Nickel, 1.50 Per Cent Chromium...... 33xx
3.00 Per Cent Nickel, 0.80 Per Cent Chromium. . . . . . 34x.x
Corrosion and Heat Resisting Steels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30xx
Molybdenum Steels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4xxx
Chromium....................................... 4lx:x
Chromium Nickel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43xx
Nickel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46xx and 48xx
Chromium Steels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5xxx
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Low Chromium. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5lx:x


Medium Chromium............................... 52x:xx
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Corrosion and Heat Resisting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51x:xx


Chromium Vanadium Steels.. . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6xx:x
Tungsten Steels. . . • . . . . . .. .. .. . . . . . . . . .. . . . .. .. . . . . 7xx.x and 7xxxx
Silicon Manganese Steels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9xx:x

TITANIUM ALLOYS
Titanium alloys are coming into increasing use in situations where
high strength at fairly high temperatures is required, as weH as in straight-
forward applications where the high strength characteristics of the ma-
terial would lead to a. saving in weight.
These alloys have been utilized in external skin and fairings in the jet
engine region (commercially pure titanium sheet), for main internal
longitudinal fuselage members and floor members (8% manganese-
titanium alloy sheet), and for engine mount trunions (alloy titanium
forgings).

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNl.VERSITY OF MICHIGAN
76 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
76

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

The application of titanium and titanium alloys is being constantly


The application of titanium and titanium alloys is being constantly

expanded as the knowledge and the development of the material increase.


expanded as the knowledge and the development of the material increase.
HARDWARE AND OTHER ITEMS

There are many items which the airframe designer does not design, but

HARDWARE AND OTHER ITEMS


which he instead selects to meet specific design requirements. Every

design office has the detailed dimensions, weights, and other specifications
There are many items which the airframe designer does uot design, but
pertaining to these parts available in the catalogs of the suppliers. Among

which he instead selects to meet specific design requirements. Every


the items that may be treated in this manner are large ones such as engines,

propellers, radio and radar equipment, wheels, tires, and seats, and also
design office has the detailed dimensions, weights, and other specifications
smaller items consisting mostly of hardware such as rivets, bolts and
pertaining to these parts available in the catalogs of the suppliers. Among
nuts, washers, pulleys, cables, bearings, etc. In selecting these, the

designer must consider weight, maintenance, space, strength, and a host


the items that may be treated in this manner are large ones such as engines,
of other factors pertinent to the particular problem involved.
propellers, radio and radar equipment, wheels, tires, and seats, and also
Table V-5.

smaller items consisting mostly of hardware such as rivets, bolts and


nuts, washers, pulleys, cables, bearings, etc. In selecting these, the
USS 18-8 Half Hard

PHYSICAL DATA (MINIMUM)

Yield Strength 110,000 psi


designer must consider weight, maintenance, space, strength, and a host
Tensile Strength 150,000 psi

Elongation in 2": Class


of other factors pertinent to the particular problem involved.
I II

0.015" and under 9% 15%

0.016" to 0.030" inc.... 10% 18%


TABLE V-5. Stainless steels.
0.031" and over 10% 18% USS 18-8 Half Hard USS 18-8 Full Hard
FINISH

PHYSICAL DATA (MINIMUM) PHYSICAL DATA (MINIMUM)


Yield Strength. . . . . . . . . . 140,000 psi
Annealed, Pickled and Cold Rolled

APPLICATIONS
Yield Strength .......... 110,000 psi
Fire Walls and Angles
Tensile Strength. . . . . . . . . 150,000 psi Tensile Strength. . . . . . . . . 185,000 psi
Cowling
Elongation in 2": Class Elongation in 2": Class
Columns

I II I II
Spars

0.015" and under. . . . . . 9% 15% 0.015" and under . . . . . . 3% 8%


0.016" to 0.030" inc.. . . 10% 18% 0.016" to 0.030" inc.. . . 4% 9%
Air Intake Manifolds

0.031" and over. . . . . . . 4% 9%


Radiators

Fuel Tanks
0.031" and over ....... 10% 18%
Oil Tanks

FINISH FINISH
Shear Webs

Annealed, Pickled and Cold Rolled Annealed, Pickled and Cold Rolled
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Fuselage Covering

Wing Cover and Wing Connection


APPLICATIONS APPLICATIONS
Fire Walls and Angles Stabilizer, Horizontal Frame Ribs
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Wing Radiator

Water Tanks

Cowling Columns
Tail Surfaces

Columns Wing Spar (complete all parts)


Bomb Racks

Spars Fuselage Cover and Structure Parts,


Air Intake Manifolds Corrugation
Bomb Shackles

Bomb Chutes

Feed and Ejection Chutes


Radiators Struts
Gun Blast Cowl
Fuel Tanks Wing Cover
Window Guides
Oil Tanks Aileron Struts and Covering
Struts
Shear Webs Bomb Racks
Stainless steels.
Fuselage Covering Bomb Shackles
USS 18-8 Full Hard
Wing Cover and Wing Connection Tail Surfaces
PHYSICAL DATA (MINIMUM)
Wing Radiator Seaplane Floats
Yield Strength 140,000 psi
Water Tanks Flying Boat Hulls
Tensile Strength 185,000 psi Tail Surfaces Rudder Flap Surface Covering
Elongation in 2": Class Bomb Racks Lattice Members
I II
Bomb Shackles Lattice Member Longerons
0.015" and under 3% 8%
Bomb Chutes Landing Gear
0.016" to 0.030" inc.... 4% 9%
Feed and Ejection Chutes Miscellaneous Fittings
0.031" and over 4% 9%
Gun Blast Cowl Fire Wall Stringers
FINISH

Window Guides Fire Wall Stiffeners


Annealed, Pickled and Cold Rolled

Struts Rudder Frame Ribs


APPLICATIONS

Stabilizer, Horizontal Frame Ribs

Columns

Wing Spar (complete all parts)

Original from
Fuselage Cover and Structure Parts,

Corrugation
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
Struts

Wing Cover

Aileron Struts and Covering


MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 77
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION

77

TABLE V-6. 8teel and sted alloys in aircraft.


Table V-6. Steel and steel alloys in aircraft.

APPLICATION S.A.E. APPLICATION


APPLICATION S.A.E. APPLICATION S.A.E.
S.A.E.

STRUCTURE AND ACCESSORIES


STRUCTURE AND ACCESSORIES

Bearings, Roller.......... . . . 4615 Screws .................... . 1120


3312 2330
Bearings, Roller

52100
Bolts, Eye and Wing Attach-

ment
3140
Clevises.
Bolts, Eye and Wing Attach- 6150
Clevis Pins
ment ................... . 3140 Seat Frames . . . ............ . X-4130
Engine Mount Structural Tub-
4140 Shackles for Cable .. .. ... .. . 2330
ing
2335 Spring Parts ... . ........... . 1065
Engine Mount Steel Forgings,
X-3140 1095
Strut Ends
Clevises ......... . ......... . 2330 Structural Tubing ......... . . X-4130
Fittings, Brackets, Hinges,
1035 4140
Bushings
Clevis Pins . ... . ........... . 2330 Tail Group Tubing ...... . . . . X-4340
Fuselage Frame Tubing. Engine Mount Structural Tub- X-4130
Nuts ing ...................... X-4130 Rudder:
Pins.
4640 Formed Shapes ...... . . . ... . X-4130
Racks, Bomb.
Engine Mount Steel Forgings, Terminals ................. . 2330
Rivets
Strut Ends. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . X-4130 Tie Rods ................. . . 2330
4615
Fittings, Brackets, Hinges, Turnbuckles ............... . 2330
3312

Bushings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2330 Universal Joints ..... . ..... . 2330


52100

X-4130 Washers ........ . ......... . 1010


3140

X-4340 1025
4140

Fuselage Frame Tubing ..... . X-4130 Wing Strut:


2335

1025 Shock Strut ............... . 4135


X-3140

Nuts ............. .. ...... . 2330 Wing Terminal. ........ .. . . 2330


2330

3140
1035

6150 LANDING GEAR


Actuating Gear of Landing
2330

X-4130
4140
4640
Pins ...................... . 2330 Carriage . . . .......... . .. . 3135
X-4130
X-4130 Cylinder, Hydraulic ........ . X-4130
2330
2315 X-4340
X-4130
2340 Links ...................... X-4130
3250 Ski Pedestal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . X-4130
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

X-4340

X-4130
4620 Struts, Various Shapes ....... X-4130
52100 Shock Strut ......... . .4140 and 4135
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1025

2330 Racks, Bomb .............. . X-4340 Drag Arm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4140


3140 Rivets ... .. ............... . 3140 Socket. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4140
6150

4140

2330

X-4130

2315

2340

3250

4620

52100

X-4340

3140

Screws.

1120

2330

3140

6150

Seat Frames X-4130

Shackles for Cable 2330

Spring Parts 1065

1095

Structural Tubing X-4130

4140

Tail Group Tubing X-4340

Original from
X-4130

Dig iz b
Rudder:
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Formed Shapes X-4130

Terminals 2330

Tie Rods 2330


78 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
78 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table V-7. Useful structural applications of nonferrous and ferrous alloys.


TABLE V-7. U8eful strnctural applications of nonferrous and ferrous alloys.
Commercial

designation

Available

Available Gas
form

Commercial
Gas

designation form weld Use and limitations


weld

Use and limitations

28 (MH)
2S(~) Tubing Yes Electrical conduit.
3S (HH)
3S 01iH) Sheet Yes Welded fuel and oil tanks. Good weld, low fa-
Tubing
tigue strength.
Sheet
3S 01iH) Bar Yes Tank flanges, bosses, etc.
Yes
38 01iH) Tube Yes On parts to be welded only.
Yes

Electrical conduit.
248 (0) Sheet No Structural-Heat treat after forming.
3S (HH) 248 (T) Sheet No Structural. Superseded by 758.
3S (HH)
24S (T) Bar No General structural-Extrusions available.
Bar
248 (T) Tube No Structural, 53ST and 61ST, may be used instead
Tube
for long columns. Although not commonly
Yes
carried in stock.
Yes

Welded fuel and oil tanks. Good weld, low fa-

52S (70!) Sheet Care Cowling and fairing subject to vibration.


tigue strength.

52S 01iH) Bar Care Spot Weld. Good on all 52S.


Tank flanges, bosses, etc.

52S (0) Tube Care Fuel, oil, and instrument lines.


On parts to be welded only.

24S (0)

43 (Alcoa) Casting Yes Nonstructural. May be cast in thin sections.


248 (T)

195 (T4 Alcoa) Casting No Pedali;t, gear boxes, camera hatches.


248 (T)

220 (Alcoa) Casting No Highly stressed members. Use on approval.


248 (T)

356 (T4 Alcoa) Casting Yes For welded tank flanges. Low strength.
Sheet

14S
Sheet

Bar
Forging No Heat treated. Highest structural strength greater
Tube
resistance to corrosion than 145.
No
17S Forging No Heat treated. Structural.
No

No
Bras! naval Sheet No (Tobin Bronze)
Brass naval Bar No Bus bar, bolts, nuts; resistant to corrosion.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

No

Structural—Heat treat after forming.

Bronze phosphor Sheet No Springs, electric contacts.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Structural. Superseded by 75S.

General structural—Extrusions available.


Bronze phosphor Bar No Bolts. Resistant to corrosion.
Structural, 53ST and 61ST, may be used instead
Bronze phosphor Cast No Bushing, bearings, gears.
for long columns. Although not commonly

carried in stock. "K" Monel Sheet Yes Nonmagnetic. Resistant to corrosion.


52S (MH) "K" Monel .par Yes Gears, chains, machine parts.
52S (HH)

528 (0)
Ferrous alloys
Sheet
SAE 1020 Bar Yes Case hardened, stamp dies and bushings.
Care
SAE 1025 Sheet Yes Nonstructural only.
Care

Bar Yes Aircraft nuts.


Care

Tubing Yes Superseded by X-4130.


Cowling and fairing subject to vibration.

Spot Weld. Good on all 52S.

SAE 1045 Bar No Tie rods, chain sprockets.


Fuel, oil, and instrument lines.

Bar

Tube

43 (Alcoa)

195 (T4 Alcoa)

220 (Alcoa)

356 (T4 Alcoa)

Casting

Casting

Casting

Casting

Yes

Original from
No

No
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Yes

Nonstructural. May be cast in thin sections.

Pedals, gear boxes, camera hatches.


MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 79
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION 79

Table V-7. (Continued). Useful structural applications of nonferrous and ferrous alloys.
TABLE V-7. (Continued). Useful structural applications of nonferrous and ferrous alloys.
Commercial

designation

Available

Commercial Available Gas


form

designation form weld Use and limitations


Gas

weld

Use and limitations


SAE 1095 Sheet No Aircraft fta.t springs.
SAE 1095 Wire No In all coil springs.
Sheet

Wire SAE 2330 Bar No Aircraft bolts, eyes, forks and terminals.
No

No
SAE X-4130 Sheet Yes Welded structural details. Purchased annealed.
Aircraft flat springs.
Bar Yes High-strength welded. Wing and landing gear
In all coil springs.
fittings or machine parts under Yrinch thick.
SAE 2330

Tubing Yes Structural. Excellent weld. Purchased normal-


Bar

ized.
No

Aircraft bolts, eyes, forks and terminals.

SAE 4140 Bar Yes Welded structural parts. Over Yrinch thick.
SAE X-4130

Forging Yes
Sheet

Bar

SAE 4340 Bar No High-strength forged or machine parts. Over 2


Yes

inches in thickness.
Yes

SAE 6150 Bar No Gee.rs. Purchased annealed.


Welded structural details. Purchased annealed.

Wire No All important springs.


High-strength welded. Wing and landing gear

fittings or machine parts under J4-inch thick.

Tubing

Yes
18-8 (Annealed) Sheet No Good "spot weld," easily formed, nonmagnetic.
Structural. Excellent weld. Purchased normal-
18-18 (~ Hard) Sheet No Good ''spot weld," structural. Ammunition chutes
ized.
and boxes.
SAE 4140

Bar
18-8 (Annealed) Tube No Good "spot weld." For exhaust system.
Yes
18-8 (Annealed) Bar No Carpenter No. 8 free machining. Cannot be heat
Yes
treated.
Welded structural parts. Over H-inch thick.

Inconel Sheet Yes Nonmagnetic. Resistant to corrosion. Wind-


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:16 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Forging

SAE 4340 shield, chut.es.


Inconel Bar Yes Difficult machining.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Bar

No
Inconel Tube Yes Nonmagnetic. Exhaust systems.
High-strength forged or machine parts. Over 2

inches in thickness.

SAE 6150

Bar

No

No

Gears. Purchased annealed.

All important springs.

Wire

18-8 (Annealed)

18-18 (}A Hard)

Sheet

Sheet

No

No

Good "spot weld," easily formed, nonmagnetic.

Good "spot weld," structural. Ammunition chutes

and boxes.

18-8 (Annealed)

18-8 (Annealed)

Tube

Bar

No

No

Good "spot weld." For exhaust system.


Original from
Carpenter No. 8 free machining. Cannot be heat
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
treated.

Inconel

Sheet
80 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
80

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


TABLE V-8. Decimal equivalent!! of gauges used on aircraft material.
Table V-8. Decimal equivalents of gauges used on aircraft material.

Birmingham

Brown & Sharpe


Birmingham Brown <(: Sharpe
Wire Gauge
Wire Gauge .4.luminum and its alloys; U. S. Standard
(all tubing) Magnesium and its alloys St~el Sheet
Aluminum and its alloys;

U. S. Standard
in inches Sheet, in inches in inches
(all tubing)

.120• .114* .125*


.IOU
Magnesium and its alloys

Steel Sheet
.109 .102
in inches
.095* .091* .094*
Sheet, in inches
.083* .081* .078*
in inches
.072 .072* .070*
.120*
.065* .064* .063*
.114*
.058* .057 .056
.125*
.049* .051 * .050*
.109
.042* .045 .044
.102 .035* .040* .038*
.109 .032* .036 .034
.095* .028* .032* .031 *
.091*
.025 .028 .025
.094*
.022* .025* .022*
.083*
.020 .ow• .0 HI
.081*

.018 .oi8 .017


.078*

.016 .016* .016*


.072

.014 .014 .014


.072*

.070*

(Note: On all material8, decimal equivalent!! of common fractions are generally used
.065*

for thicknesse8 over Vs-inch.)


.064*

.063*
*Usually considered standard thicknessei:.
.058*

.057

.056

.049*

.051*
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:16 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

.050*

.042*
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

.045

.044

.035*

.040*

.038*

.032*

.030

.034

.028*

.032*

.031*

.025

.028

.025

.022*

.025*

.022*

.020

.020*

.019

.018

.018

.017

.016

.016*

.016*

Original from
.014

.014
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
.014

(Note: On all materials, decimal equivalents of common fractions are generally used

for thicknesses over J00^-inch.)


CHAPTER VI

Detail Design Considerations

There are many guiding principles in design that are equally applicable

to the design of the wing and the design of the fuselage. The student has

been exposed to many of these principles in his initial drawing course.

There have been further additions made to his store of technical knowl-

edge through various courses preparing him for his first attempt at a

design problem. Therefore, it is not the purpose of this chapter to re-

view all of the aspects of detail design, but rather to point out some

specific helpful hints on the subject.

DESIGN PHILOSOPHIES

The approach to a specific design problem may often be influenced by


CHAPTER VI
the initial design philosophy.

Margin of Safety

Aircraft structures, for example, are generally designed to obtain the

lightest structure for a given set of conditions. In keeping with this

design philosophy, each member should be chosen so that its strength


Detail Design Conslderadons
margin of safety is zero. (Margin of safety is the difference between the

maximum load or stress a member can withstand without failing and the

maximum load or stress that is likely to be imposed under any condition

in the normal operation of the aircraft.) However, the smallest margin

of safety may not always mean the lightest member, as the illustration in

Table VI-1 shows. If one were to select a tubular member to withstand

a torsional moment of 10,500 inch-pounds, either the 1% X .049 tube

with an Fty = 85,000 psi or a 1^ X .065 tube with an Fty = 75,000


There are many guiding principles in design that are equally applicable
would be satisfactory; yet, the one with the slightly higher margin of

safety is considerably lighter.


to the design of the wing and the design of the fuselage. The student has
81
been exposed to many of these principles in his initial drawing course.
There have been further additions made to his store of technical knowl-
edge through various courses preparing him for his first attempt at a
design problem. Therefore, it is not the purpose of this chapter to re-
view all of the aspects of detail design, but rather to point out some
specific helpful hints on the subject.

DESIGN PHILOSOPHIES
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:16 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The approach to a specific design problem may often be influenced by


the initial design philosophy.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Margin of Safety
Aircraft structures, for example, are generally designed to obtain the
lightest structure for a given set of conditions. In keeping with this
design philosophy, each member should be chosen so that its strength
margin of safety is zero. (Margin of safety is the difference between the
maximum load or stress a member can withstand without failing and the
maximum load or stress that is likely to be imposed under any condition
in the normal operation of the aircraft.) However, the smallest margin
of safety may not always mean the lightest member, as the illustration in
Table Vl-1 shows. If one were to select a tubular member to withstand
a torsional moment of 10,500 inch-pounds, either the 1% X .049 tube
with an Ft 11 = 85,000 psi or a lYz X .065 tube with an Ft 11 = 75,000
would be satisfactory; yet, the one with the slightly higher margin of
safety is considerably lighter.
81

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
82 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
82 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table VT-1. Allowable torsional moment for SAE X 4130 steel tubes for length0 TABLE Vl-1. Allowable torsional moment for SAE X 4130 steel tubes for length-
0 diameter.
diameter.

L/D* Ratio = 20
L/D* Ratio = 20

Tube

Weight

Tube Weight Allowable


Allowable

size lbs/100 in. moment


sise

lbs/100 in.
F,'11 = 75,000 psi F,'11 = 85,000 psi
moment

Fty = 75,000 psi Ft, = 85,000 psi


1'4 x .049 7.42 10,180 in.-lb. 10,720 in.-lb.
\% x .049
1% x .065 9.05 10,650 in.-lb. 11,210 in.-lb.
7.42 134 x .095 9.76 10,870 in.-lb. 11,400 in.-lb.
10,180 in.-lb. 10,720 in.-lb.

IH x .065
•L = Length; D = Diameter
9.05

10,650 in.-lb. 11,210 in.-lb.

IH x .095

Maintenance Requirements
9.76

10,870 in.-lb. 11,400 in.-lb.


Sometimes maintenance may be an overriding consideration. It is
*L = Length; D = Diameter

conceivable that a wheel brake assembly could be designed to withstand


the loads imposed upon it; but if it failed to stand up for more than 100
Maintenance Requirements

Sometimes maintenance may be an overriding consideration. It is

conceivable that a wheel brake assembly could be designed to withstand landings, it would not be considered an economical item and would,
the loads imposed upon it; but if it failed to stand up for more than 100

landings, it would not be considered an economical item and would,


therefore, be redesigned to meet certain maintenance requirements.
therefore, be redesigned to meet certain maintenance requirements.

Fool-Proof Operation
Fool-Proof Operation
A system that has to be operated must be designed so as to avoid dam-

A system that has to be operated must be designed so as to avoid dam-


age that may result from any deviation from correct operating procedure.

It is desirable also to avoid designs of assemblies in which it may be pos-


age that may result from any deviation from correct operating procedure.
sible to interchange parts having similar outward appearances but different
It is desirable also to avoid designs of assemblies in which it may be pos-
characteristics.

The "Fail-Safe" Principle


sible to interchange parts having similar outward appearances but different
A structure may be designed so as to be considered "fail-safe." In characteristics.
other words, should one member of a complex structure fail, some other
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:16 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

member would be called upon to carry the load. Such design does not

The "Fail-Safe" Principle


always require a 100 per cent margin of safety, but entails a certain type

A structure may be designed so as to be considered "fail-safe." In


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of structure or arrangement of members to compensate for the failure of

any one member.

other words, should one member of a complex structure fail, some other
member would be called upon to carry the load. Such design does not
Safety

Safety may require additional consideration in design. It may be

satisfactory, for most purposes, to have only one access to a cabin, but
always require a 100 per cent margin of safety, but entails a certain type
in case of an emergency, this might be insufficient. A hydraulic system

to operate the retraction of a landing gear may be excellent, but if it fails


of structure or arrangement of members to compensate for the failure of
to function, can another system be used? Safety considerations should
any one member.
always be taken into account by the designer to avoid situations which

may have unfortunate consequences. He must foresee certain prob-

Safety
lems—the movement of a control system chafing the insulation of an

Safety may require additional consideration in design. It may be


satisfactory, for most purposes, to have only one access to a cabin, but
in case of an emergency, this might be insufficient. A hydraulic system
to operate the retraction of a landing gear may be excellent, but if it fails
to function, can another system be used? Safety considerations should
always be taken into account by the designer to avoid situations which
may have unfortunate consequences. He must foresee certain prob-
lems- the movement of a control system chafing the insulation of an

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 83
electrical system; a foreign object falling into some mechanism and hinder-
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

83

electrical system; a foreign object falling into some mechanism and hinder-
ing its operation; excessive deflections causing the malfunction of another
ing its operation; excessive deflections causing the malfunction of another

part—and he must prevent them by a suitable and effective design.


part-and he must prevent them by a suitable and effective design.
Whatever structure is designed, stress analysis will be the final de-
Whatever structure is designed, stress analysis will be the final de-
terminant. One does not say that one structure is stronger than another,

terminant. One does not say that one structure is stronger than another,
but rather that one design is more efficient than another, meaning that
but rather that one design is more efficient than another, meaning that

the material has been used more effectively. This efficiency refers not

only to individual elements but also to an assembly of elements. the material has been used more effectively. This efficiency refers not
The "One-Horse Shay" Principle

For optimum design, an assembly of elements (provided there is no


only to individual elements but also to an assembly of elements.
conflict with some other design philosophy) should be built according to

The "One-Horse Shay" Principle


the principle of the "one-horse shay"—each part fails at the same time.

For example, in an assembly or panel, working stresses are so obtained


For optimum design, an assembly of elements (provided there is no
by the distribution of material between skin and stiffeners, that insta-

conflict with some other design philosophy) should be built according to


bility of the skin occurs simultaneously with the primary and secondary

instability of the stringers.


the principle of the "one-horse shay"-each part fails at the same time.
0.002 e-strain-inches per inch
For example, in an assembly or panel, working stresses are so obtained
Figure VI-1. Typical tensile stress-strain diagrams: (A) Material having a definite

yield point (such as plain low carbon steels); (B) Materials not having a definite yield
by the distribution of material between skin and stiffeners, that insta-
point (such as aluminum alloys-high carbon, alloy, and cold worked steels); (C) Alumi-
bility of the skin occurs simultaneously with the primary and secondary
num-covered aluminum alloys.

instability of the stringers.


~-"Y---
- .... ........

stress /""

Fracture
Proportional
limit

} e-strain-inches per inch


{a)

~------"J--- .....
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:16 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

·;;;
Q.
Ultimate
x
I
"'"' stress I
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

~ Fracture
....."'I
(b)

! --.. ."x
Ultimate /
stress
Fracture

(c)
0.002 e-strain-inches per inch

FIGURE Vl- 1. Typical tensile stress-strain diagrams: (A) Material having a definite
yield point (such as plain low carbon steels) ; (B) Materials not having a definite yield
point (such as aluminum alloys-high carbon, alloy, and cold worked steels) ; (C) Alumi-
num-covered aluminum alloys.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
84 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
84

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


STRENGTH OF METAL AIRCRAFT ELEMENTS
STRENGTH OF METAL AIRCRAFT ELEMENTS

The strength properties of the most commonly used materials and ele-
ments in the aircraft industry may be found in a publication entitled
The strength properties of the most commonly used materials and ele-

ments in the aircraft industry may be found in a publication entitled

Strength of Metal Aircraft Elements, published by the U. S. Government Strength of Metal Aircraft Elements, published by the U. S. Government
Printing Office.

Printing Office.
Typical stress-strain curves are shown in Figure VI-1. It is generally

desirable to know the yield and the ultimate strength of materials, since
Typical stress-strain curves are shown in Figure Vl-1. It is generally
the basic allowable stress of a material should not exceed the yield. How-

desirable to know the yield and the ultimate strength of materials, since
the basic allowable stress of a material should not exceed the yield. How-
ever, since the yield value is sometimes arbitrarily defined, the ultimate

stress may be used as a reference. Where this is done, the allowable

stress is assumed to equal the ultimate stress divided by the factor of ever, since the yield value is sometimes arbitrarily defined, the ultimate
safety of 1.5. This may be stated as

stress may be used as a reference. Where this is done, the allowable


where Fy = yield stress of the material, in tension or compression for

example,
stress is assumed to equal the ultimate stress divided by the factor of
Fu = ultimate stress of the material, in tension or compression
safety of 1.5. This may be stated as
for example,

Jy = safety factor = 1,

Ju — safety factor = 1.5.

The allowable stresses may vary from the mechanical properties of the

material since appropriate allowances must be made for column effects,

where F 11 yield stress of the material, in tension or compress10n for


method of fabrication, form factors and conditions, stress concentration,

fatigue, and the like.


example,
A knowledge of the behavior of the structure under load is important

Fu = ultimate stress of the material, m tension or compression


(1) for obtaining the optimum efficiency of the structure as to its allowable

load and strength-weight ratio, and (2) for designing the structure so
for example,
that excessive deflections do not interfere with the safe operation of Jll = safety factor = 1,
equipment and control systems that may be attached to it.

J" safety factor = 1.5.


Stress analysis covers the determination of the stress state in a member,

and the selection of a material or member with mechanical properties

that can withstand the likely maximum stress. It is necessary to know


The allowable stresses may vary from the mechanical properties of the
the00loads imposed upon the structure as well as the structural configura-
material since appropriate allowances must be made for column effects,
tions and materials employed, for the stresses caused by the limit loads

method of fabrication, form factors and conditions, stress concentration,


fatigue, and the like.
must not exceed the allowable stress of the material. In order to avoid

permanent sets, the applied stress must fall below the yield point of the

material.

STRUCTURAL BEHAVIOR
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

In building up a complex structure composed of many open sections

and much thin material, it is important to understand not only the types
A knowledge of the behavior of the structure under load is important
(1) for obtaining the optimum efficiency of the structure as to its allowable
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of failures possible in the complete structure, but also those to which

Eallowable

STRUCTURAL BEHAVIOR
load and strength-weight ratio, and (2) for designing the structure so
that excessive deflections do not interfere with the safe operation of
equipment and control systems that may be attached to it.
Stress analysis covers the determination of the stress state in a member,
and the selection of a material or member with mechanical properties
that can withstand the likely maximum stress. It is necessary to know
the ·loads imposed upon the structure as well as the structural configura-
tions and materials employed, for the stresses caused by the limit loads
must not exceed the allowable stress of the material. In order to avoid
permanent sets, the applied stress must fall below the yield point of the
material.
In building up a complex structure composed of many open sections
and much thin material, it is important to understand not only the types
of failures possible in the complete structure, but also those to which

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 85
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

85

individual members are subject. Failures of these members are generally


individual members are subject. Failures of these members are generally

a result of instability—either primary or local.


a result of instability-either primary or local.
A column having a closed circular cross section may suffer a compres-
A column having a closed circular cross section may suffer a compres-
sion failure either through lateral deflection, usually at the middle of

the column (primary instability), or through collapse of the tube wall,


sion failure either through lateral deflection, usually at the middle of
at a stress lower than that required to produce a general column failure
the column (primary instability), or through collapse of the tube wall,
of the primary instability type.

at a stress lower than that required to produce a general column failure


Structural

Sectisn
of the primary instability type.
Figure VI-2. Structural behavior.

Compression Bending
FIGURE VI-2. Structural behavior.
Efficient as a column Structural
for slenderness ratios
Section Compression Bending Torsion

0
less than 140.

Heavier than
Efficient as a column Efficient for small Efficient for small
round tube.
for slenderness ratios members and for D/t members and for
Equivalent
less than 140. ratios less than 50. D/t <70 and L/D
round tube.
<100.
to

0
Relatively efficient

as open section; bet-


Heavier than a Better than a round About equivalent
ter when section is
round tube. tube when bending to a. round tube.
closed.
about the vertical
Efficient for small
axis.

D
members and for D/t

ratios less than 50.

Equivalent to a Equivalent to a Equivalent to a.

ouo
Better than a round

tube when bending


round tube. round tube. round tube.
about the vertical

axis.

Equivalent
Relatively efficient Compares with Compares with
round tube.
as open section; bet- square tube when square tube when
to
ter when section is closed. closed.
Compares with closed.
square tube when

---- -----
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

closed.

Torsion
--- -- Efficient when sup- Efficient when com- Somewhat ineffici-
ported against lat- pression side is sup- ent in torsion.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Efficient for small

members and for


eral deflection. ported. If unsup-
D/t <70 and L/D
Buckles easily about ported, inefficient
<100.
vertical a.xis when about vertical axis.
About equivalent

unsupported.
to a round tube.

Equivalent

round tube.

I Relatively inefficient More efficient when Open section is in-


to a

'{: l : unless supported . compressive side is efficient.


Compares with
I
I Buckles easily about supported. If unsup-
square tube when
I
I '
diagonal a.xis when ported, will rotate
closed.

--- ---- unsupported. then bend a.bout di-


Efficient when sup-

agonal axis.
ported against lat-

eral deflection.

Efficient when sup- Efficient when com- Open section is in-


Buckles easily about

ported against lat- pression side is sup- efficient.


vertical axis when

unsupported.

Efficient when com-


er al deflection. ported. If Zee iti un-
pression side is sup-
Buckles easily about supported, ineffici-
ported. If unsup-
diagonal axis when ent a.bout vertical
ported, inefficient
unsupported. a.xis.
about vertical axis.

Somewhat ineffici-

ent in torsion.

Original from
Relatively inefficient

unless supported.
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
Buckles easily about

diagonal axis when

unsupported.
86 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
86

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL An I-beam may fail by sidewise deflection of the entire compression
An I-beam may fail by sidewise deflection of the entire compression

flange extending over a comparatively large distance, or by local wrinkling


flange extending over a comparatively large distance, or by local wrinkling

of one or both of the thin outstanding flanges.


of one or both of the thin outstanding flanges.
In general, structural members should be investigated for (1) failure of
In general, structural members should be investigated for (1) failure of
the material, (2) resistance to primary instability failure, and (3) re-

sistance to local instability failure. The type of failure that occurs at


the material, (2) resistance to primary instability failure, and (3) re-
the lowest stress should be used as the criterion in design. sistance to local instability failure. The type of failure that occurs Rt
STEFFENERS OR STRINGERS

the lowest stress should be used as the criterion in design.


The cross sections of the structural members by which sheet panels are

supported play an important role in the stability as well as in the strength

of the built-up structures. Such supports may be transverse ribs in a STIFFENERS OR STRINGERS
wing, transverse frames in a fuselage, or longitudinal stringers (or stiffen-

ers) in either the wing or fuselage.


The cross sections of the structural members by which sheet panels are
Some understanding of the behavior of these structures may be ob-
supported play an important role in the stability as well as in the strength
tained from the tabulation of representative cross sections of structural

of the built-up structures. Such supports may be transverse ribs in a


members given in Figure VI-2. It will be noted that closed sections are

generally best, open symmetrical sections are next in line, and open un-
wing, transverse frames in a fuselage, or longitudinal stringers (or stiffen-
symmetrical sections are least efficient. However, local support, as
ers) in either the wing or fuselage.
afforded by sheet covering, shear webs, or plates, increase the stability

and thus the maximum load-carrying ability of the individual members.


Some understanding of the behavior of these structures may be ob-
The effect of local supports and of the addition of a lip to a free edge is
tained from the tabulation of representative cross sections of structural
shown comparatively in Figure VI-3. Open sections are generally pre-

members given in Figure VI-2. It will be noted that closed sections are
generally best, open symmetrical sections are next in line, and open un-
ferred in reinforced monocoque stricture because of accessibility in rivet-

ing or bolting. The analysis is based upon the assumption that the

various component flanges of a structural member may be considered as


symmetrical sections are least efficient. However, local support, as
panels supported or free along the edges parallel to the direction of the

applied compressive load.


afforded by sheet covering, shear webs, or plates, increase the stability
1.0
and thus the maximum load-carrying ability of the individual members.
b „i, b

The effect of local supports and of the addition of a lip to a free edge is
shown comparatively in Figure VI-3. Open sections are generally pre-
2

i j±t±L ferred in reinforced monocoque stricture because of accessibility in rivet-


5.2 4.3

Relative compressive strength


ing or bolting. The analysis is based upon the assumption that the
5.9
various component flanges of a structural member may be considered as
panels supported or free along the edges parallel to the direction of the
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Figure VI-3. Compressive strengths of stiffeners. Assumptions: all loaded edges

applied compressive load.


(perpendicular to figure) were considered simply supported; edges considered freely
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

supported without lip; between simply and freely supported with lip; rivet line offers

condition between simple and clamped support condition.

!?.-+-~j
t=bl Cb=:1 =t!:t!-:L~ -C--
- - - ----
2 ' 2
-
- - --

b b b b

l
1.0
1J
5.2
l
4.3
u.
5.9
Relative compressive strength

FIGURE VI-3. Compressive strengths of stiffeners. Assumptions: all loaded edges


{perpendicular to figure) were considered simply supported; edges considered freely
supported without lip; between simply and freely supported with lip; rivet line offers
condition between simple and clamped support condition.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 87
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

87
To obtain an optimum design on the basis of strength-weight ratio, it
To obtain an optimum design on the basis of strength-weight ratio, it

would be necessary to conduct a preliminary stress analysis for various


would be necessary to conduct a preliminary stress analysis for various
types of stringers. This would entail considering the different combina- types of stringers. This would entail considering the different combina-
tions of skin thicknesses, stringer spacing and thicknesses, and transverse

tions of skin thicknesses, stringer spacing and thicknesses, and transverse


frame or rib spacings. After obtaining such data, the next step would

be a comparison of the relative weights of the combinations. It would


frame or rib spacings. After obtaining such data, the next step would
be necessary to have stress data available on various cross sections of
be a comparison of the relative weights of the combinations. It would
stringers or stiffeners. With this, initial comparisons could be made on

the basis of crushing strength (defined as the end point of column curves,
be necessary to have stress data available on various cross sections of
projected to L/p = 0 drawn through data) obtained from tests on columns
stringers or stiffeners. With this, initial comparisons could be made on
of the section for a range of L/p values from 20 to 50, where L is the

the basis of crushing strength (defined as the end point of column curves,
projected to L/p = 0 drawn through data) obtained from tests on columns
length of the column, and p the radius of gyration.

In either the wing or the fuselage, much weight is often accumulated

by the addition of stringer splices. A closed section, for example, re-


of the section for a range of L/p values from 20 to 50, where L is the
quires heavier and more complicated splices than an open section to

^ =======a
length of the column, and p the radius of gyration .
i
In either the wing or the fuselage, much weight is often accumulated
Schematic representation

by the addition of stringer splices. A closed section, for example, re-


quires heavier and more complicated splices than an open section to
Possible deflection curves

Fixed or Free edges

clamped edges

I I

;!;~=,====:£~, :~,=====:g:=
, "
Figure VI-4. Behavior of sheet under compression for different edge conditions.

Simply supported

edges

Schematic representation

J .... ---
I

--l_ _______ .....


--r~---~
- c-- --::----:--....__

Possible deflection curves

--
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Simply supported Fixed or Free edges


edges clomped edges

F IGURE VI-4. Behavior of sheet under compression for different edge conditions.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
88 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
88

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


accomplish a satisfactory structure. It is therefore possible to save
accomplish a satisfactory structure. It is therefore possible to save

weight with an open section, in spite of the fact that it can carry a lower
allowable stress.
weight with an open section, in spite of the fact that it can carry a lower

allowable stress.

PANELS UNDER LOAD

The behavior of a panel subjected to compression depends upon the

PANELS UNDER LOAD


degree of flexibility or rigidity of the supports to which the panel is at-

tached. A schematic representation of the behavior of various edge


The behavior of a panel subjected to compression depends upon the
conditions is given in Figure VI-4, which also shows the possible deflec-

degree of flexibility or rigidity of the supports to which the panel is at-


tached. A schematic representation of the behavior of various edge
tion curves that a single panel could take if considered alone.

Figure VI-5 indicates the behavior of a panel attached to a series of

stringers or stiffeners. The sketches illustrate a portion of a wing, a conditions is given in Figure VI-4, which also shows the possible deflec-
tail surface, or a fuselage under compression. For an originally curved

tion curves that a single panel could take if considered alone.


surface, the behavior would be similar. While at first it would seem that

a rigidly supported system (Figure B or Figure D) should result in the


Figure VI-5 indicates the behavior of a panel attached to a series of
lightest structure, this is not always the case, since the rigid supports may

stringers or stiffeners. The sketches illustrate a portion of a wing, a


tail surface, or a fuselage under compression. For an originally curved
contribute an inordinate amount of weight. It would be necessary to

Figure VI-5. Relative behavior of different types of metal sheet-stringer construc-

tion when under compressive stress. (A) The torsionally flexible stringers rotate and surface, the behavior would be similar. While at first it would seem that
carry the attached thin sheet with them. The stringers in this case are considered to

a rigidly supported system (Figure B or Figure D) should result in the


offer only simple support for the sheet between the stringers. (B) The torsionally stiff

longitudinal stringers and shear webs prevent rotation and offer clamped edge conditions
lightest structure, this is not always the case, since the rigid supports may
for the sheet covering. (C) The torsionally rigid longitudinal stringers rotate only
contribute an inordinate amount of weight. It would be necessary to
slightly and thus offer a condition between the simple and clamped edge conditions.

(D) The sheet, considerably thicker relative to the integrally incorporated longitudinal

stringers, takes over. The stringers, in this case, tend to reduce the spanwise undulation

<-~--/~--~~-~--~
of the sheet covering.

(a)

I I I
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

(b)
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

-r---~---~
(c)

-~-
----===u=- - - - - u
(d)

FIGURE Vl-5. Relative behavior of different types of metal sheet-stringer construc-


tion when under compressive stress. (A) The torsionally flexible stringers rotate and
carry the attached thin sheet witll them. The stringers in this case a.re considered to
offer only simple support for the sheet between the stringers. (B) The torsionally stiff
longitudinal stringers and shear webs prevent rotation and offer clamped edge conditions
for the sheet covering. (C) The torsionally rigid longitudinal stringers rotate only
slightly and thus offer a condition between the simple and clamped edge conditions.
(D) The sheet, considerably thicker relative to the integrally incorporated longitudinal
stringers, takes over. The stringers, in this case, tend to reduce the spanwise undulation
of the sheet covering.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 89
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 89

make comparative studies for specific design conditions to ascertain the


make comparative studies for specific design conditions to ascertain the
optimum design. Even then, other factors, such as fabrication and pro-

duction, may cause the reconsideration of a design which was otherwise


optimum design. Even then, other factors, such as fabrication and pro-
thought to be optimum. duction, may cause the reconsideration of a design which was otherwise
PANEL SIZES

thought to be optimum.
The number of transverse frames or ribs can be determined in part by

the permissible dimensions of the skin panels of a given thickness.

The metal covering not only serves to give the aerodynamic form to the PANEL SIZES
wing, tail surfaces, or fuselage, but must do so under varying conditions.

It should not, for instance, develop wrinkles or an undulating surface


The number of transverse frames or ribs can be determined in part by
under normal air pressure as this would materially add to the aerodynamic the permissible dimensions of the skin panels of a given thickness.
resistance. Furthermore, it should be strong enough to withstand the

The metal covering not only serves to give the aerodynamic form to the
stresses resulting from compression or shear. Usually, for preliminary

design, a stress analysis is either not available or is impossible to perform


wing, tail surfaces, or fuselage, but must do so under varying conditions.
without some idea of the likely configuration of the structure.
It should not, for instance, develop wrinkles or an undulating surface
The dimensions recommended to prevent oil-canning provide a ready

means of determining not only the panel sizes, but also the spacing of
under normal air pressure as this would materially add to the aerodynamic
Figure VI-6. Chart for determining proportions of unsupported sheet covering for resistance. Furthermore, it should be strong enough to withstand the
exterior surfaces so as to prevent oil-canning and undesirable vibration leading to

stresses resulting from compression or shear. Usually, for preliminary


design, a stress analysis is either not available or is impossible to perform
fatigue cracking. R is the radius of curvature in inches. If the ratio of panel length

to panel width is greater than 3, either the panel width should be reduced from the

values obtained from the chart or the thickness of the sheet should be increased.
without some idea of the likely configuration of the structure.
The dimensions recommended to prevent oil-canning provide a ready
means of determining not only the panel sizes, but also the spacing of

~ 18 1-----+--+--+-----+---+1---.~~
I)
..J::.
.£ 16 1-----+---+--+----+--#-->-4~.,.__,

c:D
.5 14 > ----+- --+-- + ---+--+---+->---+-- 1
u
~12t-----+---+--~~-+--+--+----I
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

I)

~ lQt-----+---+-~++--++---+--+----i
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

..::
...
~ 8 11-17~~=-
G)
c
~ 6 r------i-~~-r------r--+--r---"1
·~
"ii .4 1-----+-"--+--+-----+--+--+------i
c
c
fl..
2
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
N M
"0
"<t I()
0 0 0 C! 0 8 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
Sheet thickness, t, inches

FIGURE VI-6. Chart for determining proportions of unsupported sheet covering for
exterior surfaces so as to prevent oil-canning and undesirable vibration leading to
fatigue cracking. R is the radius of curvature in inches. If the ratio of panel length
to panel width is greater than 3, either the panel width should be reduced from the
values obtained from the chart or the thickness of the sheet should be increased.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
90 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
90

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure VI-7. Chart for determining proportions of unsupported sheet covering for

interior surfaces so as to prevent oil-canning and undesirable vibration leading to

fatigue cracking. R is the radius of curvature in inches. If the ratio of panel length

to panel width is greater than 3, either the panel width should be reduced from the
~ 181----+--+--+--+-fr-~'t-----::I
GI
.s:.
values obtained from the chart or the thickness of the panel sheet should be increased.

frames, ribs, stringers, or other supports. Figures VI-6 and VI-7 repre-
.5 16 1------+---+--+-~,___,__ _----1

sent charts for determining suitable panel sizes. Although subsequent

di
stress analysis may indicate a change in the skin thickness, this does not
.~ 141----+---+--~~r-----+-----1
v

~12 1----+----+---+-+----t.----+--t------t
necessarily entail a change in the spacing of supports. For aircraft of

the utility category, a skin thickness of not less than .025 inches for

GI
aluminum alloy is recommended. This is usually sufficiently thick for

E
the stresses encountered at most of the airplane surface. Where greater

bending moments are likely to occur, as at the root of the wing or the

central portion of the fuselage, a thickness of .032 to .040 inches may be


-e... o
...
0
1 1-----1--~~-;c=t

8 1---+---+~~==t
assumed. An examination of Figures VI-8 and VI-9, which show the GI
c
~ 6
variation of the coefficient K with variations in panel size and edge con-

ditions, reveals that the ratio of the two sides of a rectangular panel should

~
be less than 1 for panels in compression, and 1 for panels subjected to

Gi 4 1----+- - + - -+--+--+-- +----i


shear. However, while this is true from a strength point of view, having
c
c
a..
2
many stringers, frames, or other supports may not always be best from

the standpoint of weight and construction complexity. The optimum

relationship of the dimensions of a panel depends to some extent upon

0
the individual problem.
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
,.....
II)
0
N
0
<")
0 ""'
0 0 8 0
d d d d d d d
Sheet thickness, f, inches

FIGURE VI-7. Chart for determining proportions of unsupported sheet covering for
inrerior surfaces so as to prevent oil-canning and undesirable vibration leading to
fatigue cracking. R is the radius of curvature in inches. If the ratio of panel length
to panel width is greater than 3, either the panel width should be reduced from the
values obtained from the chart or the thickness of the panel sheet should be increased.

frames, ribs, stringers, or other supports. Figures VI-6 and VI-7 repre-
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

sent charts for determining suitable panel sizes. Although subsequent


stress analysis may indicate a change in the skin thickness, this does not
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

necessarily entail a change in the spacing of supports. For aircraft of


the utility category, a skin thickness of not less than .025 inches for
aluminum alloy is recommended. This is usually sufficiently thick for
the stresses encountered at most of the airplane surface. Where greater
bending moments are likely to occur, as at the root of the wing or the
central portion of the fuselage, a thickness of .032 to .040 inches may be
assumed. An examination of Figures VI-8 and VI- 9, which show the
variation of the coefficient K with variations in panel size and edge con-
ditions, reveals that the ratio of the two sides of a rectangular panel should
be less than 1 for panels in compression, and 1 for panels subjected to
shear. However, while this is true from a strength point of view, having
many stringers, frames, or other supports may not always be best from
the standpoint of weight and construction complexity. The optimum
relationship of the dimensions of a panel depends to some extent upon
the individual problem.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 91
12....--r"T"'T-r--.-----....,.----.-----.---~
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

91 11
2345

Ratio sf panel dimensisns a/b 10


Figure VT-8. Envelope of values of K in the formula given on the chart. The

following conditions are represented: (1) ends and sides of panels clamped; (2) ends
9
simply supported, sides clamped; (3) ends clamped, sides simply supported; (4) ends

and sides simply supported; (5) ends simply supported, one side free, one side clamped;
8
" 7
(6) ends simply supported, one side free, one side simply supported. The values at the

~ - 6.8
c:4>
right of the chart are the asymptotic values for each of the six conditions.

6.35

l --
111

+-----i ~
1
]
1i
5
- n . tu

0
r 11 j i
u
4 ~ - 3.62
I u,00^—.——-,m

- I- -- -
) ii U\

p*

3
( \\[ (

2
\

1.27
11

1 -
T
0.385
.n T 0
1,s
0 2 3 4 5
1
Ratio of panel dimensions a/b
1
FIGURE Vl-8. Envelope of values of K in the formula given on the chart. The
F-A
following conditions are represented : (1) ends and sides of panels clamped; (2) ends
scr simply supported, sides clamped; (3) ends clamped, sides simply supported; (4) ends
h a â–  and sides simply supported; (5) ends simply supported, one side free, one side clamped;
K$
(6) ends simply supported, one side free, one side simply supported. The values at the
10
right of the chart are the asymptotic values for each of the six conditions.
9\

234567

Rath of long side to short side /+J


Ks
I I
Figure VT-9. Graph for determining critical shear stress factor K,; a and 6 are

101-----1-----1-- - _1_! _______ •~--


--: Ti-~~ -1::--
between adjacent skin supports, whether ribs, stringers, spars, or other supports.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

91----+----4--- , I~ i::
- _,_J ~--=~--=.!..•--
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

--,,-------n--
I I I I
81-----&--4---

I--- 0 ~
~er • Ks E {-£]2

4..._~_.,~~-'---~---''----'-~~-'-~~,.__~~~~~
O I 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Ratio of long side to short side (f)
FIGURE Vl-9. Graph for determining critical shear stress factor K.; a and b are
between adjacent skin supports, whether ribs, stringers, spars, or other supports.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
92 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

It will also be noted that for a ratio of panel dimensions of 3 or greater,


92

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

It will also be noted that for a ratio of panel dimensions of 3 or greater, the value of the coefficient K in the appropriate formulas remains con-
the value of the coefficient K in the appropriate formulas remains con-

stant. A ratio of the sides of about 3 would seem reasonable for most
stant. A ratio of the sides of about 3 would seem reasonable for most
of the cases encountered.
of the cases encountered.
Figure VI-10. The solid line in the top illustration represents the distribution of

the compressive stress on a reinforced panel after the sheet has buckled. The equivalent

stress distribution used for calculation on the basis of "effective widths" of the sheet is

shown by the dashed lines.

STRENGTH OF SHEET-STRINGER COMBINATIONS

When a combination sheet-stringer panel is subjected to compression,

the sheet will tend to buckle at a lower stress level than the stringer, and

will thereafter carry no more load. The stress distribution of such a

sheet-stringer combination is illustrated in Figure VI-10. The solid

wr
line depicts the stress distribution chordwise at the time the C-stringers

have reached their maximum allowable stress. Since the sinusoidal

nature of the stress distribution is somewhat difficult to calculate, an

approximation is made by assuming a uniform stress distribution, as

shown by the dotted lines in the above figure. The extent of this uni-
I Section A-A otu
form stress distribution is determined by the so-called "effective widths,"

as illustrated in Figure VI-11.

The effective widths may be calculated by means of the following

formula:

A A

FIGURE Vl-10. The solid line in the top illustration represents the distribution of
the compressive stress on a reinforced panel after the sheet has buckled. The equivalent
stress distribution used for calculation on the basis of "effective widths" of the sheet is
shown by the dashed lines.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

STRENGTH OF SHEET-STRINGER COMBINATIONS


When a combination sheet-stringer panel is subjected to compression,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the sheet will tend to buckle at a lower stress level than the stringer, and
will thereafter carry no more load. The stress distribution of such a
sheet-stringer combination is illustrated in Figure Vl-10. The solid
line depicts the stress distribution chordwise at the time the C-stringers
have reached their maximum allowable stress. Since the sinusoidal
nature of the stress distribution is somewhat difficult to calculate, an
approximation is made by assuming a uniform stress distribution, as
shown by the dotted lines in the above figure. The extent of this uni-
form stress distribution is determined by the so-called "effective widths,"
as illustrated in Figure Vl-11.
The effective widths may be calculated by means of the following
formula:

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSID"T!JRATIONS 93
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 93

edge
G>
O>
.»W2*j»Wl»0 ""O
G>
0

G>
edge

Li
...G>
LI..

<—H

Li-

edge

»»2| "2

"2 | "2

"2 | "2

-*

Jedge

1
FIGURE VI-11. The effective widths, w1 and w 2 , are measured from the rivet center
i
line.
i

i
where w = effective width, in inches,
Cw = .60 for wi, as shown in Figure VI-11,
i

Freej

-1

= .85 for wz, as shown in Figure VI-11,


i

1
t = thickness of sheet, in inches,
E = modulus of elasticity, psi,
1

lu

F c = allowable column stress of the combination of the stringer


and the effective widths of the sheet.
u-

Fiodbe VI-11. The effective widths, u,i and tc2, are measured from the rivet center

line.

where w = effective width, in inches,


It will be noted from Figure VI-11 that the stringer or stiffener re-
Cv> = .60 for wi, as shown in Figure VI-11,
quiring two rows of rivets makes more of the skin effective than does the
= .85 for w2, as shown in Figure VI-11,

t = thickness of sheet, in inches,


stringer requiring only a single row. Moreover, the stringer having a
closed section with the skin is itself a more effective compression member.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

E = modulus of elasticity, psi,

Fe = allowable column stress of the combination of the stringer

However, the greater cost of two rivet rows must be- considered against
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

and the effective widths of the sheet.

It will be noted from Figure VI-11 that the stringer or stiffener re-
the strength advantages.
quiring two rows of rivets makes more of the skin effective than does the

Unless the proportion of the load carried by the effective skin is ap-
stringer requiring only a single row. Moreover, the stringer having a

closed section with the skin is itself a more effective compression member.
preciable, it is often impractical to determine in preliminary design the
However, the greater cost of two rivet rows must be0 0 considered against
true effective width of skin. For a first approximation, therefore, it is
the strength advantages.

Unless the proportion of the load carried by the effective skin is ap-
satisfactory to consider an effective width of skin of 30t on each side of
preciable, it is often impractical to determine in preliminary design the the rivet line.
true effective width of skin. For a first approximation, therefore, it is

satisfactory to consider an effective width of skin of 30< on each side of

the rivet line.


EQUIVALENT STRUCTURE
EQUIVALENT STRUCTURE
In considering a wing or fuselage cross section as a cross section of beam
In considering a wing or fuselage cross section as a cross section of beam

in bending, it is immediately apparent that the effective centroid of the


in bending, it is immediately apparent that the effective centroid of the
cross section is not the center of gravity, for less material is effective on cross section is not the center of gravity, for less material is effective on
the compression side of the beam than on the tension side.

the compression side of the beam than on the tension side.


In designing any beam for bending, it is desirable to distribute the

material so that it is located as far from the neutral axis as possible. A


In designing any beam for bending, it is desirable to distribute the
sheet-stringer combination, however, involves another factor, as each

material so that it is located as far from the neutral axis as possible. A


sheet-stringer combination, however, involves another factor, as each

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
94 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
94

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

(o)

Actual location of skin

(b)

Figure VI-12. (A) A typical sheet-stringer construction; (B) the equivalent effec-

tiveness under compression. The solid line represents the shear elements, and the
, , , (a)
solid circles the bending or compression elements.

sheet-stringer element under compression acts as a column under com-


LActual location of skin
pression. Since the stringer is restrained from buckling in a direction

~~==~==-=~-=---:..-=--=--=--=--=-~~~~-~
parallel to the metal sheet covering but is only slightly restrained in the

direction perpendicular to the skin, it is desirable to have a large moment


(b)
FrouRE Vl-12. (A) A typical sheet-stringer construction; (B) the equivalent effec-
inertia for that axis to resist any buckling tendencies. The effect of this

tiveneBB under compression. The solid line represents the shear elements, and the
is shown schematically in Figure VI-12.

CUT-OUTS

Cut-outs caused by doors, windows, access or inspection plates, landing


solid circles the bending or compression elements.
gear retraction, and the like represent an interruption of the structural

integrity of the unit where they occur. Recourse to hydraulic analogy


sheet-stringer element under compression acts as a column under com-
(see Figure VI-13) indicates that high local stresses occur at the corners

pression. Since the stringer is restrained from buckling in a direction


parallel to the metal sheet covering but is only slightly restrained in the
of the cut-out, and that the structural elements ahead and behind the

cut-out are not carrying any stress unless some distortion takes place

elsewhere to transfer some of the load.


direction perpendicular to the skin, it is desirable to have a large moment
The condition of stress around a cut-out in a reinforced monocoque

structure is similar to that of a hole in plate, as illustrated in Figure VI-14.


inertia for that axis to resist any buckling tendencies. The effect of this
Doors may be designed to carry loads through the structure if proper
is shown schematically in Figure VI-12.
provision is made for transmitting the loads. However, such factors as

loose fits and requirements for emergency operation prevent this from
CUT-OUTS
being an easily-established condition.

Cut-outs caused by doors, windows, access or inspection plates, landing


Figure VI-13. Hydraulic analogy may offer an insight into the likely stress dis-

tribution around a cut-out. In the hydraulic analogy shown above, the obstruction in
gear retraction, and the like represent an interruption of the structural
the channel could represent a window in the side of a fuselage. The greatest stress con-

integrity of the unit where they occur. Recourse to hydraulic analogy


(see Figure Vl-13) indicates that high local stresses occur at the corners
centration is at the corners. The flow ahead and behind the obstruction is practically

at a standstill. Translated to the structural counterpart, the structure ahead and

behind the cut-out is carrying no load or is not stressed. of the cut-out, and that the structural elements ahead and behind the
cut-out are not carrying any stress unless some distortion takes place
elsewhere to transfer some of the load.
The condition of stress around a cut-out in a reinforced monocoque
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

structure is similar to that of a hole in plate, as illustrated in Figure Vl-14.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Doors may be designed to carry loads through the structure if proper


provision is made for transmitting the loads. However, such factors as
loose fits and requirements for emergency operation prevent this from
being an easily-established condition.

FIGURE VI-13. Hydraulic analogy may offer an insight into the likely stress dis-
tribution around a cut-out. In the hydraulic analogy shown above, the obstruction in
the channel could represent a window in the side of a fuselage. The greatest stress con-
centration is at the corners. The flow ahead and behind the obstruction is practically
at a standstill. Translated to the structural counterpart, the structure ahead and
behind the cut-out is carrying no load or is not stressed.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 95
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

95

Ui.

Figure VI-14.

jected to tension.

Stress distribution across the section through a hole in a plate sub-

Note the greater intensity adjacent to the hole.

Windows are not considered to carry loads through the structure. It is


FrnuRE Vl-14. Stress distribution across the section through a hole in a plate sub-
true that pressure on them is transmitted, but the installation and the
jected to tension. Note the greater intensity adjacent to the hole.
material of the windows are such that they are not thought of as pro-

viding continuity to the structure for stress analysis purposes.

To enable the structure around the cut-out to adequately carry the


Windows are not considered to carry loads through the structure. It is
loads imposed upon it, provision must be made for reinforcements such

as additional doubler plates or rigid frames. Figures VI-15 and VI-16


true that pressure on them is transmitted, but the installation and the
show some possible solutions.
material of the windows are such that they are not thought of as pro-
RIVETED AND BOLTED JOINTS

viding continuity to the structure for stress analysis purposes.


To enable the structure around the cut-out to adequately carry the
Should failure occur in riveted joints, it is generally better that it occur

by shearing of the connecting element, the rivet, rather than by bearing

and/or tearing of the sheet or plate.


loads imposed upon it, provision must be made for reinforcements such
Aluminum alloy rivets are available in Y%, % and % of an

inch diameters. The selection of the diameter size depends upon many
as additional doubler plates or rigid frames. Figures Vl-15 and Vl-16
factors—the ease of upsetting the shop-head, the thicknesses to be joined,
show some possible solutions.
the loads to be transmitted, and the size of rivet pattern possible. For

simple or straightforward sheet connections, a diameter approximately

equal to the total thicknesses of sheet to be joined may be assumed until


RIVETED AND BOLTED JOINTS
Figure VI-15. Treatment of cut-outs and openings. Rigid frames, rounded
Should failure occur in riveted joints, it is generally better that it occur
corners, and doubler plates help to redistribute the stresses. The arrows indicate the

principal direction of stress.


by shearing of the connecting element, the rivet, rather than by bearing
and/ or tearing of the sheet or plate.
Aluminum alloy rivets are available in ~, Ys, %?, ~' §.16 and Ys of an
inch diameters. The selection of the diameter size depends upon many
factors-the ease of upsetting the shop-head, the thicknesses to be joined,
the loads to be transmitted, and the size of rivet pattern possible. For
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

simple or straightforward sheet connections, a diameter approximately


equal to the total thicknesses of sheet to be joined may be assumed until
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

~-=f= 0
/
------
==~--====-=--=====~
'
+~-
,/
""" ~-
',
=(~
I
I
/ ... ------ .........
''

I'

~~)==
=-F=
~/

\
',
I
'
_,.
/
~ r /

----- /
-~'
I \.
~ = F-
'
',
' ' ... ______ , I
~/

FIGURE VI-15. Treatment of cut-outs and openings. Rigid frames, rounded


corners, and doubler plates help to redistribute the stresses. The arrows indicate the
principal direction of stress.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
96 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

=-='l=-=--+==~=--=-
96

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

11 I
(a) (b)
II 11 II
II ...,,- --- I
~ -=ii=
Figure VI-16. Two possible treatments of cut-outs such as windows, doors, and

access holes. (A) is appropriate for a section subjected to relatively high shear and =-41....-
compression loads. Doubler plates or increased skin thickness may be added where II I I II
the stress would otherwise be high. (B) is suitable, for example, near the neutral axis II I 'I
II I 1
-~ 4-::.
of a fuselage where the stress is low. The frame around the cut-out may be subject to

induced loads.

11 \; _ _ --' 11
the detail design has progressed far enough to allow a study of the effect

ii 11'1 1'1
of a different rivet size.

II
Bolted joints are used where the thickness of the plates or material to
=~'":....---~-=-= =tk
JI
=
be joined is large enough to warrant their use.

Whatever the method employed of joining two or more members to-

(a) (b)
gether by means of pinning, consideration has to be given to making the

parts accessible in the course of assembly and to providing the necessary


FIGURE Vl-16. Two possible treatments of cut-outs such ll.B windows, doors, and
clearance between adjacent pins (whether rivet or bolt) so that the tools
access holes. (A) is appropriate for a section subjected to relatively high shear and
used to upset the rivet head or to tighten the nut on the bolt clear all compresaion loads. Doubler plates or increased skin thickness may be added where
adjacent interferences.
the stress would otherwise be high. (B) is suitable, for example, near the neutral axis
I
of a fuselage where the stress is low. The frame around the cut-out may be subject to
J
induced loads.
[! ^

!A1

the detail design has progressed far enough to allow a study of the effect
'a'J

it

6d of a different rivet size.


1

!00<M-
Bolted joints are used where the thickness of the plates or material to
/

be joined is large enough to warrant their use.


!! c

-
Whatever the method employed of joining two or more members to-
-2d

>
gether by means of pinning, consideration has to be given to making the
Figure VI-17. Rivet patterns. Spacing for single and double rows expressed in
parts accessible in the course of assembly and to providing the necessary
terms of rivet diameters.

clearance between adjacent pins (whether rivet or bolt) so that the tools
used to upset the rivet head or to tighten the nut on the bolt clear all
adjacent interferences.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

I
~
il
I
I

I '
:-+-
_J2d~ 6d -4- -
iJ
I -

i - ~- -
2d i -~1
:I I
-+,
I
2d
I I
I

2d~

FIGURE Vl-17. Rivet patterns. Spacing for single and double rows expressed in
terms of rivet diameters.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 97
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

97

Figure VI-17 offers a guide to the development of a rivet row or rivet


pattern. Each manufacturer will have specific instructions available in a
Figure VI-17 offers a guide to the development of a rivet row or rivet

pattern. Each manufacturer will have specific instructions available in a

drafting room manual or some similar reference. However for student


drafting room manual or some similar reference. However for student
work, the simple instructions outlined in the figure should suffice.

The spacing of the rivets attaching the skin to the stiffener may often
work, the simple instructions outlined in the figure should suffice.
determine the allowable load that the structural element consisting of
The spacing of the rivets attaching the skin to the stiffener may often
the stiffener and skin may carry (if buckling of any element determines

determine the allowable load that the structural element consisting of


the stiffener and skin may carry (if buckling of any element determines
the upper design criterion) since buckling of the skin between rivets is

likely to occur first. The plastic buckling stress of the compressive skin

between the rivets may be obtained from the formula: the upper design criterion) since buckling of the skin between rivets is
3.62 E•

likely to occur first. The plastic buckling stress of the compressive skin
'(P/O2

where Fc = plastic buckling stress, psi,


between the rivets may be obtained from the formula:
Et = tangent modulus of the material,

p = rivet spacing or pitch, as measured between the center of ad-


F _ 3.62 E1
jacent rivets, in inches,

c: - (p/t)2
t = thickness of skin in inches.

where F c plastic buckling stress, psi,


If the allowable stress should be considered too low, then obviously the

designer may change the value by either increasing the skin thickness or
=
changing the rivet spacing.

E,= tangent modulus of the material,


FITTINGS

Points at which concentrated loads are transferred from one complex


p = rivet spacing or pitch, as measured between the center of ad-
structure (landing gear members, engine mount supports, wing spars, tail

jacent rivets, in inches,


surface spars) to another (the fuselage or the wing), require a special study

of methods of transferring the loads. This must be taken not only from t = thickness of skin in inches.
the point of view of stresses incurred, but also from the standpoint of

secondary effects that may result from slight misalignments, initial buck- If the allowable stress should be considered too low, then obviously the
ling, or excessive deflection of the adjacent supporting structure.

It is poor design to attach a rigid fitting to a thin sheet such as a spar


designer may change the value by either increasing the skin thickness or
web or fuselage skin because of the instability of the thin sheet and the
changing the rivet spacing.
high concentration of stresses. Figures VI-18 and VI-19 illustrate a

few simple applications of fitting attachments and splices.

For preliminary design, the point of departure in designing a fitting is


FITTINGS
to consider the pin or pins to be used for joining the two or more members Points at which concentrated loads are transferred from one complex
together. After the selection of the pin or bolt, the necessary dimensions

structure (landing gear members, engine mount supports, wing spars, tail
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

for determining the configuration of the fitting become apparent.

It is advisable to have concentric fittings wherever possible. The


surface spars) to another (the fuselage or the wing), require a special study
of methods of transferring the loads. This must be taken not only from
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

simplest fitting of this type would involve one pin subjected to double

the point of view of stresses incurred, but also from the standpoint of
shear, as shown in Figure VI-20. The minimum dimensions of the male

lug may be found by the method outlined below.

secondary effects that may result from slight misalignments, initial buck-
ling, or excessive deflection of the adjacent supporting structure.
It is poor design to attach a rigid fitting to a thin sheet such as a spar
web or fuselage skin because of the instability of the thin sheet and the
high concentration of stresses. Figures VI-18 and VI-19 illustrate a
few simple applications of fitting attachments and splices.
For preliminary design, the point of departure in designing a fitting is
to consider the pin or pins to be used for joining the two or more members
together. After the selection of the pin or bolt, the necessary dimensions
for determining the configuration of the fitting become apparent.
It is advisable to have concentric fittings wherever possible. The
simplest fitting of this type would involve one pin subjected to double
shear, as shown in Figure VI-20. The minimum dimensions of the male
lug may be found by the method outlined below.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
98 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
98

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure VI-18. Illustration of a spar fitting. The steps are introduced to avoid

sudden changes in cross section. A tapered tang could be used but spot-facing would

be necessary to assure proper seating of bolt heads and nuts.

Figure VI-19. Examples of splices. Splicing members may be riveted or bolted,

depending upon the method of connecting members in other parts of the same structure.

An internal wrenching bolt may be used for the tension splice shown in bottom figure

at the right.

Figure VI-20. Principal dimensions of a fitting lug. The dimension W should not

be less than 2R-d. Where the shank behind the bolt hole is long, additional calculations

should be made for bending stresses, especially those that may be introduced by eccen-
FIGURE Vl-18. Illustration of a. spar fitting. The steps a.re introduced to a.void
tric loads, whether due to misalignment or applied.

sudden changes in croBB section. A tapered tang could be used but spot-facing would
be neceBBa.ry to a.ssure proper seating of bolt heads and nuts.

I
I_
T/
·- 1,/
I . '
I , ' '
/ -+- /
' I

·--- - .., 1 /
U'
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FIGURE Vl-19. Examples of splices. Splicing members may be riveted or bolted,


depending upon the method of connecting members in other parts of the same structure.
An internal wrenching bolt may be used for the tension splice shown in bottom figure
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

a.t the right.

JI'
t

T w •i
d p~ 2R

l
FIGURE Vl-20. Principal dimensions of a fitting lug. The dimension W should not
be less than 2R-d. Where the shank behind the bolt hole is long, additional calculations
should be made for bending stresses, especially those that may be introduced by eccen-
tric loads, whether due to misalignment or applied.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 99
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

99
Step 1. Determining Bolt Diameter.
Step 1. Determining Bolt Diameter.

p
where P. is allowable single shear strength of bolt obtained from Table

VI-1, and
-<P,,•
2 -
P is tension or compression in pounds.

Step 2. Determining Thickness of Fitting Lug.

where P, is allowable single shear strength of bolt obtained from Table


VI-1, and
P = 2<F*,

where Ft* is allowable bearing stress of the plate. Select nearest stand-

ard thickness.
P is tension or compression in pounds.
Step 3. Determining Value of R.

P = (2R - d)tFty. Step 2. Determining Thickness of Fitting Lug.


Step 4. Checking whether Dimension R is Sufficient.

P = 2xtF„
P = 2tFbr,
where F, is the allowable shear stress of the plate and where x may be

assumed equal to R.
where Fbr is allowable bearing stress of the plate. Select nearest stand-
The illustration given should be helpful in determining proportions of

ard thickness.
other fittings involving more bolts or plates.

SANDWICH MATERIALS

Step 3.
Two metal sheets with a relatively thick low-density material placed

between them is generally called a "sandwich material." This type of


P = (2R - d)tF,,r
construction is used to increase the greater rigidity and stability of thin

sheet material under load. Step 4. Checking whether Dimension R is Sufficient.


The low-density material or core may be balsa wood, foam rubber,

fiberglass, or another synthetic compound of low density and high volume. P = 2xtF,,
This material serves primarily to give added support to the metal sheet

and thus increase the allowable stress that the material may take, whether where F, is the allowable shear stress of the plate and where x may be
it is in compression or shear. The. core, when properly bonded to the

assumed equal to R.
exterior sheets, prevents panel flutters.

The sandwich core may also be comprised of relatively high density

materials such as resin-impregnated paper or thin sheet metal, when


The illustration given should be helpful in determining proportions of
these materials are fabricated in honeycomb or a similar configuration.
other fittings involving more bolts or plates.
(See Figure VI-21.) When this type of core is employed, the sandwich

has an added strength or stability normal to the outside sheets, and it

therefore lends itself to flooring or any purpose where normal loads are
SANDWICH MATERIALS
likely to be high.

Two metal sheets with a relatively thick low-density material placed


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

between them is generally called a "sandwich material." This type of


construction is used to increase the greater rigidity and stability of thin
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

sheet material under load.


The low-density material or core may be balsa wood, foam rubber,
fiberglass, or another synthetic compound of low density and high volume.
This material serves primarily to give added support to the metal sheet
and thus increase the allowable stress that the material may take, whether
it is in compression or shear. The core, when properly bonded to the
exterior sheets, prevents panel flutters. "
The sandwich core may also be comprised of relatively high density
materials such as resin-impregnated paper or thin sheet metal, when
these materials are fabricated in honeycomb or a similar configuration.
(See Figure VI-21.) When this type of core is employed, the sandwich
has an added strength or stability normal to the outside sheets, and it
therefore lends itself to flooring or any purpose where normal loads are
likely to be high.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
100 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
100

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure VI-21. One form of sandwich construction is illustrated here. The core is

a honeycomb made of metal, fiber, or plastic. Such construction is used for flooring,

leading and trailing edges of tail surfaces and control surfaces.

The major disadvantages of sandwich construction are the difficulty of

bonding the faces to the core, the extensive tooling required by the compli-

cated configurations, and the local reinforcements and built-in fittings

necessitated by the application of concentrated loads.

FLOORING

Flooring, whether in the cabin, cockpit, or cargo compartment, requires

a type of structure that is rather rigid to the load normally applied to the

surface. For that reason, the cross section of the structure must have a

relatively high moment of inertia in order to reduce the deflections and

also a surface that is resistant to easy local penetration.

Consider, for example, a square plate of homogeneous material that is

simply supported along its edges (a conservative estimate) and subjected

to a uniformly distributed load of w pounds per square inch. The maxi-

mum deflection, occurring at the center, would be:

where b is the length of sides of the square,


FIGURE Vl-21. One form of sandwich construction is illustrated here. The core is
t is the thickness of the plate, and
a honeycomb made of metal, fiber, or plastic. Such construction is used for flooring,
E is the modulus of elasticity.
leading and trailing edges of tail surfaces and control surfaces.
For such a plate, it is obvious that steel would have approximately one

third of the deflection that aluminum alloy would have, in the ratio of The major disadvantages of sandwich construction are the difficulty of
Eal. alloy/E^ai ,

bonding the faces to the core, the extensive tooling required by the compli-
but would weigh approximately three times more (in the ratio of specific

weight of steel to the specific weight of aluminum alloy). However, if


cated configurations, and the local reinforcements and built-in fittings
the thickness of the material used was increased, the deflections would
necessitated by the application of concentrated loads.

FLOORING
Flooring, whether in the cabin, cockpit, or cargo compartment, requires
a type of structure that is rather rigid to the load normally applied to the
surface. For that reason, the cross section of the structure must have a
relatively high moment of inertia in order to reduce the deflections and
also a surface that is resistant to easy local penetration.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Consider, for example, a square plate of homogeneous material that is


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

simply supported along its edges (a conservative estimate) and subjected


to a uniformly distributed load of w pounds per square inch. The maxi-
mum deflection, occurring at the center, would be:
wb 4
d = .045 Ets'
where b is the length of sides of the square,
t is the thickness of the plate, and
Eis the modulus of elasticity.
For such a plate, it is obvious that steel would have approximately one
third of the deflection that aluminum alloy would have, in the ratio of
Eal. alley/ E1tul 1

but would weigh approximately three times more (in the ratio of specific
weight of steel to the specific weight of aluminum alloy). However, if
the thickness of the material used was increased, the deflections would

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 101
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

101

(a)

'U U U U LT^1

(b)

(c)

(d)
(a)
(e)

0—u h—u u—u u—u u—u

(f)

Figure VI-22. Cross sections of several types of flooring are illustrated: (A) an
LI LI Li
example of sandwich construction; (B) an integrally stiffened plate; (C) a "beaded" (b)
plate; (D) a corrugated sheet attached to a flat sheet on one side or to a flat sheet on

both sides; (E) a built-up section for a heavily loaded floor; (F) relatively closely-spaced

C stiffeners. The assemblies may be riveted, spot-welded, or bonded.

vary as the cube of the thickness and thereby accomplish more. Chang-

ing the dimension b would be helpful, provided that the transverse supports
(c)
were not the determining influence in the over-all deflection of a floor

comprised of many individual squares.

In reducing the deflection of a plate, much can be accomplished through

the incorporation of beads or integral stiffeners. Still more may be done


__=z__~-~~-~ : __
(d)
by using sandwich construction with a relatively stiff core, or a flat sheet

backed up by corrugations. (Figure VI-22 shows some representative

cross sections of floors.)

Further insight into the desirable characteristics of flooring construc-

tion will be gained through a consideration of the deflection formula of a

beam of uniform cross section loaded uniformly:

wl4
IC IC IC IC
(e)

tr=11
(f)
FIGURE Vl-22. Cross sections of several types of flooring are illustrated: (A) an
example of sandwich construction; (B) an integrally stiffened plate; (C) a "beaded"
plate; (D) a corrugated sheet attached to a flat sheet on one side or to a flat sheet on
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

both sides; (E) a built-up section for a heavily loaded floor; (F) relatively closely-spaced
C stiffeners. The assemblies may be riveted, spot-welded, or bonded.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

vary as the cube of the thickness and thereby accomplish more. Chang-
ing the dimension b would be helpful, provided that the transverse supports
were not the determining influence in the over-all deflection of a floor
comprised of many individual squares.
In reducing the deflection of a plate, much can be accomplished through
the incorporation of beads or integral stiffeners. Still more may be done
by using sandwich construction with a relatively stiff core, or a fl.at sheet
backed up by corrugations. (Figure VI-22 shows some representative
cross sections of floors.)
Further insight into the desirable characteristics of flooring construc-
tion will be gained through a consideration of the deflection formula of a
beam of uniform cross section loaded uniformly:
wl 4
d = 384E(

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
102 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
102

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL Obviously, the greater the moment of inertia of the cross section, the
Obviously, the greater the moment of inertia of the cross section, the

smaller the deflection. Sandwich construction generally provides a ready


smaller the deflection. Sandwich construction generally provides a ready

means of obtaining a high moment of inertia.


means of obtaining a high moment of inertia.
The requirement for floor loading depends in large part upon the type
The requirement for floor loading depends in large part upon the type
of payload or cargo that is carried. For a distributed load, up to 40 or

more pounds per square foot is common; for concentrated loads, the
of payload or cargo that is carried. For a distributed load, up to 40 or
weight of a passenger over a square foot area may be assumed. For con-
more pounds per square foot is common; for concentrated loads, the
centrated loads, such as is caused by a lady's high-heel shoe, the total

weight of a passenger over a square foot area may be assumed. For con-
weight of the passenger over an area of one square inch would be ap-

propriate.
centrated loads, such as is caused by a lady's high-heel shoe, the total
THERMAL PROBLEMS
weight of the passenger over an area of one square inch would be ap-
In the internal combustion engine, the dissipation of excess heat was

accomplished either by liquid cooling and ultimate rejection of the heat


propriate.
through the medium of air passing through the radiator through which

the liquid was circulated or, more directly, by using the circulating air to
THERMAL PROBLEMS
absorb the heat directly, without a liquid intermediary. This type of

thermal problem is an ever-present one in any heat engine, and the engi-
In the internal combustion engine, the dissipation of excess heat was
neering means for alleviating it are readily available.
accomplished either by liquid cooling and ultimate rejection of the heat
0l I I I I I I I

0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700


through the medium of air passing through the radiator through which
Exposure temperature, degrees F
the liquid was circulated or, more directly, by using the circulating air to
Figure VI-23. Typical graph of strength characteristics of Aluminum Alloy 75S-T6

absorb the heat directly, without a liquid intermediary. This type of


thermal problem is an ever-present one in any heat engine, and the engi-
extrusions at elevated temperatures. Not only is the strength less, but the creep char-

acteristics of material at elevated temperatures will cause displacements, misalignments,

and other distortions.


neering means for alleviating it are readily available.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

o.._~-'-~--"~~......._~_._~~..._~_._~__,
0 1()() 200 300 400 500 600 700
Exposure temperature, degrees F

FIGURE VI-23. Typical graph of strength characteristics of Aluminum Alloy 75S-T6


extrusions at elevated. temperatures. Not only is the strength less, but the creep char-
acteristics of material at elevated temperatures will cause displacements, misalignments,
and other distortions.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 103
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 103

Figure VI-24. Experimental structures for aircraft exposed to high-temperature-

producing conditions: (A) utilizes relatively closely spaced corrugated webs useful for

both heat dissipation and rigidity; (B) utilizes rigid trusses whose members serve to

drain the heat from the surface and function as a heat sink. In both figures, the top

skin has been removed to show the interior construction.

For short periods of excessive heating (as caused by braking), a tempo-

rary heat sink may be provided by the use of a large mass of material with

relatively high heat absorption. Since the time cycle of heating is short,

a considerable period may elapse afterwards for the cooling of the heat

sink.

A new thermal problem has presented itself with the attainment of

faster-than-sound speeds. At these high speeds, the aircraft surfaces

become heated due to aerodynamic friction. At Mach 2 (twice the speed

of sound), the metal sheet covering may reach a temperature of 275° F,

and at Mach 3, it may reach 650° F. At speeds as high as Mach 4 to 5,

the steady-state temperatures of airborne missiles may reach from 1000°


FIGURE Vl-24. Experimental structures for aircraft exposed to high-temperature-
to 2000° F.
producing conditions: (A) utilizes relatively closely spaced corrugated webs useful for
For internal spaces occupied by people and temperature-critical equip-
both heat dissipation and rigidity; (B) utilizes rigid truBSes whose member1:1 serve to
ment, air conditioners must be supplied. For the structure, materials

drain the heat from the surface and function as a heat sink. In both figures, the top
and methods of construction have to be used which:

skin has been removed to show the interior construction.


1. retain their high strength characteristics at elevated temperatures,

such as titanium alloys (Figure VI-23 shows some typical strength charac-

teristics of a metal at various elevated temperatures), or


For short periods of excessive heating (as caused by braking), a tempo-
2. serve as a heat sink (requiring much material), or
rary heat sink may be provided by the use of a large mass of material with
3. allow dissipation of the heat by providing large surfaces about which

air may be circulated, under pressure if necessary.


relatively high heat absorption. Since the time cycle of heating is short,
Much research is presently being conducted to find an effective way of a considerable period may elapse afterwards for the cooling of the heat
meeting this new challenge. Figure VI-24 shows some possible solutions.

sink.
MISCELLANEOUS

Various methods are employed to strengthen a structural member made


A new thermal problem has presented itself with the attainment of
of a relatively large area of flat sheet.
faster-than-sound speeds. At these high speeds, the aircraft surfaces
become heated due to aerodynamic friction. At Mach 2 (twice the speed
of sound), the metal sheet covering may reach a temperature of 275° F,
and at Mach 3, it may reach 650° F. At speeds as high as Mach 4 to 5,
the steady-state temperatures of airborne missiles may reach from 1000°
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

to 2000° F.
For internal spaces occupied by people and temperature-critical equip-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ment, air conditioners must be supplied. For the structure, materials


and methods of construction have to be used which:
1. retain their high strength characteristics at elevated temperatures,
such as titanium alloys (Figure VI-23 shows some typical strength charac-
teristics of a metal at various elevated temperatures), or
2. serve as a heat sink (requiring much material), or
3. allow dissipation of the heat by providing large surfaces about which
air may be circulated, under pressure if necessary.
Much research is presently being conducted to find an effective way of
meeting this new challenge. Figure VI-24 shows some possible solutions.

MISCELLANEOUS
Various methods are employed to strengthen a structural member made
of a relatively large area of flat sheet.

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
104 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
104

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Al
x^5=

iff

»j

\N If

iV III

J/ V

♦1 if

1—«-

.J

=:nr+--~
F=2ru

A 4d

mm. mm.

2 ' 2
j mm. B00B

Figure VI-25. Edge distances for lightening holes. All bend radii are at least
min. min.
three times the thickness of the material (St). The dimension d is the diameter of the
8-8
rivet used to attach a member having lightening holes to another. The lip around the
4d
lightening hole should be at least It in height.
min.
~* A—>J A-A
<—A—»»

\,
FIGU1Uil VI-25. Edge distances for lightening holes. All bend radii are at least
ft
three times the thickness of the material (3t). The dimension dis the diameter of the
he—A-
rivet used to attach a member having lightening holes to another. The lip around the
L
lightening hole should be at least 2t in height.
h-A-H

.. V5i

~Al
Figure VI-26. Minimum dimensions required for A = 3d for thicknesses of riveting

_ _U _ _
clearances sections less than .036"; A = Ad for thicknesses between .036" and .081".

------ ------
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE VI- 26. Minimum dimensions required for A = 3d for thicknesses of riveting
clearances sections less than .036"; A = 4d for thicknesses between .036" and .081 ".

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 105
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS

105 Lightening Holes


In a sense this is a misnomer, for the decrease in weight due to removal
Lightening Holes

In a sense this is a misnomer, for the decrease in weight due to removal

of material is secondary. The primary purpose of a lightening hole is


of material is secondary. The primary purpose of a lightening hole is
either (1) to increase the in-plane stability by means of the raised Up

around the hole, or (2) to provide a passageway for control systems, wir-
either (1) to increase the in-plane stability by means of the raised lip
ing, tubing, and the like, or (3) to provide an access to another portion
around the hole, or (2) to provide a passageway for control systems, wir-
of an interior.

ing, tubing, and the like, or (3) to provide an access to another portion
of an interior.
Ridges called beads or beading are used to increase the rigidity of an

otherwise flat plate.

Beading
Stiffeners

Small, relatively short-length angles may be attached to an otherwise

large flat sheet to increase its shear carrying ability and to reduce or
Ridges called beads or beading are used to increase the rigidity of an
eliminate any tin-canning tendencies.

Figube VI-28. Detail showing interconnection of a stiffener or any transverse


otherwise fiat plate.
member and a heavier structural member. The section could represent the chord

member of a tension field spar or a heavy beam in a fuselage, with the stiffener
Stiffeners
corresponding to a transverse frame.
Small, relatively short-length angles may be attached to an otherwise
Beading

min. min.
large fiat sheet to increase its shear carrying ability and to reduce or
Figure VI-27. Recommended edge distances for bolts.
eliminate any tin-canning tendencies.

Bend or
corner radius
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FIGURE VI-27. Recommended edge distances for bolts.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

LA-A Offset
stiffener

FIGURE Vl-28. Detail showing interconnection of a stiffener or any transverse


member and a heavier structural member. The section could represent the chord
member of a tension field spar or a heavy beam in a fuselage, with the stiffener
corresponding t-0 a transverse frame.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
106 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
106 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table VI-2. Typical mechanical properties of wrought aluminum alloys.


TABLE Vl-2. Typical mechanical properties of wrought aluminum alloys.
Tension

Hardness

Shear Tension Hardness Shear Fatigue


Fatigue

Alloy
Elongation
and
Alloy Yield per cent in 2 in. BrineII, Endur-
temper
and strength Ultimate 500-kg, Shearing
temper ance
Yield

(set strength, Sheet Round load strength, limit,


strength

0.23), lb/in.1 specimen specimen 10-mm lb/in.1 lb/in.1


Elongation

lb/in.2 (~in. 01in. ball


per cent in 2 in.

thick) diam.)
Brinell,

500-kg,

28-0 5,000 13,000 35 45 23 9,500 5,000


Endur-

2S-%H 13,000 15,000 12 25 28 rn,ooo 6,000


28-YzH 14,000 17,000
Ultimate

strength,
9 20 32 11,000 7,000
lb/in.»
2S-%H 17,000 20,000 6 17 38 12,000 8,500
Shearing
28-H 21,000 24,000 5 15 44 13,000 8,500
strength,

lb/in.»
38-0 6,000 16,000 30 40 28 11,000 7,000
(set
3S-%H 15,000 18,000 10 20 35 12,000 8,000
0.2%),
38-YzH 18,000 21,000 8 16 40 14,000 9,000
lb/in.1 3S-%H 21,000 25,000 5 14 47 15,000 9,500
Sheet 38-H 25,000 29,000 4 10 55 16,000 10,000
specimen

Round

248-0 11,000 27,000 19 22 42 18,000 12,000


specimen

248-T 46,000 68,000 19 22 120 41,000 18,000


load

10-mm
248-RT 57,000 73,000 13 - 130 42,000 -
ance

Alclad 248-T 43,000 64,000 18 - - 40,000 -


limit,

lb/in.J
Alclad 248-RT 53,000 67,000 11 - - 41,000 -
(X in.

528-0 14,000 29,000 25 30 45 18,000 17,000


12 18 62 20,000 17,500
thick)

52S-%H 26,000 34,000


21,000 18,000
(H in.

528-YzH 29,000 37,000 10 14 67


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:45 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

diam.)

ball
52S-%H 34,000 39,000 8 10 74 23,000 18,500
528-H 36,000 41,000 7 8 85 24,000 19,000
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2S-0

5,000

13,000 618-0 8,000 18,000 22 30 30 12,500 9,000


14,000 618-W 21,000 35,000 22 25 65 24,000 13,500
17,000
618-T 40,000 45,000 12 17 95 30,000 13,500
21,000

13,000

758-0
758-T
15,000
72,000
33,000
82,000
17
11
11
10
-
150
- -
15,000

47,000 22,500
17,000

Alclad 758-0 14,000 32,000 17 - - - -


20,000

24,000
Alclad 758-T 67,000 76,000 11 - - 46,000 -
35

12

45

25

20

17

15

23

28

32

38

44

Original from
9,500

10,000
D191 iz by
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
11,000

12,000

13,000
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:45 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

TABLE VI-3. Mechanical properties of alloy steels.

Normal- Normal- Near Normal-


c ized ized welding ized Heat- Heat- Heat- Heat-
plate plate when tubes treated treated treated treated
Tube and Tube and \\elded .188" to t-0 to to ti
Condition bar over bar .188" after heat thick and F,. = F,. = F,. • F, ... ~

~
.188"
thick
thick and
under
treatment under
(X-4130) (X-4130)
100,000
psi
125,000
psi
150,000
psi
180,000
psi ~
() Special t::
l
(X-4130) (X-4130) Special
-
I SAE I X-4130 I X-4130 X-4130 I X-4130 ti
0
F,. Ultimate stress, psi 84,000 100,000 100,000 125,000 150,000 180,000 ~
& 90,000 96,000

- Ten- Yield stress, psi 70,000 75,000 85,000 80,000 100,000 135,000 165,000 ......
Fir ~
sion F1p Proportional limit, psi 50,000 70,000 90,000 115,000 140,000 ~
~ E Modulus of elasticity, psi 29,000,000 29.!.000.!.~ 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000

~
F,. Ultimate (block) stress, psi 90,000 95,000 76,600 100,000 100,000 125,000 150,000 180,000
Cum- Fer Yidd stress, psi 70,000 75,000 85,000 100,000 135,000 165,000
pres- fi'cp Proportional limit, psi 50,000 70,000 90,000 115,000 140,000 ......
Column yield stress, psi 74,100 79,500 90,100 100,000 135,000 165,000
~
sion F.. 80,000
c= E, Modulus of elasticity, psi 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 29,000,000 129,000,000 29,000,000
:z ~
F.,. Ultimate stress, psi 55,000 55,000 52,500 58,000 65,000 75,000 90,000 105,000 ::i..
<
rn F,, Torsional modulus of "'-3
:x>O rupture, psi 80,000 80,000 73,500 84,000 90,000 110,000 125,000 145,000 ......
~-- Shear P,,. Proportional limit
c
:<'9 (torsion), psi 40,000 40,000 55,000 65,000 80,000 95,000 ~
o~ G Modulus of rigidity
:ca
"T'1 -

g3 Bear- F.,
(torsion),
Ultimate stress,
psi 11 ,000,000 11 ,000,000 11,000,000 11 ,000,000 11,000,000 11 ,000,000 l l ,_Q9(>,000 11 ,000,000
psi 140,000 140,000 130,000 147,000 14-0,000 l 7!>,000 190,000 200,000
ing
~ w Specific weight, 0.28.13 lb/ cu in. 490 lb/ cu ft
z .....
~
Heat-t00ated by user

Bare 200O sheet and slate

800,000

3O000

38,000

5O000

38,000

5O000

3.000

2.0000-

8O000

3O000

Oecond

Primar

3O000

58,000

Oecond

Primar•

3O000

58,000

<.0

36,000

3O000

38,000

9O000

38,000

9O000

0.2009

0.0 -

93,000

3O000

38,000

92,000

38,000

92,000

0.0099

0.250-

00,000

3O000

i0 0 K00r

3O000

00,000

00.000

0.000-

8O000

3O000

i 0 0 p7000 0 00000

3O000 3O000

00,000 1 58,000

00000

3O000

58,000

2.000

00.0000-

Heat-treated by user

Clad 200O sheet and slate

0.0000 lb/cu in. 0073 lb/cu ft

8O000

00,000

36.. 93600,0000 0 000,000,000 >-

3O000

5O000

i. 9,000,000000 0 000,000,000 »

3O000

5O000

3.000

2.0000-

Table V00-00. Mechanical Ooserties of aluminum alloy.


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:45 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

......
0
00
t.""J
6;:;.·
TABLE Vl-4. Mechanical properties of aluminum alloy.
~

CT Bare 24S sheet and plate Clad 248 sheet and plate
Heat-treated by user Heat-treated by user

I ~
0.250- I o.501- 1.001- 2.001- 0.064- 0.250-1 0.500- 11.001-
I I 2.001- .......
~
Thickness, in. I <0.250 0.500 1.000 2.000 3.000 <.064 0.249 0.499 1.000 2.000 3.000
~
i

~
Ten-
I F,.
F1
I Yield
l:IHmate '""""·
stress,
psi 62,000 64,000 162,000 160,000 156,000.158,000 61,000162,000 60,000 58,000 / 54,000
psi 40,000 38,000 i 38,000 38,000 I 38,000 37,000 38,000 I 38,000 36,000 36,000 l 36,000 ~
11
~
sion IE Modulus of elasticity, psi 10,500,000 Primary 10,500,000- •
I
I I Secondary 9,500,000 +---- 10,000,000--~ t::i

Com-
F <u
F, 11
I U!timate (block) stress,
: Yield stress,
I
psi 62,000 164,000 62,000 160,000 156·~, 58,000 161,000 162,000 160,000 158,000 154,000
psi 40,000 38,000 ! 38,000 38,000 38,000 37,000 38,000 381000 361000 36,000 36,000 ~
~
c::
:z
pres- E, i Modulus of elasticity, psi 10,700,000 Primary ~ 10,700,000 .,_ ~
sion Secondary 9,700,000+- 10,200,000 ""
<
590
............
F... I Ultimate stress,
Shear G Modulus of rigidity
i
psi 37,000 138,000 37,000 136,000 134,000 35,000 137 ,000 37,000 136,000 35,000 32,000
~
- t i.O' (torsion), ~
psi 4,000,000
-< :;·
or:.i Bear- ~
11:::::;:: ing F"' Ultimate stress, I psi 93,000 96,000 193,000 00,000 Is.,ooo 187,ooo 92,000 93,000 / oo,ooo 187,000 81,000 ~
~a I I
r. 3 w I Specific weight., 0.100 lb/cu in. 173 lb/cu ft ~ 0.100 lb/cu in. 173 lb/cu ft
::::r::
~ I Nominal chemical composition 4.2% Cu, 1.5% Mg, 0.6% Mn
:z For more specific values for other aluminum alloys, consult Strength of Metal Aircraft Elements, published by U. S. Government
Printing Office, Washington 25, D. C.
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 109
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 109

Table VI-5. Shear and tensile strengths of steel rivets, bolts and pins.
TABLE Vl-5. Shear and tensile strengths of steel rivets, bolts and pins.
Low

Heat-treated steel

Material
Low Heat-treated steel
carbon
Material carbon
Tensile strength, kips per
steel Standard AN bolts
steel

Standard AN bolts
Tensile strength, kips per
sq. in.
sq. in. 55 100 125 125
55 Shear strength, kips per
100 sq. in. 35 65 75 75
125

125 AN Std. bolt Diameter


Shear strength, kips per designation of rivet, Allowable single shear strength, Tension, lb
sq. in.
bolt or pin, in pounds (in thread)
35
in inches
65

75

- !{& 107 199 230 -


75

- ~ 242 449 518 -


AN Std. bolt

- .112 345 640 739 -


Diameter

- YB 430 798 920 -


designation

- .138 523 972 1,122 -


-
of rivet,

Allowable single shear strength,


- ~ 671 1,247 1,438
- .164 739 1,372 1,584 -
-
Tension, lb

bolt or pin,
- % 966 1,794 2,070
in pounds
AN-3 .190 992 1,842 2,126 2,210
(in thread)
- .216 1,282 2,381 2,748 -
in inches
- ~ 1,315 2,442 2,818 -
—
AN-4 ~ 1,717 3,190 3,680 4,080
He
AN-5 ~6 2,684 4,984 5,750 6,500
107 AN-6 % 3,868 7,183 8,280 10,100
199 AN-7 U6 5,261 9,770 11,250 13,600
230
AN-8 ~ 6,871 12,760 14,700 18,500
—
AN-9 ~6 8,697 16,152 18,700 23,600
%
AN-10 % 10,738 19,942 23,000 30,100
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

242

AN-12 % 15,463 28,717 33,150 44,000


449

AN-14 Ys 21,046 39,085 45,050 60,000


AN-16 1 27,489 51,051 58,900 80,700
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

518

—

AN-18 I YB - - 73,750 101,800


—

AN-20 1~ - - 91,050 130,200


.112

345

640

739

—

—

430

798

920

—

—

.138

523

972

1,122

—

—

671

1,247

1,438

—

Original from
—

Dig iz b
.164
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
739

1,372

1,584
110 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

TABLE VI-6.

Allowable shear strength, F,. = 30,000 psi

Diameter of r ivet or
pin in inches l1e ~ ~ ~ % x U& %
Single shear strength,
lb. 106 217 388 596 862 1,550 2,460 3,510
Double shear
strength, I b. 212 434 776 1,192 1,724 3,100 4,920 7,020

Allowable bearing strength (lb), F-,,. = 90,000 psi

Sheet thickness, Diameter of rivet or pin, in inches


in inches
J1& ~ ~ ~ % x % %
.014 78
.016 90
.Ql8 101 151
.020 112 168
.025 140 210 281
.032 180 269 360 449
.036 202 303 405 506 607
.040 225 337 450 562 675
.045 253 379 506 632 759
.051 286 430 573 716 860 1,147
.064 360 539 720 899 1,080 1,440 1,800
.072 405 607 810 1,012 1,215 1,620 2,025 2,430
.081 455 683 910 1,138 1,366 1,822 2,278 2,733
.091 511 767 1,023 1,279 1,535 2,047 2,559 3,071
.102 573 860 1,147 1,434 1,721 2,295 2,868 3,442
.128 720 1,079 1,440 1,799 2,160 2,880 3,600 4,320
~ 878 1,317 1,757 2,195 2,635 3,514 4,393 5,271
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

U& 1,054 1,581 2,109 2,635 3,164 4,218 5,273 6,328


x 1,406 2,108 2,812 3,514 4,218 5,625 7,031 8,437
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

For other values of F..,, multiply by ratio of F,./30,000. For other values of F br,
multiply by ratio of F-,,./ 90,000. For more specific values, consult the latest issue of
Strength of Metal Aircraft Elements.

TABLE VI-7. Bend radii for metal sheet.

Thickness, t Aluminum Mag.


I
in inches Alloy Alloy Steel

.016-.032 3t to St 2t to lOt lt to 4t
.040- .064 2t to 6t 2t to Bt lt to 4t
.072-.125 2t to 3t 2t to 7t lt to 4t

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 111
DETAIL DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 111

Table VI-8. Properties of round tubing.


TABLE VI-8. Properties of round tubing.
Out^

Weight,

Out- Weight,
side

side Wall Radius Weight, pounds


Wall

di- thick- Cross- of Moment Section pounds 100


Radius
ame- ness sectional gyra- of inertia, modulus D/t 100 inches,
Weight,
ter m area, ti on, I, in' I /r, in• ratio inches, alumi-
pounds in inches sq. in. inches steel num
di- inches alloy
thick-
---- - - - ------
Cross- ~ .022 .01576 .0810 .000103 .000825 11.:38 .45 .16
of
.028 .01953 .0791 .000122 .000978 8.93 .55 .20
Moment
Ys .028 .03053 .1231 .000462 .002466 13.39 .86 .31
.035 .03739 .1208 .000546 .002912 10.72 1.06 .38
.049
Section

.05018 .1166 .000682 .003636 7.65 1.43 .51


Y2 .028 .04152 .1672 .001160 .004641 17.85 1.17 .42
pounds

100

.035 .05113 .1649 .001390 .005559 14.28 1.45 .52


ame-

.049 .06943 .1604 .001786 .007144 10.20 1.96 .70


ness

% .028 .05252 .21rn .002345 .007503 22.30 1.49 .54


sectional

.035 .06487 .2090 .002833 .()()CJ005 17.85 1.84 .66


gyra-
.049 .08867 .2044 .003704 .011852 12.77 2.51 .90
of inertia,
.058 .10.331 .2016 .004195 .OJ:H25 10.79 2.93 l.05
modulus
~ .028 .06.351 .2555 .004145 .011052 26.80 1.80 .65
D/t .035 .07862 .25.31 .005036 .01:3429 21.42 2.2.3 .80
100
.049 .10791 .2485 .006661 .017762 15.30 3 .06 1.09
inches,
.058 .12609 .2455 .007601 .02027 12.94 3.57 1.28
ter
.065 .13988 .2433 .008278 .02208 11 .53 3.96 l.42
in
Ya .028 .07451 .2996 .006689 .015289 31 .2:3 2.11 .76
.035 .09236 .2973 .008161 .01865:3 25.00 2.62 .!}4
area,

.049 .12715 .2925 .010882 .02487 17.85 :mo J.2H


tion,

.058 .14887 .2896 .012484 .02853 15.10 4.22 1.51


/, tn»

.065 .16541 .2865 .013653 .O:ll21 13.47 4.66 l.68


I/r, in'

1 .035 .10611 .3414 .012368 .02474 28.56 3.01 1.07


ratio

.049 .14640 .3367 .016594 .m:llU 20.40 4.15 l.48


inches,

.058 .17164 .3337 .019111 .O:i822 17.25 4.86 J.74


steel
.065 .19093 .3314 .020970 .04lH:l 15.:l8 5.41 l.93
alumi-
lYs .035 .11985 .3856 .01782 .Dal68 32.10 3.40 J.21
in .049 .16564 .3808 .02402 .04270 22.95 4.68 1.68
.058 .19442 .3780 .02775 .049:l:l 19.40 5.51 J.97
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

inches

sq. in.
.065 .21650 .3755 .03052 .05425 17.30 6.14 2.20
l~ .035 .13360 .4297 .02467 .0.3!'48 35.70 3.78 1.35
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

inches

num
.049 .18488 .4250 .Da339 .05342 25.50 5.23 l.87
.058 .2172 .4219 .03867 .06187 21.55 6.15 2.20
.065
inches

.2420 .4196 .04260 .06816 rn.22 6.86 2.45


l Ys .035 .1473 .4739 .03:!09 .04814 :m.25 4.17 l.49
alloy

.049 .2041 .4mH .04492 .065:H 28.05 5.78 2.07


.022

.058 .2400 .4661 .0521:3 .0758:3 23.70 6.80 2.43


.01576

.065 .2675 .4638 .05753 .OS:l67 21.15 7.58 2.70


.0810

131 .035 .1611 .5181 .04324 .05765 42.80 4.56 1.63


.000103
.049 .2234 .5132 .0.5885 .07847 .:~060 6.32 2.26
.000825
.058 .2628 .5102 .06841 .09121 25.85 7.45 2.66
11.38 .065 .2!130 .5079 .07558 .1007!) 23.05 8.30 2.97
.45
.083 .3695 .5018 .OU305 .12407 18.08 10.47 :3.74
.16
1% .035 .1748 .5622 .05528 .06803 46.40 4.95 1.77
.028
.049 .2426 .55(5 .07540 .0927!1 33.15 6.87 2.46
.01953
.058 .2855 .5544 .08776 .10801 28.00 8 .09 2.8!1
.0791
.065 .3186 .5520 .OH707 .11948 25.00 !}.05 3.2:l
.083 .4021 ..545!) .1 rn85 .14751 19.58 11.40 4.06
.035 .1885 .6065 .06936 .07927 50.00 5 .32
.000122

1% l.91
.000978

.049 .2618 .6017 .09478 .10832 35.70 7.42 2.65


8.93

.058 .3063 .5986 .11046 .12624 :30.20 8.n 3.12


.55

.065 .3441 .5U62 .122:30 .1:m11 26.90 9.75 3.48


.20

.083 .4347 .5901 .15136 .17299 21.10 12.32 4.40


H

.028

.03053

.1231

.000462

Original from
.002466

13.39
Di ize b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
.86

.31

.035
112 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
112 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table VI-8. (Continued.) Properties of round tubing.


TABLE VI-8. (Continued.) Properties of round tubing.
Out^

Weight,

Out- Weight,
side

Ride Wall Radius Weight, pounds


Wall

di- thick- Cross- of Moment Section pounds 100


Radius
ame- ncsfl sectional gyra- of inertia, modulus, D/l 100 inches,
Weight,
tcr m area, tion, I, &n• I /r, '"' ratio inche11, alumi-
pounds in inches sq. in. incheM sk-el num
di- inches alloy
thick-

Cross-
I~ .035 .2023 .6507 .08565 .09136 53.60 5.73 2.04
of
.049 .2811 .6458 .11720 .12500 38.25 7.95 2.84
.058 .3311 .6427 .13677 .14589 32.30 9.38 3.35
.6404 .15156 .16166 28.80 10.47 3.74
Moment

.065 .3696
.083 .4673 .6342 .18797 .20050 22.60 13.25 4.73
Section

pounds

2 .049 .3003 .6900 .14299 .14299 40.80 8.50 3.04


100

.058 .3539 .6869 .16696 .16696 34.45 10.03 3.58


ame-

.065 .3951 .6845 .18514 .18514 30.75 11.19 4.00


ness

.083 .4999 .6783 .2300 .2301 24.10 14.16 5.06


sectional
.095 .5685 .6744 .2586 .2586 21.05 16.11 5.76
gyra-
234 .049 .3388 .7783 .2052 .1824 45.90 9.59 3.43
tion, .058 .3994 .7753 .2401 .2l:i4 38.80 11.30 4.05
of inertia, .065 .4462 .7728 .2665 .2369 34.60 12.64 4.52
modulus,
.083 .5651 .7667 .3322 .2953 27.15 16.01 5.72
D/t
.095 .6432 .7626 .3741 .3325 23.70 18.22 6.51
100
272 .049 .3773 .8667 .2834 .2267 51.00 10.68 3.82
.058 .4450 .8635 .3318 .2655 43.10 12.60 4.50
.3688 .2950 38.45 14.09 5.03
inches,

.065 .4972 .8613


ter

.083 .6302 .8550 .4607 .3686 ::m.10 17.85 6.38


in

.095 .7178 .8509 .5197 .4158 26.:m 20.34 7.27


area,

2% .049 .4158 .9551 .3793 .2759 56.10 11.78 4.20


/, in'

.058 .4905 .9521 .4446 .3233 47.40 13.90 4.96


I/r, ,'„•

.065 .5483 .9496 .4944 .3596 42.30 15.50 5.55


ratio
.083 .6954 .94:H .6189 .4501 33.15 19.70 7.04
inches,
.095 .7924 .9393 .6991 .5084 28.95 22.48 8.03
alumi- 3 .058 .5361 1.0403 .5802 .3868 51.70 15.18 5.42
in .005 .5993 l.o:J80 .6457 .4305 46.20 16.95 6.06
inches
.083 .7606 1.0318 .8097 .5.398 36.15 21.55 7.70
.(J'J5 .8670 1.0276 .9156 .6104 31.58 24.56 8.78
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

sq. in.

inches
.120 1.0857 1.0191 1.1276 .7518 25.00 30.76 11 .00
334 .058 .5816 1.1287 .7410 .4560 56.10 16.47 5.89
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

.5077 50.00 18.40 6.58


steel

.065 .6504 1.1263 .8251


.OS:~ .8258 1.1201 1.0361 .6376 39.15 23.38 8.35
num

inches

.005 .!l416 1.1160 1.1727 .7217 34.20 26.66 9.52


alloy

.120 1.1800 1.1074 1.4472 .8906 27.10 33.43 11.95


VA

3 72 .065 .7014 1.2147 1.0349 .5914 53.80 19.85 7.09


.035

.OS:~ .8910 1.2085 1.3012 .7435 42.20 25.20 9.01


.2023
.095 1.0162 1.2043 1.4739 .8422 36.85 28.70 10.25
.6507
.120 1.2742 1.1958 1.8220 1.0411 29.15 36.00 12.89
.08565
3% .065 .7525 1.3031 1.2777 68.14 57.60 21.30 7.60
.09136
.083 .9562 1.296~ 1.6080 .8576 45.20 27 06 9.67
53.60
.O!t5 1.0908 1.292 1.8228 .9722 39.50 30.84 11.04
5.73
.120 1.3685 1.2841 2.2565 1.2035 31.25 38.70 13.82
2.04
4 .065 .8035 1.3915 1.5557 .7779 61 .50 22.75 8.12
.083 1.0214 1.3852 1.9597 .9799 48.20 28.95 10.32
2.2228 l.1114 42.10 :i2.H5 11.78
.049

.o<J5 1.1655 1.3810


.120 l .4fi27 1.372.5 2.7552 l.~i776 a:t33 41.40 14.80
.2811

.6458

434 .134 l.7a27 1.4557 3.6732 1.7408 31.75 4!UO 17.55


.11720

472 .156 2.1289 1.5:~69 5.0282 2.2347 28.80 60.40 21.55


.12500

38.25
4% .188 2.6944 Ui143 I 7.0213 2.9563 25.25 76.25
--
27.20
- ---- · -
7.95

2.84

.058

.3311

.6427

.13677

.14589

Original from
32.30

9.38
Dig iz UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
3.35

.005

.3696
CHAPTER VII

VII
The Three-View

The three-view of a projected design is composed of the top or plan view,


CHAPTER
the front view or front elevation, and the side view or side elevation. It

corresponds to the photographs that might be taken of the top, front, and

side view of the completed airplane.

After the designer has his set of specifications, he makes a few sketches

The Three-View
of what he believes his final design should look like. It helps bim to visu-

alize arrangements more readily and it forms the basis of his detailed

weight estimate and subsequent balance calculations.

An experienced designer will first make a hasty "thumb-nail" three-

view sketch. It is sufficiently detailed to convey the basic ideas of .the

design and no further three-view is then made until the design has been

almost completely decided upon as to dimensions, correlation of wing,

engine, landing gear, and tail surfaces.

However, even the experienced designer usually finds it desirable to

make several three-views—each one more accurate than its predecessor.

The three-view of a projected design is composed of the top or plan view,


the front view or front elevation, and the side view or side elevation. It \~
The "thumb-nail" sketch is excellent to determine the type, to initiate

the design, and to record particular features of exceptional nature that the

designer has in mind. However, the first design on which such work as
corresponds to the photographs that might be taken of the top, front, and
the weight estimate and balance diagram can be based is the preliminary

three-view.
side view of the completed airplane.
Unless the airplane is radical in design—departs wholly from conven-
After the designer has his set of specifications, he makes a few sketches
tional design—the data obtained from existing airplanes are the best

of what he believes his final design should look like. It helps him to visu-
alize arrangements more readily and it forms the basis of his detailed
guides in proportioning the new project, and the new or uninitiated de-

signer should avoid "radical" or new designs until he has first worked

through a conventional design. The fundamental principles of airplane


weight estimate and subsequent balance calculations.
design always hold, and there is no better way to understand them than by

working through conventional designs. "Radical" designs are usually


An experienced designer will first make a hasty "thumb-nail" three- ' ,
"radical" because they disregard fundamental principles with the result
view sketch. It is sufficiently detailed to convey the basic ideas of .the
that the designer will eventually be disappointed.

design and no further three-view is then made until the design has been
almost completely decided upon as to dimensions, correlation of wing,
The outline which follows shows how standard data on existing airplanes

113

engine, landing gear, and tail surfaces.


However, even the experienced designer usually finds it desirable to
make several three-views--each one more accurate than its predecessor.
The "thumb-nail" sketch is excellent to determine the type, to initiate
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the design, and to record particular features of exceptional nature that the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

designer has in mind. However, the first design on which such work as
the weight estimate and balance diagram can be based is the preliminary
three-view.
Unless the airplane is radical in design-departs wholly from conven-
tional design-the data obtained from existing airplanes are the best
guides in proportioning the new project, and the new or uninitiated de-
signer should avoid "radical" or new designs until he has first worked
through a conventional design. The fundamental principles of airplane
design always hold, and there is no better way to understand them than by
working through conventional designs. "Radical" designs are usually
"radical" because they disregard fundamental principles with the result
that the designer will eventually be disappointed.
The outline which follows shows how standard data on existing airplanes
113

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
114 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
114

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

£

Figure VII-1. This illustrates how certain available data may be assembled in prep-

<D
aration for the initial three-view. A represents the over-all length required for the

propeller hub, engine, engine accessories, etc., with sufficient clearance allowed for the
---+- -
removal of the rearmost accessory; B the distance allowed for the pilot's cabin; C

the length of the cabin of about 30 (AT + 1) inches, where N represents the number of

rows of seats athwartship, and 30 inches the distance allowed between rows; D, equal

to about one-third over-all length, is the approximate location of the center of gravity

of the complete airplane in rear of the nose; E is equal to 2.5 to 3.0 times the mean

0 £

I:
geometric chord length of the wing; F is allowance for desired headroom in cabin; G is

allowance for depth of the front-wing spar; L is the over-all length of the fuselage with

an engine located in its nose.


L
may be made of use in laying down the preliminary three-view. (See

Figure VII-1.)
FmuRE VII-1. This illustrates how certain available data may be assembled in prep-
In making a preliminary three-view, some knowledge of the installation
aration for the initial three-view. A represents the over-all length required for the
requirements of the power plant, cockpit and cabin is necessary. The propeller hub, engine, engine accessories, etc., with sufficient clearance allowed for the
removal of the rearmost accessory; B the distance allowed for the pilot's cabin; C
+
chapters on these subjects should be carefully studied before going too far

with the preliminary sketch, and chapters on wing design, landing gear,
the length of the cabin of a.bout 30 (N 1) inches, where N represents the number of
power plants, and other parts should be referred to by the student.
rows of sea.ts athwartship, and 30 inches the distance allowed between rows; D, equal
The information necessary to draw up the first three-view can be as-
to a.bout one-third over-all length, is the approximate location of the center of gravity
sembled easily, provided the specifications for the airplane have been given
of the complete airplane in rear of the nose; E is equal to 2.5 to 3.0 times the mean ~
and a study of existing airplanes which seem to meet the specifications is

geometric chord length of the wing; F is allowance for desired headroom in cabin; G is
made. From the information at hand, and a knowledge of the engine

Allowance for depth of the front-wing spar; Lis the over-all length of the fuselage with
specifications, it is usually simple to proceed along the following lines.

an engine located in its nose.


Table VII-1 presents important data to aid in drawing up the three-view.

Step 1. Estimation of Gross Weight.

may be made of use in laying down the preliminary three-view. (See


The gross weight may be estimated in one of several ways:

(a) A first guess of the probable gross weight may be made, if the type
Figure VIl-1.)
and number of engines are specified, from the engine power P which, mul- In making a preliminary three-view, some knowledge of the installation
STEPS IN ASSEMBLING PRELIMINARY DATA

requirements of the power plant, cockpit and cabin is necessary. The


FOR THREE-VIEW

chapters on these subjects should be carefully studied before going too far
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

with the preliminary sketch, and chapters on wing design, landing gear,
power plants, and other parts should be referred to by the student.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

STEPS IN ASSEMBLING PRELIMINARY DATA


FOR THREE-VIEW
The information necessary to draw up the first three-view can be as-
sembled easily, provided the specifications for the airplane have been given
and a study of existing airplanes which seem to meet the specifications is
made. From the information at hand, and a knowledge of the engine
specifications, it is usually simple to proceed along the following lines.
Table VIl- 1 presents important data to aid in drawing up the three-view.

Step 1. Estimation of Gross Weight.


The gross weight may be estimated in one of several ways:
(a) A first guess of the probable gross weight may be made, if the type
and number of engines are specified, from the engine power P which, mul-

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE THREE-VIEW 115
THE THREE-VIEW

115

TABLE VII-I. Empirical data.


Table VII-1. Empirical data.

Wing Data

Wing Data
Area S, sq ft

Aspect ratio, R
Area S, sq ft ································································------ ----···-··························-··················-----
Span 6, ft Aspect ratio, R ............................................................................................................................
Root chord Cr, ft

Span b, ft ·············-···-···········-··--··············---------··················--------------··········································-··
Root chord CR, ft ........................................................................................................................
Tip chord Cr, ft_- —

Root airfoil

Tip airfoil
Tip chord CT, ft·-·· ···················································································································--·
Mean geometric chord, MGC ft
Root airfoil ..................................................................................................................................
Tip airfoil ·--·····································-·····························----·-··-·····-···-···········································
Location of 25% of MGC projected on root chord, ft

Aileron area S„, sq ft

Aileron span &«, ft.


Mean geometric chord, MGC ft ·························································-······································
Aileron chord C, ft
Location of 253 of MGC projected on root chord, ft ..........................................................
Flap area S/„ sq ft

Aileron area S,., sq ft ······································································--··········································


Flap span, b/„ ft

Flap chord C/„ ft


Aileron span b,., ft ···-···················································································································
Aileron area to wing area Sa/S %
Aileron chord C,., ft ....................................................................................................................
Flap area to wing area S/,/S % Flap area. 81 ,, sq ft ......................................................................................................................
General dimensions (in feet or in inches)

Flap spa.n, b1 ,, ft ........................................................................................................................


Flap chord C1 ,, ft ........................................................................................................................
Over-all span 6 -

Over-all dimensions

Over-all height to over-all span* H/b


Aileron area. to wing area S,./S ............................................................................................ 3
Wheel tread to over-all span* T/b
Flap area. to wing area S1 ,/S .............................................................................................. %
Over-all length to over-all span* L/b

General dimensions (in feet or in inches) ---·--··················--·-····················-···-·······················


Over-all height H ~

Wheel tread, T
Over-all span b .......................................................................................................................... .
Over-all length L
Over-all dimensions ..............................................................................................................................
Distance between center of gravity and tail post
Over-all height to over-all span• H /b ....................................................................................
Tail Surfaces

Wheel tread to over-all span• T /b ..........................................................................................


Vertical tail surfaces to wing area,* ST/S , %

Horizontal tail surfaces to wing area,* Sk/S . %


Over-all length to over-all span• L/b ···-·······················································-------·················-·
Fin area to vertical tail surfaces,* S//S,
Over-all height H ........................................................................................................................
Rudder area to vertical tail surfaces,* <Sr/S, %

Elevator area to horizontal tail surfaces,* S,/iS» %


Wheel tread, T ··---···················································································································-·
Over-all length L ....................................................................................................................... .
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Stabilizer area to horizontal tail surfaces,* S,/Si, %

Horizontal tail surface area


Distance between center of gravity and tail post ................................................................. .
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Elevator area <S,

Stabilizer area S,
Tail Surf aces
Aspect ratio of horizontal tail surfaces ft»

Vertical tail surfaces to wing area,• Sv/S ----··················································· ................... 3


Span of horizontal tail surfaces 6»

Chord of horizontal tail surfaces C»


Horizontal tail surfaces to wing area,• S1o/S ·-······························..···························--·····-%
Vertical tail surface area Sv
Fin area to vertical tail surfaces,• Sf/Sv ............................................................................... .
[continued

Rudder area. to vertical tail surfaces,• S,/Sv ---································································· 3


Elevator area to horizontal tail surfaces,• S,/S,. ················································-·············3
* All obtained from averages of these same ratios compiled for existing airplanes of

similar type.

Stabilizer area to horizontal tail surfaces,• S,/S,. --··························································· 3


Horizontal tail surface area s,. ································-------················································..·······
Elevator area S, ........................................................................................................................
Stabilizer area. S, ........................................................................................................................
Aspect ratio of horizontal tail surfaces R,. ............................................................................
Span of horizontal tail surfaces b,. ..........................................................................................
Chord of horizontal tail surfaces C,. ·-----············································ ....................................
Vertical tail surface area Sv ......................................................................................................
[continued
•All obtained from averages of these same ratios compiled for existing airplanes of
similar type.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
116 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
116 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table VII-1. (Continued).


TABLE VIl-1. (qontinued).
Fin area S/

Rudder area Sr

Aspect ratio of vertical tail surfaces, R,


Fin area S 1 --·-·--·---·---·----··--------·--·-··-- -- ·--- --· ·----·-----·-····----- .. ........... ---------------------------------------------
Span of vertical tail surfaces 6„, ft
Rudder area S. ----------------------------------------····--·······--··-··········--·---······----····-----···----------------····--···-
Chord of vertical tail surfaces, C„ ft
Aspect ratio of vertical tail surfaces, Rv ........... ·-·---·--- -------------------------------------------------------····
Angles

Span of vertical tail surfaces bv, ft ________ ........ ..... ___........................_...................................... ..


Landing angle of airplane

Angle in side elevation between vertical through axle and line connecting
Chord of vertical tail surfaces, C., ft---------.. -·--------- ·-- ------------------- -------------·--.. -------------........ _.
center of gravity, and line joining the center of gravity and the point

Angles
of contact with the ground at the outer wheel

Clearances with Ground Landing angle of airplane --------------------------------··-··--··---------------------------------------·--···----------··········


Propeller clearance, in.
Angle; in side elevation between vertical through axle and line connecting
Deflected elevator clearance, in.
center of gravity, and line joining the center of gravity and the point
Deflected flap clearance, in
of contact with the ground at the outer wheel
tiplied by the average of power loading W/P for existing airplanes, will

give the value of the gross weight W. Clearances u.rith Ground


(b) The gross weight of the proposed design may be calculated by de-

termining the disposable load as indicated by the specifications, and using


Propeller clearance, in. -------------------··------------··----------------------------------------------------------------------------
the known average ratios of disposable load to gross weight.
Deflected elevator clearance, in. ------------------------------------------------·- ___ ...................................... ..
(c) A likely value of the gross weight may be arrived at by assembling Deflected flap clearance, in .................................................................................----------------------
sufficient weight data, although this is usually difficult to do because the

three-view and its dimensions are required for such an estimate.

(d) If a design exists which meets the new specifications, then all the

ti plied by the average of power loading W / P for existing airplanes, will


necessary preliminary data may be obtained therefrom so that the subse-

quent steps outlined below become unnecessary.


give the value of the gross weight W.
Step 2. Estimation of Wing Area.
(b) The gross weight of the proposed design may be calculated by de-
(a) The average ratios of wing loading are based upon the gross weight

and the actual wing area, which does not include that covered by the
termining the disposable load as indicated by the specifications, and using
fuselage. the known average ratios of disposable load to gross weight.
The wing area may be determined if the wing loading is assumed from

the ratios calculated for existing airplanes, for:


(c) A likely value of the gross weight may be arrived at by assembling
W
sufficient weight data, although this is usually difficult to do because the
S = WX^

three-view and its dimensions are required for such an estimate.


(d) If a design exists which meets the new specifications, then all the
where S = the wing area, to be found,

W = the gross weight, previously calculated,

necessary preliminary data may be obtained therefrom so that the subse-


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

W . •

-g = the wing loading for airplanes of similar characteristics•

quent steps outlined below become unnecessary.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(b) If the airfoil has been selected so that its characteristics are known,

Step 2. Estimation of Wing Area.


(a) The average ratios of wing loading are based upon the gross weight
and the actual wing area, which does not include that covered by the
fuselage.
The wing area may be determined if the wing loading is assumed from
the ratios calculated for existing airplanes, for:

where S = the wing area, to be found,


W = the gross weight, previously calculated,
~ = the wing loading for airplanes of similar characteristics.

(b) If the airfoil has been selected so that its characteristics are known1

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE THREE-VIEW 117
THE THREE-VIEW

117 and if the landing speed has been either specified or assumed, then the area
and if the landing speed has been either specified or assumed, then the area

of the wing could be calculated by formula:


of the wing could be calculated by formula:

where V = the specified or assumed stalling speed in feet per second;

w
p = 0.002378 at sea level where the maximum density of the air
S= Y2PCL.....v2 '
is usually encountered; otherwise, the density corresponding

to the highest altitude at which landing takes place should

be taken;
where V = the specified or assumed stalling speed in feet per second;
= the maximum lift coefficient for the wing either with or
p = 0.002378 at sea level where the maximum density of the air
without a lift-increase device, depending upon whether the

is usually encountered; otherwise, the density corresponding


to the highest altitude at which landing takes place should
latter is used or not. Lift-increase devices, such as the

flap, are used primarily to reduce the necessary wing area

required to meet the specified landing speed. Chapter


be taken;
XVII, Design of the Wing, should be referred to for informa-

tion on selection of airfoils and more accurate determina-


CL..... = the maximum lift coefficient for the wing either with or
tion of wing area.
without a lift-increase device, depending upon whether the
If different airfoils are used along the span, a weighted average may be

latter is used or not. Lift-increase devices, such as the


flap, are used primarily to reduce the necessary wing area
used unless actual wind-tunnel tests on the particular wing are available.

For airfoil characteristics, refer to pertinent NACA reports.

Step 3. Determining Length of Span.


required to meet the specified landing speed. Chapter
The ratios of dimensions for airplanes are calculated in terms of the

span of the wing since it is a convenient reference dimension and also has
XVII, Design of the Wing, should be referred to for informa-
some justification in the fact that other characteristics such as stability
tion on selection of airfoils and more accurate determina-
and control are functions of the span of the wing.

tion of wing area.


If different airfoils are used along the span, a weighted average may be
In order to determine the span, it is first necessary to decide on the

aspect ratio R. Usually it has a value not less than 6, although aspect

ratios of 14 have been used for special purpose airplanes. Aspect ratios used unless actual wind-tunnel tests on the particular wing are available.
larger than 14 may be usefully employed for gliders.

For airfoil characteristics, refer to pertinent NACA reports.


The aspect ratio of a wing is determined by the formula:

D (span)2 b2.

It = —: = -fj)
Step 3. Determining Length of Span.
wing area b

The ratios of dimensions for airplanes are calculated in terms of the


where the wing area here includes that area of the wing blanketed by the

fuselage, whereas in the calculation of the wing loading W/S, the actual
span of the wing since it is a convenient reference dimension and also has
wing area was used for the value of S. An approximation of the wing area,
some justification in the fact that other characteristics such as stability
blanketed by the fuselage (that blanketed by engine nacelles may usually

and control are functions of the span of the wing.


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

be neglected in these preliminary calculations), may be obtained by as-

suming a likely root chord for the wing and a likely width of the fuselage. In order to determine the span, it is first necessary to decide on the
aspect ratio R. Usually it has a value not less than 6, although aspect
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The area so calculated should be added to the area calculated in Step 2.

Using this total area, the span may be calculated from:

62 = RS or 6 = V~RS. Tr
ratios of 14 have been used for special purpose airplanes. Aspect ratios
larger than 14 may be usefully employed for gliders.
The aspect ratio of a wing is determined by the formula:
'
R = ~span) 2 = b2 ; J--..
wmg area S
where the wing area here includes that area of the wing blanketed by the
fuselage, whereas in the calculation of the wing loading W / S, the actual
wing area was used for the value of S. An approximation of the wing area,
blanketed by the fuselage (that blanketed by engine nacelles may usually
be neglected in these preliminary calculations), may be obtained by as-
suming a likely root chord for the wing and a likely width of the fuselage.
The area so calculated should be added to the area calculated in Step 2.
Using this total area, the span may be calculated from:
b2 = RS or b= VHS.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
118 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
118

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Step 4. Drawing Up the Wing Planform.
Step 4. Drawing Up the Wing Planform.

With the wing area decided upon and the aspect fatio determined, a
With the wing area decided upon and the aspect tatio determined, a
suitable planform may be selected. If the wing is rectangular, the matter
suitable planform may be selected. If the wing is rectangular, the matter
is easy. If the planform is tapered, the tip chord may vary from to

is easy. If the planform is tapered, the tip chord may vary from 72 to
% of the root chord.

When the approximate dimensions of the chord have been determined,


% of the root chord.
then other items relating to the planform may be decided upon, such as
When the approximate dimensions of the chord have been determined,
whether (a) the leading edge should be perpendicular to the longitudinal

plane of symmetry of the airplane, (b) the trailing edge should be per-
then other items relating to the planform may be decided upon, such as
pendicular to the longitudinal plane of symmetry, (c) the front spar (which
whether (a) the leading edge should be perpendicular to the longitudinal
is usually located at constant percentage from the leading edge) should be

plane of symmetry of the airplane, (b) the trailing edge should be per-
pendicular to the longitudinal plane of symmetry, (c) the front spar (which
perpendicular to the longitudinal plane of symmetry, or (d) the locus of

the mean aerodynamic centers should be perpendicular to the longitudinal

plane of symmetry. A study of various planforms is presented in Chap- is usually located at constant percentage from the leading edge) should be
ter XVII, Design of the Wing.

Step 6. Determination of the Mean Aerodynamic Chord.


perpendicular to the longitudinal plane of symmetry, or (d) the locus of
Another useful dimension in proportioning the airplane is the mean
the mean aerodynamic centers should be perpendicular to the longitudinal
aerodynamic chord (MAC) which is determined for each wing planform.

plane of symmetry. A study of various planforms is presented in Chap-


Usually the mean geometric chord (MGC) is used, since it is more easily

calculated. Discussion of these two terms and how the values and loca-
ter XVII, Design of the Wing.
tion of these chords may be obtained will be found in Chapter XVII.

The final center of gravity of the airplane is usually located at about Step 6. Determination of the Mean Aerodynamic Chord.
Another useful dimension in proportioning the airplane is the mean
25 per cent of the MGC. It is desirable, therefore, to know the size and

location of this chord.

Step 6. Determining Length of Airplane. aerodynamic chord (MAC) which is determined for each wing planform.
Once the 25 per cent point of the MGC has been located, it is easy to

locate the tail post of the airplane since it is usually 2Yi to 3 times the
Usually the mean geometric chord (MGC) is used, since it is more easily
length of the MAC behind the quarter point.
calculated. Discussion of these two terms and how the values and loca-
Then, from the average of the ratios of length to span (L/b) for existing
tion of these chords may be obtained will be found in Chapter XVII.
airplanes, the over-all length of the airplane can be found since the span

of the wing was calculated in Step 3. The length of the new design is
The final center of gravity of the airplane is usually located at about
then found from: 25 per cent of the MGC. It is desirable, therefore, to know the size and
Measuring a distance forward from the tail post equal to L, less an allow-

location of this chord.


ance of 1 or 2 feet for the elevator chord, will locate the approximate posi-

Step 6. Determining Length of Airplane.


tion of the nose of the airplane.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

where

L is to be determined,

Once the 25 per cent point of the MGC has been located, it is easy to
locate the tail post of the airplane since it is usually 272 to 3 times the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

b is obtained from Step 3,

L/b is ratio obtained for existing airplanes.

length of the MAC behind the quarter point.


Then, from the average of the ratios of length to span (L/b) for existing
airplanes, the over-all length of the airplane can be found since the span
of the wing was calculated in Step 3. The length of the new design is
then found from:

where L is to be determined,
b is obtained from Step 3,
L/b is ratio obtained for existing airplanes.
Measuring a distance forward from the tail post equal to L, less an allow-
ance of 1 or 2 feet for the elevator chord, will locate the approximate posi-
tion of the nose of the airplane.

Original from
D191 iz by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE THREE-VIEW 119
THE THREE-VIEW

119

Step 7. Locating the Engines.


Step 7. Locating the Engines.
For the purpose of discussion here, a twin-engine design will be con-

For the purpoi;e of discussion here, a twin-engine design will be con-


sidered. The diameter of the propeller to be used for each engine can be
sidered. The diameter of the propeller to be used for each engine can be

found by formula (See Chapter XV, The Propeller). About a two-inch

clearance between the propeller tip and the side of the fuselage should be found by formula (See Chapter XV, The Propeller). About a two-inch
allowed. If the nose of the fuselage is later faired even more, a greater

clearance between the propeller tip and the side of the fuselage should be
clearance will usually result, but this would not be undesirable. The

centerline of each engine would then be located outboard from the side of
allowed. If the nose of the fuselage is later faired even more, a greater
Figure VII-2A. The top view of a three-view drawing of the airplane; 6» and 6„

clearance will usually result, but this would not be undesirable. The
centerline of each engine would then be located outboard from the side of
represent span dimensions of horizontal tail surfaces and ailerons, respectively; other

dimensions that could be shown are length, L, and location of mean aerodynamic

chord, C, and propeller diameter, D.

fuselage, a distance equal to [(D/2) + 2] inches. The fore and aft po-

sition of the propeller is located by taking into consideration that the

propeller plane, and vertical planes intersecting this plane at 5 degrees

ahead or 5 degrees behind at the center of rotation, should not cut through

the fuselage where any personnel is located. Usually, the placement of

the pilot as far forward as possible in the nose of the fuselage will locate

the critical personnel.

Once the propeller has been located, the rest of the engine nacelle can

be sketched in easily.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE VII- 2A. The top view of a three-view drawing of the airplane; bh and b,.
represent span dimensions of horizontal tail surfaces and ailerons, respectively; other
dime11Bions that could be shown are length, L, and location of mean aerodynamic
chord, C, and propeller diameter, D.

fuselage, a distance equal to [(D / 2) + 2] inches. The fore and aft po-
sition of the propeller is located by taking into consideration that the
propeller plane, and vertical planes intersecting this plane at 5 degrees
ahead or 5 degrees behind at the center of rotation, should not cut through
the fuselage where any personnel is located. Usually, the placement of
the pilot as far forward as possible in the nose of the fuselage will locate
the critical personnel.
Once the propeller has been located, the rest of the engine nacelle can
be sketched in easily.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
120 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
120

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

L
L
* Propeller clearance, d

Figure VII-2B. The side view of a three-view drawing of an airplane. L represents

the length of the airplane; d, the propeller clearance. The over-all height of the air-

plane, the distance between front and rear wheels, as well as the angle of incidence of

the root chord, and the position of the mean aerodynamic chord could also be shown

in this view.

Step 8. Planfonn of Horizontal Tail Surfaces.

The hinge line of the horizontal tail surfaces is usually located close to

the tail post. The approximate area of the horizontal tail surfaces may

be determined from the average ratios of horizontal tail surface area to

wing area (that is, Sh/S) and since the wing area has already been deter-

mined, the horizontal tail surface area can be calculated. Reference to

Chapter XIX, Tail Surfaces, will indicate the necessary procedure in


tPropeller clearonc~_ d
FIGt:RE VII-2B. The side view of a three-view drawing of an airplane. L represents
laying out a desirable planform.

Step 9. Completing the Top View.

The top view of the airplane can be completed by sketching in the miss-
the length of the airplane; d, the propeller clearance. The over-all height of the air-
ing lines. The width and length of that portion of the fuselage containing
plane, the distance between front and rear wheels, as well as the angle of incidence of
personnel can be obtained from consideration of the data given for seating
the root chord, and the position of the mean aerodynamic chord could also be shown
in Chapters X and XII, The Cockpit and The Passenger Cabin.
in this view.
Figure VII-2C. The front view of a three-view drawing of an airplane. A represents

the span; B, the wheel tread; C, the dihedral angle. The dihedral angle of the tail
Step 8. Planform of Horizontal Tail Surfaces.
surfaces and the propeller diameter could also be indicated in this drawing.

A
The hinge line of the horizontal tail surfaces is usually located close to
B
the tail post. The approximate area of the horizontal tail surfaces may
be determined from the average ratios of horizontal tail surface area to
wing area (that is, S,./S) and since the wing area has already been deter-
mined, the horizontal tail surface area can be calculated. Reference to
Chapter XIX, Tail Surfaces, will indicate the necessary procedure in
layin,g out a desirable planform.
Step 9. Completing the Top View.
The top view of the airplane can be completed by sketching in the miss-
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ing lines. The width and length of that portion of the fuselage containing
personnel can be obtained from consideration of the data given for seating
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

in Chapters X and XII, The Cockpit and The Passenger Cabin.


A

--

- - - 8 - -....
FIGURE VIl- 2C. The front view of a three-view drawing of an airplane. A represents
the span; B, the wheel tread; C, the dihedral angle. The dihedral angle of the tail
surfaces and the propeller diameter could also be indicated in this drawing.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE THREE-VIEW 121
THE THREE-VIEW

121

Step 10. Completing the Side View.

The top view furnishes the necessary information as far as lengths are
Step 10. Completing the Side View.
concerned. The depth of the fuselage is determined from consideration
The top view furnishes the necessary information as far as lengths are
of personnel requirements. The depth of the engine nacelles is dependent

on the dimensions of the side view of the engine used.


concerned. The depth of the fuselage is determined from consideration
The wheels are chosen on the basis of the static load placed on them,
of personnel requirements. The depth of the engine nacelles is dependent
and their placement in relation to the fuselage and the wing can be ob-

on the dimensions of the side view of the engine used.


The wheels are chosen on the basis of the static load placed on them,
tained according to the design considerations given in Chapter XVIII,

The Landing Gear.

Step 11. Completing the Front View.


and their placement in relation to the fuselage and the wing can be ob-
Most of the essential dimensions are now determined so that the front

view is easily completed.


tained according to the design considerations given in Chapter XVIII,
GENERAL NOTES FOR THREE-VIEW
The Landing Gear.
The propeller should have a minimum ground clearance of 9 inches

when the airplane is in the horizontal or level landing position with the
Step 11. Completing the Front View.
shock absorbers and tires deflected as they would be under the normal

gross weight of the airplane. For all normal considerations, the shock
Most of the essential dimensions are now determined so that the front
absorber may be assumed to be deflected about two-thirds of its normal
view is easily completed.
travel and the tires about one-quarter of their normal travel. Proper

allowance must be made for the configuration of the landing gear when

the members are so disposed that the deflection of the shock absorber may
GENERAL NOTES FOR THREE-VIEW
cause a greater deflection of the landing gear. Generally, it is not wise

to allow more than 9 inches of clearance for the propeller since this will
The propeller should have a minimum ground clearance of 9 inches
tend to increase the length of the landing-gear members and thereby
when the airplane is in the horizontal or level landing position with the
increase the weight of the landing-gear structure.

shock absorbers and tires deflected as they would be under the normal
gross weight of the airplane. For all normal considerations, the shock
Propellers on seaplanes should clear the water by at least 18 inches

when the seaplane is at rest.

A clearance of at least two inches between the tips of propellers or any


absorber may be assumed to be deflected about two-thirds of its normal
part of the structure should be allowed also.

The elevators should clear the ground by at least 2 or 3 inches when the
travel and the tires about one-quarter of their normal travel. Proper
airplane is in the three-point landing position or at rest.
allowance must be made for the configuration of the landing gear when
For the location of the various parts such as the wing, tail surfaces and

the members are so disposed that the deflection of the shock absorber may
cause a greater deflection of the landing gear. Generally, it is not wise
landing gear, which are placed in relation to the center of gravity, it is

desirable to assume the center of gravity location. For a low-wing mono-

plane, the center of gravity is from 2 to 6 inches below the thrust line; for to allow more than 9 inches of clearance for the propeller since this will
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

a high-wing monoplane, it is about 2 to 4 inches above the thrust line for

airplanes up to about 20,000 pounds gross weight. In lieu of more accu-


tend to increase the length of the landing-gear members and thereby
increase the weight of the landing-gear structure.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

rate information obtained from a balance diagram, such a location is suffi-

ciently accurate to assume for the purposes to be served by the preliminary

Propellers on seaplanes should clear the water by at least 18 inches


three-view.

when the seaplane is at rest.


A clearance of at least two inches between the tips of propellers or any
part of the structure should be allowed also.
The elevators should clear the ground by at least 2 or 3 inches when the
airplane is in the three-point landing position or at rest.
For the location of the various parts such as the wing, tail surfaces and
landing gear, which are placed in relation to the center of gravity, it is
desirable to assume the center of gravity location. For a low-wing mono-
plane, the center of gravity is from 2 to 6 inches below the thrust line; for
a high-wing monoplane, it is about 2 to 4 inches above the thrust line for
airplanes up to about 20,000 pounds gross weight. In lieu of more accu-
rate information obtained from a balance diagram, such a location is suffi-
ciently accurate to assume for the purposes to be served by the preliminary
three-view.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
122 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
122

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


ENGINEERING STUDIES
ENGINEERING STUDIES

While the thumb-nail, three-view sketch will convey the type of air-
While the thumb-nail, three-view sketch will convey the type of air-
plane the designer desires to build, it is necessary in more complex designs
plane the designer desires to build, it is necessary in more complex designs
to make a series of subordinate studies first.

to make a series of subordinate studies first.


In a retractable landing-gear design, a careful study of the wing struc-
In a retractable landing-gear design, a careful study of the wing struc-

ture, recessing well, strut attachments, gasoline-tank location, control

systems, and the like should be carefully laid out because the wing design
ture, recessing well, strut attachments, gasoline-tank location, control
may be considerably changed just by slight variations in the conception

and location of items incorporated within the wing, or attached to it. Not
systems, and the like should be carefully laid out because the wing design
only the wing but also the preliminary kinematic layout of the retractable
may be considerably changed just by slight variations in the conception
landing gear must be studied carefully. When copies are made of exist-

and location of items incorporated within the wing, or attached to it. Not
only the wing but also the preliminary kinematic layout of the retractable
ing designs, the problem is not a difficult one, but a new conception re-

quires much attention to the details of operation and how they affect the

whole. landing gear must be studied carefully. When copies are made of exist-
When production consideration is paramount, the method of attach-

ment of the wings to the fuselage may be very important, and the internal
ing designs, the problem is not a difficult one, but a new conception re-
structure of the fuselage is certainly dependent upon the method in which
quires much attention to the details of operation and how they affect the
loads are being transferred from one part of the structure to the other.

whole.
When production consideration is paramount, the method of attach-
The fuselage structure affects window spacing, for example, and window

spacing affects the final appearance of the airplane.

In the case of large passenger and cargo arrangements, a preliminary ment of the wings to the fuselage may be very important, and the internal
internal view is desirable even before the side view of the airplane is

structure of the fuselage is certainly dependent upon the method in which


sketched up.

Different types of lift-increase devices will affect the position of the wing
loads are being transferred from one part of the structure to the other.
with relation to the fuselage. If the wing is placed at the bottom of the
The fuselage structure affects window spacing, for example, and window
fuselage, deflection of the flap may be limited by ground clearances; aero-

dynamic twist of the wing, or the incorporation of varying dihedral span-


spacing affects the final appearance of the airplane.
wise, may cause difficulties in the mechanical operation of the lift-increase
In the case of large passenger and cargo arrangements, a preliminary
devices.

internal view is desirable even before the side view of the airplane is
These are only a few representative cases of engineering studies that

are necessary and desirable to assure a well coordinated design. These


sketched up.
studies should be made before detailed structural designs are considered.
Different types of lift-increase devices will affect the position of the wing
Cursory readings of subsequent chapters on wing design, fuselage, land-

ing gear, power plant, and other pertinent chapters may also be helpful
with relation to the fuselage. If the wing is placed at the bottom of the
in crystallizing ideas.
fuselage, deflection of the flap may be limited by ground clearances; aero-
dynamic twist of the wing, or the incorporation of varying dihedral span-
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FINAL THREE-VIEW

wise, may cause difficulties in the mechanical operation of the lift-increase


The final three-view is based upon more accurate information than the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

preliminary three-view since the weight estimate has been more accurately

determined and the final balance diagram has been completed. Both the
devices.
balance diagram and the final three-view depend in some degree on the

structural layout of the wing, landing gear, and fuselage, but once these
These are only a few representative cases of engineering studies that
are necessary and desirable to assure a well coordinated design. These
studies should be made before detailed structural designs are considered.
Cursory readings of subsequent chapters on wing design, fuselage, land-
ing gear, power plant, and other pertinent chapters may also be helpful
in crystallizing ideas.

FINAL THREE-VIEW
The final three-view is based upon more accurate information than the
preliminary three-view since the weight estimate has been more accurately
determined and the final balance diagram has been completed. Both the
balance diagram and the final three-view depend in some degree on the
structural layout of the wing, landing gear, and fuselage, but once these

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE THREE-VIEW 123
THE THREE-VIEW

123
difficulties in structural arrangements and the like have been ironed out,
difficulties in structural arrangements and the like have been ironed out,

it is possible to go ahead with the final three-view.


It may be found that the balance diagram has made changes in the fol-
it is possible to go ahead with the final three-view.

It may be found that the balance diagram has made changes in the fol-

lowing: lowing:
1. Position of the wing.

2. Location of the landing gear.


1. Position of the wing.
3. Location of the tail surfaces.

2. Location of the landing gear.


3. Location of the tail surfaces.
4. Location of the center of gravity.

The structural layouts may have caused changes in:

1. Planform of the wing, perhaps because the spar intersected the fuse-
4. Location of the center of gravity.
lage where a bulkhead was found to be undesirable.

2. Arrangement of landing-gear members due to changes in spar loca-


The structural layouts may have caused changes in:
tions.

3. Placement of tail surfaces with respect to planes of symmetry.


1. Planform of the wing, perhaps because the spar intersected the fuse-
4. Vertical position of engine due to installation and vision require-
lage where a bulkhead was found to be undesirable.
ments.

Only after all points have been considered should the final three-view
2. Arrangement of landing-gear members due to changes in spar loca-
be made. Usually, it is desirable to wait until the control surfaces and
tions.
landing gear, as well as cabin installations, have been made in order to

3. Placement of tail surfaces with respect to planes of symmetry.


4. Vertical position of engine due to installation and vision require-
incorporate the latest correction.

ments.
Only after all points have been considered should the final three-view
be made. Usually, it is desirable to wait until the control surfaces and
landing gear, as well as cabin installations, have been made in order to
incorporate the latest correction.
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER VIII

Preliminary Weight Estimate

Unless the beginner is copying an existing design, the first data that he

will need to begin his design after he has been given or has written his own

specifications are various estimates of the approximate gross weight of the

VIII
airplane. For on this gross weight will depend the wing area required to

meet the specified landing speed.

CHAPTER
GENERAL PROCEDURE

Once the wing area has been determined, the length of the fuselage and

the areas of the horizontal and vertical tail surfaces can be obtained, since

modern airplanes have definite relationships of areas and dimensions of

fuselages, tail surfaces, and even the landing-gear tread, in terms of the

span and area of the wing. Subsequent aerodynamic studies and wind-

tunnel tests will have to be made to determine the governing proportions


Preliminary Weight Estimate
exactly.

When the length of the fuselage is known, its weight can be estimated;

likewise, if the areas of the tail surfaces are known, their weight may be

estimated; and so on until all data are accumulated.

When an approximate figure for the gross weight has been decided upon,

the size and weights of the landing gear may be found, and so more and

Unless the beginner is copying an existing design, the first data that he
more data accumulate until the structural weight of the complete airplane

has been determined. It may be only approximate, but a series of refine-

ments will finally give a weight estimate. When each part has been built will need to begin his design after he has been given or has written his own
and weighed, this so-called estimate will be found to be surprisingly accu-

rate.
specifications are various estimates of the approximate gross weight of the
The methods by which the weight is estimated are empirical, on the
airplane. For on this gross weight will depend the wing area required to
whole, and every bit of information that can be gleaned from the specifi-

meet the specified landing speed.


cations and from existing similar designs will be helpful.

An experienced designer needs only to look at that portion of the speci-

fications which sets forth the payload and performance requirements in


GENERAL PROCEDURE
124
Once the wing area has been determined, the length of the fuselage and
the areas of the horizontal and vertical tail surfaces can be obtained, since
modern airplanes have definite relationships of areas and dimensions of
fuselages, tail surfaces, and even the landing-gear tread, in terms of the
span and area of the wing. Subsequent aerodynamic studies and wind-
tunnel tests will have to be made to determine the governing proportions
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

exactly.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

When the length of the fuselage is known, its weight can be estimated;
likewise, if the areas of the tail surfaces are known, their weight may be
estimated; and so on until all data are accumulated.
When an approximate figure for the gross weight has been decided upon,
the size and weights of the landing gear may be found, and so more and
more data accumulate until the structural weight of the complete airplane
has been determined. It may be only approximate, but a series of refine-
ments will finally give a weight estimate. When each part has been built
and weighed, this so-called estimate will be found to be surprisingly accu-
rate.
The methods by whic_h the weight is estimated are empirical, on the
whole, and every bit of information that can be gleaned from the specifi-
cations and from existing similar designs will be helpful.
An experienced designer needs only to look at that portion of the speci-
fications which sets forth the payload nnd performance requirements in
124

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 125
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 125

order to be able to estimate within a very few pounds what the gross weight order to be able to estimate within a very few pounds what the gross weight
of the airplane is likely to be, as well as what type of wing design is likely

of the airplane is likely to be, as well as what type of wing design is likely
to be most suitable. He is able to do this because he has studied similar

airplanes. Even then, his preliminary estimate must be broken down


to be most suitable. He is able to do this because he has studied similar
into as many components as possible, because an intelligent designer can-
airplanes. Even then, his preliminary estimate must be broken down
not afford to make any estimates without reasonable research to back up

those data.
into as many components as possible, because an intelligent designer can-
It is necessary to make weight estimates as accurately as possible, for not afford to make any estimates without reasonable research to back up
if the airplane should weigh more than estimated, the performance might

those data.
be seriously affected by the greater weight. If this should happen, and

the weight is greater than estimated, it might be necessary to cut down on


It is necessary to make weight estimates as accurately as possible, for
the amount of payload, which certainly is not economical; or to cut down
if the airplane should weigh more than estimated, the performance might
on the fuel load which, in turn, will cut down the range.

The question may well be asked: "Why cut down on the payload or fuel
be seriously affected by the greater weight. If this should happen, and
load if the airplane is overweight; isn't the airplane better if it carries more
the weight is greater than estimated, it might be necessary to cut down on
load than that for which it was originally designed?" No, that is not the

the amount of payload, which certainly is not economical; or to cut down


case. In any given design, such items as the payload, crew, fuel and oil

are fixed in weight; that is, they have been set by the original specification
on the fuel load which, in turn, will cut down the range.
so that any increase in weight is undoubtedly due to the structure, which
The question may well be asked: "Why cut down on the payload or fuel
has been either underestimated in weight or improperly designed. In both

cases the result is that the airplane will cost more to construct, and the
load if the airplane is overweight; isn't the airplane better if it carries more
increased cost is undesirable. Moreover, the size of the wing is deter-
load than that for which it was originally designed?" No, that is not the
mined by the gross weight and is designed to be strong enough to carry

case. In any given design, such items as the payload, crew, fuel and oil
are fixed in weight; that is, they have been set by the original specification
that load. Any increase in weight will mean also, since the wing area

cannot be changed, that the airplane will have to land faster. The faster

the landing speed, the harder it may be for the pilot to handle the airplane.
so that any increase in weight is undoubtedly due to the structure, which
Too high a gross weight for the given wing area, airfoil section, and power

will also mean that the airplane will have to travel faster and longer along
has been either underestimated in weight or improperly designed. In both
the ground before it can take off. Unless the runways of the airport are
cases the result is that the airplane will cost more to construct, and the
long enough, the airplane may not be able to take off at all. Also, the

increased cost is undesirable. Moreover, the size of the wing is deter-


mined by the gross weight and is designed to be strong enough to carry
heavier the airplane is for the given wing area and the horsepower of the

engines, the more difficult it will be to reach a high enough altitude to

clear high mountains.


that load. Any increase in weight will mean also, since the wing area
Thus, when an airplane is overweight, in order to land slowly enough

and take off quickly enough, overloading must be reduced in some way.
cannot be changed, that the airplane will have to land faster. The faster
The only way left to do this after the airplane has been built is to cut down
the landing speed, the harder it may be for the pilot to handle the airplane.
Too high a gross weight for the given wing area, airfoil section, and power
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the amount of payload or the amount of fuel.

will also mean that the airplane will have to travel faster and longer along
There is another serious factor regarding the overweight of an airplane.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

When the structure is being designed, each part is designed to withstand

a certain load imposed on it under various flying and landing conditions, the ground before it can take off. Unless the runways of the airport are
but if the airplane is overweight some of these parts may fail.

long enough, the airplane may not be able to take off at all. Also, the
Suppose an airplane has been estimated to weigh 10,000 pounds. The

landing gear (taking just one part of the airplane for illustration) is de-
heavier the airplane is for the given wing area and the horsepower of the
engines, the more difficult it will be to reach a high enough altitude to
clear high mountains.
Thus, when an airplane is overweight, in order to land slowly enough
and take off quickly enough, overloading must be reduced in some way.
The only way left to do this after the airplane has been built is to cut down
the amount of payload or the amount of fuel.
There is another serious factor regarding the overweight of an airplane.
When the structure is being designed, each part is designed to withstand
a certain load imposed on it under various flying and landing conditions,
but if the airplane is overweight some of these parts may fail.
Suppose an airplane has been estimated to weigh 10,000 pounds. The
landing gear (taking just one part of the airplane for illustration) is de-

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
126 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

signed to withstand this load without failure when landing. Suppose,


126

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

signed to withstand this load without failure when landing. Suppose,


however, when the airplane is finally built, that it is found to weigh 11,000
however, when the airplane is finally built, that it is found to weigh 11,000

pounds. Not all of this addition in weight may be due to improper struc-
pounds. Not all of this addition in weight may be due to improper struc-
tural design, perhaps, for the designer may have also decided to double
tural design, perhaps, for the designer may have also decided to double
the mail or express load after the design was started. The landing gear,
the mail or express load after the design was started. The landing gear,
originally designed to stand up under 10,000 pounds on landing, must now

stand up under 11,000 pounds. Will it do it? It may not.


originally designed to stand up under 10,000 pounds on landing, must now
Suppose the landing gear is designed originally to stand up under 11,000 stand up under 11 1 000 pounds. Will it do it? It may not.
pounds instead of 10,000 pounds, so that if the airplane does weigh more

it will be safe. Unfortunately, this is no remedy because it means design-


Suppose the landing gear is designed originally to stand up under 11,000
ing a structure which, even if not overweight, will be unnecessarily over-
pounds instead of 10,000 pounds, so that if the airplane does weigh more
strong. Overstrength of parts means fundamentally poor and very costly
it will be safe. Unfortunately, this is no remedy because it means design-
design.

The estimates may be exceeded by a small percentage. A 5 per cent


ing a structure which, even if not overweight, will be unnecessarily over-
increase in one item may be more than offset by a decrease in weight of strong. Overstrength of parts means fundamentally poor and very costly
another item. In general, it is not desirable to exceed the estimate gross

design.
weight by more than 2 or 3 per cent. When an entirely new type of air-

plane is being designed, the final gross weight may be very much larger
The estimates may be exceeded by a small percentage. A 5 per cent
than the estimate, primarily because insufficient data were available to
increase in one item may be more than offset by a decrease in weight of
make it possible to estimate more closely. An airplane designed to carry

250,000 pounds, for example, may weigh well in excess of the allowable
another item. In general, it is not desirable to exceed the estimate gross
3 per cent, but suppose ten or twelve of these large airplanes were built weight by more than 2 or 3 per cent. When an entirely new type of air-
in a series and flown extensively for a few years so that all its character-

plane is being designed, the final gross weight may be very much larger
istics were known. Then the next designer to build an airplane of similar

size would have some data available and his design would meet the origi-
than the estimate, primarily because insufficient data were available to
nal specification far more closely than the first prototype did.
make it possible to estimate more closely. An airplane designed to carry
The weight estimate goes through a series of trials until the added re-

finements indicate that it is sufficiently accurate for all subsequent cal-


250,000 pounds, for example, may weigh well in excess of the allowable
culations. The weight estimate does not become really "final" until the 3 per cent, but suppose ten or twelve of these large airplanes were built
airplane has been built and each part weighed.

in a series and flown extensively for a few years so that all its character-
ESTIMATED WEIGHTS

To arrive at any basis for subsequent calculation, design, and develop-


istics were known. Then the next designer to build an airplane of similar
ment, weights are determined by allotting certain weights to wing groups
size would have some data available and his design would meet the origi-
per unit of wing area, to gas tanks per gallon capacity, to landing gear as

percentage of gross weight, etc. In such cases the weights are said to be
nal specification far more closely than the first prototype did.
The weight estimate goes through a series of trials until the added re-
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

estimated and their accuracy depends upon the knowledge gained from

previous designs.

finements indicate that it is sufficiently accurate for all subsequent cal-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

CALCULATED WEIGHTS

The weights of parts rray be found by calculation of volumes, length,


culations. The weight estimate does not become really "final" until the
and areas of parts after the design has been sufficiently developed so that
airplane has been built and each part weighed.
definite sizes can be determined. Such calculated weights are used for

ESTIMATED WEIGHTS
To arrive at any basis for subsequent calculation, design, and develop-
ment, weights are determined by allotting certain weights to wing groups
per unit of wing area, to gas tanks per gallon capacity, to landing gear as
percentage of gross weight, etc. In such cases the weights are said to be
estimated and their accuracy depends upon the knowledge gained from
previous designs.
~ALCULATED WEIGHTS
The weights of parts :rr.a y be found by calculation of volumes, length,
and areas of parts after the design has been sufficiently developed so that
definite sizes can be determined. Such calculated weights are used for

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIJfATE 127
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE

127
subsequent weight estimation and for setting up the final weight table and
subsequent weight estimation and for setting up the final weight table and
balance diagram for the actual airplane.
balance diagram for the actual airplane.

ACTUAL WEIGHTS

After the parts or assemblies under consideration have been constructed,


ACTUAL WEIGHTS
they are weighed, as a matter of record, and also to check on estimated

After the parts or assemblies under consideration have been constructed,


they are weighed, as a matter of record, and also to check on estimated
weights previously arrived at. Very often this procedure helps in discov-

ering errors in methods of construction, or in methods of computation.

In either case, sometimes it becomes necessary, especially if the weights


weights previously arrived at. Very often this procedure helps in discov-
are far out of line, to redesign the part or assembly in order to get closer

to the estimated or allotted weight.


ering errors in methods of construction, or in methods of computation.
ALTERNATE LOADS
In either case, sometimes it becomes necessary, especially if the weights
Some designs may incorporate different engines having different weights,

are far out of line, to redesign the part or assembly in order to get closer
to the estimated or allotted weight.
or different fuel and oil loads with accompanying varying cargo. In such

a case alternate data should be included for calculating the weights.

ESTIMATING THE GROSS WEIGHT

The gross weight, before a more detailed weight breakdown has been ALTERNATE LOADS
made, can first be estimated by means of rule-of-thumb methods.

One method is to determine the probable gross weight on the basis of the
Some designs may incorporate different engines having different weights,
power loading since the specifications for the design usually state a rated

or different fuel and oil loads with accompanying varying cargo. In such
a case alternate data should be included for calculating the weights.
engine horsepower. Since

, ,. gross weight W.

power loading = • . , —;—q—2 = 77 ,

total engine horsepower P ESTIMATING THE GROSS WEIGHT


then assuming a value for the power loading, and knowing the total rated

engine horsepower, a reasonable figure for the gross weight may be ob-
The gross weight, before a more detailed weight breakdown has been
tained.
made, can first be estimated by means of rule-of-thumb methods.
Another method is to estimate as closely as possible the detailed weights

for the
One method is to determine the probable gross weight on the basis of the
1. Power plant, power loading since the specifications for the design usually state a rated
2. Crew and payload,

3. Combustible load,
engine horsepower. Since
1 d" gross weight W.
4. Furnishings and equipment.

These four items constitute from 65 to 70 per cent of the gross weight,

or in equation form
power oa mg = total engine horsepower = P '
. sum of items 1, 2, 3, and 4

then assuming a value for the power loading, and knowing the total rated
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

gross weight = 0 7

Therefore, a second gross weight can be obtained, and then the difference
engine horsepower, a reasonable figure for the gross weight may be ob-
tained.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

between the gross weight thus calculated and these four items will give the

amount allotted for the structural weight.

Another method is to estimate as closely as possible the detailed weights


for the
1. Power plant,
2. Crew and payload,
3. Combustible load,
4. Furnishings and equipment.
These four items constitute from 65 to 70 per cent of the gross weight,
or in equation form
. ht sum of items 1, 2, 3, and 4
gross we1g = O. 7 ·
Therefore, a second gross weight can be obtained, and then the difference
between the gross weight thus calculated and these four items will give the
amount allotted for the structural weight.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
128 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
128

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


ESTIMATION OF STRUCTURAL WEIGHT
ESTIMATION OF STRUCTURAL WEIGHT

It is necessary to figure a likely value for the gross weight of the air-
It is necessary to figure a likely value for the gross weight of the air-
plane in order to determine plane in order to determine
1. The wing area and consequently the wing weight,

2. The size and weight of the landing gear,


1. The wing area and consequently the wing weight,
3. The size and weight of the tail surfaces (once the wing area is tenta-

tively determined, the area of tail surfaces are likewise tentatively deter-
2. The size and weight of the landing gear,
mined),
3. The size and weight of the tail surfaces (once the wing area is tenta-
4. Fuselage length.

tively determined, the area of tail surfaces are likewise tentatively deter-
mined),
Manufacturers' ratings for wheels, tires, shock absorbers, and the like

are in terms of the static weight on these parts. Therefore, if the gross

weight of the airplane has been calculated, the static weight per wheel is 4. Fuselage length.
then one-half the gross weight of the airplane. The static weight on the

tail wheel varies from one-tenth to one-twelfth the gross weight of the
Manufacturers' ratings for wheels, tires, shock absorbers, and the like
airplane. For these static weights, the sizes of the wheels and tires can

be found by consulting the catalogues of the manufacturers.


are in terms of the static weight on these parts. Therefore, if the gross
Once the wing area has been calculated tentatively, a tentative span weight of the airplane has been calculated, the static weight per wheel is
length can be set, and since the fuselage length varies from 60 to 70 per

then one-half the gross weight of the airplane. The static weight on the
cent of the span, the fuselage dimensions can be worked out readily. Just

as soon as the fuselage dimensions are at least tentatively established, the


tail wheel varies from one-tenth to one-twelfth the gross weight of the
weight can be estimated.
airplane. For these static weights, the sizes of the wheels and tires can
RECAPITULATIONS

After the structural weights have been listed, the weights are totaled to
be found by consulting the catalogues of the manufacturers.
give another gross weight which may vary considerably from the previous Once the wing area has been calculated tentatively, a tentative span
values determined by rule-of-thumb methods. This gross weight will

length can be set, and since the fuselage length varies from 60 to 70 per
cent of the span, the fuselage dimensions can be "worked out readily. Just
change the wing and tail surface area and therefore the weights of these

items. The weight of the landing gear usually remains the same since the

difference in gross weight is usually not so large as to affect the ratings of


as soon as the fuselage dimensions are at least tentatively established, the
the landing gear components.

These corrections in the structural weight are continued with every new
weight can be estimated.
total for the gross weight caused by these corrections until the changes are

sufficiently small to make further corrections unnecessary.


RECAPITULATIONS
FORM FOR PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE

For convenience, the weights of the airplane are grouped as indicated in


After the structural weights have been listed, the weights are totaled to
the worksheet which follows. This form is shown in its preliminary stage.
give another gross weight which may vary considerably from the previous
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

It may be considerably expanded, and it is usually desirable to do so, espe-

values determined by rule-of-thumb methods. This gross weight will


change the wing and tail surface area and therefore the weights of these
cially in presenting the final weight estimate.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

In setting up a weight table, group classifications are used because group

components are more easily weighed, and often a very detailed weight esti-
items. The weight of the landing gear usually remains the same since the
mate is not possible.

difference in gross weight is usually not so large as to affect the ratings of


the landing gear components.
These corrections in the structural weight are continued with every new
total for the gross weight caused by these corrections until the changes are
sufficiently small to make further corrections unnecessary.

FORM FOR PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE


For convenience, the weights of the airplane are grouped as indicated in
the worksheet which follows. This form is shown in its preliminary stage.
It may be considerably expanded, and it is usually desirable to do so, espe-
cially in presenting the final weight estimate.
In setting up a weight table, group classifications are used because group
components are more easily weighed, and often a very detailed weight esti-
mate is not possible.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 129
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 129

Table VTII-1. Weight control.


TABLE VIII-1. Weight control.
Power Plant

Engines, dry weight .?..13.

Per cent of power plant weight


Power Plant
Per cent of weight empty
Engines, dry weight ------------·-····----····--····------·----------------····-··-··-----·-----···-----------------:....~---------·
Per cent of gross weight

Per cent of power plant weight -------- ---·-----------------·---·--·--·-··-··--·----------------------------·······----


Propellers and hubs

Per cent of weight empty -----------------·-·········------·--· -------·-·······---------------···-·······--·-·····-·······


Starters.

Per cent of gross weight ···············----··········-···-· --------- -----------· ------····-······------------·-·······-··--


Generators

Propellers and hubs ·-------·-·-·············-·------··········································-··--·--·-··----·-··--------·-·-···--


Engine instruments

Sta.rters -----··-··-·····--·-----------------------------------------··-······-·-·····································----------------···--·-
Genera.tors -·-----------------··············-----------------------··--·-·····-···-·········-·-----·····--·····-····-----------------------
Engine controls

Fuel pumps

Engine instruments --------··········-······-···-··--·-------------················--·--··---·--·-·----·-·····-·················-··


Engine controls ····-·······--·-···········-··--·-····--·····------·-····-·········-------·-··--·-···········-----·-···---··---·------·-
Scoops

Switches

Thermocouples
Fuel pumps ··-··--·-··················-------------·-······················································---··---·····--···--··········
Deflectors .
Scoops······--······-···································--·-···········-----·-················· ····················-·········---··············
Cowlings
Switches ·······················-··-··--·--·-······························-·························-··········---·-···········-···········-
Fire walls
Thermocouples ·····------------------------------------··········· ······-············-·······--·---·-····-······-·-··---·······-------
Engine mounts
Deflectors ----------------·-··------------------·················-------···------·····-------·--------------··------------··-----·-··-··-···
Exhaust manifolds
Cowlings ··--·---------·-····--·-··-------------------------------·-··································-····--··········-·--·---·······----···
Fuel tanks
Fire walls ------------------------·--·-··········-·-·--·--····· ················--··--··----·---·------------------------------------·--·-·
Fuel system
Engine mounts ····------------·----·········---·······--·--·--······-------······-··········----------·--·-·····-·-···--··-·······-···
Oil tanks Exhaust manifolds ······----------···----------------· -······· -·-······--·-··--··········---·--·-············-·-···········--·-----
Oil system Fuel tanks -·----------···-···--··········---------------·············· ···-····················-----····························-----------
Miscellaneous
Fuel system ········-·-···------------------------·-----------------·-··--·-------··················------·········--·--------------------
Total power plant...
Oil tanks --------------------··-----------------------------------················-··-····-·········-··-················---------------------
Per cent of weight empty
Oil system ----------------------------------------------------···········-······--··--· -···········--···-···-·······-········-············
Per cent of gross weight ..
Miscellaneous ...... ·······------------·-·············-··················-·····-···············-··----·-························--······
Combustible load

Gasoline ........

Tota.I power plant ··········-·······································································--··················-··········--·


Oil ill:.

Per cent of weight empty ············---·--·-·--············-····-··-·············--······-··············--·····--------··-


Total combustible load

Per cent of gross weight --------------------··················----·····································--·--·-··············


Per cent of disposable load

Per cent of gross weight


Combustible load
Crew
G8.$oline ··············-····-·-·-···-······-········-··-----·-·-················-······-··························---····--------------·-····
Pilot and co-pilot Oil ... _··-·-·--.. ____________ .________ :___ ~-- ____._-____ ..... ____________ ...............................-..........-.. -.--.--..----.-.-... ---.....---
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Navigator

Radioman

Total combustible load -----------······-----·-····························-·--······························-···················


Per cent of disposable load ·-·----·--·----·-···········--·-· ··················-···-·············-·········--·-·---·--·····-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Mechanic

Stewardess

Per cent of gross weight ------ -------------------··········· . _ ···- ·····-··························-······------·····


Total crew

Per cent of disposable load


Crew
Per cent of gross weight ....
Pilot and co-pilot ···· · ·----------· ··---- - --- -- ---·----·-- · - ·- ·····- --~ ---- ··· · ·· ·· ·-········ · ··-····· ··· · ·· · · ·· · ··· ·· ··· ·· ··-· · ······
Payload Navigator ............................................................. .. ...................... .............................................
Passengers and baggage

Radioman ·············································----------············--···········-··································· ·· ············


Mail

Mechanic ··-····--·------------------·--·----------------·······-------······ ····--·---······-···-·-·-····-··············---·----····------


Express

Stewardess ------------··---·--------------····-------·--------·-·-·····--------·--··········-·······------··-·······---------·----···--·--
Total payload

Per cent of disposable load

Tota.I crew ··----···-------·-----·-·---·---·-------------·-··-··············--·-·······----·------------·-· ---·-------··· --·---··---------·


Per cent of gross weight ....

Per cent of disposable load --·--·-----·-····················-········-················-------------·-········--------- -----


Per cent of gross weight ·--- ·--------··----·-·--·-········-························-···-·········-----·-············------·-
Payload
Passengers and baggage ···-·-··----------·····-·· .................... ······················-··························-·------
Ma.ii ··------··-------·········-···············----------··········· .............. .. ............................ .. ...................
Express -----·-··························-······················································ ..............................................

Tota.I payload ----------·······- ............................................................ ...........................................


Per cent of disposable load ........................ ................. .................................................... .
Per cent of gross weight ···-··-·············································-···············································

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
130 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
130 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table VIII-1. (Continued).


TABLE VIII-I. (Continued).
• :.-.••00•.} <. I ~

Furnishings and equipment ';_'


Flooring .
Furnishings and equipment
Surface controls and wires . .

Flooring ································--···········-······----------·····-································································
Seats and cushions

Surface controls and wires ·-···································································································


Safety belts LL*.â„¢..

Sea.ts and cushions ..................................................................................................................


Batteries

Sa.fety belts ........................................................................................................:....=................


Batteries ·--················································-········································································--··
Instruments

Instruments ···············································································-------···-·-·-································
Lighting .

Radio equipment

Upholstery
Lighting ······················································-··········-······-·---·······················································
Radio equipment ································-·······-·····-····························-···-····································
Flares

Upholstery ................................................................................................................................
Soundproofing

Heating and ventilating.


Fla.res ...................................................................... -··········--··-·········-·· ······································
First aid
Soundproofing ..........................................................................................................................
Refreshments.
Heating and ventilating ---····---············--···-···-···················-··········································:..:.········
Miscellaneous
First a.id ··········-·······················································-·--·-·-··-···--···---------·--······-············'·······-········
Total furnishings and equipment...
Refreshments ·--··················-···············-·····-··-·-····························-············································
Per cent of weight empty
Miscellaneous ·-····································-·--···-····---·······--·--··--··---·---···-·-······································
Per cent of gross weight

Structure
Total furnishings and equipment ······-·······-····························-------············----------··················
Wing group
Per cent of weight empty ..................................................................................................
Wing panels
Per cent of gross weight ··-·-·--·-··-···-····-··--·--···················-···························-·······················
Ailerons

Flaps.
Structure
Aileron controls —

Flap controls
Wing group ············································································-··-----··········································
Spoilers
Wing panels ·-····························································································-··························
Spoiler controls
Ailerons ................................................................................................................................
Fillets Flaps·-···································································································································
Struts Aileron controls ················································-···········-············-··········································
Miscellaneous Flap controls ··-····································--·······························-·······-····· ................................. .
Total wing group Spoilers ·-·····································--·--········-····-·········································--··············------········
Pounds per square foot of wing area Spoiler controls ····--·-····-·····-·················-···············---···--························································
Per cent of structure weight
Fillets ·················································--······-·---·-··---······-·····-···--·--·-·---------·--·-·-···-·------············
Struts ....................................................................................................................................
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Per cent of weight empty

Per cent of gross weight

Miscellaneous ...... ····--··-····-···--····-···········-····-····--·-·······························································


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Empennage group .

Elevators

Tota.I wing group ·····················-···-······················-········-·························-································


Trimmers or tabs for elevators

Pounds per square foot of wing area ·-·············································································


Stabilizers
Per i::ent of structure weight ..............................................................................................
Rudders

Per cent of weight empty ·· ---·----·········-·····-········································································


Trimmers or tabs for rudders

Per cent of gross weight ....................................................................................................


Empenna.ge group ·- -···································································································-···········
Fins —

Struts

Eleva.tors ..............................................................................................................................
Control systems

Trimmers or tabs for elevators ........................................................................................


Static balances

Stabilizers ···--··································· ....................................................................................


Total tail group

Rudders ................................................................................................................................
Per cent of structure weight

Trimmers or tabs for rudders ............................................................................................


Per cent of weight empty

Per cent of gross weight


Fins ·-················································································-····················································
Struts ....................................................................................................................................
Control systems ..................................................................................................................
Sta.tic balances ·······················-·············································-··--···············-··············--··········

Total tail group ············································-·······························-···········································


Per cent of structure weight ······················-······················-················································
Per cent of weight empty ..................................................................................................
Per cent of gross weight ....................................................................................................

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 131
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 131

Table VIII-1. (Continued).


TABLE VIIl-1. (Continued) .
Body group

- - - - --- -··
Fuselage, including covering

Doors
Body group ··································································································-··························
Windows
Fuselage, including covering ·-······························································,····························
Fillets
Doors .................................................................................................... ./...............................
Total body group
Windows ·---·········· ...............................................................................................................
Per cent of structure weight
Fillets ................................................................................................................................... .
Per cent of weight empty ....

Per cent of gross weight


Total body group ....................................................................................................................
Landing gear group Per cent of structure weight ................................,.............................................................
Wheels Per cent of weight empty ..................................................................................................
Tires Per cent of gross weight ....................................................................................................
Brakes
Landing gear group ................................................................................................................
Shock absorber struts
Wheels ..................................................................................................................................
Additional struts
Tires ......................................................................................................................................
Retracting mechanism

Brakes ·····-·····························································································································
Cowlings .

Shock absorber struts ..........................................................................................................


Tail wheel

Additional struts ..................................................................................................................


Tail tire

Retracting mechanism ........................................................................................................


Tail shock absorber strut ....

Cowlings ·--········-······-···········································································································
Retracting mechanisms

Tail wheel ............................................................................................................................


Total landing gear group .

Tail tire ................................................................................................................................


Tail shock absorber strut ..................................................................................................
Per cent of structure weight

Retracting mechanisms ......................................................................................................


Per cent of weight empty

Per cent of gross weight

Total

The following abbreviations and definitions are useful:


Total landing gear group ........................................................................................................
WE = weight empty = structure plus power plant plus furnishings.
Per cent of structure weight ..............................................................................................
UL = useful load = crew plus combustible load plus payload.
Per cent of weight empty .. ................................................................................................
CL = combustible load = gasoline plus oil.
Per cent of gross weight ....................................................................................................
GW = gross weight = weight empty plus useful load.

DL = disposable load = crew plus easily removable equipment and


Total
furnishings plus combustible l(jad.
The following abbreviations and definitions are useful:
Fittings, attaching bolts, built-in supports, and the like should be

WE = weight empty = structure plus power plant plus furnishings.


charged to the group to which they are permanently fastened. Bolts

UL = useful load = crew plus combustible load plus payload.


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

CL = combustible load = gasoline plus oil.


sometimes present a problem, but in most cases their weights are negli-

GW = gross weight = weight empty plus useful load.


gible with respect to the whole, so that little difference will be caused if
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

they are included in one or another group.

In the case of a retractable landing gear the matter becomes somewhat


DL = disposable load = crew plus easily removable equipment and
more involved since, undoubtedly, additional structure is necessary in the
furnishings plus combustible l~ad.
wing (if the landing gear is to be retracted in it). If so, an attempt should

be made to obtain a reasonable distribution between the landing gear and

the wing.
Fittings, attaching bolts, built-in supports, and the like should be
When stubs of wings or tail surfaces are built integrally with the fuse- charged to the group to which they are permanently fastened . Bolts
lage the weights of such items should be included with the wings or tail

surfaces since it is obvious that the purposes which these parts serve should
sometimes present a problem, but in most cases their weights are negli-
gible with respect to the whole, so that little difference will be caused if
they are included in one or another group.
In the case of a retractable landing gear the matter becomes somewhat
more involved since, undoubtedly, additional structure is necessary in the
wing (if the landing gear is to be retracted in it) . If so, an attempt should
be made to obtain a reasonable distribution between the landing gear and
the wing.
When stubs of wings or tail surfaces are built integrally with the fuse-
lage the weights of such items should be included with the wings or tail
surfaces since it is obvious that the purposes which these parts serve should

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
132 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
132

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


be the criteria. In weighing up assemblies, however, it may be difficult to
be the criteria. In weighing up assemblies, however, it may be difficult to

ascertain the weights of such parts. One of the reasons for trying to keep
ascertain the weights of such parts. One of the reasons for trying to keep

the various groups segregated is that subsequent comparisons with similar


the various groups segregated is that subsequent comparisons with similar
planes, but with slightly different structural details, become easier. planes, but with slightly different structural details, become easier.
Where difficulty is experienced in actual practice, the weight may be in-

Where difficulty is experienced in actual practice, the weight may be in-


cluded in the group to which it is attached but a special note should be

made of such a case for future reference.


cluded in the group to which it is attached but a special note should be
VARIABLES AFFECTING WEIGHT ESTIMATION
made of such a case for future reference.
As design practices change, and new materials and methods of construc-

tion are introduced, the weights of component parts of the airplane may

change considerably. It is, therefore, particularly important to re-evalu-

VARIABLES AFFECTING WEIGHT ESTIMATION


ate any formulas, and to re-examine any specialized methods in arriving

at certain weight estimates, in order to be sure that they still apply.


As design practices change, and new materials and methods of construc-
Wing Weight Estimates

tion are introduced, the weights of compenent parts of the airplane may
change considerably. It is, therefore, particularly important to re-evalu-
To illustrate how the weight estimate of a wing might change, let us

consider a cantilever wing of a given area. It would be found that the

weight of this wing would be a function of the following parameters:


ate any formulas, and to re-examine any specialized methods in arriving
1. Wing loading W/S: The higher the wing loading, the greater the

shear and bending moments, and therefore the more material required to
at certain weight estimates, in order to be sure that they still apply.
meet the requirements for the allowable stress.

2. Aspect ratio R: The greater the aspect ratio for a given wing area,
Wing Weight Estimates
the greater the span, and therefore the greater the bending moments;

again more material is required.


To illustrate how the weight estimate of a wing might change, let us
3. Another factor, which might be used in place of or in conjunction
consider a cantilever wing of a given area. It would be found that the
with the aspect ratio factor, is the span loading W/b (the gross weight di-

weight of this wing would be a function of the following parameters:


vided by the span) since obviously the greater the span loading, the greater

the bending moment, and therefore the more material required.


1. Wing loading W /S: The higher the wing loading, the greater the
4. Airfoil section used, or more specifically, thickness ratio t/C of the

airfoil used: Since the bending stress ft, = My/I, the maximum stress is
shear and bending moments, and therefore the more material required to
directly proportional to the section modulus I/y. For a symmetrical de- meet the requirements for the allowable stress.
sign (assumed for ease in illustrating the point to be made) y would be

2. Aspect ratio R: The greater the aspect ratio for a given wing area,
one-half the depth of the wing section; I varies as the third power of the

depth so that the stress would vary inversely, all other factors being equal,
the greater the span, and therefore the greater the bending moments;
as the square of the depth of the wing; therefore, the smaller the depth,
again more material is required.
the greater the stress so that more material would be required in order that

3. Another factor, which might be used in place of or in conjunction


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the allowable stress would not be exceeded.

5. Material used, or more properly, allowable ultimate stress permitted with the aspect ratio factor, is the span loading W /b (the gross weight di-
vided by the span) since obviously the greater the span loading, the greater
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

for the material used: If one material has three-fourths the allowable ulti-

the bending moment, and therefare the more material required.


mate stress, Fu, of another, then four-thirds of the one material, a 33J^ per

cent increase, would be needed for the one over the other.

6. Limit load factor n for which the wing was designed: It should be
4. Airfoil section used, or more specifically, thickness ratio t/C of the
airfoil used: Since the bending stress f b = My/ I, the maximum stress is
directly proportional to the section modulus I /y. For a symmetrical de-
sign (assumed for ease in illustrating the point to be made) y would be
one-half the depth of the wing section; I varies as the third power of the
depth so that the stress would vary inversely, all other factors being equal,
as the square of the depth of the wing; therefore, the smaller the depth,
the greater the stress so that more material would be required in order that
the allowable stress would not be exceeded.
5. Material used, or more properly, allowable ultimate stress permitted
for the material used: If one material has three-fourths the allowable ulti-
mate stress, F,,, of another, then four-thirds of the one material, a 3372 per
cent increase, would be needed for the one over the other.
6. Limit load factor n for which the wing was designed: It should be

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 133
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE

obvious that the greater the load factor, the greater the loads imposed,
133

obvious that the greater the load factor, the greater the loads imposed,

and, therefore, the more material required.


and, therefore, the more material required.
7. Mass distribution of the wing component, since flight loads would be

counteracted by the inertia loads: If the weight of the gas tanks, engine
7. Mass distribution of the wing component, since flight loads would be
nacelles, bomb loads, and other items of equipment are distributed over
counteracted by the inertia loads: If the weight of the gas tanks, engine
the span, the resultant loads in flight could be reduced materially. How-

nacelles, bomb loads, and other items of equipment are distributed over
the span, the resultant loads in flight could be reduced materially. How-
ever, it might mean that landing conditions could become critical in the

design of the wing. For future reference, the mass distribution of the

wing may be considered proportional to wi/b where wi is the weight of


ever, it might mean that landing conditions could become critical in the
the wing assembly and b its span.

8. Taper ratio, Ctip/Croot = Ct/Cr, since the greater the taper ratio, for
design of the wing. For future reference, the mass distribution of the
the same aspect ratio and area of the wing, the more load would be con-
wing may be considered proportional to wi/b where w 1 is the weight of
centrated near the root of the wing, and therefore the smaller the bending

the wing assembly and b its span.


8. Taper ratio, Ce;.,,/Croot = Cr/ Cn, since the greater the taper ratio, for
moment.

9. Amount 'of sweepback, A: High-speed airplanes, flying at speeds ap-

proaching that of sound, employ large angles of sweepback for the wing
the same aspect ratio and area of the wing, the more load would be con-
with the result that large torsional moments are introduced. Any struc-

ture subjected to torsional moments in addition to bending moments will


centrated near the root of the wing, and therefore the smaller the bending
be heavier than one not subjected to torsional moments.
moment.
From the factors just considered, it should be possible to obtain an ex-
9. Amount ·of sweepback, A: High-speed airplanes, flying at ipeeds ap-
proaching that of sound, employ large angles of sweepback for the wing
pression for the wing weight similar to the one that follows:

Such a formula might be considered as a purely theoretical formula, and

it would be necessary to obtain the exponents empirically by weighing as with the result that large torsional moments are introduced. Any struc-
many wings as possible where the various parameters were sufficiently dif-

ture subjected to torsional moments in addition to bending moments will


ferent to permit an evaluation. In practice, however, such work would

not be done because of various difficulties that would be encountered.


be heavier than one not subjected to torsional moments.
The line of investigation suggested is useful nevertheless since it should

impress the student with the fact that there are many variables having an
From the factors just considered, it should be possible to obtain an ex-
effect upon the estimates to be made.

pression for the wing weight similar to the one that follows:
A) '
In addition to the various parameters mentioned, other factors enter

into the use of any formulas which would have to be restricted to certain

types of wings. The following factors also have some bearing on the wing

W1
w w
=f( s' R, b' ~'Fu, n, b' Cn'
t W1 Cr
weight.

1. Type of construction: Just examining the historical development of

or possibly,
wing construction throws some light on this factor. Fabric-covered, two-
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

spar (perhaps of wood) wings were commonly employed. These were fol-

or possibly,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Such a formula might be considered as a purely theoretical formula, and


it would be necessary to obtain the exponents empirically by weighing as
many wings as possible where the various parameters were sufficiently dif-
ferent to permit an evaluation. In practice, however, such work would
not be done because of various difficulties that would be encountered.
The line of investigation suggested is useful nevertheless since it should
impress the student with the fact that there are many variables having an
effect upon the estimates to be made.
In addition to the various parameters mentioned, other factors enter
into the use of any formulas which would have to be restricted to certain
types of wings. The following factors also have some bearing on the wing
weight.
1. Type of construction: Just examining the historical development of
wing construction throws some light on this factor. Fabric-covered, two-
spar (perhaps of wood) wings were commonly employed. These were fol~

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
134 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
134

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

lowed by plywood-covered, two-spar wings where more of the load was


lowed by plywood-covered, two-spar wings where more of the load was
carried by the covering. Then the metal-covered (with the covering or
carried by the covering. Then the metal-covered (with the covering or
skin supported at intervals by stiffening members) wing with two metal

skin supported at intervals by stiffening members) wing with two metal


spars followed. As the wing and span loadings increased, more metal
spars followed. As the wing and span loadings increased, more metal

spars were introduced. Now, for exceptionally high-speed airplanes, sand-

wich construction (wherein two thin metal faces with a soft core of organic
spars were introduced. Now, for exceptionally high-speed airplanes, sand-
or synthetic material) and thick metal plates for skin with longitudinal

ribs and no longitudinal spars are being employed. The changes have
wich construction (wherein two thin metal faces with a soft core of organic
brought about the transfer of material from spars to the covering, and
or synthetic material) and thick metal plates for skin with longitudinal
should, therefore, affect the weight. Likewise, the change of covering

ribs and no longitudinal spars are being employed. The changes have
brought about the transfer of material from spars to the covering, and
from fabric to plywood, to thin sheet metal, to thick plate, and to sand-

wich construction affect the wing weight since certain portions of the wing,

like the trailing edge, bear relatively light loads. should, therefore, affect the weight. Likewise, the change of covering
2. Use of lift-increase devices, whether they be nose or trailing-edge

flaps, boundary layer control, or other devices: These devices introduce


from fabric to plywood, to thin sheet metal, to thick plate, and to sand-
variations in the local pressure distribution; they add to the structural
wich construction affect the wing weight since certain portions of the wing,
weight by virtue of their control systems; they increase the torsional and

like the trailing edge, bear relatlvely light loads.


bending moments, particularly in the chordwise direction; they increase

the weight by virtue of rigidity requirements, quite apart from pure


2. Use of lift-increase devices, whether they be nose or trailing-edge
strength considerations. Although a flat percentage increase may be flaps, boundary layer control, or other devices: These devices introduce
used when such lift-increase devices are used, yet the weight contributed

variations in the local pressure distribution; they add to the structural


by such devices depends upon, among others, the following factors: their

size, conditions under which they operate, variation caused in local pres-
weight by virtue of their control systems; they increase the torsional and
sure distribution, control forces and moments encountered, and rigidity
bending moments, particularly in the chordwise direction; they increase
and strength requirements.

3. Use of anti-icing systems: While the proportion of weight caused by


the weight by virtue of rigidity requirements, quite apart from pure
wing and wing-control surface anti-icing and de-icing systems very often
strength considerations. Although a flat percentage increase may be
can be allocated directly to these systems, there are certain items which

used when such lift-increase devices are used, yet the weight contributed
might be accounted for either under wing weight or anti-icing system

weights.
by such devices depends upon, among others, the following factors: their
4. Introduction of ducts, cutouts for retractable landing gears, etc.,
size, conditions under which they operate, variation caused in local pres-
will affect the wing weight: Sometimes these can be accounted for sepa-

rately and allocated against the items causing the additional weight.
sure distribution, control forces and moments encountered, and rigidity
5. Type and size of lateral control surfaces: Normally, when the con-
and strength requirements.
ventional aileron is used, its area is considered part of the wing area. If

3. Use of anti-icing systems: While the proportion of weight caused by


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

wing and wing-control surface anti-icing and de-icing systems very often
the aileron has to be modified because of lift-increase devices, the change is

usually reflected in a change in weight. The change may be small. For

can be allocated directly to these systems, there are certain items which
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

high-speed airplanes which employ a high degree of sweepback, the lateral-

control devices present a problem. Their design may have a different

effect on wing design than the conventional case.


might be accounted for either under wing weight or anti-icing system
6. Incorporation of jettisonable portions for the wing: Highly maneu-
weights.
verable military airplanes have used the device of making the outer wing-

4. Introduction of ducts, cutouts for retractable landing gears, etc.,


tip portion quickly detachable (through failure at a critical section) when

will affect the wing weight: Sometimes these can be accounted for sepa-
rately and allocated against the items causing the additional weight.
5. Type and size of lateral control surfaces: Normally, when the con-
ventional aileron is used, its area is considered part of the wing area. If
the aileron has to be modified because of lift-increase devices, the change is
usually reflected in a change in weight. The change may be small. For
high-speed airplanes which employ a high degree of sweepback, the lateral-
control devices present a problem. Their design may have a different
effect on wing design than the conventional case.
6. Incorporation of jettisonable portions for the wing: Highly maneu-
verable military airplanes have used the device of making the outer wing-
tip portion quickly detachable (through failure at a critical section) when

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 135
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 135

the airplane encounters loads greater than that for which the major portion
the airplane encounters loads greater than that for which the major portion
of the airplane has been designed. While this stratagem is useful for

military airplanes, it might be uneconomical for commercial airplanes.


of the airplane has been designed. While this stratagem is useful for
However, it is a factor to consider at the appropriate time.
military airplanes, it might be uneconomical for commercial airplanes.
7. Method of supporting .the wing; that is, whether internally or ex-

However, it is a factor to consider at the appropriate time.


7. Method of supporting .the wing; that is, whether internally or ex-
ternally braced; if externally braced, whether fixed or pinned at the fuse-

lage; if externally braced, the amount of wing-tip overhang: These factors

affect the moment distribution axial loads, and material distribution. ternally braced; if externally braced, whether fixed or pinned at the fuse-
8. Purpose for which the airplane was designed: Climatic conditions

might affect detail design of component parts. Certainly, such a factor


lage; if externally braced, the amount of wing-tip overhang: These factors
would be difficult to incorporate in any formula.
affect the moment distribution axial loads, and material distribution.
9. Requirements for inspection and maintenance: If many inspection
8. Purpose for which the airplane was designed: Climatic conditions
points are necessary for inspection and maintenance purposes, the struc-

ture will have to be modified accordingly. Likewise, if requirements for


might affect detail design of component parts. Certainly, such a factor
maintenance are such that it should be reduced to a minimum, especially would be difficult to incorporate in any formula.
when the aircraft is to be located in certain areas of the globe, it may be

9. Requirements for inspection and maintenance: If many inspection


advisable "to beef up" certain parts of the structure.

10. Requirements for painting, anticorrosion protection, and the like:


points are necessary for inspection and maintenance purposes, the struc-
The effect of these should be obvious. It may be accounted for in the
ture will have to be modified accordingly. Likewise, if requirements for
wing weight, or arrived at independently.

11. Relative distribution of structural material subject to normal


maintenance are such that it should be reduced to a minimum, especially
stresses with respect to the structural material used for transfer of shearing
when the aircraft is to be located in certain areas of the globe, it may be
forces; also the relative distribution of the primary structure, or load-

advisable "to beef up" certain parts of the structure.


10. Requirements for painting, anticorrosion protection, and the like:
carrying material, as against the secondary structure, or nonload carrying

material provided to maintain the shape, or to cut off one section from

another, and the like.


The effect of these should be obvious. It may be accounted for in the
12. Actual size of the aircraft: Relatively small airplanes (for example,

the lowest-powered airplanes) have a great part of their structure deter-


wing weight, or arrived at independently.
mined by practical considerations such as: availability of material, the
11. Relative distribution of structural material subject to normal
minimum size or dimensions of materials desirable for maintenance rea-

stresses with respect to the structural material used for transfer of shearing
forces; also the relative distribution of the primary structure, or load-
sons, the minimum sizes available for commercial reasons.

When the aircraft reaches a size outside the immediate knowledge of the

designing fraternity, then the question of weight estimation becomes even


carrying material, as against the secondary structure, or nonload carrying
more difficult since certain parts of the structure may not increase in weight

at the same rate as another part. For this reason any final formula
material provided to maintain the shape, or to cut off one section from
would be of the form:
another, and the like.
12. Actual size of the aircraft: Relatively small airplanes (for example,
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Wi = w' + w" + w'" + w"" + •••

the lowest-powered airplanes) have a great part of their structure deter-


where w', w", w'", ..., etc., represent weights of different portions of the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

wing whose estimation would be arrived at by different routes.

By analyzing the various factors involved, it would be possible, there- mined by practical considerations such as: availability of material, the
fore, to arrive at an expression for determining the weight which could

minimum size or dimensions of materials desirable for maintenance rea-


cover all cases. It is more practical to obtain simple empirical formulas

sons, the minimum sizes available for commercial reasons.


When the aircraft reaches a size outside the immediate knowledge of the
designing fraternity, then the question of weight estimation becomes even
more difficult since certain parts of the structure may not increase in weight
at the same rate as another part. For this reason any final formula
would be of the form:
W1 = w' + w" + w"' + w"" + · · ·
where w', w", w"', .. . , etc., represent weights of different portions of the
wing whose estimation would be arrived at by different routes.
By analyzing the various factors involved, it would be possible, there-
fore, to arrive at an expression for determining the weight which could
cover all cases. It is more practical to obtain simple empirical formulas

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
136 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
136

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL for weight estimation. If those are lacking, or if they are suspect, then
for weight estimation. If those are lacking, or if they are suspect, then

the problem is reduced to fundamentals. This means estimating weights


the problem is reduced to fundamentals. This means estimating weights
by as many methods as are available, scrutinizing each assumption made,
by as many methods as are available, scrutinizing each assumption made,
and then building the airplane upon such assumptions, subject to any
and then building the airplane upon such assumptions, subject to any
corrections that later stress analysis may reveal and basing subsequent

weight analyses on the information gained in building the original pro-


corrections that later stress analysis may reveal and basing subsequent
totype. weight analyses on the information gained in building the original pro-
Fuselage Weight Estimates

totype.
Many of the factors discussed in the analysis of wing-weight estimates

apply to any consideration of fuselage weight estimates. It may be worth

Fuselage Weight Estimates


while to examine a few of the factors pertinent to the fuselage. The fol-

lowing factors would affect the fuselage weight: Many of the factors discussed in the analysis of wing-weight estimates
1. Diameter D, or ratio of depth to width d/b, of the fuselage: Usually

apply to any consideration of fuselage weight estimates. · It may be worth


this is taken at the median section and is proportional to the volume of

the fuselage. The greater this ratio, or the larger the diameter, the more
while to examine a few of the factors pertinent to the fuselage. The fol-
material involved.
lowing factors would affect the fuselage weight:
2. Length L of the fuselage, since a long fuselage would indicate either

larger bending moments, or greater weight because of more material: Usu- I. Diameter D, or ratio of depth to width d/b, of the fuselage: Usually
ally the parameter used is the ratio of the fuselage length to wing span, or

L/b.
this is taken at the median section and is proportional to the volume of
3. Tail length, or distance between the center of gravity of the airplane
the fuselage. The greater this ratio, or the larger the diameter, the more
and the center of pressure of the tail surfaces: The parameter of interest

material involved.
here would be the ratio of the tail length Lt to the mean aerodynamic

chord C, or Lt/C. If the value of this ratio is small, it is an indication

2. Length L of the fuselage, since a long fuselage .would indicate either


larger bending moments, or greater weight because of more material: Usu-
that the loads on the horizontal tail surfaces are large so that the trans-

verse shear may be greater than when the tail length is relatively large.

4. Center of gravity movement, since a relatively large movement usu-


ally the parameter used is the ratio of the fuselage length to wing span, or
ally means that the aircraft has to be designed for a number of flight

conditions and usually calls for increased weight: The center of gravity
L/b.
movement is usually expressed in terms of the mean aerodynamic chord,

that is, xC.


3. Tail length, or distance between the center of gravity of the airplane
5. Design load factors for both flight and landing conditions: No one

and the center of pressure of the tail surfaces: The parameter of interest
load factor or condition is usually critical for the entire fuselage so that a

problem is presented here. However, there is no doubt that the fuselage


here would be the ratio of the tail length Lt to the mean aerodynamic
weight is a function of some load factor, n. chord C, or Lt/C. If the value of this ratio is small, it is an indication
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

6. Mass distribution, particularly of local concentrated weights caused

that the loads on the horizontal tail surfaces are large so that the trans-
by cargo: This mass distribution could be represented as some function of

verse shear may be greater than when the tail length is relatively large.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the average mass distribution and may be considered proportional to the

ratio oiv)//L where w/ is the fuselage weight and L the fuselage length.

4. Center of gravity movement, since a relatively large movement usu-


ally means that the aircraft has to be designed for a number of flight
conditions and usually calls for increased weight: The center of gravity
movement is usually expressed in terms of the mean aerodynamic chord,
that is, xC.
5. Design load factors for both flight and landing conditions: No one
load factor or condition is usually critical for the entire fuselage so that a
problem is presented here. However, there is no doubt that the fuselage
weight is a function of some load factor, n.

6. Mass distribution, particularly of local concentrated weights caused


by cargo: This mass distribution could be represented as some function of
the average mass distribution and may be considered proportional to the
ratio of w1/L where w1 is the fuselage weight and L the fuselage length.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 137
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE

137

The resulting formula, considering the factors mentioned, would be of


the order
The resulting formula, considering the factors mentioned, would be of

the order

However, there are other factors which would make necessary the

evaluation of such an expression so that it would apply to a certain cate-

gory, and thus a number of formulas would be necessary. For example,


w1 = 1(n ~'b 'f,b Le,c xC' w')·
I L
the following categories are indicative:

1. Type of fuselage: whether tubular steel, reinforced monocoque,


However, there are other factors which would make necessary the
sandwich construction; whether cabin or open cockpit; whether cargo, or
evaluation of such an expression so that it would apply to a certain cate-
passenger; all would vary the weight.

2. Type of wing attachment: whether for an internally or an externally


gory, and thus a number of formulas would be necessary. For example,
braced wing, and if the latter, whether the wing is fixed or pinned at the the following categories are indicative:
fuselage.

3. Type of landing gear and its configuration.


1. Type of fuselage: whether tubular steel, reinforced monocoque,
4. Extent of pressurization, if any.

sandwich construction; whether cabin or open cockpit; whether cargo, or


passenger; all would vary the weight.
5. Any special requirements as doors, exits, windows, windshields.

As for the wing, the weight of the fuselage can be broken down into

component parts, but here again, some estimate must first be made of the 2. Type of wing attachment: whether for an internally or an externally
weight, to proceed with the more detailed design. It is only after the more

braced wing, and if the latter, whether the wing is fixed or pinned at the
detailed design has progressed to a certain point that it is possible to get the

required information as to dimensions, etc., so that the weight estimate


fuselage.
can be revised.
3. Type of landing gear and its configuration.
4. Extent of pressurization, if any.
Control Surface Weight Estimates

Since the aileron is customarily regarded as part of the wing structure,

this discussion will apply primarily to the vertical and horizontal tail sur- 5. Any special requirements as doors, exits, windows, windshields.
faces although some of the factors concerning them apply with equal force

in the consideration of the ailerons. Likewise, some of the factors affect-

As for the wing, the weight of the fuselage can be broken down into
component parts, but here again, some estimate must first be made of the
ing estimation of the wing weight apply to control surfaces as well.

The weight of these tail surfaces would be affected by:

1. Aspect ratio R.
weight, to proceed with the more detailed design. It is only after the more
2. Proportion of movable surface area Se to the fixed Sf, or to the com-

plete surface area St, that is, Sc/S/, or Sc/St.


detailed design has progressed to a certain point that it is possible to get the
3. The ratio of the aerodynamic balance area <S», ahead of the hinge
required information as to dimensions, etc., so that the weight estimate
line to the movable surface, or Sh/Sc.

can be revised.
4. Proportion of the trimming tab surface Sta to movable surface Sc,

or SJSC.
Control Surface Weight Estimates
Generated on 2012-05-30 01:53 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

5. Mass distribution, especially where static and dynamic balancing is

required: This distribution could be considered proportional to the average


Since the aileron is customarily regarded as part of the wing structure,
this discussion will apply primarily to the vertical and horizontal tail sur-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

unit weight of the tail surfaces or Wc/Sc where Wc represents the weight

of the movable portion of the tail surfaces and Se is its area.

faces although some of the factors concerning them apply with equal force
in the consideration of the ailerons. Likewise, some of the factors affect-
ing estimation of the wing weight apply to control surfaces as well.
The weight of these tail surfaces would be affected by:
1. Aspect ratio R.
2. Proportion of movable surface area So to the fixed S1i or to the com-
plete surface area S 1, that is, Sc/81, or Sc/S,.
3. The ratio of the aerodynamic balance area SA, ahead of the hinge
line to the movable surface, or S,./ Sc.
4. Proportion of the trimming tab surface Sea to movable surface Sc,
or S1a/Sc.
5. Mass distribution, especially where static and dynamic balancing is
required: This distribution could be considered proportional to the average
unit weight of the tail surfaces or W,/So where We represents the weight
of the movable portion of the tail surfaces and 8 0 is its area.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
138 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
138

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

6. Permissible hinge moment in terms of the stick or control wheel force:


This factor could be represented by Cc'A·
6. Permissible hinge moment in terms of the stick or control wheel force:

This factor could be represented by Cc*.

7. Tail length Lt of the airplane, since the farther back, in terms of the 7. Tail length L, of the airplane, since the farther back, in terms of the
mean aerodynamic chord C, the tail surfaces are from the center of gravity

mean aerodynamic chord C, the tail surfaces are from the center of gravity
of the airplane, the lower the load on the tail surfaces.

The resulting formula would be similar to the following:


of the airplane, the lower the load on the tail surfaces.
Such a formula could be broken down separately for the fixed and mov-

able portions of the control surfaces.


The resulting formula would be similar to the following:
Landing-Gear Weight Estimates

Sc S,. S1a We C Le)


f(R ' s,' Sc' Sc' Sc' ,,., c .
The landing gear, perhaps more than any other structural assembly

with the exception of the power plant group, consists of a number of units
Wt =
whose weight is not determined by the airplane designer so that the struc-

tural weight of those items depends primarily upon availability, although


Such a formula could be broken down separately for the fixed and mov-
they are designed to meet the conditions for which they are used.

Wheels, brakes, tires, and to some degree, the shock absorber, are de-
able portions of the control surfaces.
Landing-Gear Weight Estimates
signed to satisfy the requirements of airplanes with a relative wide range

of gross weights. In the main, they are designed for a given gross weight

W and a given load factor n. However, their selection is simplified by

the manufacturers by rating them according to the static weight they are
The landing gear, perhaps more than any other structural assembly
supposed to carry.
with the exception of the power plant group, consists of a number of units
The weights of rest of the structure, consisting of struts, including the

whose weight is not determined by the airplane designer so that the struc-
shock absorber member, and the retracting mechanism, depend upon a

number of factors such as:


tural weight of those items depends primarily upon availability, although
1. Gross weight of the airplane;
they are designed to meet the conditions for which they are used.
2. Loads applied to the structure which depend upon the type of land-

ing gear, such as whether it is a conventional landing gear, or a tricycle


Wheels, brakes, tires, and to some degree, the shock absorber, are de-
type;
signed to satisfy the requirements of airplanes with a relative wide range
3. Configuration of the members; that is, whether several members are

of gross weights. In the main, they are designed for a given gross weight
W and a given load factor n. However, their selection is simplified by
used to form a tripod, for example, or a pure cantilever single-member

type, etc.;

4. Length of the members;


the manufacturers by rating them according to the static weight they are
5. Materials used.

Power Plant and Power-Plant Nacelle Weight Estimates


supposed to carry.
The estimation of the power-plant weight is relatively simple since once
The weights of rest of the structure, consisting of struts, including the
the engine is selected, the remainder is comparatively easy. The weight

shock absorber member, and the retracting mechanism, depend upon a


Generated on 2012-05-30 01:53 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

of the power-plant nacelle, consisting of the engine mount, cowling, ducts,

etc., is a function of:


number of factors such as:
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1. Gross weight of the airplane;


1. Weight of the power plant,

2. Loads applied to the structure which depend upon the type of land-
ing gear, such as whether it is a. conventional landing gear, or a. tricycle
type;
3. Configuration of the members; that is, whether several members are
used to form a tripod, for example, or a. pure cantilever single-member
type, etc.;
4. Length of the members;
5. Materials used.
Power Plant and Power-Plant Nacelle Weight Estimates
The estimation of the power-plant weight is relatively simple since once
the engine is selected, the remainder is comparatively easy. The weight
of the power-plant nacelle, consisting of the engine mount, cowling, ducts,
etc., is a function of:
1. Weight of the power plant,

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 139
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 139

2. Maximum load factor to be experienced by the airplane,


2. Maximum load factor to be experienced by the airplane,
3. Position with relation to the fuselage or the leading edge of the wing,

4. Other factors such as landing-gear attachments, inspection provision,


3. Position with relation to the fuselage or the leading edge of the wing,
disconnect features.
4. Other factors such as landing-gear attachments, inspection provision,
Weight Data Sources

disconnect features.
To obtain a realistic weight estimate, it is necessary to know the various

sources from which such data may be obtained. Weight Data Sources
1. Accessories, power plant, hardware, wheels, etc. are usually of stand-

ard manufacture, and their weights are obtained from manufacturers'


To obtain a realistic weight estimate, it is necessary to know the various
catalogs. sources from which such data may be obtained.
1. Accessories, power plant, hardware, wheels, etc. are usually of stand-
2. AVeights of fabricated assemblies must be obtained from:

(a) published materials,

(b) data available from past experience, and ard manufacture, and their weights are obtained from manufacturers'
(c) actual weighings of dismantled or junked airplanes.

'A. Preliminary studies of structural design based upon empirical and/or


catalogs.
theoretical approaches.
2. 'Veights of fabricated assemblies must be obtained from:
(a) published materials,
Design Control of Weight

The aircraft designer has little control over the weight of such items

as accessories, power plant, and hardware, except insofar as he states

(b) data available from past experience, and


the original specifications for performance, material, or size.

The fabricated portion of the airplane may not amount to more than
(c) actual weighings of dismantled or junked airplanes.
15 to 35% of the gross weight. Even if the designer were able to devise

structures having weight differences of 40%, the final result would affect
:t Preliminary studies of structural design based upon empirical and/or
the gross weight not more than about 10%. Nevertheless, he should theoretical approaehes.
make every attempt to obtain the lightest structure possible, and his

selection of the component parts must always be considered in the light


Design Control of Weight
of the possible saving of weight.

EMPIRICAL FORMULAS AND DATA


The aircraft designer has little control over the weight of such itemi:;
Some empirical formulas based upon various parameters are presented
as accessories, power plant, and hardware, except insofar as he states
here. The student may choose the ones he deems appropriate or use

the original specifications for performance, material, or size.


The fabricated portion of the airplane may not amount to more than
several for comparison purposes.

Wing Weight

1. One formula for wing-weight estimation which may be used for air-
15 to 353 of the gross weight. Even if the designer were able to devise
craft weighing up to about 50,000 pounds is stated as follows:

Ww = ^ (0.18756 + 53.50),
structures having weight differences of 40%, the final result would affect
where Ww = weight of the wing, in pounds,
the gross weight not more than about 103. Nevertheless, he should
make every attempt to obtain the lightest structure possible, and his
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

n = design load factor (see Chapter IV for a likely applicable

selection of the component parts must always be considered in the light


value),
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of the possible saving of weight.

EMPIRICAL FORMULAS AND DATA


Some empirical formulas based upon various parameters are presented
here. The student may choose the ones he deems appropriate or use
several for comparison purposes.
Wing Weight
1. One formula for wing-weight estimation which may be used for air-
craft weighing up to about 50,000 pounds is stated as follows:

w w = ~~ (0.1875b + 53.50),
where W w = weight of the wing, in pounds,
n = design load factor (see Chapter IV for a likely applicable
value),

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
140 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
140

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL b = span of the wing, in feet,


Wu gross weight of the airplane, in pounds.
b = span of the wing, in feet,

W„ = gross weight of the airplane, in pounds.


=
The limitations of the formula should be immediately apparent. The

gross weight W„ is itself an estimate at this stage; the load factor n is a
The limitation:.; of the formula should be immediately apparent. The
function of the aircraft weight and its performance (both still in their
gross weight W 11 is itself an estimate at this stage; the load factor n is a
formative stages); the span 6 of the wing is a function of the gross weight

(still an estimate) and of the airfoil characteristics, assuming that the


function of the aircraft weight and its performance (both still in their
aspect ratio is known. The indications, therefore, are that any complex
formative stages); the span b of the wing is a function of the gross weight
formula derived will give values that are still unproved.

(still an estimate) and of the airfoil characteristics, assuming that the


2. For commercial aircraft gross weights between 1,500 and 5,000

pounds:
aspect ratio is known. The indications, therefore, are that any complex
3. For military airplanes (propeller-engine type) of gross weights be-
formula derived will give values that are still unproved.
tween 10,000 and 100,000 pounds:

4. For commercial airplanes of gross weights between 20,000 to 70,000


2. For commercial aircraft gross weights between 1,500 and 5,000
pounds:

pounds:
W w = .0763 W 11 + 50.
5. For gross weights between 70,000 and 150,000 pounds for commercial

airplanes:

6. For military airplanes of gross weights between 100,000 and 300,000

pounds:
3. For military airplanes (propeller-engine type) of gross weights be-
7. Wing = 15% gross weight.

8. Weight may be obtained for metal wings by plotting (per inch of


tween 10,000 and 100,000 pounds:

W"' .034 wfl] w


span) the weight calculated from the formula

where n = highest design flight-load factor, and

= [ · 157 - 100,000 fl.


C = chord in inches,

assuming that the wing is constructed of aluminum alloy.

9. Metal wings internally braced, no flaps: 1.6 lb to 2.6 lb per ft2.


4. For commercial airplanes of gross weights between 20,000 to 70,000
Ww = .0763 W„ + 50.

pounds:
W = 0.00002 (n) (C2),

W"' = [.156 - ·~~~~"] Wfl·


5. For gross weights between 70,000 and 150,000 pounds for commercial
airplanes:
.04 wfl
W w = [ • 122 - 100 Jlt'fl .
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

000
'
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

6. For military airplanes of gross weights between 100,000 and 300,000


pounds:
W = [ 14 _ .0067 W
·D • 100,000·
o] W .U

7. Wing = 15% gross weight.


8. Weight may be obtained for metal wings by plotting (per inch of
span) the weight calculated from the formula

W = 0.00002 (n) (C2),


where n highest design flight-load factor, and
=
C = chord in inches,
assuming that the wing is constructed of aluminum alloy.
9. Metal wings internally braced, no flaps: 1.6 lb to 2.6 lb per ft2.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 141
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE

141 10. Metal wings internally braced, with flaps and retracting mechanism:
10. Metal wings internally braced, with flaps and retracting mechanism:

2.6 to 4.6 lb per sq ft, with the higher value for wings incorporating high-
2.6 to 4.6 lb per sq ft, with the higher value for wings incorporating high-

lift devices such as the Fowler flap.


lift devices such as the Fowler flap.
11. Fabric-covered wings: 1.4 to 2.5 lb per ft2.

12. For many transonic and supersonic designs, elevators, as well as


11. Fabric-covered wings: 1.4 to 2.5 lb per ft2.
the usual flaps and ailerons (either or both of which may have dual func-

tions), are incorporated into the trailing edge of the wing. The weights 12. For many transonic and supersonic designs, elevators, as well as
of these wings tend to average on the high side per square foot compared

with the internally-braced wing of greater aspect ratio.


the usual flaps and ailerons (either or both of which may have dual func-
13. Ww = 0.00591 -
tions), are incorporated into the trailing edge of the wing. The weights
where W„ = gross weight, in pounds,

of these wings tend to average on the high side per square foot compared
with the internally-braced wing of greater aspect ratio.
n = limit load factor, maximum positive,

b = wing span, in feet,

S = wing area, in square feet,

:b8]
t = maximum thickness of root section, in feet.

Tail Surfaces

Empirical formulas applying to tail-surface weight estimation are:


13. w tD = 0.0059 [ w11 .GOS I
1. (a) For rudders:

(b) For elevators:

(c) For fins:


where W11 = gross weight, in pounds,
WR = J^(S, + 340);
n = limit load factor, maximum positive,
b
WB = ^(S* + 340);

Wf = Jb(s" + 490);
= wing span, in feet,
(d) For stabilizers:

Ws = OS*+ 475);
S = wing area, in square feet,
where WR, We, Wf, Ws represent the weights of the rudder, elevator, t = maximum thickness of root section, in feet.
fin, and stabilizer, respectively, and ST, S„ Sf, S„ S„ Sh represent the areas

of the rudder, elevator, fin, stabilizer, vertical tail surfaces, and horizontal

tail surfaces, respectively.

Tail Surfaces
Empirical formulas applying to tail-surface weight estimation are:
1. (a) For rudders:

WR= 2~0 (8., + 340);


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(b) For elevators:

WE= 2~ (811 + 340);


(c) }'or fins:
8,
wF = 280 (8. + 400);
{d) For stabilizers:
s
Ws = 2gij (811 + 475);
where WR, WE, W F, Ws represent the weights of the rudder, elevator,
fin, and stabilizer, respectively, and 8,, S,, Sh 8., 8,, 8,,, represent the areas
of the rudder, elevator, fin, stabilizer, vertical tail surfaces, and horizontal
tail surfaces, respectively.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
142 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

2. For commercial aircraft of 1,500 to 5,000 pounds gross weight:


142 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

2. For commercial aircraft of 1,500 to 5,000 pounds gross weight:

WTa = .0163 Wg + 10,

for vertical and horizontal tail surfaces combined.


WTs = .0163 w" + 10,
for vertical and horizontal tail surfaces combined.
3. For commercial aircraft from 20,000 to 60,000 pounds gross weight:

w" - [M35 - S]w-

4. For commercial aircraft from 60,000 to 150,000 pounds gross weight:

w- - H - tsSst] w-
3. For commercial aircraft from 20,000 to 60,000 pounds gross weight:
w"]
5. For military aircraft between 10,000 and 35,000 pounds gross weight:

w„-[am

W•TS = [ •0435 _ .035


100,000
Tl''
rr 11·
w..

L 100,000.

6. For military aircraft between 35,000 and 70,000 pounds gross weight:

4. For commercial aircraft from 60,000 to 150,000 pounds gross weight:


w"] w11·
WTS = |.0280 - 008 W>

JVTS = [ .0255 - .00835


W..

100.000J
lOO,OOO
7. For military aircraft between 70,000 and 90,000 pounds gross weight:

5. For military aircraft between 10,000 and 35,000 pounds gross weight:
8. For military aircraft between 90,000 and 300,000 pounds gross

weight:

i~~~J W11.
w» = [°246 - mk]w-

9. Vary from 1.0 to 2 lb per sq ft

(a) Near the lower figures for externally-braced tail surfaces.


WTs = [.0394 -
(b) Figure allows for bracing.

(c) Near the higher figure for full-cantilever tail surfaces.


6. For military aircraft between 35,000 and 70,000 pounds gross weight:
(d) Static balances increase weights.

i~~~J W11 .
Fuselage Weight

1. A reasonable empirical formula with which the fuselage weight can


WTS = [:0280 -
be estimated in terms of the gross weight is given here for airplanes weigh-

ing up to about 100,000 pounds:

7. For military aircraft between 70,000 and 90,000 pounds gross weight:
w,J w11·
W

W TS = [ .0224 - .00125
F 12

where WF is the fuselage weight, and

Wg is the gross weight of the airplane.


lOO,OOO

8. For military aircraft between 90,000 and :300,000 pounds gross


weight:

i~~~J Wu.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

WTs = [.0246 -
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

9. Vary from 1.0 to 2 lb per sq ft


(a) Near the lower figures for externally-braced tail surfaces.
(b) Figure allows for bracing.
(c) Near the higher figure for full-cantilever tail surfaces.
(d) Static balances increase weights.
Fuselage Weight
1. A reasonable empirical formula with which the fuselage weight can
be estimated in terms of the gross weight is given here for airplanes weigh-
ing up to about 100,000 pounds:
WF = ll'u,
12
where W F is the fuselage weight, and
W11 is the gross weight of the airplane.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 143
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 143

Such a formula is perhaps too simple, since it would indicate that the

Such a formula is perhaps too simple, since it would indicate that the
fuselage weight for all airplanes is a little more than eight per cent of the
fuselage weight for all airplanes is a little more than eight per cent of the

gross weight of the airplane. However, the value obtained is useful for

a first approximation. gross weight of the airplane. However, the value obtained is useful for
2. Welded tubular type: 0.70 to 1.80 lb per in. of length. The length

a first approximation.
of the fuselage is considered to be the distance from the fire wall to the

tail post.

3. Reinforced monocoque: 0.60 to 1.70 lb per in. of length.


2. Welded tubular type: 0.70 to 1.80 lb per in. of length. The length
4. Reinforced monocoque weight is obtained by the formula:
of the fuselage is considered to be the distance from the fire wall to the
0.791 X (length) X (circumference of median section),

tail post.
dimensions in feet.

5. For an airplane weighing about 8,500 pounds, a typical bare fuselage

weight (for a reinforced monocoque construction) is 650 pounds, including


3. Reinforced monocoque: 0.00 to 1.70 lb per in. of length.
firewall, stringers, covering, fittings, built-in supports, doors, and door

frames.
4. Reinforced monocoque weight is obtained by the formula:
0.791 X (length) X (circumference of median section),
6. For commercial aircraft between 1,500 and 5,000 pounds gross weight:

WF = .205 Wg - 140.

7. For commercial aircraft of gross weights between 20,000 and 150,000


dimensions in feet.
pounds:

WF = .073 W„.
5. For an airplane weighing about 8,500 pounds, a typical bare fuselage
8. For military aircraft between 10,000 and 55,000 pounds:

w Tims 0309 Wj\ w


weight (for a reinforced monocoque construction) is 650 pounds, including
Wf = L1013 — lopoo"J W- firewall, stringers, covering, fittings, built-in supports, doors, and door
9. For military aircraft between 55,000 and 100,000 pounds:

.004 w;
frames.
WF = .0853 -

100,000J
6. For commercial aircraft between 1,500 and 5,000 pounds gross weight:
10. For military aircraft between 100,000 and 300,000 pounds:

4«
WF = .205 W0 - 140.
w' -10833 - mm]w-

Landing Gear
7. For commercial aircraft of gross weights between 20,000 and 150,000
1. An empirical formula which may be used is:
pounds:
W

WLG = ^ (35 + 0.1 L),


WF = .073 WI/.
where Wlo represents the landing-gear weight,

8. For military aircraft between 10,000 and 55,000 pounds:


Wg represents the gross weight of the airplane, and

·~~~~o] W
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

L represents the length, in feet, of the longest lartding-gear member.

WF = [ .1013 - 0•
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

9. .F'or military aircraft between 55,000 and 100,000 pounds:

WP = [.0853 - i~~~J Wo.


10. For military aircraft between 100,000 and 300,000 pounds:

Wr = [.0833 - i~~~J Wo.


Landing Gear
1. An empirical formula which may be used is:

Ww = l~ (:35 + 0.1 L),


where W w represents the landing-gear weight,
W 0 represents the gross weight of the airplane, and
L represents the length, in feet, of the longest landing-gear member.

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
144· AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
144 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Where there are several landing-gear assemblies (for example, a nose wheel
Where there are several landing-gear assemblies (for example, a nose wheel
and the main landing gear), an approximation of L may be obtained by

and the main landing gear), an approximation of L may be obtained by


averaging the lengths of the several assemblies involved.
averaging the lengths of the several assemblies involved.

2. The landing gear (including retraction mechanism) may be assumed

to be 5 to 6H% of the gross weight.

2. The landing gear (including retraction mechanism) may be assumed


to be 5 to 672% of the gross weight.
3. Wheels and tires are rated according to static weights imposed.

The static weight per wheel and tire is one half of the gross weight. The

static weight per tail wheel is from one tenth to one twelfth of the gross

3. Wheels and tires are rated according to static weights imposed.


weight. For tricycle landing gear, assume one sixth to one eighth on the

front wheel, the remainder on the rear wheel. With the static load
The static weight per wheel and tire is one half of the gross weight. The
rating known, the required wheel size and corresponding weight may be
static weight per tail wheel is from one tenth to one twelfth of the gross
determined.

4. For commercial aircraft between 1,500 and 5,000 pounds gross


weight. For tricycle landing gear, assume one sixth to one eighth on the
weight:
front wheel, the remainder on the rear wheel. With the static load
Wlg = .0521 W„ + 5.

rating known, the required wheel size and corresponding weight may be
5. For military aircraft between 10,000 and 30,000 pounds:

w» = [000817 - Siw-


determined.
6. For military aircraft between 30,000 and 60,000 pounds:

4. For commercial aircraft between 1,500 and 5,000 pounds gross


7. For military aircraft between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds:

w» = [000567 — mM w-


weight:
8. For military aircraft between 150,000 and 300,000 pounds:

Ww = .0521 W 11 + 5.
T «,s., 000028 W„~] T„

9. For commercial aircraft between 20,000 and 60,000 pounds:

5. For military aircraft between 10,000 and 30,000 pounds:


„. T .0383 W„l „

·~~~~"]Wu.
w» = L 077 — lopoo J w"

10. For commercial aircraft between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds:

Ww = [.0817 -
w» = [06°— mM w*

11. Wheel, tire, and tube weight in pounds:

W = 10 + 00010 Wg.
6. For military aircraft between 30,000 and 60,000 pounds:

W LG = [ .0672 - ·~~~~" JWu·


7. For military aircraft between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds:

Ww = [.0567 - i:~~J W
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

0•
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

8. For military aircraft between 150,000 and 300,000 pounds:

Ww = [.0487 - ·~~~~u] Wu.


~. For commercial aircraft between 20,000 and 60,000 pounds:

W LG = [ .077 - .0383 w"] w


100,()()() g·

10. For commercial aircraft between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds:


.012 Wu] W
W LG = [ .060 - 100,000 u·

11. Wheel, tire, and tube weight in pounds :

w = 10 + .010 w 11·

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 145
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 145

12. Brake weight in pounds:

12. Brake weight in pounds:


W = 10 + (7.2 X 10-5) (W>) (j^y

(~)·
13. Shock absorber and axle assembly in pounds:

W = 5 + (2 X 10-4) (W„) (L), W = 10 + (7.2 X 10-0) (W,,)


where L is length of shock absorber strut, in inches.

13. Shock absorber and axle assembly in pounds:


Total Fabricated Components

A check on the calculation of the weights for the wing, tail surfaces,

fuselage, and landing gear may be made with the aid of the following

formulas:
W = 5 + (2 X 10-4) (W,,) (L),
where L is length of shock absorber strut, in inches.
1. For commercial aircraft of gross weights between 1,500 and 5,000

pounds:

WST = .368 W, - 100.

Total Fabricated Components


2. For commercial aircraft of gross weights between 20,000 and 50,000

pounds:

.12 W„

A check on the calculation of the weights for the wing, tail surfaces,
fuselage, and landing gear may be made with the aid of the following
WST =

.36

100,000j formulas:
1. For commercial aircraft of gross weights between 1,500 and 5,000
3. For commercial aircraft weighing between 50,000 and 200,000 pounds:

WST = .27 Wg.

4. For military aircraft weighing from 10,000 to 50,000 pounds: pounds:


WsT = .368 W,, - 100.
w» = [AU ~ mk]w-

5. For military aircraft weighing from 50,000 to 110,000 pounds:

2. For commercial aircraft of gross weights between 20,000 and 50,000


6. For military aircraft weighing between 110,000 and 300,000 pounds:

w* = [0032 - mki\w-

7. For jet aircraft, the structural weight is about the same, being only pounds:
about Yi percent less. The above estimates may therefore be used for

.12W,,Jw
W ST = [ .36 - l()(),OOO
preliminary calculations for jet-powered aircraft.

,,.
8. For turboprop airplanes equipped with Fowler flaps, wing aspect

ratios of 14 or less, wing loadings between 20 to 100 pounds per square

foot, the weight empty, and the structural (or airframe) weight may be 3. For commercial aircraft weighing between 50,000 and 200,000 pounds:
estimated as follows:

WsT = .27 W,,.


4. For military aircraft weighing from 10,000 to 50,000 pounds:

[.417 - i:.~J W,,.


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Wsr =
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

5. For military aircraft weighing from 50,000 to 110,000 pounds:

Wsr = [.352 - i°~~~J W,,.


6. For military aircraft weighing between 110,000 and 300,000 pounds:
.02 W,,J W
W ST = [ .32 - 100,000 fl•

7. For jet aircraft, the structural weight is about the same, being only
about Y2 percent less. The above estimates may therefore be used for
preliminary calculations for jet-powered aircraft.
8. For turboprop airplanes equipped with Fowler flaps, wing aspect
ratios of 14 or less, wing loadings between 20 to 100 pounds per square
foot, the weight empty, and the structural (or airframe) weight may be
estimated as follows:

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
146 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
146

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

(a)
(a) Wsr = [.054 - 0.00:3 ~:] W,,,
s:
( w )-o.42
.054 - 0.003 4r W,

9i
(b) Wsr = 1.78 W
(b)

WST

178 w {W
Weight Empty
Weight Empty
Some idea of the reasonability of weight estimates for the structure,
Some idea of the reasonability of weight estimates for the structure,

power plant, and fixed equipment may be gained by comparing the total
power plant, and fixed equipment may be gained by comparing the total
with the values obtained for the weight empty from the appropriate
with the values obtained for the weight empty from the appropriate
empirical formulas below, which are based on commercial airplane data.

empirical formulas below, which are based on commercial airplane data.


1. For gross weights between 1,500 and 5,000 pounds:

Engine Nacelles
1. For gross weights between 1,500 and 5,000 pounds:
1. For power plant installations of the radial-type aircraft engine, a

reasonable estimate of the nacelle weight may be obtained from:


Wir = .84W,, - 450.
where W„a represents the nacelle weight, and

Wen represents the engine weight, 2. For gross weights between 20,000 and 60,000 pounds:
wa] w,,.
For other types of propulsion devices, such as jet-propulsion engines,

gas turbines, and similar power plants, the data on weights of the power-

TZT , = [ 74 _ .233
plant housing in the airplane are still too meager to permit the derivation
n E • 100,000
of any reliable relationships.

2. The following formulas may be found useful:

3. Gross weights between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds:


(a) For aircraft weighing between 20,000 and 60,000 pounds, having

.067W,,J W
2 or 4 engine nacelles:

(b) For aircraft weighing between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds, having
WE = [ .64 - 100,000 ,,.
4, 6, or 8 engine nacelles:

WB = &*Wg - 450.

2. For gross weights between 20,000 and 60,000 pounds:


Engine Nacelles
3. Gross weights between 60,000 and 150,000 pounds:
1. For power plant installations of the radial-type aircraft engine, a
W„ = 2 (WM)«*.

reasonable estimate of the nacelle weight may be obtained from:


ff' "a = 2 (W d") 314 ,
where W"" represents the nacelle weight, and
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

We" represents the engine weight,


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

For other types of propulsion devices, such as jet-propulsion engines,


gas turbines, and similar power plants, the data on weights of the power-
plant housing in the airplane are still too meager to permit the derivation
of any reliable relationships.
2. The following formulas may be found useful:
(a) .For aircraft weighing between 20,000 and 60,000 pounds, having
2 or 4 engine nacelles:

W"a = [.037 - ·~~"] W,,.


(b) For aircraft weighing between 60,000 and 150,000 pound:s, having
4, 6, or 8 engine nacelles:

W ftG = [ •03 .t~4 -


.0012
100,oOO
w,,J u;
ff u•

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 147
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE

147
3. For jet installations, the weight of the power plant plus the nacelles
3. For jet installations, the weight of the power plant plus the nacelles

is from 7 to 8 per cent of the gross weight less.


is from 7 to 8 per cent of the gross weight less.
4. Nacelles in the wings of small airplanes are from 1.5 to 2% of the
4. Nacelles in the wings of small airplanes are from 1.!l to 2% of the
gross weight.

gross weight.
Fuel Weight

1. The specific fuel consumption (e) of propeller-operated engines is

Fuel Weight
usually given in terms of the number of pounds per horsepower per hour.

For jet engines, it is given in terms of number of pounds per pound of 1. The specific fuel consumption (e) of propeller-operated engines is
thrust per hour. There may be considerable variation through the

usually given in terms of the number of pounds per horsepower per hour.
operating regime of the engine, but for weight calculations, the specific

fuel consumption at cruising power is generally selected. The power for


For jet engines, it is given in terms of number of pounds per pound of
cruising speed is usually 2/3 of the rated power rating. The following
thrust per hour. There may be considerable variation through the
formula, applicable to any type engine, may be used conveniently:

w _ (e) (2/3 rated power) (range in miles)


operating regime of the engine, but for weight calculations, the specific
/ cruising speed in miles per hour fuel consumption at cruising power is generally selected. The power for
2. The weight of one gallon of gasoline is 6 pounds.

cruising speed is usually 2/3 of the rated power rating. The following
Oil Weight

1. This weight may be determined: by a formula similar to that for


formula, applicable to any type engine, may be used conveniently:
W (2/3 rated power) (range in miles)
fuel; or by allowing at least 1 gallon of oil for every 16 gallons of fuel; or

by allowing 10 gallons of oil plus an additional gallon for every 20 gallons


= (e)
of fuel. The volume of one gallon is 231 in.8. I cruising speed in miles per hour
2. The weight of one gallon of oil is 8 pounds.

Power Plant Weights


2. The weight of one gallon of gasoline is 6 pounds.
1. Engine weights may be found in Chapter XVI, The Power Plant.

2. Engine controls for a single engine up to 500 hp. = 10-15 lb.


Oil Weight
1. This weight may be determined: by a formula similar to that for
3. Engine mount up to 500 hp, including rubber bushings, bolts, etc.,

= 32-40 lb.

4. Engine mount = 3 to 3^% of gross weight. fuel; or by allowing at least 1 gallon of oil for every 16 gallons of fuel; or
5. Exhaust manifolds:

by allowing 10 gallons of oil plus an additional gallon for every 20 gallons


(a) short stacks = 12-18 lb;

(b) collectors = 30-50 lb;


of fuel. The volume of one gallon is 231 in.3.
(c) (700 hp capacity) = 33M lb to 49 lb.

6. Firewall = 7-10 lb.


2. The weight of one gallon of oil is 8 pounds.
7. Fuel system: piping, clips, etc. = 20-30 lb per engine.

Power Plant Weights


8. Pumps (hand) = 2.5 lb.

1. Engine weights may be found in Chapter XVI, The Power Plant.


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

9. Tanks (welded, riveted aluminum, or aluminum alloy): for oil or

gasoline 10-to 50-gal capacity = 9-30 lb (varies linearly);

2. Engine controls for a single engine up to 500 hp. = 10-15 lb.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

50- to 100-gal capacity = 30-50 lb (varies linearly);

100- to 200-gal capacity = 50-80 lb (varies linearly).


3. Engine mount up to 500 hp, including rubber bushings, bolts, etc.,
= 32-40 lb.
4. Engine mount = 3 to 372% of gross weight.
5. Exhaust manifolds:
(a) short stacks = 12-18 lb;
(b) collectors = 30-50 lb;
(c) (700 hp capacity) = 3372 lb to 4g lb.
6. Firewall = 7-10 lb.
7. Fuel system: piping, clips, etc. = 20-30 lb per engine.
8. Pumps (hand) = 2.5 lb.
9. Tanks (welded, riveted aluminum, or aluminum alloy): for oil or
gasoline 10- to 50-gal capacity = 9-30 lb (varies linearly);
50- to 100-gal capa<'ity = a0:--50 lb (varies linearly);
100- to 200-gal capacity = 50-80 lb (varies linearly).

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
148 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
148

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL 10. Recommended sizes for fuel lines:


10. Recommended sizes for fuel lines:
Wall
Qutside
Outside thicknes&,
diam. (in.)
Purpo1Je Fuel to be delivered diam. (in.) min. (in.)
Wall

thickness,
(a) :From tank to fuel pumps Up to 60 gal/hr ~
min. (in.)
From 60 to 100 gal/hr % 0.040
Purpose
From 100 to 150 gal/hr ~
Fuel to be delivered

(b) (I) Pumps to carburetor, Up to 30 gal/hr % 0.032


(2) Carburetor to overflow From 30 to 60 gal/hr ~
(a)

From tank to fuel pumps

drains From 60 to 100 gal/hr % 0.040


From 100 to 150 gal/hr ~
Up to 60 gal/hr

From 60 to 100 gal/hr

From 100 to 150 gal/hr (c) Fuel pumps, relief lines Same as for item I
H

(d) Primer tubing 0.032


H

H (e) Vents 0.032


0.040

(b)

(1) Pumps to carburetor,


11. Some representative weights for oil coolers:
Up to 30 gal/hr
Rating, hp Approximate weight, lb
From 30 to 60 gal/hr

From 60 to 100 gal/hr


100 4.50
From 100 to 150 gal/hr
100-350 6.65
H
350-450 8.00
0.032
450-550 9.50
0.040
550up 12.10 up
(2) Carburetor to overflow

drains

H
12. Power plant weights for commercial transport airplanes of gro88
H
weights between 20,000 and 100,000 pounds:
(c)

w pp= [ .1155 - 1 ~~~ wg] ·wg.


Fuel pumps, relief lines

Same as for item 1

(d)

Primer tubing

13..For military airplanes of gross weights between 20,000 and 60,000


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

0.032

(e)
pounds:

100~~ wg] wg.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

wpp
Vents

X = [.325 -
0.032

14. For military airplanes of gross weights between 60,000 and 140,000
11. Some representative weights for oil coolers:

Rating, hp Approximate tveight, lb

100 4.50
pounds :

1 ~~ wg] w,.
100-350 6.65

350-450 8.00

450-550 9.50
wpp = [.247 -
550 up 12.10 up

12. Power plant weights for commercial transport airplanes of gross


15. For military airplanes of gross weights between 140,000 and 300,000
weights between 20,000 and 100,000 pounds:

pounds:
w" = [lâ„¢-wmw-]w-

13. For military airplanes of gross weights between 20,000 and 60,000

pounds:

w» - [325— mm w>]w*

14. For military airplanes of gross weights between 60,000 and 140,000

pounds:
Gross Weight
w»'[M7-v&w']w';

In order to obtain some idea of the magnitude of the gross weight of au


15. For military airplanes of gross weights between 140,000 and 300,000

pounds:
airplane before a detailed breakdown is made of the weights of the various
w" = [â„¢-mmw-]w*

components, an estimation on the basis of power loading (W /P) or thrust


Gross Weight

In order to obtain some idea of the magnitude of the gross weight of an

airplane before a detailed breakdown is made of the weights of the various

components, an estimation on the basis of power loading (W/P) or thrust

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 149
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 149

loading (W/T) is often advisable. Multiplying the appropriate ratio by


loading (W /T) is often advisable. Multiplying the appropriate ratio by
the rated horsepower or the static thrust rating yields an approximate

value of the gross weight.


the rated horsepower or the static thrust rating yields an approximate
1. Personal and business airplanes have power loadings as follows: value of the gross weight.
(a) Single-engine planes with horsepower ratings of between 65 and

450 have power loadings (W/P) of between 10 and 16 pounds


1. Personal and business airplanes have power loadings as follows:
per horsepower.

(b) Twin-engine airplanes with total horsepower of between 290 and


(a) Single-engine planes with horsepower ratings of between 65 and
900 have power loadings of between 10 and 12 pounds per horse-
450 have power loadings (WI P) of between 10 and 16 pounds
power. These airplanes usually have higher top speeds and

per horsepower.
higher rates of climb than single-engine airplanes.

2. Civil and military transport airplanes with 2 or 4 engines, each


(b) Twin-engine airplanes with total horsepower of between 290 and
having between 1475 to 3500 horsepower, have power loadings of between

900 have power loadings of between 10 and 12 pounds per horse-


power. These airplanes usually have higher top speeds and
10 to 12.5 pounds per horsepower.

3. Private airplanes with single jet units, operating at speeds less than

500 miles per hour, have thrust loadings (W/T) of between 3.5 to 6.25
higher rates of climb than single-engine airplanes.
pounds of gross weight per pound of thrust.

4. Fighters and interceptors with single jet units, operating between


2. Civil and military transport airplanes with 2 or 4 engines, each
000 and 700 miles per hour, have thrust loadings (W/T) of between 2.5
having between 1475 to 3500 horsepower, have power loadings of between
and 3.85, with the majority at about 3.

5. Transport and bombers with two jet units, operating at speeds of


10 to 12.5 pounds per-horsepower.
about 650 miles per hour, have weight-thrust ratios of between 3.5 and 3.85.
3. Private airplanes with single jet units, operating at speeds less than
6. Transports and bombers with 4, 6, or 8 jet units, operating at speeds

around 650 miles per hour, have weight-thrust ratios of between 4 and
500 miles per hour, have thrust loadings (W /T) of between 3.5 to 6.25
5.75. pounds of gross weight per pound of thrust.
7. Research aircraft operating at speeds between 650 and 1,650 miles

per hour or greater, whether utilizing one or two jet units, have had
4. Fighters and interceptors with single jet units, operating between
weight-thrust ratios of between 2 and 3. 600 and 700 miles per hour, have thrust loadings (W /T) of between 2.5
Miscellaneous Weights

Weights of equipment will vary with type and quantity. See Table
and 3.85, with the majority at about 3.
VIII-2 for some data on representative items. 5. Transport and bombers with two jet units, operating at speeds of
Propeller Weights

For weights of propellers see Chapter XV, The Propeller.


about 650 miles per hour, have weight-thrust ratios of between 3.5 and 3.85.
6. Transports and bombers with 4, 6, or 8 jet units, operating at speeds
around 650 miles per hour, have weight-thrust ratios of between 4 and
5.75.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:03 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

7. Research aircraft operating at speeds between 650 and 1,650 miles


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

per hour or greater, whether utilizing one or two jet units, have had
weight-thrust ratios of between 2 and 3.

Miscellaneous Weights
Weights of equipment will vary with type and quantity. See Table
VIII-2 for some data on representative items.

Propeller Weights
For weights of propellers see Chapter XV, The Propel'ler.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
150 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
150

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table VIII-2. Miscellaneous weights.


TABLE VIIl-2. Miscdl11.neo1111 wcightR.
Item

Weight

(lb)

Weight Item Weight


Item

Item
(lh) (lb)
Weight

(lb)

Ash trays, coat and hat racks00,

service call systems, etc., per


Ash trays, coat and hat rackit, Control system, including dual
passenger 2.5
service call systems, etc., per rudder, pedals, dual wheel
Axe, hand 2.0
passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 control, stabilizer adjust-
Baggage, usual allowance per
Axe, hand.... .. .............. 2.0 ment mechansism, cables,
passenger 40.0

Baggage, usual allowance per rods, pulleys, and supports


(small airplane) .. . .. ... .. . 110-120
passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40.0
Belts, safety 0.75 to 1.1

Berth equipment:

Belts, safety . . . . . ... . . . . . . ... 0.75 to 1.1 Crew and passengers (each per-
Bedsheet 0.5

son) . . . . ....... .. . . .. . .. . 170


Blanket 2.7
Berth equipment:
Mattress 4.8
Bedsheet... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 Curtain .. . . . .. ... . . .... .. . .. . 1.25
Pillow 1.8
Blanket... . ..... . ...... . ... 2.7 Cushion, life preserver .. . . . .. . . 2.00
Pillowcase 0.2

Mattress. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8 Cushion, rubber inflated


Mattress slip 1.4

Pillow....... . .. . .... 1.8 (17 x 19 in.) .......... . .. . 1.30


Upper-berth shock cords 0.1

Pillowcase. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.2 Cushion, rubber inflated


Lower-berth curtain 1.0

Mattress slip. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 (17x29in.) .. ... . .... . .. . 2.14


Upper-berth Rhock cords . . 0.1
Coat hanger 0.1

Cylinders, Oxygen
Lower-berth curtain. . . . . . . . . 1.0
Lower-berth support rail 1.1

Upper-berth step 2.2

Table 4.0
Coat hanger.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 Vol·u me Orer-all length
Case, aircraft data 1.5
Lower-berth support rail. . . . . I.I (ftS) (in.)
Case, airplane mooring 1.3
Upper-berth step.... . . . . . . . . 2.2 7.15 16.5
Case contents, airplane mooring
Table . .. ..... . .. . ... . .... .. 4.0 11.0 22.0
(quantity in parentheses): Case, aircraft data . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 15.2 16.75
Arrow, mooring anchor (18). . 0.2

Case, airplane mooring. . . . . . . . . 1.3 22.0 21.25


Bag, mooring (1) 1.5

Case contents, airplane mooring 28.8 18.25


Eye assembly, mooring anchor

(quantity in parentheses): 38.4 22.00


rod (3) 0.1

Arrow, mooring anchor (18). . 0.2 48.3 26.25


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Pin, mooring ground breaking

(1) 0.7
Bag, mooring ( 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . 1..5 Diameter Weight (lb)
Eye assembly, mooring anchor (in.) Plain Shatterproof
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Rod, mooring anchor (1) 1.2

rod (3) . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1


3.5 .. .... .. 5.1 6.5
Rod, mooring anchor (6) 0.3

Pin, mooring ground breaking


3.5 . .... .. . 6.9 9.1
Case, map: 1.09

Chairs, seats (upholstered):


(I). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7
Al. Alloy-reclining (single seat) 12.0 Rod, mooring anchor (1) . . . 1.2 5.25 . . ... . . 9.7 11.4
Al. Alloy-reclining (double
Rod, mooring anchor (6). . 0.3 5.25 . ... .. . 12.9 15.6
6.75 ...... . 16.4 18.5
seat) 24.5

Case, map . .. .. . : . . . . . . . . . . . 1.09 6.75 ..... . . 20.9 24.1


Steel tubing (nonreclining)... 8.5

Steel tubing (reclining) 13.0


Chairs, seats (upholstered) : 6.75 .. . ... . 26.6 31.0
Wicker (settee) 10.1
Al. Alloy-reclining (single seat) 12.0
Wicker 14.4
Al. Alloy-reclining (double Drinking fountain . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36.0
Steward's seat 9.0
seat) . . .. .. . . . .. . .. . . . .. . 24.5 Engine fire extinguisher. . . . . . . . 80.0
Combustion heaters 17.0
Steel tubing (nonreclining) . . . 8.5 Fire extinguisher. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.0
Steel tubing (reclining). . . . . . 13.0
Cockpit enclosure and fairing

Fire extinguisher (portable,


Wicker (settee) . .. . .. . ..... . 10.1
charged; weight with
(small airplane) 80-100

Control system, including dual Wicker .. . . .. . . . . . . . .. . . .. . 14.4


rudder, pedals, dual wheel
Steward's seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.0 bracket) ... . . . .... . . . . . . . 7.3 to 16
First-aid kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.0
control, stabilizer adjust-

Combustion heaters . . . . . . . . . . . 17 .0
ment mechansism, cables,
Flare, parachute . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19.0
Cockpit enclosure and fairing
rods, pulleys, and supports

(small airplane) ..... . .... . . . 80-100 Flare, bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.0


(small airplane) 110-120

Crew and passengers (each per-

son) 170

Curtain 1.25

Cushion, life preserver 2.00

Cushion, rubber inflated

Original from
(17x19 in.) 1.39

Cushion, rubber inflated


Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
(17x29 in.) 2.14

Cylinders, Oxygen

Volume Over-all length


PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 151
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 151

Table V11I-2. (Continued). Miscellaneous weights.

Item Weight
TABLE VIII-2. (Continued). Miticcllancous wPights.
(ft)

Flashlight 1.75

Flit and spray gun 2.5

- Item Weight Item Weight


Floors, metal (per ft2) 1-1^

(lb) (lb)
Floors, wood (per ft2) 1-1 Vi

Heating and ventilating system,


Flash light ... ... .. .. . . ...... . Back (quick attach-
l.75
including cabin ducts (per

Flit and spray gun . .. ..... . .. . 2.5 able) .... .. .... .. . 19 21


Chair chute ........ . 16U 18U
Floors, metal (per ftt) .. . .. ... . 1-1Y2
passenger) 0.5-10

Holder, flight report 0.86


Chest . .. . ......... . . 20 22
Floors, wood (per ft2) .. . ...... . 1-1~
Holder, paper cup 2.0

Pump:
Holder, paper towel 2.0
Heating and ventilating system, Engine-driven fuel ........ . . 3.0
Holder, magazines 4.0
including cabin ducts (per Engine-driven gear type ..... 5.11
Hydraulic operating system for
passenger) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ti.5-10 Engine-driven vacuum . ..... . 5.1
landing gear and wing flaps

Holder, Bight report .......... . 0.86 Engine-driven vane type .. ... 3.5
(for airplane of gross weight

of 19,000 lb) 120


Holder, paper cup .. . ..... . ... . 2.0 Gear-type hydraulic . .... . . .. 5.9
Ladder, entrance , 9.0 Holder, paper towel .......... . 2.0 Hand-operated hydraulic .. . .. 3.8
1.50 cubic-inch hand hydraulic 3.:l
Lavatory and equipment 45.0

Holder, magazines ............ . 4.0 2.00 cubic-inch hand hydraulic 3.7


Hydraulic operating system for
Machete 2.5

Magazine holders 4.0


Valve-in-line fuel. ... . ....... 3.3
landing gear and wing flaps Raft, life (4 man) .. . ........ ..
Mail or express (allow at least
52.0
(for airplane of gross weight
12V£ cu ft for mail to be car-

of 19,000 lb).... . . . . . . . . . .
120 Railing, entrance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.0
ried for each) 200

Mail bag (with brass padlock) for Ladder, entrance .. . .. , . . . . . . . .


9.0 Regulators, oil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.0
registered mail 6.5

Lavatory and equipment ....... 45.0 Safety belts, each . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.15


Mail bag, iron locked 2.5

Machete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.5 Smoking stand. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.0
Soundproofing materials (per ft2) 0.4-0.75
Mirror (7 x 10 inches) 1.3

Pail (10 quarts), metal 2.0


Magazine holders. . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.0
Dry zero, 2 in. thick..... . ... 0.19
Parachutes
Mail or express (allow at least Balsam wool, Y2 in. thick. . . . 0.18
Irving, 24-ft lap type 18.0

12 Y2 cu ft for mail to be car- Balsam wool, 1 in. thick . . . . . 0.30


Irving, 24-ft slat type 19.5

ried for each). . . . . . . . . . . . .


200
~are parts kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45.0
Mail bag (with brass padlock) for
Irving, 24-ft back type 17.5

Irving, 28-ft back type 24.0

registered mail .......... ~. 6.5 Starter handle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.0


Starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-35
Pilot's seat cushion type 23.5

Mail bag, iron locked. . . . . . . . . .2.5


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Russell, with cushion and back

pad 21.0
Mirror (7 x 10 inches). . . . . . . . . l.3 Toilet, chemical. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.5
Tool kit.... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-25
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Switlik (weights in pounds; in-

Pail (10 quarts), metal. .. . . . . . . 2.0


clude complete equipment):

Parachutes Towel holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.0


Over-

U-ft
Irving, 24-ft lap type . . . . . . . .
18.0 Utility rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.0
size
Irving, 24-ft slat type . . . . . . . .
19.5 Very pistol and cartridge. . . . . . . 7 .0
Pack Type
Irving, 24-ft back type ....... 17.5 Vest, life preserver. . . . . . . . . . . . 2.0
Irving, 28-ft back type. . . . . . .
24.0
Waste can. . ... . . ... . . . . . . . . 4.5
Canopy

Canopy Pilot's seat cushion type. . . . . 23.5


Seat (fixed)
Russell, with cushion and back Water, per ft3 . . ..... ... .. . . .. 62.4
20H
pad ...... . .... ...... .... 21.0 Windshield cleaner:
Seat (quick attachable)

Switlik (weights in pounds; in- Driving head complete with


2iy2

clude complete equipment): revolving blade . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48


23 H

Flexible shaft and housing (62


Back (fixed)

in. long) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.90


18 Over- Metering needle valve. . . . . . . O.Hi
20
24-ft B'ize Motor complete with pump . . :J.25
Item Weight
Pack Type Canopy Canopy Speed control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.87
(lb)

Seat (fixed) ......... . 18~ 20U 2-gallon fluid tank .. .. . . . . . . . 2.25


Back (quick attach-

Seat (quick attachable) 21Y2 23Y2 Weight of fluid (per quart)


Back (fixed) ... ... . . . 18 20 approx . . . . .... . .... .. . . . .
able) 19 21

Chair chute 16^ 18


1.81
Chest 20 22

Pump:

Engine-driven fuel 3.0

Engine-driven gear type 5.9

Engine-driven vacuum 5.1

Engine-driven vane type 3.5


Original from
Gear-type hydraulic 5.9
DI IZ UNIVERSITYOFMICHIGAN
Hand-operated hydraulic 3.8

1.50 cubic-inch hand hydraulic 3.3

2.00 cubic-inch hand hydraulic 3.7


152 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
152

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL TABLE VIIl-3.


Table VIII-3.

High pressure landing-wheel and tail-wheel tires.

Size tire
High prmnmre landing-wheel and tail-whcl'l tirns.
and wheel

Max

static
Wt in pounds,
load
Max Infl subject to Dimensions (in.)
(lb)

Size tire static press change with-


Infl

and wheel load (lbs out notice


per
(lb)
I Over- Sec- Static Flat
press

(lbs
in.) all tion loaded tire
Tire Reg
per

only tube diam diam radius radius


in.)

Wt in pounds•

Landing-Wheel Tires
subject to

change with-

30x5 1,600 30 17.0 2.6 29.76 5.01 13.7 12.0


out notice

26x6 3,750 90 21.4 2.8 25.53 6.53 11.4 8.9


Tire

26x6 3,750 63 26.6 2.8 25.62 6.56 11.4 9.3


only

30x7 4,700 90 28.6 3.8 29.19 7.70 13.0 9.9


Reg

32x8 6,000 90 35.4 4.8 30.84 8.85 13.6 10.0


32x8 6,000 65 46.0 4.8 30.70 8.85 13.6 10.3
tube

Dimensions (in.)

Over-
14.5
all
34x9 7,000 80 51.4 7.3 33.20 9.92 13.9t 10.0
diam
34x9 7,000 55 59.4 7.3 33.30 9.99 14.6 10.6
Sec-
26x6.6 5,000 82 27.4 2.8 25.52 6.53 11.4 9.0
tion
32x8.8 7,500 80 47.9 4.8 30.70 8.85 13.6 10.0
diam
34x9.9 8,500 70 62.7 7.3 33.30 9.99 14.6 11.0
Static

loaded
Tail-Wheel Tires
radius

Landing-Wheel Tires
10x3 400 55 2.1 .4 10.24 3.12 4.5 3.1
30x5
1072x4 1,200 85 3.8 .9 10.35 4.00 4.5 3.5
1,600
1272x472 1,800 75 6.5 1.3 12.25 4.61 5.2 4.1
30
1472x5 2,400 75 9.8 1.9 14.25 5.25 6.0 4.2
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

17.0

2.6
Low-pressure lauding-wheel tires.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

29.76

5.~ 660 25 4.2 1.2 13.18 4.92 5.2 3.6


5.01

13.7

12.0
7.~ 900 20 5.8 1.8 16.38 6.97 6.2 3.4
26x6 8.~ 900 18 7.9 1.8 17.40 8.09 6.6 3.6
3,750

6.0CH> 1,050 24 7.8 1.5 17.45 6.29 6.9 .(5


24 1.8 18.32 6.93 7.3 4.5
90

21.4
7.00-6 1,200 8.9
2.8
6.50-10 1,700 32 13.0 2.6 21.75 6.56 9.1 6.5
25.53
7.50-10 2,400 37 16.2 3.1 23.50 7.57 9.7 6.7
6.53

8.50-10 2,800 35 19.7 4.2 25.62 8.67 10.3 6.8


11.4

8.9
15.00-16 9,500 37 86.1 16.4 42.06 15.16 16.9 10.8
26x6
15.00-16 10,500 43 92.6 16.4 42.05 15.15 16.9 10.9
3,750 16.00-16 13,500 51 110.8 16.4 43.80 16.00 17.4 11.0
63

17.00-16 13,500 48 116.2 19.5 44.48 17.09 17.8 11.3


26.6

17.00-20 20,500 70 135.6 21.7 48.96 17.00 19.9 13.4


2.8

25.62
19.00-23 22,500 63 212.5 27.8 54.92 19.07 22.5 15.9
6.56 8.90xl2.50 1,600 18 18.7 4.5 27.47 8.79 11.3 7.5
11.4

9.3
(Continued)
30x7

4,700

90

28.6

3.8
Original from
29.19
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
7.70

13.0

9.9
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 153
PRELIMINARY WEIGHT ESTIMATE 153

Table VIII-3. (Continued). TABLE VIIl-3. (Continued ) .


Low-profile nose-wheel tires.

Wt in pounds,

subject to Low-profile nose-wheel tires.


Size tire

and wheel

Max
Wt in pounds,
static

Max Infl subject to Dimensions (in.)


load0
size tire static preBl'I change with-
0
and wheel load. (lbs out notice
Ob)

(lb) per
Infl

in.) Over- Sec- Static Flat


press
Tire Reg all tion loaded tire
only tube diam diam radius radius
--
(lbs

change with-
--
out notice
19x6.80--10 1,600 55 12.4 2.4 19.38 6.76 8;7 7.1
Dimensions (in.)
22x7.25-11.50 2,000 55 14.5 3.2 22.08 7.29 9.8 7.8
per

26x9.00-13 3,750 50 30.3 4.2 25.92 8.85 11.6 9.2


Over-

all
30x10.50-15 5,000 50 46.2 6.3 29.98 10.30 13.4 10.6
diam
33xll.50-16.50 5,500 65 48.1 7.9 33.00 11.50 14.7 11.3
Sec-
36x12.50-18 8,500 60 76.0 10.0 36.19 12.33 16.1 12.7
tion

diam

Static

loaded

radius

Flat

tire

radius
TABLE VIIl-4. Floats.
in.)

Tire

I
I
only

Reg
I Air-
tube
Oi11- Number plane Maxi-
19x6.80—10
place- of Airphrnc plus Float mum Length Tread Draft
ment com part- weight floats weight width (ft) (in.) (in.)
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1,600

55 (lb) men ts (lh) weight (lb) (in.)


I
(lb) I
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

12.4

2.4
- -
19.38

1140 5 950-1,040 1,140 150 97~ 13' 5" 75 12


6.76

1320 6 1,040-1,200 1,320 163 97~ 14' 8" 75 12


8;7

1620 5 1,200-1,'440 1,620 236 112 14' 6" 85 14


7.1

1965 6 1,440-1,765 1,965 276 112~ 16' 6" 85 14~


22x7.25—11.50

2425 5 1,765-2,205 2,425 336 123 17' O" 94 16~


2880 6 2,205-2,630 2,880 377 123 19' O" 94 16~
2,000

3430 5 2,400-3,300 3,610 475 132~~ 19' 4" 100 18~


55

4000 6 3,300-3,800 4,210 535 136~ 21' 4" 104 19


14.5

4580 5 151~ 21' 3" 114% 20


3.2

3,800-4, 180 4,580 570


143~ 20' 9" 106 22
22.08

4665 6 4,000-4,450 4,900 638


20
7.29

5250 6 4,180-4,820 5,250 630 152 23' 3" 115


124~e
9.8

7.8
5870 6 4,990-5,430 5,870 680 164 23' 1" 22
26x9.00—13
6560 6 5,430-6,080 6,560 750 164 24' 10" 124%e 22
3,750

50

30.3

4.2

25.92

8.85

11.6

9.2

30x10.50—15

5,000

Original from
50

46.2
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
6.3

29.98

10.30
154 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
154

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL TABLE VIIl-5. Fabricated components-Float11.


Table VIII-5. Fabricated components—Floats.

Estimated Added Weight

Gross Weight of Original of Floats Replacing


Estimated Added Weight
Land00plane (lb) Landing Gear (lb) Gross Weight of Original of Floats Replacing
1,125 106
Landplane (lb) Landing Gear (lb)
1,620 180

1,125 106
1,965 200

1,620 180
2,425 230

1,965 200
2,425 230
2,880 260

2,880
3,610 313

4,210 363
260
4,910 397
3,610 313
5,680 417
4,210 363
6,560 437
4,910 397
Table VIII-6. Hydraulic equipment.
5,680 417
Weight (lb)
6,560 437
Actuating Cylinders: .

Working

Strohe(in.) Pressure (psi)

Landing gear 50068 1,500 8

Landing gear 10.80 1,500 9


TABLE Vlll--0. H~·draulic equipment.
Wing flap 4.25 1,500 3.75

WngflaJ 4.75 1,500 8.75

Door operating 4.30 1,500 3.06


Weight (lb)
Pin pulling 2.69 150 3
Actuating Cylinders:
Nose wheel — l>700 8du
Working
Length (in.)
Stroke(in.) Pressure (psi)
Extended Retracted
Landing gear .............. ... ..... . 5.68 1,500 8
47 28 1,000 28
Landing gear ................ . ..... . 10.80 1,500 9
57 31 1.000 5
Wing flap ......................... . 4.25 1,500 3.75
49 21.75 1,100 13
Wing flap .................... . .... . 4.75 1,500 8.75
11.5 3 1,250 5.5

Door operating .................... . 4.30 1,500 3.06


17.75 11.5 1,250 4.5

Pin pulling ........................ . 2.69 150 3


33 19.75 1,000 5.5

Nose wheel. .. .................... . 1,700 8.30


41.5 26.5 1,000 17.5

Length (in.)
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

32 18 1,500 4.75

17 12 1,000 5.25
Extended Retracted
47 28 1,000 28
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

29.5 18.5 1,500 15

17.75 11.5 1,250 6

57 31 1,000 5
20 13.5 1,250 5.25

49 21.75 1,100 13
17.75 11.5 1,250 6.5

11.5 3 1,250 5.5


Accumulators:

17.75 11.5 1,250 4.5


1,000 5.5
9 in. dia., 240 in.» J*

33 19.75
17.5
10 in. dia., 532 in.»

5 in. dia., 69 in.» 3 50


41.5 26.5 1,000
Pump, metering....... . • • • •....... :•
32 18 1,500 4.75
Pump, hand (1,350 in.-lb at 1,500 psi less handle) 2.20
17 12 1,000 5.25
29.5 18.5 1,500 15
17.75 11.5 1,250 6
20 13.5 1,250 5.25
17.75 11.5 1,250 6.5

Accumulators:
9 in. dia., 240 in.1 ••.•••••.• . • • • • • • • • • • • . . . . . . . • . • • . . . . . • • • • • • . • 18
10 in. dia., 532 in.•... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.95
5 in. dia., 69 in.1 •• • • • • • • . . • • . • . • • • . • . • . • . . . . . • • • • . . . . • • . • • • • • • • 3.50
Pump, metering.............. .. ................................. 2.75
Pump, hand (1,350 in.-lb at 1,500 psi less handle) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER IX

The Balance Diagram

The balance diagram shows the location of the centers of gravity of the

components of the airplane as well as its contents. These centers of

gravity are usually indicated by reference to suitable horizontal and ver-

tical datum planes which may fall outside the drawing of the airplane

structure itself. For ease in calculation, these reference planes are so


CHAPTER IX
chosen that all moment arms are of the same sign. For use in the field,

however, the balance diagram is redrawn to show the location of the cen-

ters of gravity with reference to a point (usually the leading edge of the

The Balance Diagram


wing at the root) which may be easily located on the airplane.

GENERAL PROCEDURE

To be sure that the centers of gravity are located correctly, it is desir-

able to draw or refer to an inboard profile drawing showing the location of

all the main items drawn to scale.

Along with the balance diagram, there is a balance table listing all the

items contained in the weight estimate, with their weights and center of

gravity locations, as well as the vertical and horizontal moments. Calcu-

lations for various possible centers of gravity for the complete airplane

are included.

The balance diagram shows the location of the centers of gravity of the
components of the airplane as well as its contents. These centers of
In an airplane the center of gravity, or "balance point," may change

while in flight. For example, the fuel and oil are being used up at a con-

stant rate and, therefore, some of the weight disappears so that the center
gravity are usually indicated by reference to suitable horizontal and ver-
of gravity may change. Another case may occur when the balance is cor-

rect with the passenger cabin filled. What happens when there are no
tical datum planes which may fall outside the drawing of the airplane
passengers, or only a few? Suppose again, that there are only a few pas-
structure itself. For ease in calculation, these reference planes are so
sengers in a large cabin and when the flight starts, they sit in the forward

chosen that all moment arms are of the same sign. For use in the field,
however, the balance diagram is redrawn to show the location of the cen-
portion of the cabin, but later decide to sit in the rear?

These possible changes caused by what may be called the "disposable

load" (although rightly the crew is included ordinarily in the term) have ters of gravity with reference to a point (usually the leading edge of the
to be considered when the design of an airplane is contemplated.

155
wing at the root) which may be easily located on the airplane.
GENERAL PROCEDURE
To be sure that the centers of gravity are located correctly, it is desir-
able to draw or refer to an inboard profile drawing showing the location of
all the main items drawn to scale.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Along with the balance diagram, there is a balance table listing all the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

items contained in the weight estimate, with their weights and center of
gravity locations, as well as the vertical and horizontal moments. Calcu-
lations for various possible centers of gravity for the complete airplane
are included.
In an airplane the center of gravity, or "balance point," may change
while in flight. For example, the fuel and oil are being used up at a con-
stant rate and, therefore, some of the weight disappears so that the center
of gravity may change. Another case may occur when the balance is cor-
rect with the passenger cabin filled. What happens when there are no
passengers, or only a few? Suppose again, that there are only a few pas-
sengers in a large cabin and when the flight starts, they sit in the forward
portion of the cabin, but later decide to sit in the rear?
These possible changes caused by what may be called the "disposable
load" (although rightly the crew is included ordinarily in the term) have
to be considered when the design of an airplane is contemplated.
155

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
156 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
156

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


The balance diagram is such a study. It starts as a preliminary instal-
The balance diagram is such a study. It starts as a preliminary instal-
lation diagram, and therefore the fuselage becomes the first object in air-
lation diagram, and therefore the fuselage becomes the first object in air-

plane design since it normally houses all the items that may change in
plane design since it normally houses all the items that may change in
character, number, or location.
character, number, or location.
In a single-engine passenger airplane, for example, with the engine in

In a single-engine passenger airplane, for example, with the engine in


the nose of the fuselage, the procedure in obtaining a likely balance dia-
the nose of the fuselage, the procedure in obtaining a likely balance dia-

gram is to draw the engine and engine accessories accurately to scale, then

the firewall, then the pilot's cockpit, then the passenger cabin, in the order
gram is to draw the engine and engine accessories accurately to scale, then
in which they normally occur. They are arranged according to the de-

signer's wishes and drawn accurately to scale.


the firewall, then the pilot's cockpit, then the passenger cabin, in the order
This arrangement or installation serves several purposes. It is similar
in which they normally occur. They are arranged according to the de-
to the designing of a house by an architect who knows that he has to place

signer's wishes and drawn accurately to scale.


This arrangement or installation serves several purposes. It is similar
the kitchen, bedrooms, bathrooms, and the like to provide the maximum

of comfort and convenience. At the same time these arrangements help

to determine certain dimensions of the house. This principle applies also


to the designing of a house by an architect who knows that he has to place
to airplane design. The placement of the engine compartment, the pilot's

cockpit, and the passenger cabin will affect the length of the fuselage, its
the kitchen, bedrooms, bathrooms, and the like to provide the maximum
size, and weight.
of comfort and convenience. At the same time these arrangements help
After the interior arrangements have been placed more or less as they

to determine certain dimensions of the house. This principle applies also


to airplane design. The placement of the engine compartment, the pilot's
are wanted, a preliminary investigation is made to find out how much the

center of gravity of the fuselage and its contents vary when a certain num-

ber of passengers are removed. It may be found that because of first dic- cockpit, and the passenger cabin will affect the length of the fuselage, its
tates for passenger comfort, too much space has been allotted between

seats so that when the rear seats of the cabin are empty the center of
size, and weight.
gravity is too far forward; or the reverse is true when the front passenger
After the interior arrangements have been placed more or less as they
seats are empty. Thus the seats should be a little closer so that having a
are wanted, a preliminary investigation is made to find out how much the
few seats empty will not make so great a difference.

Very often, the designer is overgenerous in allowing for passenger com-


center of gravity of the fuselage and its contents vary when a certain num-
fort and finds that giving too much fore and aft room makes for poor bal- ber of passengers are removed. It may be found that because of first dic-
ance for the various possible flight-loading conditions. Likewise, allow-

tates for passenger comfort, too much space has been allotted between
ing too much height for the passengers may increase the cross-sectional

area of the fuselage so much that performance eventually will be impaired.


seats so that when the rear seats of the cabin are empty the center of
The top view is usually left to the last, unless the passenger accommo-
gravity is too far forward; or the reverse is true when the front passenger
dations are not in rows.

It is usually wise not to give too much space for the engine compartment,
seats are empty. Thus the seats should be a little closer so that having a
few seats empty will not make so great a difference.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the pilot's cockpit, or the passenger cabin. Especially in the first solution

is it desirable to keep to minimum dimensions to avoid grief. Unfortu-

Very often, the designer is overgenerous in allowing for passenger com-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

nately, generosity is denied the designer. He must learn to take advan-

tage of many small factors instead of a few large ones. To the uninitiated,
fort and finds that giving too much fore and aft room makes for poor bal-
the balance diagram may seem simple, but it is really the crux of the entire
ance for the various possible flight-loading conditions. Likewise, allow-
design. If the rules laid down subsequently in this chapter are obeyed,

there is comparatively easy sailing ahead.


ing too much height for the passengers may increase the cross-sectional
After the preliminary three-view and preliminary weight estimate one
area of the fuselage so much that performance eventually will be impaired.
The top view is usually left to the last, unless the passenger accommo-
dations are not in rows.
It is usually wise not to give too much space for the engine compartment,
the pilot's cockpit, or the passenger cabin. Especially in the first solution
is it desirable to keep to minimum dimensions to avoid grief. Unfortu-
nately, generosity is denied the designer. He must learn to take advan-
tage of many small factors instead of a few large ones. To the uninitiated,
the balance diagram may seem simple, but it is really the crux of the entire
design. If the rules laid down subsequently in this chapter are obeyed,
there is comparatively easy sailing ahead.
After the preliminary three-view and preliminary weight estimate one

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE BALANCE DIAfiRAM 157
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM

157
proceeds to the preliminary balance diagram. This includes part of the
proceeds to the preliminary balance diagram. This includes part of the

installation diagram or inboard profile as well, because arrangements have


installation diagram or inboard profile as well, because arrangements have
to be substantially correct to assure a balance diagram of reasonable
to be substantially correct to assure a balance diagram of reasonable
accuracy.

accuracy.
CENTER OF GRAVITY LOCATION

The center of gravity location along the chord of the wing determines

the pitching moments of the airplane. In order to get the airplane to trim
CENTER OF GRAVITY LOCATION
at a given angle of attack, it is necessary to have the sum of the pitching

moments equal to zero at that angle of attack. In the conventional air-


The center of gravity location along the chord of the wing determines
plane, the pitciiing moments produced by the aerodynamic forces acting
the pitching moments of the airplane. In order to get the airplane to trim
on the wing are counterbalanced by the pitching moments of the tail sur-

at a given angle of attack, it is necessary to have the sum of the pitching


moments equal to zero at that angle of attack. In the conventional air-
faces. The pitching moments produced by the fuselage usually play but

a small part.

The forces and moments acting on a typical low-wing monoplane are plane, the pitc.1ing moments produced by the aerodynamic forces acting
shown in the figure given in Chapter III, Airfoil Selection. The resultant

of the parasite resistance, which includes the drag of the tail surfaces, is
on the wing are counterbalanced by the pitching moments of the tail sur-
assumed to act through the center of gravity, primarily to simplify the
faces. The pitching moments produced by the fuselage usually play but
calculations to be made (although it is partially justified by wind-tunnel

a small part.
The forces and moments acting on a typical low-wing monoplane are
measurements). For further simplification the thrust is assumed to act

through the center of gravity.

The pitching moments about the center of gravity may then be expressed shown in the figure given in Chapter III, Airfoil Selection. The resultant
as follows:

MC.B. = Ma.c. + LwyiC sin a + LwXiC cos a — DwyiC sin a +


of the parasite resistance, which includes the drag of the tail surfaces, is
DuXiC sin a — LtXzC cos at — Lty2C sin at
assumed to act through the center of gravity, primarily to simplify the
qCSCif,.,. = qCSCM.p. + qCSCL(.Xi cos a + j/i sin a) + qCSCD (x sin a

calculations to be made (although it is partially justified by wind-tunnel


— j/i cos a) — qCSCi.,St/8 cos at y2 sin at),

and simplifying further:


measurements). For further simplification the thrust is assumed to act
Cm.*. — Cm.*. + Xi(Cl cos a + Cd sin a) + j/i(Ct sin a — through the center of gravity.
CD cos a) — y2CuStia

where cos at has been considered equal to 1, sin at negligible, and the drag
The pitching moments about the center of gravity may then be expressed
of the tail surfaces included in the parasite drag, and where:
as follows:
q =y*pv\

v = speed of the airplane at the trim angle in feet per second,


Mc. 11 • = Ma.c. + Lwy1C sin a + Lwx1C cos a - Dwy1C sin a +
S = wing area in square feet,

Dwx1C sin a - L,x,,C cos a, - L1y2C sin a,


C = mean aerodynamic chord in feet,

+ qCSCL(X1 cos a+ Y1 sin a) + qCSCD (x sin a


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:14 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Cl, Cd, and Cm.... = aerodynamic characteristics of the wing,

Cl, = lift coefficient of the horizontal tail surfaces,


qCSCM•.,. = qCSCM....
- Y1 cos a) - qCSCL,S11s (x2 cos a, Y2 sin a,),
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Cm.*. = moment coefficient of the wing airfoil about its aerodynamic

center,

and simplifying further:


CM,.,. = CM.... + x1(CL cos a+ CD sin a) + Y1(CL sin a -
CD cos a) - Y2CL.S11s
where cos a, has been considered equal to 1, sin a, negligible, and the drag
of the tail surfaces included in the parasite drag, and where:
q = ~ p v2,
v = speed of the airplane at the trim angle in feet per second,
S = wing area in square feet,
C = mean aerodynamic chord in feet,
CL, CD, and CM.... = aerodynamic characteristics of the wing,
CL. = lift coefficient of the horizontal tail surfaces,
CM•.•. = moment coefficient of the wing airfoil about its aerodynamic
center,

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
158 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
158

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


CM.... = pitching moment coefficient of the airplane about its center of
Cm.*. =

gravity,
Lw qCLS,
Lw —

Da =
=
DP =
D"' = qCDS,
Ma.c. =

Me.,. =
n,, = qcD.s,
Lt
Ma.c. = qCM....CS,
pitching moment coefficient of the airplane about its center of

Mc.(/. = qCM....cs,
L, qCL,81,
gravity,

qCLS,
=
qCDS,

qCD,S,

qCM„.cs,

qCLjSt,
;~g l = {moment
X<JC (
arms of force vectors about center of gravity.
Fig. IIl-1.
See
7 moment arms of force vectors about center of gravity.

J Fig. III-l.
Y2C)
See

To account for the fact that the air velocity over the tail surfaces may
To account for the fact that the air velocity over the tail surfaces may
not be so great as that over the wing, the quantity in is usually not be so great as that over the wing, the quantity in CL.Sits is usu1:1-lly
0.8

^04

.I

§

6-0.4

ac-<~

-y

1+

*1

â– 'i<

e
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

^+1

\
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

• —r

^+05

N\

0.5

Complete N

Wing nlane*^

airplane

\^

___ Wing alone


\

v
_ _Complete
\
-l 2 ._______.1--_ __.__~--~~a'~"~p~la._n_e__~~--......pi-.:,..--~
-4e
-I
8*

12' 16°

Figure IX-1. Wing pitching moments—the effect of moving the center of gravity

along a line parallel to the wing chord and through the aerodynamic center.

_40 4• go 12° 16°


FIGU RE IX- 1. Wing pitching moments- the effect of moving the center of gravity
along a line parallel to the wing chord and through the aerodynamic center.

Original from
D iz
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM 159
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM

159
multiplied by a factor, often assumed as 0.8 to account for a decreased
multiplied by a factor, often assumed as 0.8 to account for a decreased

velocity of about 0.9 over the wing.


velocity of about 0.9 over the wing.
The pitching moments due to the aerodynamic forces on the wing alone
The pitching moments due to the aerodynamic forces on the wing alone
have been calculated for a number of center of gravity locations and have

have b<'en calculated for a number of center of gravity locations and have
been plotted in Figures IX-1 and IX-2. It will be noted that moving the
been plotted in Figures IX-1 and IX-2. It will be noted that moving the

center of gravity longitudinally along the chord has a greater effect upon

the pitching moments than moving the center of gravity perpendicularly


center of gravity longitudinally along the chord has a greater effect upon
to the chord.

Superimposed upon these curves is another representing the desired


the pitching moments than moving the center of gravity perpendicularly
slope and angle of trim for the pitching moment curves for the complete
to the chord.
airplane. The difference in pitching moments for the complete airplane

Superimposed upon these curves is another representing the desired


slope and angle of trim for the pitching moment curves for the complete
and for the wing alone represents the pitching moments that would have

to be supplied by the horizontal tail surfaces.

Since the pitching moments of the horizontal tail surfaces are propor- airplane. The difference in pitching moments for the complete airplane
tional to XtCjJSt, it can be seen immediately that the larger the tail mo-

and for the wing alone represents the pitching moments that would have
ment required, the larger either the tail length x2C should be, or the

greater the horizontal tail area St should be, or the combination of both.
to be supplied by the horizontal tail surfaces.
Further, the slope of the pitching moment curve is a function of the slope
Since the pitching moments of the horizontal tail surfaces are propor-
12'

16* 20°
tional to x 2CL,S,, it can be seen immediately that the larger the tail mo-
Figure IX-2. Wing pitching moments—the effect of moving the center of gravity
ment required, the larger either the tail length x 2C should be, or the
perpendicular to the wing chord and through the aerodynamic center.

greater the horizontal tail area S, should be, or the combination of both.
Further, the slope of the pitching moment curve is a function of the slope

y
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

+as

12• /6• 20°


FIGURE IX-2. Wing pitching moments-the effect of moving the center of gravity
perpendicular to the wing chord and through the aerodynamic center.

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
160 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
160

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


dCd da of the lift curve of the tail surfaces.This slope is determined by
dd/da of the lift curve of the tail surfaces. This slope is determined by

the aspect ratio of the tail surfaces and the larger the aspect ratio, the
the aspect ratio of the tail surfaces and the larger the aspect ratio, the
greater the slope.
greater the slope.
Practical Solution

In order to obtain the right degree of stability with the necessary amoun t
Practical Solution
of control, the center of gravity of the airplane is placed usually as close to

the aerodynamic center of the wing as possible while the horizontal tail
In order to obtain the right degree of stability with the necessary amount
surfaces are placed from to 3 times the mean aerodynamic chord be-

of control, the center of gravity of the airplane is placed usually as close to


hind the aerodynamic center of the wing.

the aerodynamic center of the wing as possible while the horizontal tail
surfaces are placed from 272 to 3 times the mean aerodynamic chord be-
Center of Gravity Movement

Since the airplane has to carry a variable payload from time to time, it

is necessary to know how much movement may be tolerated in the location

hind the aerodynamic center of the wing.


of the airplane center of gravity. An investigation can be carried out for

Center of Gravity Movement


the given design by calculating the pitching moments for the complete

airplane for different center of gravity locations.

If the center of gravity is moved ahead of its design position, the air-

Since the airplane has to carry a variable payload from time to time, it
plane will be more stable, but will trim with the same horizontal tail sur-

face configuration as for the original center of gravity position at a smaller


is necessary to know how much movement may be tolerated in the location
angle of attack. This condition is referred to sometimes as the "nose-
of the airplane center of gravity. An investigation can be carried out for
heavy" condition. If the center of gravity is moved rearward, the air-

plane will be less stable and, with the same tail surface configuration, will
the given design by calculating the pitching moments for the complete
trim at a higher angle of attack. This is known as the "tail-heavy" con-
airplane for different center of gravity locations.
dition.

If the center of gravity is moved ahead of its design position, the air-
plane will be more stable, but will trim with the same horizontal tail sur-
The general rule is that the center of gravity of the completed airplane

should not change more than 10 to 14 per cent of the mean geometric

chord of the wing between the fully loaded condition and a condition
face configuration as for the original center of gravity position at a smaller
corresponding to the most rearward or most forward position of the center

of gravity (not necessarily the fully empty condition). The center of


angle of attack. This condition is referred to sometimes as the "nose-
gravity travel could be restricted to about 7% of the chord ahead of the
heavy" condition. If the center of gravity is moved rearward, the air-
center of gravity, and to about 7% of the chord behind the center of

plane will be less stable and, with the same tail surface configuration_, will
trim at a higher angle of attack. This is known as the "tail-heavy" con-:
gravity. For tailless designs the center of gravity movement is limited

to about 5 or 6 per cent of the mean aerodynamic chord. This means

that for an airplane weighing 10,000 pounds, fully loaded, which has a dition.
mean geometric chord of 100 inches, the movement for a condition less

than fully loaded should not be more than 8 inches. When the fuselage The general rule is that the eenter of gravity of the completed airplane
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

and its contents are considered alone (as they would be in preliminary

should not change more than IO to 14 per cent of the mean geometric
calculations) this movement for the same airplane may be greater, say

chord of the wing between the fully loaded condition and a condition
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

12 per cent, or 12 inches in this case.

For preliminary design, an eight per cent travel in the center of gravity
corresponding to the most rearward or most forward position of the center
movement is used. If the airplane were highly stable for the fully-loaded

condition, then an eight per cent movement forward would increase the
of gravity (not necessarily the fully empty condition). The center of
gravity travel could be restricted to about 7% of the chord ahead of the
center of gravity, and to about 73 of the chord behind the center of
gravity. For tailless designs the center of gravity movement is limited
to about 5 or 6 per cent of the mean aerodynamic chord. Thii; means
that for an airplane weighing 10,000 pounds, fully loaded, which has a
mean geometric chord of 100 inches, the movement for a condition less
than fully loaded should not be more than 8 inches. When the fuselage
and its contents are considered alone (as they would be in preliminary
calculation1::1) this movement for the same airplane may be greater, say
12 per cent, or 12 inches in this case.
For preliminary design, an eight per cent travel in the center of gravity
movement is used. If the airplane were highly stable for the fully-loaded
conditi~m, then an eight per cent movement forward would increase the

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM 161
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM

stability and would therefore be undesirable. Similarly, if the airplane


161

stability and would therefore be undesirable. Similarly, if the airplane

had the minimum stability for the loaded condition, then an eight per had the minimum stability for the loaded condition, then an eight per
cent movement rearward would decrease the longitudinal stability.

cent movement rearward would decrease the longitudinal stability.


Therefore, in order to determine whether the airplane has sufficient

stability, it is incumbent upon the designer to carefully analyze the design


Therefore, in order to determine whether the airplane has sufficient
after the balance diagram and the general configuration have been set.
stability, it is incumbent upon the designer to carefully analyze the design
After detailed static longitudinal calculations have been made for the

fully loaded airplane, some restrictions can be set on the movement of the
after the balance diagram and the general configuration have been set.
center of gravity location for variously loaded conditions.

After detailed static longitudinal calculations have been made for the
fully loaded airplane, some restrictions can be set on the movement of the
1. If longitudinal stability is more than adequate, the center of gravity

movement should be primarily to the rear.

2. If longitudinal stability is less than adequate, the center of gravity center of gravity location for variously loaded conditions.
l. If longitudinal stability is more than adequate, the center of gravity
movement should be forward.

3. If longitudinal stability is just adequate, the center of gravity move-

ment may be equally forward and rearward. movement should be primarily to the rear.
2. If longitudinal stability is less than adequate, the center of gravity
THE FUSELAGE AND ITS CONTENTS

Starting with the fuselage and its contents, each item from the nose of

the fuselage rearward is placed carefully to scale. movement should be forward.


:~. If longitudinal stability is just adequate, the center of gravity move-
When the fuselage and its contents are located, the center of gravity of

the fuselage and its contents are determined. In the calculations to de-

cide upon the center of gravity, the horizontal and vertical tail surfaces
ment may be equally forward and rearward.
should be included as factors.

To determine the center of gravity, two datum lines are chosen: one

through the center of the propeller in case of a single-engine airplane, or THE FUSELAGE AND ITS CONTENTS
tangent to the foremost point on the airplane for the. horizontal arms of

the individual items; another, usually the ground line, for the vertical
Starting with the fuselage and its contents, each item from the nose of
arms. It is desirable to choose these datum lines so that the arms are all the fuselage rearward is placed carefully to scale.
of the same signs, thus avoiding possible errors in addition.

When the fuselage and its contents are located, the center of gravity of
Sometimes a number of diagrams are made until the final center of

gravity of the whole group is located where the designer wants it. Figure
the fuselage and its contents are determined. In the calculations to de-
IX-3 shows one way in which a diagram may be presented.

cide upon the center of gravity, the horizontal and vertical tail surfaces
should be included as factors.
The calculations should be set up in the form of a table, listing all items

included in the fuselage and its contents. Table IX-1 has been set up

as a guide for the balance calculations to be made. To determine the center of gravity, two datum lines are chosen: one
It should be noted that it is convenient to lump together small items

through the center of the propeller in case of a single-engine airplane, or


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

located at about the same spot and determine the center of gravity of the

group by inspection. Otherwise, determination of the center of gravity


tangent to the foremost point on the airplane for the. horizontal arms of
the individual items; another, usually the ground line, for the vertical
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of the airplane becomes a series of tedious calculations. The error that

arms. It is desirable to choose these datum lines so that the arms are all
may be caused by such a method is certainly not large, as a few simple

calculations will demonstrate to the most skeptical.

Even in multi-engine designs, where the engines are attached to the


of the same signs, thus avoiding possible errors in addition.
Sometimes a number of diagrams are made until the final center of
gravity of the whole group is located where the designer wants it. Figure
IX-3 shows one way in which a diagram may be presented.
The calculations should be set up in the form of a table, listing all items
included in the fuselage and its contents. Table IX-1 has been set up
as a guide for the balance calculations to be made.
It should be noted that it is convenient to lump together small items
located at about the same spot and determine the center of gravity of the
group by inspection. Otherwise, determination of the center of gravity
of the airplane becomes a series of tedious calculations. The error that
may be caused by such a method is certainly not large, as a few simple
calculations will demonstrate to the most skeptical.
Even in multi-engine designs, where the engines are attached to the

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

0
Horizontal moment arm from vertical datum line given here

.4 - -
C l)
t,;)

us
-
N.
(I)
0.
- W--4 ---I

a'
'<
()
= ~'
;i...
0 ~
& ~
-
( i) 11 I I '+'-

-r+
;i...

~
t:1

I
~

c
:z:
<
~o
V'I .. ~
:::::; iC ~
-< :;
0 Cl The item may be named, its weight given, and it s vert ical ~
:ca3
-n-

fl
moment arm indicated from designated horizontal datum line to-

::x:
C"1
>
:::z

FIGURE IX-3. A partially completed balance diagram showing one way in which the diagram may be presented. If t here
are too many items, the centers of gravity of the individual items may be designated by numbers with Table Vl- 1 giving further
details. For easy reference the horizontal and verticai datum lines may be represented as linear scales.
TABLE IX-1. Typical balance calculation data.
Table IX-1. Typical balance calculation data.

(1)
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
.(2) Distance Distance
Distance from from
(3)
Weight vertical Horizontal horizontal Vertical
(4)
Item in lb datum moment datum moment
Distance

(5)
1. Propeller . . . . . . . . . . . . .................... .................... .................... ................... ....................
from

vertical
2. Engine . . ... ... . . . . . . .................... .................... .................... .................... ....................
datum 3·: · Starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ............................................................ ........................................
from

4.· Hotspot . . . ...... . .. . .................... ........................................ ........................................


horizontal

datum
..5. Airscoop. . . . . . . . . . . . . .................... ........................................ ........................................
Weight

6. Engine cowl . .. .. . . ... .................... .................... ··········--··-··-·· ·-----·--·····-·--·· ·-·············--···


in lb

Horizontal
7. Engine mount ..... . . . .................... ................................................................................
moment 8. Oil tank .. . .. .. . ......................... ............................................................ ....................
Vertical

9. Oil. . .. . ... . ..... . ... ........................................ .................... .................... ....................


moment

Item
10. Instruments .. . . .. ... . ........................................ ................... . .................... ....................
•
11 . Pilot ............ ... . ................................................................................ ....................
12. Co-pilot . ........ .... ........................................ .................... ....................................... .
2. Engine

^Starter

X Hotspot 13. Pilots' seats ...... . .. . ................................................................................ ....................


/ST^Oiltank

14. Controls . . ... . ...... ..................... .................... .................... .................... ....... .............
9. Oil

11. Pilot
15. Baggage (fore) .. . .. . . .................... .................... ........................................ ................... .
12. Co-pilot
16. Two seats ................................ ........................................ .................... ....................
17. Two seats ....... .... ......................................... .................... ........................................
13. Pilots' seats

14. Controls

16. Two seats _W . Two seats .. . . .. .... . ......................................... .................... .................... ....................
^STTwo seats

l9. Two seats . . . .. . . .. ....................... ........................................ .................... ....................


10. Two seats

20.' Two seats


20. Two seats ...... .. .. .. .................... .................... ............................................................
24. Two passengers
21. Two passengers . . . . . . ......................................... ........................................ ................... .
22. Two passengers . .. . . . . .................... ............................................................ ................... .
28. Radio equipment
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

,29^ Lighting

31. Fuselage structure 23. Two passengers . .. . ... .................... .................... ............................................................
24. Two passengers ... . . .. ........................................ .................... .................... ....................
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

32. Vertical tail surfaces

33. Horizontal tail surfaces

34. Tail wheel and gear...


25. Two passengers . .. . .. : .................... ........................................ .................... ....................
^ Fuel tanks
26. Stewardess ..... . . .. . . .................... .................... .................... .................... ....................
27. Cabin furnishings . . . . . .................... ............................................................ ....................
37. Fuel

163

28. R.adio equipment . . .. . .................... .................... ............................................................


29.·· Lighting ................................. .................... .................... ....................................... .
30. Baggage (rear) . . . . .. . .................... .................... .................... ........................................
31. Fuselage structure . . . . .................... .................... .................... ................................... ,....
32. Vertical tail surfaces . . ............................................................ .................... ................... .
33. Horizontal tail surfaces .................... .................... .................... .................... ................... .
34. Tail wheel and gear . . ......................................... .................... .................... ....................
35. Wing ....... . ... .. ... ........................................ .................... .................... ....................
~- Fuel tanks . .... . ..... .................... .................... ............................................................
37. Fuel .... .......... . .. .................... ........................................ .................... ....................
38. Landing gear . . . . . . . . . ........................................ .................... .................... ....................

Totals ..... . ........ .................... ............................................................ ....................


163
Original from
01 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
164 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
164

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Column 1 = sum of a.11 weight items;


Column 1 = sum of all weight items;

Column 3 = sum of all horizontal moment calculations;

Column 3 = sum of a.11 horizontal moment calculations;


Column 2 = H

ZM/r totals in column 3

Column 2 = ii = };M11 = tote.ls in column 3.


};W tote.ls in column 1'
XW totals in column l'

Column 5 = sum of all vertical moment calculations;

„ . , Tr tMy totals in column 5

Column 4 = 7= ——0 0 = — .


Column 5 = sum of a.11 vertical moment calculations;
V=
2JV totals in column 1

wings, it is usually desirable to treat the engines with the fuselage as a unit,
Column 4 = };Mv = tote.ls in column 5
since the fore and aft position of the engines is determined by the location
};W totals in column 1·
of the plane of rotation of the propeller with reference to the occupants of

the fuselage. The supporting structure making up the engine nacelle will

then be 00constructed later when the wing has been placed in its correct

position.

The reason that it is generally more desirable to follow this procedure


wings, it is usually desirable to treat the engines with the fuselage as a unit,
is that the wing planf orm and spar locations may undergo several revisions since the fore and aft position of the engines is determined by the location
in order to get suitable attachment points for the spars at the fuselage that

of the plane of rotation of the propeller with reference to the occupants of


will not interfere with any internal arrangements. With each spar loca-

tion or wing planform, however, the original position of the engines re-
the fuselage. The supporting structure making up the engine nacelle will
mains the same.
then be -constructed later when the wing has been placed in its correct
The mean aerodynamic chord is fixed with relation to the center of

gravity of the complete airplane, but any wing planform having the same
position.
length and location of the mean aerodynamic chord may be used. (See The reason that it is generally more desirable to follow this procedure
Figure IX-4.) The terms mean geometric chord and mean aerodynamic

is that the wing planform and spar locations may undergo several revisions
chord are often used interchangeably.

Likewise, the engine is more or less fixed, either because of center of


in order to get suitable attachment points for the spars at the fuselage that
gravity location requirements for the complete airplane or, more likely,
will not interfere with any internal arrangements. With each spar loca-
because the pilot and the primary-control units (excluding cables and

control rods) should be so located that none lies in the region between the
tion or wing planform, however, the original position of the engines re-
plane of rotation of the propeller and the surface generated by a line pass- mains the same.
ing at an angle of 5 degrees through the axis of propeller rotation.

The mean aerodynamic chord is fixed with relation to the center of


gravity of the complete airplane, but any wing planform having the same
THE WING AND THE LANDING GEAR

It is usually easier to treat next the wing and the landing gear as a unit.

Since both the wing and the landing-gear positions are critical with refer-
length and location of the mean aerodynamic chord may be used. (See
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Figure IX-4.) The terms mean geometric chord aud mean aerodynamic
ence to the final location of the center of gravity, it is appropriate to start

with a final center of gravity location. Figure IX-5 shows the complete

chord are often used interchangeably.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

airplane, but in preliminary work it is unnecessary to treat more than the

wing and the landing gear.

Likewise, the engine is more or less fixed, either because of center of


gravity location requirements for the complete airplane or, more likely,
because the pilot and the primary-control units (excluding cables and
control rods) should be so located that none lies in the region between the
plane of rotation of the propeller and the surface generated by a line pass-
ing at an angle of 5 degrees through the axis of propeller rotation.

THE WING AND THE LANDING GEAR


It is usually easier to treat next the wing and the landing gear as a unit.
Since both the wing and the landing-gear positions are critical with refer-
ence to the final location of the center of gravity, it is appropriate to start
with a final center of gravity location. Figure IX-5 shows the complete
airplane, but in preliminary work it is unnecessary to treat more than the
wing and the landing gear.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM 165

........
--- -- ---
--- -- ....

--- ---
--- _____
-----
.,,,,,

FIOURE IX- 4. The mean geometric chord is the Hame for the three positionH of the
root chord shown.

The next step is to guess at the location of the final center of gravity
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

position. The horizontal position is of no concern at the moment, so the


center of gravity may be any arbitrary distance behind the plane of rota-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

A
i
FIGURE IX-5. Subsidiary balance diagram for the wing and landing-gear unit. The
propeller diameter is designated by A; its clearance with the ground, B. The assumed
position of the center of gravity for the complete airplane is arbitrarily assumed at 0.
The numbers 1, 2, 3, and 4 refer to horizontal data shown in Table VI-3.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
166 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
166

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

tion of the propeller. The vertical position will have to be assumed. For
tion of the propeller. The vertical position will have to be assumed. For

a low-wing monoplane, the center of gravity may be assumed at about


a low-wing monoplane, the center of gravity may be assumed at about
seat level; for a high-wing monoplane, at about shoulder level. Should
seat level; for a high-wing monoplane, at about shoulder level. Should
this assumption be found later to be a few inches off, it will usually not

affect the final configuration of the wing and landing gear.


this assumption be found later to be a few inches off, it will usually not
A line drawn forward at an angle between 13 and 17 degrees with the
affect the final configuration of the wing and landing gear.
vertical drawn through the center of gravity will intersect the ground line

A line drawn forward at an angle between 13 and 17 degrees with the


at the point of tangency of the wheel with the ground. Thus the wheel

is located.
vertical drawn through the center of gravity will intersect the ground line
The quarter point of the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing falls di-
at the point of tangency of the wheel with the ground. Thus the wheel
rectly below (in the case of a low-wing monoplane) or directly above (in

the case of a high-wing monoplane) the final center of gravity. Therefore,


is located.
this requirement is observed by placing^the wing accordingly.
The quarter point of the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing falls di-
The centers of gravity of these component parts are easily established,

rectly below (in the case of a low-wing monoplane) or directly above (in
the case of a high-wing monoplane) the final center of gravity. Therefore,
and the center of gravity of the group is then determined. Refer to

Figure IX-5 and Table IX-2.

Table IX-2.
this requirement is observed by placing, the wing accordingly.
(1)

(2)
The centers of gravity of these component parts are easily established,.
(3)
and the center of gravity of the group is then determined. Refer to
Weight,

Figure IX-5 and Table IX-2.


Vertical

Vertical

TABLE IX-2.
No.

Item designation

(1) (2) (3)


W

arm, y

Weight, Vertical Vertical


moment, Wy

1
No. Item designation w arm, y moment, Wy
Wing

w,
1 Wing . ..... . .......... W1 Y1 W1Y1
Vi
2 Fuel tank and fuel . . .. . W2 Y2 lV2Y2
3 Wheels . . . . .. . ..... .. .. Wa Ya Way3
wiVi

2
4 Landing-gear struts . .. . . w, y, W,y,
w,

+ + Waya + W,y,,
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

2/2

y _ W1Y1 W2Y2
+ + Wa + W,
3

W1 Ws
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

w,

2/3

W,y,
It is now necessary to locate the horizontal position of the center of
4

Landing-gear struts
gravity of this group. Refer to Figure IX-6 and Table IX-3.
wt

2/« TABLE IX-:~.


Y _ Wlyi + W,y, + Wty, + Wtyt

(1) (2) (3)


Wl + Wt + W, +

It is now necessary to locate the horizontal position of the center of

Weight, Horizontal Horizontal


gravity of this group. Refer to Figure IX-6 and Table IX-3.

Table IX-3.

(1)
No. Item designation w arm, x moment, W.z
(2)

(3)
# 1 Wing ... . ... . .. . ...... W1 X1 W1X1
2 Fuel tank and fuel ..... Wi Xs W1:ts
w.
Weight,

3 Wheels . . .............. Xa W.xa


Horizontal

Horizontal
4 Landing-gear struts . .... w, x, W.x,
No.

Item designation

W
x ... W1X1 + Wix, + w.x. + w,x,.
arm, x

moment, Wx
W1 Wi+ + W1 + W,
1

Wing

Wl

Original from
Xl

WlXl
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
2

wt

Xt
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM 167
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM

167

Figube IX-tt. A simplified planview of the previous figure, showing horizontal

moment arms of the wing and landing-gear groups. The numbers 1, 2, 3, and 4 refer

to data shown in Table IX-2.

,----1
:r-2:
I
I
L
:
I
---~ - 3
~x
I

FIGURE IX-6. A simplified planview of the previous figure, showing horizontal


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:32 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

moment arms of the wing and landing-gear groups. The numbers 1, 2, 3, and 4 refer
to data shown in Table IX-~.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

J<'IGt'RE IX- 7. Combining the fuselage and power-plant group with the wing and
landing-gear group together to get the final and exact location of the center of gravity
of the complete airplane.

Dig1 IZ
Original from
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
168 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
168

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

When these calculations are finished, the group may be located on the
When these calculations are finished, the group may be located on the

fuselage. In Figure IX-7, 1 indicates the center of gravity of the fuselage


fuselage. In Figure IX-7, 1 indicates the center of gravity of the fuselage
and its contents. Its horizontal movement is known and may be found

and its contents. Its horizontal movement is known and may be found
from Table IX-1, considering all except the last four items. The 2 indi-

cates the center of gravity of the wing and landing-gear group which has
from Table IX-1, considering all except the last four items. The 2 indi-
just been determined. Its distance d behind the quarter point on the cates the center of gravity of the wing and landing-gear group which has
mean geometric chord C is also known since

d = X - \iC.
just been determined. Its distance d behind the quarter point on the
The final position of the center of gravity of the complete airplane must
mean geometric chord C is also known since
x- ~c.
be in the plane y-y through the quarter point just mentioned. Let:

Wi = weight of fuselage and its contents,


d=
Wt = weight of wing and landing gear group.

Since the horizontal moment of the complete airplane equals the sum of
The final position of the center of gravity of the complete airplane must
the horizontal moment of the component parts, it follows that:
be in the plane y-y through the quarter point just mentioned. Let:
(JFi + W,) (L + x) = WJj + [W, (L + x + d)],

from which Wix = W^i is obtained so that the value of


W1 = weight of fuselage and its contents,
Wtd
W2 = weight of wing and landing gear group.
*= FT*

Since the horizontal moment of the complete airplane equals the sum of
the horizontal moment of the component parts, it follows that:
gives the necessary information to locate the wing on the fuselage.

If the engines and engine nacelles in a multi-engine design were consid-

(W1 + W2) (L + x) = W1L + [W2 (L + x + d)],


ered with the wing and landing-gear group in these calculations instead of

with the fuselage group, it would be possible for the center of gravity of

the group (wing, engines, fuel tanks, landing gear, etc.) to fall ahead of the

quarter point of the mean aerodynamic chord. Corrections in the above


from which W 1x = W2d is obtained so that the value of
derivations can be made accordingly.

W2<l
x=-,
W1
Before proceeding with the final form of the balance diagram, check the

following items for ground clearance:

1. Depressed elevator.

2. Depressed flap.
gives the necessary information to locate the wing on the fuselage.
3. Propeller.
If the engines and engine nacelles in a multi-engine design were consid-
Also check the distance between the tail post and the center of gravity

ered with the wing and landing-gear group in these calculations instead of
with the fuselage group, it would be possible for the center of gravity of
in terms of the mean geometric chord. All weight items appearing in the

original weight estimate should appear in the balance table.

When the balance diagram has been made in its final form, the balance
the group (wing, engines, fuel tanks, landing gear, etc.) to fall ahead of the
table given in Table IX-1 should then be corrected accordingly.

quarter point of the mean aerodynamic chord. Corrections in the above


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:32 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

SUPPLEMENTARY CALCULATIONS

Before the balance data are accepted, supplementary calculations are


derivations can be made accordingly.
Before proceeding with the final form of the balance diagram, check the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

necessary to determine the positions of the center of gravity for various

possible loading conditions—fully loaded, and partially or all empty. The

following items for ground clearance:


1. Depressed elevator.
2. Depressed flap.
3. Propeller.
Also check the distance between the tail post and the center of gravity
in terms of the mean geometric chord. All weight items appearing in the
original weight estimate should appear in the balance table.
When the balance diagram has been made in its final form, the balance
table given in Table IX-1 should then be corrected accordingly.

SUPPLEMENTARY CALCULATIONS
Before the balance data are accepted, supplementary calculations are
necessary to determine the positions of the center of gravity for various
possible loading conditions- fully loaded, and partially or all empty. The

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM 169
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM

169
extreme movement of the center of gravity should be limited. A total
extreme movement of the center of gravity should be limited. A total

horizontal movement of about 8 per cent of the mean geometric chord is


horizontal movement of about 8 per cent of the mean geometric chord is
permissible and, if possible, half of this movement should be ahead and permissible and, if possible, half of this movement should be ahead and
half behind the center of gravity for the fully loaded position. A greater

half behind the center of gravity for the fully loaded position. A greater
movement may be permitted if static stability calculations for the various

locations of the center of gravity show that the airplane has sufficient
movement may be permitted if static stability calculations for the various
stability.

locations of the center of gravity show that the airplane has sufficient
stability.
If the movement is extreme, rearrangement of variable, not fixed, items

such as passengers, baggage, fuel (but excluding the pilot in these calcu-

lations) may be made to reduce the movement. Should the center of


If the movement is extreme, rearrangement of variable, not fixed, items
gravity movement still be beyond the desirable limits, ballast should be
such as passengers, baggage, fuel (but excluding the pilot in these calcu-
provided.

BALLAST
lations) may be made to reduce the movement. Should the center of
Suggestions for the use of ballast:
gravity movement still be beyond the desirable limits, ballast should be
Ballast may be used to enable aircraft to comply with the flight-test

provided.
requirements for longitudinal stability, balance, and landing, with the

following provisions:

(a) Ballast should not be used for this purpose in aircraft having a
BALLAST
gross weight of less than 5000 pounds, nor in aircraft providing a

total seating capacity of less than 7 persons.


Suggestions for the use of ballast:
Ballast may be used to enable aircraft to comply with the flight-test
(b) It should be demonstrated by the manufacturer that the specific

aircraft can be landed safely without ballast, passengers, or

cargo. requirements for longitudinal stability, balance, and landing, with the
(c) The place or places for carrying ballast should be properly de-

signed and installed• and plainly marked.


following provisions:
(d) The loading schedule which accompanies each license issued for

an aircraft may require that special loading of this type shall be


(a) Ballast should not be used for this purpose in aircraft having a
conspicuously posted either in the pilot's compartment or adja-
gross weight of less than 5000 pounds, nor in aircraft providing a
cent to the ballast compartments. Strict compliance should be

total seating capacity of less than 7 persons.


(b) It should be demonstrated by the manufacturer that the specific
required of the aircraft operator.

These suggestions should be carefully checked against current govern-

mental regulations.
aircraft can be landed safely without ballast, passengers, or
CENTERS OF GRAVITY OF INDIVIDUAL ITEMS

The centers of gravity of, the individual items may be determined by in-
cargo.
spection, or rough calculations, or from known locations.
(c) The place or places for carrying ballast should be properly de-
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The following list will give some indication of the procedure to be fol-

signed and inst.a.Berl. and plainly marked.


lowed.

(d) The loading schedule which accompanies each license issued for
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Propeller

Engine

an aircraft may require that special loading of this type shall be


conspicuously posted either in the pilot's compartment or adja-
Accessories

At centerline

Given by manufacturer cent to the ballast compartments. Strict compliance should be


Estimate

required of the aircraft operator.


These suggestions should be carefully checked against current govern-
mental regulations.
CENTERS OF GRAVITY OF INDIVIDUAL ITEMS
The centers of gravity of, the individual items may be determined by in-
spection, or rough calculations, or from known locations.
The following list will give some indication of the procedure to be fol-
lowed.

Propeller At centerline
Engine Given by manufacturer
Accessories Estimate

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
170 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
170

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Person seated At bottom vest button


Person seated At bottom vest button

Seat Seat level, forward of back


Seat Seat level, forward of back

Furnishings, soundproofing At geometric center of cabin


Furnishings, soundproofing At geometric center of cabin

Flooring At geometric centroid


Flooring At geometric centroid

Doors At geometric centroid


Windows At geometric centroid
Doors At geometric centroid

Tail surfaces Center of gravity of each chord section is about


Windows At geometric centroid

Tail surfaces Center of gravity of each chord section is about

30-35% of chord
At 4-0--42% of each chord section; make allow-
30-35% of chord

Wing At 40-42% of each chord section; make allow-


Wing
ance for flaps
ance for flaps
Fuel and oil tanks At geometric centroid
Fuel and oil tanks At geometric centroid
Landing gear By inspection
Landing gear By inspection
If the wing is assumed to weigh the same per square foot from root to

tip, and if the center of gravity of each chord is located from 25 to 40 per
If the wing is assumed to weigh the same per square foot from root to
cent behind the leading edge, the center of gravity of the entire wing

tip, and if the center of gravity of each chord is located from 25 to 40 per
cent behind the leading edge, the center of gravity of the entire wing
would be at 25 or 40 per cent of the mean geometric chord, as the case may

be. Its vertical position may be assumed halfway between the top and

bottom camber at the mean chord, taking into account the location of the would be at 25 or 40 per cent of the mean geometric chord, as the case may
mean chord due to dihedral and other structural factors.

If tail surfaces have irregular planforms, sufficient accuracy will be


be. Its vertical position may be assumed halfway between the top and
obtained by resolving the areas in equivalent rectangles and triangles.
bottom camber at the mean chord, taking into account the location of the
Fuel tanks, filled with fuel, of irregular cross section from one end to

mean chord due to dihedral and other structural factors.


the other may be resolved into a series of volumes whose centers of gravity

can be determined readily, and it is an easy matter to find the center of


If tail surfaces have irregular planforms, sufficient accuracy will be
gravity of the complete unit. The center of gravity of the empty tank, obtained by resolving the areas in equivalent rectangles and triangles. ·
unless more accurate data are available, may be assumed to coincide with

Fuel tanks, filled with fuel, of irregular cross section from one end to
the other may be resolved into a series of volumes whose centers of gravity
the center of gravity of the tank when filled.

CENTER OF GRAVITY ESTIMATION

One may occasionally be required to determine the center of gravity of


can be determined readily, and it is an easy matter to find the CP.nter of
an object with which one is not familiar and for which there is no pertinent

information at hand. That would be the time to use some extra imagina-
gravity of the complete unit. The center of gravity of the empty tank,
tion and common sense.
unless more accurate data are available, may be assumed to coincide with
Let us take a fuselage as an example. Where might one expect to find

the center of gravity of the tank when filled.


the location of the center of gravity of the bare fuselage structure? A good

method of procedure would be to assume a cylinder of equal length and

CENTER OF GRAVITY ESTIMATION


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

uniform weight; then it is obvious that the center of gravity would be

located at the center. The center of gravity of the fuselage must then
One may occasionally be required to determine the center of gravity of
an object with which one is not familiar and for which there is no pertinent
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

lie ahead rather than behind the midpoint, unless some unusual condition

information at hand. That would be the time to use some extra imagina-
exists. The larger cross section ahead of the midpoint, the greater con-

centration of load, and the many more complexities of the structure caused

by windows and doors all indicate a center of gravity at about the mid-
tion and common sense.
point of this front half section alone, or at 25% of the total length. The

center of gravity of the complete fuselage structure would then lie some-
Let us take a fuselage as an example. Where might one expect to find
where between 25 and 50% of its length. As a first approximation, 35 to
the location of the center of gravity of the bare fuselage structure? A good
40% would be a reasonable value.

method of procedure would be to assume a cylinder of equal length and


uniform weight; then it is obvious that the center of gravity would be
located at the center. The center of gravity of the fuselage must then
lie ahead rather than behind the midpoint, unless some unusual condition
exists. The larger cross section ahead of the midpoint, the greater con-
centration of load, and the many more complexities of the structure caused
by windows and doors all indicate a center of gravity at about the mid-
point of this front half section alone, or at 25% of the total length. The
center of gravity of the complete fuselage structure would then lie some-
where between 25 and 50% of its length. As a first approximation, 35 to
-103 would be a reasonable value.

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM 171
THE BALANCE DIAGRAM

171

While such an approach assumes that the structure has some degree of
homogeneity, it still yields useful results for a first approximation. Later,
While such an approach assumes that the structure has some degree of

homogeneity, it still yields useful results for a first approximation. Later,

when more data is available as to location of frames, doors, floors, and


when more data is available as to location of frames, doors, floors, and
the like, a more careful and precise determination of the center of gravity

can be made.
the like, a more careful and precise determination of the center of gravity
ERROR IN BALANCE CALCULATIONS
can be made.
Slight errors in estimating the exact location of the center of gravity

are not serious. Suppose, for example, that the center of gravity of an

ERROR IN BALANCE CALCULATIONS


item weighing 50 pounds was wrongly located by two inches, making for

a total error of 100 inch-pounds in moment. If the gross weight of the


Slight errors in estimating the exact location of the center of gravity
airplane was 2000 pounds, then the center of gravity location would be off

are not serious. Suppose, for example, that the center of gravity of an
item weighing 50 pounds was wrongly located by two inches, making for
by 100/2000, or one twentieth of an inch—certainly not a large error, and

perhaps compensated for by other similar errors. The wrong location of

the center of gravity of the individual items may be more serious, how- a total error of 100 inch-pounds in moment. If the gross weight of the
ever, when the local effects under dynamic conditions are considered.

It is certainly desirable to have data available that is as accurate as


airplane was 2000 pounds, then the center of gravity location would be off
possible, but the absence of such data, especially for non-critical items,
by 100/2000, or one twentieth of an inch- certainly not a large error, and
should not delay the progress of preliminary design.
perhaps compensated for by other similar errors. The wrong location of
the center of gravity of the individual items may be more serious, how-
ever, when the local effects under dynamic conditions are considered.
It is certainly desirable to have data available that is as accurate as
possible, but the absence of such data, especially for non-critical items,
should not delay the progress of preliminary design.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
CHAPTER

The Cockpit

The cockpit may be considered the most vital part of the airplane, for

in it all functions of the airplane and its power plant are coordinated and

directed by the pilot and his aides.

All control systems terminate in the cockpit; all operational and navi-

gational instruments are located here; all decisions regarding the flight of

the airplane, with the very few exceptions when the airplane is about to
CHAPTER X
take off and land, are determined here. As the airplane grows larger, the

cockpit assumes even greater importance. At present it is even more im-

portant than the captain's bridge of an ocean liner.

Since the pilot and his aides, such as the co-pilot or the navigational

officer or some other member of the crew, spend their entire time on a

flight in the cockpit, it is absolutely necessary that every means for com-
The Cockpit
fort, for ease of operation of controls, for co-ordination of instruments, for

vision, and a host of other odds and ends which contribute to the efficiency

and well-being of the crew, be carefully planned and arranged. Too often

an airplane, otherwise satisfactory, cannot overcome the enormous sales

resistance caused by a poorly designed or arranged cockpit. The pilot

may find that he has not been given enough leg room or enough headroom

so that even on moderately short flights, he is easily tired due to a cramped

position. Or, he may find that his vision forward, sideward, upward, and
The cockpit may be considered the most vital part of the airplane, for
downward is very poor so that when he takes off from an airport or wants
in it all functions of the airplane and its power plant are coordinated and
to land, he must guess instead of being able to see how or where he is tak-

ing off or landing.


directed by the pilot and his aides.
Another difficulty may be that the instruments are not arranged prop- All control systems terminate in the cockpit; all operational and navi-
erly: that he cannot quickly see the instruments which he needs to guide

gational instruments are located here; all decisions regarding the flight of
him in the proper operation of the engines and in the proper execution of

his flight maneuvers.


the airplane, with the very few exceptions when the airplane is about to
In some cases minor faults may be corrected to suit the flying personnel
take off and land, are determined here. As the airp_lane grows larger, the
but, for example, if there is insufficient headroom in the cockpit it may

172
cockpit assumes even greater importance. At present it is even more im-
portant than the captain's bridge of an ocean liner.
Since the pilot and his aides, such as the co-pilot or the navigational
officer or some other member of the crew, spend their entire time on a
flight in the cockpit, it is absolutely necessary that every means for com-
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

fort, for ease of operation of controls, for co-ordination of instruments, for


vision, and a host of other odds and ends which contribute to the efficiency
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

and well-being of the crew, be carefully planned and arranged. Too often
an airplane, otherwise satisfactory, cannot overcome the enormous sales
resistance caused by a poorly designed or arranged cockpit. The pilot
may find that he has not been given enough leg room or enough headroom
so that even on moderately short flights, he is easily tired due to a cramped
position. Or, he may find that his vision forward, sideward, upward, and
downward is very poor so that when he takes off from an airport or wants
to land, he must guess instead of being able to see how or where he is tak-
ing off or landing.
Another difficulty may be that the instruments are not arranged prop-
erly: that he cannot quickly see the instruments which he needs to guide
him in the proper operation of the engines and in the proper execution of
his flight maneuvers.
In some cases minor faults may be corrected to suit the flying personnel
but, for example, if there is insufficient headroom in the cockpit it may
172

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE COCKPIT 173
THE COCKPIT

173
not be possible to make changes unless the airplane is completely rede-
not be possible to make changes unless the airplane is completely rede-

signed.
signed.
Naturally, the thought arises: Why not standardize the cockpit in its
Naturally, the thought a.rises: Why not standardize the cockpit in its
dimensions, appointments, and general arrangements? In other words,

dimensions, appointments, and general arrangements? In other words,


design a satisfactory cockpit once and for all. Unfortunately it is not
design a satisfactory cockpit once and for all. Unfortunately it is not

possible to standardize cockpit design wholly until all the parts and equip-

ment located in the cockpit have been standardized. possible to standardize cockpit design wholly until all the parts and equip-
New instruments are designed daily that record or indicate additional

data not measured before. Or, new equipment is designed that will take
ment located in the cockpit have been standardized.
care of some additional functions, but which may not wholly replace other
New instruments are designed daily that record or indicate additional
equipment of almost but not quite similar functions. The additions to

data not measured before. Or, new equipment is designed that will take
care of some additional functions, but which may not wholly replace other
the available list of instruments and equipment are necessary in order to

lighten the burdens of the operating personnel, but their placement may

well upset the planned installation of the standardized cockpit. Each equipment of almost but not quite similar functions. The additions to
new cockpit, therefore, offers its own problems.

However, there is standardization to some degree and this helps enor-


the available list of instruments and equipment are necessary in order to
mously in reducing the many problems attendant in cockpit arrangement.
lighten the burdens of the operating personnel, but their placement may
The military services are attempting to standardize cockpit designs for
well upset the planned installation of the standardized cockpit. Each
certain types of airplanes.

The description below* is presented to give some idea and understand-


new cockpit, therefore, offers its own problems.
ing of the cockpit arrangements and procedures that a pilot or student However, there is standardization to some degree and this helps enor-
must follow, for example, in a jet trainer.

mously in reducing the many problems attendant in cockpit arrangement.


The side-by-side seating arrangement is favored for a trainer for two

reasons:
The military services are attempting to standardize cockpit designs for
(1) Student confidence builder. With instructor alongside, student can be more
certain types of airplanes.
easily indoctrinated with jet techniques and procedures.

(2) Ease of instruction. Instructor can observe student at all times, be "ahead" of
The description below* is presented to give some idea and understand-
him in all phases of flight training without having to resort to guesswork.
ing of the cockpit arrangements and procedures that a pilot or student
The general arrangement of instruments and controls are such that, with the student

must follow, for example, in a jet trainer.


sitting on left side, the instructor on the right, the navigation and flight instruments are

positioned on student's side, the engine instruments above throttle pedestal. The radio
The side-by-side seating arrangement is favored for a trainer for two
controls are in front of the instructor, but are within reach of the student.

reasons:
Positioned on the left, on student's side, are navigational and flight instruments

including directional and altitude indicators, altimeter, turn and slip, rate of climb and
(1) Student confidence builder. With instructor alongside, student can be more
airspeed indicators, course indicator (omni), and clock. Engine instruments, set over
easily indoctrinated with jet technique!! and procedures.
(2) Ease of instruction. Instructor can observe Htudcnt at all timcH, be "ahead" of
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the center quadrant, include tachometers, exhaust temperature indicators, fuel flow

indicators, oil pressure gages, loadmeters, accelerometer and fuel quantity indicator.
him in all phases of flight training without having to resort to guet!Bwork.
The general arrangement of instruments and controls arc 1mch that, with the 11tudent
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

In front of the instructor, on the right but within reach of student, are radio controls,

circuit breaker and instrument panel, a.c. fuses, plus airspeed and turn and slip indicators

11itting on left side, the instructor on the right, the navigation and flight i1111truments arc
and altimeter.

positioned on student's side, the engine instruments above throttle pedestal. The radio
Controls are easily accessible from either side of cockpit. Stick grips and throttle

controls are in front of the instructor, but are within reach of the student.
quadrants are fighter type. Four throttles are provided, two for each quadrant.

Throttle movement mechanically actuates each engine fuel control by means of push-
Positioned on the left, on student's side, are navigational and flight instruments
pull rods and torque tubes.
including directional and altitude indicators, altimeter, turn and slip, rate of climb and
Lift-type idle detents are included on instructor's quadrant to prevent inadvertent
airspeed indicators, course indicator (omni), and clock. Engine instruments, set over
positioning of either set of throttles from idle to cut-off. There is no de-icing equipment,
the center quadrant, include tachometers, exhaust temperature indicator11, fuel f\Qw
* Aviation Week, April 1, 1057, pp. 48-55.
indicators, oil preNsure gage11, loadmeters, accelerometer and fuel quantity indicator.
In front of the instructor, on the right but within reach of student, are radio controls,
circuit breaker and instrument panel, a.c. fuses, plus airspeed and turn and slip indicator11
and altimeter.
Control11 are ell.Bily acce1111ible from either side of cockpit. Stick grip11 and throttle
quadrants are fighter type. Four throttles are provided, two for each quadrant.
Throttle movement mechanically actuates each engine fuel control by means of push-
puil rods and torque tubes.
Lift-type idle detents are included on instructor's quadrant to prevent inadvertent
positioning of either set of throttles from idle to cut-off. There is no de-icing equipment,
•Aviation Week, April 1, HJ57, pp. 48-55.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
174 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
174

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL hut an engine ice-warning light, on instrument panel, will illuminate when ice forms over
but an engine ice-warning light, on instrument panel, will illuminate when ice forms over the ice-detect probe in left engine air inlet duct.
the ice-detect probe in left engine air inlet duct.

Two automatic press-breathing, diluter-demand oxygen regulators for both student


Two automatic press-breathing, diluter-demand oxygen regulators for both student

and instructor are located on lower left and right side of instrument panel.
and instructor are located on lower left and right side of instrument panel.

The trainer incorporates a simple cockpit check. Airplane can be started on its own
The trainer incorporates a simple cockpit check. Airplane can be started on its own
battery or external starter. Six to 10 starts can be made on former. Standard starting
battery or external starter. Six to IO starts can be made on former. Standard starting
procedure is: Battery and inverter on, fuel pump on, open fuel shut-off valve for left
procedure is: Battery and inverter on, fuel pump on, open fuel shut-off valve for left
engine, push up on starter switch and hold at 5% rpm, push up on ignition switch and
engine, push up on starter switch and hold at 5% rpm, push up on ignition switch and
hold, bring throttle forward to idle, release starter and ignition switches at 22% rpm
hold, bring throttle forward to idle, release starter and ignition switches at 22% rpm
Engine will idle at 35%. Same procedure is used to start right engine.
Engine will idle at 353. Same procedure is used to start right engine.
Power steering is activated by button on stick, and slight rudder pressure steers air-
Power steering is activated by button on stick, and slight rudder pressure stecr11 air-
plane neatly and quickly. Nose wheel will steer on free swivel to 50 deg. Large

plane neatly and quickly. Nose wheel will steer on free swivel to 50 deg. Large
transparent canopy allows excellent visibility during taxi and flight.

transparent canopy allows excellent visibility during taxi and flight.


Before take-off there are two safety pins for the student to pull and one for the instruc-

tor. One of the pins is for canopy jettison and one for student's ejection seat. The
Before take-off there are two safety pins for the student to pull and one for the instruc-
instructor's pin is for his ejection seat. Before aircraft is entered, ground crew removes
tor. One of the pins is for canopy jettison and one for student's ejection seat. The
a fourth jettison pin for canopy behind and beyond reach of pilots.
instructor's pin is for his ejection seat. Before aircraft is entered, ground crew removes
A "hot" mike, geared to the helmet, enables instructor and student to talk—without
a fourth jettison pin for canopy behind and beyond reach of pilots.
button pushing—from time electrical power is turned on until engines are shut down. A "hot" mike, geared to the helmet, enables instructor and student to talk-without
SUGGESTED PROCEDURE IN DESIGN
button pushing-from time electrical power is turned on until engines are shut down.
Since the pilot is the most important item in the design of his headquar-

ters, the cockpit is planned around him. To obtain a better conception

of his requirements, a celluloid figure with joints is made to scale to which

the cockpit installation is to be drawn. This jointed figure can then be

placed in various postures to see whether the pilot's seat is far enough up
SUGGESTED PROCEDURE IN DESIGN
from the floor, that the legs are not outstretched too far for comfort, and

that the control stick or wheel is not too far ahead so that it is awkward
Since the pilot is the most important item in the design of his headquar-
to operate. Of course, slight adjustments are obtainable in raising or low-

ering the seat, or in moving it forward or rearward.


ters, the cockpit is planned around him. To obtain a better conception
If there is insufficient headroom for the pilot to stand up in the cockpit,
of his requirements, a celluloid figure with joints is made to sea.le to which
then there should be at least enough room above his head so that he can

the cockpit installation is to be drawn. This jointed figure can then be


placed in various postures to see whether the pilot's seat is far enough up
lean forward or back, or raise himself up slightly from the seat without

fear of bumping his head.

Once the pilot has been comfortably seated—and it is desirable that his
from the floor, that the legs are not outstretched too far for comfort, and
legs make an angle of not greater than 45 degrees with the floor to assure

that the control stick or wheel is not too far ahead so that it is awkward
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

comfort in flight—it is necessary to locate the seat so that he may have

sufficient vision in all possible directions, with special attention to for-


to operate. Of course, slight adjustments are obtainable in raising or low-
ering the seat, or in moving it forward or rearward.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ward, upward, downward, and sideward vision. When this has been done,

the windshield may be located. It should not be too far forward since the

If there is insufficient headroom for the pilot to stand up in the cockpit,


ceiling will come too far ahead of the pilot and interfere with his line of

vision. Likewise, the windshield should not be curved in more than two

directions because distortion of the scene may result. then there should be at least enough room above his head so that he can
lean forward or back, or raise himself up slightly from the seat without
fear of bumping his head.

Once the pilot has been comfortably seated-and it is desirable that his
legs make an angle of not greater than 45 degrees with the floor to assure
comfort in flight-it is necessary to locate the seat so that he may have
sufficient vision in all possible directions, with special attention to for~
ward, upward, downward, and sideward vision. When this has been done,
the windshield may be located. It should not be too far forward since the
ceiling will come too far ahead of the pilot and interfere with his line of
v1s1on. Likewise, the windshield should not be curved in more than two
directions because distortion of the scene may result.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE COCKPIT 175
THE COCKPIT

175
Next, the instruments and equipment must be considered. Instru-
Next, the instruments and equipment must be considered. Instru-

mentation is discussed in detail in a subsequent chapter, but reference to


a few required features may well be made here. All switches and controls
mentation is discussed in detail in a subsequent chapter, but reference to

a few required features may well be made here. All switches and controls

ivhich the pilot must operate should be located as close to him as possible .vhich the pilot must operate should be located as close to him as possible
so that it will be unnecessary for him to stretch. Stretching reduces the

pilot's ability to operate the airplane properly at any time and especially
so that it will be unnecessary for him to stretch. Stretching reduces the
in an emergency. On the other hand, those instruments which do not
pilot's ability to operate the airplane properly at any time and especially
have to be operated manually may be farther away, but they must be

in an emergency. On the other hand, those instruments which do not


have to be operated manually may be farther away, but they must be
grouped according to functions. The more important functional group is

located in front of him. Others are slightly out of his prevailing line of

direct vision. grouped according to functions. The more important functional group is
When the arrangements for distances and clearances have been settled

located in front of him. Others are slightly out of his prevailing line of
above and below the pilot, as well as behind and ahead of him, some atten-

tion should be given to "elbow" room. Here again, he should be given as


direct vision.
much room as possible. If there is a co-pilot, the width should be doubled

When the arrangements for distances and clearances have been settled
and an appreciable allowance made for the aisle between the two. These

allowances often determine the width of the fuselage unless the airplane is
above and below the pilot, as well as behind and ahead of him, some atten-
very large. The result is that designers tend to skimp on width allowances tion should be given to "elbow" room. Here again, he should be given as
because the greater the width, the greater the eventual effect upon the

much room as possible. If there is a co-pilot, the width should be doubled


speed performance of the airplane. However, a difference of 2 or 3 inches

will be enormous as far as the comfort of the pilot is concerned and will
and an appreciable allowance made for the aisle between the two. These
hardly affect the speed characteristics of the airplane.
allowances often determine the width of the fuselage unless the airplane is
In new designs it is usually the custom to lay out the pilot's cockpit on

paper, as discussed before, with the aid of additional information given


very large. The result is that designers tend to skimp on width allowances
hereafter, and then to construct a "mockup" which is a full-scale represen-
because the greater the width, the greater the eventual effect upon the
tation of the actual installation in wood, metal, and cardboard that is

speed performance of the airplane. However, a difference of 2 or 3 inches


will be enormous as far as the comfort of the pilot is concerned and will
nailed, bolted, or screwed together. In the mockup, a man may sit in the

cockpit and test the arrangements before the airplane is constructed.

Changes are made until everything is as satisfactory as accompanying


hardly affect the speed characteristics of the airplane.
conditions permit. The final solution is then drawn up and incorporated

into the final design.


In new designs it is usually the custom to lay out the pilot's cockpit on
GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
paper, as discussed before, with the aid of additional information given
The following items must be considered in the design and study of ar-

hereafter, and then to construct a "mockup" which is a full-scale represen-


tation of the actual installation in wood, metal, and cardboard that is
rangements for the cockpit:

1. Windshield outline and construction.

nailed, bolted, or screwed together. In the mockup, a man may sit in the
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

2. Angles and field of vision.

3. Instruments and their location.

cockpit and test the arrangements before the airplane is constructed.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

4. Power-plant controls and their location.

5. Pilot's and co-pilot's seats.


Changes are made until everything is as satisfactory as accompanying
6. Primary control systems.

conditions permit. The final solution is then drawn up and incorporated


into the final design.
7. Brake systems.

8. Hydraulic controls for brakes, flaps, tabs, etc.

GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
The following items must be considered in the design and study of ar-
rangements for the cockpit:
1. Windshield outline and construction.
2. Angles and field of vision.
3. Instruments and their location.
4. Power-plant controls and their location.
5. Pilot's and co-pilot's seats.
6. Primary control systems.
7. Brake systems.
8. Hydraulic controls for brakes, flaps, tabs, etc.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
176 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
176

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


9. Automatic-pilot equipment.
9. Automatic-pilot equipment.

10. Radio equipment.


11. Lighting.
10. Radio equipment.

11. Lighting.

12. Heating and ventilating.


12. Heating and ventilating.
13. De-icing equipment and controls.

14. Oxygen equipment.


13. De-icing equipment and controls.
15. Accessibility; emergency exits.
14. Oxygen equipment.
The cockpit for an airplane should be constructed to give the maximum

15. Accessibility; emergency exits.


possible comfort, adequate vision, and accessibility to all controls. In a

cabin plane, consideration must be given to headroom, ventilation, and


The cockpit for an airplane should be constructed to give the maximum
vision.

possible comfort, adequate vision, and accessibility to all controls. In a


cabin plane, consideration must be given to headroom, ventilation, and
The cockpit and primary control units, excluding cables and control

rods, should be so located with respect to the propellers that the pilot or

controls are not in the region between the plane of rotation of any propeller
VlSIOn.
and the surface generated by a line passing through the center of the pro-

peller hub and making an angle of 5 degrees forward or tfft of the plane of
The cockpit and primary control units, excluding cables and control
rotation of the propeller.
rods, should be so located with respect to the propellers that the pilot or
Unless the airplane carries less than five passengers, the pilot or pilots

controls are not in the region between the plane of rotation of any propeller
and the surface generated by a line passing through the center of the pro-
are located in a compartment separated from the cabin. Entrance to the

cockpit from the cabin is permitted, but passage through the cockpit

should not be considered as an emergency exit for the passengers.


peller hub and making an angle of 5 degrees forward or aft of the plane of
When the pilot is entirely separated from the passengers, suitable means

for communication between the pilot or pilots and the passengers should
rotation of the propeller.
be provided.
Unless the airplane carries less than five passengers, the pilot or pilots
Oxygen supply or a supercharged cabin should be provided for the crew

are located in a compartment separated from the cabin. Entrance to the


and the passengers above 18,000 feet altitude, or when operations are for

more than 15 minutes above an altitude of 14,000 feet.


cockpit from the cabin is permitted, but passage through the cockpit
The arrangement of controls, provision for adequate vision, and seating should not be considered as an emergency exit for the passengers.
arrangements, as well as numerous other problems, are best solved by con-

structing a mockup in which every item is represented.


When the pilot is entirely separated from the passengers, suitable means
WINDOWS AND WINDSfflELDS
for communication between the pilot or pilots and the passengers should
The general requirements for windows and windshields of the pilot's

be provided. •
compartment cover the following items:

1. Satisfactory forward vision under all conditions.


Oxygen supply or a supercharged cabin should be provided for the crew
2. Suitable protection under all conditions. and the passengers above 18,000 feet altitude, or when operations are for
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. Windshields should be easily opened in flight.

more than 15 minutes above an altitude of 14,000 feet.


4. Windshields should be so arranged that the air stream and snow or

The arrangement of controls, provision for adequate vision, and seating


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

rain are deflected across the opening when the windshields are open.

5. The compartment should be so arranged that glare and reflection are


arrangements, as well as numerous other problems, are best solved by con-
avoided.

6. Leakage into the compartment during rain or snow should be avoided.


structing a mockup in which every item is represented.

WINDOWS AND WINDSHIELDS


The general requirements for windows and windshields of the pilot's
compartment cover the following items:
1. Satisfactory forward vision under all conditions.
2. Suitable protection under all conditions.
3. Windshields should be easily opened in flight.
4. Windshields should be so arranged that the air stream and snow or
rain are deflected across the opening when the windshields are open.
5. The compartment should be so arranged that glare and reflection are
avoided.
6. Leakage into the compartment during rain or snow should be avoided.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE COCKPIT 177
THE COCKPIT

177

Figure X-l. Two windshield arrangements

for military airplanes. The top windshield simi-

lar to that of the Fairchild "Cornell" may be

built in sections that slide rearward, one section

telescoping over the other. The bottom wind-

shield, similar to that of the North American

XF-JI, is an example of the bubble canopy,

which has practically no visual obstructions but

may have some optical distortions.

Figure X-2. Windshield

configurations for large trans-

port airplane. The top arrange-

ment may offer less aerodynamic

resistance while the lower may

give the better visibility.

For best vision, the windshield should be placed vertically although this

materially increases aerodynamic resistance. Hence, the rearward-slop-

ing windshield which tends to keep the streamline shape of the fuselage

is the best.

It has been proposed that in order to obtain a streamlined fuselage for

an airplane designed for greatest aerodynamic efficiency, the cockpit could

be made to retract into the fuselage just after take-off. This could be

done only with great complication.

For unusually large airplanes, it is possible to locate the pilot's cockpit

in the nose of the fuselage where, due to the enormous size, flat panes in-

FwuRE X-1. Two windshield arrangements


serted in the surface hardly affect the smooth contour of the streamlined

body. FIGURE X-2. Windshield


Windshields should be so installed that they may be cleaned or opened
for military airplanes. The top windshield simi- configurations for large trans-
easily in flight. Unless the windshields are such that rain, snow, or ice
lar to that of the Fairchild "Cornell" may he port airplane. The top arrange-
will not stick to the surface and impede vision, they should be arranged so
built in sections that slide rearward, one section ment may offer less aerodynamic
that the air stream and snow or rain are deflected across the opening.
telescoping over the other. The bottom wind- resistance while the lower may
shield, similar to that of the North American give the better visibility.
XF-JI, is an example of the bubble canopy,
which has practically no visual obstructions but
may have some optical distortions.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

For best vision, the windshield should be placed vertically although this
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

materially increases aerodynamic resistance. Hence, the rearward-slop-


ing windshield which tends to keep the streamline shape of the fuselage
is the best.
It has been proposed that in order to obtain a streamlined fuselage for
an airplane designed for greatest aerodynamic efficiency, the cockpit could
be made to retract into the fuselage just after take-off. This could be
done only with great complication.
For unusually large airplanes, it is possible to locate the pi1ot's cockpit
in the nose of the fuselage where, due to the enormous size, flat panes in-
serted in the surface hardly affect the smooth contour of the streamlined
body.
Windshields should be so installed that they may be cleaned or opened
easily in flight. Unless the windshields are such that rain, snow, or ice
will not stick to the surface and impede vision, they should be arranged so
that the air stream and snow or rain are deflected across the opening.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
178 AIRPLANE DESIGN 1lfANUAL
178

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure X-3. Other possible

solutions to the windshield prob-

lem. These offer relatively little

aerodynamic resistance, but do

not offer the highest degree of

visibility to the pilots.

Figure X-4. Windshield

treatments for high-speed trans-

port airplanes. A special, so-

called retractable, windshield

covers the main windshield in

the lower solution. For take-

off and landing, the outer wind-

shield is retracted.

Figure X-5. This windshield arrangement provides better visibility for the pilot,

but offers greater aerodynamic resistance than any of the previous solutions shown.

FIGURE X-4. Windshield


treatments for high-speed trans-
FIGURE X-3. Other pmisiblc port airplanes. A special, so-
solutions to the windshield prob- ca.lled retractable, windshield
lem. These offer relatively little covers the main windshield in
aerodynamic resistance, but do the lower solution. For take-
not offer the highest degree of off a.nd landing, the outer wind-
visibility to the pilo~. shield is retracted.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE X - 5. This windshield arrangement provides better visibility for the pilot,
but offers greater aerodynamic resists.nee than a.ny of the previous solutions shown.

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
THE COCKPIT 179
179

Figure X-6. A typical nose-treatment for high-speed aircraft. Note the careful

streamlining of the windshield into the fuselage lines. The use of a periscope for the

landing operation has been proposed, with radar serving for the other situations of visual

observation. The nose section can be constructed in the form of a jettisonable capsule,

A typical nose-treatment for high-speed aircraft. Note the careful


as indicated by the solid outlines.

FIGURE X-6.
streamlining of the windshield into the fuselage lines. The use of a periscope for the
Figure X-7. A pilot's canopy that hinges at the rear and is held up by a hydraulic-

ally-operated center jack. When in place, further engagement is obtained by means

of the three lugs on each side, through which pins are passed. All connections can be
landing operation has been proposed, with radar serving for the other situations of visual
released in time for the ejection of the pilot with his seat.
observation. The nose section can be constructed in the form of a jettisonable capsule,
Figure X-8. One way of obtaining ice-free windshields.
as indicated by the solid outlines.

l."IouRE X-7. A pilot's canopy that hinges at the rear and is held up by a hydraulic-
ally-<>perated center jack. When in place, further engagement is obtained by means
of the three lugs on each side, through which pins are passed. All connections can be
released in time for the ejection of the pilot with his seat.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

A,;..,:.~-::.)'

1't
11
1: Hot-air
Cold-air l"''~
'II:..:-- -:ti
.:::c.'='
I
:1 intake
exhaust -::..:;.,~c.o 1'11 f
II
~~=-=-=-~
------0----------.1 Cabm L,_JL''
---~-
r----.-,
Air duct
=..;,:---=...--- -•radiatorr_;;;.-
c. _____ _,

F IGURE X- 8. One way of obtaining ice-free windshields.

Original from
Drg iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
180 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
180

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL Windshields fronting on the sides of the cabin may be kept free of ice by
Windshields fronting on the sides of the cabin may be kept free of ice by

means of a rotary windshield wiper that operates at relatively high speed.


means of a rotary windshield wiper that operates at relatively high speed.
One of the airlines has devised a double windshield, consisting of J^-inch
One of the airlines has devised a double windshield, consisting of 7,4-inch
safety-glass pane in front and a J^-inch transparent plastic rear pane with

safety-glass pane in front and a ,78-inch transparent plastic rear pane with
a 7,4-inch air space separating the two. Air, heated to 170° F, from the
a J^-inch air space separating the two. Air, heated to 170° F, from the

cabin heating system, is forced through between the panes at a rate of

about 60 cubic feet per minute. cabin heating system, is forced through between the panes at a rate of
The windshield arrangement should be such as to give minimum interior

about 60 cubic feet per minute.


reflections and glare which might interfere with the pilot's vision, particu-

larly at night.
The windshield arrangement should be such as to give minimum interior
In a mockup, the windows may be represented by mirrors that show the
reflections and glare which might interfere with the pilot's vision, particu-
parts of the cockpit which may be reflected. By suitable rearrangement

of the windshield, these areas may be avoided or provision made to reduce


larly at night.
the reflection. Glare may be investigated by means of an outside source
In a mockup, the windows may be represented by mirrors that show the
of light that can be moved with respect to the cockpit.

By means of Figure X-9, the thickness of the glass for the windshield
parts of the cockpit which may be reflected. By suitable rearrangement
may be determined. The safe pressure or load that may be sustained by
of the windshield, these areas may be avoided or provision made to reduce
the glass may be calculated approximately by means of the formula

the reflection. Glare may be investigated by means of an outside source


of light that can be moved with respect to the cockpit.
P = 21,000 fl/Af

where P = unit pressure in pounds per square inch (or square foot)

(assume P = ^pV2mox in lb/ft2),

By means of Figure X-9, the thickness of the glass for the wiudshiel<l
t = thickness of glass in inches,

A — area in square inches (or square feet),


may be determined. The safe pressure or load that may be sustained by
/ = safety factor, assumed equal to 10.
the glass may be calculated approximately by means of the formula
Characteristics of Glass

Coefficient of expansion of plate glass between —70° F to +100° F is

P = 21,000 t 2 /Af
approximately 0.00000823 per degree centigrade or 0.00000457 per degree

Fahrenheit.

where P = unit pressure in pounds per square inch (or square foot)
(assume P = 3'2PV 2maz in lb/ft2),
Compression 36,000 lb per in.2 Modulus of elasticity 10 X 106 to

Tension 6,500 lb per in.2 11 X 106 lb per in.2

Modulus of rup- 3,500 lb per in.2 Weight 3.29 lb per ft2 (M inch

t = thickness of glass in inches,


ture thickness)

All the windows in the windshield should be made to open quickly, and
A = area in square inches (or square feet),
be removable, if desired. The glass should not lie too flat. An angle be- f = safety factor, assumed equal to 10.
Characteristics of Glass
tween 0 and 45 degrees between the vertical and plane of the glass when
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the airplane is horizontal is recommended. If the glass lies too flat, dis-

tortion of vision or undesirable reflections from the sky above may result.

Coefficient of expansion of plate glass between - 70° F to +100° F is


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The thickness of the glass depends upon the type and size of plane.

In general, nonshatterable glass, at least % inch thick should be used.


approximately 0.00000823 per degree centigrade or 0.00000457 per degree
Anything thinner is subject to accidental breakage or warping.
Fahrenheit. ·
Compression 36,000 lb per in.2 Modulus of elasticity 10 X 106 to
Tension 6,500 lb per in.2 11 X 106 lb per in.2
Modulus of rup- 3,500 lb per in. 2 Weight 3.29 lb per f t 2 (7,4 inch
ture thickness)

All the windows in the windshield should be made to open quickly, and
be removable, if desired. The glass should not lie too flat. An angle be-
tween 0 and 45 degrees between the vertical and plane of the glass when
the airplane is horizontal is recommended. If the glass lies too flat, dis-
tortion of vision or undesirable reflections from the sky above ·may result.
The thickness of the glass depends upon the type and size of plane.
In general, nonshatterable glass, at least ~ inch thick should be used.
Anything thinner is subject to accidental breakage or warping.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE COCKPIT 181

~
0
/80n'Tl""T-.-"ll"""ll""""'I~
, ,
------------------~
.....--.,.........curves give volues for square
~ /'10 .++._......._4-~1--~-.&.---.1plqfe lllliformly loaded. Factor
~ \ of sofety=IO. For ofller mQfe-
g 160 nals multiply by a constant.
~ .+++-ff-+-ff--+-ll---+-'~\~~For rectangular shapes, mvl-
"» 'fiply by factor given below:
l
1
50
~ 140
\ Ratio of short Mvltip/y-
to long side ing focto1
- \ 0.9 1.005
1i 130 \ 0.8 I. 02
~ \ \ 0.7 1.07
120 0 .6 1. 14
~ H++H-f-l~,~\+---'--~\4-_.. a~ ~~~
g 1101-H-V-+-f~~-v--.i.-~--.. 0.3 I. 80
Cl) \ \ 2.60
\ \ 0.2
~ IOOl-+-it-t--+-+-+--+""-H--+--~......f--o_.1,,____~~~~nf.ll'-0...,,

l~ '\ \ \ \
90t-t-t-t-t\~1 t--'..+-,~,r+-~,H~-+---P~~~--1---1----l---J
\~
.. 80t-t-'1+-+-"*""--lk---~-+..:'~+--4----l
"~-+--Thickness
~ \ \ \ \ \ ~ in inc/Jes -
70t-+-H--\-l-+--+-~~r+-~.--+--+d_~~~+---+-----I

·~
~ 60t-t-t-~k--~----llj.-~~-~-+-+--+~l:---I
' \ \ '' "' 14 "~
~ 50 \ \ \ \. '"\~I "~ !'-....
\ \ \ ~ ·~~. . +-~--f-3-d--+-~
~
40 \
'' ;"-:... "'"-- ....
"" I ............ "'"-
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

~
\ \.
30t-i:-"it---ri..:--t~:-P''~!..-~-.d--+-~-....:::-+--~~~"'=--1
['-....
">t", . . . . . . . . . . ._ ---~r--~
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

0 \
l
~
20 \ '
10
\
~
~
£"-,. 8
............
...... ......._

--
. --.. ___ ----
............... __

~ I...._:--
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Area i n square Inches (or in square feet)
FIGURE X-9. Variation of glass thickness with me and load.

Plexiglas is a thermoplastic which may be formed by heat and pressure.


The softening point, about 175° F, is so high that the material does not
lose its rigidity under sun temperatures, yet it is low enough so that the
material may be worked readily without using excessively high tempera-
tures.

Original from
D g 11zed by (~ ()Og Ie UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
182 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
182

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

VISION AND VISIBILITY


VISION AND VISIBILITY

The cockpit in jet-propelled aircraft can usually be placed well forward The cockpit in jet-propelled aircraft can usually be placed well forward
in the fuselage, thus affording pilots a type of visibility during landing

in the fuselage, thus affording pilots a type of visibility during landing


approach that is not possible with propeller-driven aircraft. Downward
approach that is not possible with propeller-driven aircraft. Downward

visibility of 17° or00more over the nose can be obtained, whereas the other

type of airplane permits as little as 3° and seldom more than 5°.
visibility of 17° or· more over the nose can be obtained, whereas the other
Downward visibility is limited by the type of equipment installed

ahead of the pilot.


type of airplane permits as little as 3° and seldom more than 5°.
The pilot at high altitudes, in addition to his other problems, is faced
Downward visibility is limited by the type of equipment installed
with an inversion of the normal brightness direction. The sky and the

ahead of the pilot.


The pilot at high altitudes, in addition to his other problems, is faced
clouds at or near the earth's surface are normally brighter than the ter-

rain. Thus, at high altitude the pilot is covered with a black sky, while

the haze and clouds in the atmosphere below him are extremely bright. with an inversion of the normal brightness direction. The sky and the
Human beings are designed with eyes recessed under the frontal region of

the skull and with eyebrows superimposed. This is to protect the eyes
clouds at or near the earth's surface are normally brighter than the ter-
from brightness from above; but there is no protection from brightness
rain. Thus, at high altitude the pilot is covered with a black sky, while
coming from below—a distinct handicap for the pilot.

the haze and clouds in the atmosphere below him are extremely bright.
Unobstructed forward vision for the pilot under all conditions is most

desirable. For easy landing, it should be possible to see the wheels at the
Human beings are designed with eyes recessed under the frontal region of
moment of contact. It is customary to allow an angle of not less than 5 the skull and with eyebrows superimposed. This is to protect the eyes
degrees subtended by the eye below the horizontal to permit adequate

from brightness from above; but there is no protection from brightness


vision forward.

Figure X-10. The closer the obstruction to the eye, the greater the angle subtended
coming from below-a distinct handicap for the pilot.
Unobstructed forward vision for the pilot under all conditions is most
for impeding vision.

The twin-engine designs can usually provide for excellent vision forward

and sideways owing to the absence of such obstructions as the engine desirable. For easy landing, it should be possible to see the wheels at the
cylinders.

moment of contact. It is customary to allow an angle of not less than 5


A wing with sweepback usually does not permit as good a view of the

landing gear as a wing that does not incorporate a sweepback.


degrees subtended by the eye below the horizontal to permit adequate
Obstructions such as posts to support the windshield do not offer as
vision forward.
much of a "blind spot" when located relatively far from the pilot's eyes.

Preliminary studies should be made to determine the most desirable

location of such supports as far as vision is concerned.

A larger field of vision is available to the pilot if the windshield or

windows are relatively close to the pilot's face. The type of windshield
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

that slopes rearward from top to bottom (Figure X-5) does not afford
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Frn FRE X- 10. The closl'I' the obstruction to the eye, the greater the angle subtended
for impeding vision.

The twin-engine designs can usually provide for excellent vision forward
and sideways owing to the absence of such obstructions as the engine
cylinders.
A wing with sweepback usually does not permit as good a view of the
landing gear as a wing that does not incorporate a sweepback.
Obstructions such as posts to support the windshield do not offer as
much of a "blind spot" when located relatively far from the pilot's eyes.
Preliminary studies should be made to determine the most desirable
location of such supports as far as vision is concerned.
A larger field of vision is available to the pilot if the windshield or
windows are relatively close to the pilot's face. The type of windshield
that slopes rearward from top to bottom (Figure X - 5) does not afford

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE COCKPIT 183
THE COCKPIT

183

Figure X-12. Windshield arrangement for

a two-seater low-wing monoplane (top) simi-

lar to that of the Aeronca "Chum," and for a

small flying boat, (bottom) similar to that of

the Republic "Sea Bee."

much vision upward or sideways since the pilot is required to seat himself

farther back than if the windshield sloped the other way.

Canopies

The cleaner aerodynamic lines required at transonic and supersonic

speeds, as well as the difficulty of providing large transparent areas of

high-heat-resistant material may lead to the elimination of canopies.

One airplane now being built incorporates a periscope.

SEATING

The pilot should be comfortably seated. His seat should be adjustable

vertically, as well as fore and aft, and angularly. The back of the seat

should not be too high.

The seat should be provided with arms, so designed that the inside arm

can be swung out of the way when getting in or out of the seat.

When two seats in a side-by-side arrangement are provided in the pilot's

compartments, it is desirable to have equal access to the controls and in-

struments; where this is not possible, the left-hand seat should be favored.

This is known as the first pilot's seat, and the right-hand one is termed

FIGURE X-11. Windshield arrange-


the second pilot's seat.

ment for a small cabin, high-wing


When a wheel control is used, the height of the wheel should be such that

monoplane, similar to that used by the


Wa.co "Aristocraft."
FIGURE X-12. Windshield arrangement for
a two-seater low-wing monoplane (top) simi-
lar to that of the Aeronca "Chum," and for a
small flying boat, (bottom) similar to that of
the Republic "Sea Bee."
much vision upward or sideways since the pilot is required to seat himself
fart her back than if the windshield sloped the other way.
Canopies
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The cleaner aerodynamic lines required at transonic and ::mpersonic


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

tipeeds, as well as the difficulty of providing large transparent areas of


high-heat-resistant material may lead to the elimination of canopies.
One airplane now being built incorporates a periscope.

SEATING
The pilot should be comfortably seated. His seat should be adjustable
vertically, as well as fore and aft, and angularly. The back of the seat
should not be too high.
The seat should be provided with arms, so designed that the inside arm
can be swung out of the way when getting in or out of the seat.
When two seats in a side-by-side arrangement are provided in the pilot's
compartments, it is desirable to have equal access to the controls and in-
struments; where this is not possible, the left-hand seat should be favored.
This is known as the first pilot's seat, and the right-hand one is termed
the second pilot's seat.
When a wheel control is used, the height of the wheel should be such that

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
-
184 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

it will clear the pilot's legs with the seat in its highest position so that the
range of seat adjustment will not be limited.
The average dimensions for a cockpit seating a normal man ~re p~e~nted
in Figure X-13. Since man does not come in a standard size, it is not

-:+fll- ~--
u U I
-,
I
I
--+-t-+ '/1-+-
I

ntn LI __ _ _JII
-:ftr"9
-- --

•....... •
•a l't) ix
"1- ti
.....

. l.o
"1-

FIGURE X-13. Average cockpit dimensions necdc.,'<i to provide adequate room for
the pilot.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:43 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

possible to standardize the dimensions of the cockpit. The Aero Medicaf


Laboratory of the Army Air Forces examined 52 subjects as representative
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of some 3000 air cadets and found that they ranged in size from 5 feet 3
inches tall, weighing a minimum of 125 pounds (nude), to 6 feet 3 inches
tall and weighing 205 pounds (nude). For these men, a range of distance
from the centerline of the seat to the rudder pedal bar was 35.5 to 41.5
inches, or a total variation of 6 inches. This adjustment should be made
at the rudder pedal (preferably in increments of 1 inch) rather than in
changing the fore a.nd aft position of the seat, although a slight adjustment
of the seat and a greater adjustment of the pedal is also a likely solution.
Further, it was found that the seat to eye height, with the pilot inclined
13.5 degrees back, had a range varying from 26.9 inches to 34.0 inches.
There is always a desire on the part of the designer to be conservative
on allowance for dimensions of the cockpit, especially for small airplanes,
since he wishes to obtain as small over-all dimensions as possible. Yet,
greater freedom would be desirable, from the point of view of the pilot,
and it would certainly increase his efficiency. The Aero Medical Labora-

Original from
019 t1zoo by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN _,
THE COCKPIT 185
tory arrived at the following desirable clearances in the cockpit for the
pilot who was clothed with full operational equipment: above the head,
2.5 inches; across the shoulders, 24 to 26 inches; across the elbows, 26 to

i-----21-·- - - i

I
FIGURE X-14. Average dimensions of a

I
,
I
I
man 6 feet tall.
I
I
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:43 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

131-" 3~
4 2
,-...-_,--- --
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

'' _...""
,.,..;,r '--... _ -
~--'-
.--l-.---, { - \,
17lJ I \ '-- --

\ (? 22"U'
\' ( I
\
\
'
'
\
I
I
} ~
/---\ - t,
,,_.,., r--·
,___ , '
~-------'

-
Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
186 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
186

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


28 inches; across each knee, 6 to 8 inches; and above knees and thighs, 26
28 inches; across each knee, 6 to 8 inches; and above knees and thighs, 26

inches. For the occupant of the private airplane with an operational ceil-
ing below 10,000 feet and with provision of a reasonable heating system,
inches. For the occupant of the private airplane with an operational ceil-

ing below 10,000 feet and with provision of a reasonable heating system,

necessary clothing is not so heavy nor thick so that the dimensions speci-
necessary clothing is not so heavy nor thick so that the dimensions speci-
fied in the listing may be reduced in some cases.

Before cockpit design has progressed to the mockup stage, it is desir-


fied in the listing may be reduced in some cases.
able to construct a two-dimensional reduced scale model of the supposed
Before cockpit design has progressed to the mockup stage, it is desir-
pilot. For this purpose, the dimensions of a man who is 6 feet tall are

able to construct a two-dimensional reduced scale model of the supposed


pilot. For this purpose, the dimensions of a man who is 6 feet tall are
presented in Figure X-14 as a practical compromise between the 5-foot

3-inch pilot and the 6-foot 3-inch pilot.

EXITS
presented in Figure X-14 as a practical compromi8e between the 5-foot
If the cockpit is not accessible from the cabin, a separate door should be

:~-inch pilot and the 6-foot ~1-inch pilot.


provided for the cockpit. It is generally desirable to have an emergency

exit as well. If the windshield is large enough when opened, it may serve

as an emergency exit; otherwise, one should be provided. EXITS


When the airplane is not equipped to carry passengers, the pilot's com-

partment may be either open or equipped with a hatch of such size that it
If the cockpit is not accessible from the cabin, a separate door should be
can be used for an emergency exit for the crew with parachutes.

provided for the cockpit. It is generally desirable to have an emergency


exit as well. If the windshield is large enough when opened, it may serve
An opening for an emergency exit should be at least 17 X 24 inches

when rectangular in shape, or 24 inches in diameter if circular. Such

openings are generally not large enough, however, for a man equipped with
as an emergency exit; otherwise, one should be provided.
a parachute, and are usually intended for emergency exit on the ground.

PROTECTION FOR THE PILOT


When the airplane is not equipped to carry passengers, the pilot's com-
Without a shoulder harness to hold the pilot in his seat, severe or fatal
partment may be either open or equipped with a hatch of such size that it
injury is probable in a landing accident as a result of his head striking

can be used for an emergency exit for the crew with pa~achutes.
An opening for an emergency exit should be at least 17 X 24 inches
the instrument panel. The danger can be avoided by making the space

in front of the occupant free of obstacles for a distance approximately

equal to the length of the torso from the hips to the top of the head, when rectangular in shape, or 24 inches in diameter if circular. Such
plus seat-belt elongation. This would necessitate a 31 to 45 inch space

clear of any solid or unyielding protuberances which might injure not


openings are generally not large enough, however, for a man equipped with
only the head but also other parts of the body.
a parachute, and are usually intended for emergency exit on the ground.
The pilot's head would be critically injured in a crash against a flat,

rigid surface at an average impact energy of about 600 in./lb. If low

density, energy-absorbing materials are used to pad the crash surfaces,

the head can take impacts five times greater.

PROTECTION FOR THE PILOT


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:43 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

In order to lessen or prevent injury, surfaces against which the pilot

might hit his head in a crash should have the following characteristics:
Without a shoulder harness to hold the pilot in his seat, severe or fatal
injury is probable in a landing accident as a result of his head striking
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1. They should be flat or have large radii for curvature;

the instrument panel. The danger can be avoided by making the space
2. They should be rigid enough to help support the head but should

deflect under contact;

in front of the occupant free of obstacles for a distance approximately


equal to the length of the torso from the hips to the top of the head,
plus seat-belt elongation. This would necessitate a 31 to 45 inch space
clear of any solid or unyielding protuberances which might injure not
only the head but also other parts of the body.
The pilot's head would be critically injured in a crash against a flat,
rigid surface at an average impact energy of about 600 in./lb. If low
density, energy-absorbing materials are used to pad the crash surfaces,
the head can take impacts five times greater.
In order to lessen or prevent injury, surfaces against which the pilot
might hit his head in a crash should have the following characteristics:
1. They should be ·flat or have large radii for curvature;
2. They should be rigid enough to help support the head but should
deflect under contact;

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE COCKPIT 187
THE COCKPIT

187
a. They should be 8mooth, with no 8harp edges to cau8e local high
3. They should be smooth, with no sharp edges to cause local high

pressure intensity;
pressure intensity;
4. The contact surface should be as large as possible for distributing
-1. The contact surface should be as large a8 poi=:sible for distributing
contact pressures;

contact pressure8;
5. Provision should be made for absorbing a relatively large amount

of impact or kinetic energy.


5. Provision should be made for absorbing a relatively large amount
EJECTION EQUIPMENT
of impact or kinetic energy.
At low speeds, the customary method for a pilot to leave an airplane

under emergency conditions is to jump over the side. This method is

reasonably safe for aircraft speeds up to Mach 0.5. Beyond this limit,

various escape methods have been proposed and possible solutions arc

still being investigated.


EJECTION EQUIPMENT
It has been suggested that between speeds of Mach 0.5 and 1.5, an
At low speeds, the customary method for a pilot to leave an airplane
escape chute located in the bottom of the fuselage may be suitable. Ejec-

tion of the pilot, complete with seat and head and face protection gear, is
under emergency conditions is to jump over the side. This method is
another alternative.
reasonably safe for aircraft speeds up to Mach 0.5. Beyond this limit,
From about Mach 1.0 up, a capsule holding the pilot's cockpit would

various escape methods have been proposed and po8sible :solutions arc
still being investigated.
be detached from the rest of the aircraft structure by pneumatic or rocket

means.

Such problems as aerodynamic heating, stability in descent, and dy-


It has been suggested that between speeds of Mach 0.5 and 1.5, an
namic loads encountered make the design of suitable ejection equipment

and methods as challenging as the design of the entire aircraft.


escape chute located in the bottom of the fuselage may be suitable. Ejec-
Some appreciation of the difficulties encountered may be gained when
tion of the pilot, complete with seat and head and face protection gear, is
it is considered that from altitudes of 30,000 and above, tumbling and

another alternative.
From about Mach 1.0 up, a capsule holding the pilot's cockpit would
spinning are serious hazards. Experiments with human subjects have

shown that a spin of 160 rpm for 12 seconds will produce unconsciousness,

and that visual, mental, and physical disorientation will take place at 90
be detached from the rest of the aircraft structure by pneumatic or rocket
rpm, or even less. Rotation at 200 rpm for two minutes has proved

fatal for animal subjects. Therefore, means will have to be provided to


means.
make any self-contained system free from tumbling and spinning char-
Such problems as aerodynamic heating, stability in descent, and dy-
acteristics.

namic loads encountered make the design of suitable ejection equipment


and methods as challenging as the design of the entire aircraft.
It is believed that a streamlined capsule containing all of the cockpit

equipment would have greater mass and better streamlining than a body

in an ejection seat. Thus, it could reduce deceleration to within human


Some appreciation of the difficulties encountered may be gained when
tolerance and give protection from tumbling, wind blast, extreme temper-

it is considered that from altitudes of 30,000 and above, tumbling and


Generated on 2012-05-30 02:43 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

atures, and lack of oxygen. At altitudes outside the normal atmosphere,

the capsule would also protect the pilot from such conditions as dynamic
spinning are serious hazards. Experiments with human subjects have
shown that a spin of 160 rpm for 12 seconds will produce unconsciousness,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

heating and sudden decelerations, which make re-entry into the normal

and that visual, mental, and physical disorientation will take place at 90
atmosphere quite dangerous. Furthermore, such a capsule would provide

an artificial environment capable of supporting the pilot for considerable

periods. rpm, or even less. Rotation at 200 rpm for two minutes has proved
fatal for animal subjects. Therefore, means will have to be provided to
make any self-contained system free from tumbling and spinning char-
acteristics.
It is believed that a streamlined capsule containing all of the cockpit
equipment would have greater mass and better streamlining than a body
in an ejection seat. Thus, it could reduce deceleration to within human
tolerance and give protection from tumbling, wind blast, extreme temper-
atures, and lack of oxygen. At altitudes outside the normal atmosphere,
the capsule would also protect the pilot from such conditions as dynamic
heating and sudden decelerations, which make re-entry into the normal
atmosphere quite dangerous. Furthermore, such a capsule would provide
an artificial environment capable of supporting the pilot for considerable
periods.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
188 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
188

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


PARACHUTES
PARACHUTES

It is not customary to provide the crew with parachutes when passen-


gers are carried. When the airplane does not carry passengers, pilots
It is not customary to provide the crew with parachutes when passen-

gers are carried. When the airplane does not carry passengers, pilots

should be equipped with parachutes. Figure X-15 shows seating pro-


8hould be equipped with parachute~. Figure X-15 show:; :;eating pro-
visions to be made for different type parachutes.

CONTROLS
visions to be made for different type parachutes.
All controls should be readily accessible.

The distance from a control wheel in its rearmost position to the back of

l<'IGl'RE X-15. Allowancei,; t-0 be


Figure X-16. Suggested configurations for the pilot's control wheel.

..... made in seating with various type


°'• parachutes. Composite sketch shows
lap and seat type parachutes.

r--,
l , __ J I
r--,
I I
I I
I I
I I
L_J
r-1
I I
I I
I I
: I
ri ,-~ I

t~~:=-:rJ;i._
CONTROLS
All controls should be readily accessible.
The distance from a control wheel in its rearmost position to the back of
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE X - Hi. Suggested configurations for the pilot's control wheel.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE COCKPIT 189
THE COCKPIT

189

the pilot should be at least 12 inches. The height of the wheel should
clear the pilot's legs with the seat in its highest position.
the pilot should be at least 12 inches. The height of the wheel should

clear the pilot's legs with the seat in its highest position.

The maximum movement of the


The maximum movement of the
controls should correspond to the

maximum movement of the con-


controls should correspond to the
trol surfaces.
maximum movement of the con-
In a small airplane, seating 2

trol surfaces.
In a small airplane, seating 2
to 5 passengers, for example, it is

sometimes customary to place a

passenger alongside the pilot. In


to 5 passengers, for example, it is
such a case, the control column or

stick should not be located between


sometimes customary to place a
the pilot and passenger unless the
passenger alongside the pilot. In
"throw-over" type of wheel con-

such a case, the control column or


stick should not be located between
trol is incorporated.

The controls should be so arranged or constructed that neither the pas-


FIGURE X-17. Control levers are being
sengers, crew, nor cargo will interfere with the operation of such controls
equipped with handles suggesting the mech- the pilot and passenger unless the
during the course of flight of the airplane. Further, all controls must be
anism each handle operates. (left) Landing "throw-over" type of wheel con-
so located and designed that the pilot or co-pilot will not bump them when

gear retraction. (right) Flap lever.


moving in or out of his seat, or in and around the cockpit. Latest designs
trol is incorporated.
of control handles simulate the mechanism which the handle operates.

The controls should be so arranged or constructed that neither the pas-


sengers, crew, nor cargo will interfere with the operation of such controls
This makes for faster action by the pilot and minimizes error in selecting

the proper control.

Figure X-17. Control levers are being during the course of flight of the airplane. Further, all controls must be
equipped with handles suggesting the mech-

anism each handle operates. (left) Landing


so located and designed that the pilot or co-pilot will not bump them when
gear retraction• (right) Flap lever.
moving in or out of his seat, or in and around the cockpit. Latest designs
INSTRUMENT BOARD
of control handles simulate the mechanism which the handle operates.
There is no agreement as to the best arrangement of the instrument

board. It is customary to place the automatic pilot in the top center of


This makes for faster action by the pilot and minimizes error in selecting
the instrument board, with the flight instruments and power-plant instru- the proper control.
ments in front of the pilot. The controls and switches should be readily

accessible, and in case of pilot and co-pilot arrangements, the engine con-

trols should be located between the two.

In a twin-engine airplane there are some 16 controls for the power plant

INSTRUMENT BOARD
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

alone, about 11 flight-control instruments in addition to the flying controls,

landing-gear retraction, lights, heating and ventilating control, radio, and There is no agreement as to the best arrangement of the instrument
board. It is customary to place the automatic pilot in the top center of
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

brakes, as well as flaps and tab controls, for which provision must be made

on the instrument board or in the cockpit.

The instrument board should have sufficient room behind it to provide


the instrument board, with the flight instruments and power-plant instru-
easy access even to the largest instrument. It may be made of any mate-
ments in front of the pilot. The controls and switches should be readily
rial, although aluminum alloy is commonly used.

In order to take additional factors into account, further reference should


accessible, and in case of pilot and co-pilot arrangements, the engine con-
be made to Chapters XI, XVI, and XX, entitled Instruments and Equip-
trols should be located between the two.
ment, The Power Plant, and Control Systems, respectively.

In a twin-engine airplane there are some 16 controls for the power plant
alone, about 11 flight-control instruments in addition to the flying controls,
landing-gear retraction, lights, heating and ventilating control, radio, and
brakes, as well as flaps and tab controls, for which provision must be made
on the instrument board or in the cockpit.
The instrument board should have sufficient room behind it to provide
easy access even to the largest instrument. It may be made of any mate-
rial, although alum1num alloy is commonly used.
In order to take additional factors into account, further reference should
be made to Chapters XI, XVI, and XX, entitled Instruments and Equip-
ment, The Power Plant, and Control Systems, respectively.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
190 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
190

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure X-18. Side and plan views of controls and instrument board for prone

position of pilot, which permits smaller cross section of fuselage for high-speed airplanes.

,-~,------------------r
,1
----, -------, -r-t
'"'-,- -- -1 c -;i
I
11
16
I ' \ -~.JI- ~-:."=II
-'-'-l ------" -=- I
•• .!.;!.J --------, ~-..... --~'-
-n::+i;;--ff-
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

! • I
1...1-1 I '-:';
:..---"----------''"'"L.- ::
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

II
'~-~--------------------~

FwuRE X-18. Side and plan views of controls and instrument boa.rd for prone
position of pilot, which permits smaller cross section of fuselage for high-speed airplanes.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER

Instruments and Equipment

From the first flight of the Wright brothers, and practically up to about

1928, pilots flew by feel and intuition. Today they cannot trust their own

senses at high altitudes or in fogs or in cross-country flights or in blind fly-

ing, since airplanes are becoming faster and more complicated with each

new design. Fogs, high altitudes, and night flying obliterate landmarks.

High headwinds, sleet, snow, and rain interfere with the intuitive senses
CHAPTER XI
of the pilots. They must rely, for safety's sake, almost entirely on radio

communication, radio beacons, range compass findings, gyroscopic com-

passes, automatic pilots, turn and bank indicators, and at least 25 other

dials and gadgets essential to the safe operation of the airplane in all kinds

of weather.

In transoceanic flying the job becomes even more complicated. The


Instruments and Equipment
captain of a transoceanic flying boat must be also a first-class seaman, a

master mariner, a radio expert, an aeronautical engineer, an engine and

airplane mechanic, a celestial navigator, and a host of other things. But

no matter how well qualified the pilot may be along these lines, he would

be entirely helpless unless there were instruments or equipment to show

how the engines were performing, what speed the airplane was making, at

what altitude he was flying (so as to clear mountains), or what course he

was following, and the innumerable other indicators required.


From the first flight of the Wright brothers, and practically up to about
This wide variety of information has to be given by reliable instruments,

1928, pilots flew by feel and intuition. Today they cannot trust their own
senses at high altitudes or in fogs or in cross-country flights or in blind fly-
and due to the diverse nature of information, the instruments, gadgets,

and mechanical aids become so numerous• that the ideal arrangement of

the various instruments, for example, on the aircraft instrument board has ing, since airplanes are becoming faster and more complicated with each
been the subject of considerable controversy among pilots since the pilot's

needs also vary with the type of flying he has to do. To this day, it has
new design. Fogs, high altitudes, and night flying obliterate landmarks.
been impossible for pilots to agree upon a definite location of even a few
High headwinds, sleet, snow, and rain interfere with the intuitive senses
instruments. This state of affairs may be better understood when it is

of the pilots. They must rely, for safety's sake, almost entirely on radio
communication, radio beacons, range compass findings, gyroscopic com-
considered that the use of various instruments differs considerably for each

191

passes, automatic pilots, turn and bank indicators, and at least 25 other
dials and gadgets essential to the safe operation of the airplane in all kinds
of weather.
In transoceanic flying the job becomes even more complicated. The
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

captain of a transoceanic flying boat must be also a first-class seaman, a


master mariner, a radio expert, an aeronautical engineer, an engine and
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

airplane mechanic, a celestial navigator, and a host of other things. But


no matter how well qualified the pilot may be along these lines, he would
be entirely helpless unless there were instruments or equipment to show
how the engines were performing, what speed the airplane was making, at
what altitude he was flying (so as to clear mountains), or what course he
was following, and the innumerable other indicators required.
This wide variety of information has to be given by reliable instruments,
and due to the diverse nature of information, the instruments, gadgets,
and mechanical aids become so numerous that the ideal arrangement of
the various instruments, for example, on the aircraft instrument board has
been the subject of considerable controversy among pilots since the pilot's
needs also vary with the type of flying he has to do. To this day, it has
been impossible for pilots to agree upon a definite location of even a few
instruments. This state of affairs may be better understood when it is
considered that the use of various instrument s differs considerably for each
191

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
192 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
192

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


particular flying problem; certain instruments, for example, necessary to
particular flying problem; certain instruments, for example, necessary to

make instrument landings (that is, making landings aided by instruments


only and not by actual view of the airport on which landing is taking place)
make instrument landings (that is, making landings aided by instruments

only and not by actual view of the airport on which landing is taking place)

are rarely, if ever, used in normal landing. The best instrument board,
are rarely, if ever, used in normal landing. The best instrument board,
therefore, is the best compromise that has been worked out for the par-

ticular conditions the airplane has to meet.


therefore, is the best compromise that has been worked out for the par-
Of course there are difficulties. It would be highly desirable for a pilot
ticular conditions the airplane has to meet.
to be able to step into a strange airplane and feel reasonably sure that he

Of course there are difficulties. It would be highly desirable for a pilot


to be able to step into a strange airplane and feel reasonably sure that he
will be able to locate any particular instrument in the usual place on the

instrument board. Such standardization, in addition to the reasons al-

ready pointed out, is also difficult owing to space and structural limita- will be able to locate any particular instrument in the usual place on the
tions, as well as the size and shape of various airplanes. Some degree of

standardization is possible if the majority of the more important instru-


instrument board. Such standardization, in addition to the reasons al-
ments are placed in the same general location on the panel.
ready pointed out, is also difficult owing to space and structural limita..
The military services prescribe some specifications, and the various air-

tions, as well as the size and shape of various airplanes. Some degree of
standardization is possible if the majority of the more important instru-
lines are accustomed to setting forth their own. Manufacturers of air-

craft are able to follow these in most instances except for the relatively

small airplane where some elasticity is necessary because of the small area ments are placed in the same general location on the panel.
of the instrument board usually available.

The military services prescribe some specifications, and the various air-
The standardization, so far made, calls for the following arrangement.

The primary flight group is immediately in front of the pilot and near the
lines are accustomed to setting forth their own. Manufacturers of air-
top of the panel. This group consists of the Sperry turn indicator and the

craft are able to follow these in most instances except for the relatively
small airplane where some elasticity is necessary because of the small area
Sperry flight indicator, both on the same level. Below these is the second-

ary flight group consisting of the airspeed, bank and turn indicator com-

bined, and the rate of climb instruments. To the left, either in the same of the instrument board usually available.
row or as close as possible, the sensitive altimeter is located. In addition,

The standardization, so far made, calls for the following arrangement.


it is customary to locate the magnetic and radio compasses as conveniently

close to the other flight instruments as possible.


The primary flight group is immediately in front of the pilot and near the
The engine instruments are usually grouped in the same general pattern,
top of the panel. This group consists of the Sperry turn indicator and the
depending upon their number, with the tachometer as close as possible to

the flight instruments.


Sperry flight indicator, both on the same level. Below these is the second-
There is often a series of other instruments placed according to the best ary flight group consisting of the airspeed, bank and turn indicator com-
location available as well as the particular purpose for which the instru-

bined, and the rate of climb instruments. To the left, either in the same
ments were designed.

It is estimated that in a subsonic jet fighter, the military pilot will


row or as close as possible, the sensitive altimeter is located. In addition,
it is customary to locate the magnetic and radio compasses as conveniently
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

have checked his instruments at a rate of nearly 200 per minute. In

the presence of rain, air turbulence, and darkness, he will have inter-

close to the other flight instruments as possible.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

preted these readings and applied control forces for definite corrections

in flight path and attitude at a rate of about 50 per minute. He will The engine instruments are usually grouped in the same general pattern,
have responded to, actuated, or concerned himself with over 200 cockpit

depending upon their number, with the tachometer as close as possible to


the flight instruments.
instruments, indicators, levers, and switches. At the point when he

stops his aircraft and clears the runway, he will have made more than

1,000 major and minor decisions and 2,000 lever, switch, and control
There is often a series of other instruments placed according tG the best
location available as well as the particular purpose for which the instru-
ments were rlesigned.
It is estimated that in a subsonic jet fighter, the military pilot wilJ
have checked his instruments at a rate of nearly 200 per minute. In
the presence of rain, air turbulence, and darkness, he will have inter-
preted these readings and applied control forces for definite corrections
in flight path and attitude at a rate of about 50 per minute. He will
have responded to, actuated, or concerned himself with over 200 cockpit
instruments, indicators, levers, and switches. At the point when he
stops his aircraft and clears the runway, he will have made more than
1,000 major and minor decisions and 2,000 lever, switch, and control

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 193
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 193

actuations or deflections—all compressed within an uninterruptable

actuations or deflections-all compressed within an uninterruptable


segment of time.
segment of time.

While the commercial pilot may not have quite so many operations,

with the increase in the speed of aircraft, the time for split decisions While the commercial pilot may not have quite so many operations,
decreases and the number of operations increases.

Q—*- Aircraft in focus in visual field -«—O


with the increase in the speed of aircraft, the time for split decisions
O—*- Lag in perception - 0.1 second •*—O
decreases and the number of operationR increases.
O—*• Time for recognition -0.5 second -*-O

I
O"*- Decision accomplished-0.1 second -*—O

0~*~Human reaction time-0.4 second-*—O

Machine reaction time plus time to

[ \)
0-- Aircraft in focus in visual field --0
deviate from flight path-2.0 seconds

q Flight path without countering action q

0-
I
Lag in perception - 0.1 second ..-Q
Time in seconds

4 3 2 10 12 3 4

3520 2640 1760 880 0 880 1760 2640 3520

0---
I
Time for recognition-0.5 second --0
Distance in feet

Figure XI-1. Estimated man-machine time-distance relationships of two aircraft

I
traveling a 180-degree collision course at a speed of 600 mph. An increase in the

amount of time spent in any phase of the time-response sequence would result in a
0-- Decision accomplished-0.1 second ~
collision. Similarly, a marked increase in the relative aircraft speeds would make

avoidance impossible. From a distance of 20,000 feet, an airplane with a 100-foot

wing span would be visible as a point. Two 900-mph airplanes approaching head-on
I
0-Human reaction time-0.4 second--0
I
Machine reaction time plus time to
would cover this distance in about 7.5 seconds.

~l'o
INSTRUMENT BOARD

The instrument board may be of any convenient material although

aluminum or aluminum alloy is most commonly used. For small instru-

deviate from flight path-2.0 seconds


ment panels, plywood may be used. Instrument boards of 17ST or 24ST

I
aluminum alloy sheet are made in thicknesses varying from J^j; to }/$ inch.

0. Flight path without countering action Q


Formica or bakelite instrument boards are from Y%\,o}/i inch thick.
• 1•
The instrument board should be fully accessible from the rear so that
Time in seconds
any instrument may be removed readily. Special attention should be
4 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4
3520 2640 1760 880 0 880 1760 2640 3520
Distance in feet
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FIGURE Xl-1. Estimated man-machine time-distance relationships of two aircraft


traveling a 180-degree collision course at a speed of 600 mph. An increase in the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

amount of time spent in any phase of the time-response sequence would result in a
collision. Similarly, a marked increase in the relative aircraft speeds would make
avoidance impossible. From a distance of 20,000 feet., an airplane with a 100-foot
wing span would be visible as a point. Two 900-mph airplanes approaching head-on
would cover this distance in about 7.5 seconds.

INSTRUMENT BOARD
The instrument board may be of any convenient material although
aluminum or aluminum alloy is most commonly used. For small instru-
ment panels, plywood may be used. Instrument boards of 17ST or 24ST
aluminum alloy sheet are made in thicknesses varying from W6 to Ys inch.
Formica or bakelite instrument boards are from .Vs to~ inch thick.
The instrument board should be fully accessible from the rear so that
any instrument may be removed readily. Special attention should be

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
194 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
194

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


paid to the depth of the instrument, space required for removal, and extra
paid to the depth of the instrument, space required for removal, and extra

space for access to connections and the like.


space for access to connections and the like.
Since instruments should not be subjected to vibration, the board should
Since instruments should not be subjected to vibration, the board should
be mounted on either felt or sponge rubber. Elastic stop nuts are excel-

be mounted on either felt or sponge rubber. Elastic stop nuts are excel-
lent for fastening down bolts which do not need extra lock washers. As
lent for fastening down bolts which do not need extra lock washers. As

the board with the instruments has sufficient weight of its own to acquire

a vigorous vibration, both it and the individual instruments should be the board with the instruments has sufficient weight of its own to acquire
mounted carefully with respect to vibration. The compass, particularly,

should be mounted as independently as possible.


a vigorous vibration, both it and the individual instruments should be
Location
mounted carefully with respect to vibration. The compass, particularly,
Instruments should be located far enough away from the pilot to permit

should be mounted as independently as possible.


him to see all the instruments at a glance. If there are a great many in-

struments, the more important ones should be grouped so that they may

be seen readily.
Location
The instrument board location is usually determined by cockpit limita-
Instruments should be located far enough away from the pilot to permit
tions, control stick clearances, and the like.

Grouping
him to see all the instruments at a glance. If there are a great many in-
The grouping of instruments depends upon the functions they perform. struments, the more important ones should be grouped so that they may
Instruments relating to engine operation should usually be close to-

be seen readily.
gether and preferably right in the line of sight of the pilot. Likewise,

instruments used for navigation, instruments used for communications,


The instrument board location is usually determined by cockpit limita-
and instruments and accessories used for heating and ventilating and
tions, control stick clearances, and the like.
similar occasional operational functions should be grouped together.

Grouping
Authorities differ as to the desirable arrangement of instruments in a par-

ticular group.

Variety of Instruments

The grouping of instruments depends upon the functions they perform.


The variety of instruments that may be included in the modern airplane

can best be realized from the following incomplete list.


Instruments relating to engine operation should usually be close to-
1. Air distance recorder—records the number of air miles. gether and preferably right in the line of sight of the pilot. Likewise,
2. Air speed indicator—registers the actual air speed, referred to stand-

ard air, at all times.


instruments used for navigation, instruments used for communications,
3. Altimeter—a visual registering (but not recording) barometer, except
and instruments and accessories used for heating and ventilating and
that instead of indicating the atmospheric pressure in equivalent inches of
similar occasional operational functions should be grouped together.
mercury, the dial is graduated to read the altitude in feet corresponding to

the pressure.
Authorities differ as to the desirable arrangement of instruments in a par-
ticular group.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

4. Accelerometer—may not be incorporated in the instrument board lay-

out. It is used to determine the maximum loads imposed upon the air-

Variety of Instruments
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

plane in gusts or in landing. It is often carried to give research workers

additional data, but is not required or used by the pilot for his information.

5. Ammeters and voltmeters—measure the electrical power used for vari- The variety of instruments that may be included in the modern airplane
can best be realized from the following incomplete list.
1. Air distance recorder-records the number of air miles.
2. Air speed indicator-registers the actual air speed, referred to stand-
ard air, at all times.
3. Altimeter-a visual registering (but not recording) barometer, except
that instead of indicating the atmospheric pressure in equivalent inches of
mercury, the dial is graduated to read the altitude in feet corresponding to
the pressure.
4. Accelerometer-may not be incorporated in the instrument board lay-
out. It is used to determine the maximum loads imposed upon the air~
plane in gusts or in landing. It is often carried to give research workers
additional data, but is not required or used by the pilot for his information.
5. Ammeters and v0ltmeters--measure the electrical power used for vari-

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 195
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 195

ous instruments or equipment such as radios, telephones, and electrically

operated retraction gear.


ous instruments or equipment such as radios, telephones, and electrically
6. Automatic pilot—a device manufactured by the Sperry Company
operated retraction gear.
and used to operate the control surfaces to maintain an even keel without

6. Automatic pi"lot-a device manufactured by the Sperry Company


and used to operate the control surfaces to maintain an even keel without
the intervention of the pilot. The automatic pilot relieves the pilot of

much strain of constantly "flying" the airplane so that he can devote more

attention to the behavior of the power plant and other equipment. the intervention of the pilot. The automatic pilot relieves the pilot of
7. Bank indicator—a visual indicating device for registering the angle

of bank.
much strain of constantly "flying" the airplane so that he can devote more
8. Climb indicator—registers the rate of climb in feet per minute, so
attention to the behavior of the power plant and other equipment.
that the pilot has a ready means of determining whether he is climbing fast

7. Bank indicator-a visual indicating device for registering the angle


enough. If it registers zero, the airplane is flying level; if it registers nega-

tively, the airplane is descending. The dial is marked to read "Up" and
of bank.
"Down." 8. Climb indicator-registers the rate of climb in feet per minute, so
9. Clock—is very important for navigation and maintaining schedules.

that the pilot has a ready means of determining whether he is climbing fast
enough. If it registers zero, the airplane is flying level; if it registers nega-
10. Compass—may be one of two types, magnetic or radio. Both are

usually used for cross-checking purposes. For private airplanes, a compass

is required when the range is 100 or more miles, or when operating over
tively, the airplane is descending. The dial is marked to read "Up" and
large bodies of water beyond sight of land.

11. Drift indicator—an instrument which measures the angle between


"Down."
the actual flight path of the airplane and the longitudinal axis of the air-
9. Clock-is very important for navigation and maintaining schedules.
plane (which indicates the direction in which the airplane is headed).

10. Compass-may be one of two types, magnetic or radio. Both are


usually used for cross-checking purposes. For private airplanes, a compass
12. Fuel level gauge—a long-distance indicating gauge for registering the

actual fuel level in the fuel tank. If there are several fuel tanks, a sepa-

rate gauge for each tank is required.


is required when the range is 100 or more miles, or when operating over
13. Fuel pressure gauge—indicates the fuel pressure in the fuel line,

necessary for determining whether the fuel is brought to the engine in the
large bodies of water beyond sight of land.
proper quantities.
11. Drift indicator-an instrument which measures the angle between
14. Flap control—either a manually operated device for controlling the

the actual flight path of the airplane and the longitudinal axis of the air-
plane (which indicates the direction in which the airplane is headed).
flap or an electric switch for starting electric control. It may also be a

hydraulic pump handle.

15. Generators—attached to the engine at locations provided for them. 12. Fuel level gauge-a long-distance indicating gauge for registering the
These generators generate the power required for lighting and for motor-

actual fuel level in the fuel tank. If there are several fuel tanks, a sepa-
driven appliances.

16. Manifold pressure gauge—registers the actual pressures in the engine


rate gauge for each tank is required.
manifolds. Nowadays a close check is kept on the manifold pressures
13. Fuel pressure gauge-indicates the fuel pressure in the fuel line,
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:57 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

which are changed from time to time by the pilot to give the necessary

power for take-off and cruising.


necessary for determining whether the fuel is brought to the engine in the
proper quantities. ·
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

17. Octant—used for celestial navigation. The instrument measures the

vertical angle between the horizon and a celestial body.

14. Flap control~ither a manually operated device for controlling the


flap or an electric switch for starting electric control. It may also be a
18. Oxygen equipment—consists of various regulators and indicators as

well as tanks and distributing units. Airplanes flying above 14,000 feet

for any great length of time are required to carry this equipment.
hydraulic pump handle.
15. Generators-attached to the engine at locations provided for them.
These generators generate the power required for lighting and for motor-
driven appliances.
16. Manifold pressure gauge-registers the actual pressures in the engine
manifolds. Nowadays a close check is kept on the manifold pressures
which are changed from time to time by the pilot to give the necessary
power for take-off and cruising.
17. Octant-used for celestial navigation. The instrument measures the
vertical angle between the horizon and a celestial body.
18. Oxygen equipment-consists of various regulators and indicators as
well as tanks and distributing units. Airplanes flying above 14,000 feet
for any great length. of time are required to carry this equipment.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
196 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
196

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


19. Propeller controls and indicators· --Prupellers of today are usually of
19. Propeller controls and indicators—Propellers of today are usually of

the controllable pitch. Whether automatically, manually, or semi-auto-


the controllable pitch. Whether automatically, manually, or semi-auto-

matically controlled, there are certain control instruments and pitch indi-
matically controlled, there are certain control instruments and pitch indi-
cators present. These vary according to the type of propeller. cators present. These vary according to the type of propeller.
20. Pumps—Fuel pumps are either hand operated or engine driven;

20. Pumps-Fuel pumps are either hand operated or engine driven;


there may be pumps for the hydraulic systems, and in some cases, oil

pumps may also be required. Pumps operated by hand, or used for in-
there may be pumps for the hydraulic systems, and in some cases, oil
termittent duty only, are usually operated from the instrument board.
pumps may also be required. Pumps operated by hand, or used for in-
21. Radio—Safe flying is dependent upon radio and telephone com-

munication. This equipment has a number of switches, dials, and con-


termittent duty only, are usually operated from the instrument board.
trols which must be located so as to be easily accessible to the co-pilot or 21. Radio---Safe flying is dependent upon radio and telephone com-
radioman.

munication. This equipment has a number of switches, dials, and con-


22. Suction gauges—indicate the suction pressure in the lines leading to

the automatic pilot and other instruments depending upon suction for
trols which must be located so as to be easily accessible to the co-pilot or
their operation.
radioman.
23. Sperry artificial horizon—a• visual indicating device used to indicate

the "horizon" when the actual horizon is obscured. It is of particular


22. Suction gauges-indicate the suction pressure in the lines leading to
importance in all blind flying operations when the intuitive sense of man
the automatic pilot and other instruments depending upon suction for
is decidedly unreliable.

their operation.
23. Sperry artificial horizon-a visual indicating device used to indicate
24. Switches—ignition switches, radio switches, light switches, electrical

appliance and equipment switches in any number, found in the cockpit.

25. Starters—Control for the operation of the engine starter may be


the "horizon" when the actual horizon is obscured. It is of particular
found in the cockpit unless the airplane is small.

26. Tachometer—It is very important that the crankshaft speeds of the


importance in all blind flying operations when the intuitive sense of man
engines be known at all times. Any sudden change is a warning that
is decidedly unreliable.
something must be wrong. The revolutions per minute indicated by the

24. Switches-ignition switches, radio switches, light switches, electrical


appliance and equipment switches in any number, found in the cockpit.
tachometer also serve as some indication of the actual power developed by

the engines on take-off; the indicated rpm is high since more power is re-

quired for the take-off than at any other time. During cruising, the rpm
25. Starters-Control for the operation of the engine starter may be
of the engine is lower than for high speed since less power is required and

better fuel and oil consumptions are obtained at lower engine speeds.
found in the cockpit unless the airplane is small.
27. Thermometers—used to register oil temperatures; to register the
26. Tachometer-It is very important that the crankshaft speeds of the
temperature of the coolant in case of liquid-cooled engines; to register
engines be known at all times. Any sudden change is a warning that
cabin temperatures for heating and ventilating purposes; to register the

outside temperatures (especially important when icing conditions are


something must be wrong.· The revolutions per minute indicated by the
tachometer also serve as some indication of the actual power developed by
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:57 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

likely to be present).

28. Turn indicator—often combined with the bank indicator; when the

the engines on take-off; the indicated rpm is high since more power is re-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

two are used in conjunction with each other they are considered among

the most important flight-control instruments and should be located on


quired for the take-off than at any other time. During cruiF>ing, the rpm
the instrument board in the direct and unobstructed forward view of the
of the engine is lower than for high speed since less power is required and
pilot in the center of what is called the "primary flight group" consisting

of the airspeed indicator, the turn-and-bank, and the rate-of-climb indi-


better fuel and oil consumptions are obtained at lower engine speeds.
cator.
27. Thermometers-used to register oil temperatures; to register the
temperature of the coolant in case of liquid-cooled engines; to register
cabin temperatures for heating and ventilating purposes; to register the
outside temperatures (especially important when icing conditions are
likely to be present).
28. Turn indicator-often combined with the bank indicator; when the
two are used in conjunction with each other they are considered among
the most important flight-control instruments and should be located on
the instrument board in the direct and unobstructed forward view of the
pilot in the center of what is called the "primary flight group" consisting
of the airspeed indicator, the turn-and-bank, and the rate-of-climb indi-
cator.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 197
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 197

29. Warning units—may be special lights that flash on and off; or buzz-
29. TVarning units-may be special lights that flash on and off; or buzz-
ing signals; or any similar devices. Very often the positions of the hands

on the various indicating dials are sufficient warning signals. Since the
ing signals; or any similar devices. Very of ten the positions of the hands
dials may be rotated, some instruments are so arranged that during the
on the various indicating dials are sufficient warning signals. Since the
most common flying regime, such as cruising, dial hands or pointers of all

dials may be rotated, some instruments are so arranged that during the
most common flying regime, such as cruising, dial hands or pointers of all
the most important instruments point in the same general direction. If

one is out of alignment, it may be an indication that either the instrument

is not functioning or that the particular piece of apparatus with which it


the most important instruments point in the same general direction. If
is used is not functioning properly. Both cases are likely to be present.

Selection of Instruments
one is out o( alignment, it may be an indication that either the instrument
Instruments and equipment required or desirable for an airplane de-
is not functioning or that the particular piece of apparatus with which it
pends greatly upon the purpose, and whether visual contact or instrument

is used is not functioning properly. Both cases are likely to be present.


flying is required. Recent airplane airworthiness regulations require

some or all of the following instruments and indicators for nonpassenger-

carrying airplanes.
Selection of Instruments
1 airspeed indicator,

Instruments and equipment required or desirable for an airplane de-


pends greatly upon the purpose, and whether visual contact or instrument
1 altimeter,

1 tachometer for each engine,

1 oil-pressure gauge when an oil-pressure system is used, flying is required. Recent airplane airworthiness regulations require
1 water thermometer for each water-cooled engine used,

some or all of the following instruments and indicators for nonpassenger-


^00t~oil thermometer for each air-cooled engine used,

1 manifold-pressure gauge, or equivalent, for each altitude engine,


carrying airplanes.
1 fuel quantity gauge,

1 landing-gear position indicator for retractable main landing gear,


1 airspeed indicator,
1 device for measuring or indicating the amount of oil in the tanks,
1 altimeter,
1 magnetic compass (for airplanes flying visual-contact, distance

1 tachometer for each engine,


greater than 100 miles).

For night visual-contact flying, the following should be added:


1 oil-pressure gauge when an oil-pressure system is used,
position lights, 1 water thermometer for each water-cooled engine used,
landing lights,

- +-oil thermometer for each air-cooled engine used,


landing flank,

storage battery for lights and radio,


1 manifold-pressure gauge, or equivalent, for each altitude engine,
radio range and weather broadcast receiver,
- 1 fuel quantity gauge,
a set of spare fuses.

If instrument flying is contemplated, the following are added:


- ! landing-gear position indicator for retractable main landing gear,
1 gyroscopic rate-of-turn indicator, 1 device for measuring or indicating the amount of oil in the tanks,
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1 bank indicator,

.. 1 magnetic compass (for airplanes flying visual-contact, distance


1 sensitive altimeter,

greater than 100 miles).


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1 clock with a sweep-second hand,

For night visual-contact flying, the following should be added:


1 generator,

1 rate-of-climb indicator.

position lights,
landing lights,
landing flank,
storage battery for lights and radio,
radio range and wea.ther broadcast receiver,
a set of spare fuses.
If instrument flying is contemplated, the following are added:
1 gyroscopic rate-of-turn indicator,
1 bank indicator,
1 sensitive altimeter,
1 clock with a sweep-second hand,
1 generator,
1 rate-of-climb indicator.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
198 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
198

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


For airplanes carrying passengers, the following may be additional instru-
For airplanes carrying passengers, the following may be additional instru-

ments and equipment required, or may replace some of similar category


ments and equipment required, or may replace some of similar category
listed already:
listed already:
1 electrically heated pitot tube, or equivalent for airspeed indicator,

1 additional portable fire extinguisher,


1 electrically heated pitot tube, or equivalent for airspeed indicator,
1 fixed fire extinguishing system for each engine compartment,
1 additional portable fire extinguisher,
1 noncontinuous manual means for providing vision through windshield

in case of rain during take-offs and landings, instrument lights,


1 fixed fire extinguishing system for each engine compartment,
cabin lights in all passenger cabins and compartments, 1 noncontinuous manual means for providing vision through windshield
1 gyroscopic direction finder,

in case of rain during take-offs and landings, instrument lights,


cabin lights in all passenger cabins and compartments,
1 free air thermometer of the distance type,

1 icing indicator.

ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT
1 gyroscopic direction finder,
The electrical equipment and system of a large transport airplane is per-

haps more complex and larger than many reasonably sized communities.
1 free air thermometer of the distance type,
All the storage and generation of the electrical power supply must be car-
1 icing indicator.
ried by the airplane. Special precautions must be taken to protect the

electrical system from fuel, oil, water, and any other damaging substances. ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT
The electrical equipment and system of a large transport airplane is per-
Moreover, adequate clearances must be provided between the wiring and

such installations as oil and fuel tanks and systems, carburetors, exhaust

piping, and moving parts. haps more complex and larger than many reasonably sized communities.
Storage batteries should be easily accessible, preferably from outside of

the airplane, and adequately isolated from fuel, oil, and ignition systems.
All the storage and generation of the electrical power supply must be car-
Suitable ventilation and isolation must be provided for each battery.
ried by the airplane. Special precautions must be taken to protect the
Fuses are a required protective feature, so installed to protect all elec-

electrical system from fuel, oil, water, and any other damaging substances.
trically operated equipment, and made readily accessible in flight.

In estimating the size of the generating system required, the engine-


Moreover, adequate clearances must be provided between the wiring and
driven generator should be designed to carry the running load with a such installations as oil and fuel tanks and systems, carburetors, exhaust
stand-by system if feasible. The running load comprises the electrical

piping, and moving parts.


consumption by all lights, radio equipment including radio-range signal re-

ceivers, and any other equipment which exacts a constant load. Radio
Storage batteries should be easily accessible, preferably from outside of
broadcasting equipment, landing lights, and electrically operated landing
the airplane, and adequately isolated from fuel, oil, and ignition systems.
gears and flaps are considered as causing only intermittent use. Landing

lights should be so installed on multi-engine aircraft so that at least one


Suitable ventilation and isolation must be provided for each battery.
light is not less than 10 feet either right or left of the first pilot's seat and Fuses are a required protective feature; so installed to protect all elec-
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

beyond the swept disk of the outermost propellers.

trically operated equipment, and made readily accessible in flight.


Instrument lights should provide sufficient illumination and should be

In estimating the size of the generating system required, the engine-


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

equipped with rheostat control for dimming unless the nondimming light

can be shown to be satisfactory.


driven generator should be designed to carry the running load with a
Position lights are required for airplanes operating at night. In normal

flying position, the red forward-position light on the left and the green
stand-by system if feasible. The running load comprises the electrical
forward-position light on the right should be spaced as far apart as possible
consumption by all lights, radio equipment including radio-range signal re-
ceivers, and any other equipment which exacts a constant load. Radio
broadcasting equipment, landing lights, and electrically operated landing
gears and flaps are considered as causing only intermittent use. Landing
lights should be so installed on multi-engine aircraft so that at least one
light is not less than 10 feet either right or left of the first pilot's seat and
beyond the swept disk of the outermost propellers.
Instrument lights should provide ~ufficient illumination and should be
equipped with rheostat control for dimming unless the nondimming light
can be shown to be satisfactory.
Position lights are required for airplanes operating at night. In normal
flying position, the red forward-position light on the left and the green
forward-position light on the right should be spaced as far apart as possible

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 199
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 199

on the wing. Each should show unbroken light between two vertical

on the wing. Each should show unbroken light between two vertical
planes whose dihedral angle is 110 degrees when measured to the left and
planes whose dihedral angle is 110 degrees when measured to the left and

right, respectively, of the airplane from dead ahead.

One rear-position light, either continuous white or alternate red and right, respectively, of the airplane from dead ahead.
white flashes (depending upon whether the airplane is a carrier or noncar-

One rear-position light, either continuous white or alternate red and


rier type) should be placed as far back as possible. It should emit light

throughout a dihedral angle of 140 degrees bisected by a vertical plane


white flashes (depending upon whether the airplane is a carrier or n.oncar-
through the longitudinal axis of the airplane.
rier type) should be placed as far back as possible. It should emit light
A master switch has to be provided in the cockpit for the entire elec-

trical equipment.
throughout a dihedral angle of 140 degrees bisected by a vertical plane
SAFETY EQUIPMENT through the longitudinal axis of the airplane.
Every airplane is required to have some safety equipment, such as safety

A master switch has to be provided in the cockpit for the entire elec-
belts for pilot, crew, and passengers. Private airplanes may carry a para-

chute for each occupant, but this item becomes a considerable weight fac-
trical equipment.
tor where the number of passengers is reasonably large. Since the majority

of accidents, when they do occur, happen at altitudes where parachutes


SAFETY EQUIPMENT
are of no value, the presence of parachutes is more psychological than

practical. Every airplane is required to have some safety equipment, such as safety
Fire extinguishers are either portable or fixed installation type. At

belts for pilot, crew, and passengers. Private airplanes may carry a para-
least one portable fire extinguisher should be accessible to the passengers,

and another accessible to the crew. Airplanes carrying no passengers


chute for each occupant, but this item becomes a considerable weight fac-
need carry only one fire extinguisher.
tor where the number of passengers is reasonably large. Since the majority
Landing flares for use in emergencies should be releasable from the pilot's

compartment. Airplanes designed only for contact flying need carry no


of accidents, when they do occur, happen at altitudes where parachutes
landing flares. are of no value, the presence of parachutes is more psychological than
DE-ICING AND ANTI-ICING

practical. -
Fire extinguishers are either portable or fixed installation type. At
Included in the safety equipment which is required for transport air-

planes are de-icers for all the surfaces and some form of de-icing means for

the propeller. One of the positive methods of breaking up dry ice forma-
least one portable fire extinguisher should be accessible to the passengers,
tion on the leading edges of the wing and tail surfaces are rubber overshoes

containing tubes that are inflated and deflated alternately to break up


and another accessible to the crew. Airplanes carrying no passengers
any ice formation.
need carry only one fire extinguisher.
Heating the leading edge surfaces by conducting heat either from the

Landing flares for use in emergencies should be releasable from the pilot's
compartment. Airplanes designed only for contact flying need carry no
engine exhaust pipes or from especially designed heaters is also employed

on larger airplanes to prevent ice formation. This method is often referred

to as anti-icing.
landing flares.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The formation of ice on propellers may be avoided by suitable anti-icing

fluid which is distributed by slinger rings at the hub.

DE-ICING AND ANTI-ICING


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Some significant features suggested for an aircraft heating and thermal

anti-icing system, as proposed by the Stewart-Warner Corporation, are

Included in the safety equipment which is required for transport air-


planes are de-icers for all the surfaces and some form of de-icing means for
indicated in the general description given here.

the propeller. One of the positive methods of breaking up dry ice forma-
tion on the leading edges of the wing and tail surfaces are rubber overshoes
containing tubes that are inflated and deflated alternately to break up
any ice formation.
Heating the leading edge surfaces by conducting heat either from the
engine exhaust pipes or from especially designed heaters is also employed
on larger airplanes to prevent ice formation. This method is often referred
to as anti-icing.
The formation of ice on propellers may be avoided by suitable anti-icing
fluid which is distributed by slinger rings at the hub.
Some significant features suggested for an aircraft heating and thermal
anti-icing system, as proposed by the Stewart-Warner Corporation, are
indicated in the general description given here.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
200 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
200

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


The safety features of the heater include a complete segregation of the
The safety features of the heater include a complete segregation of the

combustion and ventilating systems, with the combustion air being ob·
combustion and ventilating systems, with the combustion air being ob-

tained from a source separate from the ventilating air; the enclosure of the
tained from a source separate from the ventilating air; the enclosure of the
heater fuel system so that no fuel connections are exposed within the
heater fuel system so that no fuel connections are exposed within the
ventilating air stream; and, the construction of the heater so that all flame

ventilating air stream; and, the construction of the heater so that all flame
and combustion gases are contained within a one-piece, hermetically
and combustion gases are contained within a one-piece, hermetically

sealed, all-welded stainless steel assembly.

This heater is also constructed in such a manner that, if installed with


sealed, all-welded stainless steel assembly.
a 3-inch diameter exhaust pipe and with ventilating air ducts of the proper

restriction on the downstream side of the heater, the static pressure in the
This heater is also constructed in such a manner that, if installed with
ventilating air stream in the heater will be greater than the static pressure
a 3-inch diameter exhaust pipe and with ventilating air ducts of the proper
in the combustion passages. Then, even in the event of a rupture of the

restriction on the downstream side of the heater, the static pressure in the
ventilating air stream in the heater will be greater than the static pressure
normally hermetically sealed heat exchanger, there will be no leakage of

combustion gases and fuel vapors into the ventilating air stream. Instead,

there will be a flow of air from the ventilating air passages into the com-
in the combustion passages. Then, even in the event of a rupture of the
bustion chamber.

Instantaneous starting at altitudes as high as 41,000 feet, and greater,


normally hermetically sealed heat exchanger, there will be no leakage of
can be obtained. Performance runs in which the heater is controlled by
combustion gases and fuel vapors into the ventilating air stream. Instead,
rapid "cycling," as well as starting trials in which the heater is first turned

there will be a flow of air from the ventilating air passages into the com-
bustion chamber.
off and permitted to cool to ambient temperature condition, are part of

the qualifying tests usually specified.

One heater is intended to be mounted horizontally with the exhaust out- Instantaneous starting at altitudes as high as 41,000 feet, and greater,
let down so that the exhaust tube may act also as a drain. For that rea-

son, the tube should be installed so that its entire length slopes downward
can be obtained. Performance runs in which the heater is controlled by
from the outlet of the heater to the point where it discharges overboard.
rapid "cycling," as well as starting trials in which the heater is first turned
Unless the exhaust tube is very short, some provision such as a flexible,
off and permitted to cool to ambient temperature condition, are part of
the qualifying tests usually specified.
lined, stainless-steel bellows section should be provided to permit expan-

sion of the tube. The entire exhaust system should be designed to handle

exhaust gases at temperatures up to approximately 1000° F. One heater is intended to be mounted horizontally with the exhaust out-
A combustion air regulator valve is needed only if the heaters are re-

let down so that the exhaust tube may act also as a drain. For that rea-
quired to operate over a very wide range of air speeds and altitudes.

Usually, when the combustion chamber and fuel system are completely
son, the tube should be installed so that its entire length slopes downward
enclosed, the heater may be installed with ventilating air flowing in either
from the outlet of the heater to the point where it discharges overboard.
direction (parallel flow or counter flow).

Heaters are designed for operation on a constant fuel pressure of ap-


Unless the exhaust tube is very short, some provision such as a flexible,
lined, stainless-steel bellows section should be provided to permit expan-
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

proximately 15 pounds per square inch. If it is possible to obtain fuel at

that pressure from the main engine fuel pumps, the weight and potential

sion of the tube. The entire exhaust system should be designed to handle
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

service troubles of a separate heater pump can be avoided. Moreover,

the heaters then benefit from all the high-altitude provisions made in the
exhaust gases at temperatures up to approximately 1000° F.
engine fuel system to ensure delivery to the engine of fuel that is free of air
A combustion air regulator valve is needed only if the heaters are re-
and vapor bubbles. If it is not possible to obtain fuel from the main engine

pumps, and if the heaters will be required to operate at altitudes in excess


quired to operate over a very wide range of air speeds and altitudes.
of 15,000 feet, the inlet of the heater pump must be connected to a fuel
Usually, when the combustion chamber and fuel system are completely
enclosed, the heater may be installed with ventilating air flowing in either
direction (parallel flow or counter flow).
Heaters are designed for operation on a constant fuel pressure of ap-
proximately 15 pounds per square inch. If it is possible to obtain fuel at
that pressure from the main engine fuel pumps, the weight and potential
service troubles of a separate heater pump can be avoided. Moreover,
the heaters then benefit from all the high-altitude provisions made in the
engine fuel system to ensure delivery to the engine of fuel that is free of air
and vapor bubbles. If it is not possible to obtain fuel from the main engine
pumps, and if the heaters will be required to operate at altitudes in excess
of 15,000 feet, the inlet of the heater pump must be connected to a fuel

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT 201
INSTRUMENTS AND EQUIPMENT

201
source downstream of the booster pump (customarily located at the fuel
source downstream of the booster pump (customarily located at the fuel

tank) to remove vapor from the main fuel system. Whatever source is
tank) to remove vapor from the main fuel system. Whatever source is
provided, it must be capable of supplying a maximum fuel flow.
provided, it must be capable of supplying a maximum fuel flow.
Controls include: an air pressure switch to prevent operation of the

Controls include: an air pressure switch to prevent operation of the


heaters in the absence at the heater inlet of a static pressure sufficient to
heaters in the absence at the heater inlet of a static pressure sufficient to

provide an adequate air flow; a "cycling" thermal switch to maintain outlet

air temperatures at approximately 300° F by controlling a pair of fuel provide an adequate air flow; a "cycling" thermal switch to maintain outlet
shut-off valves at the heater; and, an overheat switch to close these valves

in the event outlet air temperatures reach 350° F. Since the "cycling"
air temperatures at approximately 300° F by controlling a pair of fuel
switch normally prevents outlet air temperatures much in excess of 300° F,
shut-off valves at the heater; and, an overheat switch to close these valves
the overheat switch is not called upon to operate except in the event of

in the event outlet air temperatures reach 350° F. Since the "cycling"
switch normally prevents outlet air temperatures much in excess of 300° F,
malfunctioning of the "cycling" switch. It is, in short, a safety switch.

Two shut-off valves, arranged electrically in parallel and hydraulically

in series, are used at each group of heaters to provide a double precaution the overheat switch is not called upon to operate except in the event of
in the event of sticking of one of the valves.

malfunctioning of the "cycling" switch. It is, in short, a safety switch.


Two shut-off valves, arranged electrically in parallel and hydraulic.ally
in series, are used at each group of heaters to provide a double precaution
in the event of sticking of one of the valves.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
CHAPTER XII

The Passenger Cabin

It would seem to be an easy matter to design the passenger cabin, to pro-

vide proper seating arrangement, heating and ventilating, and vision out-

ward. After all, there are only a few rows of chairs placed rather closely

together and usually a window beside each chair. But, as in all parts of

the airplane, numerous considerations enter into the final solution which
CHAPTER XII
is the result of many compromises of arrangement, structure, and balance,

as well as weight.

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS

The Passenger Cabin


From the passenger's viewpoint, as much room as possible is desirable,

but if this consideration were given full weight the size of the cabin might

become unwieldy for the type of airplane to be built. Moreover, if all the

seats are not occupied, the center of gravity will not coincide with its posi-

tion for the fully loaded condition, and just as soon as the center of gravity

has moved too far from a given position, the pilot will find it difficult to

balance, and so to fly, the airplane. This has been discussed earlier, to

some extent, when the balance diagram was considered.

Therefore, to avoid a too-large cabin, it is best to start with the question:

"What is the minimum allowance for spacing of seats, for aisle widths,

It would seem to be an easy matter to design the passenger cabin, to pro-


vide proper seating arrangement, heating and ventilating, and vision out-
and for headroom?" A student measured the distance between backs of

two church pews, one behind the other, and found it to be 28 inches, but

also reported that the spacing was not conducive to comfort. However, ward. After all, there are only a few rows of chairs placed rather closely
one may say that distance is the absolute minimum spacing possible. Any

additional allowance adds to the comfort, but discretion must be used. If


together and usually a window beside each chair. But, as in all parts of
there is a central fuselage with the engines located in the wings, greater
the airplane, numerous considerations enter into the final solution which
leeway may be permitted for both fully loaded and empty conditions and

is the result of many compromises of arrangement, structure, and balance,


still good balance obtained, because the movable or variable load may be

placed with its center of gravity coinciding with the center of gravity of
as well as weight.
the complete airplane. For a single-engine airplane with the engine in

the nose, it is not usually possible to get this happy solution and so less
GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
202

From the passenger's viewpoint, as much room as possible is desirable,


but if this consideration were given full weight the size of the cabin might
become unwieldy for the type of airplane to be built. Moreover, if all the
seats are not occupied, the center of gravity will not coincide with its posi-
tion for the fully loaded condition, and just as soon as the center of gravity
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

has moved too far from a given position, the pilot will find it difficult to
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

balance, and so to fly, the airplane. This has been discussed earlier, to
some extent, when the balance diagram was considered.
Therefore, to avoid a too-large cabin, it is best to start with the question:
"What is the minimum allowance for spacing of seats, for aisle widths,
and for headroom?" A student measured the distance between backs of
two church pews, one behind the other, and found it to be 28 inches, but
also reported that the spacing was not conducive to comfort. However,
one may say that distance is the absolute minimum spacing possible. Any
additional allowance adds to the comfort, but discretion must be used. If
there is a central fuselage with the engines located in the wings, greater
leeway may be permitted for both fully loaded and empty conditions and
still good balance obtained, because the movable or variable load may be
placed with its center of gravity coinciding with the center of gra.vity of
the complete airplane. For a single-engine airplane with the engine in
the nose, it is not usually possible to get this happy solution and so less
202

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE PASSENGER CABIN 203
THE PASSENGER CABIN

203 allowance must be given to the spacing of seats than absolute comfort may
allowance must be given to the spacing of seats than absolute comfort may

require.
require.
There should be no obstructions overhead or on the floor. Sometimes,
There should be no obstructions overhead or on the floor. Sometimes,
to avoid too deep a fuselage, a designer will locate the wing spars so that

to avoid too deep a fuselage, a designer will locate the wing spars so that
they extend above the floor level. Usually, in such a case, there is a mini-
they extend above the floor level. Usually, in such a case, there is a mini-

mum of headroom so that the passenger is likely to stoop to avoid hitting

his head and while worrying about that matter, he is more than likely to mum of headroom so that the passenger is likely to stoop to avoid hitting
forget about the floor obstructions. If floor obstructions are necessary

(and that is debatable), a wall with a door in the center may be a good
his head and while worrying about that matter, he is more than likely to
solution since passengers usually expect to step high over a sill, especially
forget about the floor obstructions. If floor obstructions are necessary
if in some way their attention is drawn to it.

(and that is debatable), a wall with a door in the center may be a good
Obstructions, even on the side walls, should be prohibited unless the

cabin is large enough to permit incorporation of compartments so that side-


solution since passengers usually expect to step high over a sill, especially
wall obstructions can be hidden in the dividing partitions. if in some way their attention is drawn to it.
COMFORT FACTORS

The interior treatment of the cabin often may give an impression of


Obstructions, even on the side walls, should be prohibited unless the
spaciousness without being actually large. White or light-colored ceilings
cabin is large enough to permit incorporation of compartments so that side-
give an impression of height, so that the cabin may be made narrower or
wall obstructions can be hidden in the dividing partitions.
shorter without affecting the passengers unfavorably. There is at present

much interest in interior decoration of aircraft cabins, particularly in the

COMFORT FACTORS
psychological effects of various treatments.

The major factors affecting the comfort of passengers are:


The interior treatment of the cabin often may give an impression of
1. Roominess, which has to be provided through proper seating; as large

spaciousness without being actually large. White or light-colored ceilings


give an impression of height, so that the cabin may be made narrower or
cubical capacity per passenger as possible; and, a reasonable amount of

leg room, elbow room, and headroom.

2. Proper heating and ventilating, which is the subject of a subsequent


shorter without affecting the passengers unfavorably. There is at present
chapter.

3. Soundproofing, which is of great importance even for airplanes flying


much interest in interior decoration of aircraft cabins, particularly in the
for relatively short periods of time and much more so for transcontinental
psychological effects of various treatments.
and transoceanic airplanes which are in the air for many hours.

The major factors affecting the comfort of passengers are:


4. Vision outward so that the passengers may see the country over which

they are flying. Although on long flights the passengers may find the
1. Roominess, which has to be provided through proper seating; as large
scenery monotonous after a short while, there is a soothing effect produced

by being able to see below.


cubical capacity per passenger as possible; and, a reasonable amount of
5. Conveniences such as toilet facilities, refreshments, reading material,
leg room, elbow room, and headroom.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

writing desks, and other small items, which make traveling more appeal-

2. Proper heating and ventilating, which is the subject of a subsequent


chapter.
ing.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The notes that follow will help the designer in planning the cabin layout.

CABIN DIMENSIONS
3. Soundproofing, which is of great importance even for airplanes flying
The cabin dimensions depend upon the type of chair, the number of

passengers, and the constructor's conceptions of comfort requirements.


for relatively short periods of time and much more so for transcontinental
and transoceanic airplanes which are in the air for many hours.
4. Vision outward so that the passengers may see the country over which
they are flying. Although on long flights the passengers may find the
scenery monotonous after a short while, there is a soothing effect produced
by being able to see below.
5. Conveniences such as toilet facilities, refreshments, reading material,
writing desks, and other small items, which make traveling more appeal-
mg.
The notes that follow will help the designer in planning the cabin layout.
CABIN DIMENSIONS
The cabin dimensions depend upon the type of chair, the number of
passengers, and the constructor's conceptions of comfort requirements.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

~
L} t.i:-.

N
ct>

2"- 6 "for structure

::i...
~
0 ~
::i...
~

c:::::
:z:
<
~o
V'I ~.
I
~
-1.0 ~
~ :;·
0 DI
"'T'1 :::::;:;
~
~
3: a
r.3
::I: FwuRE XIl-1. Suggested dimensions for windows, doors, and spacing of passenger
G"I
scats.
>
:z
THE PASSENGER CABIN 205
THE PASSENGER CABIN

205
Two rows of chairs with a center aisle are common practice. Two seats
Two rows of chairs with a center aisle are common practice. Two seats

on one side and one on the other helps to concentrate the variable load and
is therefore better for stability and trim for empty and full conditions.
on one side and one on the other helps to concentrate the variable load and

is therefore better for stability and trim for empty and full conditions.

The latter arrangement requires a wider fuselage that may affect the per-
The latter arrangement requires a wider fuselage that may afiect the per-
formance of the airplane by increasing the parasite resistance.

The main requirements for a comfortable cabin are:


formance of the airplane by increasing the parasite resistance.
1. An aisle wide enough to permit passengers to walk up and down with-
The main requirements for a comfortable cabin are:
out disturbing passengers in seats. Aisle widths vary from 12 to 24 inches

with an average width of 16 inches.


1. An aisle wide enough to permit passengers to walk up and down with-
2. An aisle ceiling high enough to permit a tall man with a hat on to

out disturbing passengers in seats. Aisle widths vary from 12 to 24 inches


walk its length without stooping. Aisle heights vary from 51 inches for

the minimum value up to 75 inches maximum. Except for possible private


with an average width of 16 inches.
use, a passenger-carrying airplane should have an aisle height of at least 2. An aisle ceiling high enough to permit a tall man with a hat on to
72 inches. Elsewhere it is not necessary to have such height as to permit

walk its length without stooping. Aisle heights vary from 51 inches for
standing erect, but the use of members over the seats that may be struck

by a passenger rising should be avoided.


the minimum value up to 75 inches maximum. Except for possible private
3. A minimum width for a cabin seating two passengers should be 66
use, a passenger-carrying airplane should have an aisle height of at least
inches with an additional 25 inches for each additional passenger across

the width of the plane. Cabin widths for two rows of passengers vary
72 inches. Elsewhere it is not necessary to have such height as to permit
from 52 inches for small cabins up to 66 inches for cabins seating 14 or
standing erect, but the use of members over the seats that may be struck
more passengers.

by a passenger rising should be avoided.


3. A minimum width for a cabin seating two passengers should be 66
A wide aisle gives the impression of spaciousness and may permit some

reduction in the allowance for headroom.

The cabin should be free from structural members. If these are un- inches with an additional 25 inches for each additional passenger across
avoidable, separate compartments provided for groups of passengers may

overcome this objection.


the width of the plane. Cabin widths for two rows of passengers vary
PASSENGER SEATS
from 52 inches for small cabins up to 66 inches for cabins seating 14 or
Passenger seats should incorporate the following features:
more passengers.
1. Seats should be adjustable with respect to the angle of the seat with

the floor and the angle of the back of the seat to the vertical.

A wide aisle gives the impression of spaciousness and may permit some
reduction in the allowance for headroom.
2. Seats should be reversible to permit the passengers to face each

other if they care to.

3. Seat adjustments should be made easily and quickly by the passen- The cabin should be free from structural members. If these are un-
ger.

4. A foot rest should be provided in the form of an apron or shelf, pref-


avoidable, separate compartments provided for groups of passengers may
overcome this objection.
Generated on 2012-05-30 02:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

erably adjustable, attached to the seat ahead.

5. Seats should be permitted to swivel for easy egress if cabin clear-

PASSENGER SEATS
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ances and weight allowances permit. Placing the chair at a slight angle

to the fore and aft axis of the cabin accomplishes practically the same

result.
Passenger seats should incorporate the following features:
1. Seats should be adjustable with respect to the angle of the seat with
the floor and the angle of the back of the seat to the vertical.
2. Seats should be reversible to permit the passengers to face each
other if they care to.
3. Seat adjustments should be made easily and quickly by the passen-
ger.
4. A foot rest should be provided in the form of an apron or shelf, pref-
erably adjustable, attached to the seat ahead.
5. Seats should be permitted to swivel for easy egress if cabin clear-
ances and weight allowances permit. Placing the chair at a slight angle
to the fore and aft axis of the cabin accomplishes practically the same
result.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
206 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
206

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


6. Easy egress may be obtained also if the outside arm of the seat can
6. Easy egress may be obtained also if the outside arm of the seat can

be dropped.
7. Cushions on seat bottom should be deep and provided with springs
be dropped.

7. Cushions on seat bottom should be deep and provided with springs

as well as padding to reduce effects of bumps on landing and in the air.


as well as padding to reduce effects of bumps on landing and in the air.
8. Direct metallic contact of the seat with the structure may be avoided

8. Direct metallic contact of the seat with the structure may be avoided
by means of suitable rubber shock-absorbing connections.

9. Width of each seat should be at least 24 inches, with 1-inch clear-


by means of suitable rubber shock-absorbing connections.
ance between seat and inner lining of the cabin. A minimum width of 19
9. Width of each seat should be at least 24 inches, with 1-inch clear-
inches may be permitted.

10. For a narrow cabin, the backs of the seats should be tapered toward
ance between seat and inner lining of the cabin. A minimum width of 19
the top, especially those paralleling the aisle. This design permits more
inches may be permitted.
room for passengers going down the aisle.

10. For a narrow cabin, the backs of the seats should be tapered toward
the top, especially those paralleling the aisle. This design permits more
11. Seats should not weigh more than 20 pounds. Seat weights vary

from about 12 to 20 pounds.

12. Seats may be made convertible into berths by lowering back to


room for passengers going down the aisle.
form bottom of berth.

13. Ample leg room should be provided. Seats are spaced from 30 to
11. Seats should not weigh more than 20 pounds. Seat weights vary
40 inches apart, with an average of 36-inch spacing for cabin passenger
from about 12 to 20 pounds.
capacities of less than 12 persons.

12. Seats may be made convertible into berths by lowering back to


form bottom of berth.
14. All passenger seats should be identical.

SEATING ARRANGEMENTS

The optimum seating arrangement for the occupants of an airplane may 13. Ample leg room should be provided. Seats are spaced from 30 to
be considered from several points of view, namely: (1) passenger comfort,

(2) minimum effect upon the center of gravity of the airplane as a whole
40 inches apart, with an average of 36-inch spacing for cabin passenger
when one or more passengers are removed, (3) minimum frontal area of
capacities of less than 12 persons.
the structure required to house the enclosed group, (4) ready access to the
14. All passenger seats should be identical.
seats and to the available means of ingress and egress. To these may be

added: (5) minimum over-all dimensions, (6) possible effect upon struc-

tural design, and (7) safety considerations. There are probably other

factors such as: (8) ease in providing suitable vision panels, (9) baggage

space requirements, and (10) multipurpose use of the airplane which


SEATING ARRANGEMENTS
might be studied in relation to passenger seating. Obviously, all these
The optimum seating arrangement for the occupants of an airplane may
factors would affect the decision as to the seating arrangement finally

chosen. However, not all these factors can be given the same weight,
be considered from several points of view, namely: (1) passenger comfort,
since all airplane design is the result of a series of compromises, and it
(2) minimum effect upon the center of gravity of the airplane as a whole
when one or more passengers are removed, (3) minimum frontal area of
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:05 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

would be extremely difficult to set up a general method of evaluation sat-

the structure required to house the enclosed group, (4) ready access to the
isfactory to every one.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The seating arrangements are dependent upon the size of its occupants.

Of course, where space is limited for engineering reasons, it would be de- seats and to the available means of ingress and egress. To these may be
sirable to know the most likely heights and weights one might expect

added: (5) minimum over-all dimensions, (6) possible effect upon struc-
among the people who do the most flying. Figures XII-2 and XII-3 show

tural design, and (7) safety considerations. There are probably other
factors such as: (8) ease in providing suitable vision panels, (9) baggage
space requirements, and (10) multipurpose use of the airplane which
might be studied in relation to passenger seating. Obviously, all these
factors would affect the decision as to the seating arrangement finally
chosen. However, not all these factors can be given the same weight,
since all airplane design is the result of a series of compromises, and it
would be extremely difficult to set up a general method of evaluation sat-
isfactory to every one.
The seating arrangements are dependent upon the size of its occupants.
Of course, where space is limited for engineering reasons, it would be de-
1:1irable to know the mm;t likely height::; and weights one might expect
among the people who do the most flying. Figures XII- 2 and XII- 3 show

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PASSENGER CABIN 207
THE PASSENGER CABIN

207

to as
s = 18 11 - 26"
1 XTv^v
A = 12 11 - 24 11
Figure XII-2. Various seating arrangements across the aisle for passenger airplanes.

various seating arrangements and measurements. But just as one would

not expect the average bed to accommodate comfortably a man 7 feet tall,

so one should not expect the cabin of a light airplane to provide headroom,

however measured, for the exceptionally tall person. The average dimen-

sions for a man 6 feet tall were assumed and all discussion hereafter will

be based upon this size.

Headroom for Small Airplanes

The first part of the problem resolves itself into consideration of head-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XIl-2. Various seating arrangements across the aisle for passenger airpla.nes.

various seating arrangements and measurements. But just as one would


not expect the average bed to accommodate comfortably a man 7 feet tall,
so one should not expect the cabin of a light airplane to provide headroom,
however measured, for the exceptionally tall person. The average dimen-
sions for a man 6 feet tall were assumed and all discussion hereafter will
be based upon this size.
Headroom for Small Airplanes
The first part of the problem resolves itself into consideration of head-

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
208 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

room. For a. small airplane one should eliminate immediately the possi-
bility of providing headroom for a. standing person, since the penalty in
parasite resistance due to the large frontal area. would be prohibitive, a.t
lea.st for the performa.nce which one normally expects of such a.n airplane.
At the other extreme, we have the bare possibility of considering the
pilot in the prone position, preferably facing downward. It doesn't seem
conceivable that such a. position would be considered for passengers, unless
they a.re dead ones, since the "sardine" arrangement would hardly be a
comfortable one. Such a position would offer the lea.st frontal area, and
the total height of the fuselage, if designed to enclose the pilot a.lone, would
be in the neighborhood of 12 to 14 inches. Again, such a placement of
the pilot would be worth while considering only for an airplane which did
not have its power plant (unless it were a low horsepower, horizontally
opposed engine in the fuselage proper) ahead of the pilot. Even so, visi-
bility and comfort would be at the bottom of any scale of acceptance.
These two positions are, therefore, no longer under consideration, and
the seated position of the pilot or passenger seems to be the logical starting
point in arriving at allowances for headroom, where headroom will be
assumed to be the distance from the seat to the ceiling.
In settling down in a. seat, it is very likely that some time during the
process, the upper portion of the body is vertical (assuming the floor to be
horizontal for ease of reference). It follows then that the headroom a.1-
lowed above the seat (its highest point if inclined) must be at lea.st equal
to the length of the upper portion of the body. Referring to the 6-foot
man, it would seem that a height of some 3772 inches would be required.
Unless the occupant is expected to wear no hat, and provided that the ceil-
ing is sufficiently well padded to avoid injuring oneself on structural mem-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

F IG URE XII- 3. Average dimensions (in inches) for the standard-type seat provided
in airplanes. The width of seat should allow for 21% inches at hip level, and 22 inches
at shoulder level. If a t oeboard is provided it should tilt at 36 to 4-0 degrees. The
width of a berth is equal to that of 2 seats.

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PASSENGER CABIN 209
THE PASSENGER CABIN

209
hers either while moving about or in sudden jolts as in a rough landing or
bers either while moving about or in sudden jolts as in a rough landing or

in gusty air, a few more inches should be allowed (certainly not less than
in gusty air, a few more inches should be allowed (certainly not less than
2 inches) so that the total headroom required is about 39 to 40 inches.
2 inches) so that the total headroom required is about 39 to 40 inches.
This headroom could be reduced if the occupant of a seat could maneuver

This headroom could be reduced if the occupant of a seat could maneuver


into position either by crouching down and crawling in, or by sliding in
into position either by crouching down and crawling in, or by sliding in

from the side. If the back of the seat were inclined so that the occupant

could recline as much as 45 degrees, a saving in headroom of 30 per cent


from the side. If the back of the seat were inclined so that the occupant
could be obtained, or for the figures cited, a total of 12 inches.

If there is an overhead canopy or opening, the passenger could drop into


could recline as much as 45 degrees, a saving in headroom of 30 per cent
his seat, and after adjusting himself into position, he could close the over-
could be obtained, or for the figures cited, a total of 12 inches.
head cover.

If there is an overhead canopy or opening, the passenger could drop into


his seat, and after adjusting himself into position, he could close the over-
It is questionable whether passengers would care to remain for any great

length of time in such a reclined position, but such a position should cer-

tainly not be ruled out.


head cover.
But even if one were to toy with the idea of reducing the headroom by

reclining the occupants, one must not forget that the pilot cannot conven-
It is questionable whether passengers would care to remain for any great
iently operate the airplane in a reclined position. He must be able to sit
length of time in such a reclined position, but such a position should cer-
upright at times, at least. In order to provide the necessary headroom, a

tainly not be ruled out.


But even if one were to toy with the idea of reducing the headroom by
special canopy could be designed to enclose the cockpit portion of the

airplane. While the frontal area of the fuselage might not be reduced

materially, still such a solution would offer less skin friction, and permit reclining the occupants, one must not forget that the pilot cannot conven-
better streamlining than if equal headroom had to be allowed for the pas-

sengers.
iently operate the airplane in a reclined position. He must be able to sit
A progressive inclining of the backs of the seats rearward as shown in
upright at times, at least. In order to provide the necessary headroom, a
Figure XI1-4 might be considered, where a number of passengers may be

special canopy could be designed to enclose the cockpit portion of the


seated one behind the other, in order to permit a gradual reduction in the

fuselage depth toward the tail of the airplane.


airplane. While the frontal area of the fuselage might not be reduced
Headroom for Large Airplanes materially, still such a solution would offer less skin friction, and permit
For large airplanes, where one of the prime criteria for design is passen-

better streamlining than if equal headroom had to be allowed for the pas-
ger comfort, headroom for a standing person should be required. The

minimum headroom for a standing person would be 2 inches, so that the


sengers.
distance between the floor and the ceiling in the aisle for a 6-foot man
A progressive inclining of the backs of the seats rearward as shown in
would be 74 inches. Six inches would be more desirable. For those

seated next to the wall, the headroom over the seats may be reduced to a
Figure XIl-4 might be eon8idered, where a number of pas8enger8 may be
value perhaps halfway between that provided for in the aisle and that
seated one behind the other, in order to permit a gradual reduction in the
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

provided for the seated person.

fuselage depth toward the tail of the airplane.


Leg Room
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

In addition to the headroom as previously denned, there would be added

an amount to allow for the placement of the legs and feet. For every inch
Headroom for Large Airplanes
increase in the height of the seat from the floor, there would be a corre-

sponding increase in the height between the ceiling and the floor.
For large airplanes, where one of the prime criteria. for design is passen-
ger comfort, headroom for a. standing person should be required. The
minimum headroom for a standing person would be 2 inches, so that the
distance between the floor and the ceiling in the aisle for a 6-foot man
would be 74 inches. Six inches would be more desirable. For those
seated next to the wall, the headroom over the seats may be reduced to a
value perhaps halfway between that provided for in the aisle and that
provided for the seated person.

Leg Room
In addition to the headroom as previously defined, there would be added
an amount to allow for the placement of the legs and feet. For every inch
increase in the height of the seat from the floor, there would be a corre-
sponding increase in the height between the ceiling and the floor.

Original from ·
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
210 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

It will be assumed that the pilot is placed in the conventional seated


position. For the passenger, one might consider him sitting on the floor
with the legs extended. If a num-
ber of passengers, one behind the
other, were to be considered, a
space about 42 inches long and at
least 3772 inches high would have
to be provided for each. It would
be possible to extend the feet of
the passenger immediately behind
the pilot under the pilot's seat
with a possible saving of about 20 FIG URE XIl-4. An increase in headroom
inches for that person alone, but is obtained by inclining the back of the sc:i.t.
since all the passengers are sitting
on the floor, which need not necessarily be on the same floor level as the
pilot, there would be no saving in space for other passengers than the first
one. ./
If now each passenger crooks his leg so that he is seated more or less
"canoe" fashion, then each passenger would require (assuming the l~g to
make a 90-degree angle with the thigh and the thigh elevated at a 45-
degree angle to the body) about 1172 inches (39(1 - cos 45°) = 11.4 in.]
less. Compared with the legs extended horizontally, such arrangement
as just proposed would take less space if more than two passengers besides
the pilot are considered. Otherwise, extending the legs straight out with
the first passenger extending his legs under the pilot's seat would have the
slight advantage of requiring just a little less space and of allowing the
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

passengers to crook their legs if they so desired.


Still considering the passengers seated on the floor, another possible
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

arrangement is the "toboggan" sea.ting with the passenger in front sitting


between the legs of the passenger in back of him. Here the passengers

FmuRE Xll- 5. Passengers could sit t his way or the second and third man could
move forward by spreading their legs-but would the passengers be comfortable?

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PASSENGER CABIN 211
THE PASSENGER CABIN

211

could be closed up about 33 inches; that is, two passengers would require
could be closed up about 33 inches; that is, two passengers would require

only 51 inches in length instead of 84 inches when the legs are kept together
only 51 inches in length instead of 84 inches when the legs are kept together
due to the fact that the seat position of each person is some 8 inches less
due to the fact that the seat position of each person is some 8 inches less
when the legs are spread about 70 degrees apart, in addition to permitting

the legs of one man to overlap the seated position of the man in front of
when the legs are spread about 70 degrees apart, in addition to permitting
him by some 17 inches. With the passengers seated thus, the feet would
the legs of one man to overlap the seated position of the man in front of
be some 48 inches apart, so that the width of the fuselage would have to

him by some 17 inches. With the passengers seated thus, the feet would
have a minimum interior width of 48 inches. Therefore, what was ob-

tained in reducing the required length was gained somewhat at the expense
be some 48 inches apart, so that the width of the fuselage would have to
of the width required.
have a minimum interior width of 48 inches. Therefore, what was ob-
If elbow room is allowed each passenger, then a width of 24 to 26 inches

Fig. XII-6 Fig. XII-7


tained in reducing the required length was gained somewhat at the expense
Figure XII-6. With the pilot seated normally, length of cabin space could be re-
of the width required.
duced by the passengers sitting on the floor as indicated, more or less toboggan fashion.

If elbow room is allowed each passenger, then a width of 24 to 26 inches


Figure X [1-7. Normal side-by-side seating.

is desirable. Seating passengers side by side, with no aisle width, would

require a width of from 48 to 52 inches, just about what would be required

for the toboggan method of seating. On the other hand, the width of the

fuselage could be kept to a minimum interior width of about 26 inches if

the wing root joining the fuselage at floor level had sufficient depth to pro-

vide the foot room for the "toboggan" seating arrangement.

In the three seating arrangements just considered, the seat level was

assumed to be the floor level so that the minimum distance between the

ceiling and the floor was somewhat less than 40 inches. Suppose the seat

level were raised. Then the possible available leg room would lie some-

what between the two extremes of having the legs and thighs extending

horizontally out from the body and that of having the lower legs perpen-

I II I
I ._. J I ... I 4

I I I I
I I I I
'ri
\ I
'T./I
' '•
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Fig. XII-6 B'ig. XII-7


FIGURE XII-6. With the pilot seated normally, length of cabin space could be re-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

duced by thn passengers sitting on the floor as indicated, more or lcs8 toboggan fashion.
FIGURE X ll-7. Normal side-by-side seating.

is desirable. Seating passengers side by side, with no aisle width, would


require a width of from 48 to 52 inches, just about what would be required
for the toboggan method of seating. On the other hand, the width of the
fuselage could be kept to a minimum interior width of about 26 inches if
the wing root joining the fuselage at floor level had sufficient depth to pro-
vide the foot room for the "toboggan" seating arrangement.
In the three seating arrangements just considered, the seat level was
assumed to be the floor level so that the minimum distance between the
ceiling and the floor was somewhat less than 40 inches. Suppose the seat
level were raised. Then the possible available leg room would lie some-
what between the two extremes of having the legs and thighs extending
horizontally out from the body and that of having the lower legs perpen-

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
212 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
212

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

dicular to, and the feet in contact with, the floor. Two configurations
are possible for this seated position: (1) with the knees of one passenger
dicular to, and the feet in contact with, the floor. Two configurations

are possible for this seated position: (1) with the knees of one passenger

touching the back of the scat of the passenger ahead of him; and, (2) with
touching the back of the spat of the passenger ahead of him; and, (2) with
the knees spread apart, so that the passenger in back would straddle the

seat of the passenger in front. In both cases the height between the ceil-
the knees spread apart, so that the passenger in back would straddle the
ing and the floor would be a minimum of 59 inches. If the knees of one
seat of the passenger in front. In both cases the height between the ceil-
touched the back of the seat of the other, a bare minimum of 24-inch spac-

ing and the floor would be a minimum of 59 inches. If the knees of one
touched the back of the seat of the other, a bare minimum of 24-inch spac-
ing would be required for each passenger; the passengers could be brought

together another 7 inches for the "pick-a-back" seating disposition and

therefore would require an average of about 17 inches for each man. ing would be required for each passenger; the passengers could be brought
This latter arrangement might be considered for a combination of pilot

and one passenger, or instructor-pilot and student arrangement, where


together another 7 inches for the "pick-a-back" seating disposition and
communication between the two could be improved and whereby a com-
therefore would require an average of about 17 inches for each man.
paratively small airplane, especially in so far as the length of the fuselage
This latter arrangement might be considered for a combination of pilot
and one passenger, or instructor-pilot and student arrangement, where
is considered, could be designed.

Both of these arrangements do not provide the most comfortable posi-

tions for the passengers. If the legs are stretched out, then more room is communication between the two could be improved and whereby a com-
required. With the leg at a 45-degree angle, and the thigh horizontal or

paratively small airplane, especially in so far as the length of the fuselage


nearly so, then two men would require 69 inches spacing and each passen-

ger after that an additional 28 inches.


is considered, could be designed.
Again, moving the passengers 7 inches forward by spreading the legs
Both of these arrangements do not provide the most comfortable posi-
apart would reduce the 28-inch spacing to about 21-inch spacing for each

passenger after the first one.


tions for the passengers. If the legs are stretched out, then more room is
Figure XII-8. "Pick-a-back" seating arrangement. required. With the leg at a 45-degree angle, and the thigh horizontal or
Extending the legs out at about a 45-degree angle permits a lowering of

nearly so, then two men would require 69 inches spacing and each passen-
the seat level of about 63^ inches and, therefore, brings the ceiling height

down a corresponding amount.


ger after that an additional 28 inches.
Again, moving the passengers 7 inches forward by spreading the legs
apart would reduce the 28-inch spacing to about 21-inch spacing for each
passenger after the first one.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

,,,"" .,,,,- \.----


__.. --- ---1
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

;'
/
I
I
\
\
'' \I
' ' ................. _ I
---- ..................... -- -
---------
FIGURE XIl-8. "Pick-a-back" seating arrangement.

Extending the legs out at about a 45-degree angle permits a lowering of


the seat level of about 672 inches and, therefore, brings the ceiling height
down a corresponding amount.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PASSENGER CABIN 213
THE PASSENGER CABIN

213 Side-by-Side Arrangements


In all these seating dispositions, a single-row tandem arrangement was
Side-by-Side Arrangements

In all these seating dispositions, a single-row tandem arrangement was

assumed side-by-side. The main value of doubling the number across


assumed side-by-side. The main value of doubling the number across
the width of the airplane is that the weight of

the passengers is kept near the center of gravity


the width of the airplane is that the weight of
of the airplane as a whole so that the condi-
the passengers is kept near the center of gravity
tions of fully loaded and partially or all empty

of the airplane as a whole so that the condi-


tions of fully loaded and partially or all empty
do not affect the center of gravity location

materially. If the passengers are seated

shoulder-to-shoulder, a minimum interior do not affect the center of gravity location


width of 52 inches would be required, with some

materially. If the passengers are seated


reduction if a sacrifice in comfort were made.

A possible alternative to the side-by-side


shoulder-to-shoulder, a mm1mum interior
seating would be to reverse the position of one

width of 52 inches would be required, with ~ome


reduction if a sacrifice in comfort were made.
of the passengers with one looking forward and

the other rearward. The allowance for the

width of the seat would be between 18 to 20 A possible alternative to the side-by-side


inches for each person with normal clothing,

seating would be to reverse the position of one


so that a minimum interior width of about

46 inches (allowing an extra 6 inches for the


of the passengers with one looking forward and
shoulders) might be obtained, or a reduction
the other rearward. The allowance for the
of about 6 inches; perhaps not much in mag-

FiGuwt XII-9. Staggered nitude but still important enough to consider I


width of the seat would be between 18 to 20
seat arrangement. in some designs. inches for each person with normal clothing,
Another side-by-side arrangement might be

,ll ll so that a minimum interior width of about


considered with the seating extending the length of the fuselage instead

of across the width. Allowing 26 inches for each person, a reduction of


46 inches (allowing an extra 6 inches for the
shoulders) might be obtained, or a reduction
q
2 inches might be obtained over that of the usual tandem arrangement.

However, the legs and feet have to be placed somewhere, with the result

that a minimum interior width from about 30 to 48 inches is required,


~
of about 6 inches; perhaps not much in mag-
depending upon whether the legs are kept vertical or extended to some
L'
rIGFRE, XII 1•
-,1. s tuggere d nitude but still important enough to consider
Staggered Arrangements

scat arrangement. in some designs.


Another side-by-side arrangement might be
A variation of the side-by-side arrangements is the staggered placement

of the seats, either across the width of the airplane or lengthwise. (See

Figure XII-9.) There is some reduction in the dimensions required but


considered with the seating extending the length of the fuselage instead
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

not at the expense of comfort. As a matter of fact there may be greater

freedom of movement since there is freedom for the legs and arms in the
of across the width. Allowing 26 inches for each person, a reduction of
2 inches might be obtained over that of the usual tandem arrangement.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

single-row arrangement.

Back-to-Back Arrangements

However, the legs and feet have to be placed somewhere, with the result
that a minimum interior width from about 30 to 48 inches is required,
Instead of the "pick-a-back" suggestion, another alternative for keeping

depending upon whether the legs are kept vertical or extended to some
degree.

Staggered Arrangements
A variation of the side-by-side arrangements is the staggered placement
of the seats, either across the width of the airplane or lengthwise. (See
Figure XII-9.) There is some reduction in the dimensions required but
not at the expense of comfort. As a matter of fact there may be greater
freedom of movement since there is freedom for the legs and arms in the
single-row arrangement.

Back-to-Back Arrangements
Instead of the "pick-a-back" suggestion, another alternative for keeping

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
214 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
214

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


the weight of the pilot and one passenger close together would be a possible
the weight of the pilot and one passenger close together would be a possible

back-to-back arrangement, where each person would require a minimum


back-to-back arrangement, where each person would require a minimum
of 41 inches for the normal seating position, but where the centers of grav-
of 41 inches for the normal seating position, but where the centers of grav-
ity of the two would be about 25 inches apart instead of about 28 inches,

ity of the two would be about 25 inches apart instead of about 28 inches,
as in the tandem arrangement. Not much would be gained by such an
as in the tandem arrangement. Not much would be gained by such an

Figure XII-10. Back-to-back seat arrangement.

arrangement; however, for a two-seater, a back-to-back arrangement

would require sufficient headroom or a shorter length of the fuselage, so

that a better streamlining of the fuselage may be possible. See arrange-

ment in Figure XII-10.

Seating Facing Rearward

Recent investigations indicate that seating the passengers so that they

face rearward would be desirable as far as safety in even a minor crash is

concerned, since the acceleration of the passengers is forward in such a

case. If they were facing forward, the impact would be on the relatively

small area of the safety belts, or if no safety belts were used at the time,

they would be catapulted out of the seat. But, if the passengers were

seated the other way, the pressure would be against the back of the seats,

a very much greater area, and there would be relatively little danger of

being catapulted out of the seat unless there were some acceleration in a
FIGURE XIl-10. Back-to-back seat arrangement.
vertical direction relative to the seat.

arrangement; however, for a two-seater, a back-to-back arrangement


While there may be many people who object to riding backwards in sur-

face transportation, there should be no pressing reason other than custom

why this objection should hold in aircraft seating. The accelerations in


would require sufficient headroom or a shorter length of the fuselage, so
flight are normally not of the same order as in an automobile or a train,

nor of the same frequency of occurrence. Moreover, since flying is done


that a better streamlining of the fuselage may be possible. See arrange-
at relatively high altitudes (at least relative to the height of objects on the
ment in Figure XII-10.
ground) the same sensations of objects passing past the window do not pre-

vail. There might be objections to reversing the usual seating arrange-


Seating Facing Rearward
ments when taking off or landing and in climbing or gliding steeply.

In trying to obtain minimum frontal area, care should be taken that the
Recent investigations indicate that seating the passengers so that they
passengers are not enclosed in the structure like mummies, for such designs
face rearward would be desirable as far as safety in even a minor crash is
concerned, since the acceleration of the passengers is forward in such a
case. If they were facing forward, the impact would be on the relatively
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

small area of the safety belts, or if no safety belts were used at the time,
they would be catapulted out of the seat. But, if the passengers were
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

seated the other way, the pressure would be against the back of the seats,
a very much greater area, and there would be relatively little danger of
being catapulted out of the seat unless there were some acceleration in a
vertical direction relative to the seat.
While there may be many people who object to riding backwards in sur-
face transportation, there should be no pressing reason other than custom
why this objection should hold in aircraft seating. The accelerations in
flight are normally not of the same order as in an automobile or a train,
nor of the same frequency of occurrence. Moreover, since flying is done
at relatively high altitudes (at least relative to the height of objects on the
ground) the same sensations of objects passing past the window do not pre-
vail. There might be objections to reversing the usual seating arrange-
ments when taking off or landing and in climbing or gliding steeply.
In trying to obtain minimum frontal area, care should be taken that the
passengers are not enclosed in the structure like mummies, for such designs

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PASSENGER CABIN 215
THE PASSENGER CABIN

215

build up sales resistance not only because of a feeling of claustrophobia but


also because of minor accidents that will constantly occur in bumping one's
build up sales resistance not only because of a feeling of claustrophobia but

also because of minor accidents that will constantly occur in bumping one's

Figure XII-11. Normal tandem seating arrangement.

head against the structure. Normal tandem seating is shown in Figure

XII-11.

VISION

In any of the tandem arrangements where the passenger faces either

forward or rearward, there should be no great difficulty in providing win-

dows for looking out, but where the passengers are seated athwartship,

the individual either has to look through the window on the opposite side

or has to crane his head to look out of a window in back of him. For large

airplanes, vision considerations are not so important as for the small air-

craft. (See Chapter X, The Cockpit.)

SEATING COMFORT

The degree of discomfort that may be tolerated is intimately tied up

with duration. A passenger may be willing to accept some discomfort for


FIGURE XII-11. Normal tandem seating arrangement.
a quarter of an hour, whereas he would be decidedly unhappy if he had to

be uncomfortable for an hour.

In general, any seating on the floor would not be acceptable in an air-


head against the structure. Normal tandem seating is shown in Figure
plane which stayed in the air any great length of time. It would be ques-

XII-11.
tionable whether such a position on the floor would be liked by passengers

in a highly maneuverable airplane subjected to even mild aerobatics.

The "pick-a-back" arrangement in a personal airplane would be decid-


VISION
edly disliked by a man who did not like someone breathing down his neck.
In any of the tandem arrangements where the passenger faces either
It would be permissible for a training airplane and perhaps moderately

acceptable in a normal single-seater personal airplane which needed pro-


forward or rearward, there should be no great difficulty in providing win-
vision for the occasional passenger.
dows for looking out, but where the passengers are seated athwartship,
SEATING ACCESSIBILITY
the individual either has to look through the window on the opposite side
or has to crane his head to look out of a window in back of him. For large
One of the greatest problems in trying to crowd several passengers into

a small place is the matter of getting each passenger settled in his place

airplanes, vision considerations are not so important as for the small air-
~raft. (See Chapter X, The Cockpit.)

SEATING COMFORT
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The degree of discomfort that may be tolerated is intimately tied up


with duration. A passenger may be willing to accept some discomfort for
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

a quarter of an hour, whereas he would be decidedly unhappy if he had to


be uncomfortable for an hour.
In general, any seating on the floor would not be acceptable in an air-
plane which stayed in the air any great length of time. It would be ques-
tionable whether such a position on the floor would be liked by passengers
in a highly maneuverable airplane subjected to even mild aerobatics.
The "pick-a-back" arrangement in a personal airplane would be decid-
edly disliked by a man who did not like someone breathing down his neck.
It would be permissible for a training r.irplane and perhaps moderately
acceptable in a normal single-seater personal airplane which needed pro-
vision for the occasional passenger.

SEATING ACCESSIBILITY
One of the greatest problems in trying to crowd several passengers into
a small place is the matter of getting each passenger settled in his place

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
216 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
216

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


with the least fuss and bother. Crowded seating arrangements require
with the least fuss and bother. Crowded seating arrangements require

jig-saw handling in that usually a particular order in filling and emptying


jig-saw handling in that usually a particular order in filling and emptying
the seats is required, especially where the number of seats exceed two or
the seats is required, especially where the number of sea.ts exceed two or
three. The more passengers the airplane is to hold and the more crowded

three. The more passengers the airplane is to hold and the more crowded
the seating is, the larger the door should be for getting into and out of the
the seating is, the larger the door should be for getting into and out of the

airplane. (See also section on Doors and Exits.)

CENTER OF GRAVITY CONSIDERATIONS airplane. (See also section on Doors and Exits.)
The closer the passengers can be brought together, the less will be the

effect upon the center of gravity between the fully loaded, partially empty,

or empty condition.
CENTER OF GRAVITY CONSIDERATIONS
h 26" H The closer the passengers can be brought together, the less will be the
Fig. XII-12 Fig. XII-13

effect upon the center of gravity between the fully loaded, partially empty,
Figure XII-12. Average dimensions for seating when the leg is vertical.

Figure XII-13. Average dimensions for seating when the lower leg is 45 degrees ts
or empty condition.
the vertical.

The single-engine airplane with the engine in the nose of the airplane
- - - - - 26·----~
will require closer spacing for the tandem arranged seats since this design

usually has the center of gravity so placed that the variable load (the pas-

sengers) is behind the center of gravity.

WINDOWS

A window should be located at each seat with the bottom of the window

at about shoulder level of the passenger when seated. The window should

also be slightly forward, that is, the right side of the window as one faces

21"

r
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Fig. XIl-12 l<'ig. XII-l:l


FIGURE XIl-12. Average dimensions for seating when the leg is vertical.
l<'IGURE XIl-13. Average dimensions for seating when the lower leg is 45 degrees lA>
the vertical.

The single-engine airplane with the engine in the nose of the airplane
will require closer spacing for the tandem arranged seats since this design
usually has the center of gravity so placed that the variable load (the pas-
sengers) is behind the center of gravity.
WINDOWS
A window should be located at each seat with the bottom of the window
at about shoulder level of the passenger when seated. The window should
also be slightly forward, that is, the right side of the window as one faces

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PASSENGER CABIN 217

it on the right side of the cabin, for example, should be somewhat ahead
of the back of the seat.
The size of the window depends upon the type of structure. The win-
dows vary in size from about 12 inches square or oval up to 17 X 24 inches,
or 24 inches in diameter when circular; if easily removable, they may be
classed as emergency exits.
The windows should be recessed in felt-covered rubber window stripping
to reduce vibration and noise. They should be designed so that the pas-
senger cannot open them.
The window glass is usually %; inch thick. Less thickness would be
dangerous since a passenger might inadvertently put his hand through the
glass. Windshield glass for the pilot's cockpit varies from %; to ~ inch
in thickness. For supercharged cabins for high-altitude flying, the win-
dows have to be made considerably thicker. (See also section on Vision.)
DOORS AND EXITS
Doors should be the full height of the cabin. Inasmuch as the head-
room is usually le.ss than, or very little greater than, the height of a nonnal
person, the door height is hardly sufficient even when the full distance be-
tween the floor and ceiling of the cabin is utilized. The main door is
located on the left-hand bide of the airplane.
A high doorsill causes inconvenience in getting out of the passenger
cabin since the passenger has to bend backwards. On the other hand, a
low door is equally inconvenient. If the full depth cannot be utilized,
then a doorsill is preferable to low headroom. In case the height is inade-
quate, then greater width should be provided.
Closed cabins on all aircraft carrying passengers must be provided with
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:08 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

at least one adequate and easily accessible external door which should not
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

be located in the plane oi rotation of the inboard propeller or in the area


included by a plane at an angle of 5 degrees ahead and behind the plane of
· rotation.

FIGURE Xll-14. Interior arrangement of a cubin.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
218 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
218

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

In addition to this door, closed aircraft cabins carrying more than 5 pas-
In addition to this door, closed aircraft cabins carrying more than 5 pas-

sengers, but not in excess of 15, require at least one emergency exit whose
sengers, but not in excess of 15, require at least one emergency exit whose
minimum dimensions are tangent to a 19 X 26 ellipse, on the side opposite minimum dimensions are tangent to a 19 X 26 ellipse, on the side opposite
the main door. When more than 15 passengers are carried, an emergency

the main door. When more than 15 passengers are carried, an emergency
exit for every additional 7 passengers should be provided. Not more than
exit for every additional 7 passengers should be provided. Not more than

4 exits are necessary, and they may be located either in the top or side.

Doors may replace exits if desired. (See also section on Accessibility.)


4 exits are necessary, and they may be located either in the top or side.
SLEEPING ACCOMMODATIONS

Separate compartments are desirable when sleeping accommodations


Doors may replace exits if desired. (See also section on Accessibility.)
are to be provided.

Berths vary in width from 28 to 32 inches with 30 inches a good average


SLEEPING ACCOMMODATIONS
value. The length of the berth varies from 72 to 76 inches with a prefer-

ence shown for the higher value.


Separate compartments are desirable when sleeping accommodations
Mattresses, blankets, pillows, and bed linen for a berth weigh from 12
are to be provided.
to 18 pounds.
Berths vary in width from 28 to 32 inches with 30 inches a good average
value. The length of the berth varies from 72 to 76 inches with a prefer-
LIGHTING

Individual lights usually placed slightly overhead are provided for each

passenger. They should be subject to control by the passenger but a mas- ence shown for the higher value.
ter switch should be located in the pilot's cockpit so that the pilot may

Mattresses, blankets, pillows, and bed linen for a berth weigh from 12
shut off the light when necessary.

FURNISHINGS
to 18 pounds.
The walls of the cabin are usually treated for soundproofing. The in-

terior may be finished in Fabrikoid, painted and doped aircraft cotton, or


LIGHTING
some suitable upholstering material.

Inspection panels (in the case of fabrics, Talon fasteners are suitable)
Individual lights usually placed slightly overhead are provided for each
must be provided to permit ready access to the structure underneath for
passenger. They should be subject to control by the passenger but a mas-
inspection purposes.
ter switch should be located in the pilot's cockpit so that the pilot may
Curtains for windows should be installed so as to permit their removal

and replacement in one minute or less.


shut off the light when necessary.
For larger transport airplanes, provision for attachment for small tables

for playing bridge or holding a typewriter should be made.


FURNISHINGS
Since many trips are long, any device used to entertain the passengers

will be welcome. Airspeed indicators, altimeter, and probably a compass


The walls of the cabin are usually treated for soundproofing. The in-
located on the front wall of the cabin will draw attention. An illustrated
terior may be finished in Fabrikoid, painted and doped aircraft cotton, or
map of the country being traversed will add to the general interest of the

some suitable upholstering material.


Generated on 2012-05-30 03:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Inspection panels (in the case of fabrics, Talon fasteners are suitable)
trip.

PROVISION FOR AIRSICKNESS

must be provided to permit ready access to the structure underneath for


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Paper bags are usually found in a pocket attached to the back of the

seat. Washroom facilities are provided, of course. The steward or stew-

ardess is also prepared to take care of such cases.


inspection purposes.
Curtains for windows should be installed so as to permit their removal
and replacement in one minute or less.
For larger transport airplanes, provision for attachment for small tables
for playing bridge or holding a typewriter should be made.
Since many trips are long, any device used to entertain the passengers
will be welcome. Airspeed indicators, altimeter, and probably a compass
located on the front wall of the cabin will draw attention. An illustrated
map of the country being traversed will add to the general interest of the
trip.
PROVISION FOR AIRSICKNESS
Paper bags are usually found in a pocket attached to the back of the
seat. Washroom facilities are provided, of course. The steward or stew-
ardess is also prepared to take care of such cases.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE PASSENGER CABIN 219
THE PASSENGER CABIN

219

FLOORING
FLOORING

The cabin flooring varies in treatment in various designs. It should be The cabin flooring varies in treatment in various designs. It should be
light and soundproof, as well as sound and vibration damped. A free-

light and soundproof, as well as sound and vibration damped. A free-


floating flooring made possible by the use of rubber or felt between the
floating flooring made possible by the use of rubber or felt between the

floor and the primary structure is desirable.

A thickness of balsa wood between thin-face plies of birch or aluminum


floor and the primary structure is desirable.
alloy makes a very effective flooring which will take considerable local

loads. The floor may be further treated with a thin cork tile or "battle-
A thickness of balsa wood between thin-face plies of birch or aluminum
ship" linoleum for appearance and wear.
alloy makes a very effective flooring which will take considerable local
Floor panels should be provided with means for quick and easy access

loads. The floor may be further treated with a thin cork tile or "battle-
ship" linoleum for appearance and wear.
to the structure below for inspection purposes.

No obstructions such as spars should extend above the floor level. It is

customary to rest the floor on the spars. Inasmuch as the airplane may
Floor panels should be provided with means for quick and easy access
take any flight attitude, it is difficult to state what constitutes a "level"

floor. A good method is to select the angle at which the cruising speed of
to the structure below for inspection purposes.
the airplane occurs and make the floor level for this condition. A varia-
No obstructions such as spars should extend above the floor level. It is
tion of a few degrees will not be serious.

customary to rest the floor on the spars. Inasmuch as the airplane may
take any flight attitude, it is difficult to state what constitutes a "level"
Passenger airplanes are equipped with toilet and washroom facilities in

a compartment separated from, and usually in the rear of, the cabin.

The toilet (see Figure XlI-15) consists of a metal container with a water- floor. A good method is to select the angle at which the cruising speed of
proof liner of sufficient capacity with a suitable chemical preparation. It

the airplane occurs and make the floor level for this condition. A varia-
should be simply designed and easily cleaned.

Wash basins are small but useful. The water supply should be placed
tion of a few degrees will not be serious.
in a tank so located that it can be filled readily from the outside, but should

be protected against freezing.


TOILETS
TOILETS

Figure XII-15. Toilet seating.


Passenger airplanes are equipped with toilet and washroom facilities in
a compartment separated from, and usually in the rear of, the cabin.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Vent
pipe

l<'wuRE XIl-15. Toilet 1:1eating.

The toilet (see Figure XII- J.5) C'.Onsist1; of a metal eo11tai11er with a water-
proof liner of sufficient capacity with a suitable chemical preparation. lt
should be simply designed and easily cleaned.
Wash basins are small but useful. The water supply should be placed
in a tank so located that it can be filled readily from the outside, but should
be protected against freezing.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
220 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
220

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

A water allowance of 2 to 3 pounds per passenger, depending upon the


A water allowance of 2 to 3 pounds per passenger, depending upon the

range of travel, is ample for both drinking and washing purposes.


range of travel, is ample for both drinking and washing purposes.
REFRESHMENTS

Since flying schedules do not permit stops at intermediate landing fields, REFRESHMENTS
Since flying schedules do not permit stops at intermediate landing fields,
it is customary to provide passengers with a light lunch, often made up in

boxes. A weight allowance of to 3^ pound per person is ample for the

food, container, paper napkins, etc. On larger and newer equipment of


it is customary to provide passengers with a light lunch, often made up in
passenger airlines, a greater allowance may be made to permit furnishing

light, hot lunches in flight.


boxes. A weight allowance of % to 72 pound per person is ample for the
BAGGAGE COMPARTMENT
food, container, paper napkins, etc. On larger and newer equipment of
Since only coats and hats which the passengers are wearing are permitted

passenger airlines, a greater allowance may be made to permit furnishing


light, hot lunches in flight.
in the cabin, suitable baggage compartments must be provided. These

compartments are not accessible in flight.

To expedite the removal of luggage, mail, or express, these baggage com-

partments must be accessible from the outside by means of separate bag- BAGGAGE COMPARTMENT
Since only coats and hats which the passengers are wearing are permitted
gage doors.

Usually, two or more baggage compartments are provided in the fuselage

to permit the limiting of center of gravity movement for the various load- in the cabin, suitable baggage compartments must be provided. These
ing conditions possible. The baggage door carries a schedule giving the

compartments are not accessible in flight.


load capacities of each baggage compartment and for fully loaded and

partially empty conditions of the airplane.


To expedite the removal of luggage, mail, or express, these baggage com-
Luggage varies in size so that it is difficult to recommend exact cubical

partments must be accessible from the outside by means of separate bag-


capacities of baggage compartments. A standard suitcase measures

9 X 17 X 31 inches.
gage doors.
Mail compartments should allow 12J^ cubic feet for each 200 pounds of Usually, two or more baggage compartments are provided in the fuselage
mail.

to permit the limiting of center of gravity movement for the various load-
ing conditions possible. The baggage door carries a schedule giving the
load capacities of each baggage compartment and for fully loaded and
partially empty conditions of the airplane.
Luggage varies in size so that it is difficult to recommend exact cubical
capacities of baggage compartments. A standard suitcase measures
9 X 17 X 31 inches.
Mail compartments should allow 1272 cubic feet for each 200 pounds of
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

mail.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER XIII

Air Conditioning

XIII
The importance of heating in an airplane cabin for aircraft operating

at high subsonic speeds can be gauged easily when it is realized that the
CHAPTER
temperature of the outside air decreases rapidly with altitude. When it

is some 60° F on the ground, it may be — 50° F at 30,000 feet. In these

days of substratosphere and stratosphere flying, the change in tempera-

ture that an airplane encounters from the moment it leaves the ground

until it reaches its required altitude only a few moments later is enormous.

A difference in temperature may also be experienced as the airplane flies

from a warm country to a cold country. While this change may not occur

in a few minutes as in the case above, it does occur during the same flight
Air Conditioning
so that a heating system has to be provided whether flying is during the

summer months or not.

It is not the heating alone, however, that has to be considered, but the

ventilation as well.
The imports ·ice of heating in an airplane cabin for aircraft operating
PHYSIOLOGICAL AND PSYCHOLOGICAL CONSIDERATIONS at high subsonic speeds can be gauged easily when it is realized that the
The objects of ventilation are of course:

temperature of the outside air decreases rapidly with altitude. When it


1. To supply oxygen,

2. To remove odors,
is some 60° F on the ground, it may be -50° F at :i0,000 feet. In these
3. To remove toxic or poisonous substances,
days of substratosphere and stratosphere flying, the change in tempera-
4. To remove body heat, moisture, and heat from other sources.

At present there are no ready means available for controlling the hu-
ture that an airplane encounters from the moment it leaves the ground
midity of the air. It is generally believed that the relative humidity should until it reaches its required altitude only a few moments later i8 enormou:-;.
be about 40 per cent for good health conditions. However, the movement

A difference in temperature may also be experienced as the airplane flies


of the air has some effect. In still air, the body is enveloped in a layer of

moist air so that even a moderate air movement tends to create the effect
from a warm country to a cold country. While this change may not occur
of a draft.
in a few minutes as in the case above, it does occur during the same flight
Care should be taken to avoid possible overheating of the cabin. The

general effects of overheating may be summarized as follows:


so that a heating system has to be provided whether flying is during the
1. Increased heart beat and blood flow. summer months or not.
2. Increased respiration.

It is not the heating alone, however, that has to be considered, but the
3. Increased sweating with attack of cramps.

4. General lassitude and dizziness.


ventilation as well.
221

PHYSIOLOGICAL AND PSYCHOLOGICAL CONSIDERATIONS


The objects of ventilation are of course:
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1. To supply oxygen,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2. To remove odors,
3. To remove toxic or poisonous substances,
4. To remove body heat, moisture, and heat from other sources.
At present there are no ready means available for controlling the hu-
midity of the air. It is generally believed that the relative humidity should
be about 40 per cent for good health conditions. However, the movement
of the air has some effect. In still air, the body is enveloped in a layer of
moist air so that even a moderate air movement tends to create the effect
of a draft.
Care should be taken to avoid possible overheating of the cabin. The
general effects of overheating may be summarized as follows:
1. Increased heart beat and blood flow.
2. Increased respiration.
3. Increased sweating with attack of cramps.
4. General lassitude and dizziness.
221

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
222 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
222

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL Poi8onous ozone, which injures a man's lungs, corrodes metal, and rapidly
Poisonous ozone, which injures a man's lungs, corrodes metal, and rapidly

rots rubber, adds to the hazards of flying at altitudes from 80,000 to 95,000
rots rubber, adds to the hazards of flying at altitudes from 80,000 to 95,000
feet. At higher and lower altitudes the ozone concentration is so low as
feet. At higher and lower altitudes the ozone concentration is so low as
to be unimportant. As altitudes approach 120,000 feet, cosmic rays in

to be unimportant. As altitudes approach 120,000 feet, cosmic rays in


the atmosphere may become a factor in human flight. The heavy nuclei
the atmosphere may become a factor in human flight. The heavy nuclei

of these rays can penetrate through a man without seriously injuring him,

but an unlucky hit on a critical nerve center could be serious. of these rays can penetrate through a man without seriously injuring him,
Table XIII-1. Human requirements and performance limitations at various altitudes.

(Courtesy of Flight Safely Foundation, Inc.)


but an unlucky hit on a critical nerve renter could be serious.
5,000 feet—Maximum for normal night vision without supplemental oxygen.

8,000 feet—Altitude at which supplemental oxygen should be used for routine flights.

10,000 feet—Maximum without routine use of oxygen.


TABLE XIIl-1. Human requirements and performance limitation!! at vu.rious altitudes.
18,000 feet—Maximum for emergency without use of oxygen.
(Courtesy o.f Flight Safety Foundation, Inc.)
20,000 feet—Altitude at which consideration should be given to use of pressurized cabins.

23,000 feet—Altitude at which there is evidence of depressurization sickness.

25,000 feet—Approximate time of consciousness without oxygen is 116 seconds.


5,000 feet-Maximum for normal night vision without supplemental oxygen.
28,000 feet—Maximum to avoid depressurization sickness. Approximate time of con-
8,000 feet-Altitude at which supplemental oxygen should be used for routine flights.
sciousness without oxygen is 69 seconds.
10,000 feet-Maximum without routine use of oxygen.
30,000 feet—Altitude above which slight positive pressure breathing should supplement
18,000 feet-Maximum for emergency without use of oxygen.
demand oxygen to avoid air leaks into oxygen mask. Approximate time
20,000 feet-Altitude at which consideration should be given to use of pres1mrized cabins.
of consciousness without oxygen is 54 seconds. 23,000 feet-Altitude at which there is evidence of depressurization sickness.
35,000 feet—Maximum for routine use of demand oxygen system. Approximate time 25,000 feet-Approximate time of consciousness without oxygen is 116 seconds.
of consciousness without oxygen is 32 seconds.
28,000 feet-Maximum to avoid depressurization sickness. Approximate time of con-
40,000 feet—Approximate time of consciousness without oxygen is 23 seconds.
sciousness without oxygen is 69 seconds.
42,000 feet—Maximum for routine use of pressure breathing.

30,000 feet- Altitude above which slight positive pressure breathing should 1mppleme11t
43,000 feet—Maximum for emergency use of demand oxygen.

demand oxygen to avoid air leaks into oxygen mask. Approximate time
45,000 feet—Bombardment aircraft having combat ceilings above this altitude require

of consciousness without oxygen is 54 seconds.


provisions for use of partial pressure suit.

35,000 feet-Maximum for routine use of demand oxygen system. Approximate time
48,000 feet—Fighter aircraft having combat ceilings above this altitude require pro-

of consciousness without oxygen is 32 seconds.


visions for use of partial pressure suit.

40,000 feet-Approximate time of consciousness without oxygen is 23 seconds.


42,000 feet-Maximum for routine use of pressure breathing.
50,000 feet—Maximum for emergency use of pressure breathing demand oxygen.

43,000 feet-Maximum for emergency use of demand oxygen.


AIR MOVEMENT FOR COMFORT

The air movement in the cabin should be such as to avoid the feeling of

drafts. To this end it is desirable, although not always possible, to meet


45,000 feet-Bombardment aircraft having combat ceilings above this altitude require
the following conditions:
provisions for use of partial pressure suit.
48,000 feet-Fighter aircraft having combat ceilings above this altitude require pro-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1. Limit the maximum air velocity to about 2 feet per second for persons

at rest.
visions for use of partial pressure suit.
50,000 feet-Maximum for emergency use of pressure breathing demand oxygen.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2. High-velocity currents of air should not be directed downward on

the occupants, nor strike them from behind at about neck level, nor come

up at about floor level.

3. The air should not be admitted to the cabin below the normal cabin
AIR MOVEMENT FOR COMFORT
temperature.

The natural movement of the air within the cabin is usually from rear
The air movement in the cabin should be such as to avoid the feeling of
to front. However, for various reasons it is desirable to reverse this flow.
drafts. To this end it is desirable, although not always possible, to meet
the following conditions: ·
1. Limit the maximum air velocity to about 2 feet per second for persons
at rest.
2. High-velocity currents of air should not be directed downward on
the occupants, nor strike them from behind at about neck level, nor come
up at about floor level.
3. The air should not be admitted to the cabin below the normal cabin
temperature.
The natural movement of the air within the cabin is usually from rear
to front. However, for various reasons it is desirable to reverse this flow.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
.1Ill CONDITIONING 223
AIR CONDITIONING

223

Figure XIII-1. A schematic diagram of the ventilating system of a flying boat

(Grumman Mallard). Fresh air is forced by ram pressure while in flight and by a

blower while on the ground. The heater (A) heats the air which is uniformly dis-

tributed through floor ducts, to windshield, and pilot's cockpit.

Normally, this reversal is accomplished easily by locating the exhaust at

the top rear and thus, due to the forced draft produced by the incoming

air and forced exhausting system usually provided, the air flow can be

easily controlled. Figure XIII-1 shows a schematic diagram of a venti-

lating system.

The circulation of air in a supercharged cabin is a problem not only of

maintaining a predetermined pressure but also of heating or cooling, and

ventilating. For hot weather, a separate cold-air system may be in-

corporated, although a by-pass for the heating unit in the system would

still permit use of the blower system as a pressure ventilator. The fresh

air is brought in through a duct, passed through a centrifugal rain separator


FIGURE XIII-I. A schematic diagram of t.hc ventilating ~ystem of a flying boat
and then into the cabin when the heating system is by-passed; otherwise
(Grumman Mallard). Fresh air is forced by ram pre111;1ure while in flight and by a
the air is passed through a heating system, as described elsewhere, before
blower while on tht• ground . The heater (.4) heats the air which is uniformly <lil'l-
being carried into the cabin. For high speeds, where heating due to high
tributed through floor ducts, to windshield, and pilot'11 cockpit.
ram pressures appreciably raises the temperature of incoming air, cooling

has to be provided.
Normally, this revertial is accomplished easily by locating the exhaust at
The toilet room should be made as airtight as possible, and a very posi- the top rear and thus, due to the forced draft produced by the incoming
tive system of ventilating should be provided for this room independent of

air and forced exhausting system usually provided, the air flow can be
the cabin.

It has been found that cool air is most effective in keeping a passenger
easily controlled. Figure XIII- I shows a schematic diagram of a venti-
comfortable in hot weather if an individual ventilator is located above and
lating system.
in front of the seat.

All incoming air should be controlled by the pilot at its source. Win-
The circulation of air in a supercharged cabin is a problem not only of
dows should not be used for ventilating purposes. maintaining a predetermined pressure but also of heating or cooling, and
AIR REQUIREMENTS

ventilating. For hot weather, a separate cold-air system may be in-


For a uniform CO2 content in the air to be breathed, about 1 cubic foot

of air per passenger per minute is necessary, although 5 cubic feet per pas-
corporated, although a by-pass for the heating unit in the system would
senger per minute is desirable when the air is recirculated, while 10 cubic

still permit use of the blower system as a pressure ventilator. The fresh
feet per passenger per minute without recirculation is ideal.

air is brought in through a duct, passed through a centrifugal rain separator


and then into the cabin when the heating system is by-passed; otherwise
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the air is passed through a heating system, as described elsewhere, before


being carried into the cabin. For high speeds, where heating due to high
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ram pressures appreciably raises the temperature of incoming air, cooling


has to be provided.
The toilet room should be made as airtight as possible, and a very posi-
tive system of ventilating should be provided for this room independent of
the cabin.
It has been found that cool air is most effective in keeping a passenger
comfortable in hot weather if an individual ventilator is located above and
in front of the seat.
All incoming air should be controlled by the pilot at its source. Win-
dows should not be used for ventilating purposes.
AIR REQUIREMENTS
Fc..r a uniform C02 content in the air to be breathed, about 1 cubic foot
of air per passenger per minute is necessary, although 5 cubic feet per pas-
senger per minute is desirable when the air is recirculated, while 10 cubic
feet per passenger per minute without recirculation is ideal.

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
224 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
224

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL A person breathes on the average about 16 times per minute while at
A person breathes on the average about 16 times per minute while at

rest on the ground for a total of 1J^ to 4 cubic feet per minute. This
rest on the ground for a total of 1~ to 4 cubic feet per minute. This
amount would be increased, depending upon the activities of the individual
amount would be increased, depending upon the activities of the individual
and the altitude at which he was working. To provide adequate ventila-
and the altitude at which he was working. To provide adequate ventila-
tion, the needs of each person in the cabin would have to be considered.

Normal air contains about 21 per cent of oxygen by volume, and 4 per cent
tion, the needs of each person in the cabin would have to be considered.
is removed by a person each time he breathes, so that the air could be Normal air contains about 21 per cent of oxygen by volume, and 4 per cent
breathed about twice before it would reach the 12 per cent minimum

desirable. Recirculation of the air would, therefore, be possible provided


is removed by a person each time he breathes, so that the air could be
that odors can be removed and the necessary sanitary precautions can be
breathed about twice before it would reach the 12 per cent minimum
observed.
desirable. Recirculation of the air would, therefore, be possible provided
Aircraft cabins provide from 10 to 40 cubic feet per person per minute,

depending upon the individual aircraft, as well as the means employed in


that odors can be removed and the necessary sanitary precautions can be
circulating the air within the cabin. observed.
Since the volume available per passenger in an aircraft cabin probably

Aircraft cabins provide from 10 to 40 cubic feet per person per minute,
varies from 40 to 60 cubic feet, regardless of the length of time the passen-

ger remains in the cabin, it is necessary to bring air into the cabin con-
depending upon the individual aircraft, as well as the means employed in
stantly to replenish the supply. Some air will filter through seams and
circulating the air within the cabin.
cracks, but such air will have the temperature of the outside air which may

be very cold. It is necessary therefore to be able to bring air in from one


Since the volume available per passenger in an aircraft cabin probably
central inlet under control, and to remove it by suitable and positive
varies from 40 to 60 cubic feet, regardless of the length of time the passen-
means.

ger remains in the cabin, it is necessary to bring air into the cabin con-
This change of air every few minutes complicates the heating problem.

In a room there are steam radiators which will heat the air, and since the
stantly to replenish the supply. Some air will filter through seams and
air is removed very slowly by natural infiltration outward through win-
cracks, but such air will have the temperature of the outside air which may
dows, doors, and cracks in the walls, it is a comparatively easy matter to

maintain a constant temperature. In an aircraft cabin, steam radiators


be very cold. It is necessary therefore to be able to bring air in from one
would be useless unless the walls, ceiling, and floors were radiators. It is
central inlet under control, and to remove it by suitable and positive
therefore necessary to heat the incoming air before it actually enters the

means.
cabin.

PRESSURE CONSIDERATIONS
This change of air every few minutes complicates the heating problem.
Both the oxygen supply and air pressure must be increased for high-alti-

In a room there are steam radiators which will heat the air, and since the
tude flying. Above 35,000 to 40,000 feet, a mask supplying pure oxygen

is required, and the outside pressure must be increased to provide enough


air is removed very slowly by natural infiltration outward through win-
lung pressure to permit breathing. At these extreme altitudes, pressure- dows, doors, and cracks in the walls, it is a comparatively easy matter to
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

equipped or pressurized cabins are the most feasible solution for large com-

maintain a constant temperature. In an aircraft cabin, steam radiators


mercial airplanes. For small planes, pressurized suits and helmets are

would be useless unless the walls, ceiling, and floors were radiators. It is
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

necessary.

It has been found, experimentally, that if his oxygen supply is cut off at
therefore necessary to heat the incoming air before it actually enters the
20,000 feet, a man will pass out in 10 minutes; at 25,000 feet in 3 minutes.

Pressure is necessary to guard against "aeroembolism," the equivalent


cabin.
of "diver's bends."

PRESSURE CONSIDERATIONS
Both the oxygen supply and air pressure must be increased for high-alti-
tude flying. Above 35,000 to 40,000 feet, a mask supplying pure oxygen
is required, and the outside pressure must be increased to provide enough
lung pressure to permit breathing. At these extreme altitudes, pressure-
equipped or pressurized cabins are the most feasible solution for large com-
mercial airplanes. For small planes, pressurized suits and helmets are
necessary.
It has been found, experimentally, that if his oxygen supply is cut off at
20,000 feet, a man will pass out in 10 minutes; at 25,000 feet in 3 minutes.
Pressure is necessary to guard against "aeroembolism," the equivalent
of "diver's bends."

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
AIR CONDITIONING 225
AIR CONDITIONING

225

No attempt is made to keep the cabin at sea-level pressure at all times.


No attempt is made to keep the cabin at sea-level pressure at all times.
In one installation, pressures vary up to the 8,000-foot level in accordance
In one installation, pressures vary up to the 8,000-foot level in accordance
with the usual atmospheric pressure relationships. From 8,000 to 14,700

feet the pressure within the cabin is maintained at the level normally exist-
with the usual atmospheric pressure relationships. From 8,000 to 14,700
ing at 8,000 feet altitude. Beyond 14,700 feet, a differential of 2.5 pounds
feet the pressure within the cabin is maintained at the level normally exist-
per square inch between the outside and the inside of the cabin is main-

ing at 8,000 feet altitude. Beyond 14,700 feet, a differential of 2.5 pounds
tained with the result that the apparent altitude at 16,000 feet altitude is

about 9,000 feet; at 18,000 feet it is 10,600: and at 20,000 feet it is approxi-
per square inch between the outside and the inside of the cabin is main-
mately 12,300 feet. (See Figure XIII-2.)
tained with the result that the apparent altitude at 16,000 feet altitude is
Indicated airplane altitude in thousands of feet

Figure XIII-2. Cabin pressure altitudes maintained by various pressure differ-


about 9,000 feet; at 18,000 feet it is 10,600: and at 20,000 feet it is approxi-
entials AP. The normal operating regime for pressurized cabins is from 6,000 to
mately 12,:~oo feet. (See Figure XIIl-2.)
12,000 feet equivalent altitudes.

Without supercharging, an altitude of 14,000 feet is assumed to be the

upper level for normal but limited commercial passenger flight.

Design for differential pressure depends upon structural limitations as

well as other considerations. If a pressure differential of 6.5 pounds per

square inch is used as the basis for structural design, and a safety factor of

2 is to be used, then the cabin would normally not be operated at pressures


Unpressurized
exceeding 3.25 pounds per square inch.
- 20 flight I / /
/ /
The oxygen content of the air is the same up to usual altitudes at which

J I
I
/
/
/
/

~
flights are made so that the air under pressure will have the necessary

I / /
oxygen supply.

16 I / / /
I I / / /
I) I / / /
/ / / /
] 12
c
c
:D 8
D
u
""'D
.! 4
D
u
.:0
-= 0
0 16 32 40 48 56
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Indicated airplane altitude in thousands of feet


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

.FIGURE XIII-2. Cabin pressure altitudes maintained by variows pressure differ-


ential:;; tJ.l'. The normal operating regime for pressurized cabins is from 6,000 to
12,()00 feet equivalent altitude!<.

Without supercharging, an altitude of 14,000 feet is assumed to be the


upper level for normal but limited commercial passenger flight.
Design for differential pressure depends upon structural limitations as
well as other considerations. If a pressure differential of 6.5 pounds per
square inch is used as the basis for structural design, and a safety factor of
2 is to be used, then the cabin would normally not be operated at pressures
exceeding 3.25 pounds per square inch.
The oxygen content of the air is the same up to usual altitudes at which
flights are made so that the air under pressure will have the necessary
oxygen supply.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
226 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
226

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

DESIGN TEMPERATURE LIMITS


DESIGN TEMPERATURE LIMITS

The temperature limits that the designer has to consider in dealing with
The temperature limits that the designer has to consider in dealing with
heating, cooling, and ventilating equipment are:

heating, cooling, and ventilating equipment are:


1. 100° F for human endurance at 50% humidity;

2. from 125° to 130° F for the engine accessory compartment;


1. 100° F for human endurance at 50% humidity;
from 150° to 160° F for hydraulic equipment;

2. from 125° to 1~0° F for the engine accessory compartment;


:J. from 150° to 160° F for hydraulic equipment;
4. from 175° to 185° F for electrical and electronic equipment.

PHYSICAL CONDITIONS

Summer temperatures greater than 100° F are seldom encountered even -1. from 175° to 185° F for electrical and electronic equipment.
in the warmest climates. Heating and ventilating systems have not yet

PHYSICAL CONDITIONS
incorporated systems for cooling the

air except the cooling of cabins of

aircraft by means of an outside re-

Summer temperatures greater than 100° Fare seldom encountered even


frigerating system before take-off.

This cooling of the cabin disappears


in the warmest climates. Heating and ventilating systems have not yet
within a short time after take-off.

incorporated systems for cooling the


air except the cooling of cabins of
By proper ventilation, moderate

temperatures above normal room

temperatures of 72° F are not un- aircraft by means of an outside re-


comfortable.

At the lower-temperature limit


frigerating system before take-off.
the heating system must be designed
This cooling of the cabin disappears
to keep both the passenger cabin and

within a short time after take-off.


"'- Radiant heat
By proper ventilation, moderate
the pilot's cockpit warm at a temper-

ature of 70° F when the outside

temperature is about — 20°, F. When


Double-pone temperatures above normal room
window
the airplane is used near the Arctic

temperatures of 72° F are not un-


or in other cold regions, the heating

system should be designed for air en-


comfortable.
tering at a temperature of —40° F. r r At the lower-temperature limit
The heating system should be designed to take care of these extremes in

temperature within five minutes after the engine is started, for warming
the heating system must be designed
up, and must be readily controllable to take care of sudden changes in out-
to keep both the passenger cabin and
side air temperatures encountered either in climbing or in passing from one

the pilot's cockpit warm at. a temper-


ature of 70° F when the outside
locality to another.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The incoming air should not be lower in temperature than that main-

tained in the cabin.


FIGURE XIII-3. A cross section of temperature is about - 20~ F. When
r11.bin showing the use of radiant heating for the airplane is used near the Arctic
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

In order to regulate the temperature reasonably it is necessary, at times,

to deflect a sufficient amount of the incoming air from entering the cabin

keeping the interior uniformly heated.


by means of a diffusing or butterfly valve operated either by an electrically

A is the supply duct for the heated air, or in other cold regions, the heating
driven gear box through a thermostat, or by manual operation. Either

and B is the exhaust duct. system should be designed for air en-
tering at a temperature of -40° F.
method has a certain amount of time lag that is not possible to overcome.

Figure XIII-3. A cross section of

cabin showing the use of radiant heating for


The heating system should be designed to take care of these extremes in
keeping the interior uniformly heated.

A is the supply duct for the heated air,


temperature within five minutes after the engine is started, for warming
and B is the exhaust duct.
up, and must be readily controllable to take care of sudden changes in out-
side air temperatures encountered either in climbing or in passing from one
locality to another.
The incoming air should not be lower in temperature than that main-
tained in the cabin.
In order to regulate the temperature reasonably it is necessary, at times,
to deflect a sufficient amount of the incoming air from entering the cabin
by means of a diffusing or butterfly valve operated either by an electrically
driven gear box through a thermostat, or by manual operation. Either
method has a certain amount of time lag that is not possible to overcome.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
AIR CONDITIONING 227
AIR CONDITIONING

227

Water separation must also be provided in the system in case of rain in


Water separation must also be provided in the system in case of rain in

the incoming air. Snow usually offers no problem since it is vaporized


the incoming air. Snow usually offers no problem since it is vaporized
easily in the heater system.
easily in the heater system.
A dust separator is especially desirable when the airplane is to operate

from dusty airports.


A dust separator is especially desirable when the airplane is to operate
As an additional means of keeping down temperatures of interiors, the
from dusty airports.
tops of fuselages are often painted white. For a normal skin temperature

As an additional meani':i of keeping down temperatures of interiors, the


of 152° F, painting the surface white reduces the temperature to 124° F,

with a possible reduction in cabin temperature of 15° F. White-painted


tops of fuselages are often painted white. For a normal skin temperature
tops are most effective under high temperatures, zero wind conditions,
of 152° F, painting the surface white reduces the temperature to 124° F,
although some reduction can even be expected during flight. Zinc chromate

primer and du Pont White DeLux 83-508 is the treatment given the
with a possible reduction in cabin temperature of 15° F. White-painted
surface.
tops are most effective under high temperatures, zero wind conditions,
AIR DUCTS

although some reduction can even be expected during flight. Zinc chromate
Air inlets should be so located as to be free from contamination of oil

fumes or other engine gases. Since the ducts should have as few bends as
primer and du Pont White DeLux 83-508 is the treatment given the
possible to permit the normal air pressure in flight to force the air into the
surface.
cabin, the location of these inlet ports may offer difficulties.

In a single-engine plane, a duct


AIR DUCTS
carried between the cowling and the

Air inlets should be so located as to be free from contamination of oil


fumes or other engine gases. Since the ducts should have as few bends as
engine ahead of the collector ring

has been found satisfactory.

For a central fuselage having no


possible to permit the normal air pressure in flight to force the air into the
engine in its nose, the foremost point

on the fuselage is an excellent loca-


cabin, the location of these inlet ports may offer difficulties.
tion for this inlet port.
In a single-engine plane, a duct
The leading edge of a wing in the

carried between the cowling and the


engine ahead of the collector ring
pressure region and within the pro-

peller slipstream, if possible, but


Cabin wall
well outside the region of possible
has been found satisfactory.
contamination from oil or exhaust

gases, has also been found suitable.


For a central fuselage having no
engine in its nose, the foremost point
The inlet ducts for leading the air

Alter
to the heater vary in cross section
on the fuselage is an excellent loca-
tion for this inlet port.
from 3 to 5 inches in diameter. It
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

must be remembered that all open-

ings of this kind add to the aero- The leading edge of a wing in the
pressure region and within the pro-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

dynamic resistance so that choice of

cross section should be guided by

the type of airplane; the larger the


peller slipstream, if possible, but Floor
craft, the larger these openings may
well outside the region of possible Fan
be permitted.

The ducts leading to the heater


contamination from oil or exhaust
Cabin wall gases, has also been found suitable. Louvte
Filter

The inlet ducts for leading the air


rs

Conduit
to the heater vary in cross section
tori":::::::.
from 3 to 5 inches in diameter. It
— ^

must be remembered that all open-


FwuRE Xlll-4. A croBI! section of an
1 Floor

1 Fan
ings of this kind add to the aero-
inlet air duct showing treatment for sound-
Louvre

dynamic resistance so that choice of and dust-proofing. Filter has fine-mesh


cross section should be guided by screen. Conduits made of doped fabric,
nun

Figure XIII-4. A cross section of an


the type of airplane; the larger the lined with felt, held in place with coarse-
mesh aluminum screen. Individual fans
inlet air duct showing treatment for sound-

and dust-proofing. Filter has fine-mesh


craft, the larger these openings may are located in each outlet. Louvres are
screen. Conduits made of doped fabric,
be permitted. controllable for regulating volume of air.
The ducts leading to the heater
lined with felt, held in place with coarse-

mesh aluminum screen. Individual fans

are located in each outlet. Louvres are

controllable for regulating volume of air.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
228 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
228

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


are made either of aluminum, aluminum alloy, or stainless steel of a mini-
are made either of aluminum, aluminum alloy, or stainless steel of a mini-

mum thickness of 0.025 inch.


mum thickness of 0.025 inch.
The ducts leading away from the heater may be of metal, but usually
The ducts leading away from the heater may be of metal, but usually
only for a short distance. The longer lengths of the ducts, after the metal

only for a short distance. The longer lengths of the ducts, after the metal
section, may be made of doped aircraft fabric. To prevent too rapid cool-
section, may be made of doped aircraft fabric. To prevent too rapid cool-

ing of the air while being transmitted to the cabin, and to aid in sound-

proofing, the fabric (or metal) ducts are lined with about 3^-inch thick felt
ing of the air while being transmitted to the cabin, and to aid in sound-
held in place by a light-mesh aluminum alloy screen. The outside diam-

eters of these ducts are about the same as the inlet ducts, but their inside
proofing, the fabric (or metal) ducts are lined with about ~-inch thick felt
diameters become less when the felt has been applied.
held in place by a light-mesh aluminum alloy screen. The outside diam-
Individual ducts are led to each seat. Since the amount of air leaving

eters of these ducts are about the same as the inlet ducts, but their inside
diameters become less when the felt has been applied.
each opening should be the same, it may be necessary to vary the opening

by inserting obstructions. Once the airflow has been regulated for each

opening, no changes need be made. Individual ducts are led to each seat. Since the amount of air leaving
For warm weather, when the air at existing temperature is brought into

the cabin, relief for the passengers may best be obtained by diverting air
each opening should be the same, it may be necessary to vary the opening
into an overhead duct in the ceiling of the cabin and forcing the air through
by inserting obstructions. Once the airflow has been regulated for each
overhead grills and individual ventilators. At other times, it is more de-

opening, no changes need be made.


sirable to have the air enter the cabin along the sides near floor level.

n ii
For warm weather, when the air at existing temperature is brought into
Figure XIII-5. Cross section of a Figure XIII-6. Cross section through
the cabin, relief for the passengers may best be obtained by diverting air
manually-operated swiveling nozzle to a conventional air scoop for auxiliary air

regulate individual cold-air supply. supply.


into an overhead duct in the ceiling of the cabin and forcing the air through
The air is taken out of the cabin through outlets located in the floor
overhead grills and individual ventilators. At other times, it is more de-
although they may be located along the roof and exhaust near the top rear.

In some cases it may be more desirable to exhaust at intervals along the


sirable to have the air enter the cabin along the sides near floor level.
side of the fuselage; however, each additional opening adds to the sound-

proofing problem.

A separate exhaust system should be provided for the toilet.

lflf
••••
I
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

I
FmuRE XIII- 5. Cross section of a FrnuRE XIII- 6. Cross section through
manually-operated swiveling nozzle t-0 a conventional air scoop for auxiliary air
regulate individual cold-air supply. supply.

The air is taken out of the cabin through outlets located in the floor
although they may be located along the roof and exhaust near the top rear.
In some cases it may be more desirable to exhaust at intervals along the
side of the fuselage; however, each additional opening adds to the sound-
proofing problem.
A separate exhaust system should be provided for the toilet.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
AIR CONDITIONING 229
AIR CONDITIONING

229

The pressure of the incoming air and the slight suction that is usually
The pressure of the incoming air and the slight suction that is usually

present on the top surface of the fuselage are enough to force exhaust of
present on the top surface of the fuselage are enough to force exhaust of
the air. If the rate of exhaust is not fast enough, an exhausting fan may
the air. If the rate of exhaust is not fast enough, an exhausting fan may
be necessary.

A grill-work made of fine mesh wire should cover each opening so that
be necessary.
nothing may fall in the duct.
A grill-work made of fine mesh wire should cover each opening so that
BOILERS AND RADIATORS

nothing may fall in the duct.


The safest type of system is one in which the exhaust gases heat a liquid

that is vaporized or circulated through a radiator. The air is forced

through the radiator and then led into the cabin. It is not feasible to
BOILERS AND RADIATORS
supply actual radiators for each passenger in the cabin since the volume of

air brought in must be heated quickly and effectively.


The safest type of system is one in which the exhaust gases heat a liquid
The liquids used in the boilers may be commercial ethylene glycol which
that is vaporized or circulated through a radiator. The air is forced
boils at 310° F to 340° F, specific heat of about 0.70; quenching oils of high

through the radiator and then led into the cabin. It is not feasible to
supply actual radiators for each passenger in the cabin since the volume of
boiling points; or a mixture of water and alcohol. The requirements for

such liquids are that they boil at about 300° F, do not freeze or congeal at

the lowest temperature likely to be encountered, and have a flashpoint air brought in must be heated quickly and effectively.
high enough so as not to offer a fire hazard in case of a leak.

The liquids used in the boilers may be commercial ethylene glycol which
The radiators normally used are the cartridge type, or similar to the oil

coolers. It is desirable that the air be in contact with the radiator suffi-
boils at 310° F to 340° F, specific heat of about 0.70; quenching oils of high
ciently long to be heated, that the heat transfer of the radiator be very
boiling points; or a mixture of water and alcohol. The requirements for
rapid, and that the airflow speed be maintained. (See also discussion

under Calculations.) •


such liquids are that they boil at about 300° F, do not freeze or congeal ~tt
HEAT SOURCES the lowest temperature likely to be encountered, and have a flashpoint
The exhaust gases of the engine supply the main source for moderate-

high enough so as not to offer a fire hazard in case of a leak.


size airplanes for heating the air, whether directly or through intermediate

means. In the case of the liquid-cooled engines, auxiliary radiators may


The radiators normally used are the cartridge type, or similar to the oil
be used for heating the air. In any case, it is desirable to have a very hot
coolers. It is desirable that the air be in contact with the radiator suffi-
ciently long to be heated, that the heat transfer of the radiator be very
source if a light, efficient, and instantaneous system is to be obtained.

An aircraft engine operating at 500 hp rejects about 1,500,000 Btu of

heat per hour through the exhaust. rapid, and that the airflow speed be maintained. (See also discussion
Because gas turbine engines provide great quantities of hot air, com-

under Calculations.)
bustion heaters are not used where such a hot air supply is available.

HEAT SOURCES
Electric "blankets" for the cabin side walls and certain areas of the

floor, and electric heaters in the cabin air-ventilation ducts may be used
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

for cabin heating systems in large airplanes.

The exhaust gases of the engine supply the main source for moderate-
size airplanes for heating the air, whether directly or through intermediate
PRESSURE CABIN EQUIPMENT
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The equipment for pressurizing cabins is still undergoing extensive re-

search and design. In general, the necessary equipment for maintaining


means. In the case of the liquid-cooled engines, auxiliary radiators may
passenger cabins at a desired pressure differential consists of:

be used for heating the air. In any case, it is desirable to have a very hot
source if a light, efficient, and instantaneous system is to be obtained.
An aircraft engine operating at 500 hp rejects about 1,500,000 Btu of
heat per hour through the exhaust.
Because gas turbine engines provide great quantities of hot air, com-
bustion heaters are not used where such a hot air supply is available.
Electric "blankets" for the cabin side walls and certain areas of the
floor, and electric heaters in the cabin air-ventilation duets may be m1ed
for cabin heating systems in large airplanes.

PRESSURE CABIN EQUIPMENT


The equipment for pressurizing cabins is still undergoing extensive re-
search and design. In general, the necessary equipment for maintaining
passenger cabins at a desired pressure differential consists of:

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
230 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
230

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL 1. A centrifugal air compressor, usually mounted on the rear of the fire
1. A centrifugal air compressor, usually mounted on the rear of the fire

wall, driven either by a flexible shaft connected to the generator drive of


wall, driven either by a flexible shaft connected to the generator drive of

the engine, or by auxiliary power. This compressor incorporates an inte-


the engine, or by auxiliary power. This compressor incorporates an inte-
gral gear box and usually a weight-flow control as well as a valve permit-
gral gear box and usually a weight-flow control as well as a valve permit-
ting the maintenance of an internal cabin pressure higher than the external

ting the maintenance of an internal cabin pressure higher than the external
pressure.
pressure.

2. A blower relief or surge valve, located in the air duct to the cabin. If

the pressure in the duct builds up due to a throttling down of the control
2. A blower relief or surge valve, located in the air duct to the cabin. If
valve unit, the air is by-passed to the outside atmosphere and so prevents

surging or overheating of the blower. Such procedure would also be de-


the pressure in the duct builds up due to a throttling down of the control
sirable at low altitudes and in warm weather, although the blower may
valve unit, the air is by-passed to the outside atmosphere and so prevents
also operate at low altitudes where it acts as a ventilating fan.

surging or overheating of the blower. Such procedure would also be de-


sirable at low altitudes and in warm weather, although the blower may
3. A supercharging control unit incorporating the air-inflow valves and

the spent-air discharge valves. The cabin pressure is regulated by chang-

ing the opening of the outlet valve. This valve is controlled by pressure- also operate at low altitudes where it acts as a ventilating fan.
sensitive mechanisms responsive to absolute pressure and to differential

3. A supercharging control unit incorporating the air-inflow valves and


pressure.

4. A valve opening inward which will not permit higher pressures to


the spent-air discharge valves. The cabin pressure is regulated by chang-
exist outside the cabin than inside.
ing the opening of the outlet valve. This valve is controlled by pressure-
CALCULATIONS

A typical example will be given here to indicate the type of calculations


sensitive mechanisms responsive to absolute pressure and to differential
that may be made.
pressure.
Temperature of incoming air —20° F

4. A valve opening inward which will not permit higher pressures to


Temperature to be maintained 70° F

Number of passengers to be supplied with air 10


exist outside the cabin than inside.
Volume of air per passenger to be supplied 25 cu ft per min

Volume of cabin 400 cu ft

Ethylene glycol for liquid-type system.


CALCULATIONS
The number of changes required will be (10 X 25)/400 per minute, or

A typical example will be given here to indicate the type of calculations


one change every 1.6 minutes.

Assuming 10 separate outlets, one for each passenger for the incoming
that may be made.
air, then air flows through each duct at the rate of 25 cubic feet per minute.

Restricting the air velocity to 2 feet per second, the area <S of each inlet
Temperature of incoming air -20° F
duct would be
Temperature to be maintained 70° F
2S

Number of passengers to be supplied with air 10


Generated on 2012-05-30 03:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

25

60'
Volume of air per passenger to be supplied 25 cu ft per min
Volume of cabin 400 cu ft
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

25

120'

or
Ethylene glycol for liquid-type system.
d = 0.515 feet, approximately 6.18 inches.
The number of changes required will be (10 X 25)/400 per minute, or
one change every 1.6 minutes.
Assuming 10 separate outlets, one for each passenger for the incoming
air, then air flows through each duct at the rate of 25 cubic feet per minute.
Restricting the air velocity to 2 feet per second, the area S of each inlet
duct would be
25
28 = 60'
7rd 2 25
s=4 = 120'
or
d = 0.515 feet, approximately 6.18 inches.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
AIR CONDITIONING 231
AIR CONDITIONING

231

For rebtivcly small airplanes, such as the problem cited, the practical
For relatively small airplanes, such as the problem cited, the practical

diameter of the inlet duct to the cabin would be about 3 inches. To re-
diameter of the inlet duct to the cabin would be about 3 inches. To re-
duce the velocity of the airflow, it would be desirable to increase the num-
duce the velocity of the airflow, it would be desirable to increase the num-
ber of openings. The duct leading up to the actual outlet into the cabin

is often larger and is provided with a valve for regulating the airflow.
ber of openings. The duct leading up to the actual outlet into the cabin
The heat balance equation may be written as
is often larger and is provided with a valve for regulating the airflow.
Q = Qi + Q* - Qs,

The heat balance equation may be written as


where Q = heat required to raise 250 cubic feet of air per minute from

—20° F to an average of 70° F within the cabin, and

Qi = heat required to raise incoming air to maintain temperature


Q = Qi + Q2 - Qa,
in cabin at 70° F, if there were no losses; then where Q = heat required to raise 250 cubic feet of air per minute from
Qi - WC,(h - <i),

-20° F to an average of 70° F within the cabin, and


Qi = heat required to raise incoming air to maintain temperature
where W — weight of air,

C,, = specific heat of air = 0.2375 at 70° F,

h = temperature of incoming air,


in cabin at 70° F, if there were no losses; then
<i = outside temperature,

Q2 = heat lost by radiation from cabin through windows, fabric,


Qi = WCp(t:i - ti),
where W :..: weight of air,
flooring, and the like,

Q3 = heat generated by the passengers. (This is usually neglected.)

The heat lost by radiation is difficult to ascertain accurately. With


C'P = specific heat of air = 0.2375 at 70° F,
~ = temperature of incoming air,
well soundproofed and hermetically sealed cabins, this loss may be quite

negligible. A loss of 100 Btu per minute will be assumed.

Weight of 250 cu ft of air at 70° F = 250 X 0.076 = 19 lb,


ti = outside temperature,
Qi = 19(0.2375) (70 + 20) = 406 Btu/min,

Q2 = heat lost by radiation from cabin through windows, fabric,


Q2 = 100 Btu/min,

Q = 406 + 100 = 506 Btu/min to be supplied.


flooring, and the like,
The temperature of the incoming air would then be Qs = heat generated by the passengers. (This is usually neglected.)
506 = 19(0.2375) (f, + 20),

U = 95° F, approximately.
The heat lost by radiation is difficult to ascertain accurately. With
This relatively high temperature indicates that the heat lost due to

well soundproofed and hermetically sealed cabins, this loss may be quite
negligible. A loss of 100 Btu per minute will be assumed.
radiation is high in proportion to the heat supplied. This heat loss should

be reduced if possible. If this is not practical, then the incoming heated

air should be so diffused that no passenger is located in a direct blast. In

Weight of 250 cu ft of air 2,t 70° F = 250 X 0.076 = 19 lb,


Qi = 19(0.2375) (70 + 20) = 406 Btu/min,
cases where the incoming air is too hot, a compromise in the temperature

level to be maintained is desirable. By lowering the temperature level

Q2 = 100 Btu/min,
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

within the cabin, and directing the warm air at the passenger at about

Q = 406 + 100 = 506 Btu/min to be supplied.


knee level, a reasonable degree of comfort may be obtained.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

When a liquid system is used, a pump is required to circulate the liquid.

The capacity of the pump can be calculated from:

Q = WCp(t2 - h).
The temperature of the incoming air would then be
506 = 19(0.2375) (t2 + 20),
t'l = 95° F, approximately.
This relatively high temperature indicates that the heat lost due to
radiation is high in proportion to the heat supplied. This heat loss should
be reduced if possible. If this is not practical, then the incoming heated
air should be so diffused that no passenger is located in a direct blast. In.
cases where the incoming air is too hot, a compromise in the temperature
level to be maintained is desirable. By lowering the temperature level
within the cabin, and directing the warm air at the passenger at about
knee level, a reasonable degree of comfort may be obtained.
When a liquid system is used, a pump is required to circulate the liquid.
The capacity of the pump can be calculated from:
Q = WCp(t2 - ti).

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
232 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
232

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL Assume a 50-degree drop through the radiator. The quantity of ethy-
Assume a 50-degree drop through the radiator. The quantity of ethy-

lene glycol (Prestone) to be circulated is then


lene glycol (Prestone) to be circulated is then
506 = TT(0.7) (300 - 250°),

506 = W(0.7) (300 - 250°),


W = 14.4 lb/min.
W = 14.4 lb/min.

The weight of the liquid at 300° F is 9.3 pounds per gallon. Therefore,

the capacity of the pump would be 14.4/9.3 = 1.55 gallons per minute.

(See also discussion under Air Ducts.)


The weight of the liquid at 300° Fis 9.3 pounds per gallon. Therefore,
HEATING SURFACE
the capacity of the pump would be 14.4/9.3 = 1.55 gallons per minute.
The heating surface required for the boiler can be calculated from the

(See also discussion under Air Ducts.)


formula:

Skdt = total heat to be supplied = Q,

where S = heating surface in square feet required,


HEATING SURFACE
k = mean coefficient of heat transmission,

dt = mean temperature difference between the liquid and the


The heating surface required for the boiler can be calculated from the
exhaust gas.
formula:
In the last problem, 506 Btu were to be supplied per minute. The mean

coefficient of heat transmission may be obtained experimentally. For a Skdt = total heat to be supplied = Q,
first approximation some value between 10 and 15 Btu per square foot per

hour may be assumed.


where S = heating surface in squ~re feet required,
m - ta ~ U

~ log.tfo/*,)'
k = mean coefficient of heat transmission,
where to = the initial temperature difference between the liquid and the
dt = mean temperature difference between the liquid and the
gases,

exhaust gas.
tf = the final temperature difference between the liquid and the gas.

Assuming the initial temperature differences to be 1000° F, and the final

In the last problem, 506 Btu were to be supplied per minute. The mean
temperature difference between the liquid and the gases to be 850° F:

_ 1000 - 850 150 =


coefficient of heat transmission may be obtained experimentally. For a
log. (1000/850) 0.162 ~ yZ0 r'
first approximation some value between 10 and 15 Btu per square foot per
Therefore

S = ^ = (12 X5925)/60 = 20073 ft2,Say3-00ft0


hour may be assumed.
0

If the exhaust pipe used for heating the liquid were 4 inches in diameter
dt = to - t1 ,
the heater would have to be (3 X 144)/47r inches or about 35 inches long. log.(to/t1)
In a similar manner, the heat transfer surface of the radiator may be

calculated. The liquid temperatures and the air temperatures would be


where t0 = the initial temperature difference between the liquid and the
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

used in the latter case in the above formulas, and calculations continued

as before.
gases,
t1 = the final temperature difference between the liquid and the gas.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Assuming the initial temperature differences to be 1000° F, and the final


temperature Q.ifference between the liquid and the gases to be 850° F:
1000 - 850 150 0

dt = log. (1000/850) = 0.162 = 925 F.

Therefore

S = k~t = (l 2 X5~~5 )/BO = 2.73 ft 2, say 3.00 ft2 •


If the exhaust pipe used for heating the liquid were 4 inches in diameter
the heater would have to be (3 X 144)/47r inches or about 35 inches long.
In a similar manner, the heat transfer surface of the radiator may be
calculated. The liquid temperatures and the air temperatures would be
used in the latter case in the above formulas, and calculations continued
as before.

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
AIR CONDITIONING 233
AIR CONDITIONING

233

AIR CONDITIONING PROBLEMS AT HIGH SPEEDS


AIR CONDITIONING PROBLEMS AT HIGH SPEEDS
As aircraft speeds increase, heat is the inevitable result. Just below As aircraft speeds increase, heat is the inevitable result. Just below
the speed of sound, the temperature of the pilot's compartment may

the speed of sound, the temperature of the pilot's compartment may


reach 150° F—without air conditioning—when the outside air tempera-

ture is zero. At Mach 2 (about 1600 mph) it may reach 280° F; at Mach
reach 150° F-without air conditioning-when the outside air tempera-
5, it is probably likely to reach 2000° F.
ture is zero. At Mach 2 (about 1600 mph) it may reach 280° F; at Mach
700

600
5, it is probably likely to reach 2000° F.
500

400

300

200 700
100

Aircraft Skin Temperatures


0L

At sea level - -........


-100

600 At 10,000 feet


Aircraft Skin Temperatures

At sea level
At 20,000 feet
At 30,000 feet
At 10,000 feet0

500 At 35,000 feet


0

At 20,000 feet 0

Jf- 400
At 30,000 feet

!
At 35,000 feet-

.2
c
200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400

... 300
True airspeed in miles per hour
8.
E
~
1600 1800

Figure XIII-7. The aircraft skin temperature gives an indication of the interior

temperature likely to occur if no cooling is provided. To the heat at these temperatures


200
might be added the heat developed by the power plant, by the electrical equipment,

and by the human occupants pf the craft.

Air conditioning at these speeds requires more attention to cooling


100
problems than to heating problems. For the jet engine, various methods

are being explored and are still subject to further development and im-

provement.

For the airplane equipped with a jet engine, high-pressure air may be
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

taken from the engine at a temperature much higher than the "ram" air
-100...__ _.____.....____...__ __._ _..___ _.____i.-._....1...._-..1._ _
0~~600~1~1~ 1~1~ 1~
around the aircraft. The ram air can thus be used as the all-important
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

"heat sink" to which heat can be conducted. A heat exchange similar

to an automobile radiator transfers the heat from the engine bleed air to
True airspeed in miles per hour
the ram air. This cooled high-pressure air is then expanded through a

FwuRE XIII- 7. The aircraft skin temperature gives an indication of the interior
temperature likely to occur if no cooling is provided. To the heat at these temperatures
might be added the heat developed by the power plant, by the electrical equipment,
and by the human occupants pf the craft.

Air conditioning at these speeds requires more attention to cooling


problems than to heating problems. For the jet engine, various methods
are being explored and are still subject to further development and im-
provement.
For the airplane equipped with a jet engine, high-pressure air may be
taken from the engine at a temperature much higher than the "ram" air
around the aircraft. The ram air can thus be used as the all-important
"heat sink" to which heat can be conducted. A heat exchange similar
to an automobile radiator transfers the heat from the engine bleed air to
the ram air. This cooled high-pressure air is then expanded through a

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
234 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
234

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


special air-cycle turbine, where the temperature is further reduced to well
special air-cycle turbine, where the temperature is further reduced to well

below the ram air temperature by giving up energy in the form of work.
below the ram air temperature by giving up energy in the form of work.
This work energy is used by the turbine to drive a fan that pulls air This work energy is used by the turbine to drive a fan that pulls air
through the heat exchanger. The cold air from the turbine is then em-

through the heat exchanger. The cold air from the turbine is then em-
ployed to cool the aircraft's cabin and its occupants.

Gas-cycle refrigeration using Freon as the gas (similar to household


ployed to cool the aircraft's cabin and its occupants.
refrigeration units) has been used for cooling systems in airplanes.
Gas-cycle refrigeration using Freon as the gas (similar to household
When airplanes start flying regularly at altitudes where there is virtually

no air, it will no longer be practicable to bleed air from the jet compressor
refrigeration units) has been used for cooling systems in airplanes.
in the large quantities required for pressurization.
When airplanes start flying regularly at altitudes where there is virtually
Perhaps the pilot will carry his own air and pressurization supply—

no air, it will no longer be practicable to bleed air from the jet compressor
in the large quantities required for pressurization.
possibly using compressed air kept in specially-designed storage tanks

within the airplane's structure, or the liquid oxygen breathing system

as a source of pressurization. Cockpit air would be recirculated through


Perhaps the pilot will carry his own air and pressurization supply-
an air-purifying dessicant canister to remove water vapor and odors.

Compressor air would be needed for cooling only, thus greatly reducing
possibly using compressed air kept in specially-designed storage tanks
bleed requirements. The air would pass through an air-cycle turbine, within the airplane's structure, or the liquid oxygen breathing system
the exhaust of which would go through a heat exchanger and then be

as a source of pressurization. Cockpit air would be recirculated through


an air-purifying dessicant canister to remove water vapor and odors.
dumped overboard.

Air conditioning experts believe vapor-cycle cooling systems will be

used in very high-speed aircraft, mainly as auxiliary coolers, absorbing


Compressor air would be needed for cooling only, thus greatly reducing
cabin heat and giving it up to a heat sink—water or fuel on its way to

the engines.
bleed requirements. The air would pass through an air-cycle turbine,
Future cooling possibilities include extensive boiling of water and
the exhaust of which would go through a heat exchanger and then be
boiling of ammonia in various mixtures. Another possibility is the use of

dumped overboard.
Air conditioning experts believe vapor-cycle cooling systems will be
liquid oxygen—commonly called "Lox"—as a stored coolant. It is pro-

posed, in one system, to spray Lox directly into the cabin to provide not

only cooling, but a breathable atmosphere and pressure level as well.


used in very high-speed aircraft, mainly as auxiliary coolers, absorbing
Under consideration for advanced aircraft is the drastic solution of having

the outer portion and leading edge of the airframe and airfoils made of a
cabin heat and giving it up to a heat sink-water or fuel on its way to
fusible material that will melt at extremely high temperatures and thus
the engines.
absorb some of the heat generated.

Future cooling possibilities include extensive boiling of water and


boiling of ammonia in various mixtures. Another possibility is the uire of
Where the top speed and altitude portions of a flight are of short dura-

tion, insulation can do much to prevent heat from reaching the critical

areas of the aircraft. This can be combined with reflective coating on


liquid oxygen-commonly called "Lox"-as a stored coolant. It is pro-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the inside of the cabin to provide further protection. Such measures can

bring reductions in the total weight of the cooling system required. Even
posed, in one system, to spray Lox directly into the cabin to provide not
only cooling, but a breathable atmosphere and pressure level as well.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

slight weight savings are vital, since in some cases a pound of such equip-

ment removed may permit as much as 100 pounds' reduction in the total

Under consideration for advanced aircraft is the drastic solution of having


the outer portion and leading edge of the airframe and airfoils made of a
weight of the aircraft.

fusible material that will melt at extremely high temperatures and thus
absorb some of the heat generated.
Where the top speed and altitude portions of a flight are of short dura-
tion, insulation can do much to prevent heat from reaching the critical
areas of the aircraft. This can be combined with reflective coating on
the inside of the cabin to provide further protection. Such measures can
bring reductions in the total weight of the cooling system required. Even
slight weight savings are vital, since in some cases a pound of such equip-
ment removed may permit as much as 100 pounds' reduction in the total
weight of the aircraft.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER XIV

Soundproofing

The increasing demand for more passenger comfort has brought sound-

proofing very much to the fore, and no airplane passenger cabin has been

correctly designed unless every effort has been made to reduce noise to the

practical minimum.

The problem of soundproofing an auditorium is entirely different from

that of soundproofing an airplane cabin because, in the former, the source


CHAPTER XIV
of noise is inside so that the noise has to be absorbed and materials must

be chosen that will not only absorb the noise but also avoid reverberation.

In an airplane cabin the greatest portion of the noise comes from outside

so that the transmission of sound must be overcome. A very thick wall

is an excellent soundproofing medium but weight is important in an air-

plane so that materials must be chosen which will weigh the least for the
Soundproofing
greatest amount of noise reduction.

MEASURE OF NOISE

The measure of noise level is the decibel. In equation form it is ex-

pressed as:

, . energy input in watts

N = 10 logw -—f—7-0 0 rr0

The increasing demand for more passenger comfort has brought sound-
0

energy output in watts

The acoustical energy is transformed into electrical energy by some suit- proofing very much to the fore, and no airplane passenger cabin has been
able device, generally the "noise meter" or the "decibel meter." Since

the decibel is a logarithmic relationship, it can be shown easily that if an


correctly designed unless every effort has been made to reduce noise to the
airplane engine makes a noise equal to 100 decibels, two such engines
practical minimum.
would cause a noise level of only 103 decibels. Therefore, to reduce the
The problem of soundproofing an auditorium is entirely different from
sound level from 100 decibels to 70 decibels, for example, requires very

careful soundproofing.
that of soundproofing an airplane cabin because, in the former, the source
235 of noise is inside so that the noise has to be absorbed and materials must
be chosen that will not only absorb the noise but also avoid reverberation.
In an airplane cabin the greatest portion of the noise comes from outside
so that the transmission of sound must be overcome. A very thick wall
is an excellent soundproofing medium but weight is important in an air-
plane so that materials must be chosen which will weigh the least for the
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

greatest amount of noise reduction.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

MEASURE OF NOISE
The measure of noise level is the decibel. In equation form it is ex-
pressed as:
N __ 10 1og10 energy input in
.
watts ·
·
energy output m watts
The acoustical energy is transformed into electrical energy by some suit-
able device, generally the "noise meter" or the "decibel meter." Since
the decibel is a logarithmic relationship, it can be shown easily that if an
airplane engine makes a noise equal to 100 decibels, two such engines
would cause a noise level of only 103 decibels. Therefore, to reduce the
sound level from 100 decibels to 70 decibels, for example, requires very
careful soundproofing.
235

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
236 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
236

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

SOURCES OF NOISE
SOURCES OF NOISE

The primary sources of noise encountered in the airplane are: The primary sources of noise encountered in the airplane are:
1. Engine exhaust.

2. Propeller.
1. Engine exhaust.
3. Moving mechanical parts, such as gears.
2. Propeller.
4. Structural vibration.

5. Wall vibration or "drumming."


3. Moving mechanical parts, such as gears.
6. Whistling sounds caused by interferences.
4. Structural vibration.
7. Clatter due to loose structure, machinery, etc.

5. Wall vibration or "drumming."


6. Whistling sounds caused by interferences.
8. Conversation.

The noises which soundproofing attempts to alleviate are, primarily,

engine-exhaust noises, propeller noises, and wall vibration. The first two 7. Clatter due to loose structure, machinery, etc.
cause the greatest disturbances by far.

A comparison of the noise of geared and ungeared airplanes is shown


8. Conversation.
in Table XIV-1.

Table XIV-1. Comparison of noise of geared and ungeared engines.


The noises which soundproofing attempts to alleviate are, primarily,
Location Geared Ungeared
engine-exhaust noises, propeller noises, and wall vibration. The first two
Propeller tip speed (ft/sec) 830 685

cause the greatest disturbances by far.


A comparison of the noise of geared and ungeared airplanes is shown
Propeller diameter (ft) 9.75 10.75

Pitch (ft) 5.7 8.7

Airspeed (mph) 90-100 90-95 in Table XIV-1.


Average noise level above threshold in plane of propellers (db) 107 91

Average noise level above threshold in rear of cabin 95 85

These tests indicate that the reducing of the propeller-tip speed helps

appreciably in noise reduction. A reduction of 100 feet per second in tip


TABLE XIV-1. Comparison of noise of geared and ungearcd engines.
speed is supposed to give as much as a 10-decibel reduction in noise level.

It is not always practical to reduce the propeller-tip speed unless it is

already in the critical region (very close to the velocity of sound) when a
Location Geared Ungeared
reduction in propeller-tip speed would also increase the propeller efficiency

Propeller tip speed (ft/sec) .... ........................... . 830 685


as well as reduce noise.

Propeller diameter (ft) ......... ... . . .. . . . ............... . 9.75 10.75


Mufflers help in reducing exhaust noises, but the level is usually not suffi-

Pitch (ft) ................... . . ................ . ........ . 5.7 8.7


ciently reduced because so many other noises are present. Moreover,

Airspeed (mph) .............. . ................ . .. ... .... . 90-100 90-95


mufflers may seriously reduce the engine horsepower and are not economi-

Average noise level above threshold in plane of propellers (db) 107 91


cal from that viewpoint.

Average noise level above threshold in rear of cabin . ... ... .. . 95 85


EFFECT OF FREQUENCY ON SOUNDPROOFING
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Experimentation with various materials reveals that all are not equally

effective in reducing the incoming noise. Thus it is necessary first to

These tests indicate that the reducing of the propeller-tip speed helps
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

analyze the frequency of the incoming noises.

appreciably in noise reduction. A reduction of 100 feet per second in tip


speed is supposed to give as much as a 10-decibel reduction in noise level.
It is not always practical to reduce the propeller-tip speed unless it is
already in the critical region (very close to the velocity of sound) when a
reduction in propeller-tip speed would also increase the propeller efficiency
as well as reduce noise.
Mufflers help in reducing exhaust noises, but the level is usually not suffi-
ciently reduced because so many other noises are present. Moreover,
mufflers may seriously reduce the engine horsepower and are not economi-
cal from that viewpoint.

EFFECT OF FREQUENCY ON SOUNDPROOFING


Experimentation with various materials reveals that all are not equally
effective in reducing the incoming noise. Thus it is necessary first to
analyze the frequency of the incoming noises.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
SOUNDPROOFING 237
SOUNDPROOFING

237
TABLE XIV-2. Frequency distribution of noise.
Table XIV-2. Frequency distribution of noise.

Frequency,
Causes of noise cycles per second
Frequency,

Causes of noise cycles per second

Propeller unbalance range 20-25


Propeller unbalance range ........... .. ............ .. ......... . 20-25
Engine unbalance range 30-40
Engine unbalance range ........... . .......................... . 30-40
Propeller beating against fuselage 60-80
Propeller beating against fuselage ...... . ............... . ....... . 60-80
Exhaust and engine explosions and vibration transmitted through
Exhaust and engine explosions and vibration transmitted through
structure 200-270
structure ... .. . . . . . . . . . . . ....... . . . ....................... . 200-270
After the range of frequency has been determined, sufficient materials

may be chosen to form a composite blanket or wall to reduce incoming

After the range of frequency has been determined, sufficient materials


noises materially.

SOUNDPROOFING MATERIALS
may be chosen to form a composite blanket or wall to reduce incoming
A variety of materials is used for soundproofing. Choice is determined
noises materially.
by:

1. Location 7. Adaptability

2. Strength 8. Cost
SOUNDPROOFING MATERIALS
3. Durability 9. Other qualities such as heat
A variety of materials is used for soundproofing. Choice is determined
4. Vermin-proof transmission, fire-resistance,

5. Availability hygroscopy, etc.


by:
6. Compactness

1. Location 7. Adaptability
The following materials have been used for soundproofing purposes:

"Dry Zero" airplane blanket Compressed cork


2. Strength 8. Cost
"Seapak" Linoleum
3. Durability 9. Other qualities such as heat
Balsam wool Micarta

Felt Wood
4. Vermin-proof transmission, fire-resistance,
Asbestos Metal
5. Availability hygroscopy, etc.
Bakelite Doped fabric

6. Compactness
Leather Upholstering material

Balsa wood Plywood

The following materials have been used for soundproofing purposes:


Rubberized hair Kapok fibers

The fibrous materials, in general, seem to be the best from the point of

view of noise reduction to weight ratio. It is not desirable to use metal


"Dry Zero" airplane blanket Compressed cork
because of possible "drumming" and reverberation.
''Seapak'' Linoleum
APPLICATION OF MATERIALS

Balsam wool Micarta


Felt Wood
Soundproofing materials are usually employed in the following applica-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

tions.

1. Cabin walls. Alternate layers of fibrous material with air spaces Asbestos Metal
Bakelite Doped fabric
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

approximately three times the thickness of the material are used. One

layer of the material should be attached to the outer metal skin. The

inner layer may be faced with any suitable upholstery material.


Leather Upholstering material
Balsa wood Plywood
Rubberized hair Kapok fibers
The fibrous materials, in general, seem to be the best from the point of
view of noise reduction to weight ratio. It is not desirable to use metal
because of possible "drumming" and reverberation.

APPLICATION OF MATERIALS
Soundproofing materials are usually employed in the following applica-
tions.
1. Cabin walls. Alternate layers of fibrous material with air spaces
approximately three times the thickness of the material are used. One
layer of the material should be attached to the outer metal skin. The
inner layer may be faced with any suitable upholstery material.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
238 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
238

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XIV-1. Suggested soundproofing treatments of cabin wall interiors. A, air

space; F, floating blanket; G, fiber glass; M, metal skin; O, organic material; H, organic

material, horizontal corrugated; V, organic material, vertical corrugated; T, cabin trim;

W, wire lacing.
M T
Any fibrous material which is not very good in tension, or is likely to
A
M 0
pull apart due to its own weight when bung, may be reinforced by muslin

covers, preferably glued on in order to eliminate stitching holes as much


w F
as possible.
0
0
A v
1 fâ„¢!

0
1—n

T T 0
Figure XIV-2. Suggested treatment of individual structural members to reduce

M or
"drumming" and resonance effects. Unsupported panels may be similarly treated.

M G
0
0
H
A

FIGURE XIV-1. Suggested soundproofing treatments of cabin wall interiors. A, air


space; F, floating blanket; G, fiber glass; M, me~l skin; 0, organic material; H, organic
material, horizontal corrugated; V, organic material, vertical corrugated; T, cabin trim;
W, wire lacing.

Any fibrous material which is not very good in tension, or is likely to


pull apart due to its own weight when bung, may be reinforced by muslin
covers, preferably glued on in order to eliminate stitching holes as much
as possible.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XIV- 2. Suggested treatment of individual structural members to reduce


"drumming" and resonance effects. Unsupported panels may be similarly treated.

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
SOUNDPROOFING 239
SOUNDPROOFING

239

Since all materials come in standard sizes, either in 36- or 72-inch widths,
wall seams in the three alternate layers should not be directly behind one
Since all materials come in standard sizes, either in 36- or 72-inch widths,

wall seams in the three alternate layers should not be directly behind one

another. another.
2. Windows. One sheet instead of double panes of window glass is

2. Windows. One sheet instead of double panes of window glass is


sufficient since the windows are far better sound insulators than any

soundproofed portion of the cabin. The glass should be set in felt-cornered


sufficient since the windows are far better sound insulators than any
window stripping and should be supported firmly over the entire perimeter.
soundproofed portion of the cabin. The glass should be set in felt-cornered
3. Flooring. A fibrous material placed over the metal floor and then

covered with micarta or "battleship" linoleum forms a very effective floor-


window stripping and should be supported firmly over the entire perimeter.
ing. Micarta-covered panels may be made removable for inspection of 3. Flooring. A fibrous material placed over the metal floor and then
control cables and structure by means of cowl fastener attachments.

covered with micarta or "battleship" linoleum forms a very effective floor-


ing. Micarta-covered panels may be made removable for inspection of
4. Doors, removable bulkheads, baggage compartments. Doors and re-

movable bulkheads may be covered with felt or some fibrous material and

then protected against ordinary wear by a doped and painted, aircraft-


control cables and structure by means of cowl fastener attachments.
linen cover. Large panels of metal in other parts of the airplane that are

subjected to drumming may be treated with small squares of fibrous mate-


4. Doors, removable bulkheads, baggage compartments. Doors and re-
rials cemented on. These are usually located in the center of the panels.
movable bulkheads may be covered with felt or some fibrous material and
5. Control cables. Control cables should be carried through a duct, pref-

then protected against ordinary wear by a doped and painted, aircraft-


linen cover. Large panels of metal in other parts of the airplane that are
erably felt-lined. Inspection may be made by inserting suitable micarta

panels at intervals.

6. Ventilating system. Since the ventilating ducts are exposed to the


subjected to drumming may be treated with small squares of fibrous mate-
open atmosphere, special attention must be paid to them. Where the fire

hazard is negligible, the ducts may be made of doped fabric. The entire
rials cemented on. These are usually located in the center of the panels.
lengths of the ducts, whether of metal or fabric construction, should be
5. Control cables. Control cables should be carried through a duct, pref-
lined with about 3^-inch layer of felt held in place by a lightweight, coarse-

erably felt-lined. Inspection may be made by inserting suitable micarta


panels at intervals.
mesh aluminum screen.

7. General. Additional precautions to take in keeping down the noise

level are: 6. Ventilating system. Since the ventilating ducts are exposed to the
(a) Placement of the exhaust stack exit below the wing, for example,

open atmosphere, special attention must be paid to them. Where the fire
in a low-wing monoplane, so that the wing may act as a sound

"shadow."
hazard is negligible, the ducts may be made of doped fabric. The entire
(b) Making the gap between the propeller tip and the fuselage structure
lengths of the ducts, whether of metal or fabric construction, should be
as large as possible to avoid any possible dirunming effect.

(c) Avoiding all unobstructed holes, no matter how small. Even


lined with about Ys-inch layer of felt held in place by a lightweight, coarse-
stitching holes are undesirable.
mesh aluminum screen.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Table XIV-3 is of interest in connection with the allocation of various

7. General. Additional precautions to take in keeping down the noise


materials used for soundproofing.

level are:
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

NOISE DUE TO JET ENGINES

Since at take-off power 100% of all noise of the order of 116 to 120
(a) Placement of the exhaust stack exit below the wing, for example,
decibels produced by a jet engine is generated behind the engine, all

muffling schemes are concerned with this noise, and any sound created
in a low-wing monoplane, so that the wing may act as a sound
within the engine itself is discounted.
"shadow."
(b) Making the gap between the propeller tip and the fuselage structure
as large as possible to avoid any possible drumming effect.
(c) Avoiding all unobstructed holes, no matter how small. Even
stitching holes are undesirable.
Table XIV-3 is of interest in connection with the allocation of various
materials used for soundproofing.
NOISE DUE TO JET ENGINES
Since at take-off power 100% of all noise of the order of l lli to 120
decibels produced by a jet engine is generated behind the engine, all
muffling schemes are concerned with this noise, and any sound created
within the engine itself is discounted.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
240 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
240

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


TABLE XIV-3.
Table XIV-3.

Material

Allowance
Allowance

Material (-per cent)


(per cent)

Fibrous soundproofing materials


Fibrous soundproofing materials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Interior fabric and dope
Interior fabric and dope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Sound deadening paint
Sound deadening paint. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Cement for attaching soundproofing material
Cement for attaching soundproofing material. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Special reinforcements along walls at floor level
Special reinforcements along walls at floor level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Cabin door Cabin door. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Talon fasteners (for inspection, removal, and replacements) Talon fasteners (for inspection, removal, and replacements). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Moulding strips, screws, stiffeners, etc Moulding strips, screws, stifieners, etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Total soundproofing weight allowance
Total soundproofing weight allowance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
54

11

13
Noise power produced in the exhaust of a jet engine fitted with con-
2

ventional circular tail pipe varies with the 8th power of the exit velocity
of the exhaust gas. However, any slight increase in the tail pipe's perim-
1

11
eter transverse to the axis of the engine will result in an appreciable
100

Noise power produced in the exhaust of a jet engine fitted with con-
reduction in noise because of the lowered velocity gradient between
ventional circular tail pipe varies with the 8th power of the exit velocity
exhaust and ambient air. The ideal way to increase the tail pipe's
of the exhaust gas. However, any slight increase in the tail pipe's perim-

perimeter is to flatten it into a long, thin orifice-a "slit exhaust"- or


make it rectangular in shape. Depending on the design, tail pipe noise
eter transverse to the axis of the engine will result in an appreciable

reduction in noise because of the lowered velocity gradient between

exhaust and ambient air. The ideal way to increase the tail pipe's suppressors may be expected to cut jet engine noise by about 6 to 18
perimeter is to flatten it into a long, thin orifice—a "slit exhaust"—or

make it rectangular in shape. Depending on the design, tail pipe noise


decibles. The disadvantages of noise suppressors are that they will
suppressors may be expected to cut jet engine noise by about 6 to 18
impose a certain weight penalty and will create thrust losses ranging from
decibles. The disadvantages of noise suppressors are that they will

1 to 5%. No adequate jet exhaust muffler yet exists.


It will take about twice as much soundproofing (in terms of weight)
impose a certain weight penalty and will create thrust losses ranging from

1 to 5%. No adequate jet exhaust muffler yet exists.

It will take about twice as much soundproofing (in terms of weight) to quiet the roar in a commercial jet's cabin than is required for a piston-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

to quiet the roar in a commercial jet's cabin than is required for a piston-

engine plane of equivalent power.


engine plane of equivalent power.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER

The Propeller

The aircraft designer is not likely to be concerned with the detailed

design of the propeller itself, but he is interested in obtaining the type of

XV
propeller most suitable for his design from the point of view of eventual

performance of the aircraft, compatibility with the engine that operates

CHAPTER
it, and the possible influence on the configuration of the aircraft.

GENERAL PROPELLER CHARACTERISTICS

The thrust of any propeller, as well as the power required to operate

it, may be determined analytically. The mathematical expressions ob-

tained are:

T - | CmW*,
The Propeller
Q = | CQnW*,

P=

\ CpnW;

also

P = 2iroQ;

where T = thrust in pounds,

Ct = non-dimensional thrust coefficient,

p = air density in slugs per cubic foot,


The aircraft designer is not likely to be concerned with the detailed
Q = torque in foot-pounds,

Cq = torque coefficient,
design of the propeller itself, but he is interested in obtaining the type of
n = revolutions per second,
propeller most suitable for his design from the point of view of eventual
D = diameter of propeller in feet,

performance of the aircraft, compatibility with the engine that operates


P = work in foot-pounds,

Cp = non-dimensional power coefficient.


it, and the possible influence on the configuration of the aircraft.
241

GENERAL PROPELLER CHARACTERISTICS


The thrust of any propeller, as well as the power required to operate
it, may be determined analytically. The mathematical expressions ob-
tained are:
T = ~ Crn2D'1
2 '
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

also
p = 211"1tQ;
where T = thrust in pounds,
Cr = non-dimensional thrust coefficient,
p = air density in slugs per cubic foot,
Q = torque in foot-pounds,
CQ = torque coefficient,
n = revolutions per second,
D = diameter of propeller in feet,
P = work in foot-pounds,
CP = non-dimensional power coefficient.
241

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
242 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
242

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL While these equations are not normally of direct interest to the aircraft
While these equations are not normally of direct interest to the aircraft

engineer, they are helpful in achieving an understanding of the operation


engineer, they are helpful in achieving an understanding of the operation

of the propeller under certain circumstances. In plotting the thrust and


of the propeller under certain circumstances. In plotting the thrust and
power coefficients for a typical propeller (Figure XV-1), it can be seen that
power coefficients for a typical propeller (Figure XV-1), it can be seen that
the propeller can operate as: a positive-thrust mechanism, or as a pro-

peller; or as a negative-thrust mechanism with power required to operate


the propeller can operate as: a positive-thrust mechanism, or as a pro-
it, and used therefore as a brake; or as a power-producing mechanism, or
peller; or as a negative-thrust mechanism with power required to operate
as a windmill, with the negative thrust as an undesirable by-product.

it, and used therefore as a brake; or as a power-producing mechanism. or


Figure XV-1. Various operating states of the propeller made possible by varying

the pitch of the propeller blades.


as a windmill, with the negative thrust as an undesirable by-product .
Through efficient design, these different states can be extended so that

the propeller can be used as a positive-thrust mechanism for high speed

and climb, and as an air brake in the landing approach and upon landing.

Some designs may permit disengaging the propeller and rotating the indi-

vidual blades so that the entire propeller may windmill with the minimum

amount of negative thrust or drag and, at the same time, transmit no

power to the engine. Other designs may incorporate a brake on the

propeller blade when transmitting no power so that it offers the least

drag. (See Table XV-1.)

...
cG
·u
~
g
u
,j V/nD
~
0
u
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

----Propeller state ----state

Figure XV-1. Various operating states of the propeller made p088ible by varying
the pitch of the propeller blades.

Through efficient design, these different states can be extended so that


the propeller can be used as a positive-thrust mechanism for high speed
and climb, and as an air brake in the landing approach and upon landing.
Some designs may permit disengaging the propeller and rotating the indi-
vidual blades so that the entire propeller may windmill with the minimum
amount of negative thrust or drag and, at the same time, transmit no
power to the engine. Other designs may incorporate a brake on the
propeller blade when transmitting no power so that it offers the least
drag. (See Table XV- 1.)

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PROPELLER 243
THE PROPELLER

243
TABLE XV-1. Relative drag of propeller under different conditions.
Table XV-1. Relative drag of propeller under different conditions.

Condition Order of remtance


Condition Order of resistance

Stopped 1.00
Stopped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.00
Idling (no thrust) .73
Idling (no thrust). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Windmilling .44
Windmilling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Fully feathered .08
Fully feathered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .08
Instead of the equations for the propeller listed above, it is customary

to use a so-called "speed-power" relationship, derivable from the follow-


Instead of the equations for the propeller listed above, it is customary
ing equation for power: 1/5

Ls — (bhp)i/5(Arrjm)2/5'
to use a so-called "speed-power" relationship, derivable from the follow-
ing equation for power:
where C, is known as the speed-power coefficient.

AERODYNAMIC EFFECTS OF PROPELLER


2.14 pll 5 V mph
The propeller, as viewed from behind, rotates toward the right. The
C, = (bhp)ll5(Nrpm)215 1
reaction of the forces acting on the propeller tends to turn the engine and

the airplane in an opposite direction. To counteract this, there must be where C, is known as the speed-power coefficient.
provided an increase in lift to produce an opposite rolling moment. This

may be done by establishing a difference in the angle of incidence between

the left and right wing so that more lift is produced on the left than on
AERODYNAMIC EFFECTS OF PROPELLER
the right. Another method is to rig the ailerons differentially or to in-
The propeller, as viewed from behind, rotates toward the right. The
duce a differential action with thfe addition of a fixed or controllable tab

inset in one of the ailerons. \


reaction of the forces acting on the propeller tends to turn the engine and
Naturally, a difference in lift will also produce a difference in drag the airplane in an opposite direction. To counteract this, there must be
which produces a yawing moment. To counteract the yawing moment

provided an increase in lift to produce an opposite rolling moment. This


with its tendency to turn the airplane to the left, (1) a slight right rudder

may be employed, or (2) a slight right rudder may be rigged by use of a


may be done by establishing a difference in the angle of incidence between )I
tab, or (3) the vertical tail surfaces may employ an unsymmetrical air-
the left and right wing so that more lift is produced on the left than on '. '.
foil, or (4) the fin may be offset slightly from the plane of symmetry.

Propeller slipstream increases the air velocity over the wing and thereby
the right. Another method is to rig the ailerons differentially or to in-
contributes to increased lift as well as drag. However, at high speeds
duce a differential action with the,_ addition of a fixed or controllable tab
the effect of slipstream is considered negligible. At low speeds, the effect

inset in one of the ailerons. "\


Naturally, a difference in lift will also produce a difference in drag
may be appreciable and therefore has been given attention in converti-

planes, where the slipstream over the wing with its lift-increase devices

may become very important.


which produces a yawing moment. To counteract the yawing moment
The propeller slipstream is of importance in the cooling of aircraft

engines while the plane is on the ground.


with its tendency to turn the airplane to the left, (1) a slight right rudder
may be employed, or (2) a slight right rudder may be rigged by use of a
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

GYROSCOPIC EFFECT

When the airplane rotates about its vertical axis, gyroscopic forces are

tab, or (3) the vertical tail surfaces may employ an unsymmetrical air-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

foil, or (4) the fin may be offset slightly from the plane of symmetry.
brought into play. The moment about the propeller shaft may be ex-

pressed by the following formula:

T = o>Mh ~ h),
Propeller slipstream increases the air velocity over the wing and thereby
contributes to increased lift as well as drag. However, at high speeds
the effect of slipstream is considered negligible. At low speeds, the effect
may be appreciable and therefore has been given attention in converti-
planes, where the slipstream over the wing with its lift-increase devices
may become very important.
The propeller slipstream is of importance in the cooling of aircraft
engines while the plane is on the ground.

GYROSCOPIC EFFECT
When the airplane rotates about its vertical axis, gyroscopic forces are
brought into play. The moment about the propeller shaft may be ex-
pressed by the following formula :
T = W1W2(I1 - 12)'

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
244 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
244

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


where w1 = angular velocity of the airplane in the turn,
w2 = angular velocity of the rotating propeller,
where coi = angular velocity of the airplane in the turn,

0)2 = angular velocity of the rotating propeller,

7i = mass polar moment of inertia of the propeller about its thrust


I 1 = mass polar moment of inertia of the propeller about its thrust
axis,

7 2 = mass polar moment of inertia of the propeller about an axis


axis,
parallel to the airplane's turning axis.
I 2 = mass polar moment of inertia of the propeller about an axis
The effect of the gyroscopic couple is to force the airplane into a left-

hand turn when the airplane is pitched down from a horizontal path; or,
paraJlel to the airplane's turning axis.
The effect of the gyroscopic couple is to force the airplane into a left-
if the airplane is making a left-hand turn, the airplane will tend to pitch

up. The opposite effect is obtained when the airplane is controlled in

the reverse directions. hand turn when the airplane is pitched down from a horizontal path; or,
This gyroscopic couple not only affects the behavior of the craft, but

if the airplane is making a left-hand turn, the airplane will tend to pitch
also introduces additional stresses in the propeller shaft and the aircraft.

For the normal propeller, the loads and consequent stresses produced
up. The opposite effect is obtained when the airplane is controlled in
upon the aircraft are considered negligible.

the reverse directions.


This gyroscopic couple not only affects the behavior of the craft, but
PROPELLER PITCH

The geometric pitch of a propeller may be defined as (1) the advance

in a solid medium, or (2) as the tangent of the blade angle, measured be- also introduces additional stresses in the propeller shaft and the aircraft.
tween the chord of the airfoil section and the plane of rotation of the

For the normal propeller, the loads and consequent stresses produced
propeller. Since the propeller blades have different blade angles from

root to tip, the geometric pitch is usually specified at three quarters of


upon the aircraft are considered negligible.
'the radius.

The individual blade can be designed so that it can be rotated about its

PROPELLER PITCH
axis, either manually or automatically, to change the blade angles. Since

variations are possible, several types will be briefly defined here. The geometric pitch of a propeller may be defined as (1) the advance
1. A fixed-pitch propeller does not permit any rotation of the individual

in a solid medium, or (2) as the tangent of the blade angle, measured be-
blade after the propeller has been built. Such propellers are lighter than

any other type because of the simplicity of construction.


tween the chord of the airfoil section and the plane of rotation of the
2. An adjustable-pitch propeller permits manual adjustment on the
propeller. Since the propeller blades have different blade angles from
ground so that the blade angle is changed to suit certain operating condi-

tions. After each such setting, the propeller operates as a fixed-pitch


., root to tip, the geometric pitch is usually specified at three quarters of
propeller.
the radius.
Both the fixed-pitch and adjustable-pitch propellers are used for rela-

The individual blade can be designed so that it can be rotated about its
axis, either manually or automatically, to change the blade angles. Since
tively low-horsepower engines, where the weight of the propeller becomes

an important factor in design considerations.

variations are possible, several types will be briefly defined here.


Generated on 2012-05-30 03:33 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. A variable- or controllable-pitch propeller is usually thought of as one

in which the blades may be rotated in flight. There are several possible

1. A fixed-pitch propelkr does not permit any rotation of the individual


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

variations of this type of propeller:

(a) It may have a limited angular range and therefore not require as
blade after the propeller has been built. Such propellers are lighter than
complicated an operating mechanism as some others.

any other type because of the simplicity of construction.


2. An adjustable-pitch propeller permits manual adjustment on the
(b) It may permit a variety of blade angles so that the engine may

ground so that the blade angle is changed to suit certain operating condi-
tions. After each such setting, the propeller operates as a fixed-pitch
propeller.
Both the fixed-pitch and adjustable-pitch propellers are used for rela-
tively low-horsepower engines, where the weight of the propeller becomes
an important factor in design considerations.
3. A variable- orcontrollable-pitch propeller is usually thought of as one
in which the blades may be rotated in flight. There are several possible
variations of this type of propeller:
(a) It may have a limited angular range and therefore not require as
complicated an operating mechanism as some others.
(b) It may permit a variety of blade angles so that the engine may

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PROPELLER 245

of
THE PROPELLER

245

operate at a constant number of revolutions per minute regardless ofthe_


operate at a constant number of revolutions per minute regardless the__
path speed of the aircraft.
path speed of the aircraft.
To reduce the resistance of a windmilling propeller after an engine has

To reduce the resistance of a windmilling propeller after an engine has


ceased to deliver power, the propeller blades may be rotated and stopped
ceased to deliver power, the propeller blades may be rotated and stopped

so that the engine itself may not be harmed and the drag of the propeller

may be reduced to a minimum. so that the engine itself may not be harmed and the drag of the propeller
To offer more resistance and thereby help to reduce the speed of the

may be reduced to a minimum.


aircraft, especially on landing, the blades may be sufficiently rotated to

act as a brake. See Table XV-2 for the effect of reversing propellers on
To offer more resistance and thereby help to reduce the speed of the
the length of the landing run.
aircraft, especially on landing, the blades may be sufficiently rotated to
Table XV-2. Effect of reversing propellers on a 4-engine airplane.

Number of
act as a brake. See Table XV-2 for the effect of reversing propellers on
propellers reversed
the length of the landing run.
Trial

Use of brakes

TABLE XV-2. Effect of reversing propellers on a 4-engine airplane.


Landing run

None

Number of
100%

Trial propellers reversed Use of brakes Landing run


100%

1 None 1003 1003


2

2 2 0 130
130

3 2 100 71
3

100

71
4 4 0 92
4

4
5 4 100 52
0

92
6 4 50 48
5

4
7 4 65 45
100

8 4 100 45
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

52

6
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

50
Both the feathering and braking features may be incorporated in a
48

7
constant-speed propeller. The effect of the various types of propellers
4
upon the airplane's performance is illustrated in Figure XV-2.
65

45

8
NUMBER OF BLADES
4 The determination of the number of blades for a propeller requires the -
100

consideration of a variety of factors. Theoretically, a one-blade propeller , _


45

Both the feathering and braking features may be incorporated in a


should have the highest propulsive efficiency since propeller blades inter- ,,,)
constant-speed propeller. The effect of the various types of propellers
fere with each other aerodynamically. However, while such a propeller '
upon the airplane's performance is illustrated in Figure XV-2.

NUMBER OF BLADES
can and has been manufactured, most propellers are produced with 2, 3,
The determination of the number of blades for a propeller requires the -
or 4 blades, with combinations of 6 or 8 for dual-rotating propellers.
consideration of a variety of factors. Theoretically, a one-blade propeller

With the increase in the number of blades, the over-all efficiency de-
creases. However, as the amount of power to be absorbed by a two-
should have the highest propulsive efficiency since propeller blades inter-

fere with each other aerodynamically. However, while such a propeller /

can and has been manufactured, most propellers are produced with 2, 3,
blade propeller, for example, increases, it would be necessary to increase
or 4 blades, with combinations of 6 or 8 for dual-rotating propellers.

With the increase in the number of blades, the over-all efficiency de-
its diameter until either the physical dimensions would be too great for
creases. However, as the amount of power to be absorbed by a two-

blade propeller, for example, increases, it would be necessary to increase

its diameter until either the physical dimensions would be too great for

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
246 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
246

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

1000

oi I I I I I I I

0 40 80 120 160 200 240 280

Airplane speed, miles per hour

Figure XV-2. The effect of different types of propellers on the performance of the

airplane:

1. Fixed-pitch propeller.

2. Limited controllable-pitch propeller.

3. Constant-speed (rpm) propeller.

4. Theoretical curve for a constant speed, variable-diameter propeller.

All propellers deliver the same power for the design speed—in this case, the maximum.

installation in a reasonable airplane design configuration or the tip speed

would approach a velocity equal to that of sound, where the efficiency

would be adversely affected.

For the absorption of rather large horsepowers, rather than increasing

the number of blades on a single propeller, a better compromise may be

made with two counter-rotating propellers. The over-all diameter of

two counter-rotating propellers is likely to be considerably less than an


o.._~_._~__,~~-'-~--'-~~.._~__._~__,
equally efficient multi-bladed propeller.
0 40 80 120 160 200 240 280
A large-diameter propeller will affect the height of the landing gear, for
Airplane speed, miles per hour
example, or may require placement of the engine nacelles farther out-

board on the wing. Either or both would lead to structural complications


FIGURE XV-2. The effect of different types of propellers on the performance of the
and consequent added weight. However, since the area swept out by
airplane:
the propeller near its hub is not very efficient aerodynamically, especially 1. Fixed-pitch propeller.
when the propeller is placed in front of a blunt body, the propeller of the

2. Limited controllable-pitch propeller.


3. Consta.ntrspeed (rpm) propeller.
larger diameter is to be preferred over the smaller diameter. A large-

diameter propeller is generally considered good for a high rate of climb,

with consequent higher service and absolute ceilings, whereas the smaller-
4. Theoretical curve for a constant speed, variable-diameter propeller.
diameter propeller is considered better for the high-speed capabilities of

All propellers deliver the same power for the design speed-in this case, the maximum.
the airplane. The metal propeller usually has good operating character-

istics throughout the entire performance range of the aircraft.

installation in a reasonable airplane design configuration or the tip speed


would approach a velocity equal to that of sound, where the efficiency
would be adversely affected.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:34 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

For the absorption of rather large horsepowers, rather than increasing


the number of blades on a single propeller, a better compromise may be
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

made with two counter-rotating propellers. The over-all diameter of


two counter-rotating propellers is likely to be considerably less than an
equally efficient multi-bladed propeller.
A large-diameter propeller will affect the height of the landing gear, for
example, or may require placement of the engine nacelles farther out-
board on the wing. Either or both would lead to structural complications
and consequent added weight. However, since the area swept out by
the propeller near its hub is not very efficient aerodynamically, especially
when the propeller is placed in front of a blunt body, the propeller of the
/
J larger diameter is to be preferred over the smaller diameter. A largc-
diameter propeller is generally considered good for a high rate of climb,
with consequent higher service and absolute ceilings, whereas the smaller-
diameter propeller is considered better for the high-speed capabilities of
the airplane. The metal propeller usually has good operating character-
istics throughout the entire performance range of the aircraft.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PROPELLER 247
THE PROPELLER

247

Increasing the number of blades will increase the weight of the propeller
Increasing the number of blades will increase the weight of the propeller
and will have some effect upon the airplane's performance.

and will have some effect upon the airplane's performance.


Beeam;e of the different faetors affecting the choice of a propeller, it is
Because of the different factors affecting the choice of a propeller, it is

particularly desirable to make a careful analysis of several types of pro-

pellers, if they happen to be available, in order to obtain the best engi- particularly deHirable to make a careful analysis of several types of pro-
neering compromise.

pellers, if they happen to be available, in order to obtain the best engi-


PROPELLER INFLUENCE ON AIRCRAFT CONFIGURATION
. .
In order that the propeller may operate at its maximum efficiency, it is
neermg compromise.
desirable that it be placed as far ahead of a thick body as possible to avoid

the "blanketing" of the propeller itself and the resulting reduction in its

effective working radius.

The propeller would give its best performance if it were placed at the
PROPELLER INFLUENCE ON AIRCRAFT CONFIGURATION
front end of a well-streamlined long shaft. Obviously, such an installa-

tion is not always possible, since it would make difficult the proper mount-
In order that the propeller may operate at its maximum efficiency, it is
ing of the shaft and increase the over-all weight of the installation.
desirable that it be placed as far ahead of a thick body as possible to avoid
Where the propeller tip operates close to a structure (at the side of the

the "blanketing" of the propeller itself and the resulting reduction in its
effective working radius.
fuselage, for example), allowance should be made for sufficient clearance

between the propeller tip and the structure. One to two inches usually

seems effective. However, the clearance is a function of the propeller-tip The propeller would give its best performance if it were placed at the
speed and the power absorbed by the propeller blade. Too little clearance

causes "drumming" of the structure and possible vibration of the pro-


front end of a well-streamlined long shaft. Obviously, such an installa-
peller or the structure or both. The structure in the region of the pro-
tion is not always possible, since it would make difficult the proper mount-
peller tip should be reinforced in any case.

ing of the shaft and increase the over-all weight of the installation.
Where the propeller tip operates close to a structure (at the side of the
PROPELLER CLEARANCE

Nacelles are located outboard as far as allowance for propeller clearance

of at least 2 inches with the side of the fuselage and the tip of the propeller fuselage, for example), allowance should be made for sufficient clearance
will require, but usually no farther.

It may be desirable to place the axis of the nacelles at an angle to the


between the propeller tip and the structure. One to two inches usually
longitudinal axis for any of several reasons; the nacelle may be brought
seems effective. However, the clearance is a function of the propeller-tip
closer to the fuselage if the thrust line is outward; or the plane of rotation

speed and the power absorbed by the propeller blade. Too little clearance
causes "drumming" of the structure and possible vibration of the pro-
of the propeller may thus be made to pass through the fuselage ahead of

the cockpit. In some cases, it has been thought preferable to place the

nacelles at a slight outward angle to assure the slipstream effect over the peller or the structure or both. The structure in the region of the pro-
vertical tail surfaces when one engine quits, for then it is necessary to coun-

peller tip should be reinforced in any case.


teract the yawing moment produced by the thrust of the other engine.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Any such angle incorporated in the design of the nacelle does not affect

the efficiency of the engine as far as forward thrust is concerned since the

PROPELLER CLEARANCE
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

cosine of an angle of 5 degrees would reduce the effective thrust forward

by less than Yi per cent. (See Figure XV-3.)

Nacelles are located outboard as far as allowance for propeller clearance


of at least 2 inches with the side of the fuselage and the tip of the propeller
will require, but usually no farther.
It may be desirable to place the axis of the nacelles at an angle to the
longitudinal axis for any of several reasons; the nacelle may be brought
closer to the fuselage if the thrust line is outward; or the plane of rotation
of the propeller may thus be made to pass through the fuselage ahead of
the cockpit. In some cases, it has been thought preferable to place the
nacelles at a slight outward angle to assure the slipstream effect over the
vertical tail surfaces when one engine quits, for then it is necessary to coun-
teract the yawing moment produced by the thrust of the other engine.
Any such angle incorporated in the design of the nacelle does not affect
the efficiency of the engine as far as forward thrust is concerned since the
cosine of an angle of 5 degrees would reduce the effective thrust forward
by less than 72 per cent. (See Figure XV-3.)

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
248 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

F10URE XV-3. The power-plant nacelle may be set nonparallel to the thrust axis at
an angle of 5 degrees or more to the plane of symmetry if clearance of the pilot's cockpit
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

becomes a problem.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The forward position of the nacelle merits some consideration. Where


the wing section immediately in rear of the engine nacelle is unusually
thick, the propeller should be placed as far forward as other considerations
permit. Otherwise, the propeller may become inefficient due to the
"blanketing" caused by the wing.
In general, the following considerations should be kept in mind in
locating the propeller or propellers :
1. Propellers should have a minimum ground clearance of 9 inches
when the airplane is in a horizontal position with the chassis deflected as
it would be under the normal gross weight of the airplane.
2. Propellers on seaplanes should clear the water by at least 18 inches
when the seaplane is at rest.
3. A clearance of at least l inch should be provided between the tips
of the propellers and the fuselage or any part of the structure.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PROPELLER 249
THE PROPELLER

249
4. Surfaces near the propeller tips should be suitably stiffened against
4. Surfaces near the propeller tips should be suitably stiffened against

vibration.
vibration.
5. The pilot and the primary control units, excluding cables and control
5. The pilot and the primary control units, excluding cables and control
rods, should not be located in the region between the plane of rotation

rods, should not be located in the region between the plane of rotation
of any propeller and the surface generated by a line passing through the
of any propeller and the surface generated by a line passing through the

center of the propeller hub and making an angle of 5 degrees fore or aft

of the plane of rotation of the propeller. center of the propeller hub and making an angle of 5 degrees fore or aft
6. Likewise, no passenger door should be located in the same region.

ASYMMETRICAL CONDITIONS
of the plane of rotation of the propeller.
The propeller in a conventional installation, in the course of its rotation,
6. Likewise, no passenger door should be located in the same region.
does not encounter the same airflow as it would if it were located at the

ASYMMETRICAL CONDITIONS
end of a long symmetrical shaft with no interferences behind it.

For example, in the propeller of a single-engine airplane, each blade

would pass by each half of the wing and the landing-gear members. (See

The propeller in a conventional installation, in the course of its rotation,


does not encounter the same airflow as it would if it were located at the
Figure XV-^t.) These interferences would set up vibrations in the pro-

peller. The frequency of the vibration may be found from the formula:

/ = nBc,
end of a long symmetrical shaft with no interferences behind it.
where / = frequency of the vibration,

B = number of blades,
}i'or example, in the propeller of a single-engine airplane, each blade
n = number of revolutions per second of the propeller,
would pass by each half of the wing and the landing-gear members. (See
c = number of interferences.

Figure XV-4.) These interferences would set up vibrations in the pro-


peller. The frequency of the vibration may be found from the formula:
Figure XV-4. This propeller has six interferences for each blade to set up vibration

responses.

f
If the natural frequency of the propeller were the same as the inducing

vibration frequency, resonance would occur, and the propeller would


= nBc,
f = frequency of the vibration,
operate roughly and would, in time, even disintegrate. Similarly, the

natural frequency of the propeller should not be in the realm of the fre-
where
quencies of engine explosions. Each propeller is therefore designed to

operate with specific engines.


B = number of blades,
Another asymmetrical condition may arise in multi-engine designs
n = number of revolutions per second of the propeller,
when the airflow through one propeller disk interferes with the airflow

c = number of interferences.
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XV-4. This propeller b&B six interferences for each blade to set up vibration
responses.

If the natural frequency of the propeller were the same as the inducing
vibration frequency, resonance would occur, and the propeller would
operate roughly and would, in time, even disintegrate. Similarly, the
natural frequency of the propeller should not be in the realm of the fre-
quencies of engine explosions. Each propeller is therefore designed to
operate with specific engines.
Another asymmetrical condition may arise in multi-engine designs
when the airflow through one propeller disk interferes with the airflow

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
250 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
250

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XV-5. Flow interferences through the propeller disks lead to asymmetrical

conditions from which vibration in the propeller blades may result.

through an adjacent propeller disk (where the propeller disk is defined as

the area swept out in one rotation of the propeller blades). See Figure

When undesirable conditions arise which may be traced to asym-

metrical conditions, the solution may be found in a different propeller of

a different natural frequency obtained by either different blade design,

different diameter, or an increase in number of blades.

The normal propeller-engine combination imposes a torque upon the

airplane that gives it a tendency to turn about the longitudinal axis.

On the ground, the rotation of the airplane is prevented by the ground

reacting against the wheels. (See Figure XV-6.) As the airplane takes

off the ground, a countering torque or rolling moment must be produced

by the aileroTfST The airplane therefore has to have sufficient air speed
FIGURE XV-5. Flow interferences through the propeller disks lead to asymmetrical
to obtain the necessary rolling moment. As the power used for the pro-
conditions from which vibration in the propeller blades may result.
peller-type engine tends to become greater and the spans of the airplane

tend to become smaller, the air speed has to be quite appreciable at take-
through an adjacent propeller disk (where the propeller disk is defined as
off to prevent possible disaster, since engine torque is usually greater at

take-off than in normal flight.


the area swept out in one rotation of the propeller blades). See Figure
XV-5.
XV-5.
EFFECT OF ENGINE TORQUE

When undesirable conditions arise which may be traced to asym-


metrical conditions, the solution may be found in a different propeller of
T

Figure XV-6. Effect of engine torque on ground reactions.

a different natural frequency obtained by either different blade design,


different diameter, or an increase in number of blades.
EFFECT OF ENGINE TORQUE
The normal propeller-engine combination imposes a torque upon .the
airplane that gives it a tendency to turn about the longitudinal axis.
On the ground, the rotation of the airplane is prevented by the ground
reacting against the wheels. (See Figure XV-6.) As the airplane takes
off the ground, a countering torque or rolling moment must be produced
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

by the ailerO'i'm"." The airplane therefore has to have sufficient air speed
to obtain the necessary rolling moment. As the power used for the pro-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

peller-type engine tends to become greater and the spans of the airplane
tend to become smaller, the air speed has to be quite appreciable at take-
off to prevent possible disaster, since engine torque is usually greater at
take-off than in normal flight.

----- T-----

FIGURE XV-6. Effect of engine torque on ground reactions.

Original from
D IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE PROPELLER 251
THE PROPELLER

251

The torque present in the propeller-engine combination might be over-


come in multi-engine designs in several ways:
The torque present in the propeller-engine combination might be over-

come in multi-engine designs in several ways:

1. An equal number of left-hand and right-hand rotations of propellers 1. An equal number of left-hand and right-hand rotations of propellers
could be used. This solution is impractical, primarily from the standpoint

of economics.
could be used. ThiH solution is impractical, primarily from the :;tandpoint
2. The engines could be arranged in tandem. Such an arrangement
of economics.
is seldom desirable due to the structural complications involved.

2. The engines could be arranged in tandem. Such an arrangement


is seldom desirable due to the structural complications involved.
3. The use of counter-rotating propellers is the most practical solution

and the one that is most commonly employed.

For relatively high-speed airplanes using large-horsepower engines, the


3. The use of counter-rotating propellers is the most practical solution
counter-rotating or dual-rotation propeller is certainly necessary.

Another necessary application is for the vertical take-off airplane, since


and the one that is most commonly employed.
there, the axis about which the torque would act is vertical. No easy
For relatively high-speed airplanes using large-horsepower engines, the
solution would be available in the design of the landing gear for counter-

counter-rotating or dual-rotation propeller is certainly necessary.


Another necessary application is for the vertical take-off airplane, since
ing the torque on the ground. The transition from the moment of take-

off to the time when sufficient air speed past ailerons was obtained would

include a period during which the aircraft rotated about its vertical axis, there, the axis about which the torque would act is vertical. No easy
unless secondary propellers were employed purely for the purpose of pro-

solution would be available in the design of the landing gear for counter-
ducing a torque to counteract the engine torque.

TANDEM ENGINES
ing the torque on the ground. The transition from the moment of take-
Tandem arrangements of engines are little used in multi-engine designs
off to the time when sufficient air speed past ailerons was obtained would
include a period during V·:hich the aircraft rotated about its vertical axis,
although the increase in power of individual units may make such a solu-

tion preferable to some others. The advantage of the tandem setup is

that in case of one engine failure there is not so great a yawing moment unless secondary propellers were employed purely for the purpose of pro-
produced by the excess thrust on one side as would be the case if the outer-

ducing a torque to counteract the engine torque.


most engine in a multi-engine design failed.

Auxiliary cooling, usually special blowers, must be provided for the rear

engine since the front engine partially blankets it. This could be over-

TANDEM ENGINES
come by providing larger airscoops in the leading edge of the wing for ob-

taining the necessary cooling air.


Tandem arrangements of engines are little used in multi-engine designs
The tandem arrangement may reduce aerodynamic resistance although

although the increase in power of individual units may make such a solu-
tion preferable to some others. The advantage of the tandem setup is
this may be open to question since scoops for cooling air will add to the

resistance. In designing the nacelle, a symmetrical airfoil shape with its

maximum thickness located approximately in the plane of the cylinders that in case of one engine failure there is not so great a yawing moment
(for radial engines) of the front engine is a good first solution. Slight alter-

produced by the excess thrust on one side as would be the case if the outer-
Generated on 2012-05-30 03:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ations may then be made as design conditions warrant.

The propeller for the rear engine, since it operates in the slipstream of
most engine in a multi-engine design failed.
Auxiliary cooling, usually special blowers, must be provided for the rear
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the front engine, may be designed with a smaller diameter than the front-

engine propeller. However, some difficulty may arise from vibration

caused by the irregular airflow.


engine since the front engine partially blankets it. This could be over-
For airplanes with the conventional type of landing gear, the propeller
come by providing larger airscoops in the leading edge of the wing for ob-
clearance requirement (9 inches between the propeller tip and the ground)

taining the necessary cooling air.


The tandem arrangement may reduce aerodynamic resistance although
this may be open to question since scoops for cooling air will add to the
resistance. In designing the nacelle, a symmetrical airfoil shape with its
maximum thickness located approximately in the plane of the cylinders
(for radial engines) of the front engine is a good first solution. Slight alter-
ations may then be made as design conditions warrant.
The propeller for the rear engine, since it operates in the slipstream of
the front engine, may be designed with a smaller diameter than the front-
engine propeller. However, some difficulty may arise from vibration
caused by the irregular airflow.
For airplanes with the conventional type of landing gear, the propeller
clearance requirement (9 inches between the propeller tip and the ground)

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
252 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
252

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

will either force the placing of the engine nacelle comparatively far above
the normal position or require an increase in landing-gear length.
will either force the placing of the engine nacelle comparatively far above

the normal position or require an increase in landing-gear length.

The torque of the tractor engine will be offset by the torque of the
The torque of the tractor engine will be offset by the torque of the
pusher engine, so that aerodynamic means do not have to be resorted to

pusher engine, so that aerodynamic means do not have to be resorted to


for providing the offsetting rolling moment.
for providing the offsetting rolling moment.

The pusher propeller in a tandem design would be smaller than the

tractor propeller and also somewhat different from it since it works in the
The pusher propeller in a tandem design would be smaller than the
slipstream of the latter. However, it may be blanketed to some extent•

by the structure ahead of it.


tractor propeller and also somewhat different from it since it works in the
PUSHER INSTALLATIONS
slipstream of the latter. However, it may be blanketed to some ext.fmt.
When the propeller operates in the rear of the engine, relative to the

by the structure ahead of it.


forward flight of the aircraft, it is known as a "pusher." Like any other

configuration, such an installation has certain advantages and disad-

vantages resulting not only from the placement of the propeller, but also
PUSHER INSTALLATIONS
from the location of the engine.

In general, a pusher installation, since it is often located aft of the


When the propeller operates in the rear of the engine, relative to the
trailing edge of the wing, will also be located aft of the center of gravity
forward flight of the aircraft, it is known as a "pusher." Like any other
of the airplane. Cargo and passenger items, then, are usually situated

configuration, such an installation has certain advantages and disad-


vantages resulting not only from the placement of the propeller, but al.so
ahead of the engine in order to get the proper location of the center of

gravity of the airplane in relation to the mean aerodynamic chord.

Some of the advantages of the pusher installation are: from the location of the engine.
1. Passengers and crew obtain unimpeded vision forward since there

are likely to be no obstructions ahead and below.


In general, a pusher installation, since it is often located aft of the
2. The installation is likely not to be as noisy as a tractor installation.
trailing edge of the wing, will also be located aft of the center of gravity
3. The pusher installation is likely to offer less aerodynamic inter-

of the airplane. Cargo and passenger items, then, are usually situated
ahead of the engine in order to get the proper location of the center of
ference to the wing, therefore enabling the wing to be more efficient.

4. With the power plant aft of the center of gravity, a longer fuselage

may be possible to house personnel and equipment since the power plant gravity of the airplane in relation to the mean aerodynamic chord.
represents a relatively heavy concentration of weight.

Figure XV-7. The pusher propeller may cause a higher location of the power plant
Some of the advantages of the pusher installation are:
in order to allow for propeller-tip clearance in the three-point landing attitude.
1. Passe:igers and crew obtain unimpeded vision forward since there
are likely to be no obstructions ahead and below.
2. The installation is likely not to be as noisy as a tractor installation.
:.3. The pusher installation is likely to offer less aerodynamic inter-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ference to the wing, therefore enabling the wing to be more efficient.


4. With the power plant aft of the center of gravity, a longer fuselage
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

may be possible to house personnel and equipment since the power plant
represents a relatively heavy concentration of weight.

Ground line for


level landing

FIGURE XV-7. The pusher propeller may ca.use a. higher location of the power plant
in order to allow for propeller-tip clearance in the three-point landing attitude.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PROPELLER 253
THE PROPELLER

253

Against these advantages, the following disadvantages should be


Against these advantages, the following disadvantages should be
considered:
considered :
1. Propeller clearance with the ground may necessitate a higher landing

1. Propeller clearance with the ground may necessitate a· higher landing


gear or a higher location for the power plant since the three-point landing

attitude will govern the location of the propeller.


gear or a higher location for the power plant since the three-point landing
2. The propeller may be badly blanketed by the engine. See Figure attitude will govern the location of the propeller.
XV-7.

2. The propeller may be badly blanketed by the engine. See Figure


XV-7.
3. Doors and escape hatches may be located in the rear. In an emer-

gency exit in flight, such a location is considered to have an unfavorable

psychological effect as it may cause the people emerging to fear that they

3. Doors and escape hatches may be located in the rear. In an emer-


may fall into the propeller.

4. A power plant behind the passengers is considered psychologically


gency exit in flight, such a location is considered to have an unfavorable
unsound since passengers may fear that the heavy engines will crash in psychological effect as it may cause the people emerging to fear that they
on them in case of a bad landing.

may fall into the propeller.


5. The structure needed to absorb the energy caused in a crash by a

pusher installation may have to be sturdier than the structure needed


4. A power plant behind the passengers is considered psychologically
to absorb the energy of the cargo and crew in a tractor installation, where

unsound since passengers may fear that the heavy engines will crash in
there is no structure ahead of the power plant.

6. The pusher installation, especially for a single-engine design, is


on them in case of a bad landing.
likely to complicate the tail structure since booms may be required to 5. The structure needed to absorb the energy caused in a crash by a
carry the tail surfaces and to protect the passengers from walking into

the propeller when embarking.


pusher installation may have to be sturdier than the structure needed
TAIL INSTALLATION
to absorb the energy of the cargo and crew in a tractor installation, where
Desgins have been proposed and built with the propeller located di-

there is no structure ahead of the power plant.


6. The pusher installation, especially for a single-engine design, is
rectly aft of the tail surfaces and operating as a pusher. The engine is

connected to the propeller by an extended shaft.

In order to protect the propeller in landing, the vertical tail surfaces likely to complicate the tail structure since booms may be required to
are located below instead of above the horizontal tail surfaces, and

usually the tail wheel is attached to the rudder post.


carry the tail surfaces and to protect the passengers from walking into
Since the air is rotated with the propeller, the air hitting the vertical
the propeller when embarking.
tail surfaces on one side below the longitudinal axis of the airplane will

produce an aerodynamic torque or rolling moment which will, to some

TAIL INSTALLATION
degree, offset the engine torque.

In an installation of this kind, more than in the normal tractor installa-

tion, the gyroscopic couple may play an important part in the handling

Desgins have been proposed and built with the propeller located di-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

rectly aft of the tail surfaces and operating as a pusher. The engine is
behavior of the airplane in a turn. In any case, the moment of inertia

of the airplane about the vertical axis will be materially changed, so that

connected to the propeller by an extended shaft.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the response of the airplane may not be quite as quick as in the conven-

ventional designs.

Both the engine torque and the gyroscopic effects can be overcome by
In order to protect the propeller in landing, the vertical tail surfaces
the dual-rotating propeller.
are located below instead of above the horizontal tail surfaces, and
usually the tail wheel is attached to the rudder post.
Since the air is rotated with the propeller, the air hitting the vertical
tail surfaces on one side below the longitudinal axis of the airplane will
produce an aerodynamic torque or rolling moment which will, to some
degree, offset the engine torque.
In an installation of this kind, more than in the normal tractor installa-
tion, the gyroscopic couple may play an important part in the handling
behavior of the airplane in a turn. In any case, the moment of inertia
of the airplane about the vertical axis will be materially changed, so that
the response of the airplane may not be quite as quick as in the conven-
ventional designs.
Both the engine torque and the gyroscopic effects can be overcome by
the dual-rotating propeller.

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
254 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
254

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

SPINNERS AND CUFFS


SPINNERS AND CUFFS

To streamline the propeller hub into the engine nacelle, a nose spinner
To streamline the propeller hub into the engine nacelle, a nose spinner
is designed to conform with the contour of the nacelle. The maximum
is designed to conform with the contour of the nacelle. The maximum
diameter of these spinners (generally located at the base of the spinning

cone) should not extend beyond the aerodynamically inoperative blade


diameter of these spinners (generally located at the base of the spinning
shank. cone) should not extend beyond the aerodynamically inoperative blade
In addition to spinners, cuffs of an airfoil cross section are designed to

shank.
cover the shank of the propeller blades. The propeller blades, especially

those that are removable from the propeller hub, end in round shanks
In addition to spinners, cuffs of an airfoil cross section are designed to
at the root. These cuffs help to increase the thrust of the propeller and

cover the shank of the propeller blades. The propeller blades, especially
improve the airflow in the region of the propeller hub. Since the aero-

dynamic loads and centrifugal forces on these cuffs are not appreciable,
those that are removable from the propeller hub, end in round shanks
they may be formed from sheet metal of suitable thickness. at the root. These cuffs help to increase the thrust of the propeller and
Table XV-3. Propeller spinners.

improve the airflow in the region of the propeller hub. Since the aero-
Dime

asions
dynamic loads and centrifugal forces on these cuffs are not appreciable,
Manufacturer
they may be formed from sheet metal of suitable thickness.
Number

Weight (lb)*

01 d Jacies

Diameter TABLE XV-3. Propeller spinners.


Length

Curtiss

Dimensions
4

Manufacturer Number Weight (lb)*


21%

of blades Diameter Length


29%

21.5

3
Curtiss .... ... ........ · I 4 21% 297' 21.5
21%
Curtiss ..... .. ......... 3 24% 25o/i6 23.0
25Vâ„¢
Curt~ss .. ... .. . .... .. . .1
3 24% 25~~ 18.5
23.0
Curtiss ...... . ... . . ... . , 3 24.Ys 25~ 22.0
3 Curtiss . .. ..... .. . ..... 3 24~ 28~ 25.5
24% Curtiss ...... .. .. . .... . 3 30.Ys 24H6 27.0
25%
Hamilton .... .... ..... . 3 23% 23% 21.0
18.5
Hamilton ...... ..... ... 2 16 15 16.0
Hamilton . ...... . ...... 2 16 20 17.5
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

24%
Aero Products . . . .. . ... . 3 23Y. 14" 24.5
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

25%

= 1 to
22.0

Curtiss
• On basis of per inch of diameter 1.25 lb.
3

24%

28%
PROPELLER SELECTION
25.5
In selecting a propeller, the maximum speed as well as the rated horse-
Curtiss

3
power at normal revolutions per minute are the usual design conditions.
30%
Since at maximum speed the thrust horsepower of the engine-propeller
24K-

unit equals the horsepower required in horizontal flight, and since


27.0

3
thp,,.a., = bhpma.z X '11maz
2Z%

23# where thp,,,,u. is the maximum thrust horsepower,


21.0

bhp,,,a., is the normal brake horsepower of the engine at rated revo-


lutions per minute,
2

16

15
'Tlmaz is maximum efficiency of the propeller,
16.0

2
it is easy, by means of a few trials, to determine the required propeller
16
diameter.
20

17.5

23K

Original from
14%

24.5
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
* On basis of per inch of diameter = 1 to 1.25 lb.

PROPELLER SELECTION

In selecting a propeller, the maximum speed as well as the rated horse-


THE PROPELLER 255
THE PROPELLER

255

1000

1000
800

I
0 600

Trial 2
«

~
800 Trial 1,

~
1 400

200
._
G)

~ 600
Trial 2

Trial l<

\t

~ /11
|j
0
:::c: 400 J !I
/
p !j

0 40 80 120 160 200 240


1'
Airplane speed, miles per hour

200 / 1'1 I
Figure XV-8. The proper selection of a propeller requires a number of trial and

error calculations to determine the point at which horsepower available is equal to the

- ~ v • I 1·
horsepower required.
11
Example. The horsepower required for corresponding speeds has been 0 11
calculated for a given design and plotted as shown in Figure XV-8. The
0 40 80 120 160 200 240
engine chosen will deliver 850 horsepower at 2450 revolutions per minute Airplane speed, miles per hour
(crankshaft speed) at sea-level conditions. The propeller is geared at

3 to 2 ratio, so that the propeller speed is % of the crankshaft speed, or

FIGURE XV-8. The proper selection of a propeller requires a number of trial and
will rotate at 1634 revolutions per minute. The brake horsepower is

error calculations to determine the point at which horsepower available is equal to the
given for the geared engine so that it is unnecessary to allow for the 2 or 3

horsepower required.
per cent reduction in power due to gearing.

First, assume propeller efficiency at maximum speed equals 80 per cent.

This gives a thrust horsepower of 850 X ^0,8 = 680 horsepower. For a

required horsepower of 680, the speed in horizontal flight would be 222


Example. The horsepower required for corresponding speeds has been
miles per hour at sea level.
calculated for a given design and plotted as shown in Figure XV-8. The
Next, the value of C, for the propeller is calculated. It is a convenient

engine chosen will deliver 850 horsepower at 2450 revolutions per minute
(crankshaft speed) at sea-level conditions. The propeller is geared at
"speed-power coefficient" which is used in an equation not involving the

propeller diameter.

= 2.14 Vmph </-


3 to 2 ratio, so that the propeller speed is % of the crankshaft speed, or
°' (bhp)1'6 (Nrpm)116 P0

0
will rotate at 1634 revolutions per minute. The brake horsepower is
given for the geared engine so that it is unnecessary to allow for the 2 or 3
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

For the conditions set forth:

c'= (^Zm^^^^ = °00008611F-*0

per cent reduction in power due to gearing.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

First, assume propeller efficiency at maximum speed equals 80 per cent.


0

For 222 miles per hour:

C. = 1.91. This gives a thrust horsepower of 850 X .,Q.8 = 680 horsepower. For a
required horsepower of 680, the speed in horizontal flight would be 222
miles per hour at sea level.
Next, the value of C, for the propeller is calculated. It is a convenient
"speed-power coefficient" which is used in an equation not involving the
propeller diameter.
c 2.14 v"'"" .y;-
• = (bhp)li6 (Nr,,...)216 p.
For the conditions set forth:

c. = (8:0~~6 \~6a~)2/6 V'0.002378 = 0.008611 v mpl·

For 222 miles per hour:


c. = 1.91.

Original from
D I IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
256 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

The corresponding maximum efficiency as obtained from Figure XV-9


is 86 per cent, indicating that our initial assumption of 80 per cent for the
propeller efficiency was somewhat low. After a few more trials the effi-
ciency of 86 per cent seems to give the closest results and the correspond-
ing high speed is 227 miles per hour.
When exact agreement has been obtained in the assumed and extrapo-
lated values for the propeller efficiency, it is then possible to calculate the
correct propeller diameter.
Referring to Figure XV- 9 (point A represents C. = 1.95), project a
line upwards until it intersects the dotted line marked "line of maximum
efficiency for given C," at point B; then project a line at right angles toward
the right until it intersects the scale for V /nD at point C. The value of

.,.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

08 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1. 8 2 .0


Calculated 5 c

FIGURE XV-9. Typical propeller characteristics. Blade angles for 75% of the
radius are indicated.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE PROPELLER 257
THE PROPELLER

257

V/nD at point C is 1.18. Since V and n are known, the diameter of the
V /nD at point C is 1.18. Since V and n are known, the diameter of the
propeller, D, may be solved for as follows:
propeller, D, may be solved for as follows:
v (227 x 1.467)
X 1 io (227 X 1.467)

nD = 1.l8 =
nD (1634/60)2>'

where D = 10.35 feet (say, 10 feet, 6 inches). The blade angle at 75 per
(1634/60)D '
cent of the radius is about 30 degrees.

The critical propeller-tip speed is about 1000 feet per second and it
where D = 10.35 feet (say, 10 feet, 6 inches). The blade angle at 75 per
should not be exceeded if serious reduction in propeller efficiency is to be

cent of the radius is about 30 degrees.


The critical propeller-tip speed is about 1000 feet per second a.nd it
avoided. The critical propeller-tip speed, Vc, may be calculated from

the following formula: & - 6 lf"

v. - VC^r25)' + ^
should not be exceeded if serious reduction in propeller efficiency is to be
For the propeller diameter just calculated Ve becomes equal to

- (1000^1634) 2 + (227 X 1.467)2 = 960 feet per second.


avoided. The critical propeller-tip speed, Ve, may be calculated from
The propeller should, therefore, give excellent performance at sea-level
the following formula: ;'; - t 'i

~(.- ~~-)' + (V)'. s';'.~,


conditions. If best cruising speed is desired at another altitude, say that

V, = ':'""":
to which the engine is supercharged, then the corresponding values of

brake horsepower and air density must be substituted in the equation


c

For the propeller diameter just calculated Ve becomes equal to


given for calculating the value of the power coefficient C,.

Figure XV-9 represents propeller characteristics when the propeller

"J'[7r (10.5)(1634)]
is placed in front of a cowled radial engine located in the leading edge of a

2
moderately thick wing. These characteristics depend upon obstructions

in the propeller slipstream. If more accurate values for efficiency and


60 + (227 X 1.467) 2 = 960 feet per second.
blade angles are desired, pertinent NACA reports should be consulted.

If a 2-bladed propeller has too large a diameter so that the tip speed is

The propeller should, therefore, give excellent performance at sea-level


conditions. If best cruising speed is desired at another altitude, say that
too high, or there is insufficient ground clearance, or other factors prevail-

ing which make it necessary to choose a smaller diameter, a 3-bladed pro-

peller may be required. to which the engine is supercharged, then the corresponding values of
For the conditions set forth, again assuming an initial efficiency of 80

per cent:
brake horsepower and air density must be substituted in the equation
c- - (mi%w»*°^* = °000086Fp.
given for calculating the value of the power coefficient C•.
For 222 miles per hour:

C, = 1.91.
Figure XV-9 represents propeller chara.cteristics when the propeller
The corresponding maximum efficiency as found before was 86 per cent.

is placed in front of a cowled radial engine located in the leading edge of a


moderately thick wing. These characteristics depend upon obstructions
This efficiency is for a 2-bladed propeller whereas a 3-bladed propeller is

to be used, the maximum efficiency of which would be reduced from 86 to

in the propeller slipstream. If more accurate values for efficiency and


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

83 per cent, which is still higher than initially assumed.

blade angles are desired, pertinent NACA reports should be consulted.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

If a 2-bladed propeller has too large a diameter so that the tip speed is
too high, or there is insufficient ground clearance, or other factors prevail-
ing which make it necessary to choose a smaller diameter, a 3-bladed pro-
peller may be required.
For the conditions set forth, again assuming an initial efficiency of 80
per cent:

C, = (8:0 ~i6 ~~63~) 215 V'0.002378 = 0.0086V.

For 222 miles per hour:


c. = 1.91.
The corresponding maximum efficiency as found before was 86 per cent.
This efficiency is for a 2-blad~d propeller whereas a 3-blade~ propeller is
to be used, the maximum efficiency of which would be reduced from 86 to
83 per cent, which is still higher than initially assumed.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
258 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
258

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


After successive trials, it is found that maximum speed is closer to 224
After successive trials, it is found that maximum speed is closer to 224

miles an hour, for which the value of C, = 1.92, and the propeller efficiency
miles an hour, for which the value of C. = 1.92, and the propeller efficiency
for a 2-bladed propeller is about 86 per cent, or 83 per cent for a 3-bladed
for a 2-bladed propeller is about 86 per cent, or 83 per cent for a 3-bladed
propeller.

propeller.
For this value of C., the corresponding V /nD, determined as before, is
For this value of C„ the corresponding V/nD, determined as before, is

1.15:

V— _ 224 X 100467


1.15:
v 224 x 1.467
nD ~ (1634/60)Z)'

/ evaluating D = 10.47 (say, 10 feet, 6 inches). The blade angle at 75

/ per cent of the radius is approximately 29.5 degrees. Again this value
nD = l.l5 = (1634/60)D'
\ is for a 2-bladed propeller since all values have been based upon those

) obtained from Figure XV-9, which is for a 2-bladed propeller. However,

i these same values may be used, and the diameter so found may be re- / evaluating D = 10.47 (say, 10 feet, 6 inches). The blade angle at 75
duced 7 per cent to obtain the corresponding diameter of a 3-bladed

propeller, if pertinent data for a 3-bladed propeller is not at hand. The


/ per cent of the radius is approximately 29.5 degrees. Again this value
diameter of the 3-bladed propeller is then 10.5 feet less 7 per cent, or 9 feet
\ is for a 2-bladed propeller since all values have been based upon those
1^ 9 inches, roughly.

) obtained from Figure XV-9, which is for a 2-bladed propeller. However,


Alternative Method of Determining Propeller Diameter. The diameter

required for the 2-bladed propeller may be calculated directly by means


f these same values may be used, and the diameter so found may be re-
of the formula: duced 7 per cent to obtain the corresponding diameter of a a-bladed
propeller diameter

For the example cited:


propeller, if pertinent data for a 3-blade<l propeller is not at hand. The
The same formula may be used to calculate the 3-bladed propeller by
diameter of the 3-bladed propeller is then 10.5 feet less 7 per cent, or 9 feet
using only 70 per cent of the value for the brake horsepower in the formula.

\ 9 inches, roughly.
EMPIRICAL FORMULAS

'
Various empirical formulas may be devised, based on various parameters,
Alternative Method of Determining Propeller Diameter. The diameter
for the determination of propeller diameters. In all cases, D is the di-

ameter in feet, P is the rated horsepower, V is the maximum speed in


required for the 2-bladed propeller may be calculated directly by means
miles per hour, and N is the number of revolutions per minute of the of the formula:
propeller.

K = 67 for a two-bladed propeller,

K = 47 for a three-bladed propeller.


.
propeller diameter 67 X
= _,r
V p
~BHP
-V X
m;;la
J*-N
-
r].m
·

For the example cited:


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

67 4/850 11
D = V'0.002378 X '\)224 X '\)1634 = 10.45 feet.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The same formula may be used to calculate the 3-bladed propeller by


using only 70 per cent of the value for the brake horsepower in the formula.

EMPIRICAL FORMULAS
Various empirical formulas may be devised, based on various parameters,
for the determination of propeller diameters. In all cases, D is the di-
ameter in feet, P is the rated horsepower, V is the maximum speed in
milP.s per hour, and N is the number of revolutions per minute of the
propeller.

1.

K = 67 for a two-bladed propeller,


K = 47 for a three-bladed propeller.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PROPELLER 259
THE PROPELLER 1 1 1

_l I Z-i I I L

+u~nonk
0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3

*
Airplane Mach number

Figure XV-10. Propellers for turboprop engines.

2. For a single- or twin-engine design:

*
2 blades.

3. For a 4-engine design:

3 blades.
I single rotation
40 0 ° = V(l^) (OTo) Xl^)'

A
2 or 3 blades.

Tronoonk
dual rotation
A—

1
Figure XV-11. Typical propeller-blade shapes for high-speed applications.

Suboonk

1
I
Subsonic
single rotation
l
dual rotation

0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3


Airplane Mach number

FIGURE XV-10. Propellers for turboprop engines.

2. For a single- or twin-engine design:


4 {P
D = 6.67 '\}v'
2 blades.

:3. For a 4-engine design:


1-
U.4'\}~'
4
D =

3 blades.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

4.
~ or 3 blades.

,' '
,.,
,

Fm URE XV- 11. Typical propeller-blade shapes for high-speed applications.

Original from
D I IZ
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
260 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
260

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

100 h

Figure XV-12. Variation of the propulsive efficiency of a propeller with airplane

100
Mach number. Further reductions for the various Mach numbers may be expected due

90
to installation, number of blades, and other possible variations.

5. For horsepowers between 2,000 and 0,000:

K = 11.5 for 3-bladed propeller,

K = 9.5 for 4-bladed propeller,


80
K = 8.0 for G-bladed propeller.

»-«(V£)(Vi>
70
For wooden propellers:

K = 48 for 2 blades,
600 2
K = 51 for 3 blades,

K = 49 for 4 blades.

FIGURE XV-12. Variation of the propulsive efficiency of a propeller with airplane


For metal propellers:

Mach number. Further reductions for the various Mach numbers may be expected due
K = (34 for 2 blades,

K = 01 for 3 blades,
to installation, number of blades, and other possible variations.
X = 57 for 4 blades.

5. For horsepowen; between 2,000 an<l U,000:


7. For horsepowers up to 3,000:

D = 480

2 or 3 blades.

K = I 1.5 for :3-bladed propeller,


K = H.•5 for 4-bladed propeller,
K = 8.0 for ti-bladed propeller.

().

For wooden propeller:-;:


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

K = -18 for 2 blade:-;,


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

K = 51 for:{ blades,
K = 49 for 4 blades.
For metal propellers:
K = li4 for 2 bla<les,
K = (i I for :~ blades,
K = 57 for 4 blades.

7. For hori:mpowers up to :~ 1 000:


480
D = (- n3)11s -,
p + :H
2 or 3 blades.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE PROPELLER 261
THE PROPELLER

261 TABJ.E XV-4. Propeller data.


Table XV-4. Propeller data.

Num-

Maxi-

Num- Maxi- Maxi-


Maxi-

Material her Diameter mum mum Weight


Material

of blades of Pitch in inches hp rpm in


ber

blades rating rating pounds


Diameter

mum

1. Wood 2 Fixed 63 40 2800 6


mum

2. Wood 2 Adjustable 84 50 14
84 54 41
Weight

of blades
3. Al. Alloy 2 Adjustable
of
4. Wood 2 Fixed 70 65 2800 10
Pitch
5. Wood 2 Fixed 70 75 2600 9
in inches
6. Wood & Plastic 2 Variable 85 76 2800 25
hp
7. Wood 2 Fixed 72 90 2700 11
rpm
8. Wood 2 Adjustable 96 100 21
in 9. Al. Alloy 2 Adjustable 86 100 52
blades 10. Al. Alloy 2 Fixed 68 108 2600 21
rating
11. Al. Alloy 2 Fixed 76 115 2800 28
rating
12. Wood 2 Adjustable 80 125 2700 16
pounds
13. Plastic 2 Adjustable 72 145 2700 17
1. Wood

14. Wood 2 Fixed 76 150 2600 13


2

15. Al. Alloy 2 Fixed 72 165 2800 32


Fixed

16. Wood 2 Adjustable 90 185 2700 28


63

17. Wood 2 Fixed 86 200 2450 18


40

18. Fabric Plastic 2 Controllable 86 215 2600 62


2800

19. Al. & Plastic 2 Controllable 84 21.5 2600 62


6

20. Wood 2 Adjustable 108 275 2700 35


2. Wood

21. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 78 to 108 350 2450


108 525 1950 108
2

Adjustable
22. Wood 2 Fixed
84
23. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 00 550 2300 175
50
24. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 90 to 1:32 550 2300
14
25. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 168 600 208
3. Al. Allov
26. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 96 650 2300 182
27. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 108 650 2200 196
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Adjustable 28. Al. Alloy 2 Controllable 120 750 1560 188


2!J. Al. Alloy :3 Controllable 132 800 320
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

84

54
30. Steel 3 Controllable 120 1200 1667 :330
41
31. Steel 3 Controllable 144 1500 1350 365
4. Wood
32. Al. Alloy 3 Controllable 145 1600 1500 37:3
2
3:3, Al. Alloy 3 Controllable 139 1600 1500 367
Fixed

34. Al. Alloy 3 Controllahle 102 to 180 1625 2100


70

35. AL Alloy :3 Controllable 151 1800 1520 397


65

36. Al. Alloy ;3 Controllable 151 1800 1520 394


2800

37. Al. Alloy 4 Controllable 139 1800 1350 458


10

38. Al. Alloy 4 Controllable 139 1800 1350 454


5. Wood

39. Al. Alloy 4 Controllable 138to156 1900 1341


2

40. Hollow Steel 3 Variable 133 2000 1260 423


Fixed

41. Hollow Steel :3 Variable 157 2000 1260 45;3


1470 ;394
70

75
42. Hollow Steel 3 Variable 1:33 2000
2600
43. Hollow Steel :3 Variable 157 2000 1470 376
9
44. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 134 2000 1470 472
6. Wood &Plastic
45. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 158 2000 1470 534
2
46. llollow Steel 3 Variable 133 2100 1470 377
Variable
47. Hollow Steel :3 Variable 157 2100 1470 ;395
85 48. Al. Alloy 4 Controllable 151 2300 1520 490
76

(Continued).
2800

25

7. Wood

Original from
Fixed

72
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
90

2700

11
262 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
262

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

TABLE XV-4. (Continued). Propeller data.


Table XV-4. (Continued). Propeller data.

Num-

Maxi-
Num- Maxi- Maxi-
Maxi-
Material ber DiametA!r mum mum Weight
Material
of blades of Pitch in inches hp rpm in
ber
blade11 rating rating pounds
Diameter

49. Al. Alloy 4 Controllable 2300 1520 494


mum

mum
151
Weight
50. Steel 3 Controllable 150 to 181 2500 1225
of blades
51. Al. Alloy 3 Controllable 114 to 180 2500 1430
of
52. Al. Alloy 6 Dual-rotation 157 2700 1400 757
Pitch
53. Al. Alloy 6 Dual-rotation 144 2700 1400 712
in inches
54. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 134 2800 1470 485
hp
55. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 158 2800 1470 509
rpm
56. Steel 4 Controllable 150 to 198 2800 960
in 57. Hollow Steel 3 Variable 156 3500 1260 611
blades 58. Hollow Steel 3 Variable 180 3500 1260 634
rating
59. Hollow Steel 3 Variable 192 3500 1225 678
rating
60. Hollow Steel 3 Variable 228 3500 1225 700
pounds
61. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 158 3500 1150 796
49. Al. Alloy

62. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 182 3500 1150 830


4

63. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 200 4300 976


Controllable

64. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 228 4300 1476


151

65. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 180 5000 916


2300

66. Hollow Steel 4 Variable 2'28 9000 800 1400


1520

67. Hollow Steel 8 Dual-rotation 228 10,000 2250


68. Hollow Steel 700 2560
494

50. Steel
8 Dual-rotation 216 15,000
3

Controllable

150 to 181

2500

1225

51. Al. Alloy


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Controllable
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

114 to 180

2500

1430

52. Al. Alloy

(i

Dual-rotation

157

2700

1400

757

53. Al. Alloy

Dual-rotation

144

2700

1400

712

54. Hollow Steel

Variable

134

2800

1470

485

55. Hollow Steel

Original from
Variable

Dig iz b
158
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
2800

1470

509
CHAPTER XVI

The Power Plant

The power plant consists of the engine, propeller, starting system, cool-

ing system, fuel and oil systems, cowling, engine mount, and miscellaneous

accessories. Each item requires a considerable amount of design study, for

the ultimate success of the airplane depends upon the proper selection and

proper functioning of every part of the power plant.

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
CHAPTER XVI
Suppose an engine is to be selected. There are air-cooled and liquid-

cooled engines, either radial or in-line, or inverted in-line, or Vee, as well

as a few others. If the horsepower required is rather large, the elimination

of a few types may be possible since there may be engines having a partic-

ular cylinder arrangement that do not develop the required horsepower.

Again, the air-cooled type may be preferred to a liquid-cooled type due to


The Power Plant
less complications in the installation since no cooling system is required

for the former, yet the liquid-cooled engine may be preferred for its lesser

frontal area or greater reliability. The line of demarcation in considering

the advantages between air-cooled and liquid-cooled engines may be fine,

and one cannot say arbitrarily that one engine is better than the other

until all the facts have been considered.

The different possible arrangements of engines are to be considered also,

so that a complete book instead of this short chapter could be written on


The power plant consists of the engine, propeller, starting system, cool-
the power plant alone. The engines may be tractors or pushers; that is,

they may be placed with the propeller in front of the engine, meeting the
ing system, fuel and oil systems, cowling, engine mount, and miscellaneous
air before the engine; or the propeller may be placed behind the engine.
accessories. Each item requires a considerable amount of design study, for
Such arrangements are sometimes desired for compactness and, as in the

the ultimate success of the airplane depends upon the proper selection and
proper functioning of every part of the power plant.
case of tailless airplanes, to obtain a center of gravity location reasonably

far back and relative to the fuselage length.

There are also tandem arrangements, or combinations of tractor and

pusher arrangements. These are to be considered especially when the GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
Suppose an engine is to be selected. There are air-cooled and liquid-
263

cooled engines, either radial or in-line, or inverted in-line, or Vee, as well


as a few others. If the horsepower required is rather large, the elimination
of a few types may be possible since there may be engines having a partic-
ular cylinder arrangement that do not develop the required horsepower.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Again, the air-cooled type may be preferred to a liquid-cooled type due to


less complications in the installation since no cooling system is required
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

for the former, yet the liquid-cooled engine may be preferred for its lesser
frontal area or greater reliability. The line of demarcation in considering
the advantages between air-cooled and liquid-cooled engines may be fine,
and one cannot say arbitrarily that one engine is better than the other
until all the facts have been considered.
The different possible arrangements of engines are to be considered also,
so that a complete book instead of this short chapter could be written on
the power plant alone. The engines may be tractors or pushers; that is,
they may be placed with the propeller in front of the engine, meeting the
air before the engine; or the propeller may be placed behind the engine.
Such arrangements are sometimes desired for compactness and, as in the
case of tailless airplanes, to obtain a center of gravity location reasonably
far back and relative to the fuselage length.
There are also tandem arrangements, or combinations of tractor and
pusher arrangements. These are to be considered especially when the
263

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
264 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
264

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


number of engines becomes so large that it may be desirable to concentrate
number of engines becomes so large that it may be desirable to concentrate

the engines as much as possible in order to reduce the length and complica-
tion of fuel, oil, and control lines.
the engines as much as possible in order to reduce the length and complica-

tion of fuel, oil, and control lines.

The selection of the engine and the arrangement of a group of engines by The selection of the engine and the arrangement of a group of engines by
no means ends the problem, for even the best engine cannot function prop-

erly unless attention has been paid to proper installation of the cooling
no means ends the problem, for even the best engine cannot function prop-
system (whether it be the NACA cowl for air-cooled engines, or radiators
erly unless attention has been paid to proper installation of the cooling
and pipe lines for liquid-cooled engines); to the correct installation of the

system (whether it be the NACA cowl for air-cooled engines, or radiators


and pipe lines for liquid-cooled engines); to the correct installation of the
fuel and oil systems with special reference to the size of pipes or tubing; to

the location of pumps and relief valves; and, to the numerous little items

that go to make up the whole. fuel and oil systems with special reference to the size of pipes or tubing; to
In the preceding paragraphs a brief survey of a few of the factors affect-

the location of pumps and relief valves; and, to the numerous little items
ing the power plant selection and design has been made. The following

material outlines the considerations to be taken into account in greater


that go to make up the whole.
detail.
In the preceding paragraphs a brief survey of a few of the factors affect-
LOCATION

.> To affect least the aerodynamic characteristics of the wing, it would be


ing the power plant selection and design has been made. The following
desirable to locate the nacelle below the wing. To reduce torsional loads material outlines the considerations to be taken into account in greater
imposed on the wing structure by the eccentric thrust-line position, it

detail.
would be desirable to locate the nacelle more or less with its axis in line

LOCATION
with the chord line. Usually, however, the governing condition for the

low-wing monoplane is the required propeller clearance with the ground.

For jet engines, the pod installation is preferred in this country. Since

. . . ._ To affect least the aerodynamic characteristics of the wing, it would be


desirable to locate the nacelle below the wing. To reduce torsional loads
the fuel is carried in the wing, the location of the jet pod below the wing

is a primary safety consideration. The torsional moment imposed on the

wing is desirable to offset the wash-out of the wing occurring at high


imposed on the wing structure by the eccentric thrust-line position, it
angles of attack and under accelerating conditions.

Unless the spar structure is cut away, the most rearward position usu-
would be desirable to locate the nacelle more or less with its axis in line
ally possible is to have the engine as close to the front face of the front
with the chord line. Usually, however, the governing condition for the
spar as clearances for accessories will permit.

low-wing monoplane is the required prope1ler clearance with the ground.


SUBMERGED ENGINES

Considerable attention has been devoted to enclosing engines within


For jet engines, the pod installation is preferred in this country. Since
the wing structure or within the fuselage. The chief reason for wanting

the fuel is carried in the wing, the location of the jet pod below the wing
is a primary safety consideration. The torsional moment imposed on the
to enclose the engine within the wing is aerodynamic. Although this

arrangement eliminates the engine nacelle, which interferes with the air-

wing is desirable to offset the wash-out of the wing occurring at high


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

flow around the wing, there is still the possibility of increased resistance

caused by ducts within the wing. For the propeller-type engine, this

angles of attack and under accelerating conditions.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

increased resistance may be partially offset by extending the propeller

shaft. Then, the propeller may work more efficiently because it is not
Unless the spar structure is cut away, the most rearward position usu-
operating directly in front of a thick body. Such extensions, however,

ally possible is to have the engine as close to the front face of the front
spar as clearances for accessories will permit.
have inherent disadvantages such as increased weight and vibration.

SUBMERGED ENGINES
Considerable attention has been devoted to enclosing engines within
the wing structure or within the fuselage. The chief reason for wanting
to enclose the engine within the wing is aerodynamic. Although this
arrangement eliminates the engine nacelle, which interferes with the air-
flow around the wing, there is still the possibility of increased resistance
caused by ducts within the wing. For the propeller-type engine, this
increased resistance may be partially offset by extending the propeller
shaft. Then, the propeller may work more efficiently because it is not
operating directly in front of a thick body. Such extensions, however,
have inherent disadvantages such as increased weight and vibration.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 265
THE POWER PLANT

265

Engines located within the fuselage permit the placing of the pilot ahead
of the engine, giving the best possible vision forward. It is also possible
Engines located within the fuselage permit the placing of the pilot ahead

of the engine, giving the best possible vision forward. It is also possible

to obtain a better structural arrangement and center of gravity location. to obtain a better structural arrangement and center of gravity location.
Adequate air intakes may be provided by means of ducts whose open-

ings are located just at the leading edge of the wing where their position Adequate air intakes may be provided by means of ducts whose open-
causes the least effect upon the aerodynamic qualities of the wing, espe-

ings are located just at the leading edge of the wing where their position
cially at very high speeds.

NUMBER OF ENGINES
causes the least effect upon the aerodynamic qualities of the wing, espe-
Assuming that a certain horsepower is required for a given design, should
cially at very high speeds.
this horsepower be provided by one or more engines? Obviously, it is

simpler and cheaper to have only one engine since there is only one set of

controls, one engine mount; in short, one installation and all that it entails.

NUMBER OF ENGINES
However, the one engine centrally located in the nose of the fuselage is a

source of undesirable noise, heat, and reduced vision. Moreover, in case

of engine failure due to any reason, the airplane must land immediately.

Assuming that a certain horsepower is required for a given design, should


The other alternatives are two, three, or four engines, so that in case of

one engine quitting, the flight may be continued, provided that this is pos-
this horsepower be provided by one or more engines? Obviously, it is
sible with the remaining engine or engines. simpler and cheaper to have only one engine since there is only one set of
If flight is to be maintained with one engine in a twin-engine design,

controls, one engine mount; in short, one installation and all that it entails.
there may be some penalty in allowable gross weight that the airplane

may carry because it is usually, although not always, difficult to maintain


However, the one engine centrally located in the nose of the fuselage is a
rectilinear flight when the thrust vectors are not symmetrical and espe-
source of undesirable noise, heat, and reduced vision. Moreover, in case
cially if the horsepower loading for the two engines is already initially

heavy. It may be possible to dump the fuel load in order to lighten the
of engine failure due to any reason, the airplane must land immediately.
load, but if the airplane is over rugged terrain it may not be advisable to The other alternatives are two, three, or four engines, so that in case of
do so since the required landing might be dangerous if attempted immedi-

one engine quitting, the flight may be continued, provided that this is pos-
sible with the remaining engine or engines.
ately (as the loss of fuel would dictate).

The three-engine design, then, has the advantage over the twin-engine

design in such a case, since, with one engine not operating, it is usually still
If flight is to be maintained with one engine in a twin-engine design,
possible to maintain rectilinear flight without loss of altitude with two

engines functioning. Moreover the power loading is increased only 50


there may be some penalty in allowable gross weight that the airplane
per cent instead of 100 per cent.
may carry because it is usually, although not always, difficult to maintain
The use of four or more engines may be necessary for large airplanes,

rectilinear flight when the thrust vectors are not symmetrical and espe-
cially if the horsepower loading for the two engines is already initially
especially when the number of large capacity engines is limited.

Opposed to the safety factor of multi-engine design in possible engine

heavy. It may be possible to dump the fuel load in order to lighten the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

failure it is to be remembered that multi-engines offer many more com-

plications and require at least one co-pilot, in addition to the chief pilot,

load, but if the airplane is over rugged terrain it may not be advisable to
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

to operate. In many cases, additional members are required in the crew

that is responsible for power plant operation.


do so since the required landing might be dangerous if attempted immedi-
In attempting to work out the best combination of engines from the

ately (as the loss of fuel would dictate).


The three-engine design, then, has the advantage over the twin-engine
point of view of maintaining flight with one or more engines not operating,

design in such a case, since, with one engine not operating, it is usually still
possible to maintain rectilinear flight without loss of altitude with two
engines functioning. Moreover the power loading is increased only 50
per cent instead of 100 per cent.
The use of four or more engines may be necessary for large airplanes,
especially when the number of large capacity engines is limited.
Opposed to the ·safety factor of multi-engine design in possible engine
failure it is to be remembered that multi-engines offer many more com-
plications and require at least one co-pilot, in addition to the chief pilot,
to operate. In many cases, additional members are required in the crew
that is responsible for power plant operation.
In attempting to work out the best combination of engines from the
point of view of maintaining flight with one or more engines not operating,

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
266 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
266

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


it is possible to arrive at a mathematical analysis by means of the prob-
it is possible to arrive at a mathematical analysis by means of the prob- ability theory. If the probability of any engine failure is independent of
ability theory. If the probability of any engine failure is independent of

any other and is the same for every engine (as would be likely when the
any other and is the same for every engine (as would be likely when the

engines have the same manufacturing and operating characteristics) then


engines have the same manufacturing and operating characteristics) then
the relative probability of 0, 1, 2 • • • failures is given by the successive
the relative probability of 0, 1, 2 · · · failures is given by the successive
terms of the binomial

terms of the binomial


(q + p)k,
(5 + P)\

where p = the probability of a failure,

q — 1 — p, where q is the probability that this failure will not occur,

k = the number of engines involved.


where p = the probability of a failure,
The value of p may be assumed if no data are available, or may be based
q = 1 - p, where q is the probability that this failure will not occur,
upon existing flight data, and may then be calculated as follows:

k = the number of engines involved.


P

/number of failures in annual number\ ,average j th of x


The value of p may be assumed if no data are available, or may be based
upon existing flight data, and may then be calculated as follows:
of miles flown H individual trips /

\ annual number of miles flown /

For example, if it is assumed that there were 10 single-engine failures in

1,000,000 miles flown and that the average trip length was 2,000 miles,
number of failur.es in annual number) (average length of)
then from these data.
P= ( of miles flown individual trips ·
'= (imm)2'000 = 002'
annual number of miles flown
q = l - p = l - 0.02 = 0.98.

An example will help to illustrate the calculation procedure and to inter-


For example, if it is assumed that there were 10 single-engine failures in
pret the algebraic terms involved: for a three-engine airplane, expanding

(q + p)8 yields q* + Zq2j>1 + 3 g'p2 + P30 0 Each term of the expanded


1,000,000 miles flown and that the average trip length was 2,000 miles,
binomial indicates the nonfailing and failing engine combination of the
then from these data.
(i,o~~ooo) 2,000 = 0.02,
three engines; for example, the exponent of q indicates the number of non-

failing engines of that combination and the exponent of p indicates the p =


number of failing engines in that combination. The term dqpp1 indicates

the number of failing and nonfailing combinations when any one of the
q =
1 - p = 1 - 0.02 = 0.98.
An example will help to illustrate the calculation procedure and to inter-
three engines may fail. The calculations for the three-engine design for

the values of p and q as determined, are tabulated in Table XVI-1.

Table XVI-1. pret the algebraic terms involved: for a three-engine airplane, expanding
1.

(q + p) 3 yields q3 + 3q2p 1 + 3 q1p 2 + p 3• Each term of the expanded


Term of binomial

q*
binomial indicates the nonfailing and failing engine combination of the
three engines; for example, the exponent of q indicates the number of non-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3?'p

2.

failing engines of that combination and the exponent of ·p indicates the


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Number of possible en-

gine failures number of failing engines in that combination. The term 3q2p1 indicates
0

the number of failing and nonfailing combinations when any one of the
1

2
three engines may fail. The ca.lculations for the three-engine design for
3
the values of p and q as determined, are tabulated in Table XVI-1.
3.

Number of no engine

XVl-1.
failures

TABLE
3

1
1. Term of binomial .. . . . . q3 3q2p 3qlp2 p3
0
2. Number of possible en-
4.
gine failures .. ... . . . 0 1 2 3
Evaluation of binomial
3. Number of no engine
term (Probability of failures .... .. . ... . . 3 2 l 0
number of no engine 4. Evaluation of binomial
failures indicated in term (Probability of
10,000 trips)
number of no engine
9,411.92 X 10-*
failures indicated in
576.24 X 10—<

10,000 trips) . ..... .. 9,411.92 x 10-' 576.24 x 10-4 11.76 x 10-• 0.08 x 10-•
11.76 X lO—4

- - - -
0.08 X 10-«

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
_- ... -- -·--·- .. ·

THE POWER PLANT 267


THE POWER PLANT

267
TABLE X Vl-2. Probable number of chances of failing and nonfailing engines in
Table XVI-2. Probable number of chances of failing and nonfailing engines in 10,000 trips.
10,000 trips.

Number of engine failures


Number of engine failures
of engines
Number
of engines 0 1 2 3 4 5
0
6
1

1 9,800 200 - - - - -
3

2 9,604 392 4 - - - -
4

3 9,412 576 12 (0) - - -


5

4 9,224 753 23 (0) (0) - -


6

5 9,039 922 38 1 (0) (0) -


1

6 8,858 1,085 55 2 (0) (0) (0)


9,800

200

2
From the calculations of possible engine failures it is possible to estimate
9,604

392
the possible number of successful flights if the flight of the airplane can be
4
maintaine<i. and controlled with one or more engines not operating. Refer
—

to Table XVI-3.
—

—
TABLE XVl-3. Probable total number of successful flights* in 10,000 trips.
—

3
With the following number of enginea not operating
9,412
Total
number 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
576

of engines
12
in aircraft
No. 3 No. 3 No. 3 No. 3 No. 3 No. 3 No. 3
(0)

--
- --- - - -
—

1 9,800 98.0 - - - - - - - - - - - -
—
2
3
9,604
9,412
96.0
94.1
9,992
9,988
99.92 -
99.88 (10,000) (100)
- -
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-- -- --
- - - - -
—

4 9,224 92.2 9,977 99.77 (10,000) (100) (10,000) (100) -


4

5 9,039 90.4 9 ,961 99.61 9,999 99.99 (10,000) (100) - - - - - -


9,224

6 8,858 88.6 9,943 99.43 9,998 99.98 (10,000) (100) (10,000) (100) - - - -
753

23

*Successful flight accomplished when rectilinear flight at a specific altitude can be maintained with
(0)
the number of enginea not operating as indicated.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

(0)

—

From these calculations, it will be evident that for the particular multi-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

engine combinations investigated, if flight is possible with one engine out


—

9,039
of commission, the number of successful flights is well over 99 per cent.
922

38
The percentage would still be high if the probability of engine failure were
1
greater than the value assumed.
(0)

(0) ENGINE RATING


—

6
The engine is not rated according to the maximum horsepower or thrust
8,858

it can develop under ideal conditions. Usually there are three commonly
1,085

55
accepted ratings.
'
2

(0)
1. Rated horsepower or thrust: a maximum rating for continuous
(0) operation.
(0)

2. Take-off rating: the horsepower or thrust that may be developed


From the calculations of possible engine failures it is possible to estimate

the possible number of successful nights if the flight of the airplane can be
for a short time without harmful effects.
maintained and controlled with one or more engines not operating. Refer
3. Emergency rating: the horsepo\ver or thrust that may be developed
to Table XVI-3.

Table XVI-3. Probable total number of successful nights* in 10,000 trips.


for continuous operation if one engine fails.
With the following number of engines not operating

number

Original from
2

3
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
i

6
268 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
268

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


These ratings may be for different altitudes for the same engine, depend-
These ratings may be for different altitudes for the same engine, depend-
ing upon the certain design characteristies.
ing upon the certain design characteristics.

ENGINE SELECTION
ENGINE SELECTION
Unless engines are specified in the original design specification, a study
Unless engines are specified in the original design specification, a study

of available engines should be made, keeping the following considerations

in mind for the propeller-type engine:


of available engines should be made, keeping the following considerations
1.

Horsepower range
in mind for the propeller-type engine:
9. 1. Horsepower range 9. Economy of fuel consump-
Economy of fuel consump-

2. Supercharged or not super- tion


2.

Supercharged or not super-


charged 10. Economy of oil consumption
tion
3. Critical altitudes of super- 11. Original cost
charged

10.
charged engine 12. Ease of maintenance
Economy of oil consumption 4. Normal revolutions per minute 13. Type of cylinder arrangement
3.

5. Propeller gearing 14. Over-all dimensions


6. Weight per horsepower
Critical altitudes of super-

11.
15. Method of cooling
Original cost
7. Dependability 16. Department of Commerce ap-
charged engine

12.
proval
Ease of maintenance
8. Durability 17. Availability
4.

Normal revolutions per minute


It is comparatively easy to determine the approximate maximum horse-
13.
power required on the basis of horsepower loading and the estimated gross
Type of cylinder arrangement

5.
weight of the airplane to be designed and built for the required horsepower
Propeller gearing
equals the ratio of gross weight to horsepower loading.
14.

Some of the considerations listed may be difficult to ascertain, especially


Over-all dimensions

6.
for the student, and may be safely disregarded. It is well to keep these
Weight per horsepower
various considerations in mind, however, for possible future use.
15.

Method of cooling
Similar com;iderations are applied in the selection of the jet-type engine.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

7.

ENGINE NACELLES
Dependability

In multi-engine design, the power plant is located in a nacelle attached


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

16.

Department of Commerce ap-

to the wing. The engine mount and engine cowling, installation of acces-
sories, and the like are the same as before. The nacelle construction is
proval

8.

Durability
similar to a shortened fuselage. The main attachment of the nacelle is to
17.

Availability
the front spar, with bracing or supports going back to the rear spar.
FUEL CONSUMPTION
It is comparatively easy to determine the approximate maximum horse-

power required on the basis of horsepower loading and the estimated gross

weight of the airplane to be designed and built for the required horsepower

The fuel consumption of an engine is one of the important criteria to


equals the ratio of gross weight to horsepower loading.

Some of the considerations listed may be difficult to ascertain, especially


consider in engine selection. Just from simple considerations alone, it is
for the student, and may be safely disregarded. It is well to keep these evident that the engine having the lowest fuel consumption would be the
various considerations in mind, however, for possible future use.

desirable one to select. One of the useful formulas, the so-called Breguet
Similar considerations are applied in the selection of the jet-type engine.

ENGINE NACELLES
formula, may be used to indicate the importance of fuel consumption in
In multi-engine design, the power plant is located in a nacelle attached
determining the range of an airplane. For the derivation of the formula
to the wing. The engine mount and engine cowling, installation of acces-

sories, and the like are the same as before. The nacelle construction is
see page 36.
similar to a shortened fuselage. The main attachment of the nacelle is to

the front spar, with bracing or supports going back to the rear spar.
R (range in miles) = 863 ~ ~ log1o ::,
FUEL CONSUMPTION

The fuel consumption of an engine is one of the important criteria to

consider in engine selection. Just from simple considerations alone, it is

evident that the engine having the lowest fuel consumption would be the

desirable one to select. One of the useful formulas, the so-called Breguet

Original from
formula, may be used to indicate the importance of fuel consumption in

determining the range of an airplane. For the derivation of the formula


Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
see page 36.

R (range in miles) = 863 If002 log,„ |P,

D c W,
THE POWER PLANT 269
THE POWER PLANT

269 where c = specific fuel consumption in pounds per brake horsepower


where c = specific fuel consumption in pounds per brake horsepower

per hour .
per hour.

Tj = propeller efficiency. (For pure jet-type engines, this term


.,, = propeller efficiency. (For pure jet-type engines, this term
disappears from the equation.)
disappears from the equation.)
L/D = lift-drag ratio of the complete airplane at speed V.

Wo = gross weight in pounds at start of flight.


L/ D = lift-drag ratio of the complete airplane at speed r.
We = W0 less oil and fuel weight.
Wo = gross weight in pounds at start of flight.
For long ranges, it would be necessary to employ a step-by-step integra-

tion using successive values for Wo and We, in order to obtain more ac-
W. = W o less oil and fuel weight.
curate results.

For long ranges, it would be necessary to employ a step-by-step integra-


tion using successive values for W o and W ,, in order to obtain more ae-
It is not always possible to so coordinate the aerodynamic characteristics

of the airplane and the best operating efficiency of the power plant.

It should be noted that any appreciable change in the fuel consumption curate results.
has a greater effect than a change in propeller efficiency. Thus, choosing

It is not always possible to so coordinate the aerodynamic characteristics


an engine with a low fuel consumption is highly desirable and more ef-

fective than trying to improve the propeller efficiency. These observa-


of the airplane and the best operating efficiency of the power plant.
tions apply to the non-propeller-type engine as well, as far as the fuel
It should be noted that any appreciable change in the fuel consumption
consumption is concerned.

The engine-mount supports virtually the entire power plant in the usual
has a greater effect than a change in propeller efficiency. Thus, choosing 1
case, although for engines of very large horsepower, the engine mount
an engine with a low fuel consumption is highly desirable and more ef- -; ;.\
proper does not extend more than a few inches beyond the rearmost acces-

fective than trying to improve the propeller efficiency. These observa-


sory. It is a better engineering design to use tubular steel supports which

may be enclosed with a suitable cowling because of the necessity of gaining


tions apply to the non-propeller-type engine as well, as far as the fuel
access to various parts of the engine and its accessories.
consumption is concerned.
Figure XVI-1. Engine mount for a radial engine of relatively low horsepower

capacity. The engine is attached to the ring by bolts through corresponding lugs on

engine mounting-plate and engine mount-ring.


ENGINE MOUNT-NON-JET ENGINES
ENGINE MOUNT—NON-JET ENGINES

The engine-mount supports virtually the entire power plant in the usual
I

i
case, although for engines of very large horsepower, the engine mount
proper does not extend more than a few inches beyond the rearmost acces-
sory. It is a better engineering design to use tubular steel supports which
may be enclosed with a suitable cowling because of the necessity of gaining
access to various parts of the engine and its accessories.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

--t--,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

/, I '\'
/ ' I ""''

FIGURE XVI-1. Engine mount for a radial engine of relatively low horsepower
capacity. The engine is attached to the ring by bolts through corresponding lugs on
engine mounting-plate and engine mount-ring.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
270 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
270

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVI-2. An engine mount for large-horsepower radial engine. A detail of

the rubber-type vibration mount is shown on the right.

Tubular steel is used customarily for the entire mount whether the air-

"' \ L
plane is to be reinforced monocoque or not. The sizes of the members are

determined by stress analysis, although lj^-in. or lj^-in. outside diameter

tubing for engines of horsepower between 500 to 1500 may be used for
' __ J
preliminary design until a stress analysis has been made.
\
The engine mount should be so constructed that the entire power plant,

including the oil-system cowling and manifold, may be readily detached \'
for replacement.

Figure XVI-3. Additional details of rubber mounts located at the points of attach- _\
ment of engine mount to the firewall frame station.

'
I
/

FIGURE XVl- 2. An engine mount for large-horsepower radial engine. A detail of


the rubber-type vibration mount is shown on the right.

Tubular steel is used customarily for the entire mount whether the air-
plane is to be reinforced monocoque or not. The sizes of the members are
determined by stress analysis, although lYs-in. or 17,4-in. outside diameter
tubing for engines of horsepower between 500 to 1500 may be used for
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

preliminary design until a stress analysis has been made.


The engine mount should be so constructed that the entire power plant,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

including the oil-system cowling and manifold, may be readily detached


for replacement.

..J
~Lii -~ ~
FIGURE XVl-3.
_J
I
I

L II __J
I
1

Lil
I

Additional details of rubber mounts located at the points of attach-


ment of engine mount to the firewall frame station.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
-
THE POWER PLANT 271

Fmmu: XVI-4. A suggested engine mount consillting or welded tubular structure


for an in-line engine.

Care should be taken that all members leading f:om the engine-mount-
ing ring to the firewall clear all accessories and permit easy access to all
necessary parts.
More and more attention is being paid to reduction of vibration trans-
mission. Rubber mounting of the engine on the engine mount and of the
engine mount to the fuselii.ge are the usual means of reducing the vibration.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

F10URE XVl-5. A forged engine mount for an in-line engine.

Original from
dbyGoogle UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
272 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

FIREWALL
1. The firewall is located as close to the engine as the removal of the
rearmost accessory located on the engine will permit.
2. No firewall need be provided when the engine is located in a separate
nacelle unless it is intended to locate fuel in the same nacelle.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. The firewall should isolate the engine compartment completely. All


openings required for cables, rods and the like should be fitted with close-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

fitting grommets or bushings. Control systems passing through the fire-


wall should be so designed that their motion is axial or rotational in order
to a.void large openings.
4. Any adjacent infla.mma.ble structural members should be protected
by asbestos or some equivalent insulating material.
5. Firewalls are made either of ferrous metal of suitable thickness, or
aluminum (or aluminum alloy) used for outside sheets of an asbestos sand-
wich. The following materials for the firewall are recommended.
(a) A single sheet of terne plate (70% tin plus 30% lead) not less
than 0.028 inch thick.
(b) A single sheet of stainless steel not less than 0.015 inch thick.
(c) A single sheet of aluminum alloy either 0.032 or 0.040 inch thick.
(d) Two sheets of aluminum or aluminum alloy not less than 0.02
inch thick fastened together with an asbestos paper or fabric
sheet at least Ys inch thick between them.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE POWER PLANT 273
THE POWER PLANT

_C_O l ____D
273

Figure XVI-8. A series of wind-tunnel tests on engine cowlings (see NACA TR

662) indicate that arrangement (2) is better than (1); (4) is better than (3).

6. It is important that the fire bulkhead fit closely to the cowling all

around the section of the fuselage.

COWLING (I) (2)


1. The type of cowl developed by the NACA for radial engines has met

with general favor by the industry. In designing the contours of any type

of engine cowling, special care should be exercised to avoid all abruptness

-E--- ff---
or reversal in curvature. A well-rounded contour will help effectively in

reducing parasite resistance. (See Figures XVI-8 and XVI-9.)

(8) (9)

Figure XVI-9. Tests indicated the exit slot of the cowling was too close to the

wing in (5), (7) was an improvement over the cowl in (6), and (9) was better than (8).

(See NACA TR 662.)

(3) (4)
FIGURE XVI-8. A series of wind-tunnel tests on engine cowlihgs (see NACA TR
662) indicate that arrangement (2) is better than (1); (4) is better than (3).

6. It is important that the fire bulkhead fit closely to the cowling all
around the section of the fuselage.
COWLING
1. The type of cowl developed by the NACA for radial engines has met
with general favor by the industry. In designing the contours of any type
of engine cowling, special care should be exercised to avoid all abruptness
or reversal in curvature. A well-rounded contour will help effectively in
reducing parasite resistance. (See Figures XVI-8 and XVI-9.)

( [[
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:30 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(5)

~--1 _IT_] (6) (7)

FIGURE
co (8)
[ ___
(9)
[]
XVl-9. Tests indicated the exit slot of the cowling was too close to the
wing in (.5), (7) was an improvement over the cowl in (6), and (9) was better than (8).
(See N ACA TR 662.)

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
274 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
274

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVI-10. A few governing dimensions are given in this illustration. Dimen-

sion A — 1 inch, B — 3 inches, C = 75 per cent of engine diameter (although 65% of

engine diameter may be permissible), D = 2 inches, and E = }4 inch.

2. The correct proportioning of the engine cowls depends much upon

I
the particular engine, engine nacelle, past experience, likely operating

conditions, etc.
t
I
I
c
3. Engine cowling should be fastened to the mount, and not to the
~'---.
fuselage, and in such a fashion that the major portion may be removed in

a few minutes for maintenance, inspection, and minor repairs. Refer to


--+------
rr-·"
Figures XVI-10, XVI-11, and XVI-12.
I
I
4. The cowling may be made of aluminum alloy 450, 2S or 52S, vary-
I
ing in thickness from 0.032 to 0.050 with the larger thickness usually re-
I
I
Figure XVI-12. This attachment of

Figure XVI-11. Attachment of engine cowling permits adjustment in

cowling to engine crankcase by means flight that may be necessary to keep cowl-

of a vibration mount whose cross sec- ing in alignment and to reduce excessive

tion is shown. stresses.

FIGURE XVI-10. A few governing dimensions are given in this illustration. Dimen-
sion A ... 1 inch, B = 3 inches, C = 75 per cent of engine die.meter (although 65% of
engine diameter may be permissible), D "" 2 inches, and E .. Y2 inch.

2. The correct proportioning of the engine cowls depends much upon


the particular engine, engine nacelle, past experience, likely operating
conditions, etc.
3. Engine cowling should be fastened to the mount, and not to the
fuselage, and in such a fashion that the major portion may be removed in
a few minutes for maintenance, inspection, and minor repairs. Refer to
Figures XVI-10, XVI-11, and XVI-12.
4. The cowling may be made of aluminum alloy 450, 28 or 528, vary-
ing in thickness from 0.032 to 0.050 with the larger thickness usually re-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:30 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVl-12. This attachment of


FIGURE XVI-11. Attachment of engine cowling permits adjustment in
cowling to engine crankcase by means flight that may be necessary to keep cowl-
of e. vibration mount whose cross sec- ing in alignment and to reduce excessive
tion is shown. stresses.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 275
THE POWER PLANT

275
served for the cowl ring proper and the smaller, or some intermediate thick-
served for the cowl ring proper and the smaller, or some intermediate thick-

ness, for the rest of the cowling.


ness, for the rest of the cowling.
5. The engine cowling should be suitably ventilated to prevent accu-
5. The engine cowling should be suitably ventilated to prevent accu-
mulation of gases. Refer to Figure XVI-13.

mulation of gases. Refer to Figure XVI-13.


Figure XVI-13. A typical cooling system for a horizontally opposed engine with

a wet sump oiling system.

6. All cowling around the power plant and on the engine side of the

firewall should be made of metal and so designed that any accumulations

of dirt, waste, or fuel may be observed without complete removal of the

cowling.

7. The cowling must fit tightly to the firewall, but openings may be

provided if the airplane surface within 15 inches is protected with metal

or other suitable material.

8. Unless small units of the cowling may be removed easily for inspec-

tion and repair purposes, it is desirable to provide properly secured, small

access doors in the cowling at suitable points.

9. The cowling should be completely drained in all attitudes of flight

and on the ground, with separate drains provided for the parts of the fuel

system liable to leakage.

10. All drains should be so located as to prevent fuel or oil from dripping

onto the exhaust manifold or any parts of the aircraft, or permeating any

cellular material.

11. Carburetor air intakes must open entirely outside of the cowling,

unless the emergence of back-fire flames is positively prevented. The air

intakes should be suitably drained.

FIGURE XVI-1~. A typical cooling system for a horizontally opposed engine with
a wet sump oiling system.

6. All cowling around the power plant and on the engine side of the
firewall should be made of metal and so designed that any accumulations
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:30 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

of dirt, waste, or fuel may be observed without complete removal of the


cowling.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

7. The cowling must fit tightly to the firewall, but openings may be
provided if the airplane surface within 15 inches is protected with metal
or other suitable material.
8. Unless small units of the cowling may be removed easily for inspec-
tion and repair purposes, it is desirable to provide properly secured, small
access doors in the cowling at suitable points.
9. The cowling should be completely drained in all attitudes of flight
and on the ground, with separate drains provided for the parts of the fuel
system liable to leakage.
10. All drains should be so located as to prevent fuel or oil from dripping
onto the exhaust manifold or any parts of the aircraft, or permeating any
cellular material.
11. Carburetor air intakes must open entirely outside of the cowling,
unless the emergence of back-fire flames is positively prevented. The air
intakes should be suitably drained.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
276 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

EXHAUST MANIFOLDS-RECIPROCATING ENGINES


276

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

EXHAUST MANIFOLDS—RECIPROCATING ENGINES

The exhaust manifold carries the exhaust gases of the cylinders to some
point outside of the power-plant section. Usually it is circular in cross
The exhaust manifold carries the exhaust gases of the cylinders to some

point outside of the power-plant section. Usually it is circular in cross

Figure XVI-14. A typical exhaust and induction system for a downdraft radial

engine.

section and, since the volume of exhaust gases increases as the number of

cylinders are added, it becomes necessary to vary the cross section of the

exhaust manifold so that the product of velocity times the pressure remains

constant.

An empirical formula for the design of exhaust manifold is given by

A = (0.04) (P) |,

where A = minimum cross-sectional area required for the section under

I'\-,
consideration,

P = maximum engine horsepower at which the engine may be

operated,

I,' \.I
I ;
n = number of cylinders exhausting into the manifold up to the

''-..:::.-_ ' - ----


section under consideration, and

AT = total number of engine cylinders.

The number of outlets varies; there may be one or two. It is possible also

to have individual outlets which are comparatively short but are0 0 also dan-
FIGURE XVl-14. A typical exhaust and induction system for a downdraft radial
gerous because the hot exhaust gases are not carried far enough away.

engine.
Manifolds with a single right-hand outlet with all gas flowing in a counter-

clockwise direction (that is, opposite to the engines firing order) are also
section and, since the volume of exhaust gases increases as the number of
used in the belief that back pressures are reduced.
cylinders are added, it becomes necessary to vary the cross section of the
The following considerations enter into the design and installation of

the exhaust manifolds:


exhaust manifold so that the product of velocity times the pressure remains
1. The exhaust manifolds, stacks, or collectors preferably should be
constant.
made of interchangeable sections, usually of 18-8 corrosion resisting steel

An empirical formula for the design of exhaust manifold is given by


(Iconel) or carbon steel. The wall thicknesses vary from 0.035 to 0.049

n
A = (0.04) (P) N'
where A = minimum cross-sectional area required for the section under
consideration,
P = maximum engine horsepower at which the engine may be
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:30 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

operated,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

n = number of cylinders exhausting into the manifold up to the


section under consideration, and
N = total number of engine cylinders.
The number of outlets varies; there may be one or two. It is possible also
to have individual outlets which are comparatively short but are. also dan-
gerous because the hot exhaust gases are not carried far enough away.
Manifolds with a single right-hand outlet with all gas flowing in a counter-
clockwise direction (that is, opposite to the engines firing order) are also
used in the belief that back pressures are reduced.
The following considerations enter into the design and installation of
the exhaust manifolds:
1. The exhaust manifolds, stacks, or collectors preferably should be
made of interchangeable sections, usually of 18-8 corrosion resisting steel
(lconel) or carbon steel. The wall thicknesses vary from 0.035 to 0.049

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 277
THE POWER PLANT

277
inch with the greater thickness reserved for high-powered engines, partic-
inch with the greater thickness reserved for high-powered engines, partic-

ularly those using high-octane fuel.


ularly those using high-octane fuel.
2. The diameters of the manifolds vary from 2 to 4 inches, and may be
2. The diameters of the manifolds vary from 2 to 4 inches, and may be
bent with an inside radius as small as 2 diameters, although a larger radius

bent with an inside radius as small as 2 diameters, although a larger radius


is customarily used for ease in fabrication as well as to reduce undesired
is customarily used for ease in fabrication as well as to reduce undesired

back pressures. The cross-sectional area of the exhaust manifolds should

gradually increase until the cross section at the last cylinder is at least 50 back pressures. The cross-sectional area of the exhaust manifolds should
per cent of the total exhaust-port area of the particular engine for which

gradually increase until the cross section at the last cylinder is at least 50
the manifold is being designed.

3. The "downwind" clearance of the open end of the exhaust pipe should
per cent of the total exhaust-port area of the particular engine for which
be at least 4 feet. Any exhaust pipe which is not exposed to the outside
the manifold is being designed.
air should be either water- or air-cooled by a special cooling system sur-

rounding the unexposed pipe.


3. The "downwind" clearance of the open end of the exhaust pipe should
4. The exhaust pipe should be kept at least 3 inches away from any in- be at least 4 feet. Any exhaust pipe which is not exposed to the outside
flammable part of the airplane, and the exhaust end should be at least 5

air should be either water- or air-cooled by a special cooling system sur-


inches away from any inflammable part.

5. Expansion joints should be provided for and such joints should be


rounding the unexposed pipe.
capable of articulation to a certain degree to permit changes not only in
4. The exhaust pipe should be kept at least 3 inches away from any in-
length but also in angle of alignment due to expansion.

6. Gases should be discharged clear of the airplane structure so that


flammable part of the airplane, and the exhaust end should be at least 5
they will not blow back on the carburetor air intake, the pilot or passen-
inches away from any inflammable part.
gers, nor cause a glare ahead of the pilot at night.

5. Expansion joints should be provided for and such joints should be


capable of articulation to a certain degree to permit changes not only in
CARBURETOR SCOOP DESIGN

Engine performance depends greatly upon the carburetor air-induction

system, especially those using the pressure-type carburetor. These often length but also in angle of alignment due to expansion.
incorporate a 90-degree elbow relatively close to the entrance flange of the

carburetor.
6. Gases should be discharged clear of the airplane structure so that
Figure XVI-15. Governing dimensions for an air scoop. The figure on the left
they will not blow back on the carburetor air intake, the pilot or passen-
shows an example of poor scoop design; the one on the right an improved scoop design.
gers, nor cause a glare ahead of the pilot at night.

CARBURETOR SCOOP DESIGN


Engine performance depends greatly upon the carburetor air-induction
system, especially those using the pressure-type carburetor. These often
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:31 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

incorporate a 90-degree elbow relatively close to the entrance flange of the


carburetor.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVl- 15. Governing dimensions for an air scoop. The figure on the left
shows an example of poor scoop design; the one on the right an improved scoop design.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
278 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
278

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Figure XVI-15 indicates both poor and good scoop design. The dimen-
Figure XVI-15 indicates both poor and good scoop design. The dimen- sions may be obtained from the following information:
sions may be obtained from the following information:

1. The length L of the straight portion of the pipe should be as long as

1. The length L of the straight portion of the pipe should be as long as


practical up to 4 diameters.
practical up to 4 diameters.

2. The radius r should be a minimum, preferably not over % inch and

may even be sharp.


2. The radius r should be a minimum, preferably not over % inch and
3. The radius R should be as large as possible, up to such a value that

R/D = 2 when r is greater than % inch.


may even be sharp.
4. The ratio of W/D should approach 6 as the upper limit, although
3. The radius R should be as large as possible, up to such a value that
generally it is more practical to keep W equal to the width of the carburetor

R/D = 2 when r is greater than % inch.


4. The ratio of W / D should approach 6 as the upper limit, although
flange. When the length L is comparatively short, good distribution can

be obtained by introducing vanes in the elbow to direct the flow.

FUEL SYSTEMS generally it is more practical to keep W equal to the width of the carburetor
The fuel system consists of tanks, piping exterior to the engine, pumps

not integral with the engine, strainers, gauges, pipe fittings, and valves
flange. When the length L is comparatively short, good distribution can
and cocks.
be obtained by introducing vanes in the elbow to direct the flow.
The primer is operated from the instrument panel board in the pilot's

cockpit. A shut-off cock is located in the primer line.

For starting the flow of fuel, it is necessary to use the hand or "wobble"
FUEL SYSTEMS
pump which should be as far below the fuel tank as possible so that it is

flooded at all times. As soon as the engine is started, the engine-driven


The fuel system consists of tanks, piping exterior to the engine, pumps
gear pump will continue the pumping of fuel. The hand or wobble pump
not integral with the engine, strainers, gauges, pipe fittings, and valves
is so arranged that fuel will flow through it even when it is not being oper-

and cocks.
ated. If its location is at some distance from the cockpit it may be oper-

ated through a suitable linkage system to a crank near at hand to the pilot.
The primer is operated from the instrument panel board in the pilot's
The engine-driven gear pump has a by-pass so that, in case of failure, cockpit. A shut-off cock is located in the primer line.
the hand or wobble pump becomes the emergency pump and will force the

For starting the flow of fuel, it is necessary to use the hand or "wobble"
fuel past the gear pump through the by-pass.

In case the pump supplies the fuel at a greater pressure than the car-
pump which should be as far below the fuel tank as possible so that it is
buretors are designed to take, the adjustable relief valve permits the fuel
flooded at all times. As soon as the engine is started, the engine-driven
to flow back into the tank.

All tanks must be vented in order to prevent partial vacuums from form-
gear pump will continue the pumping of fuel. The hand or wobble pump
ing since these may reduce or prevent proper fuel flow. This vent is usu-
is so arranged that fuel will flow through it even when it is not being oper-
ally located at the topmost point, usually the filler unit of the gasoline tank.

ated. If its location is at some distance from the cockpit it may be oper-
ated through a suitable linkage system to a crank near at hand to the pilot.
A strainer must be included in any fuel line and is usually located at the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:31 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

lowest possible point in the line and in a place where it is easily accessible;

for, the strainer collects the water, grit, and dirt which may have collected
The engine-driven gear pump has a by-pass so that, in case of failure,
the hand or wobble pump becomes the emergency pump and will force the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

in the fuel system even with the best of precautions.

The three-port, two-way cock is operated from the cockpit.

A pressure gauge is used in all fuel systems in order to indicate constantly


fuel past the gear pump through the by-pass.
the pressure in the fuel lines just ahead of the carburetors. If the pressure

In case the pump supplies the fuel at a greater pressure than the car-
buretors are designed to take, the adjustable relief valve permits the fuel
to flow back into the tank.
All tanks must be vented in order to prevent partial vacuums from form-
ing since these may reduce or prevent proper fuel flow. This vent is usu-
ally located at the topmost point, usually the filler unit of the gasoline tank.
A strainer must be included in any fuel line and is usually located at the
lowest possible point in the line and in a place where it is easily accessible;
for, the strainer collects the water, grit, and dirt which may have collected
in the fuel system even with the best of precautions.
The three-port, two-way cock is operated from the cockpit.
A pressure gauge is used in all fuel systems in order to indicate constantly
the pressure in the fuel lines just ahead of the carburetors. If the pressure

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 279
THE POWER PLANT

279

should fall below a predetermined value it is usually a sure sign of danger


should fall below a predetermined value it is usually a sure sign of danger
—either the line is clogged or the fuel has given out.
-either the line is clogged or the fuel has given out.
Pumps

1. If a mechanical pump is used, an emergency hand pump is also re-

quired.
Pumps
2. Hand pumps may be used for pumping fuel from an auxiliary to a
1. If a. mechanical pump is used, an emergency hand pump is also re-
main tank.

3. The hand or wobble pump should be placed at least 50 per cent be-
quired.
low the top of the main fuel supply. In some cases, it may be desirable 2. Hand pumps may be used for pumping fuel from an auxiliary to a
to place it as far below the fuel system as the design will permit. Opera-

main tank.
tion of the pumps may be done from the cockpit by means of a suitable

push-pull operating system.


3. The hand or wobble pump should be placed at least 50 per cent be-
4. The hand-operated pump must be so installed as to be operated
low the top of the main fuel supply. In some cases, it may be desirable
readily from the cockpit without requiring any opening of valves or cocks

in the system.
to place it as far below the fuel system as the design will permit. Opera-
Tanks,
tion of the pumps may be done from the cockpit by means of a suitable
1. Fuel tanks should be capable of withstanding an internal test pres-

push-pull operating system.


4. The hand-operated pump must be so installed as to be operated
sure of ZYi pounds per square inch without failure or leakage. Fuel tanks

that have a maximum fuel depth greater than 2 feet should be investigated

for the pressure developed during the maximum applied acceleration with
readily from the cockpit without requiring any opening of valves or cocks
full tanks.

2. No fuel tank may be closer to the engine than the remote side of the
in the system.
firewall.

3. Surfaces of the tank or tanks should be so ventilated that the fuel

Tanks,
fumes cannot accumulate in case of leakage. At least inch of air space

should be allowed between the tank and the firewall.


1. Fuel tanks should be capable of withstanding an internal test pres-
4. Each tank must be suitably vented from the top portion of the air

sure of 372 pounds per square inch without failure or leakage. Fuel tanks
that have a maximum fuel depth greater than 2 feet should be investigated
space. Such air vents should be arranged so as to minimize the possibility

of stoppage by ice formation.

5. If two or more tanks have their outlets interconnected, the air space for the pressure developed during the maximum applied acceleration with
in the tanks should also be interconnected. This will prevent the flow of

full tanks.
fuel between tanks that is often caused by differences in pressure at air

vents of each tank of sufficient magnitude.


2. No fuel tank may be closer to the engine than the remote side of the
6. Where large fuel tanks are used, the size of the vent tubes should be

firewall.
so proportioned as to permit rapid changes in internal air pressure,

3. Surfaces of the tank or tanks should be so ventilated that the fuel


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

thereby preventing collapse of the tanks in a steep glide or dive.

7. Each fuel tank should be provided with a pump and a drain located

fumes cannot accumulate in case of leakage. At least 72 inch of air space


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

at the lowest point when the airplane is in the normal position on the

ground. The main fuel supply shall not be drawn from the bottom of this
should be allowed between the tank and the firewall.
pump.

4. Each tank must be suitably vented from the top portion of the air
space. Such air vents should be arranged so as to minimize the possibility
of stoppage by ice formation.
5. If two or more tanks have their outlets interconnected, the air space
in the tanks should also be interconnected. This will prevent the flow of
fuel between tanks that is often caused by differences in pressure at air
vents of each tank of sufficient magnitude.
6. Where large fuel tanks are used, the size of the vent tubes should be
so proportioned as to permit rapid changes in internal air pressure,
thereby preventing collapse of the tanks in a steep glide or dive.
7. Each fuel tank should be provided with a pump and a drain located
at the lowest point when the airplane is in the normal position on the
ground. The main fuel supply shall not be drawn from the bottom of this
pump.

Original from
D I IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
280 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

8. The minimum available gasoline capacity should be at least 0.15


gallon per rated engine horsepower. If the fuel is other than gasoline, the
available fuel capacity with full payload should be sufficient for a 2-hour
flight at cruising speed. Consult the appropriate Civil Aeronautics pub-
lications for specific instructions.

/
I
'

FIGURE XVl- 16. A typical oil system for a single radial-engine installation.

LUBRICATING SYSTEMS
The lubricating system consists of the oil tank or tanks, oil pumps. not
integral with the engine, temperature regulators, piping, fittings, valves,
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVl- 17. A phantom view of a multi-engine oil system, similar to that
employed on the Curtiss C-46.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE POWER PLANT 281
THE POWER PLANT

281

shut-off cocks, and strainers. Typical oil systems are shown in Figures
shut-off cocks, and strainers. Typical oil systems are shown in Figures
XVI-16 and XVI-17.
XVl-16 and XVl-17.
Tanks

1. The oil capacity of the system should be at least 1 gallon for every
Tanks
16 gallons of fuel but should not be less than the minimum specified for 1. The oil capacity of the system should be at least 1 gallon for every
safe operation of engine. Commercial operators use the formula: oil re-

quired equals 10 gallons plus 1 gallon of oil for every 20 gallons of fuel.
16 gallons of fuel but should not be less than the minimum specified for
2. The oil tank should allow for at least 10 per cent volume over that
safe operation of engine. Commercial operators use the formula: oil re-
required for the oil alone to provide for expansion space.

quired equals 10 gallons plus 1 gallon of oil for every 20 gallons of fuel.
2. The oil tank should allow for at least 10 per cent volume over that
3. Oil tanks must be capable of withstanding an internal test pressure

of 5 pounds per square inch without failure or leakage.

4. Oil tanks are made of the same materials as those used for the fuel required for the oil alone to provide for expansion space.
tanks—2S, 3S, or 52S aluminum alloy with wall thicknesses varying from

3. Oil tanks must be capable of withstanding an internal test pressure


0.040 to 0.065 inch.

AIR INLET SYSTEM—TURBOPROP ENGINES'


of 5 pounds per square inch without failure or leakage.
The following discussion offers a number of design considerations

4. Oil tanks are made of the same materials as those used for the fuel
applicable to all turboprop-engine installations and gives an insight into

similar problems for other jet engines.


tanks-28, 38, or 528 aluminum alloy with wall thicknesses varying from
The induction system for the turboprop engine should be designed to
0.040 to 0.065 inch.
obtain the most uniform pressure distribution possible and the maximum

pressure recovery possible at the inlet to the compressor. Engine power AIR INLET SYSTEM-TURBOPROP ENGINES
output and fuel consumption are affected by both of these factors, and

engine performance will suffer if the inlet distribution is poor, or the


The following discussion offers a number of design considerations
pressure recovery is low. applicable to all turboprop-engine installations and gives an insight into
Induction System Configuration

similar problems for other jet engines.


There are a number of general induction system arrangements which

may be considered for the turboprop engine. The more common ones are:
The induction system for the turboprop engine should be designed to
1. Hollow or ducted spinner arrangement, Figure XVI-18A.
obtain the most uniform pressure distribution possible and the maximum
2. Conventional cowl with a conventional spinner installed over the

propeller hub to provide an annular nose inlet, Figures XVI-18B, C,


pressure recovery possible at the inlet to the compressor. Engine power
and D. output and fuel consumption are affected by both of these factors, and
3. Undercowl scoop and plenum chamber, Figure XVI-18E.

engine performance will suffer if the inlet distribution is poor, or the


Design Considerations

1. Hollow or Ducted Spinner. The ducted spinner is believed to be the


pressure recovery is low.
Induction System Configuration
best inlet design for the turboprop engine as far as internal airflow and
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

aerodynamic characteristics are concerned. Pressure recoveries of over

95 per cent and very uniform inlet pressure distributions have been ob-

There are a number of general induction system arrangements which


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

may be considered for the turboprop engine. The more common ones are:
tained in wind-tunnel and flight tests with ducted spinner configurations

designed specifically for the engine.

1 Information presented in this section is based upon material in the Installation

1. Hollow or ducted spinner arrangement, Figure XVI-ISA.


2. Conventional cowl with a conventional spinner installed over the
Handbook for the PTSG Turboprop Engine, by permission of Pratt and PPhitney Aircraft.

propeller hub to provide an annular nose inlet, Figures XVl-18B, C,


and D.
3. Undercowl scoop and plenum chamber, Figure XVl-18E.
Design Considerations
1. Hollow or Ducted Spinner. The ducted spinner is believed to be the
best inlet design for the turboprop engine as far as internal airflow and
aerodynamic characteristics are concerned. Pressure recoveries of over
95 per cent and very uniform inlet pressure distributions have been ob-
tained in wind-tunnel and flight tests with ducted spinner configurations
designed specifically for the engine.
1 Information presented in this section is based upon material in the Installation
Handbook for the P T2G Turboprop Engine, by permission of Pratt and Whitney Aircraft.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
282 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
282

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVI-18A, B, C, D, and E. Air inlets for turboprop engines.

discussion. (Courtesy Pratt and Whitney Aircraft.) •

See text for

COWL PROPELLER
BLADE curr ---..... - - - - . . COWL

SPINNER

HOLLOW CR DUCTED SPINNER CONICAL SPINNER


(a) (b)

COWL COWL

STREAMLINE SPINNER MODIF"IED CONICAL SPINNER


{c) (d)
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ll-IOER
COWL
SCOOP--4------+--

UNDER COWL SCOOP


AND PLENUM CHAMBER
(e)
FIGURE XVI- 18A, B, C, D, and E. Air inlets for turboprop engines. Sec text for
discussion. (Courtesy Pratt and Whitney Aircraft.)

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 283
THE POWER PLANT

283

The ducted spinner has some disadvantages, however, which must be


considered. It is necessarily heavier than most of the other designs and
The ducted spinner has some disadvantages, however, which must be

considered. It is necessarily heavier than most of the other designs and

may be difficult to maintain in service. Also, suitable spinner de-icing


may be difficult to maintain in service. Also, suitable spinner de-icing
systems must be developed for this design. The decision as to whether

to use the ducted spinner for a given installation should be made by weigh-
systems must be developed for this design. The decision as to whether
ing the engine performance gains which will be obtained against the me-
to use the ducted spinner for a given installation should be made by weigh-
chanical difficulties which may be encountered.

ing the engine performance gains which will be obtained against the me-
chanical difficulties which may be encountered.
2. Conventional Propeller Spinner. The conventional propeller spinner

configuration is not as good as the ducted spinner from an airflow and

pressure recovery standpoint. It is usually considered to be mechanically

2. Conventional Propeller Spinner. The conventional propeller spinner


configuration is not as good as the ducted spinner from an airflow and
superior, however, because it" is lighter, simpler to construct and main-

tain, and easier to de-ice. The pressure recoveries which can be achieved

with a conventional spinner arrangement will vary, depending upon such


pressure recovery standpoint. It is usually considered to be mechanically
design factors as: the spinner contour; the propeller cuff thickness; the

width of the gap between the spinner surface and the bottom of the pro-
superior, however, because it" is lighter, simpler to construct and main-
peller cuff; the distance from the trailing edge of the propeller cuff to the
tain, and easier to de-ice. The pressure recoveries which can be achieved
cowl'inlet; and the ratio of the area at the cowl inlet to the area at the

with a conventional spinner arrangement will vary, depending upon such


design factors as: the spinner contour; the propeller cuff thickness; the
compressor inlet. Wind-tunnel tests indicate that recoveries as high as

85 to 90% of the dynamic pressure can be obtained with a good design.

(a) Spinner Contour. A large percentage of the pressure losses which


width of the gap between the spinner surface and the bottom of the pro-
occur ahead of the cowl inlet with a conventional propeller spinner occur

as the air flows through the propeller shanks or propeller cuffs. These
peller cuff; the distance from the trailing edge of the propeller cuff to the
losses may be appreciably increased if a serious adverse pressure gradient
cow) ·inlet; and the ratio of the area at the cowl inlet to the area at the
is encountered in the region of the propeller cuffs or if any serious separa-

compressor inlet. Wind-tunnel tests indicate that recoveries as high as


85 to 90% of the dynamic pressure can be obtained with a good design.
tion occurs at the surface of the spinner. For this reason, care should be

taken to choose a spinner design which will make provision for the preven-

tion of these disturbing conditions. Wind-tunnel design information

(a) Spinner Contour. A large percentage of the pressure losses which


(such as that supplied by the NACA or similar agencies) should be utilized

in choosing the spinner shape to help insure that the desired spinner con-
occur ahead of the cowl inlet with a conventional propeller spinner occur
tour is satisfactory in this respect.
as the air flows through the propeller shanks or propeller cuffs. These
There are three principle spinner configurations which may be con-

sidered:
losses may be appreciably increased if a serious adverse pressure gradient
(1) The conical design, Figure XVI-18B.
is encountered in the region of the propeller cuffs or if any serious separa-
(2) The elliptical or streamline designs such as those recommended by

tion occurs at the surface of the spinner. For this reason, care should be
the NACA, Figure XVI-18C. .

taken to choose a spinner design which will make provision for the preven-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

(3) The modified conical spinner with the shortened and rounded nose,

Figure XVI-18D.
tion of these disturbing conditions. Wind-tunnel design information
(such as that supplied by the N ACA or similar agencies) should be utilized
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

For high-speed subsonic airplane applications, it is essential that the

cowl, spinner, and propeller shanks be designed for high critical Mach

numbers. In this respect, it is necessary to keep local velocities over the


in choosing the spinner shape to help insure that the desired spinner con-
spinner and propeller cuff platforms as low as possible.

tour is satisfactory in this respect.


From an aerodynamic standpoint, the conical-type spinner is slightly

There are three principle spinner configurations which may be con-


sidered:
(1) The conical design, Figure XVI-18B.
(2) The elliptical or streamline designs such as those recommended by
the NACA, Figure XVl-18C. ·
(3) The modified conical spinner with the shortened and rounded nose,
Figure XVI-18D.
For high-speed subsonic airplane applications, it is essential that the
cowl, spinner, and propeller shanks be designed for high critical Mach
numbers. In this respect, it is necessary to keep local velocities over the
spinner and propeller cuff platforms as low as possible.
From an aerodynamic standpoint, the conical-type spinner is slightly

Original from ·
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
284 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
284

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL better in certain respects than the streamline or elliptical spinner. The
better in certain respects than the streamline or elliptical spinner. The

principal advantages of the conical spinner are that (1) it can be operated
principal advantages of the conical spinner are that (1) it can be operated
with somewhat lower cowl inlet-velocity ratios than the elliptical spinner
with somewhat lower cowl inlet-velocity ratios than the elliptical spinner
before serious separation occurs, and (2) the design of the conical spinner
before serious separation occurs, and (2) the design of the conical spinner
is somewhat less critical than the elliptical type.
is somewhat less critical than the elliptical type.

The elliptical or streamline spinner is usually preferred, however, since

it is difficult to design a conical spinner that will clear the propeller hub The elliptical or streamline spinner is usually preferred, however, since
without detracting from some other feature. Experience indicates that

when a conical design is used, in order to avoid interference with the


it is difficult to design a conical spinner that will clear the propeller hub
propeller hub, it is generally necessary to use either a low cone angle and
without detracting from some other feature. Experience indicates that
make the spinner quite long, or a high cone angle and make the cowl
when a conical design is used, in order to avoid interference with the
diameter large. It is possible to avoid this difficulty by using a modified

conical spinner consisting of a low-cone-angle conical spinner cut short at


propeller hub, it is generally necessary to use either a low cone angle and
some point forward of the propeller blades and fitted with a rounded nose. make the spinner quite long, or a high cone angle and make the cowl
Limited wind-tunnel tests indicated that some loss in pressure recovery

diameter large. It is possible to avoid this difficulty by using a modified


will result from the nose of a conical spinner being shortened and rounded;

but these tests were very limited, and it is possible that this loss could be
conical spinner consisting of a low-cone-angle conical spinner cut short at
avoided with an improved design. Any modified conical spinner design

some point forward of the propeller blades and fitted with a rounded nose.
should be based on wind-tunnel tests to be sure that the rounded nose

does not cause separation.


Limited wind-tunnel tests indicated that some loss in pressure recovery
Wind-tunnel experience indicates that there is little difference in the will result from the nose of a conical spinner being shortened and rounded;
pressure recoveries obtained with streamline- and conical-type spinners

throughout most of the operating range, providing the contour of the


but these tests were very limited, and it is possible that this loss could be
streamline spinner is properly chosen for the conditions involved. The
avoided with an improved design. Any modified conical spinner design
recoveries obtained with the streamline spinner will be low, however, if

should be based on wind-tunnel tests to be sure that the rounded nose


does not cause separation.
the contour permits separation. Whatever the spinner contour chosen,

it is recommended that the design be based on wind-tunnel information,

and that the final design be checked by wind-tunnel tests whenever Wind-tunnel experience indicates that there is little difference in the
possible.

(b) Inlet-Velocity Ratio. For any given cowl and spinner design,
pressure recoveries obtained with streamline- and conical-type spinners
there is an optimum inlet-velocity ratio, Vi/v0 (ratio of velocity at cowl
throughout most of the operating range, providing the contour of the
inlet to airplane velocity), at which maximum pressure recovery will be

streamline spinner is properly chosen for the conditions involved. The


recoveries obtained with the streamline spinner will be low, however, if
obtained at the engine inlet. When the inlet-velocity ratio is increased

above the optimum, the inlet-duct losses increase, and the pressure re-

covery decreases. When the inlet-velocity ratio is decreased below the the contour permits separation. Whatever the spinner contour chosen,
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

optimum, the diffusion and separation losses ahead of the inlet increase,

causing a decrease in pressure recovery at the engine inlet. In working


it is recommended that the design be based on wind-tunnel information,
and that the final design be checked by wind-tunnel tests whenever
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

out the inlet design, it is necessary to investigate the inlet-velocity ratios

at which the inlet will operate under all important flight conditions, and

possible.
to choose the inlet area and cowl and spinner design so as to obtain the

best possible performance compromise for the various operating condi-


(b) Inlet-Velocity Ratio. For any given cowl and spinner design,
tions. It is usually considered desirable to design the inlet for maximum

there is an optimum inlet-velocity ratio, vifvo (ratio of velocity at cowl


inlet to airplane velocity), at which maximum pressure recovery will be
pressure recovery at the high-speed or normal-cruise condition (which-

obtained at the engine inlet. When the inlet-velocity ratio is increased


above the optimum, the inlet-duct losses increase, and the pressure re-
covery decreases. When the inlet-velocity ratio is decreased below the
optimum, the diffusion and separation losses ahead of the inlet increase,
causing a decrease in pressure recovery at the engine inlet. In working
out the inlet design, it is necessary to investigate the inlet-velocity ratios
at which the inlet will operate under all important flight conditions, and
to choose the inlet area and cowl and spinner design so as to obtain the
best possible performance compromise for the various operating condi-
tions. It is usually considered desirable to design the inlet for maximum
pressure recovery at the high-speed or normal-cruise condition (which-

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 285
THE POWER PLANT

285

ever is more important for the particular airplane involved) and to accept
ever is more important for the partiC'ular airplane involved) and to accept
some loss at climb conditions.
some loss at ('limb conditions.
For any given design there is usually a critical inlet-velocity ratio below

which separation losses ahead of the inlet become quite severe and pres-
For any given design there is usually a rritiC'al inlet-velocity ratio below
sure recoveries become relatively low. Care should be taken to design
which separation losses ahead of the inlet become quite severe and pres-
the system in such a manner that this critical inlet-velocity range is not

sure recoveries become relatively low. Care .should be taken to desig11


the system in such a manner that this critical inlet-velocity range is not
encountered at any flight condition.

The engine air-consumption data needed to compute inlet-velocity ratios

may be obtained from the engine performance curves.


enC'ountered at any flight condition.
In designing the spinner inlet configuration for the engine, the following

points should be noted.


The engine air-consumption data needed to compute inlet-velocity ratios
1. Wind-tunnel tests have shown that the optimum cone angle for a
may be obtained from the engine performance curves.
In designing the spinner inlet configuration for the engine, the following
conical spinner is about 40 degrees. This angle is not unduly critical and

may be varied plus or minus 10 to 15 degrees with only small losses in

performance.
points should he noted.
2. When a conical spinner is used, the cone should be continued all the

1. Wind-tunnel tests have :;hown that the optimum ('One angle for a
way into the cowl inlet. The surface should not be curved ahead of the

cowl inlet as separation may occur and pressure recoveries will be reduced.

3. Pressure recovery is decreased as the propeller cuff or shank thick- <·onical spinner is about 40 degrees. This angle is not unduly critical and
ness ratio is increased, particularly at high-speed conditions. The pro-

may be varied plus or minus 10 to 15 degrees with only small losses in


peller shank or cuff should be made as thin as practicable.

4. Round propeller shanks ahead of the cowl inlet are undesirable.


performance.
Pressure recoveries at critical Mach numbers will be lower with round

shanks than with faired shanks. Cuffs or fairings should be used.


2. When a conical spinner is used, the cone ::;hould be continued all the
5. The gap which is required between the spinner surface and the lower
way into the cowl inlet. The surface should not be curved ahead of the
edge of the propeller cuff to permit the blade to turn through its normal

cowl inlet as separation may occur and pressure recoveries will be reduced.
a. Pressure recovery is decreased as the propeller cuff or shank thirk-
pitch range has an adverse effect on pressure recovery which may become

quite serious when large gaps are used at high speeds. These adverse

effects may be minimized by attaching short fixed cuff sections to the

ness ratio is increased, particularly at high-speed conditions. The pro-


peller :-:;hank or cuff should be made as thin as practicable.
spinner surface to move the junction between the fixed and movable

portions of the propeller blades radially outward away from the boundary

layer area so that the wake from the junction does not enter the cowl

-l. Round propeller shanks ahead of the cowl inlet are undesirable.
Pressure recoveries at critical Mach numbers will he lower with round
inlet under any design condition. Tests indicate that this allows good

pressure recoveries to be obtained even at relatively high air speeds.

For best results, the clearance gap between the platform and the base of
shanks than with faired Hhanks. Cuffs or fairings Hhould he used.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

5. The gap which is required between the spinner surfa<'e and the lower
the propeller blade should be kept as small as possible.

6. Whenever possible, the cowl inlet area should be as large as or slightly

edge of the propeller cuff to permit the blade to turn through its normal
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

larger than the engine inlet area, i.e., a constant area or contracting duct

should be used between the cowl and engine inlets. A diffusing duct

should be avoided, as duct losses tend to be greater with diffusing systems.


pitch range has an adverse effect on presHure recovery which may become
For some applications, it may be necessary to make the cowl inlet smaller
quite serious when large gaps are used at high speeds. These adverse
effects may he minimized hy attaching short fixed cuff sections to the
spinner surface to move the junction between the fixed and movable
portions of the propeller bladeH radially outward away from the boundary
layer area so that the wake from the junction does not enter the cowl
inlet under any design condition. Tests indicate that thiH allows good
pressure recoveries to be obtained even at relatively high air speeds.
For best results, the clearance gap between the platform and the base of
the propeller blade should be kept us small as possible.
6. Whenever poHSible, the cowl inlet area should be as large as or Hlightly
larger than the engine inlet area, i.e., a constant area or contracting duct
should be used between the cowl and engine inlets. A diffusing duct
should be avoided, as duct losses tend to be greater with diffusing systems.
For some applications, it may be necessary to make the cowl inlet smaller

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
286 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
286

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


than the engine inlet in order to keep inlet velocity ratios within the de-
than the engine inlet in order to keep inlet velocity ratios within the de-

sired range under high-speed conditions. Where this is necessary, good


sired range under high-speed conditions. Where this is necessary, good
diffuser design practice should be followed in this duct. diffuser design practice should be followed in this duct.
3. Undercowl Scoop and Plenum Chamber. There has been no experi-

ence with the undercowl scoop and plenum chamber type of induction

system with the engine. In general, it is believed that this type of system
3. Undercowl Scoop and Plenum Chamber. There has been no experi-
would not be very satisfactory for this engine because the distance be-
ence with the undercowl scoop and plenum chamber type of induction
tween the propeller and engine inlet is too short to permit a good duct

configuration, and, as a result, there are high internal losses. The inlet
system with the engine. In general, it is believed that this type of system
flow conditions should be good with this design since the air which enters
would not be very satisfactory for this engine because the distance be-
the inlet does not flow through the propeller shanks, but it is difficult to

tween the propeller and engine inlet is too short to permit a good duct
configuration, and, as a result, there are high internal losses. The inlet
obtain good internal flow with this type of system.

Inlet Losses during Ground Operation

In designing an inlet for the turboprop induction system, care should


flow conditions should be good with this design since the air which enters
be taken to design the cowl lips to avoid separation and excessive inlet

losses during static ground operation. For some applications, it may be


the inlet does not flow through the propeller shanks, but it is difficult to
difficult to design a cowl lip which will be satisfactory for both static and
obtain good internal flow with this type of system.
high-speed operation. Static ground losses are important and should not

be overlooked since the power available for take-off will be reduced if

these losses are excessive. Present indications are that this problem is
Inlet Losses during Ground Operation
not serious with good ducted-spinner or good conventional-spinner con- In designing an inlet for the turboprop induction system, care should
figurations.

Engine Inlet Anti-Icing Provision


be taken to design the cowl lips to avoid separation and excessive inlet
In order to prevent icing of the engine air inlet section, provisions are
losses during static ground operation. For some applications, it may be
made for bleeding compressor discharge air through passages in the com-

difficult to design a cowl lip which will be satisfactory for both static and
high-speed operation. Static ground losses are important and should not
pressor inlet guide vanes and the four upper air inlet struts. The two

lower inlet struts are not subject to icing since oil circulates through

these during engine operation. be overlooked since the power available for take-off will be reduced if
When icing conditions are anticipated, the anti-icing valve, located in

the bleed duct at the right of the compressor section, should be opened to
these losses are excessive. Present indications are that this problem is
permit flow from the compressor discharge. The rate of flow is limited
not serious with good ducted-spinner or good conventional-spinner con-
to the amount sufficient for anti-icing purposes. The four anti-icing

figurations.
air-discharge ports are located at the outer ends of the four air inlet

case struts.
Engine Inlet Anti-Icing Provision
In order to prevent icing of the engine air inlet section, provisions are
Anti-Icing Water Runback into Engine Inlet
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

In considering an operative engine in flight icing conditions with engine

and airplane anti-icing system in operation, attention must be given to the


made for bleeding compressor discharge air through passages in the com-
pressor inlet guide vanes and the four upper air inlet struts. The two
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

likelihood of a small amount of water runback into the engine inlet.

Engine testing on this has been confined to simulated icing conditions at

low temperatures of about 10° to 15° F. Results of such tests indicated


lower inlet struts are not subject to icing since oil circulates through
these during engine operation.
When icing conditions are anticipated, the anti-icing valve, located in
the bleed duct at the right of the compressor section, should be opened to
permit flow from the compressor discharge. The rate of flow is limited
to the amount sufficient for anti-icing purposes. The four anti-icing
air-discharge ports are located at the outer ends of the four air inlet
case struts.
Anti-Icing Water Runback into Engine Inlet
In considering an operative engine in flight icing conditions with engine
and airplane anti-icing system in operation, attention must be given to the
likelihood of a small amount of water runback into the engine inlet.
Engine testing on this has been confined to simulated icing conditions at
low temperatures of about 10° to 15° F. Results of such tests indicated

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 287
THE POWER PLANT

287 that no ice formation was evident on the inlet-passage outer wall between
that no ice formation was evident on the inlet-passage outer wall between

struts or from struts aft to the inlet guide vanes; this was with engines
struts or from struts aft to the inlet guide vanes; this was with engines
being run with no cowling. With an actual installation in an airplane,
being run with no cowling. With an actual installation in an airplane,
some additional heat from within the nacelle will be available to this

some additional heat from within the nacelle will be available to this
outer wall. Anti-ice heat in engine struts and inlet guide vanes easily
outer wall. Anti-ice heat in engine struts and inlet guide vanes easily

prevented any buildup at these points. There was evidence of consider-

able heat transfer from the hot air and oil in struts to case areas between prevented any buildup at these points. There was evidence of consider-
and aft of the struts. Anti-icing of the inner passage wall was satis-

factory with transfer of heat from the propeller reduction gearing.


able heat transfer from the hot air and oil in struts to case areas between
Simulated icing in these tests utilized a very high water-air concentra-
and aft of the struts. Anti-icing of the inner passage wall was satis-
tion and, as noted above, no ice buildup was experienced. This con-
factory with transfer of heat from the propeller reduction gearing.
centration was considered to be greater than that which might be experi-

enced in actual flying during a rain at freezing temperatures, when the


Simulated icing in these tests utilized a very high water-air concentra-
ice accretion rate is at one of its highest values. tion and, as noted above, no ice buildup was experienced. This con-
The aircraft manufacturer must take the responsibility for providing

centration was considered to be greater than that which might be experi-


anti-icing systems for the spinner, cowl, propeller equipment struts, and

propeller. De-icing systems wherein the ice is alternately allowed to


enced in actual flying during a rain at freezing temperatures, when the
build up to a certain degree and then broken off should not be used for
ice accretion rate is at one of its highest values.
these components since some of the ice particles may enter the engine

inlet and cause damage to the compressor blades.


The aircraft manufacturer must take the responsibility for providing
AIR INLET SYSTEMS—TURBO-JET ENGINES anti-icing systems for the spinner, cowl, propeller equipment struts, and
The advent of the various types of jet engines requiring such enormous

propeller. De-icing systems wherein the ice is alternately allowed to


amounts of air has increased the importance of the design of the induction

systems. Not only have important gains been made in obtaining good
build up to a certain degree and then broken off should not be used for
ram recovery, but there has also been a marked impact on the amount
these components since some of the ice particles may enter t.he enu;ine
of drag (in relation to the entire design) that may be accepted.

Airplanes powered with jet engines obviously require well-coordinated


inlet and cause damage to the compressor blades.
and integrated aerodynamic, thermodynamic, and structural designs.

From an aerodynamic standpoint, an ideal induction system would

AIR INLET SYSTEMS-TURBO-JET ENGINES


deliver air to the jet engine:

1. Without reduction in available energy; The advent of the various types of jet engines requiring such enormous
2. Without increasing the over-all aerodynamic resistance of the air-

amounts of air has increased the importance of the design of the induction
craft and so detracting from the high-speed characteristics of the airplane;

3. Without interfering with a uniform air distribution at the point of


systems. Not only have important gains been made in obtaining good
delivery.
ram recovery, but there has also been a marked impact on the amount
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The induction system performance may be adversely affected by any

or all of the following factors:


of drag (in relation to the entire design) that may be accepted.
Airplanes powered with jet engines obviously require well-coordinated
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1. Separation of the airflow over the duct lips, due to stalling, through

and integrated aerodynamic, thermodynamic, and structural designs.


a relatively wide range of angles of attack;

2. Local induced velocities approaching critical Mach numbers;

3. Thickening of the boundary layer, leading to an inherent total pres-


From an aerodynamic standpoint, an ideal induction system would
deliver air to the jet engine:
1. Without reduction in available energy;
2. Without increasing the over-all aerodynamic resistance of the air-
craft and so detracting from the high-speed characteristics of the airplane;
3. Without interfering with a uniform air distribution at the point of
delivery.
The induction system performance may be adversely affected by any
or all of the following factors:
1. Separation of the airflow over the duct lips, due to stalling, through
a relatively wide range of angles of attack;
2. Local induced velocities approaching critical Mach numbers;
3. Thickening of the boundary layer, leading to an inherent total pres-

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
288 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
288

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


sure loss (a positive pressure gradient ahead of the inlet and continuing
sure loss (a positive pressure gradient ahead of the inlet and continuing throughout the length of the diffuser will result in an increasing thickness
throughout the length of the diffuser will result in an increasing thickness

of the boundary layer and may induce separation along the duct walls);
of the boundary layer and may induce separation along the duct walls);
4. Changes in the direction of flow throughout the system;
4. Changes in the direction of flow throughout the system;
5. Non-uniform flow, or cross-flow, or alternate pulsating flow caused
5. Non-uniform flow, or cross-flow, or alternate pulsating flow caused
by more than one duct feeding into the system;

6. Unusual conditions leading to increased skin friction.


by more than one durt feeding into the system;
Inlets may be classified as: 6. Unusual conditions leading to increased skin friction.
Inlets may be classified as:
1. Nose inlets, located in the nose of a fuselage or power plant, pod, or

nacelle;

2. Wing inlets, located along the leading edge of the wing, usually at

1. Nose inlets, located in the nose of a fuselage or power plant, pod, or


nacelle;
the root for single-engine installations;

3. Annular inlets, encircling, in whole or in part, the fuselage or power

plant, pod, or nacelle;


2. Wing inlets, located along the leading edge of the wing, usually at
4. Scoop inlets, which project beyond the immediate surface of the

fuselage or nacelle;
the root for single-engine installations;
5. Flush inlets, which are recessed in the side of a fuselage or nacelle.
3. Annular inlets, encircling, in whole or in part, the fuselage or power
For supersonic induction systems, additional classification may be

plant, pod, or nacelle;


4. Scoop inlets, which project beyond the immediate surface of the
made, such as:

1. The external compression type, using either a ramp or a conical

inlet;
fuselage or nacelle ;
2. The internal compression type, employing either the so-called two-

dimensional or three-dimensional design.


5. Flush inlets, which are recessed in the side of a fuselage or nacelle.
The amount of air required for a jet power plant will he specified for
For supersonic induction systems, additional cla&;ification may be
the engine and is a function of the amount of fuel consumed as well as

the amount of cooling air required.


made, such as :
For aircraft speeds up to about sonic, the air velocity in the induction
1. The external compression type, using either a ramp or a conical
system varies from three tenths to nine tenths of the aircraft speed or

Vi _ air scoop inlet velocity ^


inlet;
V„ airplane velocity
2. The internal compression type, employing either the so-called t.wo-
This ratio is known as the inlet-velocity ratio, and for preliminary design

dimensional or three-dimensional design.


purposes may be assumed to be about 0.5. For fighter aircraft, the ratio

is between 0.6 and 0.7.


The amount of air required for a jet power plant will he specified for
To determine the quantity of air by volume required, the following

the engine and is a function of the amount of fuel consumed as well as


relationships are helpful:

the amount of cooling air required.


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

V -Q

where Vi = air scoop inlet velocity, ft/sec,

For aircraft speeds up to about soni<', the air velocity in the induction
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Q = induction airflow, cu ft/sec,

A = air scoop inlet area, sq ft.


system varies from three tenthl-i to nine tenths of the aircraft speed or
Vi air scoop inlet velocity
- - > .:{ < .u.
vn airplane velocity
This ratio is known as the inlet-velocity ratio, and for preliminary design
purposes may be a&;umed to be about 0.5. For fighter aircraft, the ratio
is between 0.6 and 0.7.
To determine the quantity of air by volume required, the following
relationships are helpful:

where V1 air scoop inlet velocity, ft/sec,


=
Q = induction airflow, cu ft/sec,
A = air scoop inlet area, sq ft.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 289
THE POWER PLANT

289

where Q
Q=w
W
pg
Q=-

pg
where Q = induction airflow, cu ft/sec,
, cu ft/sec,

W = induction airflow, lb/sec,


W = induction airflow, lb/sec,
p = inlet air density, slugs/cu ft,
p = inlet air density, slugs/cu ft,
g = acceleration of gravity, 32.2 ft/sec2.

W may be estimated from the following approximate air-consumption


(} = acceleration of gravity, a2.2 ft/sec2 .
values for the non-jet reciprocating type engines:

7.0 to 7.2 lb of air per horsepower hour for best economy mix-
W may be estimated from the following approximate air-consumption
tures,

values for the non-jet reciprocating type engines:


6.1 to 0.8 lb of air per horsepower hour for best power mixtures,

G.6 to 7.0 lb of air per horsepower hour for rich best power
7.0 to 7.2 lb of air per horsepower hour for best economy mix-
mixtures.

tures,
For the jet-type engine, the specific air consumption can be calculated

on the basis of the air-fuel ratio, which for complete combustion is about
6.1 to H.8 lb of air per horsepower hour for be:-;t power mixtures,
15 to 1 by weight. The total weight of air required for combustion can

then be calculated:
6.6 to 7 .0 lb of air per horsepower hour for rich best power
where e is the specific fuel consumption (SFC) per pound of thrust or
mixtures.
equivalent shaft horsepower (eshp), as specified by the manufacturer.

It is given either as lbs/lb of thrust/hr or lbs/eshp/hr, depending upon


For the jet-type engine, the specific air consumption can be calculated
the type of engine used.

on the basis of the air-fuel ratio, which for complete combustion is about
15 to I by weight. The total weight of air required for combustion can
Some comments should be made on various types of air inlets for turbo-

jet engine installations in aircraft operating at less than supersonic speeds

in order to indicate the extent of the engineering compromises that have then be calculated:
W = 15(e) (Tor P),
to be made.

The Wing-Root Inlet

Advantages claimed for this type of installation are:


where e is the i-;pecific fuel consumption (SFC) per pound of thrw;t or
equivalent shaft horsepower (eshp), as specified by the manufacturer.
1. Excellent energy recoveries may be obtained through a satisfactory

range of angles of attack.

2. The critical Mach number for the inlet can be made as high as for It is given either as lbs/lb of thrust/hr or lb:.;/ei-;hp/hr, depending upon
the wing.

the type of engine used.


3. Boundary-layer removal can be accomplished relatively easily.

4. The fuselage remains uncluttered by ducts and therefore allows

W = total weight of air in pounds required per hour,


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

greater room for radar and cockpit installations.

5. There is practically no form drag added to the airplane.


T = thrust rating of jet engine,
P = eshp of the turboprop engine.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

W = 15(e) (T or P),

W = total weight of air in pounds required per hour,

Some comments should be made on various types of air inletH for turbo-
T = thrust rating of jet engine,

P = eshp of the turboprop engine.

jet engine installations in aircraft operating at les:-; than supersonic :-;peeds


in order to indicate the extent of the engineering compromises that have
to be made.
The Wing-Root Inlet
Advantages claimed for this type of installation arc:
1. Excellent energy recoveries may be obtained through a satisfactory
range of angles of attack.
2. The critical Mach number for the inlet can be made ai-; high as for
the wing.
:3. Boundary-layer removal can be accomplished relatively eai-;ily.
4. The fuselage remains uncluttered by ducts and therefore allows
greater room for radar and cockpit insta llations.
5. There is practically no form drag added to the airplane.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
290 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
290

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVI-19. The wing-root inlet.

Some of the unfavorable aspects of this type of installation are:

1. The wing structure is quite complicated, especially since the wing-

root section is a critical structural design problem even without ducts.

2. Unless engines are installed in the wing root, resulting bends in the

duct may lead to high energy losses.

3. Retraction space for the landing gear may be made less available

by the presence of the ducts.

Nose Inlet in the Fuselage or Nacelle

The apparent favorable features of this type are:

1. It is free of boundary layer effects.

2. Except for large angles of attack, there are few flow complications.

3. Excellent energy recoveries are possible.

4. High critical Mach numbers may be obtained.

5. It is considered an optimum design insofar as inlet aerodynamic

characteristics are concerned.

6. It is ideal for nacelle installation, especially when nacelles are below


FrouaE XVI-19. The wing-root inlet.
the wing.

The disadvantages of this type of installation are:

1. The duct system may be excessively long.


Some of the unfavorable aspects of this type of installation are:
2. The duct system may be of an undesirable shape.

3. The design may lead to excessive weight.


1. The wing structure is quite complicated, especially since the wing-
4. The design may lead to structural complications.
root section is a critical structural design problem even without ducts.
5. If it is used in the nose of a fuselage, vision is restricted since a more

2. Unless engines are installed in the wing root, resulting bends in the
duct may lead to high energy losses.
aft location of the cockpit and wider nose of fuselage are usually required.

6. Radar equipment cannot be located in the fuselage.

The Nacelle or Pod-Type Installation


3. Retraction space for the landing gear may be made less available
1. It is ideal, but there is more drag for the nacelle.

by the presence of the ducts.


Nose Inlet in the Fuselage or Nacelle
The apparent favorable features of this type are:
1. It is free of boundary layer effects.
2. Except for large angles of attack, there are few flow complications.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. Excellent energy recoveries are possible.


4. High critical Mach numbers may be obtained.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

5. It is considered an optimum design insofar as inlet aerodynamic


characteristics are concerned.
6. It is ideal for nacelle installation, especially when nacelles are below
the wing.
The disadvantages of this type of installation are:
1. The duct system may be excessively long.
2. The duct system may be of an undesirable shape.
3. The design may lead to excessive weight.
4. The design may lead to structural complications.
5. If it is used in the nose of a fuselage, vision is restricted since a more
aft location of the cockpit and wider nose of fuselage are usually required.
6. Radar equipment cannot be located in the fuselage.
The Nacelle or Pod-Type Installation
1. It is ideal, but there is more drag for the nacelle.

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 291
THE POWER PLANT

291

Figure XVI-20. Nose inlet in fuselage or nacelle. The nacelle or pod installation

is favored for multi-engine designs because it is considered less of a fire hazard, and

also keeps the exhaust heat away from the wing structure.

Figure XVI-21. The annular inlet. Such inlets may extend circumferentially only

partially or entirely around the fuselage.


-------
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVl-20. Nose inlet in fuselage or nacelle. The nacelle or pod installation
is favored for multi-engine designs because it is considered less of a fire hazard, and
also keeps the exhaust heat away from the wing structure.

FIGURE XVl-21. The annular inlet. Such inlets may extend circumferentially only
partially or entirely around the fuselage .

Original from
Dig e b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
292 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

2. Wing-nacelle interference i:-; more difficult to change than air m-


292

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

2. Wing-nacelle interference is more difficult to change than air in- duction, and therefore other means of introducing air may be better.
duction, and therefore other means of introducing air may be better.

3. It makes it difficult to achieve high critical Mach numbers.


4. Angle of attack ejfects.2
3. It makes it difficult to achieve high critical Mach numbers.

4. Angle of attack effects.2

The total pressure distribution at the inlet of the engine is usually very uniform with

The total pressure distribution at the inlet of the engine is usually very uniform with
a pod-type installation under normal level flight conditions. However, the distance

a pod-type installation under normal level flight conditions. However, the distance
from the inlet to the engine is usually so short that disturbances generated at the inlet

from the inlet to the engine is usually so short that disturbances generated at the inlet
by high angle of attack or yaw operation are not damped out before they reach the

by high angle of attack or yaw operation are not damped out before they reach the
engine, and relatively large disturbances can occur at high angles of attack. As a
engine, and relatively large disturbances can occur at high angles of attack. As a

general rule airplanes which use pod-type installations are not normally designed to
general rule airplanes which use pod-type installations are not normally designed to

operate at extreme angles of attack so this problem may not be serious. However, in

designing pod installation it should be recognized that pressure distributions at the


operate at extreme angles of attack so this problem may not be serious. However, in
engine inlet can be affected seriously by high angle of attack operation.
designing pod installation it should be recognized that pressure distributions at the
Every effort should be made to be sure that pressure distribution is satisfactory up
engine inlet can be affected seriously by high angle of attack operation.
to the maximum angle at which the airplane will operate during maneuvers. The Every effort should be made to be sure that pressure distribution is satisfactory up
adverse effect of angle of attack on inlet distribution can be reduced by using relatively to the maximum angle at which the airplane will operate during maneuvers. The
thick lips on the lower part of the inlet although this may be objectionable on high speed
adverse effect of angle of attack on inlet distribution can be reduced by using relatively
aircraft because of drag penalties. In some cases it may be necessary to compromise
thick lips on the lower part of the inlet although this may be objectionable on high speed
on lip design, even where some drag penalty is involved, in order to insure satisfactory
aircraft because of drag penalties. In some cases it may be necesRary to compromise
power plant operation during maneuver conditions.

on lip deRign, even where l'Ome drag penalty is involved, in order to insure satisfactory
The adverse effect of angle of attack on pressure distribution at the engine inlet also

power plant operation during maneuver conditionR.


The adverse effect of angle of attack on pressure distribution at the engine inlet also
can be minimized by making the distance from the cowl inlet to the face of the engine

long enough to permit distrubances created at the inlet to be damped out before reaching

the engine.
can be minimized by making the distance from the cowl inlet to the face of the engine
The Annular Inlet
long enough to permit distrubances created at the inlet to be damped out before reaching
Here, the advantages, especially when compared with the nose type, are:
the engine.
1. Good energy recoveries are possible.

2. A high critical Mach number for the inlet may be achieved. The Annular Inlet
3. The boundary layer offers little trouble.

4. Visibility may be better than for the nose inlet.


Here, the advantages, especially when compared with the nose type, are:
5. Placement of equipment in the nose of the fuselage is not inter-
1. Good energy recoveries are po88ible.
fered with.

The disadvantages considered are:


2. A high critical Mach number for the inlet may he achieved.
1. The design may lead to long and complicated duct configurations. :J. The boundary layer offers little trouble.
2. There are certain structural penalties.

4. Visibility may be better than for the nose inlet.


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. More aerodynamic drag usually results.

4. Rearward location along the fuselage may be critical.


5. Placement of equipment in the nose of the fusclagc is not inter-
fered with.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The External Scoop

The apparent advantages are:

1. May produce the lightest design.

The disadvantages considered are:


2. May least affect internal arrangements and structure.

3. May be desirable for installations where speeds below transonic are 1. The design may lead to long and complicated duct configurations.
likely to be encountered.

2. There are certain structural penalties.


2 Quoted from Pratt & Whitney JT3 Installation Handbook.

3. More aerodynamic drag usually results.


4. Rearward location along the fuselage may be critical.

The External Scoop


The apparent advantages are:
1. May produce the lightest design.
2. May least affect internal arrangements and structure.
:3. May be desirable for installations where speeds below transonic arc
likely to be encountered.
2 Quoted from Pratt & Whitney JT.'J lnstallatiori Handbook.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 293
THE POWER PLANT 293

Figure XVI-22. The external scoop. Such a scoop may also be located on top or

bottom of the wing surface for multi-engine designs.

4. Can be located outside of the boundary layer of the structure to

which it may be attached.

The disadvantages encountered are:

1. An increase in form drag,

2. A relatively low critical Mach number.

3. Due to the changes in bends, high duct losses may be expected.


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

- --~
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

~- ~
~

FIGURE XVl-22. The cxt<lrnal scoop. Such a scoop may 11.lao be located on top or
bottom of the wing surface for multi-engine designs.

4. Can be located outside of the boundary layer of the structure to


which it may be attached.
The disadvantages encountered are:
1. An increase in form drag,
2. A relatively low critical Mach number.
3. Due to the changes in bends, high duct lo~es may be cxpectc<l.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
294 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
294

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

(a)

(b)

Figure XVI-23. The flush inlet. In order to suck away the boundary layer ahead

of the main inlet, a small secondary inlet is used, as shown in the schematic sketch in

Figure B.

The Flush Inlet

If properly installed, it may have these advantages:

1. Relatively low weight.

(a)
2. Structural simplicity.

3. Low form drag.

4. Relatively straightforward ducts.

The disadvantages are due primarily to:

1. Location in a region of thickened boundary layer, necessitating some

boundary layer control, or

2. Location outside of the normal air stream so that duct bends may

lead to energy losses and lower critical Mach numbers.

Matching the air inlet system of the airframe to the turbo-jet engine

requirements presents a more difficult problem as speeds move into the

supersonic region. Some of the problems encountered are:

1. Need for high inlet pressure recovery.


(b)
2. Undesirable flow instability at Mach numbers over 1.5. FIGURE XVl-23. The flush inlet. In order to suck away the boundary layer ahead
3. Flow pattern distortions caused by the forward part of the induc-
of the main inlet, a. small secondary inlet is used, as shown in the schema.tic sketch in
tion system.
Figure B.
4. Duct rumble due to flow separation ahead of side inlets at low air

The Flush Inlet


flows, separation at inlet lips at high angles of attack.

5. Excessive spillage.

6. Reasonable efficiency of airflow and energy recovery over a relatively

If properly installed, it may have these advantages:


small portion of the operating range.

1. Relatively low weight.


2. Structural simplicity.
:3. Low form drag.
4. Relatively straightforward ducts.
The disadvantages are due primarily to:
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:41 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1. Location in a region of thickened boundary layer, necessitating some


boundary layer control, or
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2. Location outside of the normal air stream so that duct bends may
lead to energy losses and lower critical Mach numbers.

Matching the air inlet system of the airframe to the turbo-jet engine
requirements presents a more difficult problem as speeds move into the
supersonic region. Some of the problems encountered are:
1. Need for high inlet pressure recovery.
2. Undesirable flow instability at Mach numbers over 1.5.
3. Flow pattern distortions caused by the forward part of the induc-
tion system.
4. Duct rumble due to flow separation ahead of side inlets at low air
flows, separation at inlet lips at high angles of attack.
5. Excessive spillage.
6. Reasonable efficiency of airflow and energy recovery over a relatively
small portion of the operating range.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE POWER PLANT 295
THE POWER PLANT

295 Research is still progressing in this area, and the following are some of
Research is still progressing in this area, and the following are some of

the suggestions which have been offered:


the suggestions which have been offered:
1. A freely rotating blade can be installed, under certain conditions, to 1. A freely rotating blade can be installed, under certain conditions, to
improve severe velocity gradients in an annulus at the compressor face.

improve severe velocity gradients in an annulus at the compressor face.


The rotating blade transfers energy from regions of high axial velocity to

those where the velocity is low.


The rotating blade transfers energy from regions of high axial velocity to
2. Screens placed across the inlet also are effective in reducing dis-

those where the velocity is low.


2. Screens placed across the inlet also are effective in reducing dis-
tortion, but the relatively large energy losses may make screens a last-

resort method for solving the problem.

3. A diffuser, when followed by a section producing a rapid accelera- tortion, but the relatively large energy losses may make screens a last-
tion, reduces the distortion at the compressor face. Effectiveness appears

Table XVI-4. Representative reciprocating engines.


resort method for solving the problem.
Fuel
3. A diffuser, when followed by a section producing a rapid accelera-
Oil
tion, reduces the distortion at the compressor face. Effectiveness appears
Rated

con-

con-
TABLE XVI- 4. Representative reciprocating engines.
Ratio of

No. of

Cylinder
Fuel Oil
horse- Rated con- con- Ratio of No. of Cylinder
Normal
horse- Normal sump- sump- Weight weight cylin- arrange-
sump-
power rpm tion, tion, to horse- ders ment
sump-
lb/hp/hr lb/hp/ hr power
Weight

weight

65 2300 .49 .010 176 2.70 4 Horiz. Op.


cylin-

85 2575 .51 .010 184 2.20 4 Horiz. Op.


arrange-

90 2475 .52 .010 184 2.07 4 Horiz. Op.


power

100 2550 .50 .015 230 2.30 4 Horiz. Op.


rpm

108 2600 .52 .025 235 2.26 4 Horiz. Op.


tion,

125 2600 .52 .025 258 2.06 4 Horiz. Op.


lb/hp/hr

145 2700 .51 .017 265 1.82 6 Horiz. Op.


Horiz. Op.
tion,

lb/hp/hr
150 2600 .50 .015 321 2.14 6
to horse-
165 2800 .50 .015 324 1.97 6 Horiz. Op.
185 2300 .50 .020 344 1.86 6 Horiz. Op.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ders

ment
190 2300 .50 .020 399 2.10 6 Horiz. Op.
200 3100 .52 .015 333 1.66 6 Vert. Op.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

power

65 215 2500 .55 .015 487 2.26 6 Horiz. Op.


2300 225 2650 .50 .020 391 1.70 6 Horiz. Op.
.49
240 2200 .52 .025 519 2.20 7 Radial
.010
245 3275 .52 .015 353 1.44 6 Vert. Op.
176

280 2200 .50 .025 585 2.09 9 Radial


2.70

300 2200 .44 .025 505 1.90 7 Radial


4

320 3000 .50 .025 619 1.67 8 Horiz. Op.


Horiz. Op.

350 3000 .50 .025 624 1.78 8 Horiz. Op.


85

450 2300 - - 682 1.54 9 Radial


2575

550 2200 - - 865 1.57 9 Radial


.51

700 2400 .76 .150 1065 1.30 7 Radial


.010

1000 2300 .52 .200 1353 1.20 9 Radial


184

1200 2550 - - 1575 1.30 14 Twin Radial


2.20

1300 2600 - - 1870 1.50 14 Twin Radial


- Twin Radial
4

1800 2600 - 2350 1.31 18


Twin Radial
Horiz. Op.

90
1900 2600 - - 2357 1.24 18
2475
2100 2400 .48 .150 2915 1.04 18 Twin Radial
.52
2300 2600 .48 .200 2848 1.06 18 Twin Radial
.010
2650 2500 - - 3520 1.30 28 Twin Radial
184

2.07

Horiz. Op.

100

Original from
2550

.50
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
.015

230

2.30
296 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
296 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
TABLE XVJ-5. Representative gas turbine (jet) engines.
Table XVI-5. Representative gas turbine (jet) engines.

Maximum

Fuel con-
Maximum Fuel con- Maximum Maximum Dry
Maximum thrust, in sumption, diameter, length, weight,
Maximum pounds lb/hr/lb inches inches pounds
Dry

thrust, in
790 .55 - - 315
pounds
920 1.13 - - 364
sumption,

1000 1.65 22 96 370


diameter,

3250 1.06 24 120 1233


length,

4600 1.14 49 94 1790


weight,

6970 - 37 145 2554


lb/hr/lb

7650 - 37 288 3196


inches

9000 - 37 148 --
inches

10000 - 48 191 3829


pounds

790
--
.55
Jet engines with thrust.'! up to 25,000 lbs or more are available.
—

— to depend partly upon the mixing process, although it involves energy.
315

In addition to the diffusion process, losses and space available for a dif-
920

1.13
fuser are usually limited.
—

4. A relatively straight cylindrical section of the duct, when placed


—

364
ahead of the compressor face, results in suitable mixing in the duct, thus
1000 reducing distortion. Here again, space limitation is a factor in the
1.65

application.
22

96
5. Stationary mixing devices have been used where axial length is
370
limited. These mixing devices have been used at times to correct mal-
3250

1.06
distribution of flow from the compressor discharge to the combustion
24
chamber.
120

6. Variable geometry inlet to increase the operating range over which


the air-mass flow is satisfactory.
1233
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:42 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

4600

1.14

Other devices being explored are:


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

49

94

1790
7. Drooping of the lower lip of the airframe inlet duct.
6970
8. Installation of rods in the duct to change the nature of the airflow.
—

37

145
TABLE XVl-6. Representative gas turbines (turboprop).
2554

7650

—
Maximum Full Maximum Maximum Dry
37
equivalent consumption, diameter, length, weight,
288
shaft horsepower lb/hr/hp inches inches pounds
3196

9000
210 1.3 23 40 240
—
270 1.02 23 43 245
37
280 0 .99 16 37 263
148
392 1.06 16 47 458
—" 590 - 16 48 320
10000 3750 0.54 40 145 1645
—
5700 - 34 158 2564
48
6000 0.63 34 157 2650
191

3829

Jet engines with thrusts up to 25,000 lbs or more are available.

to depend partly upon the mixing process, although it involves energy.

In addition to the diffusion process, losses and space available for a dif-

Original from
fuser are usually limited.

Dig iz b
4. A relatively straight cylindrical section of the duct, when placed
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
ahead of the compressor face, results in suitable mixing in the duct, thus

reducing distortion. Here again, space limitation is a factor in the

application.
THE POWER PLANT 297

FRONT MOUNT AAAANG[MlNT REAR MOUNT ARRANC[MINT

FIGURE XVI-24A. Typical points of attachment for engine mounts for one type of
turbo-jet engine. (Courtesy Pratt and Whitney Aircraft.)
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:46 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

8RACKCT - ENGINE SUSPENSION


AICH'T HANO
INtACK[T - fNCINl SUSPCN!ION
80TTOM

FIGURE XVI-248. Typical points of attachment for engine mounts for another
type of jet engine. (Courte.,y Pratt and Whitney Aircraft.)

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
298 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
298

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

ROCKETS
ROCKETS
The rocket does not depend upon the surrounding air for its operation, The rocket does not depend upon the surrounding air for its operation,
but carries its own, usually as a component of an unstable compound or

as a readily releasable element of a compound. The burned fuel pro-


but carries its own, usually as a component of an unstable compound or
duces high-velocity exhaust, producing thrust which increases with alti-
as a readily releasable element of a compound. The burned fuel pro-
tude. It is considered the most effective of the extremely long-range and
duces high-velocity exhaust, producing thrust which increases with alti-
high-altitude power plants.

For aircraft, it is used for the additional power required to take off
tude. It is considered the most effective of the extremely long-range and
(and called "Rato," for Rocket-assisted take-off), as well as for other high-altitude power plants.
short-duration booster requirements. As higher speeds are desired, the

For aircra.ft, it is used for the additional power required to take off
limitations on high speed, all other factors being equal, may be the take-off

speed and take-off run, since there is a definite relationship for any given
(and called "Rato," for Rocket-assisted take-off), as well as for other
design between the take-off speed and the high speed. Additional power
short-duration booster requirements. As higher speeds are desired, the
at take-off would be one way of decreasing the take-off distance and

attaining the necessary take-off speed in a very short space of time.


limitations on high speed, all other factors being equal, may be the take-off
For each additional 1000 pounds of thrust at 60 miles per hour, there is
speed and take-off run, since there is a definite relationship for any given
an additional 160 horsepower available for take-off. This is equivalent to

design between the take-off speed and the high speed. Additional power
at take-off would be one way of decreasing the take-off distance and
more than 200 brake horsepower for a propeller-operated aircraft, when

it is considered that the propeller efficiency is of the order of 80%.

There are two types of rocket—one using a solid propellant, the other a
attaining the necessary take-off speed in a very short space of time.
liquid propellant.

The solid-propellant type rocket is simple in construction and operation.


For each additional 1000 pounds of thrust at 60 miles per hour, there is
A solid fuel is contained in a steel bottle having an igniter such as black
an additional 160 horsepower available for take-off. This is equivalent to
powder for the pyrotechnic agent that furnishes hot gases and solid

more than 200 brake horsepower for a propeller-operated aircraft, when


it is considered that the propeller efficiency is of the order of 803.
particles to cause the solid fuel or propellant to ignite. The combustion

then proceeds at a controlled rate, governed by the area of the exposed

burning surface and the nozzle throat. The nozzle is used to control the
There are two types of rocket-one using a solid propellant, the other a
proper working pressure and to provide the rate of expansion of the hot

exhaust gases to the atmosphere.


liquid propellant.
This type of rocket is simple in construction since it has no moving
The solid-propellant type rocket is simple in construction and operation.
mechanical parts, but once in operation, it cannot be throttled or shut off

A solid fuel is contained in a steel bottle having an igniter such as black


powder for the pyrotechnic agent that furnishes hot gases and solid
when desired.

The liquid-fuel rocket motor is more efficient but more complex in its

construction and operation. Two fuel systems are used—the mono- particles to cause the solid fuel or propellant to ignite. The combustion
propellant and the multipropellant.

then proceeds at a controlled rate, governed by the area of the exposed


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

A monopropellant, such as nitromethane or hydrogen peroxide, is in-

jected into the combustion chamber. These fuels are unstable, hard to
burning surface and the nozzle throat. The nozzle is used to control the
proper working pressure and to provide the rate of expansion of the hot
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

handle, and have relatively low performance characteristics.

exhaust gases to the atmosphere.


In the multipropellant system, an oxidant and a fuel react in a com-

bustion chamber. For repeated operations, hyperbolic or self-igniting

liquids are preferred—such as hydrogen peroxide with a calcium per-


This type of rocket is simple in construction since it has no moving
manganate catalyst, or red fuming nitric acid with aniline. Non-hyper-

mechanical parts, but once in operation, it cannot be throttled or shut off


bolic fuel systems are liquid oxygen and alcohol, or gasoline and an acid.

when desired.
The liquid-fuel rocket motor is more efficient but more complex in its
construction and operation. Two fuel systems are used-the mono-
propellant and the multipropellant.
A monopropellant, such as nitromethane or hydrogen peroxide, is in-
jected into the combustion chamber. These fuels are unstable, hard to
handle, and have relatively low performance characteristics.
In the multipropellant system, an oxidant and a fuel react in a com-
bustion chamber. For repeated operations, hyperbolic or self-igniting
liquids are preferred-such as hydrogen peroxide with a calcium per-
manganate catalyst, or red fuming nitric acid with aniline. Non-hyper-
bolic fuel systems are liquid oxygen and alcohol, or gasoline and an acid.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
Design of the Wing

CHAPTER XVII

Qln spite of its seeming simplicity, the wing of an airplane requires the y

most careful study in its design for it is the vital part of the airplane which

contributes to the lift. ) A slight change in any one of the factors affecting

the wing design is so critical that only one slight difference in two other-

wise identical designs would be apparent. These differences might be in

performance, such as the top speed, or landing speed, or in the rate of


CHAPTER XVII
climb. Again, there might be differences in stability00—one might be more

stable longitudinally, directionally, or laterally; or there might be differ-

ences in maneuverability.

Pilots who fly externally braced biplanes will attest to the fact that rig-

Design of the Wing


ging the wings differently by tightening lift wires or adjusting struts often

will change an otherwise beautifully maneuverable airplane to one that is

"logy." The change of rigging may have altered the angle of incidence

of the wings, and therefore the decalage, so that entirely different charac-

teristics of the combination are obtained.

From the foregoing statements, it should be apparent that it is not the

wing alone that should be considered but its relationship to the rest of the

airplane in combination with the fuselage and tail surfaces.

The aerodynamicist is concerned with the ultimate performance of the

airplane in flight, and therefore he is particularly interested in the aero-


(Jn spite of its seeming simplicity, the wing of an airplane requires the \
dynamic characteristics of the wing. The structural designer of the wing

is concerned with the design of a structure that can meet the aerody-
most careful study in its design for it is the vital part of the airplane which
namicist's requirements as well as withstand the loads imposed upon it. contributes to the lift. i A slight change in any one of the factors affecting
It is therefore important to consider some general design aspects before

the wing design is so critical that only one slight difference in two other-
any specific structural details are studied.

The wing is essentially a beam that is subjected to shear, bending, and


wise identical designs would be apparent. These differences might be in
torsion imposed upon it by aerodynamic and inertia loads. Figures
performance, such as the top speed, or landing speed, or in the rate of
XVII-1 and XVII-2 indicate typical spanwise loadings and moments

imposed on the wing by the normal and chord components of these forces.
climb. Again, there might be differences in stability- . one might be more
299
stable longitudinally, directionally, or laterally; or there might be difier-
ences in maneuverability.
Pilots who fly externally braced biplanes will attest to the fact that rig-
ging the wings differently by tightening lift wires or adjusting struts often
will change an otherwise beautifully maneuverable airplane to one that is
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

"logy." The change of rigging may have altered the angle of incidence
of the wings, and therefore the decalage, so that entirely different charac-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

teristics of the combination are obtained.


From the foregoing statements, it should be apparent that it is not the
wing alone that should be considered but its relationship to the rest of the
airplane in combination with the fuselage and tail surfaces.
The aerodynamicist is concerned with the ultimate performance of the
airplane in flight, and therefore he is particularly interested in the aero-
dynamic characteristics of the wing. The structural designer of the wing
is concerned with the design of a structure that can meet the aerody-
namicist's requirements as well as withstand the loads imposed upon it.
It is therefore important to consider some general design aspects before
any specific structural details are studied.
The wing is essentially a beam that is subjected to shear, bending, and
torsion imposed upon it by aerodynamic and inertia loads. Figures
XVII-I and XVII-2 indicate typical spanwise loadings and moments
imposed on the wing by the normal and chord components of these forces.
299

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
300 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
300

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Station Station
CN, Ce, or
n ;
Figure XVII-1. Reference diagram for the development of equations for bending

and torsional moments for a typical wing.

In Figure XVII-1,
Locus of a.c. r:n--j dy
or

AF„ = qCN

A
AF„ = q

144'
Plan
CnCx
view
144'

if dx = 1 inch, and represents the load at any station x inches from the

tip of the wing. Similarly,

Cxdx

AFC = qCc

144

Locus of a.c.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII-I. Reference diagram for the development of equations for bending
and torsional moments for a typical wing.

In Figure XVIl-1,

or

if dx = 1 inch, and represents the load at any station x inches from the
tip of the wing. Similarly,

Original from
D.
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 301
DESIGN OF THE WING

301
or
C,._
qC c 144 •
or

and AFc =
AMac = qCmaCz2

in inch-pounds.
and
The spanwise loads AFn, and AFC cause shears and bending or torsional

moments which may be expressed as follows for any station n:


dx'
AM ac -- qCMa C z2 144
y=n v=n y=n

y=i=o y=i=o y=i=o

y~n y=n y=n in inch-pounds.


y=i=o y=i=o y=i=o

y=n y=n
The span wise loads AF"' and AFc cause shears and bending or torsional
Mz = ^(AFn)y = ^ ^CNCyydy;

y=i=o y=t = o
moments which may be expressed as follows for any station n:
y-n y=n

M, = ^(AFc)y = j^^CcCvydy;

y=t=o y=i=o

y=n y=n

y=i=o y=i=o

Due to sweepback, the normal forces cause a torsional moment which

r•n
may be expressed as follows:

11=n 11=n

1 ~4 ,Ec.C 11 dy;
MJ = — ^\ &Fnxin = — AF„yin tan A = -Mx tan A.

|f—i—o y=t=o

Due to dihedral, the chord forces cause a torsional moment which may
S,._ = .EAFc = .EqCcC 111d.ii =
be expressed as: v=i~o veieo •-i-o
y-n y=n

.E
» = ^AFCZ<„ =^^AFcyin tan r = M, tanr.
11=n 11=n

M,._ = (AFn)Y = 1 ~4 ,EcNC11 ydy;


11=i=o 11=i=o

.E
11=n 11="

Mz = (AFc)Y = 1~4.ECcC11ydy;
v=i::ao vssi=o
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

11-n 11=n

l~.ECMaC 1 2 dy.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Mac= .EAMac =
v=i~o r=i~o

Due to sweepback, the normal forces cause a torsional moment which


may be expressed as follows:

-.E
11=n 11=n

Mac'= - .EAFnXin = AFnYin tan A -M,._ tan A.


ll"'i=o 11-i=o

Due to dihedral, the chord forces cause a torsional moment which may
be expressed as:
11=n 11=n

Mac" =.!:AF.Zin= .EAFcYin tan r = Mz tan r.


v~i = o v=i~o

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
302 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
302 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
z or normal axis
z or normal axis

Figure XVII-2. Representation of shears and moments, shown as positive, at any

spanwise station of the wing. The aerodynamic center is taken as the point of origin

of the system of axes shown. The subscripts of the moments are determined by the
y or lateral
designation of the axis about which the individual moment acts.

axis
In Figure XVII-2, M,' is the total of all these torsional moments or:

M,' = M„ + MJ + Mac", or

M/ = Mac - Mx tan A + M, tan V,

for the configuration shown. Similar formulas may be derived for the

inertia load components.

It should be noted that the bending moments Mx and Mz are inde-

pendent of sweepback, dihedral, or the locus of the aerodynamic or elastic

centers of the wing.

The bending stress caused by the moments Mx and Mz at any station

may be found from the formula:

, (MJ„ - MJZ\ (M.I„ - MJ.\ .x or longitudinal


fb = { u. - ij )x + { uu -1j ) *. axis
For purposes of subsequent discussion, let it be assumed that Mz is

insignificant with respect to Mx (which is usually the case, as can be seen

FrnuRE XVII-2. Representation of shears and moments, shown as positive, at any


by comparing the numerical value of Cc with CV), and that the principal

spanwise station of the wing. The aerodynamic center is taken as the point of origin
axes of the cross section of the beam are known. Then, the above formula

of the system of axes shown. The subscripts of the moments are determined by the
becomes the simple bending formula:

designation of the axis about which the individual moment acts.


t - Mxz

f" = —f

In Figure XVII-2, M,' is the total of all these torsional moments or:
In a complex beam, such as the wing structure presents,

Ix = I0 + pLAz? = -£Az?,

M.' = Mac +Mac' + Mac", or


M.' Mac - M., tan A+ M, tan r,
for the configuration shown. Similar formulas may be derived for the
inertia load components.
It should be noted that the bending moments M., and M. are inde-
pendent of sweepback, dihedral, or the locus of the aerodynamic or elastic
centers of the wing.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The bending stress caused by the moments M., and M. at any station
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

may be found from the formula:

f-t, = (M.,I.,. - M./"') x + (M.I.,. - M~I·) z.


l.,I. - I.,. l.,I. - !.,,
For purposes of subsequent discussion, let it be assumed that M. is
insignificant with respect to M., (which is usually the case, as can be seen
by comparing the numerical value of Cc with CN), and that the principal
axes of the cross section of the beam are known. Then, the above formula
becomes the simple bending formula:
/b = - M.,z.
I.,
In a complex beam, such as the wing structure presents,
I., = lo + l:Az12 = l:Az12,

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 303
DESIGN OF THE WING

303

Chord line

-Original or real location of skin

Principal

(b)

Figure XVII-3. (A) shows the principal components of a wing structure. (B)

represents the equivalent wing structure where the solid line segments represent the

shear elements and the solid circles the bending elements required to resist the transverse

and torsional shear and the bending moments.

from which it may be noted that all the longitudinal stringers, as well as

the chord members of the spars, will contribute to the strength of the

wing. The skin, if suitably supported so as to be able to sustain com-

(a)
pressive stresses, can be very effective in adding to the beam strength.

Figure XVII-3 gives a typical representation of the structural elements

important in the design of a suitable wing.

The torsional moments are likely to be quite severe for a swept-back

wing. If the wing has a negative dihedral, then the torsional moments

are all of the same sign and therefore of considerable magnitude. The

wing envelope must sustain these torsional moments.

In general, the bending and torsional moments are the design deter

minants for the wing structure.

<
(b)
GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS

The first three-view, the preliminary weight estimate, and the arrange- FIGURE XVII-3. (A) shows the principal components of a wing structure. (B)
ment of the balance diagram are the necessary steps in furnishing the data
represents the equivalent wing structure where the solid line segments represent the
for the type of wing for the position relative to the fuselage, and for its
shear elements and the solid circles the bending elements required to resist the transverse
size. The preliminary three-view has more or less set the shape of the
and torsional shear and the bending moments.
wing and determined whether it is to be a monoplane, a full cantilever or

an externally braced wing, or, for example, a biplane with wings of differ-

from which it may be noted that all the longitudinal stringers, as well as
the chord members of the spars, will contribute to the strength of the
ent proportions.

The preliminary weight estimate is instrumental in determining the

approximate wing area needed, so that with at least this established, it


wing. The skin, if suitably supported so as to be able to sustain com-
pressive stresses, can be very effective in adding to the beam strength.
Figure XVII-3 gives a typical representation of the structural elements
important in the design of a suitable wing.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The torsional moments are likely to be quite severe for a swept-back


wing. If the wing has a negative dihedral, then the torsional moments
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

are all of the same sign and therefore of considerable magnitude. The
wing envelope must sustain these torsional moments.
In general, the bending and torsional moments are the design deter- <
minants for the wing structure. f
•'

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
The first three-view, the preliminary weight estimate, and the arrange-
ment of the balance diagram are the necessary steps in furnishing the data
for the type of wing for the position relative to the fuselage, and for its
size. The preliminary three-view has more or less set the shape of the
wing and determined whether it is to be a monoplane, a full cantilever or
an externally braced wing, or, for example, a biplane with wings of differ-
ent proportions.
The preliminary weight estimate is instrumental in determining the
approximate wing area needed, so that with at least this established, it

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
304 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
304

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


becomes a comparatively easy matter to select a suitable aspect ratio and
becomes a comparatively easy matter to select a suitable aspect ratio and

thus be able to fix the governing dimensions of span, chord, and taper.
thus be able to fix the governing dimensions of span, chord, and taper.
The balance diagram is necessary to locate the wing relative to the cen-
The balance diagram is necessary to locate the wing relative to the cen-
ter of gravity; otherwise, difficulty might be experienced later in obtaining

ter of gravity; otherwise, difficulty might be experienced later in obtaining


suitable static longitudinal stability.
suitable static longitudinal stability.

The wing planform may be changed considerably owing to certain re-

quirements of landing-gear retraction, flap attachments, and the like. The wing planform may be changed considerably owing to certain re-
Suppose it is desired to retract the landing gear straight inboard towards

the fuselage without the necessity of swinging it back first and then in-
quirements of landing-gear retraction, flap attachments, and the like.
board in order to retract the gear fully into the wing without interfering
Suppose it is desired to retract the landing gear straight inboard towards
with the front spar? Such retraction requires that the root portion of
the fuselage without the necessity of swinging it back first and then in-
the wing be somewhat forward of the leading edge of the mean geometric

chord; or, in other words, the wing should have the leading edge swept
board in order to retract the gear fully into the wing without interfering
back so that the root chord will come forward along the fuselage. The
with the front spar? Such retraction requires that the root portion of
reason for this is that there are two original conditions that must be met

the wing be somewhat forward of the leading edge of the mean geometric
by the wing and the landing gear. (The wing, for example, should be placed

so that the 25 per cent point of the mean geometric chord falls directly
chord; or, in other words, the wing should have the leading edge swept
under the center of gravity. ^^The landing gear, if a rear tail-wheel type
back so that the root chord will come forward along the fuselage. The
is used, on the other hand, must be placed at a certain angle ahead of the

center of gravity to prevent nosing over] These conditions for the wing
reason for this is that there are two original conditions that must be met
by the wing and the landing gear. (The wing, for example, should be placed
~ so that the 25 per cent point of the mean geometric chord falls directly
and landing gear must be kept, and, unfortunately, these conditions may

play havoc with original ideas of wing planform and simple landing-gear

under the center of gravity. /(The landing gear, if a rear tail-wheel type
retraction.

The incorporation of flaps and ailerons often affects wing planform.

For simpler operating mechanisms, it may be desirable to have the hinge


is used, on the other hand, must be placed at a certain angle ahead of the
lines perpendicular to the plane of symmetry of the airplane, or perhaps it

may be desirable to have a constant chord flap whose spanwise axis is per-
) center of gravity to prevent nosing over.\ These conditions for the wing
pendicular to the plane of symmetry. Both of these more or less arbitrary
and landing gear must be kept, and, unfortunately, these conditions may
conditions will affect the ultimate planform of the wing. It is a good plan,

play havoc with original ideas of wing planform and simple landing-gear
retraction.
therefore, to list at first all the various ideas that the designer wants to

incorporate, and then, perhaps, make preliminary sketches of possible

solutions to determine whether the various ideas are compatible. · The incorporation of flaps and ailerons often affects wing planform.
Before the design of the wmg may be begun it is necessary to study

For simpler operating mechanisms, it may be desirable to have the hinge


various features which affect its final design. The more important fea-

tures are considered here although it is impossible to point out all the pos-
lines perpendicular to the plane of symmetry of the airplane, or perhaps it
may be desirable to have a constant chord flap whose spanwise axis is per-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

sible effects of miscellaneous items such as landing lights, engine nacelles,

landing gear, and fuel tanks.

pendicular to the plane of symmetry. Both of these more or less arbitrary


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

WING LAYOUT PROCEDURE

Since the wing design has to allow for so many factors—planform, spar
conditions will affect the ultimate planform of the wing. It is a good plan,
and stringer location, landing-gear attachment and retraction, power plant,

therefore, to list at first all the various ideas that the designer wants to
incorporate, and then, perhaps, make preliminary sketches of possible
ailerons, flaps, and a host of others—it is desirable to make preliminary

studies to make sure that every design feature has been properly in-

solutions to determine whether the various ideas are compatible.


Before the design of the w1ng may be begun it is necessary to study
various features which affect its final design. The more important fea-
tures are considered here although it is impossible to point out all the pos-
sible effects of miscellaneous items such as landing lights, engine nacelles,
landing gear, and fuel tanks.

WING LAYOUT PROCEDURE


Since the wing design has to allow for so many factors-planform, spar
and stringer location, landing-gear attachment and retraction, power plant,
ailerons, flaps, and a host of others-it is desirable to make preliminary
studies to make sure that every design feature has been properly in-

Original from
Dig IZed b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 305
DESIGN OF THE WING

305
corporated. The following suggestions may be followed to advantage.
corporated. The following suggestions may be followed to advantage.

The instructions are for a two-spar wing and may be modified for any
The instructions are for a two-spar wing and may be modified for any
other type of design.
other type of design.
005

1. Draw planform of wing with the necessary dimensions, to scale, to

satisfy aspect ratio, area, and sweepback.


1. Draw planform of wing with the necessary dimensions, to scale, to
2. Determine the mean geometric chord and check that the relation
satisfy aspect ratio, area, and sweepback.
of the wing to the fuselage is such that the center of gravity lies in the

lateral plane perpendicular to the mean geometric chord at the mean


2. Determine the mean geometric chord and check that the relation
aerodynamic center.
of the win(=; to the fuselage is such that the center of gravity lies in the
3. Locate the front spar at a constant percentage of the chord, from

lateral plane perpendicular to the mean geometric chord at thP. mean


aerodynamic center.
root to tip. The front spar is located at between 12 to 17 per cent of the

chord. Note that the constant percentage line of the chord is not parallel

to the leading edge of the wing. Indicate the spar location by its center
3. Locate the front spar at a constant percentage of the chord, from
line.

4. Locate the rear spar similarly. The rear spar is located at from 65
root to tip. The front spar is located at between 12 to 17 per cent of the
to 75% of the chord—usually 70% to accommodate a 25 per cent chord
chord. Note that the constant percentage line of the chord is not parallel
aileron.

to the leading ~dge of the wing. Indicate the spar location by its eP.nter
line.
Neither the front nor rear spar need extend to the extreme wing tip,

since the extreme wing-tip structure is inherently rigid and capable of

transmitting tip loads to the spars and adjacent structure. 4. Locate the rear spar similarly. The rear spar is located at from 65
5. Mark out the aileron. The leading edge of the aileron may be

parallel to the rear spar centerline. If the rear spar is located at 70 per
to 753 of the chord-usually 703 to accommodate a 25 per rent chord
cent of the chord, then the aileron chord cannot exceed about 27 per cent
aileron.
of the chord, since some allowance must be made for rear spar width,

Neither the front nor rear spar need extend to the extreme wing tip,
aileron gap, and the like.

6. If a flap is used for a lift-increase device, it may extend the entire


since the extreme wing-tip structure is inherently rigid and capable of
distance inboard of the aileron. Here some additional study may be transmitting tip loads to the spars and adjacent structure.
necessary if a considerable flap area is desired. In that case, the aileron

5. Mark out the aileron. The leading edge of the aileron may be
parallel to the rear spar centerline. If the rear spar is located at 70 per
chord might be increased, even if such an aileron has some adverse charac-

teristics. Increasing the aileron chord may necessitate moving the rear

spar slightly forward to give sufficient clearances. The flap chord is


cent of the chord, then the aileron chord cannot exceed about 27 per cent
usually less than the aileron chord—perhaps 15 to 20% of the wing chord.

A false spar, needed to support the flap hinges, may have to be added to
of the chord, since some allowance must be made for rear spar width,
the wing structure.
aileron gap, and the like.
6. If a flap is used for a lift-increase device, it may extend the entire
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

7. The wing rib spacing may be spotted in next. There are certainly

likely to be ribs located at each aileron and flap hinge (unless a piano-type

distance inboard of the aileron. Here some additional study may be


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

hinge is possible). The aileron must have at least three hinges for sup-

port. The rib-spacing distance is determined from panel-size considera-


necessary if a considerable flap area is desired. In that case, the aileron
tions, to which reference should be made. Some adjustments in the rib

spacings may be desirable to get hinge-rib locations to coincide with the


chord might be increased, even if such an aileron has some adverse charac-
rib stations. Reinforced ribs are also called for for engine-mount attach-
teristics. Increasing the aileron chord may necessitate moving the rear
ments, landing-gear-member attachments, and fuel-tank supports. Also,

spar slightly forward to give sufficient clearances. The flap chord is


usually less than the aileron chord-perhaps 15 to 203 of the wing chord.
A false spar, needed to support the flap hinges, may have to be added to
the wing structure.
7. The wing rib spacing may be spotted in next. There are certainly
likely to be ribs located at each aileron and flap hinge (unless a piano-type
hinge is possible) . The aileron must have at least three hinges for sup-
port. The rib-spacing distance is determined from panel-size considera-
tions, to which reference should be made. Some adjustments in the rib
spacings may be desirable to get hinge-rib locations to coincide with the
rib stations. Reinforced ribs are also called for for engine-mount attach-
ments, landing-gear-member attachments, and fuel-tank supports. Also,

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
306 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

such ribs may suggest relocations of the other ribs in order to obtain a
306

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

such ribs may suggest relocations of the other ribs in order to obtain a
more pleasing pattern.
more pleasing pattern.

8. Spanwise stringers may be located. These may be placed parallel

to each other or at constant percentages of the wing chord. These span-


8. Spanwise stringers may be located. These may be placed parallel
wise stringers are not normally carried out to the tip, but are rather
to each other or at constant percentages of the wing chord. These span-
discontinued at intervals inboard of the tip so that fewer and fewer stringers

are left from the mid-span outboard.


wise stringers are not normally carried out to the tip, but are rather
9. The main elements of the wing structure have now been located. If
discontinued at intervals inboard of the tip so that fewer and fewer stringers
the layout is considered satisfactory, other details may now be added.

are left from the mid-span outboard.


9. The main elements of the wing structure have now been located. If
Some of them may cause reconsideration of the structure locally. For

example, the well for the retraction of the landing gear may necessitate

some re-design.
the layout is considered satisfactory, other details may now be added.
10. The layout outlined above is shown primarily in outline form by

means of centerlines, with subsidiary sketches showing structural details.


Some of them may cause reconsideration of the structure locally. For
Until the stress analysis is completed, such dimensions as thicknesses,
example, the well for the retraction of the landing gear may necessitate
limiting dimensions, and the like should be omitted. After the stress

some re-design.
10. The layout outlined above is shown primarily in outline form by
analysis is completed, a more detailed drawing is possible.

Before the structural layout has progressed too far, it may be wise to

check on the effect of the spar and spanwise stringer location on the means of centerlines, with subsidiary sketches showing structural details.
fuselage structure. If the front spar necessitates the installation of a

Until the stress analysis is completed, such dimensions as thicknesses,


double frame just where the pilot has to be provided with the best vision,

it may be wise to relocate the spar, or even change the wing planform.
limiting dimensions, and the like should be omitted. After the stress
If the wing fuel tanks interfere with the landing-gear retraction, some
analysis is completed, a more detailed drawing is possible.
re-design considerations are in order.

In considering the wing layout, it is necessary to keep the requirements


Before the structural layout has progressed too far, it may be wise to
of the fuselage, the power plant, and the landing gear constantly in mind.
check on the effect of the spar and spanwise stringer location on the
MEAN GEOMETRIC CHORD

fuselage structure. If the front spar necessitates the installation of a


double frame just where the pilot has to be provided with the best vision,
The center of gravity of the complete airplane is placed, usually, at the

maximum forward position of the center of pressure on the mean aero-

dynamic chord in order to get the desired stability.


it may be wise to relocate the spar, or even change the wing planform.
The mean aerodynamic chord is difficult to determine unless the pressure

distribution for the wing being designed is definitely known. Moreover,


If the wing fuel tanks interfere with the landing-gear retraction, some
the pressure distribution varies with the angle of attack. It is customary,
re-design considerations are in order.
therefore, to use the mean geometric chord of the wing instead.

In considering the wing layout, it is necessary to keep the requirements


of the fuselage, the power plant, and the landing gear constantly in mind.
The mean aerodynamic chord, or the mean geometric chord, is deter-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

mined for only one-half of the wing, either up to the side of the fuselage

for a wing whose center portion is blanketed by the fuselage, or up to the


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

plane of symmetry as in the case of a parasol monoplane.

MEAN GEOMETRIC CHORD


The mean geometric chord of a rectangular wing is located just halfway

out along the semispan out from the fuselage.

The center of gravity of the complete airplane is placed, usually, at the


maximum forward position of the center of pressure on the mean aero-
dynamic chord in order to get the desired stability.
The mean aerodynamic chord is difficult to determine unless the pre;:)Sure
distribution for the wing being designed is definitely known. Moreover,
the pressure distribution varies with the angle of attack. It is customary,
therefore, to use the mean geometric chord of the wing instead.
The mean aerodynamic chord, or the mean geometric chord, is deter-
mined for only one-half of the wing, either up to the side of the fuselage
for a wing whose center portion is blanketed by the fuselage, or up to the
plane of symmetry as in the case of a parasol monoplane.
The mean geometric chord of a rectangular wing is located just halfway
out along the semispan out from the fuselage.

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
- -- . - -

DESIGN OF THE WING 307

FIGURE XVII-4. To determine the ordinates of the airfoil at station x, when the
root and tip airfoils are known, at one-half of the chord,
(hIv ) 11 -- (h Jv ) - (h,. -b liJv)z ' etc •
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVIl-5. Determining the equivalent semispan for mean geometric chord
calculations.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
308 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
308

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVII-6. Geometric determination of the mean geometric chord for a simple

trapezoidal wing.

If the tip of the wing is tapered or rounded off, an equivalent semispan

can be determined such that the area included in the equivalent semispan

is equal to the area excluded.

A geometrical method for finding the mean geometric chord of a trape-

zoidal planform wing is shown in Figure XVII-6.

The length of the mean geometric chord may also be calculated by

means of the formula:

The distance out from the side of the fuselage or plane of symmetry may

be calculated from

_ b (C + 2CQ

X ~ 3 (C + CO'

where b is the dimension as shown in Figure XVII-5, and the distance in

rear of the leading edge of the root chord

_ yi (C + 2d)
(.)-
y ~ 3 (C + Ci)"

FIGURE XVII-6. Geometric determination of the mean geometric chord for a t1imple
trapezoidal wing.

If the tip of the wing is tapered or rounded off, an equivalent semispan


can be determined such that the area included in the equivalent semispan
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

is equal to the area excluded.


A geometrical method for finding the mean geometric chord of a trape-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

zoidal planform wing is shown in Figure XVIl-6.


The length of the mean geometric chord may also be calculated by
means of the formula:

C2 =
2(C + Ci -
3 C c~
+ C1) .
The distance out from the side of the fuselage or plane of symmetry may
be calculated from
b (C + 2C1)
x = 3 (C + C1)'
where bis the dimension as shown in Figure XVIl-5, and the distance in
rear of the leading edge of the root chord
Y1 (C + 2C1)
y = 3 (C +Ci) .

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 309
DESIGN OF THE WING 309

When the wing is made up of a rectangular and a tapered portion, the


When the wing is made up of a rectangular and a tapered portion, the
procedure is to

1. Determine the mean geometric chord of the trapezoidal and the


procedure is to
rectangular section separately.

1. Determine the mean geometric chord of the trapezoidal and the


f

\ r* yn
rectangular section separately.
it

<>

I
\

—r <o

- - t - - - - 1 - - - ~.....
~re
t

*l
~~
'2

tix .j
"3

Figure XVII-7. Geometric determination of the mean geometric chord for a com-

bined rectangular and trapezoidal planform. If the wing is elliptical in planform, an

x2

::LCx,,
equivalent trapezoid may be used.
1
2. If the area of the rectangle is A, and the trapezoid A2 then the mean

geometric chord of the combination is

„ _ CR At + Ci A,

t2~ Al + A2'
2
Its distance from the mean geometric chord of the rectangular section is

If the root section is not rectangular, the method is similar.

The mean aerodynamic chord may be determined also by the elemental

strip method. The location of the chord out from the side of the fuselage
FIGURE XVII-7. Geometric determination of the mean geometric chord for a com-
or plane of symmetry may be expressed mathematically:
bined rectangular and trapezoidal planform. If the wing is elliptical in planform, an
fCixds _ fCixCdx _ 2(CixC)
equivalent trapezoid may be used.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

fddS fCiCdx 2(C,C)'


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2. If the area of the rectangle is A, and the trapezoid A2 then the mean
geometric chord of the combination is
C2 = CR Ai + Ci A2.
Ai+ A2
I ts distance from the mean geometric chord of the rectangular section is

Xa = [ A2 (X2 +Xi)]
2 + (Ai+ A2) .

If the root section is not rectangular, the method is similar.


The mean aerodynamic chord may be determined also by the elemental
strip method. The location of the chord out from the side of the fuselage
or plane of symmetry may be expressed mathematically:

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
310 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
310 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

I—*—I

h X -|

Figure XVII-8. Reference diagram for mathematical calculation of the mean aero-

dynamic chord.

The integration is best done mathematically by choosing an elemental

strip of width dx = unity. If the airfoil used is the same from root to tip,

and the angle of incidence of each strip is the same, Cl will cancel in the

numerator and the denominator. C is the chord at the distance x from

the reference plane.

PLANFORMS AND TAPER RATIOS

The taper ratio of wings varies greatly, depending upon the speed range,

span, aspect ratio and other similar parameters. For structural con-

siderations, it should be obvious that if no other factors need to be con-

sidered, a triangular planform assuming a uniform lift distribution per

square foot from root to tip would cause less bending moment at the root

than a rectangular wing of equal area. A triangular planform has an

aspect ratio of 26/C, where b is the span and C is the chord at the longi-

tudinal plane of symmetry; its geometric chord is equal to 2/3 C. To

obtain good performance for subsonic airplanes, an aspect ratio of at

least 6 is to be expected. Thus the result here would be a root chord of

one third the span—an unusually large chord at the root which brings

into its wake several problems of structural arrangement control and

stability. Certainly, in the conventional airplane using the conventional

horizontal and vertical tail surface arrangements, the aircraft would be-

come unusually large.

FIGURE XVII-8. Reference diagram for mathematical calculation of the mean aero-
dynamic chord.

The integration is best done mathematically by choosing an elemental


strip of width dx = unity. If the airfoil used is the same from root to tip,
and the angle of incidence of each strip is the same, CL will cancel in the
numerator and the denominator. C is the chord at the distance x from
the reference plane.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

PLANFORMS AND TAPER RATIOS


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The taper ratio of wings varies greatly, depending upon the speed range,
span, aspect ratio and other similar parameters. For structural con-
siderations, it should be obvious that if no other factors need to be con-
sidered, a triangular planform assuming a uniform lift distribution per
square foot from root to tip would cause less bending moment at the root
than a rectangular wing of equal area. A triangular planform has an
aspect ratio of 2b/C, where bis the span and C is the chord at the longi-
tudinal plane of symmetry; its geometric chord is equal to 2/3 C. To
obtain good performance for subsonic airplanes, an aspect ratio of at
least 6 is to be expected. Thus the result here would be a root chord of
one third the span-an unusually large chord at the root which brings
into its wake several problems of structural arrangement control and
stability. Certainly, in the conventional airplane using the conventional
horizontal and vertical tail surface arrangements, the aircraft would be-
come unusually large.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 311
DESIGN OF THE WING 311

Leading edge of wing

perpendicular to plane

of symmetry.

Leading edge of wing


Trailing edge perpendicular to

perpendicular to plane
plane of symmetry.

Front spar perpendicular

to plane of symmetry
of symmetry.
Locus of aerodynamic centers

perpendicular to plane of

symmetry

Rear spar perpendicular to

plane of symmetry

Trailing edge perpendicular to


Figure XVII-9. Variation in wing planforms due to specified initial conditions.

plane of symmetry.
Figure XVII-10. A wing planform employing two different angles of sweepback to

reduce the effect of tip stall.

Front spar perpendicular


to plane of symmetry

Locus of aerodynamic centers


perpendicular to plane of
symmetry

Rear spar perpendicular to


plane of symmetry
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVIl-9. Variation in wing planforms due to specified initial conditions.

----------

FIGURE XVIl- 10. A wing planform employing two different angles of sweepback to
reduce the effect of tip stall.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
312 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
312

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVII-11. A double delta-wing design for obtaining optimum relative posi-

tions of the aerodynamic center and the center of gravity. Inner delta incorporates air

duct for jet engines. A low thickness ratio can be employed for the outer delta. In

spite of the low aspect ratio and small thickness ratio, the delta wing, because of its large

root chord, offers a relatively large volume and depth for ducts, structure, and retraction

of landing gear.

J Ideally, the wing planform should be planned so as to give an elliptical

1 lift distribution at subsonic speeds. All other things being equal, an

elliptical planform would therefore be in order. However, because of the

structural problems presented by such a planform, it is seldom used, except

for some fabric-covered wings. The closest compromise to the elliptical

planform for aerodynamic reasons, and to the triangular planform for

structural reasons is, then, the trapezoidal planform. FIGURE XVIl-11. A double delta-wing design for obtaining optimum relative posi-
Figure XVII-12. Three planforms of wings with pronounced sweepback.
tions of the aerodynamic center and the center of gravity. Inner delta incorporates air
duct for jet engines. A low thickness ratio can be employed for the outer delta. In
spite of the low aspect ratio and small thickness ratio, the delta wing, because of its large
root chord, offers a relatively large volume and depth for ducts, structure, and retraction
of landing gear.

I Ideally, the wing planform should be planned so as to give an elliptical


1 lift distribution at subsonic speeds. All other things being equal, an
elliptical planform would therefore be in order. However, because of the
structural problems presented by such a planform, it is seldom used, except
for some fabric-covered wings. The closest compromise to the elliptical
planform for aerodynamic reasons, and to the triangular planform for
structural reasons is, then, the trapezoidal planform.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVIl- 12. Three planforms of wings with pronounced sweepback.

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 313
DESIGN OF THE WING

313

Typical taper ratios of root chord to tip chord are 2 to 1, 3 to 1, and


Typical taper ratios of root chord to tip chord are 2 to 1, 3 to 1, and ·.;,
3 to 2, with intermediate values. Rectangular planforms are also in the
3 to 2, with intermediate values. Rectangular planforms are also in the
running.
running.
To help solve some of the different aerodynamic problems posed by very

high-speed aircraft, triangular planforms and inverse taper ratios have


To help solve some of the different aerodynamic problems posed by very
been proposed and used. Some of these are discussed under "Sweepback."
high-speed aircraft, triangular planforms and inverse taper ratios have
Some unusual planforms are illustrated in this chapter. See also Figures

XVII-9, 10, 11, 12.


been proposed and used. Some of these are discussed under "Sweepback."
SWEEPBACK FOR HIGH-SPEED AIRPLANES
Some unusual planforms are illustrated in this chapter. See also Figures
For aircraft operating at high subsonic speeds, the use of the sweepback
XVIl-9, 10, 11, 12.
in the planform of the wing is favored in order to increase the critical

Mach number of the wing. Since the thickness ratio t/C is measured for

the section parallel to the plane of symmetry, it can be made smaller.


SWEEPBACK FOR mGH-SPEED AIRPLANES
If, for example, a rectangular wing planform of chord C and thickness t

For aircraft operating at high subsonic speeds, the use of the sweepback
were swept back an angle A, the apparent thickness ratio, instead of t/C,

would now be </(C/cos A) or t cos A/C. For a tapered wing planform,


in the planform of the wing is favored in order to increase the critical
the apparent thickness ratio would be even less. Therefore, by sweeping
Mach number of the wing. Since the thickness ratio t/C is measured for
the wing back, the critical Mach number—which is a function of the

thickness ratio—can be increased, while still maintaining a reasonable


the section parallel to the plane of symmetry, it can be made smaller.
thickness or depth for structural considerations.
If, for example, a rectangular wing planform of chord C and thickness t
However, unless steps are taken in the design of the wing, a highly

were swept back an angle A, the apparent thickness ratio, instead of t/C,
swept-back wing is liable to experience tip-stalling effects. As the angle

Figure XVII-13. Suggested design limits for aspect-ratio determination based upon
would now be t/(C/cos A) or t cos A/C. For a tapered wing planform,
effect of sweepback angle on tip-stall tendencies.
the apparent thickness ratio would be even less. Therefore, by sweeping
the wing back, the critical Mach number-which is a function of the
thickness ratio-can be increased, while still maintaining a reasonable
thickness or depth for structural considerations.
However, unless steps are taken in the design of the wing, a highly
swept-back wing is liable to experience tip-stalling effects. As the angle
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Greater tip-stall
tendency
.Q 8 t---_,....~.......-t--+----+--+-----+------1-~
~
~Q. 6 t----+-----r..........._.:....1------+---+----+-----+-~
...
<
4t----+----t--+"o~rl--~-+----+-----+-~
Less tip-stall
tendency

o ........ . . . . .
~ ~----~~.._~ ........
~-'---_.__.....;;;:z..-.___,
0 10 20
30 40 50 60 70 80
Sweepback angle /3 measured for quarter chord locus

FIGURE XVIl-13. Suggested design limits for aspect-ratio determination based upon
effect of sweepback angle on tip-stall tendencies.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIGAN
314 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
314

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


of attack of the swept-back wing is increased, the wing will stall at the
of attack of the swept-back wing is increased, the wing will stall at the

tips first, thereby reducing the lift at the tips. Since the lift on the swept-
back tip has a large moment arm from the center of gravity, the pitching
tips first, thereby reducing the lift at the tips. Since the lift on the swept-

back tip has a large moment arm from the center of gravity, the pitching

moment is materially reduced so that a "pitch-up" occurs, increasing the moment is materially reduced so that a "pitch-up" occurs, increasing the
angle of attack still further. In addition to stalling the entire wing, the

angle of attack still further. In addition to otalling the entire wing, the
tip of the wing losing the lift first will drop, and a spiral dive will ensue.

Sweeping the wing back produces two aerodynamic results. For the
tip of the wing losing the lift first will drop, and a spiral dive will ensue.
ordinary non-swept wing, the pressure distribution spanwise drops off
Sweeping the wing back produces two aerodynamic results. For the
towards the tip, whereas for the swept wing, the reverse is true. The

increased pressure distribution indicates that the lift coefficient is greater


ordinary non-swept wing, the pressure distribution spanwise drops off
at the tip than inboard, and therefore the tip of the wing will stall before
towards the tip, whereas for the swept wing, the reverse is true. The
the inboard section.

increased pressure distribution indicates that the lift coefficient is greater


at the tip than inboard, and therefore the tip of the wing will stall before
Concomitant with the pressure distribution, there is an outflow from

the longitudinal plane of symmetry or a drift of the boundary layer to-

wards the tip that tends to further complicate the problem of lift dis-
the inboard section.
tribution.

The tip-stalling tendency seems to be more pronounced with high-


Concomitant with the pressure distribution, there is an outflow from
aspect-ratio wings than with low. Figure XVII-13 presents some design
the longitudinal plane of symmetry or a drift of the boundary layer to-
limits.

wards the tip that tends to further complicate the problem of lift dis-
tribution.
Various compromises are incorporated in the wing design to ameliorate

the tip-stall tendency. Such compromises may include (1) low aspect

ratio with large angle of sweepback, which leads to poor performance, (2) The tip-stalling tendency seems to be more pronounced with high-
wing fences on the top wing surface to reduce or prevent the outflow of

the boundary layer, (3) wash-out of the wirig tip, (4) choice of special
aspect-ratio wings than with low. Figure XVII-13 presents some design
airfoils, (5) design of wing-fuselage combinations to promote stalling of
limits.
the wing near the root rather than at the tip, and (6) special planforms
Various compromises are incorporated in the wing design to ameliorate
and aero-elastic designs such as the inversely-tapered planforms, the

"crescent" wing and the "isoclinic" wing, and the "cranked" wing.
the tip-stall tendency. Such compromises may include (1) low aspect
Figure XVII-14. A variable-sweep wing would employ a normal, partially-swept ratio with large angle of sweepback, which leads to poor performance, (2)
configuration for low subsonic-speed operations and a more swept-back version for higher

wing fences on the top wing surface to reduce or prevent the outflow of
speeds. The aerodynamic center of the mean geometric chord would be used as the

approximate pivot point. A root cuff to accommodate the various positions of the wing
the boundary layer, (3) wash-out of the wing tip, (4) choice of special
would be used to streamline the section. A complicated spar mechanism would have
airfoils, (5) design of wing-fuselage combinations to promote stalling of
to be constructed to permit variable sweep and to sustain the loads imposed upon the

structure.
the wing near the root rather than at the tip, and (6) special planforms
and aero-elastic designs such as the inversely-tapered planforms, the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

"crescent" wing and the "isoclinic" wing, and the "cranked" wing.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII- 14. A variable-sweep wing would employ a normal, partially-swept


configuration for low subsonic-speed operations and a more swept-back version for higher
speeds. The aerodynamic center of the mean geometric chord would be used as the
approximate pivot point. A root cuff to accommodate the various positions of the wing
would be used to streamline the section. A complicated spar mechanism would have
to be constructed to permit variable sweep and to sustain the loads imposed upon the
structure.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 315
DESIGN OF THE WING 315

Figure XVII-15. A wing planform incorporating reversed taper as well as sweep-

back.

To obtain better control, stability, and performance throughout the

flight range, designs have incorporated a variable sweep, making it possible

to attain anything from a wing planform with no sweepback to a planform

with the maximum sweepback. This compensates for shifts in center of

gravity and presents the optimum configuration for performance through-

out the flight regime. A forward position is desirable for take-offs and

landings, while a rearward position is best for high-speed flight. Figure

XVII-14 is a schematic illustration of the variable swept-back wing.

Figure XVII-15 demonstrates that an inversely-tapered wing counter-

acts the reduction in lift distribution spanwise by committing more area

Figure XVII-16. The "crescent" wing.

FIGURE XVIl-15. A wing planform incorporating reversed taper as well as sweep-


back.

To obtain better control, stability, and performance throughout the


flight range, designs have incorporated a variable sweep, making it possible
to attain anything from a wing planform with no sweepback to a planform
with the maximum sweepback. This compensates for shifts in center of
gravity and presents the optimum configuration for performance through-
out the flight regime. A forward position is desirable for take-offs and
landings, while a rearward position is best for high-speed flight. Figure
XVII-14 is a schematic illustration of the variable swept-back wing.
Figure XVIl-15 demonstrates that an inversely-tapered wing counter-
acts the reduction in lift distribution spanwise by committing more area
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

- - --- Locus of elastic centers


- - - - - Locus of aerodynamic centers
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII- 16. The "crescent" wing.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
316 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
316

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


- - - - Locus of aerodynamic centers
Locus of aerodynamic centers
- - - Locus of elastic centers of beam
Locus of elastic centers of beam
of high torsional rigidity
of high torsional rigidity
----Locus of elastic centers of
Locus of elastic centers of /

beam of low torsional


beam of low torsional A

rigidity
Figure XVII-17. The "aero-isoclinic" wing.

to the tip section and by increasing the chord length at the tip to increase

the Reynold's number for a better lift coefficient. The distribution of

the lift farther outboard and the decreased depth of structure at the root

do involve some structural penalties. With the inversely-tapered wing,

there is less fuselage-wing interference at the root.

Figure XVII-16 illustrates the "crescent" design developed in England.

It employs three sections having different sweepback angles: 50° at the

leading edge for the root section; 40° for the middle section; 30° for the

tip section. The wash-out due to bending in the middle section is offset

by the wash-in due to torsion caused by the loads on the tip section. Be-
FIGURE XVIl-17. The "acro-isoclinic" wing.
cause of the smaller sweep of the tip section, the possibility of aileron

reversal is minimized, since the torsion of that section alone is less.

Figure XVII-17, shows the so-called "aero-isoclinic" wing. It is similar


to the tip section and by increasing the chord length at the tip to increase
to the "crescent" wing except that the different sections of the wing

incorporate varying degrees of torsional rigidity in order to counteract


the Reynold's number for a better lift coefficient. The distribution of
or reduce the wash-out effects produced by the torsional moments imposed
the lift farther outboard and the decreased depth of structure at the root
upon the wing due to sweepback and particularly tip-stalls.

do involve some structural penalties. With the inversely-tapered wing,


there is less fuselage-wing interference at the root.
Figure XVII-18. A "cranked" wing design proposed to counteract effects of "tip-

stall" and consequent "pitch-ups."

Figure XVII-16 illustrates the "crescent" design developed in England.


It employs three sections having different sweepback angles: 50° at the
leading edge for the root section; 40° for the middle section ; 30° for the
tip section. The wash-out due to bending in the middle section is offset
by the wash-in due to torsion caused by the loads on the tip section. Be-
cause of the smaller sweep of the tip section, the possibility of aileron
reversal is minimized, since the torsion of that section alone is less.
Figure XVII-17, shows the so-called "aero-isoclinic" wing. It is similar
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

to the "crescent" wing except that the different sections of the wing
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

incorporate varying degrees of torsional rigidity in order to counteract


or reduce the wash-out effects produced by the torsional moments imposed
upon the wing due to sweepback and particularly tip-stalls.

FIGURE XVII-18. A "cranked" wing design proposed to counteract effects of "tip-


stall" and consequent "pitch-ups."

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 317
DESIGN OF THE WING

317

Effect of Wing Sweepback


Effect of Wing Sweepback
Some discussion of sweepback has already taken place in considering
Some discussion of sweepback has already taken place in considering
effective dihedral. In general, it may be said that sweeping of the wing

back decreases the maneuverability of the airplane since aileron control


effective dihedral. In general, it may be said that sweeping of the wing
is impaired and the damping moments in roll are impaired.
back decreases the maneuverability of the airplane since aileron control
The effects of wing and fuselage mass distributions, wing loading, and

is impaired and the damping moments in roll are impaired.


The effects of wing and fuselage mass distributions, wing loading, and
wing incidence and sweepback are increasingly important for high-speed

airplanes approaching or exceeding sonic speeds. They are also impor-

tant, although to a lesser degree, for lower-speed airplanes.


wing incidence and sweepback are increasingly important for high-speed
DIHEDRAL

The amount of dihedral that must be given to a wing must ultimately


airplanes approaching or exceeding sonic speeds. They are also impor-
be determined by wind-tunnel tests.
tant, although to a lesser degree, for lower-speed airplanes.
A wing equipped with flaps will probably require more dihedral than

one without since the span is relatively shorter for the former than for the

latter. However, it is not a question of lateral stability alone but of the


DIHEDRAL
relation of lateral to directional stability as well.

The amount of dihedral that must be given to a wing must ultimately


be determined by wind-tunnel tests.
It is customary to give at least 3 degrees up to as much as 6 degrees

dihedral to the wing. This may be given to the entire wing from the

fuselage outward or from the stub wing outward. Again, in the latter
A wing equipped with :flaps will probably require more dihedral than
case more dihedral would be required than for the former case.

It is difficult to determine what the effective dihedral is for a wing ta-


one without since the span is relatively shorter for the former than for the
pered in planform and thickness. The angle measured between the plane,
latter. However, it is not a question of lateral stability alone but of the
passed through the mean aerodynamic chord and parallel to the locus of

relation of lateral to directional stability as well.


It is customary to give at least 3 degrees up to as much as 6 degrees \_
the aerodynamic centers of the airfoils, and the horizontal plane, will give

the accepted value.

In Figure XVII-19, (A) illustrates a negative dihedral angle often used dihedral to the wing. This may be given to the entire wing from the '
to counteract the effect of a high degree of sweepback. Some airplanes

Figure XVII-19. Various configurations showing dihedral. The angles have been
fuselage outward or from the stub wing outward. Again, in the latter
exaggerated in magnitude to show contrast. The dihedral angle is measured between
case more dihedral would be required than for the former case.
the horizontal plane and a plane through the locus of the aerodynamic centers of the

It is difficult to determine what the effective dihedral is for a wing ta-


pered in planform and thickness. The angle measured between the plane,
airfoils.

passed through the mean aerodynamic chord and parallel to the locus of
the aerodynamic centers of the airfoils, and the horizontal plane, will give
the accepted value.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

In Figure XVIl-19, (A) illustrates a negative dihedral angle often used


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

to counteract the effect of a high degree of sweepback. Some airplanes

FIGURE XVII- 19. Various configurations showing dihedral. The angles have been
exaggerated in magnitude to show contrast. The dihedral angle is measured between
the horizontal plane and 1t plane through the locus of the aerodynamic centers of the
airfoil11.

Original from
D IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
318 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
318

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


show this droop appearance because of the aerodynamic twist of the wing
show this droop appearance because of the aerodynamic twist of the wing

rather than the dihedral. The usual negative dihedral varies from 3
rather than the dihedral. The usual negative dihedral varies from 3

to 6 degrees.
to 6 degrees.
(B) combines a negative dihedral for the root section and a positive
(B) combines a negative dihedral for the root section and a positive
dihedral for the tip section. Such an arrangement may be employed to

obtain shorter landing-gear members or sufficient clearance for a nose


dihedral for the tip section. Such an arrangement may be employed to
propeller. The positive angle of the dihedral in such a design is greater
obtain shorter landing-gear members or sufficient clearance for a nose
than in a wing that is entirely at a dihedral angle. This serves both to

propeller. The positive angle of the dihedral in such a design is greater


than in a wing that is entirely at a dihedral angle. This serves both to
counteract the negative dihedral and to provide sufficient effectiveness for

the smaller portion of the wing affected. The positive dihedral would

vary from 5 to 10 degrees, depending upon the conditions involved.


counteract the negative dihedral and to provide sufficient effectiveness for
(C) shows no provision for dihedral for the root section, but greater

dihedral for the tip section. Such a design might be employed to obtain
the smaller portion of the wing affected. The positive dihedral would
suitable space in the root section for landing-gear retraction or cargo,
vary from 5 to 10 degrees, depending upon the conditions involved.
fuel, or several of these.

(C) shows no provision for dihedral for the root section, but greater
dihedral for the tip section. Such a design might be employed to obtain
(D) represents the dihedral angle applied to the full wing span. The

angle varies from 3 to 8 degrees.

COMBINATION DIHEDRAL AND SWEEPBACK suitable space in the root section for landing-gear retraction or cargo,
For high-speed designs whose maximum speeds are approaching the

velocity of sound, extreme sweepback is used to obtain lower effective


fuel, or several of these.
Mach numbers, as noted in Chapter III. The extreme sweepback of the
(D) represents the dihedral angle applied to the full wing span. The
wings has necessitated a decrease in built-in dihedral so that in some cases

angle varies from 3 to 8 degrees.


negative dihedral is required. The incorporation of a negative dihedral

gives the front view of an airplane a "droop wing" effect.

/ The dihedral for a conventional airplane improves the lateral stability


COMBINATION DIHEDRAL AND SWEEPBACK
since in an asymmetrical gust, the airplane is rolled over into a sideslip

with the descending wing operating at a higher angle of attack, and there-
For high-speed designs whose maximum speeds are approaching the
fore, greater lift than the ascending wing. The effectiveness of the dihe-
velocity of sound, extreme sweepback is used to obtain lower effective
dral for a given airplane is measured by the rate of change of the rolling-

Mach numbers, as noted in Chapter III. The extreme sweepback of the


wings has necessitated a decrease in built-in dihedral so that in some cases
moment coefficient with the angle of sideslip.

When the wing is swept back, the effective dihedral increases rapidly

with change in the lift coefficient of the wing so that the effectiveness is negative dihedral is required. The incorporation of a negative dihedral
excessive. To decrease this, negative dihedral has to be employed in

gives the front view of an airplane a "droop wing" effect.


combination with large sweepback angles. The combination results in

practically no effective dihedral at low angles of attack or high-speed flight


The dihedral for a conventional airplane improves the lateral stability
since in an asymmetrical gust, the airplane is rolled over into a sideslip
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

and reasonably effective dihedral at high angles of attack or low speed, or

take-off.

with the descending wing operating at a higher angle of attack, and there-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The effect on directional stability of the airplane (measured by the rate

of change with angle of sideslip) of increased negative dihedral is improved


fore, greater lift than the ascending wing. The effectiveness of the dihe-
with increasing angle of attack, while practically no effect is obtained on

dral for a given airplane is measured by the rate of change of the rolling-
moment coefficient with the angle of sideslip.
directional stability by increasing positive dihedral when the wing incor-

porates sweepback.

When the wing is swept back, the effective dihedral increases rapidly
with change in the lift coefficient of the wing so that the effectiveness is
excessive. To decrease this, negative dihedral has to be employed in
combination with large sweepback angles. The combination results in
practically no effective dihedral at low angles of attack or high-speed flight
and reasonably effective dihedral at high angles of attack or low speed, or
take-off.
The effect on directional stability of the airplane (measured by the rate
of change with angle of sideslip) of increased negative dihedral is improved
with increasing angle of attack, while practically no effect is obtained on
directional stability by increasing positive dihedral when the wing incor-
porates sweepback.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 319
DESIGN OF THE WING

319

Moreover, as far as pitching moments are concerned, increasing positive


Moreover, as far as pitching moments are concerned, increasing positive
dihedral with swept-back wings tends towards longitudinal instability, dihedral with swept-back wings tends towards longitudinal instability,
while increasing the negative dihedral with a swept-back wing tends to

while increasing the negative dihedral with a swept-back wing tends to


increase the longitudinal stability.
increase the longitudinal stability.

ANGLE OF INCIDENCE

Theoretically, an airplane designed for high speed should have its wing

set at such an angle to the fuselage that the combination will give the least

ANGLE OF INCIDENCE
possible drag. This setting is difficult to determine without wind-tunnel

tests, due to unknown interference effects. Theoretically, an airplane designed for high speed should have its wing
.^fa good compromise is to set the wing at an angle to the longitudinal axis

set at such an angle to the fuselage that the combination will give the least
possible drag. This setting is difficult to determine without wind-tunnel
of the fuselage corresponding to the angle at which minimum drag occurs.

Other considerations may be the deciding factors such as flap clearance

in the deflected position, or the inconvenient ground angle for the fuselage
tests, due to unknown interference effects.
~good compromise is to set the wing at an angle to the longitudinal axis
when in the three-point landing position. The former case usually requires

of the fuselage corresponding to the angle at which minimum drag occurs.


a smaller fixed angle of wing setting while the latter requires a larger angle

of incidence.

To obtain a desired lift distribution of the wing especially near the tip

Other considerations may be the deciding factors such as flap clearance


in the deflected position, or the inconvenient ground angle for the fuselage
where premature stalling is undesirable, as well as to change the stalling

characteristics of different sections, the various airfoil sections are given

different angles of incidence which result in the so-called aerodynamic when in the three-point landing position. The former case usually requires
twist. Formerly, wash-in and wash-out was resorted to for the wing-tip

a smaller fixed angle of wing setting while the latter requires a larger angle
section only, but it is now customary to study every section along the

wing and to develop the change of angles of incidence carefully so that cer-
of incidence.
tain specific results may be obtained.

To obtain a desired lift distribution of the wing especially near the tip
A wing is said to have zero aerodynamic twist when the zero lift lines

of all airfoils from the root of the wing outboard are parallel.
where premature stalling is undesirable, as well as to change the stalling
High-speed aircraft require low drag of the wing-fuselage combination, characteristics of different sections, the various airfoil sections are given
especially at cruising speed at high altitude, with the result that the angle

different angles of incidence which result in the so-called aerodynamic


of incidence of the wing with relation to the fuselage axis is relatively large.

The resulting angle happens to be useful in simplifying the landing-gear


twist. Formerly, wash-in and wash-out was resorted to for the wing-tip
design since the fuselage ground angle is reduced as well.
section only, but it is now customary to study every section along the
However, the large angle of incidence of the wing causes the airplane

fuselage to fly "nose-down" at high speeds. This negative inclination of


wing and to develop the change of angles of incidence carefully so that cer-
the fuselage tends to reduce the damping of oscillations resulting from a
tain specific results may be obtained.
sideslip, while the reverse is true when the inclination of the fuselage is

A wing is said to have zero aerodynamic twist when the zero lift lines
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

of all airfoils from the root of the wing outboard are parallel.
positive. The difference in the fuselage axis and the wing chord axis

causes coupling of inertia forces in such a manner that a rolling accelera-

High-speed aircraft require low drag of the wing-fuselage combination,


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

tion produces a yawing moment and a yawing moment produces a rolling

moment.

For high-speed flight at high altitude, the thin wings have a relatively
especially at cruising speed at high altitude, with the result that the angle
larger angle of attack than might be expected for the subsonic designs.
of incidence of the wing with relation to the fuselage axis is relatively large.
In order to reduce the over-all drag of the wing and the fuselage, the wing

The resulting angle happens to be useful in simplifying the landing-gear


design since the fuselage ground angle is reduced as well.
However, the large angle of incidence of the wing causes the airplane
fuselage to fly "nose-down" at high speeds. This negative inclination of
the fuselage tends to reduce the damping of oscillations resulting from a
sideslip, while the reverse is true when the inclination of the fuselage is
positive. The difference in the fuselage axis and the wing chord axis
causes coupling of inertia forces in such a manner that a rolling accelera-
tion produces a yawing moment and a yawing moment produces a rolling
moment.
For high-speed flight at high altitude, the thin wings have a relatively
larger angle of attack than might be expected for the subsonic designs.
In order to reduce the over-all drag of the wing and the fuselage, the wing

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
320 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
320

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


is set at a relatively larger angle of incidence to the fuselage so that at
is set at a relatively larger angle of incidence to the fuselage so that at

high speeds the combination will present the optimum configuration.


high speeds the combination will present the optimum configuration.
The angle of incidence is dependent upon the airfoil chosen and the aspect
The angle of incidence is dependent upon the airfoil chosen and the aspect
ratio of the wing. Whereas for subsonic designs, the angle of incidence

ratio of the wing. Whereas for subsonic designs, the angle of incidence
of the root chord to the wing is of the order of 1, 2, or 3 degrees, for tran-
of the root chord to the wing is of the order of 1, 2, or 3 degrees, for tran-

sonic and supersonic designs, the angle of incidence is about twice those

values. sonic and supersonic designs, the angle of incidence is about twice those
WING LOADING

For high rates of climb and high service ceiling, relatively low wing
values.
loadings (W/S) are required, especially for the subsonic range.

If no lift-increase device is employed, the limitations on the wing load-


WING LOADING
> ing are (1) the maximum lift coefficient obtainable, and (2) the permissible

landing speed, which is likely to be about the same as the stalling speed.
For high rates of climb and high service ceiling, relatively low wmg
The personal or small executive airplane is likely to dispense with lift-
loadings (W / S) are required, especially for the subsonic range.
increase devices because of the additional cost and the reduction in the

,. If no lift-increase device is employed, the limitations on the wing load-


ing are (1) the maximum lift coefficient obtainable, and (2) the permissible
margin left for cargo and pay load. These aircraft are likely to have

wing loadings between 10 and 18 pounds per square foot.

For commercial airplanes, high speed—if any one performance charac-


landing speed, which is likely to be about the same as the stalling speed.
teristic can be singled out—is probably the determining factor in design.

Assuming the power or thrust is available, then in order to achieve the


The personal or small executive airplane is likely to dispense with lift-
high speed, relatively high wing loadings are necessary. Thus, for this
increase devices because of the additional cost and the reduction in the
class of airplanes, one may expect to find wing loadings of from 18 to 80

margin left for cargo and pay load. These aircraft are likely to have
wing loadings between 10 and 18 pounds per square foot.
pounds per square foot. To obtain reasonable landing speeds, lift-

increase devices—most of which are more commonly known as wing

brakes—have to be incorporated into the wing design. For commercial airplanes, high speed-if any one performance charac-
Military airplanes in the predominantly high-speed category are not

teristic can be singled out-is probably the determining factor in design.


necessarily limited in landing speeds—certainly not to speeds of the order

of magnitude of 65 to miles per hour. To obtain high top speeds, it is


Assuming the power or thrust is available, then in order to achieve the
also necessary to raise the landing speeds. Here, the wing loadings are
high speed, relatively high wing loadings are necessary. Thus, for this
class of airplanes, one may expect to find wing loadings of from 18 to 80
likely to be exceptionally high—although lift-increase devices will prob-

ably not be used—so that values between 45 and 70 pounds per square

foot are to be expected. Wing loadings up to 150 pounds per square pounds per square foot. To obtain reasonable landing speeds, lift-
foot are not uncommon.

increase devices-most of which are more commonly known as wing


ASPECT RATIOS

Aspect ratios for wings operating at subsonic speeds vary from 6 to 12,
brakes-have to be incorporated into the wing design.
Military airplanes in the predominantly high-speed category are not
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

) with the higher aspect ratio usually indicated for turboprop-powered

aircraft operating at high altitudes. In order to make large aircraft

necessarily limited in landing speeds-certainly not to speeds of the order


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

economical, relatively high wing loadings are required, resulting in rela-

tively small wetted surface for the lifting surface as compared with the
of magnitude of 65 to miles per hour. To obtain high top speeds, it is
fuselage and engine nacelles. To offset the larger proportion of the

also necessary to raise the landing speeds. Here, the wing loadings are
likely to be exceptionally high-although lift-increase devices will prob-
parasitic drag, the induced drag can be materially reduced by incorpora-

ably not be used- so that values between 45 and 70 pounds per square
foot are to be expected. Wing loadings up to 150 pounds per square
foot are not uncommon.

ASPECT RATIOS
Aspect ratios for wings operating at subsonic speeds vary from 6 to 12,
with the higher aspect ratio usually indicated for turboprop-powered
aircraft operating at high altitudes. In order to make large aircraft
economical, relatively high wing loadings are required, resulting in rela-
tively small wetted surface for the lifting surface as compared with the
fuselage and engine nacelles. To offset the larger proportion of the
parasitic drag, the induced drag can be materially reduced by incorpora-

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 321
DESIGN OF THE WING

321

tion of the high aspect ratio. Increasing the aspect ratio from 6 to 12
tion of the high aspect ratio. Increasing the aspect ratio from 6 to 12
cuts the induced drag in half. A better lift over drag ratio (L/D) for the
cuts the induced drag in half. A better lift over drag ratio (L/D) for the
complete airplane may be expected throughout the entire flying range,

complete airplane may be expected throughout the entire flying range,


and therefore better performance is a result.
and therefore better performance is a result.

For the personal or private business airplane, aspect ratios between 5

and 8 are common. For the personal or private business airplane, aspect ratios between 5
Aspect ratios for high-speed airplanes operating at transonic or greater

speeds vary with the designs. Some idea of the selection of the aspect
and 8 are common.
ratio may be obtained from Figure XVII-13 which indicates the relation-
Aspect ratios for high-speed airplanes operating at transonic or greater
ship between aspect ratio and sweepback angle. Based on data for

speeds vary with the designs. Some idea of the selection of the aspect
ratio may be obtained from Figure XVII-13 which indicates the relation-
American transport airplanes, with gross weights between 5,000 and

150,000 pounds and operating at wing loadings between 18 and 80 pounds

per square foot, the aspect ratios vary between 6.5 and 12, with the higher ship between aspect ratio and sweepback angle. Based on data for
aspect ratios for the higher wing loadings. The following linear relation-

American transport airplanes, with gross weights between 5,000 and


ship gives a reasonable approximation:

For speeds between 500 and 650 miles per hour, foreign fighter airplanes
150,000 pounds and operating at wing loadings between 18 and 80 pounds
have aspect ratios ranging between 4 and 7 for wing loadings between

per square foot, the aspect ratios vary between 6.5 and 12, with the higher
aspect ratios for the higher wing loadings. The following linear relation-
44 and 72 pounds per square foot. The relationship between them may

be expressed as:

W ship gives a reasonable approximation:


^ = 10.4 AR.
---,
o

For aircraft operating at speeds between 400 and 800 mph, the follow-
AR = 5 + _!_
12 s
(W)·
ing empirical formula based on thrust loading seems reasonable:

For speeds between 500 and 650 miles per hour, foreign fighter airplanes
AR = 3 + 1.175 ~

AIRFOIL THICKNESS AND THICKNESS RATIOS


have aspect ratios ranging between 4 and 7 for wing loadings between
In considering the relative suitability of an airfoil for locating the front
44 and 72 pounds per square foot. The relationship between them may
be expressed as:
and rear spars of a two-spar system, the thickness ratios at various sta-

tions along the chord with reference to the maximum thickness ratio

may be examined.

Since
w=
S 10.4 AR.
d

For aircraft operating at speeds between 400 and 800 mph, the follow-
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ing empirical formula based on thrust loading seems reasonable:

AR=3+1.175~·
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

AIRFOIL THICKNESS AND THICKNESS RATIOS


In considering the relative suitability of an airfoil for locating the front
and rear spars of a two-spar system, the thickness ratios at various sta-
tions along the chord with reference to the maximum thickness ratio
may be examined.
Since

and
d,
y:::::: _
2

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
322 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
322

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL and


and

/ « bds,
I = bd3,
where d/2 is the distance from the neutral axis to the outermost fiber of

the section under consideration, where in this case d is the depth of the
where d/2 is the distance from the neutral axis to the outermost fiber of
airfoil at station under consideration,
the section under consideration, where in this case d is the depth of the
then

airfoil at station under consideration,


f ~L

h d2

then
A "measure" may be devised by obtaining the ratio of d2 at any station

to the value of d2 for the maximum thickness of the airfoil.

Table XVII-1. Data calculated for a few representative airfoils.

Chord

NACA

23018
A "measure" may be devised by obtaining the ratio of d2 at any station
NACA
to the value of d2 for the maximum thickness of the airfoil.
0018

NACA TABLE XVII-I. Data calculated for a few representative airfoils.


63018

I
NACA

643018
Chord NACA 23018 NACA 0018 NACA 63018 NACA 643'}18
station
station
d
d d 2 /dmaz 2 d d2/d,,.az2 d d 2 /dm,.,, 2 d d 2 /dmaz 2
d

dydma2
% % % % % % % % %
d
5.0 10.72 35.8 10.68 35.0 8.724 23.4 8.372 22.8
d
7.5 12.61 49.5 12.60 48.8 10.616 34.3 10.152 33.7
d*/dmax2
10.0 14.05 61.3 14.04 60.7 12.136 45.5 11.606 43.7
%
15.0 16.04 80.1 16.04 79.2 14.450 64.2 13.884 62.5
%
20.0 17.22 92.1 17.20 91.1 16.096 75.8 15.564 78.5
%
30.0 17.92 100.0 18.00 100.0 17.826 98.0 17.578 100.0
% 35.0 -- -- -- -- 18.000 100.0 -- --
% 50.0 15.86 78.2 15.88 77.7 15.884 77.5 16.228 85.6
% 60.0 13.69 58.2 13.68 57.5 12.910 51.5 13.316 57.7
%
70.0 11.00 37.6 11.00 37.3 9.244 26.2 9.684 30.4
%
80.0 7.88 19.3 7.88 19.1 5.382 8.9 5.776 10.8
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

5.0
Chord stations and d are given in percentage of the wing chord.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

10.72

35.8
It will be noted that relative depths and effectiveness of the NACA
10.68

23018 and NACA 0018 are the same. It will also be noted that locating
the front spar at 153 of the chord appreciably increases the moment of
35.0

8.724

23.4 inertia. Similar investigations may be made for other thickness ratios
8.372

22.8
and are equally applicable whether one, two, or more spars are employed,
7.5
. or whether some other type of construction is used.
12.61

For subsonic airplanes, thickness ratios for the wing at the root may
vary from 12 to 21 per cent, with the smaller ratio possible for low-aspect-
49.5

12.60

48.8 ratio wings. At the wing tip, either 9 to 12 per cent thickness ratios are
10.616

common.
34.3

10.152
As the speed of the aircraft approaches or exceeds the velocity of sound,
33.7
thinner airfoils are required. This makes thickness ratios of 7 to 10 per cent
10.0

14.05
reasonably common. Indeed, thickness ratios of 5 per cent or even less
61.3
are being considered, especially for wings of low aspect ratios such as the
14.04

delta wings.
60.7

12.136

45.5

11.606

43.7

Original from
15.0

16.04
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
80.1

16.04

79.2
DESIGN OF THE WING 323
DESIGN OF THE WING

323

WING-FUSELAGE CONFIGURATIONS
WING-FUSELAGE CONFIGURATIONS

A discussion of various wing-fuselage configurations has been given in


A discussion of various wing-fuselage configurations has been given in
Chapter II, Types of Airplanes. There is also some discussion of this

Chapter II, Types of Airplanes. There is also some discussion of this


subject in Chapter XXI, The Fuselage. Every configuration has certain

advantages and disadvantages which the designer must evaluate.


subject in Chapter XXI, The Fuselage. Every configuration has certain
In the delta-wing designs, the fuselage becomes an integral portion of advantages and disadvantages which the designer must evaluate.
the wing structure over the entire root-chord length since a multi-spar

In the delta-wing designs, the fuselage becomes an integral portion of


design is usually employed. Moreover, due to the length of the root

chord, the depth of the wing becomes appreciable and easily accommodates
the wing structure over the entire root-chord length since a multi-spar
the fuselage requirements.
design is usually employed. Moreover, due to the length of the root
METAL WING CONSTRUCTION r

Since the wing (considered as a structural unit) is essentially a beam,


chord, the depth of the wing becomes appreciable and easily accommodates
different solutions are theoretically possible for a suitable internal struc- the fuselage requirements.
ture. Figure XVII-20 presents a number of these likely solutions, ar-

ranged in order of increasing complexity of configuration.

Figure A may be used for high-speed aircraft employing relatively thin

wings. Its advantages are:


METAL WING CONSTRUCTION t
1. Distribution of material as far away from the neutral axis as possible.

Since the wing (considered as a structural unit) is essentially a beam,


different solutions are theoretically possible for a suitable internal struc-
2. May be tapered in cross section span wise, either through milling to

the proper thicknesses or through building up of excessive layers properly

bonded to each other. ture. Figure XVll-20 presents a number of these likely solutions, ar-
3. Especially suitable for lifting surfaces having no attachments or

movable control surfaces.


ranged in order of increasing complexity of configuration.
The disadvantages may be listed as: Figure A may be used for high-speed aircraft employing relatively thin
1. Difficulty in disposing control rods, cables, and the like in the interior.

2. High weight, which may be attributed to the small depth available,


wings. Its advantages are:
since this type of construction would probably not be utilized for deeper 1. Distribution of material as far away from the neutral axis as possible.
wing sections.

Figure B is a modification of Figure A. The spanwise stiffeners are


2. May be tapered in cross section spanwise, either through milling to
integrally incorporated with the skin. This type of construction may be
the proper thicknesses or through building up of excessive layers properly
utilized for deeper wing sections where the skin may be somewhat less,

bonded to each other.


3. Especially suitable for lifting surfaces having no attachments or
but may need spanwise support.

Figure C is a design long considered. Variations of it have been used,

particularly for gliders. movable control surfaces.


The disadvantages may be listed as:
Its advantages are:
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1. The vertical shear-web spar may be located at the chord station of

greatest depth rather than at a station of less depth and may therefore

l. Difficulty in disposing control rods, cables, and the like in the interior.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2. High weight, which may be attributed to the small depth available,


sustain the bending moment most efficiently.

2. The torsional moment may be taken care of by the wing envelope.

3. The number of individual units is small.


since this type of construction would probably not be utilized for deeper
wing sections.
Figure B is a modification of Figure A. The spanwise stiffeners are
integrally incorporated with the skin. This type of construction may be
utilized for deeper wing sections where the skin may be somewhat less,
but may need spanwise support.
Figure C is a design long considered. Variations of it have been used,
particularly for gliders.
Its advantages are:
1. The vertical shear-web spar may be located at the chord station of
greatest depth rather than at a station of less depth and may therefore
sustain the bending moment most efficiently.
2. The torsional moment may be taken care of by the wing envelope.
3. The number of individual units is small.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
324 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
324 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVII-20. Different methods of wing construction.

The disadvantages of the type of construction shown in Figure C may be

enumerated as:

1. The addition of aileron and flaps necessitate a supporting spar which,

for optimum design, might as well work in conjunction with the main
(a}
spar. Thus, the ultimate design of this type of structure would lead to a

two-spar structure.

2. The wing envelope has to be attached to the fuselage side in order to

avoid transferring torsional moments to the spar, which, unless it is itself

of box construction, would be an inefficient torsional member. The skin

..J
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII- 20. Different methods of wing construction.

The disadvantages of the type of construction shown in Figure C may be


enumerated as:
1. The addition of aileron and flaps necessitate a supporting spar which,
for optimum design, might as well work in conjunction with the main
spar. Thus, the ultimate design of this type of structure would lead to a
two-spar structure.
2. The wing envelope has to be attached to the fuselage side in order to
avoid transferring torsional moments to the spar, which, unless it is itself
of box construction, would be an inefficient torsional member. The skin

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 325
DESIGN OF THE WING

325

is of no benefit in carrying the wing bending moment. There may be


is of no benefit in carrying the wing bending moment. There may be

handling difficulties with thin skins.


handling difficulties with thin skins.
3. The skin may form wrinkles when the spar bends and thus present a
3. The skin may form wrinkles when the spar bends and thus present a
poor aerodynamic form.

4. The skin is of no benefit for sustaining any bending moments, and


poor aerodynamic form.
may therefore be a contributor of inefficient material leading to excess
4. The skin is of no benefit for sustaining any bending moments, and
weight.

may therefore be a contributor of inefficient material leading to excess


Figure D is a two-spar or multi-rib design with the chordwise ribs spaced

relatively close together. There are no spanwise stringers or stiffeners,


weight.
and the skin is subject to torsional stresses only.
Figure Dis a two-spar or multi-rib design with the chordwise ribs spaced
The favorable aspects of this structural configuration are:

1. No stringer cut-outs in ribs, thereby reducing fabrication difficulties


relatively close together. There are no spanwise stringers or stiffeners,
and the number of individual parts.
and the skin is subject to torsional stresses only.
2. Minimum thicknesses, and therefore minimum weight of the sheet

covering.
The favorable aspects of this structural configuration are:
3. Minimum weight penalty for cut-outs because the skin is less highly
1. No stringer cut-outs in ribs, thereby reducing fabrication difficulties
stressed than in other forms of construction where it has to withstand

both shear and compression or shear and tension stresses.


and the number of individual parts.
4. Simplicity of construction of a two-spar system with load concentra-
2. Minimum thicknesses, and therefore minimum weight of the sheet
tion in the spar chords leads to simpler fittings, whether for attachment

covermg.
to the fuselage or a wing folding joint, or for landing-gear attachments.

There are some disadvantages, such as:


3. Minimum weight penalty for cut-outs because the skin is less highly
1. Relatively smaller effective depth for the spars, which are usually
stressed than in other forms of construction where it has to withstand
located at about 15% and 70% of the chord.

2. Closer rib spacing is needed to carry the air loads into the spars
both shear and compression or shear and tension stresses.
which are the main bending moment resistant members.
4. Simplicity of construction of a two-spar system with load concentra-
3. Undesirable wrinkling between ribs, leading to poor aerodynamic

tion in the spar chords leads to simpler fittings, whether for attachment
form.

4. Possible handling difficulties with thin skin unless the skin thickness
to the fuselage or a wing folding joint, or for landing-gear attachments.
is increased to enable it to carry some compressive stress.

There are some disadvantages, such as:


Figure E illustrates one of the more popular types of construction used

in reinforced monocoque designs. Its advantages are: 1. Relatively smaller effective depth for the spars, which are usually
1. Utilization of the skin in bending as well as in torsion.

located at about 153 and 703 of the chord.


2. Readily available means for resisting wrinkling or buckling of the

skin by supporting it in smaller panel sizes.


2. Closer rib spacing is needed to carry the air loads into the spars
which are the main bending moment resistant members.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. Relatively fewer ribs or formers and correspondingly fewer fabrica-

tion difficulties.

3. Undesirable wrinkling between ribs, leading to poor aerodynamic


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

4. Greater opportunity for distributing stresses caused by cut-outs,

attachments, and local loads. form.


5. Rugged construction leading to easy maintenance and handling.

4. Possible handling difficulties with thin skin unless the skin thickness
is increased to enable it to carry some compressive stress.
No structure is without some attendant disadvantages. For Figure

E, these are:

Figure E illustrates one of the more popular types of construction used


in reinforced monocoque designs. Its advantages are:
1. Utilization of the skin in bending as well as in torsion.
2. Readily available means for resisting wrinkling or buckling of the
skin by supporting it in smaller panel sizes.
3. Relatively fewer ribs or formers and correspondingly fewer fabrica-
tion difficulties. ·
4. Greater opportunity for distributing stresses caused by cut-outs,
attachments, and local loads.
5. Rugged construction leading to easy maintenance and handling.
No structure is without some attendant disadvantages. For Figure
E, these are :

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
326 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
326

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


1. Tie-in with fuselage structure offers difficulties.
1. Tie-in with fuselage structure offers difficulties.

2. More riveting and bolting required than for other types.


2. More riveting and bolting required than for other types.
Figure F depicts a multi-spar type which has these advantages:
Figure F depicts a multi-spar type which has these advantages:
1. Unusually rugged construction suitable for rather large aircraft.
1. Unusually rugged construction suitable for rather large aircraft.

2. Relative ease in taking care of cut-outs, attachments, and the like.

3. Possible "fail-safe" design since a local failure can be completely


2. Relative ease in taking care of cut-outs, attachments, and the like.
localized.

4. Wing deflections are less than for any other type shown.
3. Possible "fail-safe" design since a local failure can be completely
5. Wrinkling of skin is minimized.
localized.
6. Number of former ribs may be reduced.

4. Wing deflections are less than for any other type shown.
5. Wrinkling of skin is minimized.
Among the disadvantages are:

1. More fabrication.

2. Less accessibility to the interior due to greater compartmentization.


6. Number of former ribs may be reduced.
Among the disadvantages are:
3. Possible greater structural weight due to inefficient use of material.

The final structure of the wing is dependent upon its final arrangement

on the location of the aileron, the flap, the fuel tanks, the retractable land-

1. More fabrication.
ing gear, and any other items peculiar to the particular design.

Figure XVII-21. A cutaway sketch showing one type of metal wing construction.
2. Less accessibility to the interior due to greater compartmentization.
In order to save weight, tapering of the wing cover as a function of the
3. Possible greater structural weight due to inefficient use of material.
The final structure of the wing is dependent upon its final arrangement
loading must be considered for the thin wings operating at transonic or

supersonic speeds. Some of the recent designs have had thicknesses of

1% inches and more at the root section. For missile designs, such wing
on the location of the aileron, the flap, the fuel tanks, the retractable land-
covers may be cast from a magnesium alloy. However cast wing covers

are not used for manned aircraft receiving repeated use, primarily because
ing gear, and any other items peculiar to the particular design.
of the relatively low strength characteristics and relatively poor resistance

to vibration.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII-21. A cutaway sketch showing ·one type of metal wing construction.

In order to save weight, tapering of the wing cover as a function of the


loading must be considered for the thin wings operating at transonic or
supersonic speeds. Some of the recent designs have had thicknesses of
1% inches and more at the root section. For missile designs, such wing
covers may be cast from a magnesium alloy. However cast wing covers
are not used for manned aircraft receiving repeated use, primarily because
of the relatively low strength characteristics and relatively poor resistance
to vibration.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 327

FIGURE XVII-22. The underside of an inner wing panel showing numerous cutouts
for inspection purposes, retraction of landing gear, etc. Note the spar fittings for
attachment to engaging fittings at the fuselage.

SPARS AND THEIR LOCATION


In general, a spar is thought of as a member having a relatively large
area of material in the flanges, chords, or caps located at the top and
bottom of the member, with a relatively thin shear web connecting the
two. It may be classed as a tension-field beam or as a shear-resistant
beam.
The tension-field beam allows the shear web to wrinkle, and thus the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

transverse shear is resisted by tension in more or less the same way as a


wire-braced truss. Such beams have been used extensively for aircraft
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

because they are relatively light. For examples, see Figure XVII-23.
In some cases the deflection-especially that due to shear-has been con-
sidered excessive. The wrinkling of the web would not occur until the
limit load was imposed, so that at loads less than the limit load, the spar
could be considered a shear-resistant beam.
The shear-resistant beam (See Figure XVII-24) is designed so that the
shear web will not wrinkle under limit loads. Shear-resistant beams are
often used in railroad-bridge construction when the bridges are relatively
short in span. In order to increase the shear load that the web can with-
stand, stiffeners are attached at specified intervals.
Beams such as I-beams and box spars may be classed in either the ten-
sion-field or shear-resistant spar categories.
The fact that the line of demarcation between the tension-field and the
shear-resistant beams is not too precise makes detailed stress analysis
required. Should the web be designed so that it does not buckle under

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
328 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
328

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVII-24. The "tension-field" spar on the left, or modifications thereof,


- ------1....----1 ----1-........,_..
~

are in common use. The one on the right shows a "shear-type" spar with lightening

holes.

----- - - - - - - - - - ---

~o~o~o~
- - -- - - - - - - - - - - - - -
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII-23. Spars of the tension-field variety which show the various designs
possible.

FIGURE XVII-24. The "tension-field" spar on the left, or modifications thereof,


are in common use. The one on the right shows a "shear-type" spar with lightening
holes.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 329
DESIGN OF THE WING

329

the action of the limit load, the spar or beam would be considered a normal
the action of the limit load, the spar or beam would be considered a normal
shear-resistant beam; if allowed to buckle, it would be considered a ten-
shear-resistant beam; if allowed to buckle, it would be considered a ten-
sion-field beam. A pure tension-field beam is difficult to obtain, and

sion-field beam. A pure tension-field beam is difficult to obtain, and


most airplane. spars fall in the semi-tension-field category.
most airplane-spars fall in the semi-tension-field category.

Since the dimensions of a spar obviously depend upon the loads im-

posed and the depth of the wing available, it is difficult to give many
Since the dimensions of a spar obviously depend upon the loads im-
guiding dimensions. However in general, a tension-field beam would have

a shear web made of sheet material at least 0.025 inches thick and chord
posed and the depth of the wing available, it is difficult to give many
members with thicknesses two or more times that of the sheet. For a
guiding dimensions. However in general, a tension-field beam would have
shear-resistant beam, extruded sections are common where the thickness

a shear web made of sheet material at least 0.025 inches thick and chord
members with thicknesses two or more times that of the sheet. For a
of the web is about the same order of magnitude as the chord members.

Truss-type spars (See Figure XVII-25) have been used only rarely in

recent designs. For small aircraft, the truss-type spar has some merit as shear-resistant beam, extruded sections are common where the thickness
far as weight is concerned.

of the web is about the same order of magnitude as the chord members.
For a mono-spar wing, the spar would be located at the maximum

depth of the airfoil.


Truss-type spars (See Figure XVII-25) have been used only rarely in
Figure XVII-25. Suggested truss-type spar construction. Trusses are used rela-

recent designs. For small aircraft, the truss-type spar has some merit as
tively infrequently.

For a two-spar system, the front spar is located at from 12 to 17 per


far as weight is concerned.
cent of the chord, with the rear spar located at from 65 to 75 per cent of
For a mono-spar wing, the spar would be located at the maximum
the wing chord. While analyses could be made to determine the optimum

depth of the airfoil.


spacing of a two-spar system on the basis of center of pressure travel in

the normal flight regime and the load factors encountered at low and high

I
A
angles of attack (since not only the magnitude but also the distribution of

~-.._

I I
/:Sf"
---- - ~ - --1--

l
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

t
FIGURE XVII-25.
tively infrequently.
Suggested truss-type spar construction. Trusses are used rela-

For a two-spar system, the front spar is located at from 12 to 17 per ' -,
cent of the chord, with the rear spar located at from 65 to 75 per cent of
the wing chord. While analyses could be made to determine the optimum
spacing of a two-spar system on the basis of center of pressure travel in
the normal flight regime and the load factors encountered at low and high
angles of attack (since not only the magnitude but also the distribution of

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
330 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
330

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVII-26. A bolted fitting holding two sections of a spar together.

the loads has to be considered), the above percentages of chord locations

are common.
•• •
-
For a multi-spar design, it would be desirable to have the shear center


of the structural system coincide with the center of pressure. Since the


center of pressure of the wing varies with the angle of attack and there-

fore may vary as much as 25 per cent of the chord (more with trailing

edge flaps), it is difficult to pinpoint the desirable location of the shear



center.

Combination of spars and stringers, as well as the wing envelope, make

up the more common type of wing structures where the spars lose their

identity to some extent and are more commonly referred to as shear webs.

The spars vary not only in depth for the tapered wing, but also in the

cross-sectional area of the spar chords. If the spar chords are milled or

forged, the variation in cross-sectional area can be made without serious

discontinuities. In the built-up spar chords, plates may be added at the

root, and then discontinued at suitable intervals along the span. Since

FtGURE XVII-26. A bolted fitting holding two sections of a spar together.


the spar members will most likely have to be spliced, a reduction in thick-

ness can be made for the adjacent outboard member. If two angles back

to back form a Tee section for the inboard section of the spar, one of the

angles may be discontinued for the outboard section. In case of any


the loads has to be considered), the above percentages of chord locations
changes, special precautions must be taken to make sure that the dis-

are common.
For a multi-spar design, it would be desirable to have the shear center
continuities in cross-sectional area are not too abrupt; otherwise fatigue

failures may result.

SPANWISE STRINGERS AND THEIR LOCATION of the structural system coincide with the center of pressure. Since the
In an earlier chapter, cross sections of typical spanwise stringers are

center of pressure of the wing varies with the angle of attack and there-
shown. In the discussion on "Metal Wing Construction," it is brought

fore may vary as much as 25 per cent of the chord (more with trailing
edge flaps), it is difficult to pinpoint the desirable location of the shear
center .
.' Combination of spars and stringers, as well as the wing envelope, make
up the more common type of wing structures where the spars lose their
· identity to some extent and are more commonly referred to as shear webs.
The spars vary not only in depth for the tapered wing, but also in the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:53 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

cross-sectional area of the spar chords. If the spar chords are milled or
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

forged, the variation in cross-sectional area can be made without serious


discontinuities. In the built-up spar chords, plates may be added at the
root, and then discontinued at suitable intervals along the span. Since
the spar members will most likely have to be spliced, a reduction in thick-
ness can be made for the adjacent outboard member. If two angles back
to back form a Tee section for the inboard section of the spar, one of the
angles may be discontinued for the outboard section. In case of any
changes, special precautions must be taken to make sure that the dis-
continuities in cross-sectional area are not too abrupt; otherwise fatigue
failures may result.

SPANWISE STRINGERS AND THEIR LOCATION


In an earlier chapter, cross sections of typical spanwise stringers are
shown. In the discussion on "Metal Wing Construction," it is brought

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 331
DESIGN OF THE WING

331

out that spanwise stringers serve to add to the bending strength of the >
out that spanwise stringers serve to add to the bending strength of the 3,
wing.
wmg.
The spacing chordwise of these stringers is arrived at—as it is for the ribs

The spacing chordwise of these stringers is arrived at-as it is for the ribs
-by the optimum proportions of the wing-skin panels, which may be
—by the optimum proportions of the wing-skin panels, which may be

determined from oil-canning considerations before the stress analysis of

the wing has been completed. determined from oil-canning considerations before the stress analysis of
The stringers may be located at a constant percentage loci or spaced

the wing has been completed.


equidistantly apart. Not all the stringers are carried out to the extreme

tip since the wing-tip portion is relatively more rigid—even for the mini-
The stringers may be located at a constant percentage lo.ci or spaced
mum structure—than the inboard sections. Carrying out all the stringers

equidistantly apart. Not all the stringers are carried out to the extreme
to the extreme tip would result in an unnecessarily strong wing portion

in that area. Accordingly, the spanwise stringers are discontinued, a


tip since the wing-tip portion is relatively more rigid-even for the mini-
few at a station, from about the mid-span outboard so as to avoid extreme
mum structure-than the inboard sections. Carrying out all the stringers
discontinuities in cross-sectional area. When stringers are discontinued,

to the extreme tip would result in an unnecessarily strong wing portion


they should have their ends attached to a transverse rib.

Usually the positive load factor will cause greater compressive loads on
in that area. Accordingly, the spanwise stringers are discontinued, a
the top surface of the wing than the negative load factor will cause on the
few at a station, from about the mid-span outboard so as to avoid extreme
bottom. Therefore the stringers on the bottom surface can be lighter in \•

gauge or fewer in number.


discontinuities in cross-sectional area. When stringers are discontinued,
RIBS AND THEIR LOCATION
they should have their ends attached to a transverse rib.
The primary functions of the ribs in the wing are (1) to maintain the ~\

Usually the positive load factor will cause greater compressive loads on
the top surface of the wing than the negative load factor will cause on the
chordwise shape of the airfoil, (2) to act as supports for the panels of the

wing skin or envelope, and (3) to transmit the pressures on the wing to the

o V ^ V ^ \/
bottom. Therefore the stringers on the bottom surface can be lighter in ~­
Figure XVII-27. Cross sections of a metal wing. In the top illustration, corru-

gated sheet with a smooth skin on the outside, serves the same function as spanwise
gauge or fewer in number.
stringers. In the bottom illustration, truss-type ribs, spanwise C-sections, and tension

field spars show one type of metal wing construction. Plain transverse former ribs of
RIBS AND THEIR LOCATION
C-sections may be employed without resorting to any of the truss-type bracing.

The primary functions of the ribs in the wing are (1) to maintain the z.
chordwise shape of the airfoil, (2) to act as supports for the panels of the
wing skin or envelope, and (3) to transmit the pressures on the wing to the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:53 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVIl-27. Cross sections of a metal wing. In the top illustration, corru-
gated sheet with a smooth skin on the outside, serves the same function as spanwise
stringers. In the bottom illustration, truss-type ribs, spanwise C-sections, and tension
field spars show one type of metal wing construction. Plain transverse former ribs of
C-sections may be employed without resorting to any of the truss-type bracing.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
332 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
332

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

spanwise bending members. In some cases, they also serve to act as the

supporting members to which landing-gear members or engine-mount

members are attached, or as supports for fuel tanks, control systems, and

localized loads. In turn, such ribs transmit the loads to the spanwise

spars.

The spacing of ribs may be determined by the need to prevent oil-

canning of the skin or by the optimum panel proportions, as discussed in

/ an earlier chapter. For preliminary considerations, rib spacings from 6

( to 18 inches may be assumed.

Ribs are located at or near centerlines of aileron and flap hinges of fitting

attachments and other supports.

Figures XVII-27, 28, 29 show some rib constructions. It is customary

to assemble the ribs in three sections—the nose section, the center, and

the trailing edge sections—in order to avoid any cut-outs of the spars.

The ribs are notched for the spanwise stringers, which should also be con-

tinuous members.

Unless the transverse ribs have to transmit concentrated loads, the

thickness of the sheet used in their construction may be one gauge lighter

than the skin covering of the wing.

Where concentrated loads are applied to transverse ribs, the rib struc-

ture has to be carefully designed to take the shears and bending moments

FIGURE XVIl-28. A section of a wing showing spars, transverse ribs, and longi-
imposed.

tudinal stringers, all of metal construction. The metal skin is attached to spars, ribs,
and stringers.

spanwise bending members. In some cases, they also serve to act as the
supporting members to which landing-gear members or engine-mount
members are attached, or as supports for fuel tanks, control systems, and
localized loads. In turn, such ribs transmit the loads to the spanwise
spars.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:53 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The spacing of ribs may be determined by the need to prevent oil-


canning of the skin or by the optimum panel proportions, as discussed in
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

an earlier chapter. For preliminary considerations, rib spacings from 6


.· to 18 inches may be assumed.
Ribs are located at or near centerlines of aileron and flap hinges of fitting
attachments and other supports.
Figures XVIl-27, 28, 29 show some rib constructions. It is customary
to assemble the ribs in three sections-the nose section, the center, and
the trailing edge sections-in order to avoid any cut-outs of the spars.
The ribs are notched for the spanwise stringers, which should also be con-
tinuous members.
Unless the transverse ribs have to transmit concentrated loads, the
thickness of the sheet used in their construction may be one gauge lighter
than the skin covering of the wing.
Where concentrated loads are applied to transverse ribs, the rib struc-
ture has to be carefully designed to take the shears and bending moments
imposed.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 333
DESIGN OF THE WING

333

Figure XVII-29. Various metal rib configurations. Flat sheet, beaded and light-

ening holes add to the rigidity of the wing. Truss-type ribs utilize U-sections for

added column strengths for the diagonals. Former ribs, top and bottom, are simplest

in form and are generally satisfactory for wings utilizing occasional ribs of the more

rigid type. The ribs shown are center-section ribs; the nose and tail portions are of

similar construction or utilize methods of other ribs shown for their construction. Ribs

are riveted, by means of integral flanges or separate brackets, to the faces of the spars

or shear webs. The top three ribs show cut-outs for transverse stringers. The skin

covering offers continuity of structure since it is riveted to the ribs and the spanwise

stringers.

-
(Q: 0 - {

'\
I
,
'
I

II
.......... _... '--- .....
/

oOO oQoo
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

[::=====~======::::~

FIGURE XVII- 29. Various metal rib configurations. Flat sheet, beaded and light-
ening holes add to the rigidity of the wing. Truss-type ribs utilize U-sections for
added co}umn strengths for the diagonals. Former ribs, top and bottom, are simplest
in form and are generally satisfactory for wings utilizing occasional ribs of the more
rigid type. The ribs shown are center-section ribs; the nose and tail portions are of
similar construction or utilize methods of other ribs shown for their construction. Ribs
are riveted, by means of integral flanges or separate brackets, to the faces of the spars
or shear webs. The top three ribs show cut-outs for transverse stringers. The skin
covering offers continuity of structure since it is riveted to the ribs and the spanwise
stringers.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
334 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
334

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

V--""' (a)

WING-FUSELAGE ATTACHMENTS

The problem of providing attachments for the wing structure to the

fuselage merits considerable attention and detailed study, except for

the flying wing or some delta-wing designs where the fuselage becomes

practically an integral part of the wing structure.

If no other considerations but the structural were involved, it would

be desirable to support a wing not only at the fuselage, but at some point

outboard. The two-spar wing lends itself most conveniently to the ex-

ternal support.
J
The effects of different methods of wing support are illustrated in Figure

XVII-30.

Figure A shows two external configurations for the same wing spar—

one full cantilever when the lift strut, shown dotted, is supplied.

Figure B illustrates a spanwise lift loading, making no allowance for tip

losses which would be the same regardless of the wing support.

Figures C, D, and• E present the spanwise distribution of the bending

(e)
From this point outboard,
the bending moments for
all these cases are the same

FIGURE XVIl-30. The effect of wing support on bending moments.


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

WING-FUSELAGE ATTACHMENTS
The problem of providing attachments for the wing structure to the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

fuselage merits considerable attention and detailed study, except for


the flying wing or some delta-wing designs where the fuselage becomes
practically an integral part of the wing structure.
If no other considerations but the structural were involved, it would
be desirable to support a wing not only at the fuselage, but at some point
outboard. The two-spar wing lends itself most conveniently to the ex-
ternal support.
The effects of different methods of wing support are illustrated in Figure
XVIl-30.
Figure A shows two external configurations for the same wing spar-
one full cantilever when the lift strut, shown dotted, is supplied.
Figure B illustrates a spanwise lift loading, making no allowance for tip
losses which would be the same regardless of the wing support.
Figures C, D, and E present the spanwise distribution of the bending

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 335
DESIGN OF THE WING

moment when (in C) the wing is full cantilever; when (in D) the wing is
335

moment when (in C) the wing is full cantilever; when (in D) the wing is

externally supported and pinned at the fuselage; when (in E) the wing is externally supported and pinned at the fuselage; when (in E) the wing is
externally supported and fixed at the fuselage. The pinned condition is

externally supported and fixed at the fuselage. The pinned condition is


obtained by the use of a single pin placed parallel to the wing chord. For

a pinned connection, no bending moment can be transmitted to the ad-


obtained by the use of a single pin placed parallel to the wing chord. For
jacent structure. For a fixed condition, two or more horizontal pins
a pinned connection, no bending moment can be transmitted to the ad-
placed parallel to the chord are common. A vertical pin accomplishes the

same result—a many-riveted or bolted connection tying the wing spar to


jacent structure. For a fixed condition, two or more horizontal pins
the fuselage structure. In all cases where the lift struts are employed,
placed parallel to the chord are common. A vertical pin accomplishes the
pin connections are used at the ends, with the pin parallel to the wing

same result- a many-riveted or bolted connection tying the wing spar to


the fuselage structure. In all cases where the lift struts are employed,
chord or line of flight so that only axial loads are imposed upon the struts.

Schematic diagrams of various externally-supported wing configurations

are shown in Figure XVII-31.


pin connections are used at the ends, with the pin parallel to the wing
I

Figure XVII-31. Various external support arrangements for a semi-cantilever wing.


chord or line of flight so that only axial loads are imposed upon the struts.
The primary advantage of supporting a wing externally is that the re-
Schematic diagrams of various externally-supported wing configurations
duction in bending moments imposed produces a lighter structure. If a

are shown in Figure XVII- 31.


smaller bending moment is imposed, a thinner wing, (i.e., a wing of a lower

thickness ratio) could be used. If the wing can be pin-connected to the

fuselage, that structure will be subjected to axial or direct loads only,

and there will therefore be fewer complications in the design of the fuselage

structure at that point. Any gains in the wing construction may be

offset by the additional supporting structure.

Schematic diagrams of full cantilever wing attachments to the fuselage

are given in Figure XVII-32 and are described as follows:

Figure A. The fuselage transverse frame and wing spar assembled as


Generated on 2012-05-30 04:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Frn URE XVII -31. Various external support arrangements for a semi-cantilever wing.
The primary advantage of supporting a wing externally is that the re-
duction in bending moments imposed produces a lighter structure. If a
smaller bending moment is imposed, a thinner wing, (i.e., a wing of a lower
thickness ratio) could be used. If the wing can be pin-connected to the
fuselage, that structure will be subjected to axial or direct loads only,
and the.re will therefore be fewer complications in the design of the fuselage
structure at that point. Any gains in the wing construction may be
offset by the additional supporting structure.
Schematic diagrams of full cantilever wing attachments to the fuselage
are given in Figure XVII-32 and are described as follows:
Figure A. The fuselage transverse frame and wing spar assembled as

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
336 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

FIGURE XVII- 32. Some schematic illustrations of wing-fuselage attachments.


an integral structure. The continuous structure is provided by riveting
or bolting of frame to spar web.
Figure B. A full-cantilever wing can be detached at the fuselage by
the removal of one or more vertical pins at the spar fitting.
Figure C. An alternative to the vertical pin is the provision for two or
more horizontal pins located parallel to the plane of symmetry of the
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:58 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

fuselage.
Figure D. Bending moments of the wing are not transmitted to the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

fuselage frame, making for a lighter fuselage frame structure.


Figure XVII- 33 shows a detail of a spar juncture at the fuselage. The

FxouRE XVII-33. A detail of a spar juncture at the fuselage.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 337

FIGURE XVIl- 34. In order to make the stringers effective at the fuselage juncture,
they have to be tied in the transverse frames of the fuselage. The above schematic
sketch shows t he individual fittings attaching the stringers to the fuselage frame.
Another method is shown in the connection of one wing section to another by means of
an external ring (of which only a short section is shown in the Rket,r.h). The load from
the stringer is transmitted gradually to the ring by means of the gusset or doubler plate.

fuselage fitting has to tie in with a rigid transverse fuselage frame. The
wing-spar fitting for a tension-field spar would be similar as that shown
in the illustration.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Figure XVII-34 indicates the proper treatment of a wing having a


number of spanwise stringers. In order to make these stringers fully
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

effective at the root, they would have to tie into a rigid circumferential
chordwise ring, or each stringer would have to be tied, by simple bolt.
fittings or a multi-riveted plate, to the transverse frames of the fuselage.

FABRIC-COVERED WING CONSTRUCTION

The primary structure of the wing consists of the spars, compression


ribs, and drag wires. The compression ribs are so spaced that the result-
ing truss approximates a square, although they may be spaced farther
apart towards the tip of the wing. The spacing may be determined by
hinge locations for flaps or ailerons, and also by the lateral buckling
strength of the spars whose effective column length in the case of lateral
buckling is determined by the compression-rib spacing.
Compression ribs or members do not need to conform to the regular rib
dimensions. Any column, whether plywood, built up to form an I-section,

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
338 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Anti-drag wire
Front spar
leading
edge Compression
rib

Rear spar
Trailing edge
Orog wire
FIGURE XVIl-35. Name designations of the principal or primary structure of a.
fabric-covered wing.
)

plain board, one or two steel tubes, or a built-up aluminum alloy box,
{ would be satisfactory.
Drag bracing usually consists of a double set of wires for internally
braced wings. These wires are spaced as far apart as the depth of the
wing will permit in order to increase the torsional strength of the wing.
Externally braced wings may have a single set of drag truss wires if the
overhang of the wing tip is not greater than the mean chord of the wing.
Instead of wires, compression members along one diagonal may be used.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

However, these are not so readily adjustable nor so light as wire bracing.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The trailing-edge portion is reserved for lift-increase devices and ailer-


ons. The hinges for these devices may be located on the back face of the
rear spar, or if this is too far away from the leading edge of the aileron or
the flap, a false spar may be inserted, usually parallel to the leading edge
or the spar of the flap or aileron. The rib structure of the main wing is
continued in the movable surface. A single spar to which the operating
mechanism is attached is the main structural member of the~ movable
surfaces.
The fabric covers the rigid structure, is sewn into place, and doped as
well as painted to give the finished wing.
The fabric-covered, two-spar wing, used most extensively on rela-
tively small and slow-speed designs, has the front spar located between 12
to 17 per cent of the chord in rear of the leading edge of the wing, and the
rear spar between 65 to 70 per cent of the chord in rear of the leading edge
of the wing.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 339
DESIGN OF THE WING

339

These spars are spaced at a constant percentage span00wise, although they These spars are spaced at a constant percentage spanwise, although they
may be equally spaced provided the taper ratio of the wing planform is not

may be equally spaced provided the taper ratio of the wing planform is not
too great. In the latter case, equidistant spacing may cause relatively

too close spacing near the root and too large spacing near the tip for
too great. In the latter case, equidistant spacing may cause relatively
economical design.
too close spacing near the root and too large spacing near the tip for
In some wings of tapered planform, the spars are not placed either

equidistant or at a constant percentage from the leading edge in order to


economical design.
obtain some particular structural feature, such as suitable spar attach-
In some wings of tapered planform, the spars are not placed either
ments at the fuselage or to obtain enough space for a retractable landing-

equidistant or at a constant percentage from the leading edge in order to


obtain some particular structural feature, such as suitable spar attach-
gear well.

When spars are equidistant, it is possible to slip the ribs over the spars

from the tip end, but modern construction of ribs usually calls for three ments at the fuselage or to obtain enough space for a retractable landing-
sections—nose, center, and trailing edge section so that another assembly

gear well.
method may be used.

Wood or metal may be used for either the spars or ribs or both. Spars
When spars are equidistant, it is possible to slip the ribs over the spars
and ribs may be made of the same material.
from the tip end, but modern construction of ribs usually calls for three
The ribs are spaced from about 6 to 14 inches apart depending upon the

speed of the airplane. Recommendations for rib spacing for fabric-covered


sections-nose, center, and trailing edge section so that another assembly
wings may be obtained from Figure XVII-37.
method may be used.
This spacing is based upon the gliding (or diving) speed and may be

Wood or metal may be used for either the spars or ribs or both. Spars ~­
and ribs may be made of the same material.
assumed to be about V/i times the maximum speed attained (or expected)

Figure XVII-36. Samples of wooden rib construction for two-spar wings. These

could be made of metal with a little modification, as shown, for example, in the third
The ribs are spaced from about 6 to 14 inches apart depending upon the
illustration from the top.

speed of the airplane. Recommendations for rib spacing for fabric-covered


wings may be obtained from Figure XVll-37.
This spacing is based upon the gliding (or diving) speed and may be
':'!Ssumed to be about 1~ times the maximum speed attained (or expected)
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII-36. Samples of wooden rib construction for two-spar wings. These
could be made of metal with a little modification, as shown, for example, in the third
illustration from the top.

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
340 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
340

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


in horizontal flight. The chord line of the ribs is placed parallel t<> the
in horizontal flight. The chord line of the ribs is placed parallel to the

axis of symmetry (longitudinal axis) of the airplane. The ribs are usually
axis of symmetry (longitudinal axis) of the airplane. The ribs are usually
parallel to the longitudinal vertical plane of symmetry of the airplane.
parallel to the longitudinal vertical plane of symmetry of the airplane.
A piece of sheet metal or plywood covers the nose section so that the

A piece of sheet metal or plywood covers the nose section so that the
doped fabric maintains its shape properly. Where rib spacing is quite
doped fabric maintains its shape properly. Where rib spacing is quite

large compared to the thickness of the nose covering, extra nose ribs be-

tween the standard ribs may be inserted.


large compared to the thickness of the nose covering, extra nose ribs be-
Wherever compression ribs or members are located in the drag truss, or

where there are hinge connections, concentrated loads are applied to the
tween the standard ribs may be inserted.
spar, so that local reinforcements are required. In the case of wood spars,
Wherever compression ribs or members are located in the drag truss, or
extra plies are glued to the sides, or a solid block is inserted in the box-type

where there are hinge connections, concentrated loads are applied to the
spar, so that local reinforcements are required. In the case of wood spars,
spar. Metal spars have extra plates riveted or bolted to the sides to trans-

mit the load properly.

For fabric-covered wings, the maximum spacing of rib lacing may be


extra plies are glued to the sides, or a solid block is inserted in the box-type
determined from the accompanying graph. These values are based on

wing designs incorporating leading-edge supports such as plywood, metal,


spar. Metal spars have extra plates riveted or bolted to the sides to trans-
or subribs.
mit the load properly.
Figure XVII-37. Graph for determining spacing of fabric attachment. Va is the

For fabric-covered wings, the maximum spacing of rib lacing may be


determined from the accompanying graph. These values are based on
design dive speed or design glide speed. (Adapted from C.A.M. 04.)

wing designs incorporating leading-edge supports such as plywood, metal,


or subribs.
Generated on 2012-05-30 04:59 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

100 150 200


v6 , mlles per hour

FIGURE XVIl-37. Graph for determining spacing of fabric attachment. Va is the


design dive speed or design glide speed. (Adapted from C..4 .M. 0.4-)

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
DESIGN OF THE WING 341
DESIGN OF THE WING

In the slipstream, use 75 per cent factor for lacing and rib spacings, ex-
341

In the slipstream, use 75 per cent factor for lacing and rib spacings, ex-

cept that lacing spacing need not be less than 1 inch; aft of 30 per cent
cept that lacing spacing need not be less than 1 inch; aft of 30 per cent
chord point, when aft portion only is fabric covered, lacing and rib spac-

ings may be increased by 25 per cent. The lacing should be carried to


chord point, when aft portion only is fabric covered, lacing and rib spac-
leading edge when velocity exceeds 275 miles per hour.
ings may be increased by 25 per cent. The lacing should be carried to
An externally braced wing could be either pin-ended or fixed-ended at
leading edge \Vhen velocity exceeds 275 miles per hour.
An externally braced wing could be either pin-ended or fixed-ended at
the juncture of the wing spar with the fuselage. For pin-type ends, a

male and female fitting with a single horizontal bolt is the usual solution.

No vertical bending moments can be transmitted through such a joint, a the juncture of the wing spar with the fuselage. For pin-type ends, a
necessary condition for a pin joint. For fixed ends, a male and female fit-

ting with a single vertical bolt or tapered pin for alignment purposes is a
male and female fitting with a single horizontal bolt is the usual solution.
common solution where the bearing loads are not excessive. Another
No vertical bending moments can be transmitted through such a joint, a
solution is the use of two horizontal bolts. For transmitting large bend-
necessary condition for a pin joint. For fixed ends, a male and female fit-
ing moments (that is, fixed ends), continuity may be obtained by a series

of bolts, or rivets, or other pin connections.


ting with a single vertical bolt or tapered pin for alignment purposes is a
The lift struts supporting externally braced wings are pin-connected common solution where the bearing loads are not excessive. Another
at their ends with one horizontal bolt parallel to the plane of symmetry at

solution is the use of two horizontal bolts. For transmitting large bend-
ing moments (that is, fixed ends), continuity may be obtained by a series
each end of the strut. No bending moment from the wing should be

transmitted from the wing to the strut.

AILERONS
of bolts, or rivets, or other pin connections.
Figure XVII-38 shows a few possible planforms (A to F) for ailerons,

and some aileron sections (G to T). Figure A of this group shows an


The lift struts supporting externally braced wings are pin-connected
aileron which diminishes in effectiveness at high angles of attack, although
at their ends with one horizontal bolt parallel to the plane of symmetry at
very effective at low angles. Figure B shows the aileron slightly too far

each end of the strut. No bending moment from the wing should be
transmitted from the wing to the strut.
inboard which is particularly undesirable when the maximum span for a

flap as a lift-increase device is required.

Figure C is a bad combination of a relatively good aileron and a bad

wing tip in that the same effect is obtained as for Figure A.

Figures D, E, and F show generally desirable planforms. An aileron

preferably should be not more than 25 per cent of the chord although 30
AILERONS
per cent is common when flaps are used for increased lift.

Figure G is a plain aerodynamic balanced aileron. Figure H shows a


Figure XVIl-38 shows a few possible planforms (A to F) for ailerons,
balanced aileron of the Frise type, and Figure I a modified Frise type.
and some aileron sections (G to T). Figure A of this group shows an
Figure J is the Handley-Page balanced type Figure K is a balanced

aileron which diminishes in effectiveness a.t high angles of attack, although


very effective at low angles. Figure B shows the aileron slightly too far
aileron with a deflector plate. Figures L and M, both shown in neutral
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

position, are distinguished respectively by variable and constant slot

widths. Figure N is the piano-hinged type. Figure 0 shows the slot-tip


inboard which is particularly undesirable when the maximum span for a
flap as a lift-increase device is required.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

type. Figure P illustrates the retractable-spoiler type, Figure Q the

floating wing-tip type, Figure R another retractable-spoiler type. Figure

S is a conventional narrow-chord aileron with the flap ahead of it. Figure


Figure C is a bad combination of a relatively good aileron and a bad
T is an upper-surface aileron.
wing tip in that the same effect is obtained as for Figure A.
Figures D, E, and F show generally desirable planforms. An aileron
preferably should be not more than 25 per cent of the chord although 30
per cent is common when flaps are used for increased lift.
Figure G is a plain aerodynamic balanced aileron. Figure H shows a
balanced aileron of the Frise type, and Figure I a modified Frise type.
Figure J is the Handley-Page balanced type Figure K is a balanced
aileron with a deflector plate. Figures Land M, both shown in neutral
position, are distinguished respectively by variable and constant slot
widths. Figure N is the piano-hinged type. Figure 0 shows the slot-tip
type. Figure P illustrates the retractable-spoiler type, Figure Q the
floating wing-tip type, Figure R another retractable-spoiler type. Figure
Sis a conventional narrow-chord aileron with the flap ahead of it. Figure
Tis an upper-surface aileron.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
342
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

342

IQ IZ
AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Original from
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 343
DESIGN OF THE WING

343

The next question that arises is whether the aileron should be aerody-
The next question that arises is whether the aileron should be aerody- _,,
namically balanced. For relatively slow-speed airplanes and possibly
namically balanced. For relatively slow-speed airplanes and possibly _
for high-speed airplanes utilizing auxiliary mechanical, electrical, or hy-,

for high-speed airplanes utilizing auxiliary mechanical, electrical, or hy-_ ·


draulic aid, unbalanced ailerons may be used.
draulic aid, unbalanced ailerons may be used.

The leading edge preferably should not project beyond the normal con-

tour of the wing when deflected, since ice may form on the leading edge of
The leading edge preferably should not project beyond the normal con-
the control surface.

In order to reduce the manual effort to operate ailerons, a type of servo-


tour of the wing when deflected, since ice may form on the leading edge of
control has been devised whereby a small surface is deflected in order to
the control surface.
move a larger surface.

In order to reduce the manual effort to operate ailerons, a type of servo-


control has been devised whereby a small surface is deflected in order to
For control purposes, these trailing-edge flaps or tabs should have as

high an aspect ratio as possible and about 10 to 12 per cent of the total

movable area. A smaller percentage is sufficient when the tab is intended


move a larger surface.
for trim purposes. Reference to Chapter XIX, Tail Surfaces, should be

For control purposes, these trailing-edge flaps or tabs should have as


made for further explanations.

The aileron's primary function is to rotate the airplane about its longi-
high an aspect ratio as possible and about 10 to 12 per cent of the total
tudinal axis. In general, any method that would increase or decrease the

movable area. A smaller percentage is sufficient when the tab is intended


for trim purposes. Reference to Chapter XIX, Tail Surfaces, should be
lift on one side relative to the other would meet the objective. Various

devices have been invented and applied to flying designs. A few may be

briefly mentioned here. made for further explanations.


1. The spoiler. A small slat usually raised near the top surface of the

The aileron's primary function is to rotate the airplane about its longi-
wing near the leading edge. This is still used in conjunction with the flap-

type aileron.
tudinal axis. In general, any method that would increase or decrease the
2. Opening ports on one side to destroy the lift. Such a scheme is highly
lift on one side relative to the other would meet the objective. Various
effective for high angles of attack or low speeds, but ineffective at high

speeds. Moreover, the control system is not a continuous one in that the
devices have been invented and applied to flying designs. A few may be
control stick would have to disengage the control system for one side be- briefly mentioned here.
fore engaging that of the other side.

1. The spoiler. A small slat usually raised near the top surface of the
3. Floating ailerons which are extensions spanwise at the wing tips

These smalf wings of symmetrical cross section are permitted to float at


wing near the leading edge. This is still used in conjunction with the flap-
zero lift, regardless of the wing's angle of attack, and are therefore effective
type aileron.
for any angle of attack. Such ailerons require relatively more area than

the flap type, and while they may increase the apparent aspect ratio of
2. Opening ports on one side to destroy the lift. Such a scheme is highly
the wing, this gain is offset by the parasite resistance of these surfaces.
effective for high angles of attack or low speeds, but ineffective at high
4. The differentially-operated flap, which is the most commonly used

speeds. Moreover, the control system is not a continuous one in that the
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

control stick would have to disengage the control system for one side be-
device.

5. Other devices can easily be envisaged that would meet the require-

fore engaging that of the other side.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

ments for rotating the airplane.

The aerodynamic characteristics of the flap-type aileron are defined by

the following equations for:


3. Floating ailerons which are extensions spanwise at the wing tips
1. Rolling moments
These smalf wings of symmetrical cross section are permitted to float at
L = CiSwbq;

zero lift, regardless of the wing's angle of attack, and are therefore effective
for any angle of attack. Such ailerons require relatively more area than
the flap type, and while they may increase the apparent aspect ratio of
the wing, this gain is offset by the parasite resistance of these surfaces.
4. The differentially-operated flap, which is the most commonly used
device.
5. Other devices can easily be envisaged that would meet the require-
ments for rotating the airplane.
The aerodynamic characteristics of the flap-type aileron are defined by
the following equations for:
1. Rolling moments

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
344 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
344

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


2. Yawing moments
2. Yawing moments

N = ChSwbq;

3. Hinge moments

3. Hinge moments
H = ChSaCaq;

where L, N, and H are moments expressed in foot-pounds,


H = ChSaCaq;
C(, C„, and Ch are, respectively, the non-dimensional rolling, yawing,

and hinge-moment coefficients for the aileron,


where L, N, and Hare moments expressed in foot-pounds,
Sw is the wing area in square feet,

Sa is the aileron area in square feet,

C 1, Cn, and Ch are, respectively, the non-dimensional rolling, yawing,


and hinge-moment coefficients for the aileron,
b is the wing span in feet,

q is the dynamic pressure, in pounds per square foot, at the velocity,

V, of the airplane, and

Sw is the wing area in square feet,


Ca is the aileron chord.

/ Ideally, the rolling-moment characteristics of the ailerons or equivalent


Sa is the aileron area in square feet,
devices should be high, the yawing moment should be relatively small or

zero, and the hinge moments should be within the normal capacities of
b is the wing span in feet,
the control system.
q is the dynamic pressure, in pounds per square foot, at the velocity,
To explain further, it is obvious than efficient or most effective aileron

V, of the airplane, and


ca is the aileron chord.
system is one that requires a relatively small proportion of the wing area.

The measure of effectiveness is gained in flight tests, and for the subsonic

region, combined lateral stability and control are usually specified as

/
follows:

Ideally, the rolling-moment characteristics of the ailerons or equivalent


, devices should be high, the yawing moment should be relatively small or
With the rudder locked, and the stick or control wheel thrown hard over,

°" zero, and the hinge moments should be within the normal capacities of
the airplane should:

1. Reach its maximum rolling velocity in not more than 0.2 seconds

later; *

the control system.


2. Should attain a rolling velocity such that

g > 0.07,
To explain further, it is obvious than efficient or most effective aileron
where p is the maximum rolling velocity in radians per second,

system is one that requires a relatively small proportion of the wing area.
The measure of effectiveness is gained in flight tests, and for the subsonic
b is the span of the wing, in feet, and

V is the true forward airspeed of the airplane in feet per second;

3. At any speed below 80 per cent of maximum level flight speed, should region, combined lateral stability and control are usually spe<'ified as
attain the desired value of pb/2V without exceeding control forces of 80

follows:
pounds for the wheel, or 30 pounds for the stick-type of control.

With the rudder held fixed, and the airplane flying at 110 per cent of its

With the rudder locked, and the stick or control wheel thrown hard over,
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

minimum speed, the craft should not sideslip more than 20 degrees due to

the yaw created by fully deflected ailerons.

the airplane should:


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1. Reach its maximum rolling velocity in not more than 0.2 seconds
later; '
2. Should attain a rolling velocity such that
-1!!2
2 V > 0.07,
where p is the maximum rolling velocity in radians per second,
b is the span of the wing, in feet, and
V is the true forward airspeed of the airplane in feet per second;
3. At any speed below 80 per cent of maximum level flight speed, should
attain the desired value of pb/2V without exceeding control forces of 80
pounds for the wheel, or 30 pounds for the stick-type of control.
With the rudder held fixed, and the airplane flying at 110 per cent of its
minimum speed, the craft should not sideslip more than 20 degrees due to
the yaw created by fully deflected ailerons.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 345
DESIGN OF THE WING

345

In a sideslip:
1n a sideslip :
1. The rolling moment obtained should vary smoothly with the sideslip
1. The rolling moment obtained should vary smoothly with the sideslip

angle;

2. Aileron control should always be necessary to depress the leading angle;


wing as sideslip is increased;

3. The tendency of the aileron to return to its trim position should in-
2. Aileron control should always be necessary to depress the leading
crease with increase of sideslip.
wing as sideslip is increased;
To obtain the desired lateral stability, low-wing monoplanes usually

3. The tendency of the aileron to return to its trim position should in-
require 4 to 8 degrees more dihedral than high-wing monoplanes.

The greater the lateral stability induced by the dihedral and/or sweep-
crease with increase of sideslip.
back effect of the wing, the larger the aileron area has to be to counteract

such effects.
To obtain the desired lateral stability, low-wing monoplanes usually
Ailerons of the flap type produce an adverse yawing moment—adverse
require 4 to 8 degrees more dihedral than high-wing monoplanes.
because the moment tends to turn the airplane out of its designated turn.

Variable aileron types produce different magnitudes of such yawing mo-

The greater the lateral stability induced by the dihedral and/or sweep-
back effect of the wing, the larger the aileron area has to be to counteract
ments. Differentially-operated ailerons are those whereby the down-going

aileron travels through a greater angle than the up-going aileron.

Figure XVII-39 shows a typical case of the effectiveness of the aileron


such effects.
changes with the angle of attack.

Figure XVII-39. Typical rolling and moment variation with anuglar deflection of
Ailerons of the flap type produce an adverse yawing moment-adverse
the ailerons and the angle of attack of the wing.
because the moment tends to turn the airplane out of its designated turn.
Variable aileron types produce different magnitudes of such yawing mo-
ments. Differentially-operated ailerons are those whereby the down-going
aileron travels through a greater angle than the up-going aileron.
Figure XVII-a9 shows a typical case of the effectiveness of the aileron
changes with the angle of attack .
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:00 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

- "'
.5
c-o
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

CD c
E ::>
~ 8.
Cl..c
c u
.:.:: .5
0
°'
10° 20° 30° 40° 50° 60°

FJCaJRE XVII-39. Typical rolling and moment variation with anuglar deflection of
the ailerons and the angle of attack of the wing.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
346 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
346

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL The hinge moments have to be overcome by the pilot at the control
The hinge moments have to be overcome by the pilot at the control

stick or wheel. If they are too large, auxiliary boosting systems actuat-
stick or wheel. If they are too large, auxiliary boosting systems actuat-
ing hydraulic or electrical mechanisms have to be employed. Since the
ing hydraulic or electrical mechanisms have to be employed. Since the
greater the ratio of flap chord to wing chord, the greater the hinge moments
greater the ratio of flap chord to wing chord, the greater the hinge moments
produced, the general compromise is not to exceed an aileron-chord to wing-

chord ratio of 25 per cent. The hinge moments may be reduced in magni-
produced, the general compromise is not to exceed an aileron-chord to wing-
tude either by forward aerodynamic balancing of the surface or by aero- chord ratio of 25 per cent. The hinge moments may be reduced in magni-
dynamic balancing through the use of trailing-edge tabs. The systems

tude either by forward aerodynamic balancing of the surface or by aero-


employed for elevators and rudders are applicable here, and reference

should be made to Chapter XIX, Tail Surfaces, for further information


dynamic balancing through the use of trailing-edge tabs. The systems
on this subject.
employed for elevators and rudders are applicable here, and reference
Aileron areas vary from 8 to 12 per cent of the total wing area (including

the aileron area, which is considered as part of the wing area).


should be made to Chapter XIX, Tail Surfaces, for further information
Figure XVII-40 gives some guiding dimensions for determining the
on this subject.
cross section of an aileron located in the trailing edge of a wing. The

Aileron areas vary from 8 to 12 per cent of the total wing area (including
the aileron area, which is considered as part of the wing area).
dimensions may have to be modified since the depth of airfoils vary.

0.005 C

0.1 C J
Figure XVIl-40 gives some guiding dimensions for determining the
0.005 C

-M —0.25 C
cross section of an aileron located in the trailing edge of a wing. The
- c-
dimensions may have to be modified since the depth of airfoils vary.
Radius R variable

Figure XVII-40. Typical aileron (or flap) dimensions. The aerodynamic balance

may vary between 15 and 35 per cent of the aileron chord.


0.005C

0.005C
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Radius R variable
FIGURE XVII-40. Typical aileron (or flap) dimensions. The aerodynamic balance
may vary between 15 and 35 per cent of the aileron chord.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 347
DESIGN OF THE WING

347

For delta-wing designs, particularly, the aileron function is combined


For delta-wing designs, particularly, the aileron function is combined
with the function of the elevators so that the control surfaces combining
with the function of the elevators so that the control surfaces combining
both functions are known as "elevons." The control system has to be so

arranged that the surfaces can be operated differentially as ailerons, and


both functions are known as "elevons." The control system has to be so
together in the same direction as elevators.
arranged that the surfaces can be operated differentially as ailerons, and
LET-INCREASE DEVICES AND SPOILERS

together in the same direction as elevators.


Figure XVII-41A represents a so-called plain flap of the type commonly

used for ailerons. An aileron-flap combination could be employed whereby

the aileron function would take place from any flap position.
LIFT-INCREASE DEVICES AND SPOILERS
In Figure B, a specially-designed slot has been incorporated just ahead

of the flap leading edge to provide a less turbulent airflow over the flap in
Figure XVII-41A represents a so-called plain flap of the type commonly
the deflected position.
used for ailerons. An aileron-flap combination could be employed whereby
In Figure C, a second slot has been incorporated in the design in order

the aileron function would take place from any flap position.
In Figure B, a specially-designed slot has been incorporated just ahead
to obtain a higher lift coefficient and less turbulent airflow aft of the flap.

In Figure D, the Handley-Page slot and flap are shown. This combina-

tion offers a number of possibilities. The slot can be brought out into of the flap leading edge to provide a less turbulent airflow over the flap in
position automatically by virtue of the suction pressure at the leading

edge at high angles of attack. If the slot is connected to the flap by a


the deflected position.
suitable linkage mechanism, the flap can be depressed at the same time.
In Figure C, a second slot has been incorporated in the design in order
The design must ensure fool-proof mechanical operation, since the front
to obtain a higher lift coefficient and less turbulent airflow aft of the flap.
slot, because of its shallow dimensions, is difficult to make reasonably

rigid. Under icing conditions it would have to be heated, lest ice interfere
In Figure D, the Handley-Page slot and flap are shown. This combina-
with its operation. tion offers a number of possibilities. The slot can be brought out into
In Figure E, the Wragg flap or external airfoil flap not only increases the

position automatically by virtue of the suction pressure at the leading


lift due to flap action, but also increases the effective wing area.

Figure F is a split flap in which the recessed portion may be deflected


edge at high angles of attack. If the slot is connected to the flap by a
downward while the top half remains fixed in place. A variation uses a
suitable linkage mechanism, the flap can be depressed at the same time.
movable top split flap as well. This flap, moving up while the other

moves down, acts primarily as a spoiler to create more drag and is there-
The design must ensure fool-proof mechanical operation, since the front
fore useful in the landing approach.
slot, because of its shallow dimensions, is difficult to make reasonably
Figure G is a split flap which moves rearwardly and down, thus increas-

rigid. Under icing conditions it would have to be heated, lest ice interfere
with its operation.
ing the wing area and providing additional lift action when deflected.

The famous Fowler flap employs a recessed airfoil section for such a flap.

This type gives the highest increase in the maximum lift coefficient ob- In Figure E, the Wragg flap or external airfoil flap not only increases the
tainable.

lift due to flap action, but also increases the effective wing area.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

There are other devices for increasing lift which are not shown. There

has been some study on a series of smaller recessed airfoils which when
Figure F is a split flap in which the recessed portion may be deflected
downward while the top half remains fixed in place. A variation uses a
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

extended give a "Venetian-blind" appearance.

movable top split flap as well. This flap, moving up while the other
Boundary layer control offers much promise both in increasing the

maximum lift coefficient and in decreasing the drag coefficients. The

advent of the turbo-jet engine promises to solve some of the problems moves down, acts primarily as a spoiler to create more drag and is there-
involved in getting enough air of sufficient pressure from a reliable source.

fore useful in the landing approach.


Figure G is a split flap which moves rearwardly and down, thus increas-
ing the wing area and providing additional lift action when deflected.
The famous Fowler flap employs a recessed airfoil section for such a flap.
This type gives the highest increase in the maximum lift coefficient ob-
tainable.
There are other devices for increasing lift which are not shown. There
has been some study on a series of smaller recessed airfoils which when
extended give a "Venetian-blind" appearance.
Boundary layer control offers much promise both in increasing the
maximum lift coefficient and in decreasing the drag coefficients. The
advent of the turbo-jet engine promises to solve some of the problems
involved in getting enough air of sufficient pressure from a reliable source.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
C:-- A

C- 8
-~
'~

' ' ' ''


' '\,,
\
\

C:--- c
~~,~-
------------------------------- ' '\
'
' ,,',,

E
~
' ' ,,
\
\
~\
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

C:-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

,,
F ,\,,,~,
,,
'
G

FIGURE XVIl- 41. Lift-increase devices: (A) plain flap; (B) slotted flap; (C) double
slotted flap; (D) Handley-Page slot and flap; (E) external airfoil flap; (F) split flap;
(G) split flap with a rear hinge point-the flap may have an airfoil shape a.a for the
Fowler flap.
348

Original from
Dig 1ze UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 349
DESIGN OF THE WING

349

TABLE XVII-2. Maximum lift coefficients for various lift-increase devices.


(See Figure XVIl-41 for reference.)
Table XVII-2. Maximum lift coefficients for various lift-increase devices.

(See Figure XVII-41 for reference.)

o, de-

a, de-
•

Description or Flap Maxi- grees L/D NACA


Description or

Flap

Maxi-
diagram data mum for at Cm., reference
grees
CL CLmGz CL,,.az
L/D

NACA
Clark Y airfoil Basic airfoil 1.29 15 7.5 -.085 TN459
diagram
Plain flap (Figure A) Chord .30 Cw L~- 12 4.0 - TR427
data
deflected 45°
mum
Slotted flap (Figure Chord .30 Cw 1.98 12 4.0 - TR427
for
B) deflected 45 °
at
Handley-Page auto- . ... . ... ... ... 1.84 28 4.1 - TN459
reference matic slot
Cl
Handley - Page slot Chord .30 Cw 2.18 19 3.7 - TR427
CLmax
and flap (Figure D) deflected 45°
Clark Y airfoil
Handley - Page slot Chord .40 Cw 3.36 16 3.7 -.740 TN459 ·.
Basic airfoil .
and Fowler flap deflected 45°
1.29
Split flap (Figure F) Chord .30 Cw 2.16 14 4.3 -.250 TN422
15

deflected 45°
7.5

Fowler flap (Figure Chord .30 Cw 2.82 13 4.55 -.660 TR534


-.085

G) deflected 40°
TN459

Double slot and flap Chord .30 Cw 2.44 16 - - -


Plain flap (Figure A)

(Figure C) deflected 45 °
Chord .30 Cw

NACA 23012 Basic airfoil 1.3 16 - -.024 TR824


L95_

Plain flap (Figure A) Chord .25 Cw 2.15 14 - -.30 TR644


Slotted flap (Figure Chord .25 Cw 2.65 13 - -.36 TR644
12

-------
.B}'
4.0

deflected 30°
—

Split flap (Figure F) Chord .25 Cw 2.26 ', 14 - -.19 TR644


TR427

deflected 45°
-~~~cted 30° ... -----· - ·
Slotted flap (Figure
Fowler flap (Figure Chord .25Cw 2.9 10 - -.60 TR664
Chord .30 Cw
G) deflected 30°
Wragg or external air- Chord .20C w 2.45 - - - -
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1.98

12
foil flap (Figure E) deflected 30°
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

4.0

—

TR427
In addition to flaps being located at the trailing edge, there may be
B)
others positioned anywhere along the chord on either the top or lower
deflected 45°
surface. In these locations, the flaps serve primarily as spoilers to kill
Handley-Page auto-

1.84
the lift and increase the drag. If used differentially at the wing tips, such
28 spoilers assist the normally operating ailerons. They are also quite
4.1

useful at high angles of attack when normal ailerons are often not ef-
—

TN459
fective enough, especially when other flaps are employed for lift-increase
matic slot
purposes. When not used for aileron action, spoilers are utilized to reduce
Handley - Page slot

Chord .30 Cw
the landing speed and length of landing run.
2.18
Airplanes employing any lift-increase device are essentially two air-
19

planes in one--one operating without such devices, another operating


with them. Accordingly, the effect upon stability and therefore the
3.7

—

TR427
design considerations for the tail surfaces are different for the two cases.
and flap (Figure D)

deflected 45°
The tail surfaces are likely to be "blanketed" by the wing and flaps;
Handley - Page slot
that is, the airflow behind the wing may be both turbulent and low in
Chord .40 Cw

3.36

16

3.7

Original from
-.740

Dig IZed b
TN459 v.
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIGAN
and Fowler flap

deflected 45°

Split flap (Figure F)


350 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
350

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


speed, with the result that the horizontal tail surfaces do not operate
speed, with the result that the horizontal tail surfaces do not operate

under favorable conditions.


under favorable conditions.
• Since the center of pressure moves rearward along the chord, the ef-
• Since the center of pressure moves rearward along the chord, the ef-
fective tail moment arm is decreased and the moment coefficient about

fective tail moment arm is decreased and the moment coefficient about
the original aerodynamic center is increased. The ratio of the horizontal
the original aerodynamic center is increased. The ratio of the horizontal

tail surfaces to the basic wing area is therefore greater for an airplane

using the flaps than for an airplane not using them. Accordingly, the
tail surfaces to the basic wing area is therefore greater for an airplane
degree of static stability is different. An airplane designed to have ade-

quate stability when flaps are employed will have more than adequate
using the flaps than for an airplane not using them. Accordingly, the
static longitudinal stability when the flaps are not in use.
degree of static stability is different. An airplane designed to have ade-
Pertinent NACA reports should be referred to for a list of likely values

quate stability when flaps are employed will have more than adequate
static longitudinal stability when the flaps are not in use.
to be obtained for the lift, drag, and hinge moment coefficients. These

are given for full-span flaps on test models under two-dimensional testing

conditions. In the actual application, the flaps seldom extend over the Pertinent NACA reports should be referred to for a list of likely values
full span of the wing, nor is the wing likely to be identical with that used

in the test. Some qualifications in the data used are therefore always
to be obtained for the lift, drag, and hinge moment coefficients. These
necessary, but reasonable estimates are still possible until particular tests
are given for full-span flaps on test models under two-dimensional testing
are made.
conditions. In the actual application, the flaps seldom extend over the
In general, it may be said that the maximum lift coefficient obtainable

for a given flap configuration is possible for any airfoil, regardless of what
full span of the wing, nor is the wing likely to be identical with that used
its maximum lift coefficient may be when no flap is used. Therefore, an in the test. Some qualifications in the data used are therefore always
1.4

necessary, but reasonable estimates are still possible until particular tests
0 10 20 30 40 50 60

Flap deflection, in degrees


are made.
Figure XVII-42. Typical curve showing rate of increase of maximum lift coefficient
In general, it may be said that the maximum lift coefficient obtainable
with flap deflection. Curve shown is for a split flap with a chord of 20 per cent of the

wing chord, Cw'.


for a given flap configuration is possible for any airfoil, regardless of what
its maximum lift coefficient may be when no flap is used. Therefore, an

1.4

i 1.2
~i
S-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

u J 1.0
:E~ ~ ---
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

e' /
~ i 0.8 v
·~:; /
ou0.6
/~
iuJ
..~
u
<l 0.4
v
..:
0.2 J
I 10 20 30 40 50 60
Flap deflection, in degrees

F10URE XVII-42. Typical curve showing rate of increase of maximum lift coefficient
with flap deflection. Curve shown is for a split flap with a chord of 20 per cent of the
wing chord, Cw'.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
-- ·-----· ·- .... _..........., ______
DESIGN OF THE WING 351

FIGURE XVIl- 43. Flap clearance as affected by wing setting.

airfoil chosen because of its pre-eminently low drag coefficients-especially


in the low angle of attack and high-speed range-will be able to have a
sufficiently high maximum lift coefficient with the use of flaps.
The maximum lift coefficient is usually obtained at a flap deflection of \
90 degrees, but since the value of the lift coefficient tends to become
asymptotic after a deflection of 40 to 45 degrees (see Figure XVIl-42), it
is seldom desirable to consider a deflection greater than 45 degrees.
The hinge moment coefficients increase both with the ratio of flap chord
to wing chord and with the angular deflection of the flap. The magnitude
of these hinge moments often limits the flap chord to about 20 per cent of
the wing chord and to a maximum deflection of about 30 degrees. For
low wing designs, the ground clearances required (see Figure XVIl-43)
may also influence the positioning and the deflection of the flap.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:01 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII-44. Areas of different lift qualities.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
352 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
352

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

- For an airplane equipped with conventional size ailerons, and with flaps
devoted to the rest of the span not covered by the ailerons, the maximum
For an airplane equipped with conventional size ailerons, and with flaps

devoted to the rest of the span not covered by the ailerons, the maximum

lift coefficient for the entire wing area is often arbitrarily assumed to have ,. lift coefficient for the entire wing area is often arbitrarily assumed to have
been increased 40 per cent.

been increased 40 per cent.


A more analytical method is to calculate the "effective" maximum lift

coefficient (refer to Figure XVII-44), as follows: A more analytical method is to calculate the "effective" maximum lift
[(CLmaz)(areas A + D) +' (1.7 CLmax)(areas B+ C) + (0.1 CLmax)(area E)\

h- [areas (A + B + C + £>)] = effective CLmax,


coefficient (refer to Figure XVII-44), as follows:
where 1.7 Cimai represents a 70 per cent increase in lift due to the flap.

[(CLmaz)(areasA + D) +· (1.7 CLmaz)(areas B+ C) + (0.1 CLmaz)(area E)]


+ [areas (A + B + C + D)] = effective CLmaz,
The area covered by the fuselage is normally not included in the wing

area, but if a flap is made continuous across the bottom of the fuselage,

additional lift results, depending upon the type of fuselage. This addi-

tion has been estimated at one-tenth of the maximum lift coefficient in where 1.7 C Lmaz represents a 70 per cent increase in lift due to the flap.
the empirical formula just given.

A recent development of a lift-increase device has been a so-called nose


The area covered by the fuselage is normally not included in the wing
flap or "droop snoot" whereby the forward portion of the wing nose is

rotated downward as much as 60 degrees. Several illustrations are shown


area, but if a flap is made continuous across the bottom of the fuselage,
in Figure XVII-45. Wind-tunnel investigations of a laminar-flow air-
additional lift results, depending upon the type of fuselage. This addi-
foil equipped with such a nose indicated that the lift coefficient could be

tion has been estimated at one-tenth of the maximum lift coefficient in


the empirical formula just given.
increased by about 30 per cent, and almost 60 per cent in conjunction

with a trailing-edge flap.

Figure XVII-45. Nose slats and flaps.

A recent development of a lift-increase device has been a so-called nose


flap or "droop snoot" whereby the forward portion of the wing nose is
the wing chord.

The chord is usually about 10 per cent of

rotated downward as much as 60 degrees. Several illustrations are shown


in Figure XVII-45. Wind-tunnel investigations of a laminar-flow air-
foil equipped with such a nose indicated that the lift coefficient could be
increased by about 30 per cent, and almost 60 per cent in conjunction
with a trailing-edge flap.

c ~
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

(/(c ~
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

~ ~
l:=---~
~
~
FIGURE XVIl-45. Nose slats and flaps. The chord is usually about 10 per cent of
the wing chord.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
.......... ::._.~

DESIGN OF THE WING 353

Di stance B
Longitudi nal
plane of symmetry

FIGURE XVII-46. Suggestions for locating spars, ailerons, and flaps on a wing.
Front spar is located from 12% to 17% of the chord. Rear spar is located from 65%
to 70% of the chord. Line A should be parallel to the line of flight. Distance B is
that between the centerline of the spar and the leading edge of the aireron or flap; allow
from 2% to 5% of the chord.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:02 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVII- 47. A cutaway sketch of a wing flap. The cambered surface of the
flap need not be covered for a split flap unless unusual rigidity is required.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OFMICHIGAN
354 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
354

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

The nose flap also increases the angle of attack at which the maximum
The nose flap also increases the angle of attack at which the maximum
lift coefficient is obtained over that for the basic airfoil, evidently because
lift coefficient is obtained over that for the basic airfoil, evidently because
the nose flap aligns the airflow better at the stall. However, even so, the

the nose flap aligns the airflow better at the stall. However, even so, the
position of the flap is critical.
position of the flap is critical.

Another good feature of the nose flap is that the additional pitching

moment created by the nose flap is not so great, at least at low angles of Another good feature of the nose flap is that the additional pitching
attack, as by the trailing-edge flap; at high angles of attack, the effective

pitching moment tends to decrease, thereby maintaining approximately


moment created by the nose flap is not so great, at least at low angles of
the same longitudinal stability for the airplane without the use of the nose
attack, as by the trailing-edge flap; at high angles of attack, the effective
flap.

pitching moment tends to decrease, thereby maintaining approximately


Figure XVII-48. "Wing fences" used to prevent drift of boundary layer towards

the tip. Note the "wing fences" on the vertical tail surfaces.
the same longitudinal stability for the airplane without the use of the nose
Wing fences have been employed for the transonic and supersonic air- flap.
planes to prevent the outward flow of the boundary layer. These fences

consist of essentially simple vertical surfaces, about 4 inches or less in

height, attached to the top surface of the wing and extending from the

leading edge of the wing to the leading edge of the flap or aileron. Usually

two such fences are used on each half of the wing, sectioning the wing

semi-span into about three equal lengths. (See Figure XVII-48.)

The addition of engines, fuel, bombs, and other similar concentrated

weights along the wing of the airplane increases the rolling and yawing

moments of inertia so that the normal size ailerons provide reduced rolling

WING FENCES

EFFECT OF WING MASS DISTRIBUTION

FIGURE XVII-48. "Wing fences" used to prevent drift of boundary layer towards
the tip. Note the "wing fences" on the vertical tail surfaces.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:04 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

WING FENCES
Wing fences have been employed for the transonic and supersonic air-
planes to prevent the outward flow of the boundary layer. These fences
consist of essentially simple vertical surfaces, about 4 inches or less in
height, attached to the top surface of the wing and extending from the
leading edge of the wing to the leading edge of the flap or aileron. Usually
two such fences are used on each half of the wing, sectioning the wing
semi-span into about three equal lengths. (See Figure XVII-48.)

EFFECT OF WING MASS DISTRIBUTION


The addition of engines, fuel, bombs, and other similar concentrated
weights along the wing of the airplane increases the rolling and yawing
moments of inertia so that the normal size ailerons provide reduced rolling

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
DESIGN OF THE WING 355
DESIGN OF THE WING

accelerations and thereby require a longer time to attain a given angle of


355

accelerations and thereby require a longer time to attain a given angle of

bank. Likewise, the increased moments of inertia reduce the desired


bank. Likewise, the increased moments of inertia reduce the desired
oscillatory stability, and increase the time for the airplane to damp out
oscillatory stability, and increase the time for the airplane to damp out

oscillations. It has been found that this effect was small for low values

of effective dihedral but became increasingly undesirable for high values oscillations. It has been found that this effect was small for low values
of effective dihedral, especially when the ratio of vertical tail surface area

of effective dihedral but became increasingly undesirable for high values


to the wing area is small. The solution for high moment of inertia would

be either increased vertical tail surface area with relation to the wing, or
of effective dihedral, especially when the ratio of vertical tail surface area
low effective or negative dihedral, or both. Gusts or turbulent air do not
to the wing area is small. The solution for high moment of inertia would
affect an airplane with a high value of moment of inertia as much as one

with a low value of the moment of inertia; but due to poor damping, steady
be either increased vertical tail surface area with relation to the wing, or
flight is hard to obtain and rough rides may result.
low effective or negative dihedral, or both. Gusts or turbulent air do not
EFFECT OF WING LOADING

affect an airplane with a high value of moment of inertia as much as one


While ordinarily the wing loading is given as the ratio of the gross weight

of the airplane to the wing area, it has recently been pointed out that the
with a low value of the moment of inertia; but due to poor damping, steady
relative density of the airplane (that is, the density of the airplane divided
flight is hard to obtain and rough rides may result.
by the density of the surrounding air) would be more appropriate. The

general effect of increasing the airplane relative density either by increas-

ing the wing loading at sea level or flying it at high altitudes where the air

EFFECT OF WING LOADING


density is less is the same. In both cases the degree of the lateral stability

is decreased.

The solution would be to increase the ratio of the vertical tail area to

While ordinarily the wing loading is given as the ratio of the gross weight
of the airplane to the wing area., it has recently been pointed out that the
the wing area in order to obtain an equivalent value of effective dihedral.

FLUTTER PREVENTION

Precautions must be taken in the design of the wing to prevent flutter.


relative density of the airplane (that is, the density of the airplane divided
Some recommendations are:

(a) Structural stiffness.


by the density of the surrounding air) would be more appropriate. The
(b) Elimination of all play in hinges and control system joints.
general effect of increasing the airplane relative density either by increas-
(c) Rigid interconnection between ailerons.

ing the wing loading at sea level or flying it at high altitudes where the air
density is less is the same. In both cases the degree of the lateral stability
(d) A relatively high degree of weight balance of control surfaces.

(e) A relatively low amount of aerodynamic balance.

(f) High frictional damping of control system.


is decreased.
(g) Adequate fillets.

(h) Proper fairing.


The solution would be to increase the ratio of the vertical tail area to
Features tending to create aerodynamic disturbance, such as sharp lead-
the wing area. in order to obtain an equivalent value of effective dihedral.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ing edges on movable surfaces, should be avoided. (These are also prone

to collect ice.)
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FLUTTER PREVENTION
Precautions must be taken in the design of the wing to prevent flutte.r.
Some recommendations are:
(a) Structural stiffness.
(b) Elimination of all play in hinges and control system joints.
(c) Rigid interconnection between ailerons.
(d) A relatively high degree of weight balance of control surfaces.
(e) A relatively low amount of aerodynamic balance.
(f) High frictional damping of control system.
(g) Adequate fillets.
(h) Proper fa.iring.
Features tending to create aerodynamic disturbance, such as sharp lead-
ing edges on movable surfaces, should be avoided. (These are also prone
to collect ice.)

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
356 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
356

When ailerons are attached to internally braced wings, they should be


AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

When ailerons are attached to internally braced wings, they should be

statically balanced about their hinge lines. If a balancing weight is used,


statically balanced about their hinge lines. If a balancing weight is used,
it is usually more effective when located near the outboard end of the

aileron.
it is usually more effective when located near the outboard end of the
Partial static balance may be satisfactory when an irreversible and ex-
aileron.
ceptionally rigid control system is used.
Partial static balance may be satisfactory when an irreversible and ex-
ceptionally rigid control system is used.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
CHAPTER XVIII

The Landing Gear

The lac ding gear consists of the wheels, tires, brakes, shock absorbers,

struts, cowlings and, if retractable, the retracting mechanism. With only

minor exceptions, most of the items making up the landing gear are not

designed by the airplane designer but by the accessory manufacturer.

However, their selection and their relationship are determined by the air-

XVIII
plane designer so that it is important for him to know the various condi-

tions which the landing gear must meet and the purpose for which each
CHAPTER
part has been designed.

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS

The landing of the airplane may be considered in terms of:

1. The approach glide. This is assumed to be a steady or uniform

rectilinear motion along a flight path, making an angle with the horizontal.

2. The transition from steady gliding flight to substantially level flight


The Landing Gear
before the point of contact. During this operation the rate of descent is

slowed to practically zero at contact; also the flight path speed along the

flight path is decelerated to substantially the stalling speed at contact.

3. The ground run during which the airplane is decelerated horizontally

from the contact speed to zero.

The landing gear is brought into the picture from the moment of contact

with the ground until the airplane comes to rest.

The landing gear must, of course, take the shocks when landing or when

The landing gear consists of the wheels, tires, brakes, shock absorbers,
going over an obstruction, and so it incorporates two means of absorbing

shock loads—the tire which absorbs minor shocks, and the shock absorber
struts, cowlings and, if retractable, the retracting mechanism. With only
which absorbs hard and sudden shocks. Not only must the landing gear
minor exceptions, most of the items making up the landing gear are not
be able to take these shocks, but it must also be so arranged that the air-

plane will be prevented from nosing over when landing.


designed by the airplane designer but by the accessory manufacturer.
357
However, their selection and their relationship are determined by the air-
plane designer so that it is important for him to know the various condi-
tions which the landing gear must meet and the purpose for which each
part has been designed.

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
The landing of the airplane may be considered in terms of:
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1. The approach glide. This is assumed to be a steady or uniform


rectilinear motion along a flight path, making an angle with the horizontal.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

2. The transition from steady gliding flight to substantially level flight


before the point of contact. During this operation the rate of descent is
slowed to practically zero at contact; also the flight path speed along the
flight path is decelerated to substantially the stalling speed at contact.
3. The ground run during which the airplane is decelerated horizontally
from the contact speed to zero.
The landing gear is brought into the picture from the moment of contact
with the ground until the airplane comes to rest.
The landing gear must, of course, take the shocks when landing or when
going over an obstruction, and so it incorporates two means of absorbing
shock loads-the tire which absorbs minor shocks, and the shock absorber
which absorbs hard and sudden shocks. Not only must the landing gear
be able to take these shocks, but it must also be so arranged that the air-
plane will be prevented from nosing over when landing.
357

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
358 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
358

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


The proper design of the landing gear requires possibly as much or more
The proper design of the landing gear requires possibly as much or more

attention than any other component of the aircraft, even though the use
of the landing gear contributes such a very small proportion of the useful
attention than any other component of the aircraft, even though the use

of the landing gear contributes such a very small proportion of the useful

life of the aircraft. life of the aircraft.


In coming in for a landing, there are generally three distinct phases:

the initial or steady-approach glide path; a transition phase of either a


DYNAMIC LOADS
"dead-stick landing" or a flared landing path; and the final ground run.

These are depicted in Figure XVIII-1.


In coming in for a landing, there are generally three distinct phases:
Figure XVIII-1. Various stages in the landing approach of an airplane.
the initial or steady-approach glide path; a transition phase of either a
The difference in the landing load factor between the "dead-stick"

landing approach and the flared-path approach is insignificant. However,


"dead-stick landing" or a flared landing path; and the final ground run.
the attitude of the airplane may affect the distribution of the loads, mak-
These are depicted in Figure XVIII-1.
ing it necessary to investigate various conditions to make sure that the

landing-gear members are sufficiently strong. Such components as

wheels, tires, and brakes are not investigated by the airframe designer

since their selection on the basis of static load assures that strength re-

quirements have been amply met.

Steady approach
For the tail-wheel type of landing gear, the basic landing conditions

glide path
cover (1) the level landing attitude with inclined reactions at the main

wheels, and (2) the tail-down landing with vertical reactions at the wheels.

In addition (3) a brake-roll condition, and (4) a side-load condition are

investigated to cover the use of brakes and the landing occurring from a

side-slip.

DYNAMIC LOADS

Normal or "flared" landing path

Ground run

"Dead stick"
landing path
>" ',
Ground run

Ground ' ',


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:06 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FIGURE XVIII-I. Various stages in the landing approach of an airplane.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The difference in the landing load factor between the "dead-stick"


landing approach and the flared-path approach is insignificant. However,
the attitude of the airplane may affect the distribution of the loads, mak-
ing it necessary to investigate various conditions to make sure that the
landing-gear members are sufficiently strong. Such components as
wheels, tires, and brakes are not investigated by the airframe designer
since their selection on the basis of static load assures that strength re-
quirements have been amply met.
For the tail-wheel type of landing gear, the basic landing conditions
cover (1) the level landing attitude with inclined reactions at the main
wheels, and (2) the tail-down landing with vertical reactions at the wheels.
In addition (3) a brake-roll condition, and (4) a side-load condition are
investigated to cover the use of brakes and the landing occurring from a
side-slip.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE LANDING GEAR 359
THE LANDING GEAR

359

For the nose-wheel type of landing gear, the basic landing conditions
For the nose-wheel type of landing gear, the ha.sic landing conditions
are (1) level landing with inclined reactions at the nose and main wheels,
are (1) level landing with inclined reactions at the nose and main wheels,
(2) level landing with inclined reactions at the main wheels, and the nose

wheel just off the ground, (3) the tail-down landing. Subsidiary condi-
(2) level landing with inclined reactions at the main wheels, and the nose
tions take care of (4) braked landing, (5) obstruction load, and (6) side
wheel just off the ground, (3) the tail-down landing. Subsidiary condi-
loads, as well as several supplementary conditions for the nose wheel only.

tions take care of (4) braked landing, (5) obstruction load, and (6) side
loads, as well as several supplementary conditions for the nose wheel only.
The maximum load factor encountered in landing depends upon the

landing-gear characteristics and the method of landing. For the typical

commercial airplane, the limit vertical inertia load factor is one obtained The maximum load factor encountered in landing depends upon the
with a descent velocity, in feet per second, of

V = 4.4 (W7<S)1'«,
landing-gear characteristics and the method of landing. For the typical
but need not exceed 10 feet per second nor be less than 6 feet per second.
commercial airplane, the limit vertical inertia load factor is one obtained
Other restrictions may be imposed, such as that the inertia load factor

with a descent velocity, in feet per second, of


used for design purposes should not be less than 2.67. Since the aircraft

designer does not necessarily desire a load factor greater than 2.67, he

V = 4.4 (W /S)l",
attempts to design the landing gear so that the load factor is not likely

to exceed the minimum specified value.

In the main, the load factor is determined by the rate of energy dissipa-
but need not exceed 10 feet per second nor be less than 6 feet per second.
tion. To keep the load factor as low as possible, the designer would
Other restrictions may be imposed, such as that the inertia load factor
ideally favor a long stroke for the shock absorber. The action of the
used for design purposes should not be less than 2.67. Since the aircraft
shock absorber is similar to that of catching a ball: in order to soften the

impact of the ball hitting his hand at a relatively high speed, the catcher
designer does not necessarily desire a load factor greater than 2.67, he
draws back his hand while catching the ball. attempts to design the landing gear so that the load factor is not likely
Compromises in the design of the shock-absorber stroke are inevitable.

to exceed the minimum specified value.


In the main, the load factor is determined by the rate of energy dissipa-
If it is unusually long, the extended landing gear offers difficulties in re-

traction. Moreover, the motion of the airplane upon landing might be

uncomfortable for the passengers. Therefore, the stroke of the shock


tion. To keep the load factor as low as possible, the designer would
absorber is generally limited to between 6 and 8 inches for normal air-

craft, and from 8 to 12 inches, or sometimes more, for helicopters.


ideally favor a long stroke for the shock absorber. The action of the
MEANS FOR LANDING-SPEED REDUCTION
shock absorber is similar to that of catching a ball: in order to soften the
It would be desirable to reduce the approach speed and the landing-

impact of the ball hitting his hand at a relatively high speed, the catcher
draws back his hand while catching the ball.
run speed, thereby correspondingly reducing the kinetic energy and, in

turn, the work of the shock absorber and the wheel brakes. Some of the

means utilized to accomplish a possible reduction are:


Compromises in the design of the shock-absorber stroke are inevitable.
1. Aerodynamic. To reduce the sinking velocity, high lift-increase

If it is unusually long, the extended landing gear offers difficulties in re-


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

devices may be employed just before the landing run starts. Not only

is the sinking speed changed, but the drag is increased, thereby reducing
traction. Moreover, the motion of the airplane upon landing might be
uncomfortable for the passengers. Therefore, the stroke of the shock
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

forward speed. High lift-increase devices, when employed in this manner,

absorber is generally limited to between 6 and 8 inches for normal air-


are often referred to as air brakes.

It is also possible to increase the drag by having flaps added to the

craft, and from 8 to 12 inches, or sometimes more, for helicopters.

MEANS FOR LANDING-SPEED REDUCTION


It would be desirable to reduce the approach speed and the landing-
run speed, thereby correspondingly reducing the kinetic energy and, in
turn, the work of the shock absorber and the wheel brakes. Some of the
means utilized to accomplish a possible reduction are:
1. Aerodynamic. To reduce the sinking velocity, high lift-increase
devices may be employed just before the landing run starts. Not only
is the sinking speed changed, but the drag is increased, thereby reducing
forward speed. High lift-increase devices, when employed in this manner,
are often referred to as air brakes.
It is also possible to increase the drag by having flaps added to the

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
360 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
360

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL fuselage or by splitting the vertical tail surfaces and opening them up to
fuselage or by splitting the vertical tail surfaces and opening them up to

present a greater flat-plate surface.


present a greater flat-plate surface.

Boundary layer control methods are being extensively investigated for


Boundary layer control methods are being extensively investigated for
possible use in obtaining high lift coefficients to reduce the approach
possible use in obtaining high lift coefficients to reduce the approach
speed.

Various suggestions regarding the use of jet compressors for obtaining


speed.
high-volume, high-velocity air, available either as vertical thrust and thus Various suggestions regarding the use of jet compressors for obtaining
lift or for boundary layer control, seem to offer great possibilities for re-

high-volume, high-velocity air, available either as vertical thrust and thus


ducing landing speeds to manageable proportions.

2. Reversible Propellers. Discussion of the use of reversible propellers


lift or for boundary layer control, seem to offer great possibilities for re-
may be found in Chapter XV, The Propeller.
ducing landing speeds to manageable proportions.
3. Drag Chute. For high-speed airplanes, primarily military aircraft,

a drag chute released from the tail of the airplane works effectively as a
2. ReverS'ible Propellers. Discussion of the use of reversible propellers
braking device. The reasons for using a drag chute may be summarized
may be found in Chapter XV, The Propeller.
as follows:

3. Drag Chute. For high-speed airplanes, primarily military aircraft,


(a) To provide positive decelerating forces under all conditions and

thus permit landing on a given field, regardless of the runway conditions.


a drag chute released from the tail of the airplane works effectively as a
(b) To provide emergency braking in case of the breakdown of landing
braking device. The reasons for using a drag chute may be summarized
gear.

(c) To augment the normal braking system, thereby making possible


as follows:
the use of shorter runways.
(a) To provide positive decelerating forces under all conditions and
(d) To save tire wear.

thus permit landing on a given field, regardless of the runway conditions.


The following data provide a specific example of the advantages in-

volved in the utilization of a drag chute in a landing operation.


(b) To provide emergency braking in case of the breakdown of landing
Length of landing run utilized
gear.
Condition of runway: Dry Icy

Wheel brakes alone 100% 300%


(c) To augment the normal braking system, thereby making possible
Wheel brakes and drag chute 53% 113%
the use of shorter runways.
4. Jet Thrust Reversers. There have been various designs devoted to

(d) To save tire wear.


applying the principle of thrust reversal to jet engines. These thrust

reversers are essentially cups placed in the exhaust jet stream to reverse
The following data provide a specific example of the advantages in-
the direction of the exhaust gases and thereby produce a reverse thrust or

volved in the utilization of a drag chute in a landing operation.


drag. It has been proposed that it might be worth while to employ small

jet engines, which would direct the thrust in a direction opposite to that

Length of landing run utilized


of the motion of the aircraft.

Condition of runway: Dry Icy


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

5. Rockets. Short-lived rockets, operating to produce a reverse thrust,

may also be employed to reduce the landing run.

Wheel brakes alone 100% 300%


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

6. Expendable Skids. Expendable skids or skis extended below the

fuselage to make contact with the ground at about the same level as the
Wheel brakes and drag chute 53% 113%
wheels constitute another possible means of reducing the landing run.

7. Barriers. Barriers at the end of the landing run that make contact
4. Jet Thrust Reversers. There have been various designs devoted to
with the wing, fuselage, and landing gear have been used to advantage

applying the principle of thrust reversal to jet engines. These thrust


reversers are essentially cups placed in the exhaust jet stream to reverse
the direction of the exhaust gases and thereby produce a reverse thrust or
drag. It has been proposed that it might be worth while to employ small
jet engines, which would direct the thrust in a direction opposite to that
of the motion of the aircraft.
5. Rockets. Short-lived rockets, operating to produce a reverse thrust,
may also be employed to reduce the landing run.
6. Expendable Skids. Expendable skids or skis extended below the
fuselage to make contact with the ground at about the same level as the
wheels constitute another possible means of reducing the landing run.
7. Barriers. Barriers at the end of the landing run that make contact
with the wing, fuselage, and landing gear have been used to advantage

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE LANDING GEAR 361
THE LANDING GEAR

361

in stopping the airplane. Such a device would not be desirable in pr<>-


peller-driven aircraft.
in stopping the airplane. Such a device would not be desirable in pro-

peller-driven aircraft.

8. Cables. These are picked up by a landing hook. They have been


8. Cables. These are picked up by a landing hook. They have been
used on aircraft carriers and can be adapted for land use.

DISSIPATION OF ENERGY
used on aircraft carriers and can be adapted for land use.
The normal airplane upon landing has both a sinking and a forward

velocity. The kinetic energy of the airplane from the time the aircraft

first makes contact with the landing area—be it an airport, a ship's deck,

DISSIPATION OF ENERGY
or a water surface—until it comes to rest must be absorbed in some man-

ner. The various devices employed to accomplish this are termed shock
The normal airplane upon landing has both a sinking and a forward
absorbers.

velocity. The kinetic energy of the airplane from the time the aircraft
first makes contact with the landing area-be it an airport, a ship's deck,
Since the airplane may glide to contact with the ground in landing, the

vertical and horizontal component of the landing speed can be determined.

(See Figure XVIII-2 and also Chapter III.)


or a water surface-until it comes to rest must be absorbed in some man-
Lw = W cos 0 = Y2pvgCLS,

v = ^jW cos (3
ner. The various devices employed to accomplish this are termed shock
vg sin j3,
absorbers.
V2pCtS'

vg = gliding speed,
Since the airplane may glide to contact with the ground in landing, the
v, — sinking speed
vertical and horizontal component of the landing speed can be determined.
Vh = Vg cos /3.

(See Figure XVIII-2 and also Chapter III.)


The energy of the airplane due to the sinking speed v, has to be absorbed

by the shock absorbers. The energy

of the airplane due to v>> is usually ab-


Lw = W cos ~ = ~pv.PLS,
sorbed by the brakes of the airplane,

although air resistance also helps.

/W cos~
Therefore, when the airplane is about

ready to contact the ground, the pilot


v" = '\J ~pcLs'
brings it up to the maximum lift co-

efficient so that the speed may be


v11 = gliding speed,
decreased by the high lift coefficient

and the large drag. In order to attain


v. = sinking speed = v11 sin~'
this lift coefficient, the landing gear
Vh = V 11 COS~·
must be so designed as to obtain the corresponding angle.

This energy may be dissipated in any one or a combination of the "The energy of the airplane due to the sin~ing speed v. has to be absorbed
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

following ways:

1. Hysteresis of a material. Rubber shock cords in tension or rubber


by the shock absorbers. The energy
of the airplane due to vh is usually ab-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

disks in compression dissipate energy by hysteresis. Steel in the form of

a coiled spring or a cantilever beam may also be used for the same purpose.

sorbed by the brakes of the airplane,


although air resistance also helps.
Figure XVIII-2. The velocity vec-

tor diagram for the airplane in the glide.

Therefore, when the airplane is about


ready to contact the ground, the pilot
brings it up to the maximum lift co-
------vh efficient so that the speed may be
FrnuRE XVIII-2. The velocity vec- decreased by the high lift coefficient
tor diagram for the airplane in the glide. and the large drag. In order to attain
this lift coefficient, the landing gear
must be so designed as to obtain the corresponding angle.
This energy may be dissipated in any one or a combination of the
following ways:
1. Hysteresis of a material. Rubber shock cords in tension or rubber
disks in compression dissipate energy by hysteresis. Steel in the form of
a coiled spring or a cantilever beam may also be used for the same purpose.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
362 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
362

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL However, since such materials also store up some energy, "bouncing"
However, since such materials also store up some energy, "bouncing"

results, and landing with these shock absorbers may therefore be rough.
results, and landing with these shock absorbers may therefore be rough.
Light airplanes or single-place gliders may employ such means with
Light airplanes or single-place gliders may employ such means with
weight-saving results.
weight-saving results.
2. Friction

(a) Brake friction is the usual accepted method. Here the result
2. Friction
is heat, necessitating provision for adequate heat sinks.
(a) Brake friction is the usual accepted method. Here the result
(b) Fluid friction, whereby a fluid is forced through one or more

orifices, is the standard principle of the so-called hydraulic shock absorbers.


is heat, necessitating provision for adequate heat sinks.
(c) Friction between adjacent leaves of a spring may also be employed (b) Fluid friction, whereby a fluid is forced through one or more
where the energy to be dissipated is not too great.

orifices, is the standard principle of the so-called hydraulic shock absorbers.


3. Compression of a gas. The usual aircraft shock absorber employs

both a fluid-friction device and the compression of air. The adiabatic


(c) Friction between a.djacent leaves of a spring may also be employed
compression of the air represents a portion of the work done, and some of
where the energy to be dissipated is not too great.
the energy is therefore dissipated by this work. The amount of energy

thus dissipated is relatively small, but the compressed air acts as a spring.
3. Compress-ion of a gas. The usual aircraft shock absorber employs
Since the air is forced into the absorber under pressure, it tends to keep
both a fluid-friction device and the compression of air. The adiabatic
the shock absorber (consisting of a piston and a cylinder) extended when-

ever the load is relieved.


compression of the air represents a portion of the work done, and some of
A combination of these energy-dissipating media is present in every
the energy is therefore dissipated by this work. The amount of energy
airplane. The craft itself is a flexible structure, so that it may absorb

thus dissipated is relatively small, but the compressed air acts as a spring.
Since the air is forced into the absorber under pressure, it tends to keep
some of the energy. The wheels and tires are also shock-absorbing

mechanisms.

There has been some experimentation with starting landing wheels in


the shock absorber (consisting of a piston and a cylinder) extended when-
rotation before contact is made with the ground. In this way, the initial

landing shock could be lessened and the wear and tear on the tire reduced.
ever the load is relieved.
Such rotation has been accomplished by means of flaps attached to the
A combination of these energy-dissipating media is present in every
side of the tire acting like a wind-mill or by means of direct application of

airplane. The craft itself is a flexible structure, so that it may absorb


some of the energy. The wheels and tires are also shock-absorbing
power from a small electric motor.

Higher wing loadings generally result in faster landings, creating a need

for stronger struts and wheels, tires that can withstand higher ground-
mechanisms.
impact loads and spin-up speeds, and brakes to absorb and dissipate

increasing amounts of kinetic energy and heat. Since high-speed air-


There has been some experimentation with starting landing wheels in
planes require high wing loadings to attain the desired speeds, the landing
rotation before contact is made with the ground. In this way, the initial
speeds become correspondingly greater unless additional devices or means

landing shock could be lessened and the wear and tear on the tire reduced.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Such rotation has been accomplished by means of flaps attached to the


are used to decrease the approach speed. Such devices and means would

be auxiliary and would usually serve only one specific purpose—to reduce

side of the tire acting like a wind-mill or by means of direct application of


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the approach speed.

SHOCK ABSORBERS

power from a small electric motor.


All landing gears must be equipped with some shock-absorbing device in

Higher wing loadings generally result in faster landings, creating a need


for stronger struts and wheels, tires that can withstand higher ground-
impact loads and spin-up speeds, and brakes to absorb and dissipate
increasing amounts of kinetic energy and heat. Since high-speed air-
planes require high wing loadings to attain the desired speeds, the landing
speeds become correspondingly greater unless additional devices or means
are used to decrease the approach speed. Such devices and means would
be auxiliary and would usually serve only one specific purpose-to reduce
the approach speed.

SHOCK ABSORBERS
All landing gears must be equipped with some shock-absorbing device in

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE LANDING GEAR 363
THE LANDING GEAR

363

Inflation valve
order to avoid sudden shocks to the
Compressed air
passengers, and to a void the enor-
Friction material
mously high stresses that would be
Rubber spring

Compression tube
caused even in a normal landing if
order to avoid sudden shocks to the
no shock absorbers were used.
passengers, and to avoid the enor-

There are various types of shock


mously high stresses that would be

absorbers. At the present time, the Friction mat1rlal


caused even in a normal landing if

no shock absorbers were used.


popular type of shock absorber iM
There are various types of shock

one that utilizes an oil which is made Rubb~r spring


absorbers. At the present time, the

popular type of shock absorber is


to pass from one chamber to another
one that utilizes an oil which is made

through one or more orifices. Com-


to pass from one chamber to another

through one or more orifices. Com-


pressed air is used as a spring to
pressed air is used as a spring to keep the shock absorber extended.
keep the shock absorber extended.

Shock absorbers usually have to


be designed for a particular airplane
Shock absorbers usually have to

be designed for a particular airplane

although it is possible to obtain


although it is possible to obtain
some stock sizes.

These shock absorbers are de-


some stock sizes.
signed to absorb the energy created
These shock absorbers are de-
by a free drop, in inches, of 0.36

signed to absorb the energy created


by a free drop, in inches, of 0.36
times the calculated stalling speed

in miles per hour (but not greater

than 18 inches total for conventional times the calculated stalling speed
airplanes) and in doing so, should

not exceed the design load factors


in miles per hour (but not greater
for the landing conditions.
than 18 inches total for conventional FIGURE XVIIl-3. A shock absorber
In designing shock absorbers it is usually necessary to consider the fol-

airplanes) and in doing so, should developed by Firestone. The illustration


lowing:

1. Gross weight of airplane.


not exceed the design load factors shows a suggested installation.
2. Static load on shock absorber. for the landing conditions.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:07 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. Design load factors.

4. Design load for the principal landing conditions.


In designing shock absorbers it is usually necessary to consider the fol-
lowing:
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

5. Required height of free drop in inches equal to 0.36 (stalling speed

in mph) but not greater than 18 inches.

6. Weight of chassis.
1. Gross weight of airplane.
7^ Vertical movement of wheel center.

8. Maximum tire deflection.


2. Static load on shock absorber.
9. Tire size.
3. Design load factors.
10. Tire inflation.

4. Design load for the principal landing conditions.


5. Required height of free drop in inches equal to 0.36 (stalling speed
11. Shock-absorber strut travel desired.

12. Required length of shock-absorber strut under static load in level-

landing and three-point landing position. in mph) but not greater than 18 inches.
Figure XVIII-3. A shock absorber

6. Weight of chassis.
7.- Vertical movement of wheel center.
developed by Firestone. The illustration

shows a suggested installation.

8. Maximum tire deflection.


9. Tire size.
10. Tire inflation.
11. Shock-absorber strut travel desired.
12. Required length of shock-absorber strut under static load in level-
landing and three-point landing position.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
364 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
364

13. Minimum or maximum length, or both, required for fully com-


AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

13. Minimum or maximum length, or both, required for fully com-

pressed condition.
pressed condition.
14. Minimum or maximum length, or both, required for fully extended

condition.
14. Minimum or maximum. length, or both, required for fully extended
It is often desirable to draw up a three-view line drawing of the landing
condition.
gear to show the configuration of the various members.

It is not generally desirable to place the shock absorbers at too great an


It is often desirable to draw up a three-view line drawing of the landing
angle to the vertical for the best results. A limiting angle of 45 degrees

may be assumed although not more than half that would be more desirable.
gear to show the configuration of the various members.
CLASSIFICATION BY LANDING CONTACT
It is not generally desirable to place the shock absorbers at too great an
The landing gear could be initially classified according to the number of
angle to the vertical for the best results. A limiting angle of 45 degrees
contacts made by the wheels. Since variations are possible, it will be

helpful to discuss them briefly. Whatever the arrangement of wheels,


may be assumed although not more than half that would be more desirable.
the primary goals are usually a minimum of weight installation difficulties

and of retraction complexities.

One-Point Contact
CLASSIFICATION BY LANDING CONTACT
A single wheel has been used primarily for relatively light gliders or to

obtain an amphibious gear. In either case, the wheel is usually partially


The landing gear could be initially classified according to the number of
recessed in the fuselage or in the keel of the flying boat hull. To obtain
contacts made by the wheels. Since variations are possible, it will be
stability on the ground and to protect the rest of the structure, a tail or

helpful to discuss them briefly. Whatever the arrangement of wheels,


the primary goals are usually a minimum of weight installation difficulties
nose skid and wing skids are used. When the aircraft is under way,

either in landing or taking off, contact with the ground is made only

with the wheel. and of retraction complexities.


Some modifications of this principle are possible through the use of a

dual-wheel installation (side by side), which would give the craft some
One-Point Contact
lateral stability on the ground; a tandem arrangement, which would give

some longitudinal stability of the craft on the ground; either a triangular


A single wheel has been used primarily for relatively light gliders or to
three-wheel or a rectangular four-wheel arrangement, which would give
obtain an amphibious gear. In either case, the wheel is usually partially
both lateral and longitudinal stability on the ground and thus eliminate

recessed in the fuselage or in the keel of the flying boat hull. To obtain
stability on the ground and to protect the rest of the structure, a tail or
skids.

Two-Point Contact

Two main wheels having a reasonable tread (distance between wheels nose skid and wing skids are used. When the aircraft is under way,
in the lateral direction) may be employed with the aid of a nose or tail

either in landing or taking off, contact with the ground is made only
skid. Since this imposes some importance on the skids, there may be a

question as to whether such an arrangement really may be termed as


with the wheel.
Some modifications of this principle are possible through the use of a
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:08 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

having two points of contact. This arrangement was used for relatively

light airplanes, but objections were raised against the wear and tear

dual-wheel installation (side by side), which would give the craft some
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

caused by the skids.

A tandem arrangement of two wheels with an appreciable distance be-


lateral stability on the ground; a tandem arrangement, which would give
tween them could be considered. Wing skids would have to be provided

some longitudinal stability of the craft on the ground; either a triangular


three-wheel or a rectangular four-wheel arrangement, which would give
both lateral and longitudinal stability on the ground and thus eliminate
skids.
Two-Point Contact
Two main wheels having a reasonable tread (distance between wheels
in the lateral direction) may be employed with the aid of a nose or tail
skid. Since this imposes some importance on the skids, there may be a
question as to whether such an arrangement really may be termed as
having two points of contact. This arrangement was used for relatively
light airplanes, but objections were raised against the wear and tear
caused by the skids.
A tandem arrangement of two wheels with an appreciable distance be-
tween them could be considered. Wing skids would have to be provided

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE LANDING GEAR 365
THE LANDING GEAR

365

for lateral balance unless there was a dual installation of wheels at either
for lateral balance unless there was a dual installation of wheels at either
the forward or rearward location or both.
the forward or rearward location or both.
Three-Point Contact

This arrangement consists of two main wheels plus either a nose or tail
Three-Point Contact
wheel and is described in greater detail elsewhere in this chapter It is

This arrangement consists of two main wheels plus either a nose or tail
generally thought of as offering the best all-round compromise for weight,

ground stability, and control.


wheel and is described in greater detail elsewhere in this chapter It is
Four-Point Contact
generally thought of as offering the best all-round compromise for weight,
This arrangement, simulating the arrangement of conventional surface

vehicles, has been proposed and used. While ground stability is excep-
ground stability, and control.
tional, other aspects such as control, weight, and installation complexity

(especially retraction) are generally unfavorably affected.


Four-Point Contact
LANDING GEAR—TAIL-WHEEL TYPE This arrangement, simulating the arrangement of conventional surface
The tail-wheel type landing gear consists of (1) two main wheels or

their equivalent, placed slightly ahead of the center of gravity, and (2)
vehicles, has been proposed and used. While ground stability is excep-
a tail wheel or skid at some distance aft of the center of gravity.
tional, other aspects such as control, weight, and installation complexity
While it may be desirable to have the main wheels reasonably far

(especially retraction) are generally unfavorably affected.


ahead of the center of gravity of the airplane, if placed too far forward

there would be difficulty in taking off. In taking off, the tail of the air-

plane must be raised until the longitudinal axis of the airplane is practically

horizontal. In this position, the airplane accelerates quickly until it

reaches a climbing speed and is ready to take off. But, in order to reach
LANDING GEAR-TAIL-WHEEL TYPE
this horizontal attitude, there must be a lift on the horizontal tail surfaces
The tail-wheel type landing gear consists of (I) two main wheels or
produced by the relative wind on these tail surfaces caused by the pro-

peller slipstream and the forward acceleration of the craft. This lift, mul-
their equivalent, placed slightly ahead of the center of gravity, and (2)
tiplied by the distance from the center of pressure on the horizontal tail
a tail wheel or skid at some diRtance aft of the center of gravity.
surfaces to the point of contact of the wheel with the ground, is the mo-

While it may be desirable to have the main wheels reasonably far


ahead of the center of gravity of the airplane, if placed too far forward
ment which must be just equal to the moment produced by the weight of

the airplane times the distance from the center of gravity of the airplane

to the point of wheel and ground contact. When these two moments are
there would be difficulty in taking off. In taking off, the tail of the air-
equal, the airplane will be in a horizontal attitude. As soon as the airplane

starts to accelerate, the elevators, which have been depressed up to this


plane must be raised until the longitudinal axis of the airplane is practically
time, are gradually neutralized. Otherwise, too much lift would be
horizontal. In this position, the airplane accelerates quickly until it
created and the airplane would nose over.

reaches a climbing speed and is ready to take off. But, in order to reach
this horizontal attitude, there must be a lift on the horizontal tail surfaces
If the front wheels were quite far ahead of the center of gravity of the
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:08 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

airplane, a greater moment would have to be produced by the horizontal

tail surfaces. Since the lift on the tail surfaces is proportional to the
produced by the relative wind on these tail surfaces caused by the pro-
peller slipstream and the forward acceleration of the craft. This lift, mul-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

square of the speed, it would be necessary to increase the speed to obtain

the necessary lift. However, it takes time to start at zero speed and ac-

celerate up to a particular speed, and the longer it takes to accelerate, the


tiplied by the distance from the center of pressure on the horizontal tail
surfaces to the point of contact of the wheel with the ground, is the mo-
ment which must be just equal to the moment produced by the weight of
the airplane times the distance from the center of gravity of the airplane
to the point of wheel and ground contact. When these two moments are
equal, the airplane will be in a horizontal attitude. As soon as the airplane
starts to accelerate, the elevators, which have been depressed up to this
time, are gradually neutralized. Otherwise, too much lift would be
created and the airplane would nose over.
If the front wheels were quite far ahead of the center of gravity of the
airplane, a greater moment would have to be produced by the horizontal
tail surfaces. Since the lift on the tail surfaces is proportional to the
square of the speed, it would be necessary to increase the speed to obtain
the necessary lift. However, it takes time to start at zero speed and ac-
celerate up to a particular speed, and the longer it takes to accelerate, the

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
366 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

FIGURE XVllI--4. Preliminary considerations in locating the landing gear. The gen-
eral dimensions follow: A, propeller tip clearance with the ground, with the tire defiated
approximately one quarter of its nominal diameter, should be 9 inches; B, the rolling
diameter of the tire (see D); C, the angle included between the perpendicular erected
at the point of contact of the wheel with the ground in the level landing position and a
line connecting the axle and the fully loaded center of gravity position of the airplane,
should be between 13 to 17 degrees; D, the nominal tire diameter. The bottom of the
wing should clear the top of the tire by a few inches with shock absorber fully com-
pressed to eliminate possibility of preventing wheel rotation due to ice and mud. E, an
angle equal to that corresponding to 9/10 of the maximum lift coefficient of the wing.
Dimensions a and b are useful in determining the static load on the wheels.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:08 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Fmuu XVIII-5. The front wheel should not swing more than 5 degrees ahead of
the vertical for the tail-high position by the airplane. The limitihg positions of the
center of gravity should be between 16 and 25 degrees of the vertical shown, for a total
of 9 degrees. The tail wheel should not swing under the various loading conditions of
more than 5 degrees. A is the rolling radius of wheel; Eis the angle designated in the
previous figure. C is the angle of incidence of the root chord of the wing.

Original from
019 t1zoo by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
---
--
THE LANDING GEAR 367

FrnuaE XVllI-6. Note the clearances that have to be kept in mind: A, propeller
and ground clearance; B, wheel and wing clearance; C, deflected flap clearance with the
ground; D, deflected elevator clearance with the ground.

longer will be the take-oft' run. The recommendations given in this chap-
ter are the result of many years of experience of aircraft designers and
present the best all-round compromise of all factors involved.
Brakes are used to reduce the landing run. If the brakes were used
immediately upon level landing, the inertia of the airplane might be suffi-
cient to nose it over. It is necessary, therefore, to put the wheels farther
forward for a landing gear employing brakes than one without brakes.
Landing introduces another problem in the disposition of the wheels.
If the tail wheel is too close to the front wheels, or the front wheels are too
close together in relation to the span of the wings, the airplane may ground-
loop, a phenomenon in which the airplane may pivot on one wheel, mean-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:08 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

while dragging a wing tip along the ground.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

LANDING GEAR-NOSE-WHEEL TYPE


In this design the center of gravity is slightly ahead of the two main
wheels, and the nose wheel is placed as far forward as the particular
airplane design will permit.
The advantages claimed for this configuration of wheels are:
1. 1.' here should be greater passenger comfort since the passengers are
sitting in a cabin which is level not only when flying but also on the take-
off.
2. There is better vision both for the pilot and for the passengers not
only in landing but also on the take-off.
3. The tricycle landing gear gives greater ground stability since the
three wheels are likely to be more evenly loaded at all times.
4. There should be no tendency to nose over since the nose wheel, being
ahead of the center of gravity of the airplane, would resist any nosing over.
The nose wheel is therefore a definite nosing-over preventative.

, Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
368 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

5. Since the airplane cannot nose over, there is the possibility of landing
at almost any angle of attack. For the private flyer who may be a "dub"
pilot, this is a very good fea.ture since the landing technique need not be
well-nigh letter perfect. For transport airplanes, the possibility of land-
ing at almost any angle is advantageous in blind flying when the ground is
not visible.
6. Also, because nosing over is unlikely, it is possible to have a shorter
landing run since the brakes can be applied as soon as contact with the
ground is made. Moreover, since the lift on the wings is less at the mo-
ment of landing due to the smaller angle of attack, the load on the wheels
will be greater, and with brakes on all three wheels, the braking will be-
come more effective.
7. The smaller angle of incidence of the airplane with the ground wiU
permit the airplane to accelerate faster up to take-off speed anct practically
"automatic" take-offs a.re possible and in much shorter time than for the
conventional landing gear.
8. The quicker take-offs and shorter landing runs permit a shorter block-
to-block speed which is an important factor in economical commercial air
transports.ti on.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:09 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

F1ouaE XVIIl-7. Angular requirements for. the components of the tricycle landing
gear are shown here. The front wheel motion is limited to an angular range from
10 to 15 degrees from the vertical; the main wheel from 7~ to 15 degrees, and the rear
emergency tail wheel 5 degrees from the vertical. The ratio of the tread of the main
wheels (see Figure XIV-2) to the dimension A should not be less than 0.75 nor greater
than 1.25 for good ground< handling characteristics. The angle C should be not less
than B. D is the angle of incidence of the wing. Dimensions a and b are useful in
determining the static load on the wheels.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE LANDING GEAR 369

9. The airplane rests on wheels with the wings at a smaller angle of at-
tack than for the conventional landing gear. The lift coefficient of the
wings at small angles of attack is small so that even at relatively large wind
speeds, the lift on the wings is not likely to be great enough to blow the
airplane over.
Against these very favorable advantages of the tricycle landing gear,
there should be balanced these possible disadvantages which may be en-
tirely or at least partially overcome by proper design:
1. If the two main wheels in rear of the center of gravity are too far back,
the load on the nose wheel will be increased. This will necessitate a heav-
ier nose wheel.
2. If the two main wheels are too near the center of gravity, the nose
wheel will not have enough load on it and will therefore tend to bounce
more easily when taxying.
3. If the front wheel is located too close to the two main wheels, one of
the following may occur:
(a) A sudden swerve of the airplane may be followed by turning over,
at about a line connecting the nose wheel with one of the two
main wheels.
(b) The front or no~ wheel may shimmy unless there is friction
damping.
(c) The airplane may have a tendency to buck.
4. Unless the airplane can assume a greater angle of attack at take-off,
the take-off run on muddy ground may be long. The propeller thrust
and the higher ground drag due to the mud seem to cause the nqse wheel
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:09 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVIIl-8. Note the clearances that have to be kept in mind: A, propeller
and ground clearance; B, wheel and wing clt:arance; C, deflected flap and ground clear-
ance; D, deflected elevator and ground clearance. E and Fare rolling radii of wheels.

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
370 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
370

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


to dig in at low angles of attack. By raising the nose of the airplane the
to dig in at low angles of attack. By raising the nose of the airplane the

load on the nose wheel is relieved.


load on the nose wheel is relieved.
5. With increase in propeller thrust, the load on the nose wheel increases 5. With increase in propeller thrust, the load on the nose wheel increases
since the propeller thrust line is above the nose wheel. Unless the nose

since the propeller thrust line is above the nose wheel. Unless the nose
wheel is equipped with a larger "oleo" travel and a stronger structure,
wheel is equipped with a larger "oleo" travel and a stronger structure,

severe shock loads are likely to be transmitted to the airplane structure,

for the "oleo" or shock absorber may be compressed long before any seri-
severe shock loads are likely to be transmitted to the airplane structure,
ous loads are imposed.

6. Difficulty may be encountered with the nose wheel in riding over


for the "oleo" or shock absorber may be compressed long before any seri-
obstacles. The tail wheel seems to behave better under such circum-
ous loads are imposed.
stances.

6. Difficulty may be encountered with the nose wheel in riding over


obstacles. The tail wheel seems to behave better under such circum-
7. The tail wheel has the advantage of protecting the tail surfaces. Un-

less a skid or special crash pad is provided for the rear portion of the fuse-

lage when the nose-wheel type of landing gear is used, the rear portion of stances.
the fuselage may be damaged in case of an unusual "tail low" landing.

8. The nose wheel causes more difficulty in retraction because of its


7. The tail wheel has the advantage of protecting the tail surfaces. Un-
location in the forward portion of the fuselage and because of its longer
less a skid or special crash pad is provided for the rear portion of the fuse-
shock-absorber travel.
lage when the nose-wheel type of landing gear is used, the rear portion of
TRACK-TYPE LANDING GEAR

Track-type landing gears have received serious consideration for large


the fuselage may be damaged in case of an unusual "tail low" landing.
transport planes.
8. The nose wheel causes more difficulty in retraction because of its
The advantages of the track-type landing gear are:

location in the forward portion of the fuselage and because of its longer
shock-absorber travel.
1. Ability to operate from sand, dirt, and sod, since the track-type

gear sink is less than one third as much as the tires.

2. Ability of heaviest planes to operate from existing runways since

the aircraft load is spread over approximately 250 per cent greater run-

way surface.

3. "Bounce" eliminated from hot landings; the gear holds to the ground
TRACK-TYPE LANDING GEAR
after touch-down.
Track-type landing gears have received serious consideration for large
4. Virtual elimination of ground-loop dangers.

5. Elimination of possibility of blowouts and punctures.


transport planes.
6. Compactness enables retraction into smaller wing or nacelle well.
The advantages of the track-type landing gear are:
7. Greater stability when striking ground obstacles.

1. Ability to operate from sand, dirt, and sod, since the track-type
gear sink is less than one third as much as the tires.
8. More efficient braking through larger ground-contact area; better

cooling of brakes through better heat dissipation.

2. Ability of heaviest planes to operate from existing runways since


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:09 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

9. Belt runs cooler than a tire so wears less; also, low unit ground

pressure of belt upon landing allows sufficient slippage at first contact to

the aircraft load is spread over approximately 250 per cent greater run-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

practically eliminate wear as a factor in longevity.

The apparent disadvantages are:


way surface.
1. Heavier installation.
3. "Bounce" eliminated from hot landings; the gear holds to the ground
2. May be very bulky and hard to retract. (See 6 above)

after touch-down.
4. Virtual elimination of ground-loop dangers.
5. Elimination of possibility of blowouts and punctures.
6. Compactness enables retraction into smaller wing or nacelle well.
7. Greater stability when striking ground obstacles.
8. More efficient braking through larger ground-contact area; better
cooling of brakes through better heat dissipation.
9. Belt runs cooler than a tire so wears less; also, low unit ground
pressure of belt upon landing allows sufficient slippage at first contact to
practically eliminate wear as a factor in longevity.
The apparent disadvantages are:
1. Heavier installation.
2. May be very bulky and hard to retract. (See 6 aboveJ

Original from
Dig 1ze b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE LANDING GEAR 371
THE LANDING GEAR

371
3. At present, relatively easy to put out of commission with rocks and
3. At present, relatively easy to put out of commission with rocks and

sand. (See 5 above.)


sand. (See 5 above.)
4. Requires more maintenance. (See 9 above.)
4. Requires more maintenance. (See 9 above.)
Many of these disadvantages must be viewed in the light of the early

stage of development of track-type landing gear at present. Probably, with


Many of these disadvantages must be viewed in the light of the early
more time, study, and ideas, most of these unfavorable aspects can be
stage of development of track-type landing gear at present. Probably, with
lessened or even eliminated.

TANDEM GEAR
more time, study, and ideas, most of these unfavorable aspects can be
In place of the track-type landing gear, tandem wheel trains have been lessened or even eliminated.
devised, using either two wheels in tandem in place of the main wheel, or

two sets of dual wheels in tandem. These arrangements have been sug-

gested in order to:

TANDEMGEAR
1. Reduce the over-all size of the individual wheels and thus encourage

compactness. In place of the track-type landing gear, tandem wheel trains have been
2. Reduce the "foot-print" pressures of the tires by increasing their

devised, using either two wheels in tandem in place of the main wheel, or
contact area.

3. Obtain some of the favorable characteristics of the track-type land-


two sets of dual wheels in tandem. These arrangements have been sug-
ing gear without the concomitant mechanical difficulties.
gested in order to:
Some of the disadvantages encountered in such a landing gear are:

1. The speed range in which smooth landings can be made is more


1. Reduce the over-all size of the individual wheels and thus encourage
limited. The airplane cannot be landed at a speed much higher than
compactness.
that required for simultaneous contact of both gears. Touching the

front gear first with an appreciable rate of descent will result in an up-
2. Reduce the "foot-print" pressures of the tires by increasing their
ward bounce or will at least prevent sufficient load being applied to the contact area.
wheel to pemit effective braking.

3. Obtain some of the favorable characteristics of the track-type land-


2. Due to the large fore and aft spread of the tandem gears, the pilot

has virtually no control over the attitude on the ground. However, this
ing gear without the concomitant mechanical difficulties.
arrangement has been found satisfactory as it prevents the pilot from

Some of the disadvantages encountered in such a landing gear are:


varying the unstick speed improperly. The ground attitude is selected

for optimum take-off speed.


1. The speed range in which smooth landings can be made is more
CROSS-WIND LANDING GEAR

In a cross-wind landing, the pilot approaches the airport with the air-
limited. The airplane cannot be landed at a speed much higher than
plane at a slight angle to the runway in order to counteract the drifting
that required for simultaneous contact of both gears. Touching the
force produced by the cross-wind. If his judgment is wrong, he may align

front gear first with an appreciable rate of descent will result in an up-
ward bounce or will at least prevent sufficient load being applied to the
the airplane with the runway either too early or too late, thus imposing
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:09 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

severe loads on the landing gear that make ground-looping possible.

The cross-wind landing gear incorporates wheel installations that may wheel to pemit effective braking.
2. Due to the large fore and aft spread of the tandem gears, the pilot
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

allow the wheels to swivel and to line up the airplane not with its longi-

tudinal axis, but in the direction of its inertia forces.

has virtually no control over the attitude on the ground. However, this
arrangement has been found satisfactory as it prevents the pilot from
varying the unstick speed improperly. The ground attitude is selected
for optimum take-off speed.

CROSS-WIND LANDING GEAR


In a cross-wind landing, the pilot approaches the airport with the air-
plane at a slight angle to the runway in order to counteract the drifting
force produced by the cross-wind. If his judgment is wrong, he may align
the airplane with the runway either too early or too late, thus imposing
severe loads on the landing gear that make ground-looping possible.
The cross-wind landing gear incorporates wheel installations that may
allow the wheels to swivel and to line up the airplane not with its longi-
tudinal axis, but in the direction of its inertia forces.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
372 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
372

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Several types of cross-wind landing gear have been proposed both here
Several types of cross-wind landing gear have been proposed both here

and abroad.
and abroad.

One type provides for an assembly of wheel and wheel fork permitted One type provides for an assembly of wheel and wheel fork permitted
to swivel any amount under control of the pilot but locked by him in a

predetermined position. Where such a landing gear is employed, the


to swivel any amount under control of the pilot but locked by him in a
pilot must make a free run over the field to decide the amount of wind
predetermined position. Where such a landing gear is employed, the
correction needed.

pilot must make a free run over the field to decide the amount of wind
correction needed.
The advantages claimed for this type are:

1. The pilot has accurate steering at all times. The airplane will taxi

just as with the normal configuration except that the longitudinal axis

The advantages claimed for this type are:


of the airplane may not coincide with the direction of travel.

2. As the gear is locked at the desired angle of swivel, resistance to side


1. The pilot has accurate steering at all times. The airplane will taxi
loads due to taxiing, propeller thrust, etc., will be exerted, regardless of the

position of the wheels.


just as with the normal configuration except that the longitudinal axis
3. As only a wheel-positioning attachment is needed, no changes in the of the airplane may not coincide with the direction of travel.
wheel, axle, and shock-absorber strut assembly are required.

2. As the gear is locked at the desired angle of swivel, resistance to side


4. A shimmy damper is not necessary.

5. The arrangement requires a minimum of added weight.


loads due to taxiing, propeller thrust, etc., will be exerted, regardless of the
The disadvantages may be summarized as:
position of the wheels.
1. Additional operation required of the pilot.

2. Difficulty in exactly determining surface winds or in forecasting


3. As only a wheel-positioning attachment is needed, no changes in the
gusts. The amount of locked-in swivel is therefore hard to gauge and wheel, axle, and shock-absorber strut assembly are required.
in any case cannot be accurately predetermined without practice.

4. A shimmy damper is not necessary.


Another type cross-wind landing gear is automatic in operation since

it employs the use of casterable wheels. Shimmy dampers would be


5. The arrangement requires a minimum of added weight.
required.

The disadvantages may be summarized as:


The favorable aspects of this type may be listed as the following:

1. The pilot does not have to actuate the gear to the desired swivel 1. Additional operation required of the pilot.
angle.

2. Difficulty in exactly determining surface winds or in forecasting


2. As the mechanism is simple, there is less chance of failure.

3. Fool-proof landings can be made if the runways are sufficiently wide.


gusts. The amount of locked-in swivel is therefore hard to gauge and
The disadvantages involved in this type are:
in any case cannot be accurately predetermined without practice.
1. The wheels are somewhat difficult to steer since the longitudinal axis

of the airplane must be turned through the entire swivel range of the
Another type cross-wind landing gear is automatic in operation since
wheel (unless a strap is engaged) before the wheel starts to turn and the
it employs the use of casterable wheels. Shimmy dampers would be
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:09 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

required.
direction of travel is changed.

2. There is the possible danger of wheel shimmy unless an adequate

The favorable aspects of this type may be listed as the following:


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

shimmy damper is employed.

3. As the longitudinal axis of the airplane may vary greatly from the

direction of travel, instrument take-offs and landings may be difficult for


1. The pilot does not have to actuate the gear to the desired S'Yivel
pilot-operated airplanes.

angle.
2. As the mechanism is simple, there is less chance of failure.
3. Fool-proof landings can be made if the runways are sufficiently wide.
The disadvantages involved in this type are:
1. The wheels are somewhat difficult to steer since the longitudinal axis
of the airplane must be turned through the entire swivel range of the
wheel (unless a strap is engaged) before the wheel starts to turn and the
direction of travel is changed.
2. There is the possible danger of wheel shimmy unless an adequate
shimmy damper is employed.
3. As the longitudinal axis of the airplane may vary greatly from the
direction of travel, instrument take-offs and landings may be difficult for
pilot-operated airplanes.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE LANDING GEAR 373
THE LANDING GEAR

373

4. If used on an aircraft with dual wheels, a device must be provided


4. If used on an aircraft with dual wheels, a device must be provided
to prevent any uncontrolled swivelling resulting from the unbalanced
to prevent any uncontrolled swivelling resulting from the unbalanced
moments caused by tire blowouts. To avoid this difficulty, each wheel

moments caused by tire blowouts. To avoid this difficulty, each wheel


of a dual-wheel (side-by-side) arrangement would have to be independently
of a dual-wheel (side-by-side) arrangement would have to be independently

operated.

5. It is estimated that the weight increase in the landing gear for this
operated.
type of installation may be as much as 50 per cent above the normal

configuration.
5. It is estimated that the weight increase in the landing gear for this
Use of the cross-wind gear should shorten take-off runs in most cases
type of installation may be as much as 50 per cent above the normal
since during cross-wind operation there is an alleviation both of the early

configuration.
separation of the flow over the down-wind wing in the region near the

root and the condition of boundary layer wash-out. This is especially


Use of the cross-wind gear should shorten take-off runs in most cases
true for swept-wing designs.

since during cross-wind operation there is an alleviation both of the early


separation of the flow over the down-wind wing in the region near the
shows how the wheels would operate in a crosswind landing. The wheels line up with

the direction of the inertia of the airplane, not with the longitudinal axis of the airplane.

The swivelling wheel, fork, and shock-absorber member may be preset in flight, and root and the condition of boundary layer wash-out. This is especially
then locked, to give the pilot steering control of the wheel; or wheel may be given a

slight trail (point of contact is behind the swivel axis) so as to give each wheel inde-
true for swept-wing designs.
pendent and automatic castering ability.

Shimmy is a phenomenon commonly encountered in landing-gear

installations.

When castering rubber-tired nose or tail wheels are used, there is a

tendency for the wheel to oscillate violently about the spindle axis. This

phenomenon is popularly termed 'shimmy'. It may be corrected by (1)

the application of friction at the spindles of the tail wheels, (2) locking

the wheels while taxiing at high speeds, and (3) incorporation of shimmy

dampers.

Shimmy is common with the large nose wheels used in tricycle landing

gears. Because it is impossible to lock the wheels, friction for the spindle

has been the sole means of correction; but the larger the wheel and the

The illustration

SHIMMY AND SHIMMY DAMPERS

FIGURE XVIII-9. A ca.sterable landing gear has been developed. The illustration
shows how the wheels would operate in a. crosswind landing. The wheels line up with
the direction of the inertia of the airplane, not with the longitudinal a.xis of the airplane.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The swivelling wheel, fork, and shock-absorber member may be preset in flight, a.nd
then locked, to give the pilot steering control of the wheel; or wheel may be given a.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

slight trail (point of contact is behind the swivel axis) so a.s to give ea.ch wheel inde-
pendent and automatic ca.stering ability.

SHIMMY AND SHIMMY DAMPERS


Shimmy is a phenomenon commonly encountered m landing-gear
installations.
When castering rubber-tired nose or tail wheels are used, there is a
tendency for the wheel to oscillate violently about the spindle axis. This
phenomenon is popularly termed 'shimmy'. It may be corrected by (1)
the application of friction at the spindles of the tail wheels, (2) locking
the wheels while taxiing at high speeds, and (3) incorporation of shimmy
dampers.
Shimmy is common with the large nose wheels used in tricycle landing
gears. Because it is impossible to lock the wheels, friction for the spindle
has been the sole means of correction; but the larger the wheel and the

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
374 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
374

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

greater the load carried by the wheel, the larger the amount of spindle
friction necessary to prevent shimmy. Friction devices absorb energy by
greater the load carried by the wheel, the larger the amount of spindle

friction necessary to prevent shimmy. Friction devices absorb energy by

clamping together two dissimilar materials. The resultant damping


clamping together two dissimilar materials. The resultant damping
action is maximum at zero velocity and decreases with motion, depend-

action is maximum at zero velocity and decreases with motion, depend-


ing upon the materials and type of rubbing surfaces. Moreover, the damp-

Figure XVIII-10. A shimmy-damper installation. The wheel and fork assembly


ing upon the materials and type of rubbing surfaces. Moreover, the damp-
may rotate in the upper bearing. The rotation is limited by the shimmy-damper

installation shown above and to the right of the axis of the fork strut. The shock

absorber is shown inclined upward to the right. The "scissors" or "nut-cracker"

attachment allows for only axial motion of the piston inside the shock-absorber cylinder.

The shimmy could be incorporated within the lower end of the shock-absorber strut.

The distance between the vertical through the axle center and the axis of rotation of

the wheel fork, at ground contact, is known as the caster length.


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FmuRE XVIII-IO. A shimmy-damper installation. The wheel and fork assembly


may rotate in the upper bearing. The rotation is limited by the shimmy-damper ..
installation shown above an<l to the right of the axis of the fork strut. The shock
absorber is shown inclined upward to the right. The "scissors" or "nut-era.cker"
attachment allows for only axial motion of the piston inside th~ shock-absorber cylinder.
The shimmy could be incorporated within the lower end of the shock-absorber strut.
The distance between the vertical through the axle center and the axis of rotation of
the wheel fork, at ground contact, is known as the caster length.

Original from
Dig 1ze b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE LANDING GEAR 375
THE LANDING GEAR

375

ing is likely to fluctuate and to be undependable. The structure, further-


ing is likely to fluctuate and to be undependable. The structure, further-
more, is large and unwieldy. Since friction damping is maximum at low more, is large and unwieldy. Since friction damping is maximum at low
velocities, the nose wheel does not respond to steering and to finding its

velocities, the nose wheel does not respond to steering and to finding its
true castering position.

Hydraulic damping means, on the other hand, have very little resistance
true castering position.
for slow wheel movements. However, as wheel motion due to shimmying
Hydraulic damping means, on the other hand, have very little resistance
increases, the damping action increases also, since hydraulic energy ab-

sorption is proportional to the square of the velocity.


for slow wheel movements. However, as wheel motion due to shimmying
Hydraulic shimmy dampers may be of two types—the piston and the increases, the damping action increases also, since hydraulic energy ab-
vane type.

sorption is proportional to the square of the velocity.


Hydraulic shimmy dampers may be of two types-the piston and the
The piston damper is similar to the common hydraulic shock absorber.

The piston is connected by suitable means to the wheel fork and operates

in a cylinder attached to the shock strut. Through a system of torque


vane type.
scissors and sliding collar, the wheel movements are transmitted to the

movement of the piston. The piston, in turn, reciprocates within the


The piston damper is 8imilar to the common hydraulic shock absorber.
cylinder and forces a fluid through appropriate orifices for energy ab-
The piston is connected by suitable means to the wheel fork and operates
sorption.

in a cylinder attached to the shock strut. Through a system of torque


scissors and sliding collar, the wheel movements are transmitted to the
One vane-type damper consists of an oscillatory pair of vanes connected

to a shaft, plus a stationary pair of vanes connected to the housing or

stationary cylinder. This combination forms two pairs of diametrically-


movement of the piston. The piston, in turn, reciprocates within the
opposite pressure chambers. Displacement of fluid and consequent re-

sistance are obtained by the movable vanes turning toward or in relation


cylinder and forces a fluid through appropriate orifices for energy ab-
to the stationary vanes. The fluid is passed through a valve orifice from
sorption.
the chamber of decreasing volume to the adjacent chamber of increasing

One vane-type damper consists of an oscillatory pair of vanes connected


to a shaft, plus a stationary pair of vanes connected to the housing or
volume. The fluids used are the same as for the shock absorber.

TREAD

The wheel tread is a function of (a) the height of the center of gravity
stationary cylinder. This combination forms two pairs of diametrically-
above the ground, (b) the wing span, and (c) the distance between the

front wheels and the tail wheel. As these dimensions increase in size, the
opposite pressure chambers. Displacement of fluid and consequent re-
larger the wheel tread should be for good ground behavior.
sistance are obtained by the movable vanes turning toward or in relation
WHEEL AND TIRE SIZE

to the stationary vanes. The fluid is passed through a valve orifice from
the chamber of decreasing volume to the adjacent chamber of increasing
The size of the wheels and tires in the conventional landing gear is de-

termined by the static weight equal to half the gross weight of the airplane

per wheel. It is not necessary to determine the load factors and loads im- volume. The fluids used are the same as for the shock absorber.
posed by various landing conditions since the wheels and tires are origi-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

nally designed with ample margins of safety.

The size of the wheels for a tricycle landing gear depends upon their

TREAD
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

position relative to the center of gravity. The two rear wheels may have

The wheel tread is a function of (a) the height of the center of gravity
above the ground, (b) the wing span, and (c) the distance between the
front wheels and the tail wheel. As these dimensions increase in size, the
larger the wheel tread should be for good ground behavior.

WHEEL AND TIRE SIZE


The size of the wheels ·and tires in the conventional landing gear is de-
termined by the static weight equal to half the gross weight of the airplane
per wheel. It is not necessary to determine the load factors and loads im-
posed by various landing conditions since the wheels and tires are origi-
nally designed with ample margins of safety.

The size of the wheels for a tricycle landing gear depends upon their
position relative to the center of gravity. The two rear wheels may have

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
376 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
376

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

from 85 to almost 100 per cent of the load while the front wheel may have
from 85 to almost 100 per cent of the load while the front wheel may have
from 10 to 25 per cent of the gross weight of the airplane as the static load.
from 10 to 25 per cent of the gross weight of the airplane as the static load.
The weight of the tail wheel for preliminary weight estimate and balance

determination can be estimated by assuming a static load of about one-fifth

to one-twelfth the gross weight of the airplane and then choosing the re-
SIZE OF TAIL OR NOSE WHEEL
The weight of the tail wheel for preliminary weight estimate and balance
quired nose or tail wheel, with the larger fraction for the nose wheel.

After the center of gravity has been found, the weight and size of the

nose or tail wheel may be corrected by finding the correct static load on determination can be estimated by assuming a static load of about one-filth
the wheel as follows:

Examination of the landing gears reveals that the wheel without any
to one-twelfth the gross weight of the airplane and then choosing the re-
load on it, as incorporated in the normal landing gear, may toe-in; or the
quired nose or tail wheel, with the larger fraction for the nose wheel.
vertical centerline when viewed from the front is at an angle of several de-
After the center of gravity has been found, the weight and size of the
grees from the vertical, commonly known as camber. These two features

are of course accentuated when the landing gear is in the fully extended
nose or tail wheel may be corrected by finding the correct static load on
position due to the configuration of the particular members of a landing
the wheel as follows:
gear. The condition for which to design is the static-loaded condition,

~ b) gross weight.
either in the level-landing position or the three-point landing position.

The wheels are given no toe-in for the normal condition unless the con-

static load Ri = (a
figuration of the landing gear should be such as to cause an appreciable

toeing-out in the fully contracted position.

The camber given the wheels may be 1 or 2 degrees outward unless,


Refer to Figure XVIIl-4 and Figure XVIll-7.
again, the configuration of the landing gear is such as to give an undesir-

able camber when in the fully contracted position.

Too much leeway either way may cause the tire to roll off when landing.
WHEEL POSITION
The position of the wheels with relation to the center of gravity is shown

in the illustration for the conventional landing gear and the tricycle land-
Examination of the landing gears reveals that the wheel without any
ing gear.

load on it, as incorporated in the normal landing gear, may toe-in; or the
SIZE OF TAIL OR NOSE WHEEL

Refer to Figure XVIII-4 and Figure XVIII-7.


vertical centerline when viewed from the front is at an angle of several de-
WHEEL POSITION grees from the vertical, commonly known as camber. These two features
RETRACTION OF LANDING GEAR

No high-speed airplane should have a nonretracting gear if the best pos-


are of course accentuated when the landing gear is in the fully extended
sible performance is desired.
position due to the configuration of the particular members of a. landing
The simplest form of retraction is one that employs only one motion,
gear. The condition for which to design is the static-loaded condition,
either in the level-landing position or the three-point landing position. ·
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The wheels are given no toe-in for the normal condition unless the con-
figuration of the landing gear should be such as to cause an appreciable
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

toein11;-out in the fully contracted position.


The camber given the wheels may be 1 or 2 degrees outward unless,
again, the configuration of the landing gear is such as to give an undesir-
able camber when in the fully contracted position.
Too much leeway either way may cause the tire to roll off when landing.
The position of the wheels with relation to the center of gravity is shown
in the illustration for the conventional landing gear and the tricycle land-
ing gear.

RETRACTION OF LANDING GEAR


No high-speed airplane should have a nonretracting gear if the best pos-
sible performance is desired.
The simplest form of retraction is one that empl9ys only one motion,

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
THE LANDING GEAR 377
THE LANDING GEAR

377

either in a plane parallel to the


line of flight or in a plane per-
either in a plane parallel to the

line of flight or in a plane per-

pendicular to the line of flight.


pendicular to the line of flight.
For moderately small airplanes

of the single-engine type, retrac-


For moderately small airplanes
tion sideways is best since suf-
of the single-engine type, retrac-
ficient room is available in the

tion sideways is best since suf-


root of the wing whereas retrac-

tion rearward will still leave at


ficient room is available in the
least half of the wheel exposed. root of the wing whereas retrac-
The student should study the

tion rearward will still leave at


least half of the wheel exposed.
schematic sketches of retractable

landing gear here presented in Figure XVIII-11. A landing gear re-

Figures XVIII-11, XVIII-12, tracted sideways into the fuselage•


The student should study the
and XVIII-13, in order to get a

good conception of the various methods that may be employed for re-
schematic sketches of retractable
traction. landing gear here presented in FIGURE XVIII-11. A landing gear re-
In manually operated retracting mechanisms, the force to operate the
Figures XVIIl-11, XVIIl-12, tracted sideways into the fuselage.
and XVlll-13, in order to get a
crank or lever should not exceed 15 or 20 pounds. About sixty 12-inch

strokes per minute is a practical maximum. Large and heavy landing-

gear retraction systems incorporate a bungee.


good conception of the various methods that may be employed for re-
To prevent creeping, the usual reduction ratios of screw and nut, or

Fiocbb XVIII-12. The landing gear is retracted directly rearward into the wing
traction.
between the front and rear spars. Similar linkages could be employed to retract the
In manually operated retracting mechanisms, the force to operate the
gear sideways.

crank or lever should not exceed 15 or 20 pounds. About sixty 12-inch


strokes per minute is a practical maximum. Large and heavy la.nding-
gear retraction systems incorporate a bungee.
To prevent creeping, the usual reduction ratios of screw and nut, or
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XVIIl-12. The landing gear is retracted directly rearward into the wing
between the front and rear spars. Similar linkages could be employed to retract the
gear sideways.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
378 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
378

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVIII-13. Another retractable landing gear design where space between

the front and rear wing spars is limited.

worm and wormwheel combinations, will insure irreversibility although

some positive stop device should be incorporated to assure safety.

Special attention should be paid to limit switches, valves, cable installa-

tion, latches, indicating systems, universal joints, and pressure devices to

reduce maintenance problems.

Table XVIII-1. Minimum radius of bend for hydraulic lines. Aluminum alloy or

stainless steel tubing.

Outside diameter of

Minimum bend radius

tube, in inches

measured to tube centerline

'/£

2
Fiouu XVIIl-13. Another retractable landing gear design where space between
IX
the front and rear wing spars is limited.
1

worm and wormwheel combinations, will insure irreversibility although


some positive stop device should be incorporated to assure sa.fety.
Special attention should be paid to limit switches, valves, cable installa-
tion, latches, indicating systems, universal joints, and pressure devices to
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:10 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

reduce maintenance problems.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

TABLE XVIIl-1. Minimum radius of bend for hydraulic lines. Aluminum alloy or
stainless steel tubing.

Outside diameter of Minimum bend radius


tube, in inches measured to tube centerline
Ys 72
~ %
~ 1
%i 1
% 1~
72 172
% 1%
% 2
1 3

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE LANDING GEAR 379
THE LANDING GEAR

379

Figure XVIII-14. A simple brake installation. The arrows indicate the direction of

linkage when applying full brake. The brake pedal system is suspended from the

rudder bar.

Figure XVIII-15. A detail drawing of the landing gear used on the Ercoupe.

FIGURE XVIIl-14. A simple brake installation. The arrows indicate the direction of
link.age when applying full brake. The brake pedal system is suspended from the
rudder bar.

Front beam 01eo


/igsupport
_.,_ _ End fitting
Spacers ~--.w rP~~-- Piston

--Fe
~-- Rubber fl1/er
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Air chamber Thrust plate


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Fairing edge
Cylinder ---..--U.--1
Oiler fitnnn
'I --it--+-\\-..&:;~
,I Cup
Tie rod--t--f-4~'
Aluminum alloy
casting
Sleeve of synthetic
material

Aluminum alloy
costing
Fitted with
hydraulic brake
FIGURE XVIIl- 15. A detail drawing of the landing gear used on the Ercoupe.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
380 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
380

+
~l-~-~-=OJ--
AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XVIII-16. Representative proportions of a typical shock absorber are

shown in this figure. The piston has the smaller diameter.

Table XVIII-2. Representative dimensions of hydraulic-type shock absorbers.

Static load, in pounds,

Stroke,

Piston diameter,

Length,
FIGURE XVIIl-16. Representative proportions of a typical shock absorber are
per strut
shown in this figure. The piston has the smaller diameter.
in inches

in inches

in inches

500- 1000

6
TABLE XVIIl-2. Representative dimensions of hydraulic-type shock absorbers.
1.50

19.5

1000- 1500
Static load, in pounds, Stroke, Piston diameter, Length,
6
per strut in inches in inches in inches
1.75

19.5-23.5
500- 1000 6 1.50 19.5
1500- 2000
1000- 1500 6 1.75 19.5-23.5
6
1500- 2000 6 2.00 19.5-24.0
2.00 2000- 2500 6 2.25 19.5-25.5
19.5-24.0 2500- 3000 6 2.50 19.5-26.0
2000- 2500
3000- 4000 6 2.75 19.5-28.0
6
4000- 5000 6 3.125 20.0-30.5
2.25
5000- 6000 6 3.50 20.0-32.5
19.5-25.5
6000- 8000 6 4.125 20.0-32.5
2500- 3000

8000-10,000 6 4.625 20.5-34.0


6

10,000-12,000 6 5.00 20.5-34.0


2.50

12,000-14,000 6 5.50 20.5-34.0


19.5-26.0

3000- 4000

2.75

19.5-28.0

SPECIAL PROBLEMS
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

4000- 5000

Speeds approaching hypersonic flight are posing special problems in the


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

3.125

20.0-30.5 design of landing gear and associated equipment. It is possible that


5000- 6000

these equipment items will someday all but disappear.


Wings for transonic and supersonic flight are already too thin for
6

3.50

20.0-32.5
stowing complicated retractable landing gear. It is also difficult to find
6000- 8000

6
room for the gear in the crowded fuselage, which must carry increasing
4.125
quantities of avionics, fuel, cooling systems, and other equipment. As
20.0-32.5

planes fly deeper into the thermal region, the landing-gear wheel wells
would have to be cooled to preserve such components as shock strut and
8000-10,000

4.625 brake seals and tires. This would require larger cooling systems and
20.5-34.0

10,000-12,000
better sealed and insulated wheel-well doors.
6
Recent detailed studies of landing-gear accidents indicate that aft-
5.00
retracting nose gears have often been the cause. Inadequate fairing
20.5-34.0

12,000-14,000
doors, inadequate tires, inadequate brakes, and inadequate retracting
6
mechanisms have also played a part. All of these items merit special
5.50

consideration in design.
20.5-34.0

SPECIAL PROBLEMS

Speeds approaching hypersonic flight are posing special problems in the

design of landing gear and associated equipment. It is possible that

these equipment items will someday all but disappear.

Original from
Wings for transonic and supersonic flight are already too thin for

Dig 1ze b
stowing complicated retractable landing gear. It is also difficult to find
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
room for the gear in the crowded fuselage, which must carry increasing

quantities of avionics, fuel, cooling systems, and other equipment. As

planes fly deeper into the thermal region, the landing-gear wheel well's
THE LANDING GEAR 381
THE LANDING GEAR

381

Figure XVIII-17. Minimum clearance between wheel and supporting structure is

approximately 1/25 to 1/30 of the wheel diameter. There should be increasing allow-

ance away from the entrance point.


..,

FIGURE XVIII-17. Minimum clearance between wheel and supporting structure is


approximately 1/25 to 1/30 of the wheel diameter. There should be increasing allow-
ance away from the entrance point.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:11 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
CHAPTER XIX

Tail Surfaces

The tail surfaces serve two functions. The fixed portions of the tail

surfaces, together with the movable, provide stability vhile the movable

portion in conjunction with the fixed portion provides a means for control.

LONGITUDINAL STABILITY CONSIDERATIONS

Imagine an airplane flying along in horizontal flight at constant speed

struck by a sudden gust of wind, either on the wing or on the tail surfaces,
CHAPTER XIX
so that the airplane is forced suddenly nose upward or nose downward.

Without any control exerted by the pilot, or any change made in the

throttle setting, the airplane should return to its original angle of attack

after cessation of the gust and continue to fly in its original direction. It

may not return to its original angle of attack instantaneously, but may

oscillate back and forth, with the oscillations gradually diminishing.


Tail Surfaces
Definitions

Stability is that property which tends to return an airplane to its orig-

inal condition of equilibrium or line of motion when it has been disturbed

from that condition. This deviation from equilibrium or steady motion

may be caused by an external force, such as a gust, or it may be caused by

the pilot when he depresses the elevator and then returns it to its original

position almost immediately. When the airplane regains equilibrium or

line of motion (flies at a given angle of attack at constant speed) due to


The tail surfaces serve two functions. The fixed portions of the tail
forces and moments developed inherently and of such character as to

surfaces, together with the movable, provide stability v.rhile the movable
portion in conjunction with the fixed portion provides a means for control.
counteract the disturbing force or moments, it demonstrates this property

of stability. An example of longitudinal stability has been cited in the

previous paragraph. There are similar cases of stability about the longi-

tudinal axis, or lateral stability, and about the vertical or normal axis, or

LONGITUDINAL STABILITY CONSIDERATIONS


directional stability.

Imagine an airplane flying along in horizontal flight at constant speed


struck by a sudden gust of wind, either on the wing or on the tail surfaces,
so that the airplane is forced suddenly nose upward or nose downward.
Without any control exerted by the pilot, or any change made in the
throttle setting, the airplane should return to its original angle of attack
after cessation of the gust and continue to fly in its original direction. It
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

may not return to its original angle of attack instantaneously, but may
oscillate back and forth, with the oscillations gradually diminishing.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Definitions

Stability is that property which tends to return an airplane to its orig-


inal condition of equilibrium or line of motion when it has been disturbed
from that condition. This deviation from equilibrium or steady motion
may be caused by an external force, such as a gust, or it may be caused by
the pilot when he depresses the elevator and then returns it to its original
position almost immediately. When the airplane regains equilibrium or
line of motion (flies at a given angle of attack at constant speed) due to
forces and moments developed inherently and of such character as to
counteract the disturbing force or moments, it demonstrates this property
of stability. An example of longitudinal stability has been cited in the
previous paragraph. There are similar cases of stability about the longi-
tudinal axis, or lateral stability, and about the vertical or normal axis, or
directional stability.
382

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 383
TAIL SURFACES

383
There are two distinct types of stability, aside from their relationships
There are two distinct types of stability, aside from their relationships

to particular axes. An airplane, for example, is so designed that at one


to particular axes. An airplane, for example, is so designed that at one
angle of attack the resulting moment of all forces about the center of
angle of attack the resulting moment of all forces about the center of
jrravity will be zero. This satisfies the condition of equilibrium together

~a.vity will be zero. This satisfies the condition of equilibrium together


with the fact that the sum of all forces along the 3 axes equals zero, but

this is known as static longitudinal stability. It was mentioned earlier


with the fact that the sum of all forces along the 3 axes equals zero, but
that the airplane does not come back to its original condition of equilibrium
this is known as static longitudinal stability. It was mentioned earlier
immediately but continues to oscillate. This oscillation is a manifestation

of dynamic longitudinal stability.


that the airplane does not come back to its original condition of equilibrium
There are also three different states of static stability and of dynamic
immediately but continues to oscillate. This oscillation is a manifestation
stability, whether applied to longitudinal stability, to lateral stability, or

of dynamic longitudinal stability.


There are also three different states of static stability and of dynamic
to directional stability.

-4° 0° 4° 8° 12° 16° 20°

Figtob XIX-1. Pitching moment coefficients about the center of gravity plotted
stability, whether applied to longitudinal stability, to lateral stability, or
for the wing, the tail, and the complete airplane. The diagram shows how and where

the slope of the pitching moment curve should be measured.


to directional stability.
For example, an airplane may be neutrally stable. It may be disturbed

from its original attitude, and instead of coming back to it, will continue

in its new attitude.

Or, the airplane may be unstable: When disturbed from its original atti-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:12 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

-40 40 8" 12° 16° 20°


FIGURE XIX-1. Pitching moment coefficients about the center of gravity plotted
for the wing, the tail, and the complete airplane. The diagram shows how and where
the slope of the pitching moment curve should be measured.

For example, an airplane may be neutrally stable. It may be disturbed


from its original attitude, and instead of coming back to it, will continue
in its new attitude.
Or, the airplane may be unstable: When disturbed from its original atti-

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
384 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
384

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


tude, instead of coming back to it, it will go farther and farther, not re-
tude, instead of coming back to it, it will go farther and farther, not re-

maining at any attitude.


H the airplane does come back to its original attitude, then it is said to
maining at any attitude.

If the airplane does come back to its original attitude, then it is said to

be stable. be stable.
These three examples are cases of static stability. Similar cases of

These three examples are cases of static stability. Similar cases of


dynamic stability would be:

1. Stable when the oscillations of the airplane gradually decrease to zero


dynamic stability would be:
after they are once started.

2. Neutral when the oscillations do not decrease or increase in amplitude


1. Stable when the oscillations of the airplane gradually decrease to zero
when once the oscillations have been set up.
after they are once started.
3. Unstable when the oscillations increase with time after they have

been once set up.


2. Neutral when the oscillations do not decrease or increase in amplitude
Preliminary Calculations for Static Longitudinal Stability
when once the oscillations have been set up.
Static longitudinal stability of an airplane may be determined with

3. Unstable when the oscillations increase with time after they have
been once set up.
reasonable accuracy by calculating the pitching moments about the center

of gravity of the fully loaded airplane. See Figure XIX-1.

Preliminary Calculations for Static Longitudinal Stability


The equation for the pitching moments has been derived in Chapter IX

and reads as follows:

Cm„. = Cm„. + Xi(CL cos a + CD sin a) + j/i(Ci sin a — Cd cos a) —
Static longitudinal stability of an airplane may be determined with
0.8y2 CL, f*. (1)

or simply,
reasonable accuracy by calculating the pitching moments about the center
Cm,.,. = Cm. + Cm,. (la) of gravity of the fully loaded airplane. See Figure XIX-1.
This equation may be used for the initial calculations to determine whether

stability is adequate. When the designer is reasonably satisfied with his


The equation for the pitching moments has been derived in Chapter IX
design configuration, then a more accurate equation may be derived to and reads as follows:
take into consideration effect of fuselage, landing gear, and the like.

The student may set up his own tables, which are always desirable where

· .. · CM.... = CM.... + x1(CL cos a+ CD sin a) + Y1(CL sin a - Cv cos a) -

ff~,
repetitive calculations are called for, to evaluate numerically the various

values of the equation

0.8y2 CL, (1)


Cm,.,. = Cm. + Cm,0

or simply,
ADEQUACY OF STATIC STABILITY

To determine whether or not the longitudinal stability is adequate, the


(la)
degree of stability is determined by calculating the value of the so-called

Diehl's stability coefficient:

This equation may be used for the initial calculations to determine whether
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:13 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

stability is adequate. When the designer is reasonably satisfied with his


(dCM.Jda)

W/S

design configuration, then a more accurate equation may be derived to


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

take into consideration effect of fuselage, landing gear, and the like.
The student may set up his own tables, which are always desirable where
repetitive calculations are called for, to evaluate numerically the various
values of the equation

ADEQUACY OF STATIC STABILITY

To determine whether or not the longitudinal stability is adequate, the


degree of stability is determined by calculating the value of the so-called
Diehl's stability coefficient:
(dCM•.,./da)
W/S

Original from
_JJ~IVERSITY OF MICHIG N
TAIL SURFACES 385
TAIL SURFACES

385

If, therefore, the value of Cm.*• is found for a series of angles of attack 0,
If, therefore, the value of CM.... is found for a series of angles of attack 0,
and plotted as the ordinate with values of a as the abscissa, then the value and plotted as the ordinate with values of a as the abscissa, then the value
of the slope of the resulting curve, particularly in the region in the angle

of the slope of the resulting curve, particularly in the region in the angle
of trim will give the value of dCM..../da. This value divided by the wing
of trim will give the value of dCM..,./da. This value divided by the wing

loading W/S for the airplane will give the value of the stability coefficient.

For commercial airplanes of the passenger transport type, the value for
loading W / S for the airplane will give the value of the stability coefficient.
dCit„./da of the stability coefficient lies between —0.0005 and —0.0010.

FLIGHT CRITERIA FOR STABILITY AND CONTROLS


For commercial airplanes of the passenger transport type, the value for
The designer attempts to build into the airplane such characteristics as dCM,.../da of the stability coefficient lies between -0.0005 and -0.0010.
will insure adequate stability and control. The particular recommenda-

tions and procedures outlined in this book are relatively brief and are in-

tended to point out the high lights. They are believed to be all that a

student can cover in a reasonable time. The practicing engineer, how-


FLIGHT CRITERIA FOR STABil.,ITY AND CONTROLS
ever, has to make a careful study of all existing reports and research papers

in order to be able to select those features necessary to achieve the quali- The designer attempts to build into the airplane such characteristics as
ties desired for a given design.

will insure adequate stability and control. The particular recommenda-


To give an idea of some of the free flight characteristics desired for air-

planes, the following synopsis based upon NACA reports (for example,
tions and procedures outlined in this book are relatively brief and are in-
NACA Wartime Report L-276) may be useful.
tended to point out the high lights. They are believed to be all that a
Longitudinal Stability and Control

When the elevator is held in a given position, the airplane should main-
student can cover in a reasonable time. The practicing engineer, how-
tain the attitude assumed:
ever, has to make a careful study of all existing reports and research papers
1. With engines idling, flaps up or down, at all speeds above the stall;

in order to be able to select those features neces.sary to achieve the quali-


ties desired for a given design.
2. With engines at cruising, flaps down, landing gear down, as for land-

ing approach, at all speeds above the stall;

3. With engines at full power, flaps up, at all speeds above 120 per cent
To give an idea of some of the free flight characteristics desired for air-
of the stalling speed;

4. At maximum and minimum speeds in level flight.


planes, the following synopsis based upon N ACA reports (for example,
The elevator should be designed to
NACA Wartime Report L-276) may be useful.
1. Obtain control forces such that "pull forces" are required at all

speeds below the trim speed, and "push forces" at all speeds above;

2. Obtain control forces always sufficient to return the airplane to its


Longitudinal Stability and Control
trim position;
When the elevator is held in a given position, the airplane should main-
3. Obtain the allowable load factor (G's) of the airplane as well as the

maximum lift coefficient of the airplane by use of the elevator alone;


tain the attitude as.sumed:
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:15 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

4. Obtain at least 4 inches of rearward movement of the stick for a

highly maneuverable airplane, such as a fighter, for a change in lift co-


1. With engines idling, flaps up or down, at all speeds above the stall;
2. With engines at cruising, flaps down, landing gear down, as for land-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

efficient from 0.2 to the maximum lift coefficient of the wing;

ing approach, at all speeds above the stall;


3. With engines at full power, flaps up, at all speeds above 120 per cent
of the stalling speed;
4. At maximum and minimum speeds in level flight.

The elevator should be designed to


1. Obtain control forces such that "pull forces" are required at all
speeds below the trim speed, and "push forces" at all speeds above;
2. Obtain control forces always sufficient to return the airplane to its
trim position;
3. Obtain the allowable load factor (G's) of the airplane as well as the
maximum lift coefficient of the airplane by use of the elevator alone;
4. Obtain at least 4 inches of rearward movement of the stick for a
highly maneuverable airplane, such as a fighter, for a change in lift co-
efficient from 0.2 to the maximum lift coefficient of the wing;

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
386 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
386

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

5. Obtain control forces varying not more than 50 pounds for every G
5. Obtain control forces varying not more than 50 pounds for every G

attained in steady turning flight for heavy transports, but less than 6
attained in steady turning flight for heavy transports, but less than 6
pounds per G for highly maneuverable types, and at least 30 pounds of
pounds per G for highly maneuverable types, and at least 30 pounds of
stick force for every type to attain the allowable load factor;

6. Hold the airplane off the ground until the minimum speed of the air-
stick force for every type to attain the allowable load factor;
plane has been reached with the control force not exceeding 50 pounds on
6. Hold the airplane off the ground until the minimum speed of the air-
control wheels, and 35 pounds on control sticks;

plane has been reached with the control force not exceeding 50 pounds on
control wheels, and 35 pounds on control sticks;
7. Hold the airplane level after one-half of the take-off speed has been

reached;

8. Be capable of trimming the airplane, after it has been trimmed in


7. Hold the airplane level after one-half of the take-off speed has been
level flight with zero stick forces, without obtaining forces greater than 50

pounds for the wheel and 35 pounds for the stick, regardless of the changes
reached;
in power or flap settings.
8. Be capable of trimming the airplane, after it has been trimmed in
Elevator trim tabs must be capable of reducing stick forces to zero under

level flight with zero stick forces, without obtaining forces greater than 50
pounds for the wheel and 35 pounds for the stick, regardless of the changes
the following conditions:

1. Cruising condition at any speed between high speed and 120 per cent

of the stalling speed of the airplane; in power or flap settings.


2. In the landing condition at any speed between 120 to 140 per cent of

the landing speed;


Elevator trim tabs must be capable of reducing stick forces to zero under
3. Must maintain a given setting for an indefinite period of time.

Stick-free damping may be examined in flight by moving the stick sud-


the following conditions:
denly and releasing it with the airplane in steady and level flight. The

resulting pitching of the airplane and movement of the elevator must dis-
1. Cruising condition at any speed between high speed and 120 per cent
appear completely after 1 cycle in order to insure stability in rough air of the stalling speed of the airplane;
without aggravating the pitching of the airplane and thereby incurring

2. In the landing condition at any speed between 120 to 140 per cent of
loss of control. Short period damping depends on:

1. Elevator hinge moment coefficients,


the landing speed;
2. Mass balance of the control system,
3. Must maintain a given setting for an indefinite period of time.
3. Moment of inertia of the control system.

GENERAL REQUIREMENTS

It is very important that these tail surfaces be so located that they are
Stick-free damping may be examined in flight by moving the stick sud-
not blanketed by the fuselage. If the fuselage has a relatively large cross
denly and releasing it with the airplane in steady and level flight. The
section for the greater part of its length and then tapers suddenly near the

resulting pitching of the airplane and movement of the elevator must dis-
appear completely after 1 cycle in order to insure stability in rough air
tail post, it is very likely that the horizontal tail surfaces will be blanketed

unless the aspect ratio of these surfaces is high.

without aggravating the pitching of the airplane and thereby incurring


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The vertical tail surfaces are most likely to be blanketed not only by

the fuselage but also by the horizontal tail surfaces, especially when the

loss of control. Short period damping depends on:


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

airplane is at a high angle of attack. In order to minimize this effect, it

1. Elevator hinge moment coefficients,


would be desirable to get some of the vertical tail surfaces below the hori-

zontal tail surfaces.

2. Mass balance of the control system,


3. Moment of inertia of the control system.

GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
It is very important that these tail surfaces be so located that they are
not blanketed by the fuselage. If the fuselage has a relatively large cross
section for the greater part of its length and then tapers suddenly near the
tail post, it is very likely that the horizontal tail surfaces will be blanketed
unless the aspect ratio of these surfaces is high.
The vertical tail surfaces are most likely to be blanketed not only by
the fuselage but also by the horizontal tail surfaces, especially when the
airplane is at a high angle of attack. In order to minimize this effect, it
would be desirable to get some of the vertical tail surfaces below the hori-
zontal tail surfaces.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
TAIL SURFACES 387
TAIL SURFACES

387

Aerodynamically, it would be nice to have a large aspect ratio for both


the vertical and horizontal tail surfaces, but unfortunately the greater the
Aerodynamically, it would be nice to have a large aspect ratio for both

the vertical and horizontal tail surfaces, but unfortunately the greater the

aspect ratio the more difficult it becomes to get an efficient structure that aspect ratio the more difficult it becomes to get an efficient structure that
will be rigid. Since the movable surfaces are a reasonably large propor-

will be rigid. Since the movable surfaces are a reasonably large propor-
tion of the total area, the fixed portion, which supports the movable sur-

faces, must contain all the necessary structure. If the aspect ratio is too
tion of the total area, the fixed portion, which supports the movable sur-
great for the area, there is relatively little depth with the result that
faces, must contain all the necessary structure. If the aspect ratio is too
the fixed surfaces may deflect so much under a load that the hinges of

the movable surfaces bind.


great for the area, there is relatively little depth with the result that
The proportion of the movable surfaces to the whole depends upon the
the fixed surfaces may deflect so much under a load that the hinges of
degree of control desired. A large movable surface, for example, needs

the movable surfaces bind.


The proportion of the movable surfaces to the whole depends upon the
less angular deflection than a smaller-sized surface. If the airplane is to

be very maneuverable, it is desirable to have relatively large movable sur-

faces. In any case it is necessary to have sufficient control at the slowest degree of control desired. A large movable surface, for example, needs
and at the highest speeds the airplane will attain.

The elevator should be able to trim the airplane at the lowest, or stall
less angular deflection than a smaller-sized surface. If the airplane is to
speed, at which time the elevator will usually have its maximum angular
be very maneuverable, it is desirable to have relatively large movable sur-
deflection upward. The elevator should also be able to trim the airplane
faces. In any case it is necessary to have sufficient control at the slowest
practically at zero lift, at which time the elevator may have its maximum

angular deflection downward.


and at the highest speeds the airplane will attain.
Control, however, is not measured only by the change in angle of trim
The elevator should be able to trim the airplane at the lowest, or stall
of the airplane caused by a definite angular deflection of the elevator (and

speed, at which time the elevator will usually have its maximum angular
deflection upward. The elevator should also be able to trim the airplane
the discussion here applies equally to the vertical tail surfaces) but also by

the hinge moments produced. If for the same angular deflection of the

movable surface one has greater hinge moments than another, it should
practically at zero lift, at which time the elevator may have its maximum
be obvious that the one with the smaller hinge moments can be actuated

far more quickly, and the response of the entire airplane will be quicker
angular deflection downward.
therefore.
Control, however, is not measured only by the change in angle of trim
CONTROL SURFACES

of the airplane caused by a definite angular deflection of the elevator (and


the discussion here applies equally to the vertical tail surfaces) but also by
Typically, control surfaces are flapped surfaces located at the trailing

edge of a stationary surface. Therefore an aileron, a rudder, an elevator,

a tab, or a combination of these are control surfaces of the flap variety. the hinge moments produced. If for the same angular deflection of the
They are designed to change the lift of the entire surface (whether wing,

movable surface one has greater hinge moments than another, it should
or horizontal or vertical tail surface) and thereby create a moment about

one of three axes of the airplane for motion or control about that axis.
be obvious that the one with the smaller hinge moments can be actuated
far more quickly, and the response of the entire airplane will be quicker
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:17 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Some discussion on flaps and ailerons in Chapter XVII, Design of the

Wing, dealt with increase in lift versus flap deflection and with hinge

therefore.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

moments. The student is referred to that discussion since it is equally

applicable to tail surfaces.

The magnitude of these hinge moments is becoming an increasingly im-

CONTROL SURFACES
portant problem. There are several solutions available. In some cases,

(for example, the aileron) it helps materially in reducing the hinge mo-
Typically, control surfaces are flapped surfaces located at the trailing
edge of a stationary surface. Therefore an aileron, a rudder, an elevator,
a tab, or a combination of these are control surfaces of the flap variety.
They are designed to change the lift of the entire surface (whether wing,
or horizontal or vertical tail surface) and thereby create a moment about
one of three axes of the airplane for motion or control about that axis.
Some discussion on flaps and ailerons in Chapter XVII, Design of the
Wing, dealt with increase in lift versus flap deflection and with hinge
moments. The student is referred to that discussion since it is equally
applicable to tail surfaces.
The magnitude of these hinge moments is becoming an increasingly im-
portant problem. There are several solutions available. In some cases,
(for example, the aileron) it helps materially in reducing the hinge mo-

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
388 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
388 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

merits to have a smaller chord so that the ratio of the chord of the movable

ments to have a smaller chord so that the ratio of the chord of the movable
surface to that of the entire surface is 15 to 20 per cent. This necessitates
surface to that of the entire surface is 15 to 20 per cent. This necessitates

a larger span in order to get the same total control but, unfortunately, the

rudder or elevator seldom has the ratio of its chord to the chord of the com- a larger span in order to get the same total control but, unfortunately, the
plete surface less than 45 or 50 per cent. In order to reduce the hinge

rudder or elevator seldom has the ratio of its chord to the chord of the com-
plete surface less than 45 or 50 per cent. In order to reduce the hinge
moments, the surfaces may be partially aerodynamically balanced either

by having the hinge line of the movable surface somewhat in rear of its

leading edge, or by having a small movable surface or tab attached near


moments, the surfaces may be partially aerodynamically balanced either
the trailing edge of the main movable surface. This small surface has an

angular deflection opposite to that required for the main movable surface.
by having the hinge line of the movable surface somewhat in rear of its
If the tab is small or its setting fixed and changed only when the load
leading edge, or by having a small movable surface or tab attached near
conditions change the center of gravity, then its purpose is for trim only,

the trailing edge of the main movable surface. This small surface has an
angular deflection opposite to that required for the main movable surface.
and is known as a trimming tab. It takes the place of the adjustable

stabilizer.

If the tab can be controlled from the cockpit, it may be used to operate If the tab is small or its setting fixed and changed only when the load
the larger surface and is then called a control tab or a servotab.

conditions change the center of gravity, then its purpose is for trim only,
Aerodynamic balance is generally used, even if trailing-edge tabs are

present. The design of this balance is very critical and is still the subject
and is known as a trimming tab. It takes the place of the adjustable
of much experimental work. For greater effectiveness, a slot in front of
stabilizer.
the leading edge of the balance is provided. Although this slot helps to

increase the effectiveness of the movable surfaces, yet, more often than
If the tab can be controlled from the cockpit, it may be used to operate
not, the relatively large gap caused by the slot increases the parasite drag.
the larger surface and is then called a control tab or a servotab.
Great care should be taken in designing the leading edge of the aero-

Aerodynamic balance is generally used, even if trailing-edge tabs are


present. The design of this balance is very critical and is still the subject
dynamic balance so that it is not too sharp and does not project too far

above the upper or lower contour of the fixed surface when the movable

surface is deflected. Such projections collect ice very quickly under icing
of much experimental work. For greater effectiveness, a slot in front of
conditions and may lead to unbalance of the control surface, or jamming

of the controls.
the leading edge of the balance is provided. Although this slot helps to
Design details of the tail surfaces are given under the various paragraph
increase the effectiveness of the movable surfaces, yet, more often than
heads immediately following.
not, the relatively large gap caused by the slot increases the parasite drag.
For high-speed aircraft at or near transonic speeds, flaps for controls

produce an appreciable increase in drag, known as trim drag. For that


Great care should be taken in designing the leading edge of the aero-
reason, instead of flapped surfaces, the entire surface is sometimes moved
dynamic balance so that it is not too sharp and does not project too far
(as on the Wright Brothers'original airplane).

above the upper or lower contour of the fixed surface when the movable
AIRFOIL SECTIONS

Symmetrical airfoils are usually used for tail surfaces so that equal effec-
surface is deflected. Such projections collect ice very quickly under icing
conditions and may lead to unbalance of the control surface, or jamming
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

tiveness per degree of deflection may be obtained for both up and down

of the contr<>ls.
movements.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The airfoil section used should have a thickness ratio of from 6 to 9 per

cent and not more than 12 per cent. Unless the tail surfaces are ex- Design details of the tail surfaces are given under the various para.graph
ceptionally large, the same airfoil is used from tip to root. The NACA

heads immediately following .


0006, 0009 and 0012 series are recommended.

.For high-speed aircraft at or near transonic speeds, flaps for controls


produce an appreciable increase in drag, known as trim drag. For that
reason, instead of flapped surfaces, the entire surface is sometimes moved
(as on the Wright Brothers' original airplane).
AIRFOIL SECTIONS
Symmetrical airfoils are usually used for tail surfaces so that equal effec-
tiveness per degree of deflection may be obtained for both up and down
movements.
The airfoil section used should have a thickness ratio of from 6 to 9 per
cent and not more than 12 per cent. Unless the tail surfaces are ex-
ceptionally large, the same airfoil is used from tip to root. The N ACA
0006, 0009 and 0012 series are recommended.

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 389
389

Figure XIX-2. Three forms of aerodynamic balance for movable surfaces. (A) is

called an unshielded horn balance; (B) is a shielded horn type; (C) shows the more

commonly used aerodynamic balance. All have a certain amount of area ahead of the

hinge pin.

AERODYNAMIC BALANCE

When the flap or control surface is deflected, the center of pressure or

the aerodynamic forces on the flapped surface is behind the hinge line,

producing hinge moments. These hinge moments divided by the lever

arm of the control arm in the cockpit give rise to the stick force that the

pilot has to exert in order to move the control surface.

Figures XIX-2 and XIX-3 show a number of means for obtaining

aerodynamic balance, each of which has special merits of its own. There

are various NACA reports which should be consulted for aerodynamic

details.

The ratio of aerodynamic balance area to the movable surface usually

is from .15 to .20 for the rudder and the elevator. It is generally not

desirable to overbalance the movable surface since it is considered psycho-

logically sound to have the stick forces that are to be overcome increase

with the angular deflection of the surface.

Figure XIX-3. The balancing tab reduces the hinge moments. The hinge moment,

FIGURE XIX-2. Three forms of aerodynamic balance for movable surfaces. (A) is
H, for the illustration, is equal to Pia " PJ>.

called an unshielded horn balance; (B) is a shielded horn type; (C) shows the more
commonly used aerodynamic balance. All have a certain amount of area ahead of the
hinge pin.
AERODYNAMIC BALANCE
When the flap or control surface is deflected, the center of pressure or
the aerodynamic forces on the flapped surface is behind the hinge line,
producing hinge moments. These hinge moments divided by the lever
arm of the control arm in the cockpit give rise to the stick force that the
pilot has to exert in order to move the control surface.
Figures XIX-2 and XIX-3 show a number of means for obtaining
aerodynamic balance, each of which has special merits of its own. There
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:18 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

are various NACA reports which should be consulted for aerodynamic


details.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The ratio of aerodynamic balance area to the movable surface usually


is from .15 to .20 for the rudder and the elevator. It is generally not
desirable to overbalance the movable surface since it is considered psycho-
logically sound to have the stick forces that are to be overcome increase
with the angular deflection of the surface.

FIGURE X IX- 3. The balancing tab reduces the hinge moments. The hinge moment,
H, for the illustration, is equal to Pia - P2b.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
390 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
390

[_]~
AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Fig. XIX-* Fig. XIX-5

Figure XIX-4. Bulge contour for control surfaces. These tend to float, and

thereby to reduce the control forces.

Figure XIX-5. Pressure diaphragm balance, shown schematically. A flexible

membrane is used for the diaphragm.

Fig. XIX-6 Fig. XIX-7

Fig. XIX-4 Fig. XIX-5


Figure XIX-6. Cord or bead along the trailing edges of control surfaces may be

used in place of trimming tabs.


F10URE XIX-4. Bulge contour for control surfaces. These tend to float, and
Figure XIX-7. Wedge or bevel contour for control surfaces may be used in place
thereby to reduce the control forces.
of trim tabs.

FIGURE XIX-5. Pressure diaphragm balance, shown schematically. A flexible


membrane is used for the diaphragm.
Figure XIX-8. Different arrangements for the operation of trim tabs. The top

two diagrams illustrate fixed trim tabs adjustable, by trial and error, to the proper

degree on the ground, while the two lower diagrams show arrangements which may be

operated from the cockpit.

Fig. XIX--6 Fig. XIX-7


FIGURE XIX--6. Cord or bead along the trailing edges of control surfaces may be
used in place of trimming tabs.
FIGURE XIX-7. Wedge or bevel contour for rontrol surfaces may be used in place
of trim tabs.

c
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:19 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

-----#r-
e ~
c ------...,\1- 1~
FtGl-U: XIX-8. Different arrangements for the operation of trim tabs. The top
t'l\·o diagrams illustrate fi..,;ed trim tabs adjustable, by trial and error, to the proper
degree on the ground, while the two lower diagrams show arrangements 'llrbi~h may be
operated from the cockpit.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 391

c---~---~.. ~
TAIL SURFACES

391

c ____$Es~ ~
Figure XIX-9. Different arrangements of servo-control and boost-type tabs.

Trailing-Edge Tabs and Other Devices

Trailing-edge tabs on movable surfaces are another means of obtaining

aerodynamic balance.

A tab on the aileron is used to overcome engine torque. It may be used

with the rudder for the same purpose as the offset fin and on the elevator

for the same purpose as the adjustable stabilizer.

Trimming tabs have a chord varying from 5 to 10 per cent of the mov-

able surface chord and approaching 25 per cent of the chord if used as

servocontrol tabs. The aspect ratio should be as high as possible, varying

usually from as low as 5 to as high as 20.

A control surface is said to be statically balanced when the center of

gravity of the plane containing the hinge line acts through that hinge

line. Static balance is one of the design features required to avoid flutter

possibilities.

For low-speed aircraft having maximum speeds below about 200 miles,

static balances are generally not necessary. For greater speeds, static

balance for movable surfaces becomes a necessity.

For a surface that has its hinge line at the leading edge, static balance
FIGURE XIX-9. Different arrangements of servo-control and boost-type tabs.
can be obtained only with a concentrated weight ahead of the hinge line

to counterbalance the weight of the movable surface.

For the surface having its hinge line at some distance to the rear of the

leading edge, the structural weight can be so distributed that the center of
Trailing-Edge Tabs and Other Devices
gravity falls on the hinge line. Usually, however, this is more easily ac-

Trailing-edge tabs on movable surfaces are another means of obtaining


STATIC BALANCE

aerodynamic balance.
A tab on the aileron is used to overcome engine torque. It may be used
with the rudder for the same purpose as the offset fin and on the elevator
for the same purpose as the adjustable stabilizer.
Trimming tabs have a chord varying from 5 to 10 per cent of the mov-
able surface chord and approaching 25 per cent of the chord if used as
servocontrol tabs. The aspect ratio should be as high as possible, varying
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:19 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

usually from as low as 5 to a.13 high as 20.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

STATIC BALANCE
A control surface is said to be statically balanced when the center of
gravity of the plane containing the hinge line acts through that hinge
line. Static balance is one of the design features required to avoid flutter
possibilities.
For low-speed aircraft having maximum speeds below about 200 miles,
static balances are generally not necessary. For greater speeds, static
balance for movable surfaces becomes a necessity.
For a surface that has its hinge line at the leading edge, static balance
can be obtained only with a concentrated weight ahead of the hinge line
to counterbalance the weight of the movable surface.
For the surface having its hinge line at some distance to the rear of the
leading edge, the structural weight can be so distributed that the center of
gravity falls on the hinge line. Usually, however, this is more easily ac-

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
392 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
392 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XIX-10. Three different ways by which static balance of a movable surface

could be obtained. By proper positioning of the added weight ahead of the hinge line,

dynamic balance may also be achieved.

complished with a fabric-covered surface than with one that is metal

covered. For the latter, some counterbalancing of the nose section may

become necessary.

DYNAMIC BALANCE

For a movable control surface to be fully balanced dynamically, the

principal mass axes of the surface in the plane containing the hinge line

must coincide with the hinge axis and an axis perpendicular to the hinge

line about which angular deflection could take place when subjected to

aerodynamic or inertia loads. For the rudder and elevator, this per-

pendicular axis would be the neutral or longitudinal axis of the fuselage.

For airplanes with a speed greater than 150 miles per hour, it is de-

sirable to have the rudder and elevator dynamically balanced. The

criterion for such balancing is a dynamic balance coefficient of not more

than 0.08.

The dynamic balance coefficient is nondimensional, which may be ex-

pressed by the formula:

iff p xydxdy) 4- (Sf p dxdy)

= Cdb0

FIGURE XIX-10. Three different ways by which static balance of a movable surface
could be obtained. By proper positioning of the added weight ahead of the hinge line,
dynamic balance may also be achieved.

complished with a fabric-covered surface than with one that is metal


covered. For the latter, some counterbalancing of the nose section may
become necessary.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:19 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

DYNAMIC BALANCE
For a movable control surface to be fully balanced dynamically, the
principal mass axes of the surface in the plane containing the hinge line
must coincide with the hinge axis and an axis perpendicular to the hinge
line about which angular deflection could take place when subjected to
aerodynamic or inertia loads. For the rudder and elevator, this per-
pendicular axis would be the neutral or longitudinal axis of the fuselage.
For airplanes with a speed greater than 150 miles per hour, it is de-
sirable to have the rudder and elevator dynamically balanced. The
criterion for such balancing is a dynamic balance coefficient of not more
than 0.08.
The dynamic balance coefficient is nondimensional, which may be ex-
pressed by the formula:
( f f p xydxdy) ..;- (Sf P dxdy) = Cdb·

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 393
TAIL SURFACES

393

Figure XIX-11. Designation of quadrants for rudder dynamic-balance calculations.

The hinge line is the F-axis, while the neutral axis of the fuselage is the X-axis.

Figure XIX-11 shows a typical surface with the axes designated and

the terms indicated for the equation above, in which the numerator is the

resultant product of inertia of the control surface, and the denominator

is the product of the mass and the aerodynamic area of the control sur-

face. In the formula expressed, p is the unit weight or mass referred to

the surface area, x is the distance between the center of gravity of the

mass and the F-axis, y is the distance between the center of gravity of

the mass and the X-axis, and dx dy is the area of the mass under con-

sideration, S = X dxdy.

The products of inertia in the first and third quadrants are considered

positive; the products of inertia in the second and fourth quadrants are

considered negative. For movable surfaces the hinge line is one axis,

and the principal or longitudinal axis the other.

FLUTTER PREVENTION

The Department of Commerce at one time suggested the following gen-

eral principles to be observed for flutter prevention on all airplanes in the


FIGURE XIX-11. Designation of quadrants for rudder dynamic-balance calculations.
design of control surfaces and control systems.
The hinge line is the Y-axis, while the neutral axis of the fuselage is the X-axis.
1. Structural stiffness.

Figure XIX-11 shows a typical surface with the axes designated and
2. Elimination of all play in hinges and control-system joints.

3. Rigid interconnections between elevators.

4. A relatively low amount of aerodynamic balance.


the terms indicated for the equation above, in which the numerator is the
5. High frictional damping.

6. Adequate wing fillets and fairing.


resultant product of inertia of the control surface, and the denominator
7. Sharp leading edges on movable surfaces should be avoided.
is the product of the mass and the aerodynamic area of the control sur-
face. In the formula expressed, p is the unit weight or mass referred to
the surface area, x is the distance between the center of gravity of the
mass and the Y-axis, y is the distance between the center of gravity of
the mass and the X-axis, and dx dy is the area of the mass under con-
sideration, S = l: dxdy.
The products of inertia in the first and third quadrants are considered
positive; the products of inertia. in the second and fourth quadrants are
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:19 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

considered negative. For movable surfaces the hinge line is one axis,
and the principal or longitudinal axis the other.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FLUTTER PREVENTION

The Department of Commerce at one time suggested the following gen-


eral principles to be observed for flutter prevention on all airplanes in the
design of control surfaces and control systems.
1. Structural stiffness.
2. Elimination of all play in hinges and control-system joints.
3. Rigid interconnections between elevators.
4. A relatively low amount of aerodynamic balance.
5. High frictional damping.
6. Adequate wing fillets and fairing.
7. Sharp leading edges on movable surfaces should be avoided.

Original from
Dig 1ze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
394 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
394

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

The following features are considered essential for flutter prevention.


The following features are considered essential for flutter prevention.

8. When separate elevators are used, the interconnecting structure that

8. When separate elevators a.re used, the interconnecting structure that


is required must be as stiff in torsion as practicable.

9. Trailing-edge controls should be irreversible, relatively rigid, and


is required must be as stiff in torsion as practicable.
the tab installation should be designed to prevent any development of free
9. Trailing-edge controls should be irreversible, relatively rigid, and
motion of the tab. When the tabs are completely statically balanced,

irreversible controls are not required, provided that the tab control system
the tab installation should be designed to prevent any development of free
cannot be manipulated abruptly through a large range. A small amount
motion of the tab. When the tabs are completely statically balanced,
of overbalance of the tab, obtained by putting its center of gravity ahead

irreversible controls are not required, provided that the tab control system
cannot be manipulated abruptly through a large range. A small amount
'of the hinge line, will help to offset harmful effects of any possible looseness

or tab-control system flexibility.

10. When trailing-edge tabs are used to assist in moving the main sur- of overbalance of the tab, obtained by putting its center of gravity ahead
face, the areas and relative movements must be so proportioned that the

main surface is not aerodynamically overbalanced at any time.


·of the hinge line, will help to offset harmful effects of any possible looseness
11. Experimental determination of the natural frequency of vibration
or tab-control system flexibility.
of certain components of the airplane may be desirable in cases where dan-

10. When trailing-edge tabs are used to assist in moving the main sur-
gerously low frequencies or the coincidence of the natural frequencies of

two or more structural components exist. Where such cases do occur, re-
face, the areas and relative movements must be so proportioned that the
design is necessary to change such natural frequencies. main surface js not aerodynamically overbalanced at any time.
Figure XIX-12. Layout of the principal elements of the tail-surface structure.

11. Experimental determination of the natural frequency of vibration


Unlike the wing, the spars of the tail surfaces need not be located at a constant

percentage of the chord.


of certain components of the airplane may be desirable in cases where dan-
The structural details of the vertical and horizontal tail surfaces are gerously low frequencies or the coincidence of the natural frequencies of
similar to a simplified version of the wing tip which includes the aileron.

two or more structural components exist. Where such cases do occur, re-
A spar at or near the hinge line is desirable for the elevator or rudder.

This spar is supported by at least three hinge brackets, which in turn


design is necessary to change such natural frequencies.
are supported by the rear spar of the fixed surface, which usually has

another spar located at about 10 or 15 per cent of the chord.

Figure XIX-12 shows a schematic layout of the primary structure of

--
the tail surface. While spars in the wing are located at or close to a

constant percentage of the chord spanwise, such is not the case for tail

CONSTRUCTION

,/Rearspar
_ _L_ ______ _
-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:19 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Spar of
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

moveable surface
FIGURE XIX-12. Layout of the principal elements of the tail-surface structure.
Unlike the wing, the spars of the tail surfaces need not be located at a constant
percentage of the chord.

CONSTRUCTION
The structural details of the vertical and horizontal tail surfaces are
similar to a simplified version of the wing tip which includes the aileron.
A spar at or near the hinge line is desirable for the elevator or rudder.
This spar is supported by at least three hinge brackets, which in turn
are supported by the rear spar of the fixed surface, which usually has
another spar located at about 10 or 15 per cent of the chord.
Figure XIX-12 shows a schematic layout of the primary structure of
the tail surface. While spars in the wing are located at or close to a
constant percentage of the chord spanwise, such is not the case for tail

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 395
TAIL SURFACES

395

Figure XIX-13. The box structure at the hinge of this movable surface carries the

torsional moment around the hinge cut-out of the leading edge D-spar.

surfaces. Here, the location of the spars is dictated by other considera-

tions, such as hinge-bracket distances, location of attachment to the

fuselage, and rigidity requirements.

For aircraft operating at speeds less than 350 miles per hour or there-

abouts, the movable surfaces are usually fabric covered in order to obtain

a saving in weight and to reduce difficulties in static and dynamic balanc-

ing of the surface.

HORIZONTAL TAIL SURFACES

Location

The horizontal tail surfaces should be so located that any blanketing by

the wing or the fuselage is avoided. Partial blanketing usually exists,

however, but certain features may be incorporated to limit the effect of

blanketing.

In some cases, the location of the horizontal tail surfaces is determined

by clearance requirements for the elevator, as shown in Figure XIX-14,


FmuRE XIX-13. The box structure at the hinge of this movable surface carries the
when the elevator is deflected downward through its total angular range
torsional moment around the hinge cut-Qut of the leading edge D-spar.
and with the tail-wheel assembly fully deflected.

Conventional airplanes j>f today locate the tail surfaces about to 3

chord lengths (mean geometric chord of the wing) behind the center of

gravity so that the observance of this rule will assure reasonable static
surfaces. Here, the location of the spars is dictated by other considera-
longitudinal stability.

The horizontal tail surfaces may be ahead of or behind the vertical tail
tions, such as hinge-bracket distances, location of attachment to the
surface or somewhere between these two extreme positions, as shown in fuselage, and rigidity requirements.
Figure XIX-15.

For aircraft operating at speeds less than 350 miles per hour or there-
abouts, the movable surfaces are usually fabric covered in order to obtain
a saving in weight and to reduce difficulties in static and dynamic balanc-
ing of the surface.

HORIZONTAL TAIL SURFACES


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:20 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Location
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The horizontal tail surfaces should be so located that any blanketing by


the wing or the fuselage is avoided. Partial blanketing usually exists,
however, but certain features may be incorporated to limit the effect of
blanketing.
In some cases, the location of the horizontal tail surfaces is determined
by clearance requirements for the elevator, as shown in Figure XIX-14,
when the elevator is deflected downward through its total angular range
and with the tail-wheel assembly fully deflected.
Conventional airplanes of todj!.y_loca.te the tail .surfaces-about 2~ t6- 3-
chord lengths (mean geometric chord of the wing) behind the center of
gravity so that tlte observance of this rule will assure reasonable static
longitudinal stability.
The horizontal tail surfaces may be ahead of or behind the vertical tail
surface or somewhere between these two extreme positions, as shown in
Figure XIX- 15.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIGAN
396 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
396

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XIX-14. Layout of the horizontal tail surfaces showing cut-out of elevators

to prevent interference with the movement of the rudder. Each movable surface should

be supported by at least three hinges.

For the small airplane, because of structural and dimensional considera-

tions, the rear stabilizer spar and the rear fin spar usually intersect and

are built in integrally with the fuselage frame at that station unless either

or both the fin and stabilizer are adjustable in flight or on the ground.

A position of the horizontal tail surfaces ahead of the vertical tail

surfaces may be considered if it results in less complication of the control

system. One disadvantage of such a location is the blanketing of the

vertical tail surfaces at high angles of attack.

Figure XIX-15. Location of horizontal tail surfaces. They may be located ahead

or behind the vertical tail surfaces. or located vertically anywhere between the two

extremes of the vertical tail surfaces at the bottom of the fuselage or at the top of the

FIGURE XIX-14. Layout of the horizontal tail surfaces showing cut-out of elevators
vertical tail surfaces.

to prevent interference with the movement of the rudder. Each movable surface should
be supported by at least three hinges.

For the small airplane, because of structural and dimensional considera-


tions, the rear stabilizer spar and the rear fin spar usually intersect and
are built in integrally with the fuselage frame at that station unless either
or both the fin and stabilizer are adjustable in flight or on the ground.
A position of the horizontal tail surfaces ahead of the vertical tail
surfaces may be considered if it results in less complication of the control
system. One disadvantage of such a location is the blanketing of the
vertical tail surfaces at high angles of attack.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XIX-15. Location of horizontal tail surfaces. They may be located ahead
or behind the vertical tail surfaces. or located vertically anywhere between the two
extremes of the vertical tail surfaces at the bottom of the fuselage or at the top of the
vertical tail surfaces.

Original from
D I IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
TAIL SURFACES 397
TAIL SURFACES

397
A position of the horizontal tail surfaces behind the vertical tail surfaces
A position of the horizontal tail surfaces behind the vertical tail surfaces

would clear both, so that neither would be blanketed by the other.


would clear both, so that neither would be blanketed by the other.
Vertically there may also be some choice of location. The lowest
Vertically there may also be some choice of location. The lowest
position would probably be determined by the ground clearance of the

position would probably be determined by the ground clearance of the


deflected elevator, whether or not the nose-wheel or tail-wheel type landing
deflected elevator, whether or not the nose-wheel or tail-wheel type landing

gear is used.

The location of the horizontal tail surfaces where they can be securely
gear is used.
attached to the fuselage structure is advantageous from the structural

point of view.
The location of the horizontal tail surfaces where they can be securely
For the higher-speed airplanes, especially those having the exhaust
attached to the fuselage structure is advantageous from the structural
duct or ducts of the jet engines in .the tail of the fuselage, the horizontal
point of view.
tail surfaces have to be located above the fuselage. Thus the horizontal

surfaces have to be secured to the vertical tail surfaces. Under asym-


For the higher-speed airplanes, especially those having the exhaust
metrical conditions, the aerodynamic load on the horizontal tail surfaces
duct or ducts of the jet engines in .the tail of the fuselage, the horizontal
produces a torsional moment upon the vertical tail surfaces. It there-

tail surfaces have to be located above the fuselage. Thus the horizontal
surfaces have to be secured to the vertical tail surfaces. Under asym-
fore becomes necessary for those surfaces to be constructed more rigidly,

thereby entailing greater weight.

Consideration has been given to the use of a biplane set of horizontal


metrical conditions, the aerodynamic load on the horizontal tail surfaces
tail surfaces, whereby the smaller elevator could, in its operation, be used

as a booster control for the larger surface through suitable linkage.


produces a torsional moment upon the vertical tail surfaces. It there-
A design used occasionally is the so-called canard type, which locates
fore becomes necessary for those surfaces to be constructed more rigidly,
the horizontal tail surfaces ahead of the wing. In that position, the

thereby entailing greater weight.


Consideration has been given to the use of a biplane set of horizontal
surfaces are acting in the up-wash, rather than the down-wash of the

wing. For this reason, the horizontal tail surfaces are apt to stall before

the wing, so that sufficient control may not be available at a critical time. tail surfaces, whereby the smaller elevator could, in its operation, be used
However, this feature has been considered an advantage since the tail

as a booster control for the larger surface through suitable linkage.


A design used occasionally is the so-called canard type, which locates
surfaces could act as a stall-warning for the wing. The location of the

tail surfaces ahead of the wing may interfere with the vision forward.

It is considered psychologically bad to be able to see the deflection of the


the horizontal tail surfaces ahead of the wing. In that position, the
surfaces at practically all times. Another advantage, in addition to the

stall-warning device, is that the arrangement of the surfaces forward may


surfaces are acting in the up-wash, rather than the down-wash of the
serve as a suitable crash-absorber in case of an accident.
wing. For this reason, the horizontal tail surfaces are apt to stall before
Angular Deflection

the wing, so that sufficient control may not be available at a critical time.
Elevators are designed to have an equal angular movement up and

down from neutral. About 30-degree movement is considered maximum,


However, this feature has been considered an advantage since the tail
surfaces could act as a stall-warning for the wing. The location of the
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:21 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

and, with efficient design, a 25-degree deflection up and a 25-degree

deflection down should be sufficient.

tail surfaces ahead of the wing may interfere with the vision forward.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Adjustable Stabilizer

The stabilizer may be adjusted through a small angular displacement


It is considered psychologically bad to be able to see the deflection of the
either on the ground or in the air from the cockpit (usually the latter, if at
surfaces at practically all times. Another advantage, in addition to the
all, since trimming tabs are displacing adjustable stabilizers).

stall-warning device, is that the arrangement of the surfaces forward may


serve as a suitable crash-absorber in case of an accident.
Angular Deftection
Elevators are designed to have an equal angular movement up and
down from neutral. About 30-degree movement is considered maximum,
and, with efficient design, a 25-degree deflection up and a 25-degree
deflection down should be sufficient.

Adjustable Stabilizer
The stabilizer may be adjusted through a small angular displacement
either on the ground or in the air from the cockpit (usually the latter, if at
all, since trimming tabs are displacing adjustable stabilizers).

Original from
Dig 1ze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
398 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

If an adjustable stabilizer is used, a total of 6- to 8-degree movement


398

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

If an adjustable stabilizer is used, a total of 6- to 8-degree movement (about 5 degrees up and 3 degrees down) is usually used.
(about 5 degrees up and 3 degrees down) is usually used.

The adjustable stabilizer is used to change the trim angle of the air-
The adjustable stabilizer is used to change the trim angle of the air-
plane without displacing the elevator. The elevator can then operate
plane without displacing the elevator. The elevator can then operate
from the new neutral position determined by the stabilizer. In the first
from the new neutral position determined by the stabilizer. In the first
prototype to be flown, the range of angles provided may be greater than

is absolutely necessary until flight tests have determined the desirable


prototype to be flown, the range of angles provided may be greater than
range.
is absolutely necessary until flight tests have determined the desirable
For high-speed airplanes operating through the transonic regime, the

ran~. .
For high-speed airplanes operating through the transonic regime, the
adjustable stabilizer is preferred over the elevator trim tab, since the trim

drag is becoming an important factor in the performance of the airplane.

Where power operation has been provided, a one-degree-per-second rate


adjustable stabilizer is preferred over the elevator trim tab, since the trim
of change through 11-degree travel has been used.

On small airplanes it has been customary to make the stabilizer adjust-


drag is becoming an important factor in the performance of the airplane.
able through a limited angular range, about 3 degrees up and 3 degrees
Where power operation has been provided, a one-degree-per-second rate
down. This adjustment has been possible either on the ground or in the
of change through 11-degree travel has been used.
On small airplanes it has been customary to make the stabilizer adjust-
air by means of a control located in the pilot's cockpit. The adjustment

in the air is preferable. On the large transport airplanes, variations in

trim (the object of the adjustable stabilizer) are obtained by means of able through a limited angular range, about 3 degrees up and 3 degrees
trailing-edge tabs.

down. This adjustment has been possible either on the ground or in the
Aspect Ratio

The aspect ratio of the tail surfaces should be as high as possible (usually
air by means of a control located in the pilot's cockpit. The adjustment
from 3 to 5) in order to avoid blanketing of the structure to which they
in the air is preferable. On the large transport airplanes, variations in
are attached. Aspect ratios greater than 6 are seldom used unless ttyey

can be adequately braced.


trim (the object of the adjustable stabilizer) are obtained by means of
In proportioning the tail surfaces, it is not desirable to start with the
trailing-edge tabs.
aspect ratio because the fuselage section increases the span of the tail sur-

faces seemingly beyond the desirable limit.

For correcting airfoil data from the given aspect ratio to that of the tail
Aspect Ratio
surfaces, the aspect ratio is calculated on the basis of the square of the span
The aspect ratio of the tail surfaces should be as high as possible (usually
length from tip to tip divided by the area including that covered by the

fuselage. In other words, exactly the same procedure is followed as in


from 3 to 5) in order to avoid blanketing of the structure to which they
calculating the aspect ratio of the wing.
are attached. Aspect ratios greater than 6 are seldom used unless tl~ey
Angle of Incidence

can be adequately braced.


The incidence of the horizontal tail surfaces is determined by the amount

In proportioning the tail surfaces, it is not desirable to start with the


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

of downwash from the wing, its relative location with respect to the wing,

and the moment required to obtain the required trim angle.


aspect ratio because the fuselage section increases the span of the tail sur-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

The angle of trim of the airplane is denned at that angle at which the

sum of the pitching moments about the center of gravity of the airplane is
faces seemingly beyond the desirable limit.
zero. Normally, it is expected that the elevator be in the neutral position,
For correcting airfoil data from the given aspect ratio to that of the tail
that is, undeflected for that attitude of the airplane or angle of trim for

surfaces, the aspect ratio is calculated on the basis of the square of the span ·
length from tip to tip divided by the area including that covered by the
fuselage. In other words, exactly the same procedure is followed as in
calculating the aspect ratio of the wing.
Angle of Incidence
The incidence of the horizontal tail surfaces is determined by the amount
of downwash from the wing, its relative location with respect to the wing,
and the moment required to obtain the reQuired trim angle.
The angle of trim of the airplane is defined at that angle at which the
sum of the pitching moments about the center of gravity of the airplane is
zero. Normally, it is expected that the elevator be in the neutral position,
that is, undeflected for that attitude of the airplane or angle of trim for

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 399
TAIL SURFACES

399

which the flying time is the greatest. This attitude is usually for cruising.
which the flying time is the greatest. This attitude is usually for cruising.
In order to determine this angle, it would be desirable to have calculated
In order to determine this angle, it would be desirable to have calculated
the preliminary performance. In lieu of the necessary data from such

the preliminary performance. In lieu of the necessary data from such


calculations, it may be assumed that the desired angle of trim lies between

the angle of the wing at which the minimum drag coefficient occurs, and
calculations, it may be assumed that the desired angle of trim lies between
the angle at which the maximum ratio of lift to drag occurs. the angle of the wing at which the minimum drag coefficient occurs, and
Once the angle of trim has been decided upon, the angle of incidence (or

the angle at which the maximum ratio of lift to drag occurs.


setting) of the horizontal tail surfaces can be determined for at trim by:

Cjfw. = 0 = Cm. + Cm a or Cm, = —Cm.;


Once the angle of trim has been decided upon, the angle of incidence (or
but

setting) of the horizontal tail surfaces can be determined for at trim by:
or

-0.8yi CL, f*. or


but
— Cm.

— -0.8yASt/SK)&ttTim> (2)

where Cm. has been calculated for that angle of attack of the airplane cor-

responding to the angle of trim.

Once the lift coefficient of the tail surfaces at trim condition has been

determined, the required angle of attack of the tail surfaces can be deter-
or

O.By~~isw) at trim,
mined from the aerodynamic characteristics of the tail surface airfoil.

Since the tail surfaces are affected by the downwash of the wing, correc-

CL, = (2)
tion for this downwash must be made not only to determine the angle of

incidence of the tail surfaces, but to determine the angle of attack of the

tail surfaces corresponding to the angle of attack of the wing.


where CM. has been calculated for that angle of attack of the airplane cor-
The downwash angle is given sufficiently accurately by the following
responding to the angle of trim.
modified Diehl's equation:

Once the lift coefficient of the tail surfaces at trim condition has been
determined, the required angle of attack of the tail surfaces can be deter-
e = ^a^»ir*» (3)

where e is the downwash angle in degrees,

Cl is the lift coefficient of the wing, mined from the aerodynamic characteristics of the tail surface airfoil.
R is the aspect ratio of the wing, "u0

Since the tail surfaces are affected by the downw..tsh of the wing, correc-
0

x is the number of mean aerodynamic wing-chord lengths that


tion for this downwash must be made not only to determine the angle of
V the 20 per cent pomt of the mean geometric chord of the hori-
incidence of the tail surfaces, but to determine the angle of attack of the
zontal tail surfaces is behind the aerodynamic center of the

wing, and
tail surfaces corresponding to the angle of attack of the wing.
y is, similarly, the number of chord lengths the horizontal tail
The downwash angle is given sufficiently accurately by the following
modified Diehl's equation:
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

surfaces are above or below the mean aerodynamic chord of the

I
wing.

40CL
=R x-<>·25 y-<> .n•, - •2 (3)
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

For any given design, equation (3) could be written in terms of the angle

E
of attack of the wing since Cl — aa*, where aa is so measured that a = 0

when Cl = 0, and a is the slope of the lift curve. By further evaluation,

the formula would finally take the form


where E is the downwash angle in degrees,
CL is the lift coefficient of the wing,
R is the aspect ratio of the wing, ~ '-C
x is the number of mean aerodynamic wing-chord lengths that
t the 20 per cent pomt of the mean geometric chord of the hori-
zontal tail surfaces is behind the aerodynamic center of the
wing, and
y is, similarly, the number of chord lengths the horizontal tail
surfaces are above or below the mean aerodynamic chord of the
wmg.
For any given design, equation (3) could be written in terms of the angle
of attack of the wing since CL = a~ where a 111 is so measured that a = 0
when CL = 0, and a is the slope of the lift curve. By further evaluation,
the formula would finally take the form

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
400 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
400 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

e = kaa, (3a) E = kau,, (3a)


where

0.40a
where
£-0.25 y-0.7I_
k = 0.40a x-0·21i ~·71.
Then, if the wing has an angle of incidence measured with relation to a
R
fixed reference line on the fuselage, the effective angle of downwash meas-

ured with relation to this reference line would be e + iw. The angle of Then, if the wing has an angle of incidence measured with relation to a
Figure XIX-16. Reference diagram for angles referred to in equation (4a).

fixed reference line on the fuselage, the effective angle of downwas_h meas-
ured with relation to this reference line would be E + i'°. The angle of
attack of the horizontal tail surfaces, when placed at zero angle of incidence

to the fuselage reference line, would be — (« + ij). Should the horizontal

tail surfaces have an angle of incidence of its own, the angle of attack of

the horizontal tail surfaces would be it — (« + i«).

Recapitulating,

at = -(« + (4)

or

OLt = it — (e + im), (4a)

depending upon whether the horizontal tail surfaces have an angle of inci-

dence or not. This angle of incidence can now be determined for the re-

quired at, for Cl [as obtained from equation (2)] at trim gives the neces-

sary information. For subsequent calculations, it would be desirable to

determine at from a modified form of equation (4a) such as at = fca„ —

i* + it0

E
Sweepback

Normally, any sweepback that the horizontal tail surfaces may have is

due to the trapezoidal planform. However, just as sweepback has been

employed for the wing as speeds approach M = 1, so sweepback has to be

applied to the horizontal tail surfaces. The discussion relating to sweep-

FIGURE XIX-16. Reference diagram for angles referred to in equation (4a).


back in Chapter XVII, Design of the Wing, is applicable to the design of

the horizontal tail surfaces.

attack of the horizontal tail surfaces, when placed at· zero angle of incidence
to the fuselage reference line, would be - (E + i,.). Should the horizontal
tail surfaces have an angle of incidence of its own, the angle of attack of
the horizontal tail surfaces would be i, - (E + i.).
Recapitulating,
+ i.),
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

a,= -(E (4)


or
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

a, = ie - (E + i,.), (4a)
depending upon whether the horizontal tail surfaces have an angle of inci-
dence or not. This angle of incidence can now be determined for the re-
quired a,, for CL [as obtained from equation (2)] at trim gives the neces-
sary information. For subsequent calculations, it would be desirable to
determine a, from a modified form of equation (4a) such as a, = ka. -
iVI + i,.
Sweepback
Normally, any sweepback that the horizontal tail surfaces may have is
due to the trapezoidal planform. However, just as sweepback has been
employed for the wing as speeds approach M = 1, so sweepback has to be
applied to the horizontal tail surfaces. The discussion relating to sweep-
back in Chapter XVII, Design of the 'Wing, is applicable to the design of
the horizontal tail surfaces.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 401
TAIL SURFACES

401
In order to obtain relatively uniform down-wash conditions on the
In order to obtain relatively uniform down-wash conditions on the

horizontal tail surfaces, some sweepback may be employed to compensate


for t.he sweepback of the wing.
horizontal tail surfaces, some sweepback may be employed to compensate

for the sweepback of the wing.

Dihedral

Normally horizontal tail surfaces are not given any dihedral, but it has

been found that the effectiveness of the horizontal tail surfaces can be in-
Dihedral
creased considerably, particularly at high angles of attack, by incorporat-

ing some dihedral in the horizontal tail surfaces. How large the dihedral
Norm.ally horizontal tail surfaces are not given any dihedral, but it has
angle should be depends upon the down wash of the wing; for purposes of
been found that the effectiveness of the horizontal tail surfaces can be in-
symmetry, the span line of the tail surfaces may be made parallel to the

creased considerably, particularly at high angles of attack, by incorporat-


ing some dihedral in the horizontal tail surfaces. How large the dihedral
span line of the wings.

Area

Examination of airplanes of all sizes reveals that the jpatio of the hori- angle should be depends upon the downwash of the wing; for purposes of
zontal tail surfaces to the effective wing area varies from'20xo 25 per cent.

symmetry, the span line of the tail surfaces may be made parallel to the
The greater the tail length is, in terms of the wing chord, the smaller per-

centage area is required. Wings equipped with lift-increase device usually


span line of the wings.
require that the percentage area of the horizontal tail surfaces be greater

than if the wings were not so equipped.

The elevator area varies from 35 to 45 per cent of the horizontal tail sur-

face area.
Area
Construction

For ease in assembly and disassembly, the horizontal tail surfaces are
Examination of airplanes of all sizes reveals that the ~io of the hori-
attached to the top of the fuselage, especially if tubular steel construction zontal tail surfaces to the effective wing area varies from· 20 Ito 25 per cent.
is used for both the tail surfaces and the fuselage. When reinforced metal

monocoque construction is used, the horizontal tail surfaces may be located


The greater the tail length is, in terms of the wing chord, the smaller per-
nearer the longitudinal centerline of the rear portion of the fuselage and
centage area is required. Wings equipped with lift-increase device usually
still obtain the necessary rigidity.

require that the percentage area of the horizontal tail surfaces be greater
than if the wings were not so equipped.
Planform

Some indication of planforms used for horizontal tail surfaces may be

obtained from those shown in Figure XIX-17. Since the aspect ratios
The elevator area varies from 35 to 45 per cent of the horizontal tail sur-
are about the same for the horizontal tail surfaces as for the wing, and

some other considerations of design are similar, the planforms of the


face area.
horizontal tail surfaces look very similar to the wing planforms. Some

modification may be made due to the greater role that the movable sur-

face, which takes up almost half of the total area, plays in the design of
Construction
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:22 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the structure.

For ease in assembly and disassembly, the horizontal tail surfaces are
attached to the top of the fuselage, especially if tubular steel construction
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

is used for both the tail surfaces and the fuselage. When reinforced metal
monocoque construction is used, the horizontal tail surfaces may be located
nearer the longitudinal centerline of the rear portion of the fuselage and
still obtain the necessary rigidity.

Planform
Some indication of planforms used for horizontal tail surfaces may be
obtained from those shown in Figure XIX-17. Since the aspect ratios
are about the same for the horizontal tail surfaces as for the wing, and
some other considerations of design are similar, the planforms of the
horizontal tail surfaces look very similar to the wing planforms. Some
modification may be made due to the greater role that the movable sur-
face, which takes up almost half of the total area, plays in the design of
the structure.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
402 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
402

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XIX-17. Typical planforms of horizontal tail surfaces. Only one half of

the surfaces are shown. Vertical tail surface planforms are similar.

Other Solutions

For some aircraft, especially those of the flying-wing type, the horizontal

tail surfaces disappear as separate entities, but their function is taken

over by trailing-edge flaps or wing-tip surfaces. The high-speed transonic

and supersonic designs employing the delta wing should be studied, es-

pecially with reference to the means employed in obtaining longitudinal

stability and control through flaps and other similar devices.

For other high-speed designs, there may be no elevator as such, but the

entire horizontal tail surface may be deflected angularly in order to elim-

inate the increase in drag caused by the deflected flap.


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

- - -- - - - - -
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XIX-17. Typical planforms of ho1·izontal tail surfaces. Only one half of
the surfaces are shown. Vertical tail surface planforms are similar.

Other Solutions
For some aircraft, especially those of the flying-wing type, the horizontal
tail surfaces disappear as separate entities, but their function is taken
over by trailing-edge flaps or wing-tip surfaces. The high-speed transonic
and supersonir designs employing the delta wing should be studied, es-
pecially with reference to the means employed in obtaining longitudinal
stability and control through flaps and other similar devices.
For other high-speed designs, there may be no elevator as such, but the
entire horizontal tail surface may be deflected angularly in order to elim-
inate the inrrease in drag caused by the deflerted flap.

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 403
TAIL SURFACES 403

Figube XIX-18. Two illustrations showing the application of moveable wing tips

that, freely floating, would operate as an aileron on a normal wing, as in (A); or, for a

tailless airplane the tip surfaces could be operated differentially for aileron action or

unidirectionally for elevator action, as shown in (B).

Clearances

When the horizontal tail surfaces have been positioned on the fuselage

or some other component of the airplane structure, the student should

check allowable clearances with the ground when the elevator is deflected,

and with the vertical tail surfaces, especially the rudder.

VERTICAX TAIL SURFACES

The vertical tail surfaces consist of the fixed surfaces (the rudder), the

movable surface (the elevator), and the trim tab.

The function of these surfaces is to obtain the necessary directional

stability and control in flight.

Figure XIX-19. A "canard-type" airplane with the horizontal tail surfaces located

ahead of the center of gravity. The vertical tail surfaces are located at the wing tip.

J<'muaE XIX-18. Two illustrations showing the application of moveable wing tips
that, freely floating, would operate as an aileron on a normal wing, as in (A); or, for a
tailless airplane the tip surfaces could be operated differentially for ail<'ron action or
unidirectionally for elevator action, as 11hown in (B).

Clearances
When the horizontal tail surfaces have been positioned on the fm;elage
or some other component of the airplane structure, the student should
check allowable clearances with the ground when the elevator is deflected,
and with the vertical tail surfaces, especially the rudder.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

VERTICAL TAIL SURFACES


The vertical tail surfaces consist of the fixed surfaces (the rudder), the
movable surface (the elevator), and the trim tab.
The function of these surfaces is to obtain the necessary directional
stability and control in flight.

FIGURE XIX- 19. A "canard-type" airplane with the horizontal tail surfaces located
ahead of the center of gravity. The vertical tail 1mrfares are located at the wing tip.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
404 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
404

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL Directional Stability and Control


Straight flight should be attainable at any speed above 140 per cent of
Directional Stability and Control

Straight flight should be attainable at any speed above 140 per cent of

the minimum speed by sideslipping without the use of the rudder and with
the minimum speed by sideslipping without the use of the rudder and with
a single engine (of a multi-engine design) being inoperative.

The yawing moment in a sideslip should be such that right-rudder de-


a single engine (of a multi-engine design) being inoperative.
flection would be required for a sideslip toward the left, and left-rudder
The yawing moment in a sideslip should be such that right-rudder de-
deflection toward the right. For small angles of sideslip, the sideslip angle

flection wc>uld be required for a sideslip toward the left, and left-rudder
deflection toward the right. For small angles of sideslip, the sideslip angle
should be proportional to the rudder angle.

The airplane should always tend to return from a sideslip without the

use of the rudder regardless of the angle of the sideslip. should be proportional to the rudder angle.
Rudder control should be such that:

The airplane should always tend to return from a sideslip without the
1. A control force of not more than 180 pounds is required to maintain

the airplane in rectilinear flight with one engine inoperative and the other
use of the rudder regardless of the angle of the sideslip.
or others at full rated power at all speeds above the minimum take-off

speed;

2. To meet the spin recovery requirements of the airplane;


Rudder control should be such that:
3. To overcome the adverse yawing moment caused by aileron deflec-

tions at any speed.


1. A control force of not more than 180 pounds is required to maintain
When all controls are released in flight, lateral oscillations of the air-

the airplane in rectilinear flight with one engine inoperative and the other
plane should always damp to one half amplitude within two complete

cycles. When the ailerons or rudder are moved and released quickly,
or others at full rated power at all speeds above the minimum take-off
they should return to their neutral position and damp any oscillations of
speed;
the airplane in one cycle.

Both rudder and aileron may employ trimming systems. They should
2. To meet the spin recovery requirements of the airplane;
be:
3. To overcome the adverse yawing moment caused by aileron deflec-
1. Used if the control forces for level flight are 10 per cent greater than

tions at any speed.


80 pounds for the aileron control wheel or 30 pounds for the aileron control

stick, or 180 pounds for the rudder pedals for any speed between the maxi-
When all controls are released in flight, lateral oscillations of the air-
mum speed and 120 per cent of the minimum speed;

2. Powerful enough to maintain rectilinear flight with one engine inop-


plane should always damp to one half amplitude within two complete
erative (for a multi-engine airplane) at speeds 140 per cent of the minimum cycles. When the ailerons or rudder are moved and released quickly,
or above.

they should return to their neutral position and damp any oscillations of
Further, the approaching stall of the airplane should develop gradually

and make itself felt by increasing "pull force" on the control column, and
the airplane in one cycle.
by evidence of buffeting of the airplane. Recovery, after complete stall
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

has been attained, should be possible by normal use of the controls.

Rolling or yawing moments of the airplane at less than 2 degrees above


Both rudder and aileron may employ trimming systems. They should
be:
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the attitude required for a 3-point landing should not cause the airplane to

stall.

1. Used if the control forces for level flight are 10 per cent greater than
80 pounds for the aileron control wheel or 30 pounds for the aileron control
stick, or 180 pounds for the rudder pedals for any speed between the maxi-
mum speed and 120 per cent of the minimum speed;
2. Powerful enough to maintain rectilinear flight with one engine inop-
erative (for a. multi-engine airplane) at speeds 140 per cent of the minimum
or above.
Further, the approaching stall of the airplane should develop gradually
and make itself felt by increasing "pull force" on the control column, and
by evidence of buffeting of the airplane. Recovery, after complete stall
has been attained, should be possible by normal use of the controls.
Rolling or ya.wing moments of the airplane at less than 2 degrees above
the attitude required for a 3-point landing should not ca.use the airplane to
stall.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
TAIL SURFACES 405
TAIL SURFACES

405
From the flight criteria mentioned, the designer is able to work back to
From the flight criteria mentioned, the designer is able to work back to

the detail design so that the airplane will incorporate the characteristics
the detail design so that the airplane will incorporate the characteristics
desired. Many features are arrived at through past experience or from
desired. Many features are arrived at through past experience or from
examination of existing designs. Other features are subject to research

examination of existing designs. Other features are subject to research


in the wind· tunnel, for there may be a number of variables that require
in the wind tunnel, for there may be a number of variables that require

proper proportions to obtain the desired effect.

Location
proper proportions to obtain the desired effect.
The location of the vertical tail surfaces depends upon the type and

speed range of the aircraft. For the small, single-engine private airplane,

L-0cation
the vertical tail surfaces are, almost without exception, located above the

horizontal tail surfaces in order to centralize control systems and simplify

the supporting structure contained in the fuselage.

The location of the vertical tail surfaces depends upon the type and
speed range of the aircraft. For the small, single-engine private airplane,
It is desirable to locate about half of the rudder below the axis of sym-

metry of the fuselage, but this may not be possible because of required

clearance with the ground. the vertical tail surfaces are, almost without exception, located above the
Large airplanes employ multiple vertical tail surfaces (see Figure

XIX-20) for several reasons, although the primary one is to obtain the
horizontal tail surfaces in order to centralize control systems and simplify
advantage of slipstream effect over one of the surfaces when an engine of a
the supporting structure contained in the fuselage.
multi-engine design quits. The increased slipstream velocity helps in pro-

It is desirable to locate about half of the rudder below the axis of sym-
metry of the fuselage, but this may not be possible because of required
viding the greater yawing moment necessary to overcome that produced

by the offset thrust.

In large designs, it is often difficult to


clearance with the ground.
prevent blanketing of the vertical tail

surfaces by the large fuselage so that


Large airplanes employ multiple vertical tail surfaces (see Figure
dividing the area into several smaller
XIX-20) for several reasons, although the primary one is to obtain the
ones and placing them at the ends of the

advantage of slipstream effect over one of the surfaces when an engine of a


horizontal tail surfaces increases their

relative efficiency.
multi-engine design quits. The increased slipstream velocity helps in pro-
Where the required area is very large, viding the greater yawing moment necessary to overeome that produced
three instead of two sets of vertical tail

surfaces are used. This reduces the tor- Figure XIX-20. Arrangements
by the offset thrust.
sional load imposed by the outrigger type of twin vertical tail surfaces.
In large designs, it is often difficult to
of vertical tail surfaces which also complicates the control-system design.

The extension of the fin area ahead of the middle fin in triple vertical
prevent blanketing of the vertical tail
tail-surface design has often been added after flight tests indicated that surfaces by the large fuselage so that
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

additional vertical tail area was necessary. While inefficient aerodynami-

dividing the area into several smaller


cally, such extensions do not impose very much additional torsion on the

ones and placing them at the ends of the


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

fuselage.

To a less extent, multiple vertical tail surfaces are used in order to re-
horizontal tail surfaces increases their
duce the over-all height of the aircraft structure, especially in those designs

for which hangar door clearances are the determining factors.


relative efficiency.
Where the required area is very large,
three instead of two sets of vertical tail
surfaces are used. This reduces the tor- FwuRE XIX- 20. Arrangements
sional load imposed by the outrigger type of twin vertical tail surfaces.
of vertical tail surfaces which also complicates the control-system design.
The extension of the fin area ahead of the middle fin in triple vertical
tail-surface design has often been added after flight tests indicated that
additional vertical tail area was necessary. While inefficient aerodynami-
cally, such extensions do not impose very much additional torsion on the
fuselage.
To a less extent, multiple vertical tail surfaces are used in order to re-
duce the over-all height of the aircraft structure, especially in those designs
for which hangar door clearances are the determining factors.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
406 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

For high-speed aircraft, the vertiral tail surfaces may be displaced at


406

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

For high-speed aircraft, the vertical tail surfaces may be displaced at


the wing tips of the swept-back \ving, where they obtain a sufficiently long
the wing tips of the swept-back wing, where they obtain a sufficiently long

moment arm to produce a satisfactory yawing moment.


moment arm to produce a satisfactory yawing moment.
The placing of the vertical tail surfaces at the end of the horizontal tail
The placing of the vertical tail surfaces at the end of the horizontal tail
surfaces helps, although to a very small degree, to increase the effective

surfaces helps, although to a very small degree, to increase the effective


aspect ratio of the horizontal tail surfaces.
aspect ratio of the horizontal tail surfaces.

In some cases the vertical tail surfaces are slightly tilted from the ver-

tical. This is usually the result of the dihedral incorporated in the hori- In some cases the vertical tail surfaces are slightly tilted from the ver-
zontal tail-surface design where dihedral is employed to account for the

tical. This is usually the result of the dihedral incorporated in the hori-
downwash of the wing.

Angular Deflection
zontal tail-surface design where dihedral is employed to account for the
The rudder has an angular movement of a maximum of 30 degrees each
downwash of the wing.
side of neutral. It is generally desirable to have all primary control

surfaces operate through the same angular range so that a pilot transferring

Angular Defiection
from one airplane to another is at least likely to be familiar with the

amount of control to be expected for the control-stick or rudder-pedal The rudder has an angular movement of a maximum of 30 degrees each
movement.

side of neutral. It is generally desirable to have all primary control


The fin may be adjustable to offset the yawing moment induced by the

means used to produce a rolling moment of the wing to offset the torque
surfaces operate through the same angular range so that a pilot transferring
of the reciprocating engine.
from one airplane to another is at least likely to be familiar with the
Aspect Ratio

The aspect ratio of the vertical tail surfaces may be somewhat restricted
amount of control to be expected for the control-stick or rudder-pedal
by the possible torsional moment imposed upon the fuselage structure
movement.
since the vertical tail surfaces are usually asymmetrical about the longi-

The fin may be adjustable to offset the yawing moment induced by the
tudinal axis. Since the tail surfaces are at zero angle of attack throughout

the flight regime, aspect-ratio effects play a very small part, if any, in
means used to produce a rolling moment of the wing to offset the torque
Figure XIX-21. For aspect-ratio calculations, the surface area represented by the
of the reciprocating engine.
side of the fuselage aft of the dotted line is included in the total area; but it is not con-

sidered as part of the vertical tail surface area in the evaluation of the ratios of tail
Aspect Ratio
The aspect ratio of the vertical tail surfaces may be somewhat restricted
surface area to wing area—which ratio may vary from .08 to .12.

by the pos.5ible torsional moment imposed upon the fuselage structure


since the vertical tail surfaces are usually asymmetrical about the longi-
tudinal axis. Since the tail surfaces are at zero angle of attack throughout
the flight regime, aspect-ratio effects play a very small part, if any, in
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:23 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

I
I
I
I

FIGURE XIX-21. For aspect-ratio calculations, the surface area represented by the
side of the fuselage aft of the dotted line is included in the total area; but it is not con-
sidered as part of the vertical tail surface area in the evaluation of the ratios of tail
surface area to wing area- which ratio may vary from .08 to .12.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
TAIL SURFACES 407
TAIL SURFACES

407

the over-all aerodynamic drag of the airplane. The main consideration


the over-all aerodynamic drag of the airplane. The main consideration
for the vertical tail surface is to locate it so that it is not made ineffective
for the vertical tail surface is to locate it so that it is not made ineffective
by blanketing of the fuselage or horizontal tail surfaces. To minimize

such blanketing, a higher aspect ratio for the vertical tail surfaces often
by blanketing of the fuselage or horizontal tail surfaces. To minimize
becomes necessary.
such blanketing, a higher aspect ratio for the vertical tail surfaces often
The aspect ratio of the vertical tail surfaces should be between 2 and 4.

becomes necessary.
It is difficult to state exactly what the aspect ratio of the vertical tail sur-

faces may be, because the rear portion of the fuselage influences the vertical
The aspect ratio of the vertical tail surfaces should be between 2 and 4.
tail surface effectiveness.
It is difficult to state exactly what the aspect ratio of the vertical tail sur-
Area

The size of the tail surfaces is dependent upon the location; the greater
faces may be, because the rear portion of the fuselage influences the vertical
the distance between the center of gravity of the airplane and the center
tail surface effectiveness.
of pressur^of the vertical tail surfaces in terms of the mean^ierodynamic
Area
chord^ofThe wing^the smaller the area needs to be. Where the vertical

tail surfaces are attached to the wing tips, the relative distance is likely
The size of the tail surfaces is dependent upon the location.; the greater
to be smaller, so that the area would have to be proportionately greater
the distance between the center of gravity of the airplane and the. .c_enter
in order to obtain the same degree of directional stability and control.

The area of the vertical tail surfaces ranges from !10jto 15 per cent of
of pr~of the· vertical tail surfaces in terms of the mean aerodynamic
the wing area, with about 30 to 50 per cent of the area devoted to the
chord-oftne wing;-the smaller the area needs to be. Where the vertical
rudder. An exception is provided by those designs where dorsal or

tail -~faces Hore attached to the wing tips, the relative distance is likely
ventral fins are employed, in which case the movable portion of the vertical

tail surfaces is likely to be no more than 30 per cent of the total area.
to be smaller, so that the area would have to be proportionately greater
The dorsal fin (see Figure XIX-22) may be used to increase the fin area
in order to obtain the same degree of directional stability and control.
in order to (1) increase the directional stability if the original surface

Figure XIX-22. The dotted lines show various ways of increasing the fin area.
The area of the vertical tail surfaces ranges from (lO_j.(} 15 per cent of
The top diagram illustrates a dorsal fin, while the two bottom diagrams illustrate the
the wing area, with about 30 to 50 per cent of the area devoted to the
vertical-type fin.

rudder. An exception is provided by those designs where dorsal or


ventral fins are employed, in which case the movable portion of the vertical
tail surfaces is likely to be no more than 30 per cent of the total area.
The dorsal fin (see Figure XIX-22) may be used to increase the fin area
in order to (1) increase the directional stability if the original surface
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

----------

_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _J
--
__ ,,,
J

FIGtTRE XIX - 22. The dotted lines show variouR ways of increasing the fin area.
The top diagram illustrateR a dorRal fin, while the two bottom diagrams illustrate the
vcrtiral-typc fin .

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
408 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
408

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

proves inadequate, (2) transmit the loads on the fin to a greater number
proves inadequate, (2) transmit the loads on the fin to a greater number

of fuselage frames, (3) reduce the torsional moment about the longitudinal
of fuselage frames, (3) reduce the torsional moment about the longitudinal
fuselage axis, (4) reduce the over-all height dimensions of the vertical tail

fuselage axis, (4) reduce the over-all height dimensions of the vertical tail
surfaces, and (5) obtain a possible weight saving, although the total fin

area is likely to be greater for a dorsal fin than for a normal fin-type
surfaces, and (5) obtain a possible weight saving, although the total fin
surface. area is likely to be greater for a dorsal fin than for a normal fin-type
The ventral fin (See Figure XIX-22) is another solution to increasing

surface.
the fin area. Since it is located below the fuselage, it is not blanketed

by any of the aircraft structure and is likely to be even more effective


The ventral fin (See Figure XIX-22) is another solution to increasing
than the dorsal fin.
the fin area. Since it is located below the fuselage, it is not blanketed
Planform

The vertical tail surfaces have a variety of planforms, depending some-


by any of the aircraft structure and is likely to be even more effective
what upon their location. A few likely designs are illustrated in Figure than the dorsal fin.
XIX-23.

Planform
Figure XIX-23. Typical planforms of vertical tail surfaces.

Sweepback
The vertical tail surfaces have a variety of planforms, depending some-
For transonic and supersonic designs, the vertical tail surfaces must

what upon their location. A few likely designs are illustrated in Figure
XIX-23.
incorporate sweepback. For lower-speed aircraft, on the other hand,

the sweepback observed in the design of the vertical tail surfaces is a result

of other design considerations such as planform, appearance, and position

of the fin-post.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XIX-23. Typical planforms of vertical tail surfaces.

Sweepback
For transonic and supersonic designs, the vertical tail surfaces must
incorporate sweepback. For lower-speed aircraft, on the other hand,
the sweepback observed in the design of the vertical tail surfaces is a result
of other design considerations such as planform, appearance, and position
of the fin-post .

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
TAIL SURFACES 409
TAIL SURFACES

409
Tail Length
Tail Length

For subsonic designs of conventional layout, the tail surfaces have been
For subsonic designs of conventional layout, the tail surfaces have been
so located that the distance from the center of gravity of the airplane to
so located that the distance from the center of gravity of the airplane to
the estimated center of pressure of the horizontal or vertical tail surfaces

is from 2.5 to 3.25 times the mean geometric chord of the wing.
the estimated center of pressure of the horizontal or vertical tail surfaces
As speeds approach the supersonic, the "trim drag", especially with
is from 2.5 to 3.25 times the mean geometric chord of the wing.
deflected surfaces, becomes an appreciable portion of the total drag of

As speeds approach the supersonic, the "trim drag", especially with


deflected surfaces, becomes an appreciable portion of the total drag of
the airplane. To ameliorate this condition, the tail length is made as

long as possible, so that smaller areas may be employed for the tail sur-

faces and relatively little deflection is necessary for the desired amount
the airplane. To ameliorate this condition, the tail length is made as
of control. Both are attempts to reduce the drag. However, there is a

point of diminishing return in that a longer fuselage also implies a greater


long as possible, so that smaller areas may be employed for the tail sur-
skin drag, and thus a gain in one may be offset by a loss in the other.
faces and relatively little deflection is necessary for the desired amount
|- A M

of control. Both are attempts to reduce the drag. However, there is a


point of diminishing return in that a longer fuselage also implies a greater
Figure XIX-24. The distance A for conventional airplanes should be from to 3

times the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing. The angle B, corresponding to the

maximum deflection of the elevator, should permit the tailing edge of the elevator to
skin drag, and thus a gain in one may be offset by a loss in the other.
clear the ground comfortably.

BUTTERFLY OR VEE TAIL

This type of tail surface combines the vertical and horizontal tail

surfaces in one, as shown in Figure XIX-25. The vertical component of

the lift corresponds to the normal tail-surface load, while the horizontal

Figure XIX-25. A "Vee" or "Butterfly" tail.


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

FIGURE XIX-24. The distance A for conventional airplanes should be from 2Y2 to~
times the mean aerodynamic chord of the wing. The angle B, corresponding to the
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

maximum deflection of the elevator, should permit the tailing edge of the elevator to
clear the ground comfortably.

BUTTERFLY OR VEE TAIL


This type of tail surface combines the vertic-al and horizontal tail
surfaces in one, as shown in Figure XIX- 25. The vertical component of
the lift corresponds to the normal tail-surface load, while the horizontal

FIGURE XIX- 25. A "Vef'" or "Butterfly" tail.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
410 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
410

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


component of lift when both halves of the surfaces are neutral is zero,
component of lift when both halves of the surfaces are neutral is zero,

unless both surfaces are at an angle to the normal direction of flight


unless both surfaces are at an angle to the normal direction of flight

when the horizontal component of lift produces the necessary yawing


when the horizontal component of lift procluces the necessary yawing
moment to weather-cock the airplane.
moment to weather-cock the airplane.
The movable trailing-edge flaps act as elevators when both are deflected

in the same direction, and as rudders when operated in the opposite


The movable trailing-edge flaps act as elevators when both are deflected
direction. It is also possible to operate them in a combination of the two
in the same direction, and as rudders when operated in the opposite
motions so that simultaneous pitching and yawing moments are obtained.

direction. It is also possible to operate them in a combination of the two


motions so that simultaneous pitching and yawing moments are obtained.
The movable surfaces are called either ruddervaters or elerudders.

The cockpit controls are the same as for the normal type of rudders and

elevators, although the control mechanism from the cockpit to the tail The movable surfaces are called either ruddervaters or elerudders.
surfaces is a little more complicated.

The advantages claimed for such an arrangement are:


The cockpit controls are the same as for the normal type of rudders and
1. A saving in weight due to its simplicity of construction, its fewer
elevators, although the control mechanism from the cockpit to the tail
elements, and the smaller total area possible.

surfaces is a little more complicated.


The advantages claimed for 8Uch an arrangement are:
2. Higher maximum speed, due to less area and consequently less pro-

file drag as well as less interference drag.

3. Better spin recovery due to less blanketing of the tail surfaces.


1. A saving in weight due to its simplicity of construction, its fewer
The detailed design information is to be found in an NACA report.

For preliminary design purposes, the following relationships may be


elements, and the smaller total area possible.
considered:
2. Higher maximum speed, due to less area and consequently less pro-
The effective horizontal tail surface area

file drag as well as less interference drag.


3. Better spin recovery due to less blanketing of the tail surfaces.
SH = S cos 0; (1)

oc

nOOOC The detailed design information is to be found in an NACA report.


) O O Oil

For preliminary design purposes, the following relationships may be


DO

JUj
considered:
uihrj

— i
The effective horizontal tail surface area
<

r
SH = s cos {3; (1)
5—4

1= \

Figure XIX-26. Dive brakes are used to reduce speed of aircraft and may be used
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

as spoilers for additional aileron or directional control, depending upon the number

used and their location. When not in use, they recess—flush—into the top surface of
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the wing.

!o o o o o 00000]

,
-- .
I
I +~
•• - "tr- '

__,_
·~

FIGURE XIX-26. Dive brakes are used to reduce speed of aircraft and may be used
as spoilers for additional aileron or directional control, depending upon the number
used and their location. When not in use, they recess-flush-into the top surface of
the wing.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
TAIL SURFACES 411
TAIL SURFACES

411

The effective vertical tail surface area


The effective vertical tail surface area

Sv = S sin 0. (2)

Sv = S sin {J. (2)


Dividing (2) by (1),

tan /3 =

Dividing (2) by (1),


so that using the proportion of areas needed for the conventional vertical

and horizontal tail surfaces, the value of tan /J can be determined where /3

Sv.
t an/>JR = - ,
SH
is the dihedral angle for the tail surfaces. Once the value of /3 has been

found, the total area of the Vee tail can be calculated from either equation

so that using the proportion of areas needed for the conventional vertical
(1) or equation (2).

and horizontal tail surfaces, the value of tan {J can be determined where {J
is the dihedral angle for the tail surfaces. Once the value of {J has been
found, the total area of the Vee tail can be calculated from either equation
(1) or equation (2).
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
CHAPTER

Control Systems

The control system incorporates all the operating mechanisms located

in the cockpit, the connections between these mechanisms, and the control

surfaces.

TYPICAL SYSTEMS

The systems commonly employed are:

1. The push-pull system (Figure XX-1) consists of tubes which may

take tension and compression and whose direction may be conveniently

changed by suitable mechanical devices, usually bell-cranks.


CHAPTER XX
The push-pull system is likely to be heavy since any member subjected

to compression is larger than one subjected to tension. Where the struc-

ture, as the wing for example, has large deflections, the push-pull control

system may be bent with the wing causing difficulty of operation. It may

be used for part of the system in combination with others, and for engine

controls, and rudder and elevator controls. Its advantage is that it has
C.ontrol SystelD.8
no appreciable stretch to cause lag in operation of the movable controls.

2. The cable system, most extensively employed because deflections of

the structure to which it is attached do not affect its operation, consists of

a continuous system of cables operating over pulleys and through fairleads.

Since cables have a tendency to stretch, they are prestretched before in-

stallation to about 60 per cent of their rated strength; some manufacturers

install them with an initial tension of 100 to 150 pounds. Long cables,

particularly, may have a large amount of stretch unless these special


The control system incorporates all the operating mechanisms located
precautions are taken to limit it.
in the cockpit, the connections between these mechanisms, and the control ·
3. The torque-tube system, which converts lineal motion into rotary mo-

surfaces.
tion, has relatively few members and usually its installation is compara-

tively simple structurally. Long members under torsion have consider-

able angular deflection which is liable to cause a time lag in operation of


TYPICAL SYSTEMS
412
The systems commonly employed are:
1. The push-pull system <Figure XX-1) consists of tubes which may
take tension and compression and whose direction may be conveniently
changed by suitable mechanical devices, usually bell-cranks.
The push-pull system is likely to be heavy since any member subjected
to compression is larger than one subjected to tension. Where the struc-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:24 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ture, as the wing for example, has large deflections, the push-pull control
system may be bent with the wing causing difficulty of operation. It may
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

be used for part of the system in combination with others, and for engine
controls, and rudder and elevator controls. Its advantage is that it has
no appreciable stretch to cause lag in operation of the movable controls.
2. 1.'he cable system, most extensively employed because deflections of
the structure to which it is attached do not affect its operation, consists of
a continuous system of cables operating over pulleys and through fairleads.
8ince cables have a tendency to stretch, they are prestretched before in-
stallation to about 60 per cent of their rated strength; some manufacturers
install them with an initial tension of 100 to 150 pounds. Long cables,
particularly, may have a large amount of stretch unless these special
precautions are taken to limit it.
3. The torque-tube system, which converts lineal motion into rotary mo-
tion, has relatively few members and usually its installation is compara-
tively simple structurally. Long members under torsion have consider-
able angular deflection which is liable to cause a time lag in operation of
412

Original from
iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CONTROL SYSTEMS 413
CONTROL SYSTEMS

413

controls or, if stops are provided in the system, the angular deflections
may be large enough to reduce seriously the angular depression of the con-
controls or, if stops are provided in the system, the angular deflections

may be large enough to reduce seriously the angular depression of the con-

trol surface it is to operate. To limit the angular deflections, relatively

~
rigid members (offering greater weight) have to be employed.

I
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:25 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ch
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

'

trol surface it is to operate. To limit the angular <leflections, relatively


rigid members (offering greater weight) have to be employed.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
414 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
414

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL In designing control systems, especial care should be given to assure
In designing control systems, especial care should be given to assure

that there is no binding, change in tension, or interference of the various


that there is no binding, change in tension, or interference of the various
components comprising the system as well as possible interference with
components comprising the system as well as possible interference with
the attaching structure. Extreme weather conditions require considera-
the attaching structure. Extreme weather conditions require considera-
tion of thermal expansion and contraction.

Adjustable stabilizer-elevator combinations, especially when the stabi-


tion of thermal expansion and contraction.
lizer is adjusted to its extreme position, may cause either interference with Adjustable stabilizer-elevator combinations, especially. when the stabi-
other parts of the control system or excessive tension in the rigging of the

lizer is adjusted to its extreme position, may cause either interference with
surfaces or in the control system.

PULLEYS
other parts of the control system or excessive tension in the rigging of the
Cables passing over pulleys are kept in place by guards. These should
surfaces or in the control system.
be close-fitting to prevent jamming or to prevent cables from slipping off

PULLEYS
when they slacken due to temperature variations.

Figure XX-2. Schematic diagram of the tension cable system for control surface

operation. Motion caused by rotation of control wheel for aileron, and by fore and

aft motion of the control column. Rudder operation is obtained by another control
Cables passing over pulleys are kept in place by guards. These should
system employing a cross-bar or a pedal assembly actuated by the foot. be close-fitting to prevent jamming or to prevent cables from slipping off
The pulleys should be located in such a way that the plane of rotation

when they slacken due to temperature variations.


of the pulley lies in the plane determined by the cables. There should be

no rubbing of the cable against the side of the pulley flanges.

CABLES

Control cables are designated by the number of strands such as 6 X 19

or 7 X 19 extra flexible. These are generally preferred because of their

greater sturdiness, but 6 X 7 or 7 X 7 flexible cable of ^2-inch diameter

may be used where especial care is taken to provide against wear. Cable

smaller than %a-inch diameter may not be used in the primary control
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:25 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XX-2. Schematic diagram of the tension cahle system for control surface
operation. Motion caused by rotation of control wheel for aileron, and by fore e.nd
aft motion of the control column. Rudder operatirm is obtained hy another control
system employing a cross-bar or a. pedal assembly actuated by the foot.

The pulleys should be located in such a way that the plane of rotation
of the pulley lies in the plane determined by the cables. There should be
no rubbing of the cable against the side of the pulley flanges.

CABLES
Control cables are designated by the number of strands such as 6 X 19
or 7 X 19 extra flexible. These are generally preferred because of their
greater sturdiness, but 6 X 7 or 7 X 7 flexible cable of %rinch diameter
may be used where especial care is taken to provide against wear. Cable
smaller than %rinch diameter may not be used in the primary control

Original from
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
CONTROL SYSTEMS 415
CONTROL SYSTEMS

415
system except for tab-control systems, provided the airplane may still be
system except for tab-control systems, provided the airplane may still be

controlled should such cables fail.


controlled should such cables fail.
In general, cable sizes are determined by considerations of control-system
In general, cable sizes a.re determined by considerations of control-system
deflections previously discussed as well as by strength requirements.

deflections previously discussed as well as by strength requirements.


Table XX-1 shows weights and lengths of cables.
Table XX-1 shows weights and lengths of cables.

FAIRLEADS

Cable systems, or chains, or connecting links of the control system

should be supported at inter-

vals to prevent chafing of the

system against adjacent struc-


FAIRLEADS
ture or possible interference

with other components of the


Cable systems, or cha.ins, or connecting links of the control system
same system. For such pur-

poses, fairleads are employed.


should be supported at inter-
These should not be used to vals to prevent chafing of the
change the direction of the

system against adjacent struc-


cable, although for relatively

low cable loads, a change up to


ture or possible interference
3 degrees is permitted.
with other components of the
Wherever guards or fair-

leads are used, means should


same system. For such pur-
be available for easy inspec- poses, fairleads a.re employed.
tion and maintenance.

Figure XX-3. A fairlead block attached to


These should not be used to
a metal bracket to prevent chafing of the metal
change the direction of the
control cable.
cable, although for relatively
In "open" systems for the

aileron-control system where


low cable loads, a change up to
the balance cable between the 3 degrees is permitted.
ailerons is the only system for returning the ailerons to neutral, the effects

Wherever guards or fa.ir-


leads are used, means should
of opposite loads on the wheels or sticks of a dual-control system may

cause such deflections (stretch) in the control cables or chains that jamming

may occur unless close-fitting fairleads or guards are used.


be available for easy inspec-
STOPS

tion and maintenance.


FIGURE XX-3. A fairlead block attached to
Adjustable stabilizers require stops at their extreme limits in case the

In "open" systems for the


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:25 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

a metal bracket to prevent chafing of the metal


adjusting mechanism should fail. Elevator trailing-edge tab systems also

should be provided with stops to limit the travel. It is generally wise to

control cable. aileron-control system where


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the balance cable between the


incorporate some form of stops on all movable surfaces to avoid interfer-

ence with the adjacent structure. It is also desirable to have additional

stops located close to the operating force in order to avoid a "springy"


ailerons is the only system for returning the ailerons to neutral, the effects
control.

of opposite loads on the wheels or sticks of a dual-control system may


cause such deflections (stretch) in the control cables or cha.ins that jamming
may occur unless close-fitting fairleads or guards are used.

STOPS
Adjustable stabilizers require stops at their extreme limits in case the
adjusting mechanism should fail. Elevator trailing-edge tab systems also
should be provided with stops to limit the travel. It is generally wise to
incorporate some form of stops on all movable surfaces to avoid interfer-
ence with the adjacent structure. It is also desirable to have additional
stops located close to the operating force in order to avoid a "springy' 1
control.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
St-

.a I

£ g

(in.)

Size

S- <n «f ^- oo~ of e£

strength Oh)

b00aking

Minimum

»-H l-( N

feet Qb)

thouOnd

Weight ser

(in.)

Oize

SSSSSoSqoS0

strength (lb)

b00aking

Minimum

m « « « n .* xoo n «o e« m • s«»

feet Ob)

thouOnd

Weight ser

'$ '% 'g k 'S '§ k p§ > 'St '% f E >

(in.)

Size

i-T pa to to oo" o cf h--

OO00OOOOQOOOOOOQQ

lOOOQOOOOOOOQO©

rtrtHNft

strength (lb)

b00aking

Minimum

noiusOHqoqqooqo

feet (lb)

thouOnd

Weight ser

Ex

11

S5 S

C »H

*j

iS

CP

° 8

03 g

si

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

416
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:25 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

0
<5"
-
~

-
i';i"

TABI,E XX-1. Weights and strength of cable. (Courtesy of Air Associates, Inc.)
O"

Extra flexible cable Flexible cable N onflexible cable


7 X 19 construction 7 X 7 construction 7-wire or 19-wire construction ~

Size
(in.)
Minimum
breaking
strength (lb)
Weight per
thousand
feet (lb)
Size
(in.)
Minimum
breaking
strength (lb)
Weight per
thousand
feet {lb)
Size
(in.)
Minimum
breaking
strength {lb)
Weight per
thousand
feet (lb) ~~
% 2,000 27 Yie 480 7 %2 7-wire 185 2.2
%2 2,800 42 %· 550 11 %• 7-wire 300 5.6

c:
:z:
<
SBo
%11
~I
~
%1
%11
1%1
4.200
5,600
7,000
8,000
9,800
12,500
79
103
131
161
195
60 %2
%
%2
Yi11
%2
~
920
1,350
2,600
3,200
4,600
5,800
16
27
43
61
81
106
~e 19-wire
%• 19-wire
%2 19-wire
%• 19-wire
% 19-wire
%2 19-wire
500
780
1,100
1,600
2,100
3,200
8.8
13.7
20.0
28.l
35.0
57.0
I
~
V'I ::::!.
%2 ~
--11.C
-< :;·
01:11
"Tl ::::;:;
"
14,400 232
,,
%e
7,200
9,200
13,100
138
166
230
%11 19-wire
~I 19-wire
~ 19-wire
%2 19-wire
4,600
6,100
8,000
75.0
106.0
136.0
~
~
~
_a
,....., 3 %11 19-wire
10,000
12,500
177.0
214.0
:I: " 19-wire 17,500 301.0
C'i
>
:z:
CONTROL SYSTEMS 417

-~ \
•.,l \
l'5
I
I
I
• 1
11 ·~1· I

. I ------~
j
REAR SPAR
J
AIL.ERON HINGE
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:25 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

I ST. PILOT ~ND. PILOT

FIGURE XX-4. Aileron control schematic. (Courtesy Convair.)

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
418 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
418

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XX-5. Aileron control unit. The mechanism employed here may be used

with equal effectiveness for the operation of any movable surface. (Courtesy Convair.)

-t-~~~~---
1 Al ,
I 0-----~-:'I("--.,£.-/"---.H.._7

TIM1<£N RQ.LIR

SHIMS (llarH ENo->


FOA~L
"D.JUSTMENT OI' _ , .

MIMS FOii 1.ATERAL AO,J.


O~ QUADRANT
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:25 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

TIMl<l!N AOl.L.ltR
&•ARING>
................
-'<'--....L.......-.a
L.CM'

A01 ~.OM
.....__

*~
'--+/ . .-
FIGURE XX-5. Aileron control unit. The mechanism employed here may be used
with equal effectiveness for the operation of any movable surface. (Courtesy Convair.)

Original from
D191 iz by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
CONTROL SYSTEMS · 419

DIFFERENTIAL AILERONS
Aileron-control systems incorporating extreme ranges of differential
motion or a large amount of aerodynamic balance require a system rea-
sonably free from excessive friction in order to permit the ailerons to re-
turn to normal.
ADJUSTABLE STABILIZER
To reduce the effort of the pilot to keep the airplane at trim in the nor-
mal cruising range at which time the horizontal tail surfaces are more or
less neutral, an adjustable stabilizer or & trimming tab may be used to take
care of variations in center of gravity locations. Moving the center of
gravity forward from the normal produces a "nose heavy" condition; mov-
ing it to the rear of normal produces a "tail heavy" condition; the adjust-
able stabilizer or the trimming tab is designed to take care of such a con-
dition, within limits.

C.Ontro/ coble to
gyropilof and

--
pilot

Vibration damper
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:26 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ond
lost motion linkage
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1 Boost rotio,. .1l..


A
Control
Coble

FIGURE XX-6. One method to reduce pilot effort by hooking the booster cylinder
into the control system through the de-booster and relief valve.

Adjustable stabilizer controls should be free from creeping tendencies.


This may be accomplished by means of an adjusting screw or worm whose
lead angle does not exceed 4 degrees, or by means of friction, or detent, or
equivalent means. The screw or worm is one form of an irreversible
mechanism which is particularly suitable, especially when the stabilizer is
hinged near its trailing edge.

Original from
019 t11ed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
420 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

TAB CONTROLS
Irreversible and nonflexible control systems should be used for tab con-
trols. When the tab is statically balanced a.bout its hinge line, other sys-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:26 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

F1ouRE XX-7. Aileron servotab control system as developed by Consolidated-Vultee.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

terns may be used. Small travel for the tabs should be avoided because
of possible abrupt action of the tab. Precautions should be taken in de-
sign to prevent the possibility of inadvertent, abrupt, or opposite opera-
tion of the tab. Indicating devices a.re considered essential for showing
not only the relative position but also direction of motion required to ob-
tain the necessary control.

FLAP CONTROLS
In the operation of the flap, loss of lift may result when the flap is first
opened. It is for this reason that sudden, inadvertent, or automatic oper-
ation of the flap is not desirable except in cases where the flap is used in
landing and the airplane is coming in on a glide approach when a sudden
loss of lift merely causes a settling which is not disastrous.
The flap should not be capable of full extension or retraction in less than
15 seconds. Means should be provided for indicating the position at any

Original from
019 tied by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
CONTROL SYSTEMS 421

rl--r---- - - - - - w·ing contour


I\:
----/t/
_....z_,........
I ----'------/~
__ 13•
I ------y~~liO <
-· Torque tube - - - -~ ,·5·11
~ /
--t--l----·--·- ~ £: .___
_j_/._.
/ / I ·-·
_ . . ~-. ,, 1-
1s•t2•

I 11
----=----1.i-
-:::-.J
Lr--/
--- T' ~
- - --p--=--:..~
I ·. ---- \ / Aileron / ~
U~---\.---------- \../ hinge <i 1

Tab hinge <i


Rear Rear spar <i
1 Bearing
spar <t No lubrication required
~~=i.
-a++-t~
Retainer ass'y ball bearing Control ass'y aileron trim tab

FIGU RE XX-8. Aileron trim-tab control system. (Courtesy Conva.ir.)

Fairing +·
-- -- -
Counterbalance
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:26 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Section A-A

FIGURE XX-9. Elevator control system. The linkage system can be used for flaps, \
tabs, and other movable surfaces. (Courtesy <;onvair.)

Original from
0191t1zed by Gqoglc UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
422 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

time. Positive means should also be incorporated for providing positive


422

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

time. Positive means should also be incorporated for providing positive


retention of the flap in the fully retracted position.
retention of the flap in the fully retracted position.

WING FLAPS

WING FLAPS
In addition to the usual air loads acting upon the deflected wing flaps,

high local loads may also be caused by the impact of water, especially In addition to the usual air loads acting upon the deflected wing flaps,
when low-wing airplanes are operated from wet fields or water. For these

high local loads may also be caused by the impact of water, especially
reasons, it is desirable to make the flaps sturdy. When the piano-type

hinge is used, a series of short sections rather than one long section should
when low-wing airplanes are operated from wet fields or water. For these
be used not only for ease of maintenance but also for better operation.

reasons, it is desirable to make the flaps sturdy. When the piano-type


Ground clearance of the flap for low-wing installation should be carefully

considered, especially in the initial design stages because subsequent flight


hinge is used, a series of short sections rather than one long section should
tests may indicate that a greater angular deflection of the flap may be de- be used not only for ease of maintenance but also for better operation.
sirable. The ground clearance is least for the largest angular depression

Ground clearance of the flap for low-wing installation should be carefully


of the flap. For a start, 12 inches of ground clearance is assumed reason-

able.
considered, especially in the initial design stages because subsequent flight
TABS
tests may indicate that a greater angular deflection of the flap may be de-
Tabs for control surfaces should be rigid and well anchored to prevent

damage or misalignment from handling. For small airplanes, such tabs


sirable. The ground clearance is least for the largest angular depression
usually consist of thin sheets attached to the trailing edge. In this case, of the flap. For a start, 12 inches of ground clearance is assumed reason-
care should be taken that successive bendings of these tabs do not interfere

able.
with the performance of the main surface or do not damage the tab itself.

HINGES TABS
Tabs for control surfaces should be rigid and well anchored to prevent
Hinges for control surfaces need careful study. It is usually desirable

to provide at least three hinges for control surfaces to assure operation

of the surfaces. The deflections of the surfaces and the structure to which damage or misalignment from handling. For small airplanes, such tabs
they are attached should be studied.

usually consist of thin sheets attached to the trailing edge. In this case,
Usually it is desirable to so space these hinges that the load for each

hinge is the same. However, a study of deflections may indicate another


care should be taken that successive bendings of these tabs do not interfere
disposition. For initial design, hinges may be spaced equidistant since

with the performance of the main surface or do not damage the tab itself.
subsequent stress analysis is necessary to indicate likely deflections.

Bearings usually allow a few degrees for misalignment, but if deflections

cause too much misalignment, the surface cannot be deflected at all.


HINGES
Closed piano-type hinges are acceptable when they are positively at-

Hinges for control surfaces need careful study. It is usually desirable


tached (other than wood screws) as close to the hinge line as possible.

Several sections should be used to reduce inspection and maintenance


to provide at least three hinges for control surfaces to assure operation
of the surfaces. The deflections of the surfaces and the structure to which
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:26 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

problems and they should not be located near the control horns where the

load is concentrated.

they are attached should be studied.


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Strap-type hinges are generally not desirable since the wear is appre-

ciable, and their repair relatively difficult. Usually it is desirable to so space these hinges that the load for ea.ch
Provision for lubrication should be provided wherever self-lubrication

hinge is the same. However, a study of deflections may indicate another


disposition. For initial design, hinges may be spaced equidistant since
methods or sealed bearings are not used.

subsequent stress analysis is necessary to indicate likely deflections.


Bearings usually allow a few degrees for misalignment, but if deflections
caURe too much misalignment, the surface cannot be deflected at all.
Closed piano-type hinges are acceptable when they are positively at-
tached (other than wood screws) as close to the hinge line as possible.
Several sections should be used to reduce inspection and maintenance
problems and they should not be located near the control horns where the
load is concentrated.
Strap-type hinges are generally not desirable since the wear is appre-
ciable, and their repair relatively difficult.
Provision for lubrication should be provided wherever self-lubrication
methods or sealed bearings are not used.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
CONTROL SYSTEMS 423
CONTROL SYSTEMS

423

FLAP- AND TAB-CONTROL LOADS


FLAP- AND TAB-CONTROL LOADS

For the upper limit, a torque of 133 inch-pounds applied to the control
For the upper limit, a torque of 133 inch-pounds applied to the control
knob in "twist" controls may be considered a design factor. Where con-

trol wheels, cranks, levers, or handwheels with a well-defined rim are used,
knob in "twist" controls may be considered a design factor. Where con-
a torque of T = 100 R (where R is the radius of the wheel) should be con-
trol wheels, cranks, levers, or handwheels with a well-defined rim are used,
sidered.

a torque of T = 100 R (where R is the radius of the wheel) should be con-


sidered.
HYDRAULIC AND PNEUMATIC SYSTEMS

Hydraulic and pneumatic systems are increasingly used to replace

manual operation of all devices which are changed from one position or

condition to another for which the time element may not be important
HYDRAULIC AND PNEUMATIC SYSTEMS
Hydraulic and pneumatic systems are increasingly used to replace
and where rapid reversals of such motions are not required.

The widest application so far has been for cases requiring lineal motion

although rotary motion can also be obtained through the use of hydraulic manual operation of all devices which are changed from one position or
motors employing a variable-volume hydraulic pump as a pressure source.

Hydraulic systems have been used extensively for actuating:


condition to another for which the time element may not be important
1.
and where rapid reversals of such motions are not required.
Retractable landing gears

The widest application so far has been for cases requiring lineal motion
although rotary motion can also be obtained through the use of hydraulic
8.

Fuel dump valves

2.
motors employing a variable-volume hydraulic pump as a pressure source.
Wheel brakes

9.
Hydraulic systems have been used extensively for actuating:
1. Retractable landing gears 8. Fuel dump valves
Tail wheels

3.

Automatic pilot 2. Wheel brakes 9. Tail wheels


10.

3. Automatic pilot 10. Hydraulic motors for starting


Hydraulic motors for starting

4.
4. Trailing-edge wing flaps auxiliary engines
Trailing-edge wing flaps
5. Engine-cowling flaps 11. Remotely-mounted fuel
auxiliary engines

5.
6. Windshield wipers pumps
Engine-cowling flaps
7. Full-feathering hydromatic 12. Folding wings or wing tips.
11.

propellers
Remotely-mounted fuel

6.

All these could also be operated by electrical means and for military pur-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:26 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Windshield wipers

pumps
poses. Such means would be preferable because of the vulnerability of
the hydraulic systems. However, weight saving is always an important
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

7.

matter in commercial design and the hydraulic systems are considerably


Full-feathering hydromatic

12.

Folding wings or wing tips. lighter than a comparable electrical system.


propellers

Hydraulic systems are generally preferred because of:


All these could also be operated by electrical means and for military pur-

poses. Such means would be preferable because of the vulnerability of

the hydraulic systems. However, weight saving is always an important


1. Flexibility of control permitting immediate and positive starting and
matter in commercial design and the hydraulic systems are considerably
stopping of operating mechanisms.
lighter than a comparable electrical system.

2. Simple variation of output by modification of bore and stroke.


3. Ease of installation.
Hydraulic systems are generally preferred because of:

1. Flexibility of control permitting immediate and positive starting and

stopping of operating mechanisms.


4. Ease of inspection and maintenance-both of which are done by any
2. Simple variation of output by modification of bore and stroke.

3. Ease of installation.
mechanic more quickly than for the equivalent electrical system.
4. Ease of inspection and maintenance—both of which are done by any
5. Reserve power available (when pressure accumulators are used)
mechanic more quickly than for the equivalent electrical system.
when the engine quits.
5. Reserve power available (when pressure accumulators are used)

when the engine quits.

In large airplanes several hydraulic systems may be required since pres-


In large airplanes several hydraulic systems may be required since pres-

sure and fluid requirements vary. Usually one system is installed for use
sure and fluid requirements vary. Usually one system is installed for use
with engine oil for operation of full-feathering hydromatic propeller, and
with engine oil for operation of full-feathering hydromatic propeller, and

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
424 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
424

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


another for use with Lockheed hydraulic fluid for operating brakes, re-
another for use with Lockheed hydraulic fluid for operating brakes, re-

tractable mechanisms, flaps, and the like.


tractable mechanisms, flaps, and the like.
Hydraulic systems for aircraft may operate from 1000 to 1500 pounds
Hydraulic systems for aircraft may operate from 1000 to 1500 pounds
per square inch for which 52SO aluminum alloy tubing is usually employed.

per square inch for which 5280 aluminum alloy tubing is usually employed.
Occasionally the systems may be required to operate at 3000 pounds per
Occasionally the systems may be required to operate at 3000 pounds per

square inch or higher, for which stainless-steel tubing may be employed.

Hydraulic
square inch or higher, for which stainless-steel tubing may be employed.
tubing

Support

bracket

Support

bracket
Support
Figure XX-10. Hydraulic bracket
cylinder.
tubing
Actuating cylinder

Sketch showing one method of installing a hydraulic actuating

The diameter of the tubing is selected on the basis of fluid flow required.

The wall thickness is determined on the basis of allowable stress, required

load factor, and commercial thickness available. The average fluid flow

for certain tubing sizes is listed here.

Nominal Tubing,

Outside Diameter (in.)

y*

Support
Average Flow Desired

(gal per min)

1.2 bracket
2.3

3.5

6.0
Actuating cylinder
10.5

16.0 FIGURE XX- 10. Sketch showing one method of installing a hydraulic actuating
29.0 cylinder.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:27 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Barlow's formula for wall thickness is

The diameter of the tubing is selected on the basis of fluid flow required.
KPD
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

t=

2F
The wall thickness is determined on the basis of allowable stress, required
lu

load factor, and commercial thickness available. The average fluid flow
for certain tubing sizes is listed here.

Nominal Tubing, Average Flow Desired


Outside Diameter (in.) (gal per min)
~ 1.2
%1 2.3
% 3.5
7' 6.0
% 10.5
% 16.0
1 29.0

Barlow's formula for wall thickness is


t = KPD
___ ,
2Fiu

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CONTROL SYSTEMS 425
CONTROL SYSTEMS

425

where t = wall thickness in inches,


where /

= wall thickness in inches, K = safety factor required (usually about 5),


P = nominal operating pressure, pounds per square inch,
K

= safety factor required (usually about 5),

D = outside diameter of tube in inches,


= nominal operating pressure, pounds per square inch,

D
F ''" = ultimate tensile stress of the material.
= outside diameter of tube in inches,

= ultimate tensile stress of the material. Pneumatic systems, because of the availability of a large air supply and
Pneumatic systems, because of the availability of a large air supply and

the absence of extreme changes in viscosity, are used for aircraft powered
the absence of extreme changes in viscosity, are used for aircraft powered
with jet engines.
with jet engines.
Above 70,000 feet, air compressors will probably not be used since the

ambient air is too thin to compress efficiently. Furthermore, the turbo-


Above 70,000 feet, air compressors will probably not be used since the
jet engine will need all the air it can get, leaving none for such functions
ambient air is too thin to compress efficiently. Furthermore, the turbo-
as cabin pressurization or operation of controls.

jet engine will need all the air it ran get, leaving none for such functions
as cabin pressurization or operation of controls.
A pneumatic source will probably still be necessary, but the use of air

will most likely be restricted to emergency operations such as canopy or

stores jettisoning. Seals and joints of the entire operating system would

A pneumatic source will probably still be necessary, but the use of air
will most likely be restricted to emergency operations such as canopy or
have to be completely leak-free. The power or supply source may be

high-pressure air bottles or specially designed compressed-air storage

areas within the aircraft structure.


stores jettisoning. Seals and joints of the entire operating system would
Another source of pneumatic povrer could be nitrogen or another gas in

liquid form. This would require an insulated, high-strength container.


have to be completely leak-free. The power or supply source may be
"Pseudo-pneumatics"—still another source of power—makes use of
high-pressure air bottles or specially designed compressed-air storage
the expanding gases produced by the firing of explosive cartridges to

areas within the aircraft structure.


operate certain pneumatic components, such as starters, and could be

adapted for other functions requiring reliability and instantaneous action.


Another source of pneumatic po-.rnr could be nitrogen or another gas in
TRAVEL OF CONTROLS

liquid form. This would require an insulated, high-strength container.


It is generally desirable to standardize on the travel allowed for the

various controls so that a pilot, in transferring from one type of airplane "Pseudo-pneumatics"-still another source of power-makes use of
Figure XX-11. A schematic diagram of a simple irreversible control mechanism.

the expanding gases produced by the firing of explosive cartridges to


(See also detail in Figure XX-5 for irreversible control.)

operate certain pneumatic components, such ·as starters, and could be


adapted for other functions requiring reliability and instantaneous action.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:27 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

TRAVEL OF CONTROLS
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

It is generally desirable to standardize on the travel allowed for the


various controls so that a pilot, in transferring from one type of airplane

FIGURE XX-11. A schematic diagram of a simple irreverHible control mechanism.


(Sec also detail in Figure XX- 5 for irreversible control.)

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
426 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
426

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

to another, does not have to become accustomed to a new set of controls


and lose much valuable time in the learning process. The travel of pri-
to another, does not have to become accustomed to a new set of controls

and lose much valuable time in the learning process. The travel of pri-

mary control elements seems to be dependent to a great degree on the size


mary control elements seems to be dependent to a great degree on the size
Figure XX-12. Pulleys guiding and supporting control cables. Pulleys are also

used to change the angular direction of the cables.

of the aircraft. Stick travel at the grip may vary 18 inches fore and aft,

and 18 inches side to side, to somewhat smaller dimensions for the light

airplane. Angular travel of the control wheel from neutral may vary cor-

respondingly from 270 degrees to 90 degrees. The usual pedal travel

amounts to a total of 6 inches.

Adjustment in the controls, especially in the rudder controls, seems 'to

be preferred to fore and aft adjustment of the pilot's seat.

Irreversible Controls

In subsonic designs where the control forces caused by hinge moments

are not too severe, irreversible controls are used primarily for reducing

the chances of flutter. For higher-speed designs, especially those employ-

ing boost controls, irreversible controls are required.

Above Mach 0.8, effectiveness of the control surfaces drops off since

the upstream surfaces are no longer influenced by the control surface

deflections. However, the stick forces, and the hinge moments that

cause them, increase rapidly as the speed of the aircraft increases. Ir-

reversible power controls are therefore required for such craft. An

artificial feel corresponding to the actual pressures exerted is usually

introduced in such systems so that the pilot may also have some psycho-

logical response to the increased forces.

FIGURE XX-12. Pulleys guiding and supporting control cables. Pulleys are 11.lso
used to change the angular direction of the cahlcR.

of the aircraft. Stick travel at the grip may vary 18 inches fore alid aft,
and 18 inches side to side, to somewhat smaller dimensions for the light
airplane. Angular travel of the control wheel from nP.utral may vary cor-
respondingly from 270 degrees to 90 degrees. The usual pedal travel
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:27 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

amounts to a total of 6 inches.


Adjustment in the controls, especially in the rudder controls, seems ·to
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

be preferred to fore and aft adjustment of the pilot's seat.

Irreversible Controls
In subsonic designs where the control forces caused by hinge moments
are not too severe, irreversible controls are used primarily for reducing
the chances of flutter. For higher-speed designs, especially those employ-
ing boost controls, irreversible controls are required.
Above Mach 0.8, effectiveness of the control surfaces drops off since
the upstream surfaces are no longer influenced by the control surface
deflections. However, the stick forces, and the hinge moments that
cause them, increase rapidly as the speed of the aircraft increases. Ir-
reversible power controls are therefore required for such craft. An
artificial feel corresponding to the actual pressures exerted is usually
introduced in such systems so that the pilot may also have some psycho-
logical response to the increased forces.

Original from
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
CONTROL SYSTEMS 427
CONTROL SYSTEMS

427

DETAIL REQUIREMENTS
DETAIL REQUIREMENTS
Detail requirements specified for a design may be of interest.
Detail requirements specified for a design may be of interest.
Controls

1. A dual set of controls should be readily removable. All controls not

Controls
duplicated should be so located as to be conveniently accessible to the

co-pilot but no control should be so


1. A dual set of controls should be readily removable. All controls not
located as to constitute a hazard when

the front seat is occupied by a pas-


duplicated should be so located as to be conveniently acce~ible to the
senger. co-pilot but no control should be so
2. All control surfaces should be

located as to constitute a hazard when


adequately balanced.

3. Adequate controllable trimming


the front seat is occupied by a pas-
tabs should be fitted to the elevator
senger.
and rudder.

4. Ball- or roller-bearing hinges


2. All control surfaces should be
should be used throughout.
adequately balanced.
5. The rudder pedals should be ad-

3. Adequate controllable trimming


tabs should be fitted to the elevator
justable fore and aft.

6. The rudder pedals should con-

trol the differential action of the


and rudder.
brakes. (Note: The brake controls

preferably should be mounted on the


4. Ball- or roller-bearing hinges
rudder pedals and provided with ad-
should be used throughout.
ditional parking brake lock.)

5. The rudder pedals should be ad-


justable fore and aft.
7. A suitable parking brake ca-

pable of holding the plane against

maximum thrust should be provided. 6. The rudder pedals should con-


8. Full operation of high-lift de-

vices should not require an independ-


trol the differential action of the
ent readjustment of the trim control
brakes. (Note: The brake controls
for trim.

preferably should be mounted on the


rudder pedals and provided with ad-
9. Electric, hydraulic, or mechan-

ical operation of high-lift devices and

retractable landing gear, if provided, ditional parking brake lock.)


is required and full operation in either direction should not require more

7. A suitable parking brake ca-


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:27 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

than one minute.

Figure XX-13. A detail of the con-


pable of holding the plane against
maximum thrust should be provided.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

trol wheel: 1-2 elevator up cables; 3-4

elevator down cables; 5-6 aileron cables.

Engine Controls
8. Full operation of high-lift de-
1. Engine controls consist of all mechanisms exterior to the engine
vices should not require an independ-
required for controlling spark, throttle and mixture adjustments, as well

I ent readjustment of the trim c9ntrol


as cowling shutter controls, and the like.

for trim.
FIGURE XX-13. A detail of the con-
trol wheel: 1-2 elevator up cables; 3- 4 9. Electric, hydraulic, or mechan._
elevator down cables; 5-6 aileron cable:;;. ical operation of high-lift devices and
retractable landing gear, if provided,
is required and full operation in either direction should not require more
than one minute.

Engine Controls
1. Engine controls consist of all mechanisms exterior to the engine
required for controlling spark, throttle and mixture adjustments, as well
as cowling shutter controls, and the like.

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
428 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
428

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XX-14. Extruded components of a piano hinge (A); machined (B);

assembled (C). The bottom figures show the top view and cross section of such a hinge.

2. Engine controls should be placed at the left of the pilot's seat, except

for side-by-side seating of pilots, when they should be located between the

pilots' seats.

3. All engine controls should be marked plainly to show their function

and method of operation.

4. Throttle control and ignition switches should be easily accessible to

the pilot and so arranged as to afford a positive means of controlling all

engines separately or simultaneously.

5. A positive means for shutting off all ignition must be readily acces-
A c
sible to the pilot.

6. Throttle controls may be operated by an approved positive-action

cable or wire control system.

7. The controls should be positively operated and springs should not

be relied upon to actuate the controls in either direction. Push-and-pull

rods should be used wherever possible.

8. Engine controls should be so designed as to avoid the undoing of a

large number of bolts or unions to take the rods apart.

9. Ball-bearing supports should be provided wherever possible.

FIGURE XX-14. Extruded components of a piano hinge (A); machined (B);


10. Each control system should have one lever of adjustable length.

11. All rod lengths should be adjustable and stiff enough to take 70
assembled (C). The bottom figurm; ~how the top view and eroRs section of such a hinge.
pounds on the control handle without failure.

12. Adjustable stops should be provided.

2. Engine controls should be placed at the left of the pilot's seat, except
for side-by-side seating of pilots, when they should be located between the
pilots' seats.
3. All engine controls should be marked plainly to show their function
and method of operation.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:27 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

4. Throttle control and ignition switches should be easily accessible to


the pilot and so arranged as to afford a positive means of controlling all
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

engines separately or simultaneously.


5. A positive means for shutting off all ignition must be readily acces-
sible to the pilot.
6. Throttle controls may be operated by an approved positive-action
cable or wire control system.
7. The controls should be positively operated and springs should not
be relied upon to actuate the controls in either direction. Push-and-pull
rods should be used wherever possible.
8. Engine controls should be so designed as to avoid the undoing of a
large number of bolts or unions to take the rods apart.
9. Ball-bearing supports should be provided wherever possible.
10. Each control system should have one lever of adjustable length.
11. All rod lengths should be adjustable and stiff enough to take 70
pounds on the control handle without failure.
12. Adjustable stops should be provided.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
CONTROL SYSTEMS 429
CONTROL SYSTEMS

429

Figure XX-15. Piano hinge, unbalanced control surface.

ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS

By use of motors and suitable linkages, and mechanisms, the hydraulic

system may be completely replaced by an electrical system.

FwunE XX-15. Piano hinge, unbalanceJ control surface.

ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
By use of motors and suitable linkages, and mechanisms, the hydraulic
system may be completely replaced by an electrical system.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER XXI

The Fuselage

Even though comparatively little thought seems to have been given to

the size, shape, and structure of the fuselage up to now, it has been practi-

cally designed in most of its major elements while the pilot's cockpit, the

passenger cabin, the placement of the wing, and the balance diagram were

under consideration.

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS

For conventional designs, the fuselage and its contents usually represent

the largest concentration of mass items. Under acceleration, the relative


CHAPTER XXI
effect of loads due to inertia forces is therefore greatest on this structure.

Furthermore, the conventional fuselage is the connecting link for the

various appendages that transmit the aerodynamic and landing loads to

The Fuselage
it. Because of these loads of significant proportions, the structure must

be strong and efficiently designed.

The fuselage serves another important function: it represents the most

basic- part of the airplane, for it houses the crew, cargo, instrumentation,

etc. This serves to present problems in such important areas as heating,

ventilating, and air supply.

The fuselage design therefore requires the consideration of a great many

factors and the adaptation of many compromises. In arriving at a final

design, it is advisable to prepare a large number of detail designs before

the final compromise is accepted. Once a likely arrangement of struc-

Even though comparatively little thought seems to have been given to


the size, shape, and structure of the fuselage up to now, it has been practi-
tural members, openings, and attachments has been agreed upon, a more

detailed study of the component parts is possible.

WING-FUSELAGE CONSIDERATIONS cally designed in most of its major elements while the pilot's cockpit, the
In discussing various aspects of wing design, the matter of wing-fuselage

passenger cabin, the placement of the wing, and the balance diagram were
configurations was included in some detail, primarily from the standpoint

430
under consideration.

GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
For conventional designs, the fuselage and its contents usually represent
the largest concentration of mass items. Under acceleration, the relative
effect of loads due to inertia forces is therefore greatest on this structure.
Furthermore, the conventional fuselage is the connecting link for the
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

various appendages that transmit the aerodynamic and landing loads to


it. Because of these loads of significant proportions, the structure must
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

be strong and efficiently designed.


The fuselage serves another important function: it represents the most
basic- part of the airplane, for it houses the crew, cargo, instrumentation,
etc. This serves to present problems in such important areas as heating,
ventilating, and air supply.
The fuselage design therefore requires the consideration of a great many
factors and the adaptation of many compromises. In arriving at a final
design, it is advisable to prepare a large number of detail designs before
the final compromise is accepted. Once a likely arrangement of struc-
tural members, openings, and attachments has been agreed upon, a more
detailed study of the component parts is possible.

WING-FUSELAGE CONSIDERATIONS
In discussing various aspects of wing design, the matter of wing-fuselage
configurations was included in some detail, primarily from the standpoint
4-30

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE FUSELAGE 431
THE FUSELAGE

431

of the wing structure. However, the suggestions brought forth there


of the wing structure. However, the suggestions brought forth there

should be referred to again when considering the design of the fuselage.


should be referred to again when considering the design of the fuselage.
For airplane speeds of less than 350 miles per hour, the problem of
For airplane speeds of less than 350 miles per hour, the problem of
reducing the drag of wing-fuselage configurations has been met primarily

by careful streamlining. In general, a fuselage that by itself represents


reducing the drag of wing-fuselage configurations has been met primarily
a minimum drag form, when combined with the wing produces an optimum
by careful streamlining. In general, a fuselage that by itself represents
combination. Filleting at the juncture of the wing and the fuselage helps

a minimum drag form, when combined with the wing produces an optimum
to reduce the drag.

NACA TR 540 entitled "Interference of Wing and Fuselage" covers


combination. Filleting at the juncture of the wing and the fuselage helps
extensive wind-tunnel tests made on various wing and fuselage combina-
to reduce the drag.
tions. Parasol arrangements with round fuselages seemed to be best if

drag of supporting struts were neglected; otherwise, a slightly higher than


NACA TR 540 entitled "Interference of Wing and Fuselage" covers
midwing arrangement was next best; forward positions of the wing with
extensive wind-tunnel tests made on various wing and fuselage combina-
respect to the fuselage seemed favorable; low-wing positions are unfavor-

tions. Parasol arrangements with round fuselages seemed to be best if


drag of supporting struts were neglected; otherwise, a slightly higher than
able, except by means of adequate filleting. Efficient airfoils of moderate

thickness and low camber are most susceptible to adverse interference

effects.
midwing arrangement was next best; forward positions of the wing with
In general, acute angles included between the fuselage and attaching

wing or tail surfaces should be avoided.


respect to the fuselage seemed favorable; low-wing positions are unfavor-
When multi-engine designs are considered, care has to be taken that
able, except by means of adequate filleting. Efficient airfoils of moderate
the nacelle shape—particularly if it is long and of a cross section comparable

thickness and low camber are most susceptible to adverse interference


effects.
in magnitude to the fuselage cross section—does not cause interference

effects when the nacelle is placed too close to the fuselage or to another

nacelle. Wind-tunnel tests are necessary to determine the optimum


In general, acute angles included between the fuselage and attaching
configuration. The interference effects are manifested not only in a drag

that is higher than would be expected from consideration of the drag


wing or tail surfaces should be avoided.
characteristics of the individual components alone, but also in longitudinal
When multi-engine designs are considered, care has to be taken that
and directional stability problems.

the nacelle shape-particularly if it is long and of a cross section comparable


With transonic speeds, the problem of wing-fuselage integration becomes

more acute. For the large delta wing, the fuselage practically disappears
in magnitude to the fuselage cross section-does not cause interference
within the contour of the root airfoil and therefore presents no serious
effects when the nacelle is placed too close to the fuselage or to another
problem. For other designs, a more careful study must be made of the

spanwise cross-sectional area distribution along the longitudinal axis of


nacelle. Wind-tunnel tests are necessary to determine the optimum
the airplane according to what is known as the Whitcomb's Area Rule.
configuration. The interference effects are manifested not only in a drag
The method is illustrated in Figure XXI-1. The side and top views of a

that is higher than would be expected from consideration of the drag


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

proposed design are shown in the top two figures. The cross-sectional

areas normal to the line of flight are plotted against the longitudinal axis
characteristics of the individual components alone, but also in longitudinal
and directional stability problems.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of the airplane, as shown in the bottom figure. Curve ABCEF represents

the cross-sectional area of the fuselage and the tail surfaces. Curve BDE

is the cross-sectional area of the fuselage normal to the longitudinal axis


With transonic speeds, the problem of wing-fuselage integration becomes
of the airplane, plotted on top of the fuselage curve. An "ideal" com-
more acute. For the large delta wing, the fuselage practically disappears
posite curve, approximating that of a volume of revolution with good

within the contour of the root airfoil and therefore presents no serious
transonic (and speeds beyond) drag characteristics, is shown in curve

problem. For other designs, a more careful study must be made of the
spanwise cross-sectional area distribution along the longitudinal axis of
the airplane according to what is known as the Whitcomb's Area Rule.
The method is illustrated in Figure XXl-1. The side and top views of a
proposed design are shown in the top two figures. The cross-sectional
areas normal to the line of flight are plotted against the longitudinal axis
of the airplane, as shown in the bottom figure. Curve ABCEF represents
the cross-sectional area of the fuselage and the tail surfaces. Curve BDE
is the cross-sectional area of the fuselage normal to the longitudinal axis
of the airplane, plotted on top of the fuselage curve. An "ideal" com-
posite curve, approximating that of a volume of revolution with good
transonic (and speeds beyond) drag characteristics, is shown in curve

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
432 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
432

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XXI-1. Application of Whitcomb's Area Rule.

ACDG. The station where the pilot's cockpit would be located was taken

as the determining diameter. As a result of this "ideal" curve, for the

cross-sectional area distribution, it would be necessary to reduce the cross-

sectional area of the fuselage by the amount indicated by the cross-hatched

portion of the curve ABDCA, and to increase the cross-sectional area of

the rear portion of the fuselage as indicated by the cross-hatched portion

of curve DGFE.

Since the fuselage has to be reduced in cross-sectional area in the region

of the wing and power-plant nacelles, it is likely that for airplanes flying

A~~
at transonic or supersonic speeds and required to carry many passengers,

the fuselage may become very long in order to have the cargo and pas-

sengers ahead of the wing. To compensate for the large mass ahead of

the center of gravity, the power plant will be carried somewhat aft of the

center of gravity.

The student should study the latest NACA reports on this subject in

order to obtain a further insight into the basic aerodynamic problems

- - Original fuselage and tail


involved in the design. Design of high-speed aircraft today requires

-----Wing
careful integration of the aerodynamic, structural, and power plant
- - - Revised fuselage, wing, and tail
aspects.

SHAPE OF FUSELAGE
FIGURE XXl-1. Application of Whitcomb's Area Rule.
The length of the fuselage is determined by the cockpit and cabin con-

siderations in the front and the location of the tail surfaces and the tail

wheel at the rear; the over-all depth and width by cabin requirements.

ACDG. The station where the pilot's cockpit would be located was taken
as the determining diameter. As a result of this "ideal" curve, for the
cross-sectional area distribution, it would be necessary to reduce the cross-
sectional area of the fuselage by the amount indicated by the cross-hatched
portion of the curve ABDCA, and to increase the cross-sectional area of
the rear portion of the fuselage as indicated hy the cros.5-hatched portion
of curve DGFE.
Since the fuselage has to be reduced in cross-sectional area in the region
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

of the wing and power-plant nacelles, it is likely that for airplanes flying
at transonic or supersonic speeds and required to carry many passengers,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the fuselage may become very long in order to have the cargo and pas-
sengers ahead of the wing. To compensate for the large mass ahead of
the center of gravity, the power plant will he carried somewhat aft of the
center of gravity.
The student should study the latest N ACA reports on this subject in
order to obtain a further insight into the basic aerodynamic problems
involved in the design. Design of high-speed aircraft today requires
careful integration of the aerodynamic, structural, and power plant
aspects.

SHAPE OF FUSELAGE
The length of the fuselage is determined by the cockpit and cabin con-
siderations in the front and the location of the tail surfaces and the tail
wheel at the rear; t.he over-all depth and width by cabin requirements.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE FUSELAGE 433
THE FUSELAGE

433

For efficient structural design, a circular cross section is desired, but this

shape is inefficient for accommodating a rectangular cross section required

by the cabin so that the natural compromise is an oval, perhaps with greater

width at the top than at the bottom. Figure XXI-2 shows three basic

fuselage shapes.

The various cross sections of the fuselage may vary from a circular sec-

tion at the engine mount to an oval section and finally to a circle or a rec-

tangle at the tail post. It is, therefore, very important to fair one section

into another very carefully, and to avoid double curvatures (two curvatures

at an angle to each other) wherever possible. Circular cross section for


FIGURE XXI-2. Basic fuselage shapes.
F'or efficient structural design, a circular cross section is desired, but this
the fuselage offers theoretically greater strength for shell structures, but

the inscribed rectangle indicates the available useful space. Rectangular

cross section permits the most economical use of the space but is not suit-
shape is inefficient for accommodating a rectangular cross section required
able for shell structures. Oval or elliptical outline for the reinforced

by the cabin so that the natural compromise is an oval, perhaps with greater
width at the top than at the hottom. Figure XXI-2 shows three basic
monocoque or shell-type fuselage is the best compromise between the cir-

cular and rectangular cross section.

The fuselage structure is determined gradually, and often, when it is


fuselage shapes.
The various cross sections of the fuselage may vary from a circular sec-
not possible to compromise, radical changes in the wing planform or in

the interior arrangement may result. For example, it may be desirable

to have the front-spar double frame intersect the fuselage at the front tion at the engine mount to an oval section and finally to a circle or a rec-
cabin wall; but in order to do so, the wing has to be given an appreciable

sweepback in order to satisfy not only the particular condition just men-
tangle at the tail post. It is, therefore, very important to fair one section
tioned but also to obtain the proper location of the mean geometric chord
into another very carefully, and to avoid double curvatures (two curvatures
with respect to the center of gravity.

at an angle to each other) wherever possible. Circular cross section for


the fuselage offers theoretically greater strength for shell structures, but
Figure XXI-3. Cross sections of two fuselage shapes designed for large volume

capacity. The two intersecting circular shapes lend themselves to two compartments

without too great an increase in structural wieght. the inscribed rectangle indicates the available useful space. Rectangular
cross section permits the most economical use of the space but is not suit-
able for shell structures. Oval or elliptical outline for the reinforced
monocoque or shell-type fuselage is the best compromise between the cir-
cular and rectangular cross section.
The fuselage structure is determined gradually, and often, when it is
not possible to compromise, radical changes in the wing planform or in
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the interior arrangement may result. For example, it may be desirable


to have the front-spar double frame intersect the fuselage at the front
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

cabin wall; but in order to do so, the wing has to be given an appreciable
sweepback in order to satisfy not only the particular condition just men-
tioned but also to obtain the proper location of the mean geometric chord
with respect to the center of gravity.

FmuRE XXI-3. Cross sections of two fuselage shapes designed for large volume
capacity. The two intersecting circular shapes lend themselves to two compartments
without too great an increase in structural wieght.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
434 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
434

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Since all these items affect the sire and shape of the fuselage, it is obvious
Since all these items affect the size and shape of the fuselage, it is obvious

that the arrangement and general dimensions of the pilot's cockpit and
that the arrangement and general dimensions of the pilot's cockpit and
the passenger cabin are the primary considerations. Only after all this is the passenger cabin are the primary considerations. Only after all this is
done should the contours of the fuselage be settled. The cross sections of

done should the contours of the fuselage be settled. The cross sections of
the fuselage will vary from circular at the nose to slightly elliptical at the

pilot's cockpit, and then to an elliptical section somewhat modified by the


the fuselage will vary from circular at the nose to slightly elliptical at the
intersection of the root of the wing, and then to an elliptical or oval section,
pilot's cockpit, and then to an elliptical section somewhat modified by the
sometimes even rectangular (with the long side vertical) at the tail post.

The object of approaching the elliptical section is that it represents the


intersection of the root of the wing, and then to an elliptical or oval section,
best compromise between the square or rectangular section which is most
sometimes even rectangular (with the long side vertical) at the tail post.
efficient for space utilization (as cabins, cockpits, etc.) and the circular

The object of approaching the elliptical section is that it represents the


best compromise between the square or rectangular section which is most
section which is most efficient from a structural point of view for reinforced

monocoque structure, and for aerodynamic reasons.

If the fuselage is to be designed for a single-engine airplane, the type of efficient for space utilization (as cabins, cockpits, etc.) and the circular
engine and its cowling determine the nose treatment of the fuselage. The

pilot's cockpit governs the development of the windshield and that section
section which is most efficient from a structural point of view for reinforced
of the fuselage directly behind the engine. If there is no nose engine, as
monocoque structure, and for aerodynamic reasons.
in multi-engine designs, the pilot's cockpit has even a greater influence on

If the fuselage is to be designed for a single-engine airplane, the type of


engine and its cowling determine the nose treatment of the fuselage. The
the development of the front section of the fuselage.

The main section of the fuselage is built around the passenger cabin, and

then the rear portion of the fuselage is gradually tapered back to the tail pilot's cockpit governs the development of the windshield and that section
post.

Other considerations affecting fuselage shapes have been referred to


of the fuselage directly behind the engine. If there is no nose engine, as
under "Wing-Fuselage Considerations."
in multi-engine designs, the pilot's cockpit has even a greater influence on
For a preliminary approach, the student will find the following pro-
the development of the front section of the fuselage.
cedures useful in arriving at a reasonable solution.

1. Lay out the cockpit to scale, showing the important items to assure
The main section of the fuselage is built around the passenger cabin, and
that proper clearances have been provided. Since the relationship of the
then the rear portion of the fuselage is gradually tapered back to the tail
cockpit to the cabin may vary, it is helpful to draw the layout of the

post.
cockpit separately, so that it may readily be moved up or down or forward

or rearward, as the case may be, before being traced on the fuselage
Other considerations affecting fuselage shapes have been referred to
drawing.
under "Wing-Fuselage Considerations."
2. Lay out the cabin and cargo areas to scale so that the limiting interior

dimensions can be ascertained. This layout, too, should be a separate


For a preliminary approach, the student will find the following pro-
drawing.
cedures useful in arriving at a reasonable solution.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:28 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

3. Draw the root airfoil at the fuselage intersection as a separate draw-

ing, indicating the principal structural members which will subsequently

1. Lay out the cockpit to scale, showing the important items to assure
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

point out the location of the frames.

4. Draw the empennage, if there is one, as a separate drawing.


that proper clearances have been provided. Since the relationship of the
5. These separate drawings can now be assembled, by tracing, in a

final drawing of the fuselage interior, and an inboard profile can be ob-
cockpit to the cabin may vary, it is helpful to draw the layout of the
tained. If the immediate goal is to obtain the fuselage shape, many of
cockpit separately, so that it may readily be moved up or down or forward
or rearward, as the case may be, before being traced on the fuselage
drawing.
2. Lay out the cabin and cargo areas to scale so that the limiting interior
dimensions can be ascertained. This layout, too, should be a separate
drawing.
3. Draw the root airfoil at the fuselage intersection as a separate draw-
ing, indicating the principal structural members which will subsequently
point out the location of the frames.
4. Draw the empennage, if there is one, as a separate drawing.
5. These separate drawings can now be assembled, by tracing, in a
final drawing of the fuselage interior, and an inboard profile can be ob-
tained. If the immediate goal is to obtain the fuselage shape, many of

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE FUSELAGE 435
THE FUSELAGE

435

M
nn

I I
(a) (b)

Figure XXI-4. Rear fuselage cross sections just ahead of the tail surfaces often
c.:- -- -- ..:3
look like this. If the cross section in (A) is used, the horizontal and vertical tail surfaces

are more likely to be blanketed than if the cross section in (B) is used.

the interior arrangements may now be omitted, since the immediate

purpose was to determine the limiting interior dimensions.

FUSELAGE LENGTH

For subsonic airplanes having wings of aspect ratios between 6 and 14,

the ratio of fuselage length to wing span is from .60 to .70; for supersonic

airplanes having a wing aspect ratio varying from 2.5 to 4.5, the ratio of
(a) (b)
fuselage length to wing span becomes materially greater, not only because

of the shorter wing span but also because the fuselage must be longer.

FIGURE XXI-4. Rear fuselage cross sections just ahead of the tail surfaces often
In general, there is as much or more of the fuselage length ahead of the

look like this. If the cross section in (A) is used, the horizontal and vertical tail surfaces
wing as there is behind it, and ratio of fuselage length to wing span varies

are more likely to be blanketed than if the cross section in (B) is used.
from 1.2 to 2.5.

The optimum fineness ratio (length to maximum diameter) is 16, with

the volume of revolution such that both ends are pointed. However,

the interior arrangements may now be omitted, since the immediate


purpose was to determine the limiting interior dimensions.
"boat-tail" bodies are the practical compromises.

DETERMINING FUSELAGE LINES

The contour of a fuselage has to satisfy not only certain aerodynamic

minimums, but also production requirements. These vary with each

FUSELAGE LENGTH
design. In any case, the development of the fuselage lines entails the

establishment of second-degree curves. Various methods available for

determining fuselage lines are:

For subsonic airplanes having wings of aspect ratios between 6 and 14,
the ratio of fuselage length to wing span is from .60 to .70; for supersonic
1. The mockup, from which the lines may be transferred to suitable

templates. These pose problems in storing and handling but are never-

theless necessary, even in conjunction with other methods. airplanes having a wing aspect ratio varying from 2.5 to 4.5, the ratio of
2. Lofting of curves requiring full-size layouts on large metal sheets

painted a dull white. This method has been adopted from the marine
fuselage length to wing span becomes materially greater, not only because
field, where it is common practice to lay out the lines on a large lofting
of the shorter wing span but also because the fuselage must be longer.
In general, there is as much or more of the fuselage length ahead of the
wing as there is behind it, and ratio of fuselage length to wing span varies
from 1.2 to 2.5.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The optimum fineness ratio (length to maximum diameter) is 16, with


the volume of revolution such that both ends are pointed. However,
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

"boat-tail" bodies are the practical compromises.

DETERMINING FUSELAGE LINES


The contour of a fuselage has to satisfy not only certain aerodynamic
minimums, but also production requirements. These vary with each
design. In any case, the development of the fuselage lines entails the
establishment of second-degree curves. Various methods available for
determining fuselage lines are:
1. The mockup, from which the lines may be transferred to suitable
templates. These pose problems in storing and handling but are never-
theless necessary, even in conjunction with other methods.
2. Lofting of curves requiring full-size layouts on large r.1etal sheets
painted a dull white. This method has been adopted from the marine
field, where it is common practice to lay out the lines on a large lofting

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
436 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
436

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL floor. In this method, curves are laid in by long flexible splines and are
floor. In this method, curves are laid in by long flexible splines and are

faired by eye. To determine the agreement of curve sections, different


faired by eye. To determine the agreement of curve sections, different

angles through the body have to be taken to determine how well the
angles through the body have to be taken to determine how well the
curves faired; the method is long and tedious. Again, permanent records
curves faired; the method is long and tedious. Again, permanent records
require large steel plates which have to be filed.

3. Mathematical techniques have been developed to achieve a more


require large steel plates which have to be filed.
uniform and accurate result—one that is easily reproducible and where
3. Mathematical techniques have been developed to achieve a more
storage presents no problem. The second-degree curve technique based

uniform and accurate result-one that is easily reproducible and where


storage presents no problem. The second-degree curve technique based
on curves defined analytically by an equation of the form

Ax* + Bxy + Cy* + Dx + Ey + F = 0

is the one most often used. By properly assigning values to the con-
on curves defined analytically by an equation of the form
+ Bxy + Cy2 + Dx + +F
stants A, B, C, D, E, and F, any useful curve can be defined.

USE OF THE MOCKUP


Ax2 Ey = 0
Since it is difficult to visualize a structure as complex as the fuselage

and the arrangement of its interior, it is customary to build a full-scale


is the one most often used. By properly assigning values to the con-
mockup, usually made of materials at hand that require little fabrication.

In such a mockup the transverse rings may be represented by plywood


stants A, B, C, D, E, and F, any useful curve can be defined.
forms that may be easily sawn to shape and to which attachments may be

easily nailed, bolted, or screwed.

The covering may be represented by thin plywood sheets or even heavy

cardboard. Where double curvatures exist, thin sheet metal, properly

formed, may be inserted. Seats, equipment, instrumentation, and such


USE OF THE MOCKUP
may be represented by the actual prototypes or reasonable facsimiles.

The mockup can be used to determine external line, even if a more


Since it is difficult to visualize a structure as complex as the fuselage
analytical approach may have been used in determining the lines of the
and the arrangement of its interior, it is customary to build a full-scale
fuselage, since some solutions are arrived at only by trial and error methods.

By building a mockup, a fuselage form may be evolved which may use


mockup, usually made of materials at hand that require little fabrication.
flat sheet material without resorting to double curvatures, and so help in
In such a mockup the transverse rings may be represented by plywood
materially reducing the production costs. If the covering has a curvature

forms that may be easily sawn to shape and to which attachments may be
in one direction only, a flat sheet may be used. If, however, there is a

curvature at an angle to the main radius of curvature, the covering has


easily nailed, bolted, or screwed.
what is known as a double curvature which must be produced by forming
The covering may be represented by thin plywood sheets or even heavy
the sheet either by gradual "bumping" or by hydraulic presses over special

dies.
cardboard. Where double curvatures exist, thin sheet metal, properly
The mockup also helps to indicate whether any other modifications in
formed, may be inserted. Seats, equipment, instrumentation, and such
may be represented by the actual prototypes or reasonable facsimiles.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

arrangements are desirable. This method is a simple and inexpensive way

The mockup can be used to determine external line, even if a more


to solve many problems usually too intricate for the drafting board, and it
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

also helps to visualize a design far better than a series of drawings could

possibly do.
analytical approach may have been used in determining the lines of the
fuselage, since some solutions are arrived at only by trial and error methods.
By building a mockup, a fuselage form may be evolved which may use
flat sheet material without resorting to double curvatures, and so help in
materially reducing the production costs. If the covering has a curvature
in one direction only, a flat sheet may be used. If, however, there is a.
curvature at an angle to the main radius of curvature, the covering has
what is known as a double curvature which must be produced by forming
the sheet either by gradual "bumping" or by hydraulic presses over special
dies.
The mockup also helps to indicate whether any other modifications in
arrangements are desirable. This method is a simple and inexpensive way
to solve many problems usually too intricate for the drafting board, and it
also helps to visualize a design far better than a series of drawings could
possibly do.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE FUSELAGE 437
Figure XXI-5. The fuselage structure, consisting of the skin and longitudinal

stringers, has to withstand the bending moment caused by the inertia and tail loads.

The above diagram illustrates the bending moment distribution for a fuselage to which

a two-spar wing is attached. To best sustain the bending moment, the fuselage, con-

sidered as a beam, has to be deep with bending elements as far away from the neutral

axis as practicable.

ANALYTICAL STUDIES OF FUSELAGE STRUCTURE

Assuming, then, that the outside contour has been definitely established,

the next step is to locate the structure. Wherever concentrated loads

have to be transmitted to the fuselage (as from the wing spars, or landing

gear members, or tail surface spars), a double or reinforced frame has to be

located. For example, there would be double frames at the front and rear

spar locations of the wing. Between these double frames, single frames

would be located. The spacing of these frames may be governed by the

window locations. How often do the front spar frames intersect a window
FIGURE XXl-5. The fuselage structure, consisting of the skin and longitudinal
which has been painstakingly placed so as to give the passenger the
stringers, has to withstand the bending moment caused by the inertia and tail loads.
proper vision! It is generally not desirable to break or distort these main

The above diagram illustrates the bending moment distribution for a fuselage to which
frames just to accommodate a window. In such a case the difficulty

a two-spar wing is attached. To best sustain the bending moment, the fuselage, con-
may be adjusted by relocating the window, or relocating the spar so that

sidered as a beam, has to ht> dt>ep with lwnding elements as far away from the neutral
the frames may be changed.

axis as practicable.
Naturally there will be frames at each side of the door, for such frames

will provide convenient hinge supports as well as door frame supports.

The front and rear cabin wall will determine another station where frames

should be located to provide anchorage for the cabin. Such considerations

gradually "build up" the structure until a few intermediate frames are
ANALYTICAL STUDIES OF FUSELAGE STRUCTURE
added just to cut down the unsupported length between frames. Similar
Assuming, then, that the outside contour has been definitely established,
considerations determine the location of the longitudinal members.

Some insight may be gained into the desirable sheet, stringer, and
the next step is to locate the structure. Wherever concentrated loads
frame-spacing combinations by investigating, for bending stresses, a
have to be transmitted to the fuselage (as from the wing spars, or landing
fuselage section close to the rear wing spar or shear web. The approxi-

gear members, or tail surface spars), a double or reinforced frame has to be


located. For example, there would be double frames at the front and rear
mate bending moment at this station could be found from previously-

determined tail load and from the inertia loads of the structure and items

of equipment that the tail portion of the fuselage contains.


spar locations of the wing. Between these double frames, single frames
would be located. The spacing of these frames may be governed by the
window locations. How often do the front spar frames intersect a window
which has been painstakingly placed so as to give the passenger the
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:29 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

proper vision! It is generally not desirable to break or distort these main


frames just to accommodate a window. In such a case the difficulty
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

may be adjusted by relocating the window, or relocating the spar so that


the frames may be changed.
Naturally there will be frames at each side of the door, for such frames
will provide convenient hinge supports as well as door frame supports.
The front and rear cabin wall will determine another station where frames
should be located to provide anchorage for the cabin. Such considerations
gradually "build up" the structure until a few intermediate frames are
added just to cut down the unsupported length between frames. Similar
considerations determine the location of the longitudinal members.
Some insight may be gained into the desirable sheet, stringer, and
frame-spacing combinations by investigating, for bending stresses, a
fuselage section close to the rear wing spar or shear web. The approxi-
mate bending moment at this station could be found from previously-
determined tail load and from the inertia loads of the structure and items
of equipment that the tail portion of the fuselage contains.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
438 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
438

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL The investigation may be carried out in the following steps:
The investigation may be carried out in the following steps:

1. Select one or more longitudinal stringer sections that are considered


1. Select one or more longitudinal stringer sections that are considered

to have good crushing-strength characteristics. A closed section may be


to have good crushing-streng_th characteristics. A closed section may be
desirable at times, but production considerations may make an open
desirable at times, but production considerations may make an open
section more fitting.

2. Determine the bending stresses for a number of combinations of skin


section more fitting.
thicknesses, frame spacings (which determine stringer column lengths), and
2. Determine the bending stresses for a number of combinations of skin
stringer spacings. Reject any combinations for which the applied stress

thicknesses, frame spacings (which determine stringer column lengths), and


exceeds the allowable stress.

3. Compare the weights of the various combinations investigated.


stringer spacings. Reject any combinations for which the applied stress
4. Check the more promising combinations for stresses imposed by the
exceeds the allowable stress.
transverse shear and torsion.

Such studies can result in optimum designs for the combinations chosen.
3. Compare the weights of the various combinations investigated.
They would have to be modified by other considerations in the most highly-
4. Check the more promising combinations for stresses imposed by the
used section of the fuselage, where cut-outs, floors, equipment, cargo, and

transverse shear and torsion.


the like impose other problems.

The main portion of the fuselage structure, aside from the frames just
Such studies can result in optimum designs for the combinations chosen.
discussed, is the skin and supporting longitudinal structure. Much de-
They would have to be modified by other considerations in the most highly-
pends upon the proper proportioning of the frames and stringers.

For example, if the fuselage is without any reinforcement longitudinally,


used section of the fuselage, where cut-outs, floors, equipment, cargo, and
the wall thickness of the shell would have to be considerably greater to
the like impose other problems.
avoid local buckling. Such a fuselage structure could be employed with

The main portion of the fuselage structure, aside from the frames just
discussed, is the skin and supporting longitudinal structure. Much de-
profit for small, light airplanes where the thickness, originally determined

by maintenance considerations, would be strong enough.

If the skin is partially reinforced longitudinally by a few members, the


pends upon the proper proportioning of the frames and stringers.
skin contributes little to the strength of the fuselage.

When enough longitudinal members are used, the skin will add mate-
For example, if the fuselage is without any reinforcement longitudinally,
rially to the bending strength. Proper balance between stringers and skin
the wall thickness of the shell would have to be considerably greater to
will provide the best combination from a strength-weight ratio.

a.void local buckling. Such a. fuselage structure could be employed with


profit for small, light airplanes where the thickness, originally determined
Instead of stringers, corrugated sheet covered with flat sheet will give a

very rigid structure but, unfortunately, somewhat unsuitable where double

curvatures are required. by maintenance considerations, would be strong enough.


A unique form of construction is the so-called geodetic structure which,

essentially, employs stringers that wind around the fuselage contour.


If the skin is partially reinforced longitudinally by a few members, the
Figure XXI-6. The fuselage structure may "sit" on top of the wing structure with
skin contributes little to the strength of the fuselage.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:31 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

connections at the wing spars (see chapter on Design of the Wing). The leading and

When enough longitudinal members are used, the skin will add mate-
rially to the bending strength. Proper balance between stringers and skin
trailing edge portions of the wing are discontinued at the side of the fuselage.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

will provide the best combination from a strength-weight ratio.


Instead of stringers, corrugated sheet covered with flat sheet will give a
very rigid structure but, unfortunately, somewhat unsuitable where double
curvatures are required.
A unique form of construction is the so-called geodetic structure which,
essentially, employs stringers that wind around the fuselage contour.

---..."' -----
-;..'T'-..-..;;;.;~~.... ~::.:::: - ---
FIGURE XXI- 6. The fuselage structure may " sit" on top of the wing structure with
connections at the wing apara (see chapter on Design of the Wing). The leading and
trailing edge portions of the wing are discontinued at the side of the fuselage .

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
THE FUSELAGE 439
THE FUSELAGE

439

Figure XXI-7. Longitudinal stringers may be omitted at the bow or nose section

of a fuselage since the curvature of the skin enhances the pressure-supporting ability of

the structure. Simple frames, such as shown above, are sufficient to maintain the

cylindrical shape. Similarly, in the tail section of the fuselage, the longitudinal stringers

may be omitted so that rigidity is obtained through the curved skin and the transverse

frames.

Figure XXI-8. Where transverse frames allow the longitudinal stringers by suitable

cut-outs, additional rigidity may be obtained by small brackets riveted to both the

stringer and the frame. A frame like the one above may support brackets or attachment

fittings for control systems, electrical conducts, and other light equipment.

FIGURE XXI-7. Longitudinal stringers may be omitted at the bow or nose section
of a fuselage since the curvature of the skin enhances the pressure-supporting ability of
the structure. Simple frames, such as shown above, are sufficient to maintain the
cylindrical shape. Similarly, in the tail section of the fuselage, the longitudinal stringers
may be omitted 110 that rigidity ill obt.ained through the curved 11kin and the tranRverse
frames.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:31 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XXl-8. Where transverse frames allow the longitudinal stringers by suitable
cut-outs, additional rigidity may be obtained by small brackets riveted to both the
stringer and the frame . A frame like the one above may support brackets or attachment
fittings for control systems, electrical conducts, and other light equipment.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
440 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
440

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

FRAMES AND THEIR LOCATION

Just as for the ribs in the wing structure, the primary functions of the

transverse fuselage frames are (1) to maintain the shape of the fuselage,

(2) to sustain concentrated loads imposed, (3) to serve as attachments for

equipment, flooring, and the like, and (4) to transmit the loads to ad-

jacent structural members. The frames may therefore be roughly classi-

fied into three categories:

1. The frames which serve merely to maintain the shape of the fuselage.

These will not be subjected to stress unless distortion of the entire ad-

jacent structure has taken place. They are often just one gauge thinner

than the metal sheet covering, and the developed width of the frame,

formed out of sheet material, varies from 2 to 4 inches for aircraft weighing

from 2000 pounds to 50,000 pounds. It should be realized that in addi-

tion to the developed width, the other variable available is the thickness of

the sheet from which the frame is fashioned. For purposes of later

identification, these forms will be referred to as simple frames.

2. The frames which serve to act as anchorage for medium-weight

equipment, control systems, and the like. These are similar to the simple,

single-member, transverse frame, but must be reinforced locally to carry

the load and reduce deflections to a minimum. Such frames are subjected

to severe loads only locally and therefore may differ little from the simple

frames. Additional brackets may have to be introduced and tied in with

FIGURE XXl-IJ. Transven1e frames may be made more rigid through the use of
flanged or lipped lightening holes. These holes may he few in number if passage for
control lines, rlcctrical wiring, or special conduits is d<'sircd.

FRAMES AND THEIR LOCATION


Just as for the ribs in the wing structure, the primary functions of the
transverse fuselage frames are (1) to maintain the shape of the fuselage,
(2) to sustain concentrated loads imposed, (3) to serve as attachments for
equipment, flooring, and the like, and (4) to transmit the loads to ad-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

jacent structural members. The frames may therefore be roughly classi-


fied into three categories:
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

1. The frames which serve merely to maintain the shape of the fuselage.
These will not be subjected to stress unless distortion of the entire ad-
jacent structure has taken place. They are often just one gauge thinner
than the metal sheet covering, and the developed width of the frame,
formed out of sheet material, varies from 2 to 4 inches for aircraft weighing
from 2000 poundH to 50,000 pounds. It should be realized that in addi-
tion to the developed width, the other variable available is the thickness of
the sheet from which the frame is fashioned. For purposes of later
identification, these forms will be referred to as simple fram€s.
2. The frames which serve to act as anchorage for medium-weight
equipment, control systems, and the like. These are similar to the simple,
single-member, transverse frame, but must be reinforced locally to carry
the load and reduce deflections to a minimum. Such frames are subjected
to severe loads only locally and therefore may differ little from the simple
frames. Additional brackets may have to be introduced and tied in with

Original from
Dig iz UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
THE FUSELAGE 441
THE FUSELAGE

441

Figure XXI-10. Transverse frames located where additional rigidity is desired or

where the depth of the fuselage is comparatively large may add to the rigidity of the

fuselage either by the larger depth of the frame ring around its entire circumference or

by the added depth of the bottom half of the frame as shown in the sketch above.

Figure XXI-11. Certain frames may be modified to incorporate a beam for the

support of flooring or as a continuation of the wing spar. In the latter case, two frames

may be placed back to back, as the cross section indicates. If the flooring alone is to

be supported, one frame may suffice. Longitudinal stringers may pass through the

frame and be tied into the frame structure more securely by special brackets.

~'muRE XXI- 10. Transverse frames located where additional rigidity is desired or
where the depth of the fuselage is comparatively large may add to the rigidity of the
fuselage either by the larger depth of the frame ring around its entire circumference or
by the added depth of the bottom half of the framP as shown in the Rkckh above.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

___ .,
r----- F!o======;n=~~:;====::;;:;====~~==;r:r===~---- :
'
I
IL.. ____ _
I
I
I
--- --· '

FIGURE XXl-11. Certain frames may be modified to incorporate a beam for the
support of flooring or as a continuation of the wing spar. In the latter case, two frames
may be placed back to back, as the cross section indicates. If the flooring alone is to
be supported, one frame may suffice. Longitudinal stringers may pass through the
frame and be tied into the frame structure more securely by special brackets.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
442 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
442

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XXI-12. In order to make the spanwise stringers of the wing effective, such

stringers would have to tie into the frame structure of the fuselage either through

separate fittings or through the aid of local reinforcements or gusset plates. The span-

wise stringers, furthermore, could be riveted or bolted to the longitudinal stringers of the

fuselage through intermediate gusset plates or fittings. Only the spars, not the stringers

of the wing structure, would pass through from one side of the fuselage to the other.

the longitudinal stringers as well as the frames. For purposes of later

identification, these will be referred to as intermediate frames.

3. The primary frames, to which large external loads are supplied

through the landing gear, power plant, or wing structure. These are

usually two in number, spaced a small distance apart, and designed so as

to take fittings to serve as carry-through members and, in short, act as

the main transverse load carrying members. For purposes of later


FIGURE XXl-12. In order to make the spanwise stringers of the wing effective, such
identification, these will be referred to as main frames.
stringers would have to tie into the frame structure of the fuselage either through
Figures XXI-7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 show some sketches of typical

separate fittings or through the aid of local reinforcements or gusset plates. The span-
frames serving different functions.

wise stringers, furthermore, could be riveted or bolted to the longitudinal stringers of the
Figure XXI-13. For a two-spar wing, the spars could pass through the fuselage and

fuselage through intermediate gusset plates or fittings. Only the spars, not the stringers
be supported by two transverse frames, back to back. The spars may be at an angle

of the wing structure, would pass through from one side of the fuselage to the other.
to the perpendicular to the wing chord if the inclination will permit the frames to clear

the windshield of the cockpit or cabin. The wing profile and the structure other than

the two spars stop at the side of the fuselage.

the longitudinal stringers as well as the frames. For purposes of later


identification, these will be referred to as intermediate frames.
3. The primary frames, to which large external loads are supplied
through the landing gear, power plant, or wing structure. These are
usually two in number, spaced a small distance apart, and designed so as
to take fittings to serve as carry-through members and, in short, act a.s
the main transverse load carrying members. For purposes of later
identification, these will be referred to as mainframes.
Figures XXI-7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 show some sketches of typical
frames serving different functions.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

--
FIGURE XXI- 13. For a two-spar wing, the spars could pass through the fuselage and
be supported by two transverse frames, back to back. The spars may be at an angle
to the perpendicular to the wing chord if the inclination will permit the frames to clear
the windshield of the cockpit or cabin. The wing profile and the structure other than
the two spars stop at the side of the fuselage.

Original from
D I IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
THE FUSELAGE 443
THE FUSELAGE

443

Figure XXI-14. The transverse frames of the fuselage are perpendicular to the

longitudinal axis of the airplane even though the spars are at an angle to that axis.

The frames, whether circular rings or reinforced frames, are located

from 10 to 24 inches apart with the closer spacing near the cabin and cock-

pit and gradually increasing towards the tail post.

The frames may rest on the longitudinal members or on the outside

covering with cutouts for the longitudinal members.

Reinforced frames are located wherever concentrated loads are applied

as at attachment of wing spars or landing-gear members. In order to

reduce structural weight, it is decidedly advisable to locate several external

attachment points on the same frame wherever possible.

In general, the locating of frames will be determined first by the location

of spars, landing gear, doors, and windows. Reinforced frames are re-

quired at every one of these locations of external attachments in order to

distribute the loads into the metal covering evenly. After these reinforced

frames have been placed, the intermediate frames can be placed at proper

intervals.

Reinforced frames may be similar to intermediate frames in construction

except for the thicker material or local reinforcements; or they may be two

frames, back to back, but spaced a few inches apart, with tying members
FIGURE XXI-14. The transverse frames of the fuselage are perpendicular to the
between them to obtain rigidity and continuity of structure.
longitudinal axis of the airplane even though the spars are at an angle to that axis.
The spacing of the simple and intermediate frames is dependent to some

extent on (1) tin-canning of the sheet covering, (2) the allowable shear

stresses of the covering, and (3) the allowable column compressive stress

of the longitudinal stringers and adjacent effective widths of the covering.

The discussion on selecting panel dimensions in an earlier chapter should


The frames, whether circular rings or reinforced frames, are located
be referred to. from 10 to 24 inches apart with the closer spacing near the cabin and cock-
pit and gradually increasing towards the tail post.
The frames may rest on the longitudinal members or on the outside
covering with cutouts for the longitudinal members.
Reinforced frames are located wherever concentrated loads are applied
as at attachment of wing spars or landing-gear members. In order to
reduce structural weight, it is decidedly advisable to locate several external
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

attachment points on the same frame wherever possible.


In general, the locating of frames will be determined first by the location
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

of spars, landing gear, doors, and windows. Reinforced frames are re-
quired at every one of these locations of external attachments in order to
distribute the loads into the metal covering evenly. After these reinforced
frames have been placed, the intermediate frames can be placed at proper
intervals.
Reinforced frames may be similar to intermediate frames in construction
except for the thicker material or local reinforcements; or they may be two
frames, back to back, but spaced a few inches apart, with tying members
between them to obtain rigidity and continuity of structure.
The spacing of the simple and intermediate frames is dependent to some
extent on (1) tin-canning of the sheet covering, (2) the allowable shear
stresses of the covering, and (3) the allowable column compressive stress
of the longitudinal stringers and adjacent effective widths of the covering.
The discussion on selecting panel dimensions in an earlier chapter should
be referred to.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
444 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
444

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XXI-15. Main frames, to which external loads and bending moments are

applied, have transverse shear, axial load, and bending moment varying in intensity all

along the centerline of the frame. The representation above illustrates the mathe-

matical approach to the solution of the stresses in the indeterminate frame. Because

these frames have to withstand severe stresses, their construction is somewhat different

from the non-load-carrying frames.

The main frames are subjected to a variety of concentrated loads and

require a stress analysis for the determination of dimensions. Figure

XXI-15 illustrates the stress-analysis problem that is involved. It will

be noted that the frame is subjected to shear, axial load, and bending

moments, making it necessary to provide an adequate structure for these

conditions.

LONGITUDINAL STRINGERS AND THEIR LOCATION

Since the fuselage is essentially a beam, the longitudinal stringers serve

an important function in that they, along with the effective width of sheet

covering, are the main bending elements of the structure.

For small aircraft of gross weights of about 2500 pounds or less and
FIGURE XXl-15. Main frames, to which external loads and bending moments are
fuselage depths of less than 48 inches, relatively few stringers are neces-
applied, have transverse shear, axial load, and bending moment varying in intensity all
sary, since the minimum thickness of sheet—0.025 inches—selected for
along the centerline of the frame. The representation above illustrates the mathe-
handling and maintenance reasons, usually contributes markedly to the

matical approach to the solution of the stresses in the indeterminate frame. Because
bending strength. The curvature of the sheet adds to the allowable

these frames have to withstand severe stresses, their construction is somewhat different
compressive strength of the sheet as well.

from the non-load-carrying frames.


The cross sections of the longitudinal stringers are the same as for the

wing.

The stringer spacing is determined by the number required for the

loads imposed. An analytical approach is possible to determine the light-

est combination of stringer-sheet combination.

The main frames are subjected to a variety of concentrated loads and


require a stress analysis for the determination of dimensions. Figure
XXI-15 illustrates the stress-analysis problem that is involved. It will
be noted that the frame is subjected to shear, axial load, and bending
moments, making it necessary to provide an adequate structure for these
conditions.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

LONGITUDINAL STRINGERS AND THEIR LOCATION


Since the fuselage is essentially a beam, the longitudinal stringers serve
an important function in that they, along with the effective width of sheet
covering, are the main bending elements of the structure.
For small aircraft of gross weights of about 2500 pounds or less and
fuselage depths of less than 48 inches, relatively few stringers are neces-
sary, since the minimum thickness of sheet-0.025 inches-selected for
handling and maintenance reasons, usually contributes markedly to the
bending strength. The curvature of the sheet adds to the allowable
compressive strength of the sheet as well.
The cross sections of the longitudinal stringers are the same as for the
wmg.
The stringer spacing is determined by the number required for the
loads imposed. An analytical approach is possible to determine the light-
est combination of stringer-sheet combination.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE FUSELAGE 445
THE FUSELAGE

445

Figure XXI-16. Figure (A) shows a partially reinforced monocoque construction

where the skin contributes little to the strength. Figure (B) shows a pure monocoque

structure where the skin is made sufficiently thick to avoid local buckling.

Since the fuselage shape is not likely to be very regular, the spacing

from frame to frame is apt to vary. A pattern of stringer spacing when

projected upon the plane for symmetry may show parallel lines. Further

examination, however, may show that the longitudinal stringers have to

be twisted about their longitudinal axis to achieve such a pattern. It

might therefore be better to obtain a location at which the stringers would

Figure XXI-17. Figure (A) shows an increase in longitudinal stiffening members


A 8
so that the skin is amply supported and contributes materially to the fuselage strength.

The longitudinal members have been replaced by corrugated sheet, as shown in Figure

(B), to form a very rigid structure but causing difficulties in production.

FIGURE XXl-16. Figure (A) shows a partially reinforced monocoque construction


whero the skin contributes little to the strength. Figure (B) shows a pure monocoque
structure where the skin is made sufficiently thick to avoid local buckling.

Since the fuselage shape is not likely to be very regular, the spacing
from frame to frame is apt to vary. A pattern of stringer spacing when
projected upon the plane for symmetry may show parallel lines. Further
examination, however, may show that the longitudinal stringers have to
be twisted about their longitudinal axis to achieve such a pattern. It
might therefore be better to obtain a location at which the stringers would
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:35 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XXl-17. Figure (A) shows a.n increase in lon~itndina.l stiffening members
so that the skin is amply supported and contributes materially to the fuselage strength.
The longitudinal members have been replaced by corrugated sheet, as shown in Figure
(B), to form a very rigid structure but ca.using difficulties in production.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
446 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
446

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


have little twist but would follow a faired line. Another method would
have little twist but would follow a faired line. Another method would

be to use proportional distances for the spacing from frame to frame—i.e.,


be to use proportional distances for the spacing from frame to frame--i.e.,
the larger spacing at the largest cross section—and to reduce the spacing
the larger spacing at the largest cross section-and to reduce the spacing
for the smaller cross sections in proportion to the radius.

for the smaller cross sections in proportion to the radius.


Since openings have to be reinforced along the edges, it is desirable to
Since openings have to be reinforced along the edges, it is desirable to

have the top and bottom of all frames for such openings rest on longi-

tudinal stringers. It is customary to spot in these stringers first* in order have the top and bottom of all frames for such openings rest on longi-
to avoid unnecessarily close spacings, should the desired stringer spacing

tudinal stringers. It is customary to spot in these stringers first, in order


and the required stringer spacings not coincide.

Longitudinal members are spaced from 6 to 12 inches apart around the


to avoid unnecessarily close spacings, should the desired stringer spacing
periphery of the largest cross section. Since the cross sections gradually
and the required stringer spacings not coincide.
diminish in size, the spacing is closer towards the tail post so that alternate

members may be stopped at a forward frame. It is desirable not to end


Longitudinal members are spaced from 6 to 12 inches apart around the
all longitudinal members at the same frame.
periphery of the largest cross section. Since the cross sections gradually
To assure a continuous structure, it is customary to make the longitu-

diminish in size, the spacing is closer towards the tail post so that alternate
members may be stopped at a forward frame. It is desirable not to end
dinal members continuous rather than breaking them at every frame.

Since the nose of the fuselage is not heavily subjected to bending mo-

ments, some of the longitudinal stringers may be discontinued in that all longitudinal members at the same frame.
section by ending a few stringers at each frame starting at a frame for-

To assure a continuous structure, it is customary to make the longitu-


ward of the front spar.

The same procedure would be in order in the rear portion of the fuselage,
dinal members continuous rather than breaking them at every frame.
where the bending moments are less severe and where the available circum-
Since the nose of the fuselage is not heavily subjected to bending mo-
ferential space is likely to be very limited.

In general, since the stringers are the main bending elements, they
ments, some of the longitudinal stringers may be discontinued in that
should be continuous and therefore pass through the transverse frames.
section by ending a few stringers at each frame starting at a frame for-
Where local stresses are likely to be high, brackets tying the frames and

ward of the front spar.


stringers together are added for greater rigidity and load-carrying capa-

bilities.
The same procedure would be in order in the rear portion of the fuselage,
FUSELAGE SKIN where the bending moments are less severe and where the available circum-
The gauge of metal sheet used for the fuselage will vary according to

ferential space is likely to be very limited.


the region of application. The normal pressures likely to be encountered

are not apt to be too critical. Where the structure is more or less normal
In general, since the stringers are the main bending elements, they
to the line of flight, such as the windshield and fuselage nose, the posi-
should be continuous and therefore pass through the transverse frames.
tive pressures, even at 800 miles an hour, may be of the order of 350 to

600 pounds per square inch; whereas curved surfaces along the top
Where local stresses are likely to be high, brackets tying the frames and
stringers together are added for greater rigidity and load-carrying capa-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:36 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

bottom, or sides of the fuselage may have normal negative pressures vary-

ing from 60 to 300 pounds per square inch. At lower speeds, the pres-

bilities.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

sures may be assumed to vary as the square of the speed. Obviously,

in the region of high pressures, the skin thickness will have to be relatively

greater in order to avoid tin-canning of the surface.

FUSELAGE SKIN

The gauge of metal sheet used for the fuselage will vary according to
the region of application. The normal pressures likely to be encountered
are not apt to be too critical. Where the structure is more or less normal
to the line of flight, such as the windshield and fuselage nose, the posi-
tive pressures, even at 800 miles an hour, may be of the order of 350 to
600 pounds per square inch; whereas curved surfaces along the top
bottom, or sides of the fuselage may have normal negative pressures vary-
ing from 60 to 300 pounds per square inch. At lower speeds, the pres-
sures may be assumed to vary as the square of the speed. Obviously,
in the region of high pressures, the skin thickness will have to be relatively
greater in order to avoid tin-canning of the surface.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE FUSELAGE 447
THE FUSELAGE

447
In the region of propeller-tip passage, as in multi-engine designs, the
In the region of propeller-tip passage, as in multi-engine designs, the

skin thickness is often increased to reduce the noise caused by drumming


and to avoid fatigue failures resulting from the induced vibration.
skin thickness is often increased to reduce the noise caused by drumming

and to avoid fatigue failures resulting from the induced vibration.

In areas where rough handling is likely to occur (e.g., around doors and
In areas where rough handling is likely to occur (e.g., around doors and
cargo compartments), again, a heavier gauge is probably necessary.

The smallest gauge of aluminum alloy sheet or aluminum-coated


cargo compartments), again, a heavier gauge is probably necessary.
aluminum alloy sheet is 0.025 inches, since a thinner sheet is easily punc-
The smallest gauge of aluminum alloy sheet or aluminum-coated
tured and is rather hard to handle. For airplanes of less than 10,000

aluminum alloy sheet is 0.025 inches, since a thinner sheet is easily punc-
tured and is rather hard to handle. For airplanes of less than 10,000
pounds gross weight, the predominant gauge thicknesses are 0.025 and

0.032 inches. For heavier aircraft, the thicknesses are proportionately

greater. pounds gross weight, the predominant gauge thicknesses are 0.025 and
In regions such as jet exhausts, where excessive heat is likely to be en-

0.032 inches. For heavier aircraft, the thicknesses are proportionately


countered, nickel steel or titanium alloys replace the aluminum alloy sheet.

WINDOWS
greater.
Since windows are not considered part of the primary structure, they
In regions such as jet exhausts, where excessive heat is likely to be en-
are not designed to serve as carry-through members for the transmission

of stresses in the primary structure. Therefore they are carried by a


countered, nickel steel or titanium alloys replace the aluminum aJloy sheet.
rigid frame, which must bear the stresses around the cut-outs caused

by the windows.

The normal pressures are likely to be high for the material used, espe-

cially for pressurized cabins. A differential pressure of 8.15 pounds per


WINDOWS
square inch at an altitude of 20,000 feet is a common design value.

For generous vision, the proportions of the window should be reason-


Since windows are not considered part of the primary structure, they
ably large. However, since windows have been known to fail in flight,
are not designed to serve as carry-through members for the transmission
there is a tendency to make the openings smaller. In this way, in case

of stresses in the primary structure. Therefore they are carried by a


rigid frame, which must bear the stresses around the cut-outs caused
of failure resulting in explosive decompression, a passenger seated next

to the window would not be blown out.

For additional safety, window materials are shatterproof and windows hy the windows.
for pressurized cabins are three layers thick, with each layer constructed

The normal pressures are likely to be high for the material used, espe-
of two or more plies.

The student should also refer to Chapter XII, The Passenger Cabin.
cially for pressurized cabins. A differential pressure of 8.15 pounds per
PRESSURIZED CABINS
square inch at an altitude of 20,000 feet is a common design value.
To avoid the use of individual oxygen supplies, the passenger cabins of

today's transport airplanes are pressurized. To simplify the control of


For generous vision, the proportions of the window should be reason-
pressurization, to avoid structural interferences, and to reduce leaks, it is
ably large. However, since windows have been known to fail in flight,
there is a tendency to make the openings smaller. In this way, in case
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:36 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

common to provide a separate structure for the pressurized cabin.

of failure resulting in explosive decompression, a passenger seated next


For optimum weight, it is desirable to construct the pressurized cabin
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

as a cylinder with hemispherical ends. The stresses imposed by the

to the window would not be blown out.


For additional safety, window materials are shatterproof and windows
for pressurized cabins are three layers thick, with each layer constructed
of two or more plies.
The student i:;hould also refer to Chapter XII, The Passenger Cabin.

PRESSURIZED CABINS
To avoid the use of individual oxygen supplies, the passenger cabins of
today's transport airplanes are pressurized. To simplify the control of
pressurization, to avoid structural interferences, and to reduce leaks, it is
common to provide a separate structure for the pressurized cabin.
For optimum weight, it is desirable to construct the pressurized cabin
as a cylinder with hemispherical ends. The stresses imposed by the

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
448 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
448

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


differential pres.sure can then be calculated by means of the standard
differential pressure can then be calculated by means of the standard

formula
formula

Jt 2t

The pressurized cabin floats inside the fuselage on flexible mounts so

that the stresses and distortions of the fuselage are not transmitted to the

fI = (ap)(D).
2t
cabin.

Structurally, the pressurized cabin is similar to the fuselage in that

frames and stringers are used.

Since the cabin is not subjected to the airstream, stringers and other

structural members may be used either on the inside or the outside of the

skin or metal envelope.

The pressurized cabin floats inside the fuselage on flexible mounts so


that the stresses and distortions of the fuselage are not transmitted to the
To make cabins pressure-tight, special attention must be paid to all

seams, openings such as windows and doors, and control-system operation

through nominally airtight openings.


cabin.
Skin seams of the main structure may be sealed effectively by inserting

flannel tape impregnated with a sealing compound (much the same as for
Structurally, the pressurized cabin is similar to the fuselage in that
water-tightening a metal float or hull) between the seam laps prior to rivet-
frames and stringers are used.
ing. In addition, the rivets are spaced from 4 to 6 diameters apart to form

Since the cabin is not subjected to the airstream, stringers and other
structural members may be used either on the inside or the outside of the
a double row of staggered rivets.

Soft rubber gaskets, so arranged that they are pressed together when

subject to internal pressure, are used to seal all doors and hatches. Win-
skin or metal envelope.
dows are sealed in rubber channels. Sliding windows are best mounted

in steel frames seated against rubber seals.


To make cabins pressure-tight, special attention must be paid to all
Control cables, passing through the pressurized section, should pass
seams, openings such as windows and doors, and control-system operation
through a special gland which reduces air leakage to a minimum.

through nominally airtight openings.


Skin seams of the ma.in structure may be sealed effectively by inserting
A spherical shape is ideal for a structure designed to withstand internal

pressure most efficiently. In the case of the fuselage, a spherical shape

has to be modified. A cylinder with partly spherical ends is the best com-
flannel tape impregnated with a sealing compound (much the same as for
promise.

Unless the airplane is very large, so that the weight involved becomes
water-tightening a metal float or hull) between the seam laps prior to rivet-
negligible, the pressure cabin forms an integral part of the fuselage.
ing. In addition, the rivets a.re spaced from 4 to 6 diameters apart to form
Where weight considerations are not so vital, the pressure cabin is a sepa-

a double row of staggered rivets.


Soft rubber gaskets, so arranged that they are pressed together when
rate compartment "floating" inside the fuselage. Airtight openings for

control systems and the like are not a serious problem in such cases.

Cabin windows should be double with a dead air space between, or pro- subject to internal pressure, are used to sea.I all doors and hatches. Win-
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:36 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

vision may be made to heat and circulate the heated air at high altitudes,

because the moisture in the air within the cabin has a tendency to frost
dows a.re sea.led in rubber channels. Sliding windows are best mounted
in steel frames seated against rubber seals.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

the windows.

Control cables, passing through the pressurized section, should pass


through a special gland which reduces air leakage to a minimum.
A spherical shape is ideal for a structure designed to withstand internal
pressure most efficiently. In the case of the fuselage, a spherical shape
has to be modified. A cylinder with partly spherical ends is the best com-
promise.
Unless the airplane is very large, so that the weight involved becomes
negligible, the pressure cabin forms an integral part of the fuselage.
Where weight considerations are not so vital, the pressure cabin is a sepa-
rate compartment "floating" inside the fuselage. Airtight openings for
control systems and the like are not a serious problem in such cases.
Cabin windows should be double with a dead air space between, or pro-
vision may be made to heat and circulate the heated air at high altitudes,
because the moisture in the air within the cabin has a tendency to frost
the windows.

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE FUSELAGE 449
THE FUSELAGE

FLOORING
449

FLOORING

A general analytical approach to the design of flooring is given in the


A general analytical approach to the design of flooring is given in the
chapter on Detail Design Considerations.

Flooring may float: it may not be structurally tied to frames and string-
chapter on Detail Desi,gn Consi.derations.
ers. In this way, loads on the fuselage structure are not transmitted to
Flooring may float: it may not be structurally tied to frames and string-
the flooring. However, the loads on the flooring may be transmitted to

ers. In this way, loads on the fuselage structure are not transmitted to
the rest of the structure through flexible spring or rubber supports. In

other words the floating floor may be shock-mounted. The primary


the flooring. However, the loads on the flooring may be transmitted to
advantages of such a type of support is that vibration is not transmitted
the rest of the structure through flexible spring or rubber supports. In
to the flooring. Since the flooring is not an integral part of the main

structure, it may be altered without worrying about the structural in-


other words the floating floor may be shock-mounted. The primary
tegrity of the primary structure.
advantages of such a type of support is that vibration is not transmitted
Flooring may be tied in with the primary structure and so become part

to the flooring. Since the flooring is not an integral part of the main
structure, it may be altered without worrying about the structural in-
of it. The advantage is likely to be a saving of weight since the flooring

would serve a dual purpose. Whether or not the flooring is tied into the

main structure will to some extent determine its detailed construction.


tegrity of the primary structure.
The flooring would extend only over that section of the fuselage where

the presence of passengers, crew, and cargo make it necessary. The


Flooring may be tied in with the primary structure and so become part
floors in the various compartments need not all be placed at the same
of it. The advantage is likely to be a saving of weight since the flooring
level, nor necessarily at the same angle.
would serve a dual purpose. Whether or not the flooring is tied into the
main structure will to some extent determine its detailed construction.
Since the flooring will transmit loads to the fuselage structure, it should

rest on longitudinal stringers, which may have to be larger than those

that are not so loaded. Usually the transverse frames brought up to the The flooring would extend only over that section of the fuselage where
floor level will help to support the flooring as well.

the presence of passengers, crew, and cargo make it necessary. The


Reference should be made to Chapter XII, The Passenger Cabin, which

contains some additional discussion on this subject.


floors in the various compartments need not all be placed at the same
DOORS AND EXITS
level, nor necessarily at the same angle.
The number of doors and exits included in an airplane will depend upon

the number of persons it must carry. It is desirable to have separate


Since the flooring will transmit loads to the fuselage structure, it should
exits for the crew and for the passengers, although the main entrance to
rest on longitudinal stringers, which may have to be larger than those
the cockpit may be through the passenger cabin. (See Chapter XII.)

that are not so loaded. Usually the transverse frames brought up to the
floor level will help to support the flooring as well.
The closures for doors and exits are usually rigid in construction so as

to avoid possible distortions that would lead to interference in opening

the doors; yet they are seldom designed to act as part of the primary
Reference should be made to Chapter XII, The Passenger Cabin, which
structure of the fuselage unless the locking device can be depended upon

contains some additional discussion on this subject.


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:37 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

to provide a continuous type structure.

Access Doors
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Where access from the outside is required, readily removable access

doors, which usually employ some form of cowl fastener for quick opening,

should be provided in the fuselage design.

DOORS AND EXITS


The number of doors and exits included in an airplane will depend upon
the number of persons it must carry. It is desirable to have separate
exits for the crew ahd for the passengers, although the main entrance to
the cockpit may be through the passenger cabin. (See Chapter XII.)
The closures for doors and exits are usually rigid in construction so as
to avoid possible distortions that would lead to interference in opening
the doors; yet they are seldom designed to act as part of the primary
structure of the fuselage unless the locking device can be depended upon
to provide a continuous type structure.
Access Doors
Where access from the outside is required, readily removable accesR
doors, which usually employ some form of cowl fastener for quick opening,
should be provided in the fuselage design.

Original from
Dig IZed b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
450 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
450

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Batteries should be removable from the outside and not from the inside
Batteries should be removable from the outside and not from the inside
of the cabin or cockpit; likewise, the water tank should be finable from
of the cabin or cockpit; likewise, the water tank should be fillable from
the outside. Since these two items are not removable and access is not
the outside. Since these tw0 items are not removable and access is not
required at every landing, the access doors do not have to be as easily

opened as the doors to the baggage compartments.


required at every landing, the access doors do not have to be as easily
Baggage Compartments
opened as the doors to the baggage compartments.
Baggage compartments and the like are lined with a secondary structure

of metal sheet, either flat or corrugated (may be covered with canvas or

felt for soundproofing purposes). This secondary structure is attached


Baggage Compartments
to the frames or longitudinal members at appropriate points.
Baggage compartments and the like are lined with a secondary structure
To avoid the added complexity and higher costs involved in the design

of a larger fuselage, the use of twin fuselage designs has been proposed.
of metal sheet, either flat or corrugated (may be covered with canvas or
This suggestion may be worth while provided that different functions
felt for soundproofing purposes). This secondary structure is attached
are assigned to each fuselage. It could also prove effective in cases where

to the frames or longitudinal members at appropriate points.


the heavy concentrated load of the larger fuselage would hinder the ful-

fillment of center of gravity requirements. It must be recognized, how-

ever, that the maneuverability of such a craft might be curtailed by the

TWIN FUSELAGES
increased moment of inertia resulting from the dispersion of large units.

The design considerations for the tail booms are very similar to those
To avoid the added complexity and higher costs involved in the design
for the aft section of a fuselage. The boom is subjected primarily to

of a larger fuselage, the use of twin fuselage designs has been proposed.
This suggestion may be worth while provided that different functions
TWIN FUSELAGES

TAIL BOOMS

Figure XXI-18. A twin fuselage airplane. are assigned to each fuselage. It could also prove effective in cases where
the heavy concentrated load of the larger fuselage would hinder the ful-
fillment of center of gravity requirements. It must be recognized, how-
ever, that the maneuverability of such a craft might be curtailed by the
increased moment of inertia resulting from the dispersion of large units.

TAIL BOOMS
The design considerations for the tail booms are very similar to those
for the aft section of a fuselage. The boom is subjected primarily to
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:37 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XXl- 18. A twin fuselage airplane.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
THE FUSELAGE 451
THE FUSELAGE

451
bending and torsional moments, with very little transverse shear. For
bending and torsional moments, with very little transverse shear. For

this reason, a cross section that is fundamentally circular in form is the


this reason, a cross section that is fundamentally circular in form is the
most efficient one.
most efficient one.
For the nose-wheel type of landing gear, the tail boom or booms would

For the nose-wheel type of landing gear, the tail boom or booms would
seem to have considerable merit for the small airplane design.
seem to have considerable merit for the small airplane design.

For a pusher-propeller installation, twin tail booms—one on each side

of the engine—serve as protection from the propeller. For a pusher-propeller installation, twin tail booms-one on each side
There is some weight penalty involved with twin tail booms. On the

basis of skin alone, it can be seen that 2 ir di > v d, where di is the di-
of the engine-serve as protection from the propeller.
ameter of each of the twin booms, and d is the diameter required for a
There is some weight penalty involved with twin tail booms. On the
single boom. The single-boom diameter would be a little larger than the

basis of skin alone, it can be seen that 2 11" di > 11" d, where di is the di-
ameter of each of the twin booms, and d is the diameter required for a
twin-boom diameter.

Figure XXI-19. A centerline sketch of a truss-type fuselage for an in-line engine in

the nose. Only the top and front side trusses are shown. The Pratt truss is shown for single boom. The single-boom diameter would be a little larger than the
the top and rear portion of the fuselage, and the Warren truss for the front side. The

side trusses may be either Pratt or Warren, or a combination of the two, while the top
twin-boom diameter.
and bottom trusses are always Pratt type since they tie in the side trusses, which are

usually symmetrical with each other.

ALTERNATE TYPE STRUCTURES

The use of truss-type structures, especially for small airplanes, should

not be ruled out entirely. In some cases, a desirable solution is found in

composite structure utilizing a reinforced monocoque structure for the

cockpit and cabin section and a steel truss structure for the tail section,

or vice versa.

Some of the truss arrangements are shown in Figures XXI-19 and

XXI-20. The two truss types employed are (1) the Warren truss, in

which three adjacent members in the side truss are placed to resemble a

letter W, and (2) the Howe truss, in which every two members in the side

truss are parallel to each other.

FIGURE XXl-19. A centerline sketch of a truss-type fuselage for an in-line engine in


the nose. Only the top and front side trusses are shown. The Pratt truss is shown for
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:37 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the top and rear portion of the fuselage, and the Warren truss for the front side. The
side trusses may be either Pratt or Warren, or a combination of the two, while the top
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

and bottom trusses are always Pratt type since they tie in the side trusses, which are
usually symmetrical with each other.

ALTERNATE TYPE STRUCTURES


The use of truss-type structures, especially for small airplanes, should
not be ruled out entirely. In some cases, a desirable solution is found in
composite structure utilizing a reinforced monocoque structure for the
cockpit and cabin section and a steel truss structure for the tail section,
or vice versa.
Some of the truss arrangements are shown in Figures XXI-19 and
XXI-20. The two truss types employed are (1) the Warren truss, in
which three adjacent members in the side truss are placed to resemble a
letter W, and (2) the Howe truss, in which every two members in the side
truss are parallel to each other.

· Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
452 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
452 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Figure XXI-20. Possible arrangements for structural members around a door for a

truss-type fuselage.

In general, the truss structures are easily produced. The stress analysis

of such a structure is also relatively uncomplicated. No prototype struc-

ture has to be tested statically, as in a reinforced monocoque structure,

since the structural analysis is well authenticated.

In order to provide a streamlined fuselage, a fairing structure is built

around the trusses. Although this satisfies the aerodynamic requirements,

the structural weight may be high since separate structures are used—one

for primary purposes to carry the load, the other for secondary purposes

only; whereas in the reinforced monocoque structure, the two purposes or

functions are combined in one.

Another design approach is to use one or more keel beams to serve the

needs of the primary structure. The remainder of the structure, consist-

ing of transverse frames, stringers, and covering, would serve a secondary

role.

Such a structure would be particularly useful in situations in which

local concentrated loads were extremely high, such as carrying heavy

machinery or driving tractors or tanks into the cargo compartment.

The structure has been proposed for small airplanes in which the seats

and control systems would be attached to the longitudinal fuselage beam.

The structural advantages of using one or more beams of this kind are (1)

that they are easily stress-analyzed, (2) they are easy to manufacture, and FIGURE XXI-20. Possible arrangements for structural members around a door for a
(3) their deflections and distortions are reasonably easy to predict.
truBB-type fuselage.

In general, the truss structures are easily produced. The stress analysis
of such a structure is also relatively uncomplicated. No prototype struc-
ture has to be tested statically, as in a reinforced monocoque structure,
since the structural analysis is well authenticated.
In order to provide a streamlined fuselage, a fairing structure is built
around the trusses. Although this satisfies the aerodynamic requirements,
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:37 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

the structural weight may be high since separate structures are used-one
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

for primary purposes to carry the load, the other for secondary purposes
only; whereas in the reinforced monocoque structure, the two purposes or
functions are combined in one.
Another design approach is to use one or more keel beams to serve the
needs of the primary structure. The remainder of the structure, consist-
ing of transverse frames, stringers, and covering, would serve a secondary
role.
Such a structure would be particularly useful in situations in which
local concentrated loads were extremely high, such as carrying heavy
machinery or driving tractors or tanks into the cargo compartment.
The structure has been proposed for small airplanes in which the seats
and control systems would be attached to the longitudinal fuselage beam.
The structural advantages of using one or more beams of this kind are (1)
that they are easily stress-analyzed, (2) they are easy to manufacture, and
(3) their deflections and distortions are reasonably easy to predict.

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
THE FUSELAGE 453
THE FUSELAGE

453
EFFECT OF FUSELAGE MASS DISTRIBUTION
EFFECT OF FUSELAGE MASS DISTRIBUTION

When the mass is distributed primarily in the fuselage of the airplane,


When the mass is distributed primarily in the fuselage of the airplane,
the moment of inertia about the normal axis of the airplane is increased.
the moment of inertia. about the normal axis of the airplane is increased.
It was found that in extreme cases, as long as the principal or longitudinal

axis was kept inclined at a positive angle of attack to the flight path, the
It was found that in extreme cases, as long as the principal or longitudinal
oscillatory stability was improved, but at zero angle of attack, there was axis was kept incW.ned at a positive angle of attack to the flight path, the
a decrease in this stability.

oscillatory stability was improved, but at zero angle of attack, there was
a. decrease in this stability.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:37 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
CHAPTER XXII

Preliminary Performance Calculations

Performance calculations are necessary at several stages of the design to

determine whether or not the original specifications set forth for the design

are being met. The first set of preliminary performance calculations is


CHAPTER XXII
based upon empirical formulae that have been established on the basis of

past performance of similar airplanes and which are predicated upon simi-

lar power and wing loadings, gross weights, and general design. These

calculations are wholly rule-of-thumb and are used by the engineer for his

general information and to decide whether his design is likely to meet the

performance specifications at all.


Prelhninary Performance Caleuladons
SOURCE OF DATA

The second form of preliminary performance calculations is set forth

briefly in this chapter. The data for determining the horsepower required

to fly in horizontal flight may be obtained in several ways:

1. From scattered wind-tunnel tests made by various testing agencies.

2. From wind-tunnel tests on individual components of the design.

3. From wind-tunnel tests on the complete design.

4. From wind-tunnel tests and full flight corrections obtained on similar


Performance calculations are necessary at several stages of the design to
previous designs.
determine whether or not the original specifications set forth for the design
These calculations can be considered only as preliminary since their

accuracy depends upon the judgment of the engineer using the particular
are being met. The first set of preliminary performance calculations is
data. Performance data must be obtained finally from actual full flight
based upon empirical formulae that have been established on the basis of
tests.

past performance of similar airplanes and which are predicated upon simi-
Preliminary performance estimates for minimum or stalling speed,

maximum speed, maximum rate of climb, service and absolute ceiling,


lar power and wing loadings, gross weights, and general design. These
and range may be obtained by a series of calculations for horsepower re-
calculations are wholly rule-of-thumb and are used by the engineer for his
quired at various speeds and the corresponding horsepower available.

These calculations are given here in briefest form, and their accuracy de-
general information and to decide whether his design is likely to meet the
pends upon the accuracy of the various assumptions made. However,
performance specifications at all.
they may be considered sufficiently accurate until extensive wind-tunnel

tests on the design have been made.

SOURCE OF DATA
454

The second form of preliminary performance calculations is set forth


briefly in this chapter. The data for determining the horsepower required
to fly in horizontal flight may be obtained in several ways:
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:37 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1. From scattered wind-tunnel tests made by various testing agencies.


2. From wind-tunnel tests on individual components of the design.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

3. From wind-tunnel tests on the complete design.


4. From wind-tunnel tests and fuH flight corrections obtained on similar
previous designs.
These calculations can be considered only as preliminary since their
accuracy depends upon the judgment of the engineer using the particular
data. Performance data must be obtained finally from actual full flight
tests.
Preliminary performance estimates for minimum or stalling speed,
maximum speed, maximum rate of climb, service and absolute ceiling,
and range may be obtained by a. series of calculations for horsepower re-
quired at various speeds and the corresponding horsepower available.
These calculations are given here in briefest form, and their accuracy de-
pends upon the accuracy of the various assumptions made. However,
they may be considered sufficiently accurate until extensive wind-tunnel
tests on the design have been made.
454

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 455
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

455

CALCULATIONS FOR HORSEPOWER REQUIRED


CALCULATIONS FOR HORSEPOWER REQUIRED

The horsepower required at different speeds in horizontal flight is calcu-


The horsepower required at different speeds in horizontal flight is calcu-
lated by means of the equation:

Pr = (D. + D,) X,
lated by means of the equation:
where D„ = wing drag in pounds at speed V,

Pr = (D111
v,
+ D 550
Dp = sum of parasite and interference drag in pounds at speed V
9)
and

V = speed in feet per second of the airplane in horizontal flight

at the corresponding angle of attack.


where D. = wing drag in pounds at speed V,
The wing-drag coefficients are usually obtainable for an infinite aspect
D11 = sum of parasite and interference drag in pounds at speed V
ratio and must be corrected for the aspect ratio used. These corrections

a.nd
V = speed in feet per second of the airplane in horizontal flight
are outlined in Chapter III, Airfoil Selection.

The parasite resistance includes all the resistance caused by the fuselage,

tail surfaces, surface irregularities, landing gear, supports and the like, and
at the corresponding angle of attack.
all parts of the airplane except the wing proper.

Parasite-resistance coefficients are obtainable from various sources and


The wing-drag coefficients are usually obtainable for an infinite aspect
are often referred to unit length as in the case of struts; or, per unit as in

ratio and must be corrected for the aspect ratio used. These corrections
the case of wheels; or, per square foot of maximum cross section in the case

of the fuselage. It is usually desirable to obtain the total drag for a speed
are outlined in Chapter III, Airfoil Selection.
of 1 foot per second and then obtain a new coefficient referred to the wing
The parasite resistance includes all the resistance caused by the fuselage,
area by dividing by the wing area.

The interference drag is more difficult to appraise. Usually it is ac-


tail surfaces, surface irregularities, landing gear, supports and the like, a.nd
counted for in the calculations by arbitrarily increasing the parasite re-
all parts of the airplane except the wing proper.
sistance by a small percentage. An airplane with a fuselage well faired

Parasite-resistance coefficients are obtainable from various sources and


are often referred to unit length as in the case of struts; or, per unit as in
into the wing, with landing gear retracted, offers far less interference drag

than one not so well faired. The arbitrary factor may be as much as 5

per cent.
the case of wheels; or, per square foot of maximum cross section in the case
These calculations are best carried out by means of a table, such as

Table XXII-1.
of the fuselage. It is usually desirable to obtain the total drag for a. speed
Table XXII-1.
of 1 foot per second and then obtain a. new coefficient referred to the wing
(1)

area. by dividing by the wing area.


The interference drag is more difficult to appraise. Usually it is ac-
(2)

(3)

(4) counted for in the calculations by arbitrarily increasing the parasite re-
(5)

sistance by a. small percentage. An airplane with a fuselage well fa.ired


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

(6)

(7)
into the wing, with landing gear retracted, offers far less interference drag
than one not so well faired. The arbitrary factor may be as much as 5
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

(8)

(9)

(10)
per cent.
(11)
These calculations are best carried out by means of a table, such as
(12)

Table XXII- 1.
(13)

(14)

TABLE XXIl- 1.
D•

Dl,

(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14)
-- --,Dr,g
_ -- - - --, _ - - - - - - - -
Dvts

Dbts

D,, D,, X 1.05 CDp


A>

D, X 1.05
a D1 DvTs DB'l'B
-- - - - , _
CD. CD, CL
" D HP
- -, _ --------
Com

Cd,

CL

HP

Original from
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
456 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
456

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Computations Derived from Table XX Il-1.
Computations Derived from Table XXII-1.

Column 1. Here are entered the angles of attack of the airplane or the

wing, whichever is chosen for reference. The angular range should start
Column 1. Here are entered the angles of attack of the airplane or the
slightly above the angle at which zero lift of the wing occurs and should

stop at a few angles beyond that at which maximum lift of the wing occurs.
wing, whichever is chosen for reference. The angular range should start
It is usually satisfactory to use 2-degree intervals.
slightly above the angle at which r.ero lift of the wing occurs and should
Column 2. Record here the total drag, at 1 foot per second, of the fuse-

stop at a few angles beyond that at which maximum lift of the wing occurs.
It is usually satisfactory to use 2-degree intervals.
lage. The fuselage drag usually varies with angle of attack. If this

change is considered small, it may be neglected and thus be assumed con-

stant for all angles of attack.


Column 2. Record here the total drag, at 1 foot per second, of the fuse-
Column S. The total drag of the landing gear, at 1 foot per second, of

the wheels, struts, and cowling. This drag usually remains constant for
lage. The fuselage drag usually varies with angle of attack. If this
all angles of attack.
change is considered small, it may be neglected and thus be assumed con-
Column 40 0 The vertical tail surfaces do not change their angle of attack
stant for all angles of attack.
Column S. The total drag of the landing gear, at 1 foot per second, of
as the airplane changes its angle of attack; therefore, the drag remains

constant for all angles of attack. Any blanketing effect of the fuselage on

the vertical tail surfaces is neglected. The drag of the vertical tail sur- the wheels, struts, and cowling. This drag usually rem.a.ins constant for
faces at 1 foot per second is therefore constant.

all angles of attack.


Column 4. The vertical tail surfaces do not change their angle of attack
Column 6. The drag of the horizontal tail surfaces changes with angle

of attack so that the drag at 1 foot per second varies with increasing angle

of attack of the airplane. The drag coefficients of the horizontal tail sur-
as the airplane changes its angle of attack; therefore, the drag remains
faces must be corrected for aspect ratio. These corrections are outlined

in Chapter III. Usually no account is taken of difference in the drag of


constant for all angles of attack. Any blanketing effect of the fuselage on
the horizontal tail surfaces due to downwash of wing. the vertical tail surfaces is neglected. The drag of the vertical tail sur·
Column 6. If columns 2, 3, 4, and 5 account for all items (outside of

faces at 1 foot per second is therefore constant.


Column 5. The drag of the horizontal tail surfaces changes with angle
the wing) contributing to the parasite drag, then the addition of these col-

umns for each angle of attack will give the total parasite resistance, desig-

nated Dp, at 1 foot per second.


of attack so that the drag at 1 foot per second varies with increasing angle
Column 7. As previously explained, the interference drag may be ac-

counted for by multiplying the parasite resistance by a factor varying


of attack of the airplane. The drag coefficients of the horizontal tail sur-
from 1.00 to 1.05. This may be called a "bogey factor" by which any
faces must be corrected for aspect ratio. These corrections are outlined
omissions in the calculation of parasite resistance may readily be accounted

in Chapter III. Usually no account is taken of difierence in the drag of


the horizontal tail surfaces due to downwash of wing.
for if so desired.

Column 8. The value of Cd„ the parasite and interference resistance co-

efficient in the absolute system referred to the wing area, may be found by
Column 6. If columns 2, 3, 4, and 5 account for all items (outside of
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

dividing the values found in column 6 by Yi p Su v2 where Sw represents

the wing area; since v = 1 foot per second (the speed for which calculations
the wing) contributing to the para.site drag, then the addition of these col-
umns for each angle of attack will give the total parasite resistance, desig-
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

were made, or if desired, calculations may be made for 100 feet per second)

the expression becomes p Sa (or 5000 pS„).

nated Dp, at 1 foot per second.


Column 7. AB previously explained, the interference drag may be ac-
Column 9. Here are recorded the drag coefficients of the wing corrected

for aspect ratio, of the airfoil used in the design corresponding to the angles

of attack listed in column 1.


counted for by multiplying the parasite resistance by a factor varying
from 1.00 to 1.05. This may be called a "bogey factor" by which any
omissions in the calculation of parasite resistance may readily be accounted
for if so desired.
Column 8. The value of CD.. the parasite and interference resistance co-
efficient in the absolute system referred to the wing area, may be found by
dividing the values found in column 6 by ~ p Sw v2 where S"' represents
the wing area; since v = 1 foot per second (the speed for which calculations
were ma.de, or if desired, calculations may be made for 100 feet per second)
the expression becomes~ p 8111 (or 5000 pS"').
Column 9. Here are recorded the drag coefficients of the wing corrected
for aspect ratio, of the airfoil used in the design corresponding to the angles
of attack listed in column 1.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 457

Column 10. The addition of the CD. a.nd CD. gives CD,, the tota.1 re-
sistance coefficient of the a.irpla.ne referred to the wing a.res.
Column 11. The lift coefficient for the airfoil used for the wing, for the
angles of a.tta.ck given in column 1, a.re listed here.
Column 1!. The speed of the airplane for increa.eing angle of a.tta.ck in
horizontal flight is found by means of the formula
= /gross weight
v (fps) '\J 72/JCz.S 1

which for a. given design ma.y be simplified to the form of

v (fps)= K~·
If desired, the expressions l / CL and~ may be included in the table
or included in a. subsidiary ta.hie. The values for Cz. for different angles
of attack a.re those listed in column 11.

HP available
of sea level

.,""
._
C)
6 00>----+----+->.
.,
~
Cl)
~ 4001-----1~--+-- ~,__----1- _ _,,__,.__ _- l -_ _-4
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

:t:
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Mox.$peed in hori-'\.!
zontol flight 224 "'I .
0 40 80 120 160 200 240
FIGURE XXIl-1. T ypical horsepower available and required curves.

Column 1S. The total drag of the airplane is then found by means of
the expression D = ~pSCn, v2, which for a given design may be simplified
to read D = K1CD, v2 where corresponding values of CD, and v may be
found in columns 10 and 12, respectively.
Column 14. The horsepower required, hp, is found by means of the
formula.
hp-=-,
Dv
. 550

Original from
01 91t1zed by Google UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
TABLE XXII-2. Standard atmospheres. ! 0 - 2

Altitude
Table XXII-2. Standard atmospheres.

gp p
Altitude

(ft) t (°F) p p/po


(in.) p/po
(ft)
Ob/ft1)
<(°F)

p
0 59. 0.002378 1. 0.07651 29.92 1.
p/po
1,000 55.434 0.002309 0.9710 0.07430 28.86 0.9644
Ob/ft«)
2,000 51.868 0.002242 0.9428 0.07213 27.82 0.9298
gp
3,000 48.301 0.002176 0.9151 0.07001 26.81 0.8962
P
4,000 44.735 0.002112 0.8881 0.06794 25.84 0.8636
p/po
5,000 41.169 0.002049 0.8616 0.06592 24.89 0.8320
(in.)

6,000 37.603 0.001988 0.8358 0.06395 23.98 0.8013


0

7,000 34.037 0.001928 0.8106 0.06202 23.09 0.7716


59.

8,000 30.471 0.001869 0.7859 0.06013 22.22 0.7427


0.002378

9,000 26.904 0.001812 0.7619 0.05829 21.39 0.7147


10,000
1.

0.07651
23.338 0.001756 0.7384 0.05649 20.58 0.6876
29.92
11,000 19.772 0.001702 0.7154 0.05474 19.79 0.6614
1.
12,000 16.206 0.001648 0.6931 0.05303 19.03 0.6359
1,000
13,000 12.640 0.001596 0.6712 0.05136 18.28 0.6112
55.434
14,000 9.074 0.001545 0.6499 0.04973 17.57 0.5873
0.002309 15,000 5.507 0.001496 0.6291 0.04814 16.88 0.5642
0.9710
16,000 1.941 0.001448 0.6088 0.04658 16.21 0.5418
0.07430
17,000 -1.625 0.001401 0.5891 0.04507 15.57 0.5202
28.86
18,000 -5.191 0.001355 0.5698 0.04359 14.94 0.4992
0.9644

19,000 -8.757 0.001311 0.5509 0.04216 14.33 0.4790


20,000 -12.323 0.001267 0.5327
2,000

0.04075 13.74 0.4594


21,000 -15.890 0.001225 0.5148
51.868

0.03938 13.18 0.4405


22,000
0.002242

0.9428
-19.456 0.001183 0.4974 0.03806 12.63 0.4222
0.07213
23,000 -23.022 0.001143 0.4805 0.03676 12.10 0.4045
27.82
24,000 -26.588 0.001103 0.4640 0.03550 11.59 0.3874
0.9298 25,000 -30.154 0.001065 0.4480 0.03427 11.10 0.3709
3,000 26,000 -33.720 0.001028 0.4323 0.03308 10.62 0.3550
48.301
27,000 -37.287 0.000992 0.4171 0.03192 10.16 0.3397
0.002176
28,000 -40.853 0.000957 0.4023 0.03078 9.72 0.3248
0.9151
29,000 -44.419 0.000922 0.3869 0.02968 9.293 0.3106
0.07001

30,000 -47.985 0.000889 0.3740 0.02861 8.880 0.2968


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

26.81

31,000 -51.551 0.000857 0.3603 0.02757 8.483 0.2834


0.8962

32,000 -55.117 0.000826 0.3472 0.02656 8.101 0.2707


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

33,000 -58.684 0.000795


4,000

0.3343 0.02558 7.732 0.2583


34,000 -62.250
44.735

0.002112
0.000765 0.3218 0.02463 7.377 0.2465
0.8881
35,000 -65.816 0.000736 0.3098 0.02367 7.03() 0.2352
0.06794
36,000 -67. 0.000704 0.2962 0.02265 6.708 0.2242
25.84
37,000 -b7. 0.000671 0.2824 0.02160 6.394 0.2137
0.8636 38,000 -61. 0.900640 0.2692 0.02059 6.096 0.2037
5,000 39,000 -67. 0.000610 0.2566 0.01963 5.812 0.1943
41.169

40,000 -67. 0.000582 0.2447 0.01872 5.541 0.1852


0.002049

41,000 -67. 0.000554 0.2332 0.01785 5.283 0.1765


0.8616

42,000 -67. 0.000529 0.2224 0.01701 5.036 0.1683


0.06592

43,000 -67. 0.000504 0.2120 0.01622 4.802 0.1605


24.89

44,000 -67. 0.000481 0.2021 0.01546 4.578 0.1530


0.8320

6,000
45,000 -67. 0.000459 0.1926 0.01474 4.365 0.1458
37.603
46,000 -67. 0.000437 0.1837 0.01405 4.160 0.1391
0.001988
47,000 -67. 0.000417 0.1751 0.01339 3.966 0.1325
0.8358
48,000 -67. 0.000397 0.1669 0.01277 3.781 0.1264
0.06395
49,000 -67. 0.000379 0.1591 0.01217 3.604 0.1205
23.98
50,000 -67. 0.000361 0.1517 0.01161 3.436 0.1149
0.8013

7,000

458
34.037

0.001928

0.8106

0.06202

Original from
23.09

0.7716
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOF ICHIGAN
8,000

30.471

0.001869
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 459
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

459 where D and corresponding v are found in columns 13 and 12, respectively.
where D and corresponding v are found in columns 13 and 12, respectively.

This procedure comprises the calculations for horsepower required. It


This procedure comprises the calculations for horsepower required. It
is customary to plot the values of horsepower versus corresponding speed
is customary to plot the values of horsepower versus corresponding speed
(usually given in miles per hour); then, with the aid of horsepower avail-
(usually given in miles per hour); then, with the aid of horsepower avail-
able curves, almost all the performance figures required may be calculated

readily. Refer to Figure XXII-1.


able curves, almost all the performance figures required may be calculated
The calculations outlined are usually calculated for sea-level conditions. readily. Refer to Figure XXII-1.
They may be extended to include calculations for other altitudes by mul-

tiplying the square roots of the relative densities by both the velocity and

horsepower found at another altitude as follows:


ALTITUDE CORRECTIONS
where vi represents the new speed at the density pi at the new altitude,

The calculations outlined are usually calculated for sea-level conditions.


vo represents the originally calculated speed at the density po,

hpi represents the new horsepower corresponding to Vi, and


They may be extended to include calculations for other altitudes by mul-
hpo represents the originally calculated horsepower corresponding
tiplying the square roots of the relative densities by both the velocity and
The density relationships of any altitude to that of sea level may be

found in Table XXII-2.


horsepower found at another altitude as follows:
The table for standard atmosphere, as normally presented, gives the

density relationships of air at any altitude at 45 degrees latitude. This


V1 = Vo /po,
table does not usually extend beyond the stratosphere, or above 50,000

feet. Additional data has been made available for use in extreme high-
"\J P1
altitude considerations. The information presented in Tables XXII-3

hp; = hpo /Po,


and XXII-4 covers upper atmosphere characteristics under the most

probable conditions and the arbitrary standard atmosphere, and may be


"\J Pi
of interest even though it may not be of immediate use to the student.

Aside from performance calculations, a number of other problems are


where v1 represents the new speed at the density p1 at the new altitude,
introduced by increase in altitude. Under special conditions, people can
Vo represents the originally calculated speed at the density po,
live in altitudes up to 18,000 feet without the need of oxygen, but oxygen
hp1 represents the new horsepower corresponding to vi, and
has to be supplied beyond that altitude. Pressure has to be supplied, as

well, for the human system to absorb the required oxygen, but if no other
hpo represents the originally calculated horsepower corresponding
difficulties arose, it would be found that the human blood would boil at its to Vo.
own temperature at 63,000 feet altitude. One hundred per cent oxygen

would be required from altitudes above 40,000 feet.


The density relationships of any altitude to that of sea level may be
ALTITUDE CORRECTIONS

found in Table XXII-2.


tO V0.

ARBITRARY STANDARD ATMOSPHERE

ARBITRARY STANDARD ATMOSPHERE


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:38 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

The table for standard atmosphere, as normally presented, gives the


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

density relationships of air at any altitude at 45 degrees latitude. This


table does not usually extend beyond the stratosphere, or above 50,000
feet. Additional data has been made available for use in extreme high-
altitude considerations. The information presented in Tables XXII-3
and XXII-4 covers upper atmosphere characteristics under the most
probable conditions and the arbitrary standard atmosphere, and may be
of interest even though it may not be of immediate use to the student.
Aside from performance calculations, a number of other problems are
introduced by increase in altitude. Under special conditions, people can
live in altitudes up to 18,000 feet without the need of oxygen, but oxygen
has to be supplied beyond that altitude. Pressure has to be supplied, as
well, for the human system to absorb the required oxygen, but if no other
difficulties arose, it would be found that the human blood would boil at its
own temperature at 63,000 feet altitude. One hundred per cent oxygen
would be required from altitudes above 40,000 feet.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
460 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
460 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

Table XXII-3. Upper atmosphere characteristics.*


TABLE XXII-3. Upper atmosphere characteristics.•
Altitude

Mean free path


(ft)

Altitude
Altitude Altitude Weight of air between mole- Molecules
(miles)
(ft) (miles) (lb/cu ft) culee (in.) (per in.1)
Weight of air

-
(lb/cu ft)

500,000 94.6 370 43 x 1011


-
Mean free path

450,000 85.2 65 25 x 1011


-
between mole-

cules (in.)
400,000 75.8 12 15 x 1011
Molecules
350,000 66.3 0.2x1~ 1.9 84 x 10"
300,000 56.8 2.6 x 1()-7 0.3 48 x 1014
t2.9 x 10-1 5.8 x 10-1
(per in.*)

250,000 47.4 27 x 1011


1.6 x 10--.
500,000

94.6 200,000 37.9 1.0 x 10-1 16 x 1011


370 150,000 28.4 9.5 x 10--. 1.7 x 10-1 96 X lQlS
43 X 10"
100,000 18.9 0.000107 2.7 x 10-• 62 x 1017
450,000
50,000 9.5 0.0116 3.6 x lQ--6 47 x lQ18
85.2
0.0 0.0765 3.5 x 10--. 44 x 1019
—

•From "Developments in High Speed Aircraft," by E. H. Heinemann, Mechanical


65

25 X 10"

Engineering, October 1947.


t This is another way of saying 2.9 pounds per million cubic foot.
400,000

75.8

—

12
TABLE XXIl-4. Arbitrary standard atmosphere.•
15 X 10"

350,000

Speed of Density Pressure Temperature Weight


66.3

Altitude soundt ratio in of air


0.2 X 10-»

1.9
(ft) (mph) p/po (lb/in.1) OF oc (lb/ft1)
84 X 10"

300,000 100,000 664 0.014 0.16 -67 -55 0.0011


56.8
90,000 664 0.023 0.28 -67 -55 0.0017
2.6 X 10—7
80,000 664 0.036 0.40 -67 -55 0.0028
0.3
70,000 664 0.058 0.65 -67 -55 0.0044
48 X 10"
60,000 664 0.094 1.05 -67 -55 0.0072
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

250,000

50,000 664 0.152 1.69 -67 -55 0.0116


47.4

40,000 664 0.245 2.72 -67 -55 0.0187


30,000 680 0.374 4.36 -48 -44 0.0286
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

t2.9 X 10-*

5.8 X 10-*

20,000 708 0.533 6.76 -12 -25 0.0408


27 X 10"

10,000 736 0.738 10.11 +23 -5 0.0565


200,000

0 763 1.000 14.70 +59 +15 0.0765


37.9

1.6 X 10-»

1.0 x io-«
•From "Developments in High Speed Aircraft," by E. H. Heirtemann, Mechanical
16 X 10"
Engineering, October 1947.
150,000 t The speed of sound is a function of the absolute temperature only.
28.4

Where gasoline is required for power plants, it would be found that gaso-
9.5 X 10-*

1.7 X 10-'

96 X 10"
line would boil at -68° F and 33,000 feet altitude unless the gasoline were
100,000

18.9
kept under pressure.
0.000107

2.7 X 10—«
PARASITE RESISTANCE DATA
62 X 10"

50,000
The data on parasite resistance may be found from wind-tunnel tests
9.5

and NACA reports, as well as in various handbooks. The following data


are representative.
0.0116

3.6 X 10-*

47 X 1018

0.0

0.0765

3.5 X 10-*

Original from
44 X 10"

* From "Developments in High Speed Aircraft," by E. H. Heinemann, Mechanical


Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
Engineering, October 1947.

f This is another way of saying 2.9 pounds per million cubic foot.

Table XXII-4. Arbitrary standard atmosphere.*


PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 461
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

461 Full scale drag


Item Item in pounds at
Vertical tail surface cantilever per square foot. If the minimum drag
100 mph
coefficient of the vertical tail surfaces is known, this value may be

Vertical tail surface cantilever per square foot. If the minimum drag 0.40
used with an increase of about 25 per cent to account for gap at hinges.

coefficient of the vertical tail surfaces is known, this value may he


If the surfaces are externally braced, increase the drag by about 50

used with an increase of about 25 per cent to account for gap at hinges.
per cent.

If the surfaces are externally braced, increase the drag by about 50


Horizontal tail surfaces, cantilever, use drag coefficients, corrected for

per cent.
aspect ratio, for each angle of attack. Add about 25 per cent for

Horizontal tail surfaces, cantilever, use drag coefficients, corrected for


aspect ratio, for each angle of attack. Add about 25 per cent for
gap at hinges. If horizontal tail surfaces are externally braced, in-

gap at hinges. If horizontal tail surfaces are externally braced, in-


crease the drag coefficients by about 50 per cent. If the external

bracings are struts of streamlined tubing, allow additional foot for

each end fitting, and estimate drag of bracing on basis of projected


crease the drag coefficients by about 50 per cent. If the external
length of these struts when thrust line is horizontal.
bracings are struts of streamlined tubing, allow additional foot for
Fuselage plus cowled engine per square foot of projected maximum frontal
each end fitting, and estimate drag of bracing on basis of projected
area. If the fineness ratio (ratio of length to depth) is rather small,
length of these struts when thrust line is horizontal.
use high figure. The variation of fuselage drag (for approximately
Fuselage plus cowled engine per square foot of projected maximum frontal 6-8.5
elliptical cross section) may be obtained by means of the formula
area. If the fineness ratio (ratio of length to depth) is rather small,
Da = D0 + 0.0015 Do a1
use high figure. The variation of fuselage drag (for approximately
where Do = value given (for angle of attack a = 0 degrees).
elliptical cross section) may be obtained by means of the formula
THE ENGINE

The horsepower available at different speeds of the airplane in horizon-


Da = Do + 0.0015 Do a 1

tal flight is determined from the brake horsepower curves of the engine

where Do = value given (for angle of attack a = 0 degrees).


used for the design, and the propeller characteristics.

The brake horsepower, usually plotted against corresponding revolu-

tions per minute of the engine is generally furnished by the manufacturer.


THE ENGINE
This power curve is given for sea-level conditions unless the engine happens

to be supercharged when the power curve corresponds to the rated altitude


The horsepower available at different speeds of the airplane in horizon-
limit of the supercharger. See Figure XVIII-6.
tal flight is determined from the brake horsepower curves of the engine
The brake horsepower of nonsupercharged engines and of supercharged

used for the design, and the propeller characteristics.


The brake horsepower, usually plotted against corresponding revolu-
engines above the rated altitude limit of the supercharger varies with the

altitude. This variation may be determined easily from the following

formula: tions per minute of the engine is generally furnished by the manufacturer.
P = P„ (p/po)1 \

This power curve is given for sea-level conditions unless the engine happens
where P = brake horsepower at altitude considered,

Po = brake horsepower at sea level or at limiting supercharged alti-


to be supercharged when the power curve corresponds to the rated altitude
limit of the supercharger. See Figure XVIII-6.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

tude,

p = density at altitude under consideration,

The brake horsepower of nonsupercharged engines and of supercharged


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

po = density at sea level or at limiting supercharged altitude.

The following should be borne in mind also when the engine horsepower
engines above the rated altitude limit of the supercharger varies with the
is desired for other than the usual standard for the engine in question.

altitude. This variation may be determined easily from the following


formula:
1. Propeller gearing will reduce the engine brake horsepower 2 or 3 per

cent.

2. For engines equipped with turbo supercharger, the power decreases P = Po (p/ Po)1.2,
Full scale drag

in pounds at
where P = brake horsepower at altitude considered,
100 mph

Po = brake horsepower at sea level or at limiting supercharged alti-


tude,
0.40

6-8.5

p = density at altitude under consideration,


Po = density at sea level or at limiting supercharged altitude.
The fallowing should be borne in mind also when the engine horsepower
is desired for other than the usual standard for the engine in question.
1. Propeller gearing will reduce the engine brake horsepower 2 or 3 per
cent.
2. For engines equipped with turbo supercharger, the power decreases

Original from
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
462 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
462 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

to about 80 per cent of the normal sea-level power of the unsupercharged


to a.bout 80 per cent of the normal sea-level power of the unsupercharged
engine.

engme.
3. For direct-drive superchargers, the power at the limiting altitude of
3. For direct-drive superchargers, the power at the limiting altitude of

the supercharger is the same as the normal sea-level power developed by

the unsupercharged engine. the supercharger is the same as the normal sea-level power developed by
A typical power curve for an engine is shown in Figure XXII-2.

the unsupercharged engine.


900

I 800
A typical power curve for an engine is shown in Figure XXII-2.
%

* 700

«s

5 600

900 Rated horsepower-850


Normal RPM - 2400
500

-t----+---t
1400 1600 1800 2000 2200

Revolutions per minute

Figure XXII-2. Variation of brake horsepower of the engine with the propeller

~
• 800 t----+---+---+--~,___,.;c----+---~
.
shaft speed in revolutions per minute.

Q
~
Horsepower Available

The modern constant-speed propellers are so designed as to keep the

~
same revolutions per minute regardless of the forward speed of the air-

plane, at least within the permissable angular range of the propeller blades.

Q 700 t----+---+---~-~,__----+---~
It is easy, therefore, to determine the horsepower available by calculating
c::
the value of C, and determining the corresponding efficiency and blade

angle. It is desirable to determine the blade angle also, since the con-
._•
stant-speed propellers are usually limited to 8 to 10 degrees in angular

range. The method of determining the horsepower available may be


~ 600 r----t-~-+----+----+---+-----1
illustrated best by the results of calculations presented in Table XXII-5.

1400 1600 1800 2000 2200


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Revolutions per minute


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

FIGURE XXII-2. Variation of brake horsepower of the engine with the propeller
shaft speed in revolutions per minute.

Horsepower Available

The modern constant-speed propellers are so designed as to keep the


same revolutions per minute regardless of the forward speed of the air-
plane, at least within the permissable angular range of the propeller blades.
It is easy, therefore, to determine the horsepower available by calculating
the value of C, and determining the corresponding efficiency and blade
angle. It is desirable to determine the blade angle also, since the con-
stant-speed propellers are usually limited to 8 to 10 degrees in angular
range. The method of determining the horsepower available may be
illustrated best by the results of calculations presented in Table XXIl- 5.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 463
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

463

TABLE XXIl-5. Determining horsepower available. Design speed 224 mph; pro-
Table XXII-5. Determining horsepower available. Design speed 224 mph; pro-

peller die.meter 9.75, 3 blades; engine 850 horsepower at 2450 rpm; sea level = 0.002378;
peller diameter 9.75, 3 blades; engine 850 horsepower at 2450 rpm; sea level = 0.002378;

gear ratio 2 :3.


gear ratio 2:3.

(1)

(2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9)
(3) v Propeller Brake HP
(4) {mph) V*/nD c. fl* 71• '11 (rpm} hp available
(5)

(6)
224 1.11 1.92 29.5° 86 83 1,634 850 706
(7)

200 1.025 1.72 28.5 85 82 1,634 850 697


(8)

180 0.922 1.55 27.0 83 80 1,634 850 680


(9)

160 0.821 1.375 26.5 81 78 1,634 850 664


V

140 0.717 1.202 25.5 78 75 1,634 850 638


Propeller

120 0.616 1.032 25.0 74 71 1,634 850 604


Brake

100 0.512 0.860 24.5 69 66 1,634 850 562


HP

80 0.410 0.688 24.0 64 61 1,634 850 518


(mph)

60 0.307 0.517 24.0 58 55 1,634 850 467


V*/nD

C.

0*
• Based upon 2-bladed propeller.
n*

Computations to be Derived for Table XXII-5 .


li

(rpm)

hp
Column 1. Speeds are tabulated in this column usually in 20-mile in-
available

224
tervals between approximate stalling speed to maximum speed.
1.11
Column 2. Values of V /nD are calculated for speeds listed in column 1.
1.92

Column 3. Values of c. are calculated for the values of speeds tabulated


in column 1, and horsepower and corresponding rpm values tabulated in
29.5°

86

83 columns 7 and 8, respectively.


1,634

850

706

200
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

1.025

1.72

HP available at
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

28.5

85

7000 ft a fitude
"""
82

1,634 •600i--~-r-~--i~r=:t=:;~=-+-~--j~-/--+-~~
0
850

~ Mox. excess
HP 430
"
697

180
Cl)
0.922

~ 4001--~--i~-...-+---+--+-~~--~----~~~~--4
1.55

~
27.0

83

80

1,634

850

680

160

0.821

0 40 80 120 160 200 240


Speed, miles p~r /lour
1.375

26.5

81

78
F10 URE XXII-3. Available and required horsepower curves obtained for the critical
1,634
altitude of 7000 feet for the specified aircraft engine.
850

664

140

0.717

Original from
1.202

25.5
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
78

75

1,634
464 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
464

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

40 50 60 70 80 90 100

~
Per cent of design airplane speed

Figure XXII-4. The variation of engine power with change in aircraft speed when

~
a fixed-pitch propeller is used.

~
Column 40 0 The blade angles at 75 per cent of the radius are determined

---
for the values of C, given in column 3. See Chapter XV, The Propeller.

Column 5. The propeller efficiency and blade angle corresponding to


~
the calculated values of C, are determined with the aid of curves such as

those to be found in Chapter XV.


""' Curve I or per cent
Column 6. Since the efficiencies tabulated in column 5 are for 2-bladed
"- of rated HP at sea
propellers, a subtraction of 3 per cent is made from those values to give the level
efficiencies for a 3-bladed propeller. See column 6.

Columns 7 and 8. Since the controllable-pitch propeller is a constant-

speed propeller, the engine brake horsepower and corresponding revolu-

tions per minute remain constant throughout the angular range.

Column 9. Values of brake horsepower given in column 8, multiplied by

------
the corresponding propeller efficiencies given in column 6, give the horse-

------
power available at full throttle at the speed listed in column 1. These

-----
values are plotted in Figure XXII-3.

In case of a fixed-pitch propeller, the calculations are slightly different

since the engine revolutions per minute and power do not remain the same.

Refer to Figure XXII-4. Suppose the controllable-pitch propeller used


-- ~
l
Curve for per cent of
rated HP at 10,000
could not change its pitch angle below 20.0 degrees so that the propeller

would be, in reality, a fixed-pitch propeller at speeds below 140 miles per
feet altitude .
hour. The calculations are set forth in Table XXII-6.
50 60 70 80 90 100
Per cent of design airplane speed
FIGURE XXIl-4. The variation of engine power with change in aircraft speed when
a fixed-pitch propeller is used.
Column 4. The blade angles at 75 per cent of the radius are determined
for the values of C. given in column 3. See Chapter XV, The Propeller.
Column 5. The propeller efficiency 1:1.nd blade angle corresponding to
the calculated values of C. are determined with the aid of curves such as
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:39 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

those to be found in Chapter XV.


Column 6. Since the efficiencies tabulated in column 5 are for 2-bladed
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

propellers, a subtraction of 3 per cent is made from those values to give the
efficiencies for a 3-bladed propeller. See column 6.
Columns 7 and 8. Since the controllable-pitch propeller is a constant-
speed propeller, the engine brake horsepower and corresponding revolu-
tions per minute remain constant throughout the angular range.
Column 9. Values of brake horsepower given in column 8, multiplied by
the corresponding propeller efficiencies given in column 6, give the horse-
power available at full throttle at the speed listed in column 1. These
values are plotted in Figure XXII- 3.
In case of a fixed-pitch propeller, the calculations are slightly different
since the engine revolutions per minute and power do not remain the same.
Refer to Figure XXII-4. Suppose the controllable-pitch propeller used
could not change its pitch angle below 20.0 degrees so that the propeller
would be, in reality, a fixed-pitch propeller at speeds below 140 miles per
hour. the calculations are set forth in Table XXII- 6.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 465
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 465

Table XXII-6.
TABLE XXIl-6.
(1)

(2)

Per
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7} (8) (9) (10) (11)
cent
Per Per
of
cent cent
(3)
of of Pro- HP
design rated Brake RPM peller avail-
v c.
Per

cent
speed hp hp rpm f3 'I. 'll able
(4)
- -- -- -
(5)
140 100 100 850 2,450 1,634 1.202 25.5 78 75 638
(6) 120 85.7 94.5 803 2,300 1,535 1.071 25.5 74 71 570
Pro- 100 71.4 90.0 765 2,185 1,456 0.919 25.5 72 69 528
(7)
80 57.2 87.2 742 2,120 1,415 0.785 25.5 67 64 474
(8)
60 42.8 86.5 727 2,080 1,387 0.570 25.5 58 55 400
(9)

(10)

• Based upon 2-bla.ded propeller.


(11)

HP

of
Computations to be Derived for Table XX I 1-6.
design

Column 1. The speeds for the fixed-pitch range of the propeller are
tabulated in this column.
rated

Brake

RPM Column 2. The per cent of design speed is calculated for the speeds
peller

avail-
given in column 1. These values are used in conjunction with Figure
V
XXII-3. Since the propeller is assumed to become a fixed-pitch propeller
speed
at about 140 miles per hour, the design speed is then 140 miles per hour.
Other speeds are then a certain per cent of this design speed.
hp

hp

rpm
Column 3. The per cent of rated power for corresponding per cent of ·
C.

design speed has been found with the aid of the curve in Figure XXIl-4,
indicated as the per cent of rated horsepower at sea level or critical altitude.
1*

ii

able
Column 4. By multiplying the rated horsepower by the percentages
140

tabulated in column 3, the actual brake horsepower corresponding to the


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

100

100
speeds tabulated in column 1 has been found. The rated horsepower is,
in this case, that horsepower of the engine as it enters the fixed-pitch
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

850

propeller range.
2,450

1,634

1.202 Column 5. The engine re.•,:olutions per minute, corresponding to the


25.5

78
brake horsepower tabulated in column 4, may be found with the aid of
75
Figure XXII-2.
638

Column 6. Since the propeller gear ratio is 3 :2, the actual propeller
revolution-per-minute values have to be calculated.
120

85.7

94.5 Column 7. The values of C. are calculated for the corresponding values
803

of speed, power, and propeller revolution per minute found in columns 1,


2,300

2,185
4, and 6.
1,535
Column 8. The propeller blade angle remains constant.
1.071

25.5
Column 9. The efficiency of a 2-bladed propeller for the values of C, in
74 column 7 and f3 = 25.5° are obtained from the appropriate curve m
71

Chapter XV.
570

100
Column 10. Reduction is made for the 3-bladed propeller.
71.4
Column 11. Multiplying the values of brake horsepower in column 4
90.0

765

1,456

0.919

Original from
25.5

72
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
69

528

80
466 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
466

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL by the corresponding efficiencies 'h in column 10 will give the values of
by the corresponding efficiencies 1/1 in column 10 will give the values of

horsepower available in column 11.


horsepower available in column 11.
The calculations for other altitudes are similar to those given for sea-
The calculations for other altitudes are similar to those given for sea-
level conditions. The horsepower-available values for the critical alti-
level conditions. The horsepower-available values for the critical alti-
tude of the supercharged engine are tabulated in Table XXII-7.

The upper limit of the controllable-pitch propeller of 29.5 degrees has


tude of the supercharged engine are tabulated in Table XXII-7.
been determined by the design sea-level condition and therefore remains
The upper limit of the controllable-pitch propeller of 29.5 degrees has
the same.

been determined by the design sea-level condition and therefore remains


Table XXII-7. Horsepower—available values for critical altitude. Design speed

238 mph; altitude 7000p = 0.001928; engine 850 horsepower at 2450 rpm; propeller
the same.
diameter 9.75 feet, 3 blades; gear ratio 2:3.

Propeller
TABLE XXII-7. Horsepower-available values for critical altitude. Design speed
Brake 238 mph; altitude 7000p = 0.001928; engine 850 horsepower at 2450 rpm; propeller
Available
diameter 9.75 feet, 3 blades; gear ratio 2:3.
(mph)

C.

V»/nD

v Propeller Brake Available


V*

»?i
(mph) c. V*/nD fJ* ". '11 rpm hp hp

238 1.982 1.22 29.5 86 83 1,634 850 705


rpm

hp

hp
220 1.815 1.13 29.0 85 82 1,634 850 697
238
200 1.65 1.025 28.5 84 81 1,634 850 687
1.982
180 1.485 0.922 28.0 83 80 1,634 850 680
1.22
160 1.321 0.821 27.5 82 79 1,634 850 672
29.5
145 1.20 0.744 27.0 79 7-6 1,634 850 646
86

83
• Based upon 2-bladed propeller.
1,634

850

705

220

1.815
Above the supercharged altitude, the engine develops less than its rated
1.13 horsepower. This variation with altitude above the critical altitudes for
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

29.0

supercharged engines is shown in Figure XXIl-5.


85

The rated horsepower at 10,000 feet for the engine in the problem just
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

82

1,634
illustrated is only 89 per cent of that at its critical altitude of 7000 feet, or
850

697
0.89 X 850 = 757 horsepower. The corresponding revolutions per
200
minute (from Figure XXIl- 2) is 2165 revolutions per minute. The calcu-
1.65

lations for horsepower available are otherwise similar to those in Tables


1.025

28.5
XXIl-5 and XXII-7.
84
The stalling speed may be determined from the formula
81

v= /gross weight.
1,634

\} ~pCz-.S
850

687

180

1.485
The landing speed is usually assumed to be equal to, or a few miles less
0.922

than, the calculated stalling speed.


28.0

83

80
MAXIMUM SPEED
1,634
The intersection of the curves of the horsepower available and the horse-
850

680
power required determines the maximum speed, in horizontal flight of the
160

1.321

0.821

27.5

Original from
82

79
by UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
1,634

850

672
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 467
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

467

55700

(a

v.

':;:::o/00 ........._ _+ - - - - + - - - - + - - - - + - - - - 1
*>
c:::
^ 80

v.
"
(,)

"""
<i

£ 60
~ 801------>~~----------1
< 40

"~"" 601----+----+--"~~+-"'>o~-+------t
*.

Critical ~
20,0

altitude

= Critical altitude
~
00 ft/

OO ft.'
20,000 ft.
level'

.c::: 40 12,000 ft.


~
- /£,0<

sea level
sea

....
~ 201--~--+~~--+~~-+-~~-t-~----1
0 4 8 12 16

Altitude above critical altitude of

supercharged engine (thousand ft.)

Figure XXII-5. Variation of brake horsepower of a normal supercharged engine

above the critical altitude.

800\

5:
0 4 8 12 16
200\
Altitude above ctitical altitude of
HP i supercharged engine (thousand ff.)
1O,0(

FIGURE XXII-5. Variation of brake horsepower of a normal supercharged engine


ivailable

OO ft. a
above the critical altitude.
at

1titude

Ma*

HP
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

: excess

385
800
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

HP available at
i|

>

10,000 ft. alh'fude


/

K
!'-.. If
~ ......

/
HP ret

at 1O,t
Mox. excess ;....-- I-"""°
juired

700 ft.
HP 385 y
/ '\

.V
? 40 80 120 1t

iO 200 2*

HP required
at 10,000 ft
to

Speed, miles per hour

200
Figure XXII-6. Available and required horsepower curves obtained for an altitude

of 10,000 feet for the supercharged engine whose critical altitude was 7000 feet.
\. - ~

0 40 80 120 160 200 240


Speed, miles per hour
FIGURE XXII-6. Available and required horsepower curves obtained for an altitude
of 10,000 feet for the supercharged engine whose critical altitude was 7000 feet.

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
468 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
468

airplane. In Figure XXIl-1, the maximum speed at sea level is 224 miles
AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

airplane. In Figure XXII-1, the maximum speed at sea level is 224 miles

per hour. Figure XXII-3 indicates that the maximum speed at 7000
per hour. Figure XXII-3 indicates that the maximum speed at 7000
feet is 238 miles per hour, and Figure XXII-6 indicates that the maximum

speed at 10,000 feet is 237 miles per hour.


feet is 238 miles per hour, and Figure XXII-6 indicates that the maximum
RATE OF CLIMB
speed at 10,000 feet is 237 miles per hour.
The rate of climb is calculated by means of the formula

»,.,.-. . ± 33,000 (excess horsepower)

RATE OF CLIMB
rate of climb in feet per minute = —1 —. , • . c—-,——

gross weight in pounds

The maximum difference between the curves of the horsepower available

The rate of climb is calculated by means of the formula


and the horsepower required at the same speed along the flight path will

. b . f t . te 33,000 (excess horsepower)


rate of c1im m ee per mmu = gross we1·ght m
determine the maximum rate of climb at the particular altitude for which

the calculations are made. · pounels ·


In Figure XXII-1, the maximum excess power is 435 horsepower; the

rate of climb is then

435 X 33,000 , , .
The maximum difference between the curves of the horsepower available
^ — = 1436 feet per minute
and the horsepower required at the same speed along the flight path will
at sea level. Similarly, the rate of climb at 7000 feet is 1419 feet per min-

determine the maximum rate of climb at the particular altitude for which
the calculations are made.
ute, and at 10,000 feet the maximum rate of climb is 1270 feet per minute.

Refer to Figure XXII-7.

ABSOLUTE AND SERVICE CEILINGS


In Figur ~ XXIl-1, the maximum excess power is 435 horsepower; the
The absolute ceiling is that altitude at which the rate of climb Ja zero

feet per minute. The service ceiling is that altitude at which the rate of
rate of clin1b is then
Islimb is 100 feet per minute^ ~~~~ . —

435 x 33 000 . .
The absolute and service ceilings may be obtained graphically by deter-

lO,OOO = 1436 feet per mmute


mining the rates of climb for two different altitudes (outside of the super-

charged region and extending the straight line drawn through these points

to intersect the zero ordinate).


at sea level. Similarly, the rate of climb at 7000 feet is 1419 feet per min-
This has been done in Figure XXII-7. The service and absolute

ute, and at 10,000 feet the maximum rate of climb is 1270 feet per minute.
Refer to Figure XXII-7.
ceilings, of course, also could have been calculated by means of trig-

onometric relationships for two different altitudes. Actually, the rate of

climb does not vary directly with the change in altitude but the assump-

tion is sufficiently close for all practical purposes.

RANGE

The range may be calculated on the basis of the known horsepower, fuel ABSOLUTE AND SERVICE CEILINGS
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:40 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

consumption, and speed. This method is likely to give too conservative

The absolute ceiling is that altitude at which the rate of climb__ia_~o


feet per minute. The service ceiling i_~ -~hat altitude at which the rate of
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

climb is 100 feet per minute.


The absolute and service ceilings may be obtained graphically by deter-
mining the rates of climb for two different altitudes (outside of the super-
charged region and extending the straight line drawn through these points
to intersect the zero ordinate).
This has been done in Figure XXII-7. The service and absolute
ceilings, of course, also could have been calculated by means of trig-
onometric relationships for two different altitudes. Actually, the rate of
climb does not vary directly with the change in altitude but the assump-
tion is sufficiently close for all practical purposes.

RANGE
The range may be calculated on the basis of the known horsepower, fuel
consumption, and speed. This method is likely to give too conservative

Original from
Dig ized b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 469
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

469

40

I32

24

16

bsolute
40
?rvice c

Absolute ce1~ing
~

i""
Service ceiling
ceiling

eiling
'-
Si

rv

1\

I
l
I

~
i
I

""
1

I
1

1
I
I
~
1

8 I
I

i I -7000 feet
— TOOL

I
7 feel

I
U-l 1

400 800 1200 1600 2000

400 800 1200 1600 2000


Rate of climb (feetper minj

Figure XXII-7. A typical rate-of-climb curve for an airplane equipped with a Rate of climb (feet per min.)
supercharged engine.

values although more refined formulae are available. Breguet's formula

is also used:
FIGURE XXII-7. A typical rate-of-climb curve for an airplane equipped with a
R = range in miles = 863 (J^J ^ logw (^r^)' supercharged engine.
where L/D = maximum over-all effectiveness of the complete airplane,
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:47 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

rj = average propeller efficiency at cruising,

c = average fuel consumption in pounds per brake horsepower


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

per hour at cruising,

Wo = gross weight of airplane at start of flight, and

W, = Wo less oil and fuel weight.


values although more refined formulae a.re available. Breguet's formula
Extensive flight tests are made on the prototype airplane to establish
is also used:
(~) ~ log10 (::}
the necessary data on the basis of which the usefulness of the airplane for

certain operations can be evaluated. The outline presented here gives an


R = range in miles = 863
indication of the type of data desired.

where L/D = maximum over-all effectiveness of the complete airplane,


1/ = average propeller efficiency at cruising,
c = average fuel consumption in pounds per brake horsepower
per hour at cruising,
Wo = gross weight of airplane at start of Hight, and
W. = Wo less oil and fuel weight.
Extensive flight tests are made on the prototype airplane to establish
the necessary data. on the basis of which the usefulness of the airplane for
certain operations can be evaluated. The outline presented here gives an
indication of the type of data desired.

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
470 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
470

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS


With fixed equipment as listed in the following text, and a useful load
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS

With fixed equipment as listed in the following text, and a useful load

consisting of consisting of
1 pilot 170 lb

1 pilot 170 lb
5 passengers 850 lb

5 p&SSengers 850 lb
baggage 200 lb

baggage 200 lb
cargo 200 lb

cargo 200 lb
fuel and oil sufficient for a cruising

fuel and oil sufficient for a cruising


range of 500 miles at any altitude
range of 500 miles at any altitude

between sea level and 5000 feet,


between sea level and 5000 feet,

the minimum performance acceptable when using fuel of not more than

80 octane will be:

1. * High speed in level flight 175 mph

the minimum performance acceptable when using fuel of not more than
80 octane will be:
2. f Landing speed with power off 65 mph

3. Ceiling (one engine dead) 6000 ft

4. Distance from start to clear 50-foot obstacle 1500 ft

1. • High speed in level flight 175 mph


2. t
5. Distance to stop after clearing 50-foot obstacle 1000 ft

* At any altitude from sea level to 5000 feet altitude (standard air),
Landing speed with power off 65mph
t Standard air.
3. Ceiling (one engine dead) 6000 ft
Take-off performance with all engines functioning normally.
4. Distance from start to clear 50-foot obstacle 1500 ft
1. Ground run to minimum take-off speed.
5. Distance to stop after clearing 50-foot obstacle 1000 ft
•At any altitude from sea level to 5000 feet altitude (standard air).
Weight

Min take-off

speed (mph)
t Standard air.
Distance

(ft)

Engine

manifold
Take-oft performance with all engines functioning normally.
pressure (in.)

Propeller

rpm
1. Ground run to minimum take-off speed.
Max gross

Light

Engine
2. Horizontal distance required for acceleration from standing start to

Weight Min take-off Distance manifold Propeller


speed (mph) (ft) rpm
pressure (in.)
minimum speed required for level flight with one engine dead.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Weight

Min
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

dead engine

speed (mph)
Max grOBB ••••••••
Distance

(ft)
Light ............ .
Engine

manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller
2. Horizontal distance required for acceleration from standing start to
rpm

Max gross
minimum speed required for level flight with one engine dead.
Light

Min Engine
Weight dead engine Distance manifold Propeller
speed (mph) (ft) preSBure (in.) rpm

Max groSB ..... . . .

Light ... ... . . .... .

Original from
D1 ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N

PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 471
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

471

3. Horizontal distance required for acceleration from standing start to


3. Horizontal distance required for acceleration from standing start to
speed of best angle of climb.
speed of best angle of climb.
Engine

manifold

pressure (in.)

Engine
Weight

Weight Best climbing Distance manifold Propeller


speed (mph) (ft) rpm
Best climbing

pressure (in.)
speed (mph)

Distance

Max grOBB ••••••••


(ft)

Propeller

Light ............ .
rpm

Light

4. Best angle of climb.

Angle

(degrees)

Engine manifold

pressure (in.)
4. Best angle of climb.
Propeller

rpm

Angle Engine manifold Propeller


Weight

Weight (degrees) pressure (in.) rpm


Performance in air with all engines functioning normally.

1. High speed in level flight (at maximum gross weight).

Altitude

(ft)

• High speed

(mph)

Engine manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller

rpm
Performance in air with all engines functioning normally.
Sea level 1. High speed in level flight (at maximum gross weight).
5,000 ft

Critical altitude of engine

2. Service ceiling (where best climb is 100 feet per minute).

Altitude ·High speed Engine manifold Propeller


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Engine manifold

(ft) (mph) pressure (in.) rpm


pressure (in.)
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Propeller

rpm

Weight
Sea level .......... . ... .
Ceiling (ft)

Max. gross at start


5,000 ft .......... . ..... .
Light

Critical altitude of engine

2. Service ceiling (where best climb is 100 feet per minute).

Engine manifold Propeller


Weight Ceiling (ft) pressure (in.) rpm

Max. gross at start . ... . .

Light ... ... .... ..... .. .

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
472 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
472

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

3. Cruising speed (approximately 70 per cent rated power, dependent


upon operating instructions, maximum gross weight only).
3. Cruising speed (approximately 70 per cent rated power, dependent

upon operating instructions, maximum gross weight only).

Altitude (ft)

Cruising speed

Cruising speed Engine manifold Propeller


(mph)

Altitude (ft) (mph) pre88Ure (in.) rpm


Engine manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller

rpm
Sea level. ............. .
Sea level

Critical altitude of engine


Critical altitude of engine
4. Fuel and oil consumption at cruising speed, maximum gross weight.

Fuel consumption (gals per hr) Oil consumption (gals per hr)

5. Minimum level flight speed.

Speed with flaps

retracted (mph)

Speed with flaps

extended (mph)
4. Fuel and oil consumption at cruising speed, maximum gross weight.
Engine manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller
Fuel consumption (gals per hr) Oil consumption (gals per hr)
rpm

Performance in air with one engine dead.

1. Service ceiling (where best climb is 100 feet per minute).

Engine manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller

rpm

Weight

Ceiling (ft)

Max. gross

Light
5. Minimum level flight speed.

Speed with flaps Speed with flaps Engine manifold Propeller


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

retracted (mph) extended (mph) pressure (in.) rpm


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

....... ............. ·------------··-------------··-- ---------·--·------------------- ---·-------------·····----···-·

Pedormance in air with one engine dead.

1. Service ceiling, (where best climb is 100 feet per minute).

Engine manifold Propeller


Weight Ceiling (ft) pressure (in.) rpm

Max. gross . . . .. .. .. .

Light . ... . .. . . . . ... .

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 473
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 473

2. High speed in level flight with engines at maximum power authorized

2. High speed in level flight with engines at maximum power authorized


for continuous operation, maximum gross weight only.
for continuous operation, maximum gross weight only.

Engine manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller

rpm
Engine manifold Propeller
Altitude
Altitude Speed (mph) pressure (in.) rpm
Speed (mph)

(a) Sea level

(b) Engine ceiling....

(a) Sea level. ....... .


3. Fuel and oil consumption for conditions 2a and 2b.

Fuel consumption (gals per hr) Oil consumption (gals per hr)

(b) Engine ceiling ... .


4. Best angle of climb.

Angle

(degrees)

Engine manifold

pressure (in.)

Propeller

rpm
3. Fuel and oil consumption for conditions 2a and 2b.
Weight

Max cross

light

Fuel consumption (gals per hr) Oil consumption (gals per hr)
Landing.

1. Steepest gliding angle practicable for landing approach, flaps ex-

tended, maximum gross weight, no power.

Angle (degrees)

Speed (mph)

4. Best angle of climb.

Angle Engine manifold Propeller


Weight (degrees) pressure (in.) rpm
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

__
--------------·------··-········ ----····-·····----------------- .....................................
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Max. gross ......... .


Light .............. .

Landing.

l. Steepest gliding angle practicable for landing approach, flaps ex-


tended, maximum gross weight, no power.

Angle (degrees) Speed {mph)

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
474 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
474

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


2. Length of ground roll from 3-point landing, maximum gross weight
2. Length of ground roll from 3-point landing, maximum gross weight

only, brakes used, landing for conditions as in 1.


only, brakes used, landing for conditions as in 1.
Flap position Distance (ft) Landing speed (mpb)

EMPIRICAL FORMULAS

It is sometimes desirable to calculate performance data from a few basic


Flap position Distance (ft) Landing speed (mph)
assumptions, such as wing loading and power or thrust loading, in order to

determine whether a set of proposed performance requirements is realistic

and can be reasonably met.

The formulas listed below have been based upon published data and

can be used to determine reasonable values.

Maximum Speed

1. Maximum speed, in miles per hour, in level flight at critical altitude

of power plant for power loadings (W/P) between 5 and 12 and wing

loadings (W/S) between 20 and 90 may be found from the formula: EMPIRICAL FORMULAS
It is sometimes desirable to calculate performance data from a few basic
'—» + *(?)(?).

This equation holds for propeller-equipped aircraft for speeds between

200 and 400 mph. assumptions, such as wing loading and power or thrust loading, in order to
2. For aircraft powered with jet engines, with speeds of between 450

determine whether a set of proposed performance requirements is realistic


and 700 miles an hour, the following formulas have reasonable validity:

V^, - 450 + 1.28 (^r)(y): (a)


and can be reasonably met.
V— = 780 - 1.28 (b)
The formulas listed below have been based upon published data and
can be used to determine reasonable values.
For the upper values of speed, the following formula gives closer values:

Vmax = 820 - 1.28 (jf)0 0 (c)

The available data for jet-powered airplanes are still too sparse to en-

able one to determine reliable values for the constants in these empirical

equations. Therefore, any such formulas should be checked with existing


Maximum Speed
data and the constants should be re-evaluated.
1. Maximum speed, in miles per hour, in level flight at critical altitude
of power plant for power loadings (W /P) between 5 and 12 and wing
loadings (W / S) between 20 and 90 may be found from the formula:

V mu = 200 + ~ (~) (~)·


This equation holds for propeller-equipped aircraft for speeds between
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

200 and 400 mph.


2. For aircraft powered with jet engines, with speeds of between 450
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

and 700 miles an hour, the following formulas have reasonable validity:

V mu = 450 + 1.28 (~) (~); (a)

V maz = 780 - 1.28 (~) (~) • (b)

For the upper values of speed, the following formula gives closer values:

V mu = 820 - 1.28 (~) (~)· (c)

The available data for jet-powered airplanes are still too sparse to en-
able one to determine reliable values for the constants in these empirical
equations. Therefore, any such formulas should be checked with existing
data and the constants should be re-evaluated.

Original from
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 475
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

475

3. For aircraft powered with reciprocating engines, the following


3. For aircraft powered with reciprocating engmes, the following
formula may be used:
formula may be used:
where K has a value from 135 to 145 for small personal aircraft employing

p)l/3
fixed-pitch propellers;

K has a value from 125 to 135 for small flying boats and amphibians;
v'"°" = K (s I

K has a value from 200 to 225 for transport airplanes employing

constant-speed propellers.

where K has a value from 135 to 145 for small personal aircraft employing
fixed-pitch p'ropellers;
4. Another formula that may be usefully employed in determining

maximum speed reads as follows:

for which K may be evaluated from existing values of Vmaz, Vm,„, and

K has a value from 125 to 135 for small flying boats and amphibians;
power loading, (W/P).

5. When enough data become available for specific categories of air-


K has a value from 200 to 225 for transport airplanes employing
planes equipped with jet power, an empirical formula such as the following

constant-speed propellers.
can be used:

Minimum or Stalling Speed


4. Another formula that may be usefully employed in determining
The following formula may be used with good results to determine the

maximum speed reads as follows:

I(w)11a
minimum or stalling speed in miles per hour:

where K varies from 15 to 18 for small airplanes without the use of lift-

increase devices and with fixed-pitch propellers, for wing loadings (W/S), V maz = K (V min2)113 p 1

between 5 and 25,

K varies from 10 to 13 for transport airplanes equipped with partial

span flaps and constant-speed propellers for W/S values from 30 to 80.

Rate of Climb at Sea Level


for which K may be evaluated from existing values of V ....u, V min, and
The rate of climb, in feet per minute, may be calculated from the fol-
power loading, (W /P).
lowing empirical formulas:

R = 18,000 ~ - 45 ^-
5. When enough data become available for specific categories of air-
planes equipped with jet power, an empirical formula such as the following
can be used:

Minimum or Stalling Speed


The following formula may be used with good results to determine the
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:48 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

minimum or stalling speed in miles per hour:


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

V ... in = K~~·
where K varies from 15 to 18 for small airplanes without the use of lift-
increase devices and with fixed-pitch propellers, for wing loadings (W /S),
between 5 and 25,
K varies from 10 to 13 for transport airplanes equipped with partial
span flaps and constant-speed propellers for W / S values from 30 to 80.

Rate of Climb at Sea Level


The rate of climb, in feet per minute, may be calculated from the fol-
lowing empirical formulas:

R = 18,000~ - 45 ~·

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
476 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
476

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL

for personal airplanes equipped with fixed-pitch propellers, and power


for personal airplanes equipped with fixed-pitch propellers, and power

loadings (W/P) varying from 15 to 25;


loadings (W /P) varying from 15 to 25;
PW

Re =
p
18,000 W - 10 - 1
w
s
Rc = 18,000 w- 10 -^

for aircraft using constant-speed propellers with wing loadings (W/8)

from 30 to 80, and power loadings (W/P) from 5 to 15.

Absolute Ceiling
for aircraft using constant-speed propellers with wing loadings (W / S)
1. The theoretical formula for reciprocating-engine-powered airplanes is

H = 40,000 logio (jr)<


from 30 to 80, and power loadings (W / P) from 5 to 15.
where Pao is the horsepower available at sea level, and

Pr„ is the horsepower required to fly at speed V at sea level.


Absolute Ceiling
2. From the formula above, an empirical formula such as the following

may be derived:
1. The theoretical formula for reciprocating-engine-powered airplanes is

(~::)·
H = 40,000 log,o ,^v* y

\p)\s)

where K may have a value from 105 to 120 for


H = 40,000 log10
• jw

where P 11 0 is the horsepower available at sea level, and


p

values ranging from 45 to 55 for personal airplanes with unsupercharged


P,.o is the horsepower required to fly at speed V at sea level.
engines.

3. For supercharged reciprocating engines, the formula takes the form

2. From the formula above, an empirical formula such as the following


K

H = Hc + 40,000 logio
may be derived:
K
where Hc is the critical altitude to which the engine is supercharged, and

~ 40,000 log,. (~) (~) •


K has a value between 215 and 230, for values for W/PVW/S from 40

to 90.
H
4. Turbo-jet-powered aircraft have a practical ceiling between 50,000

and 75,000 since the number of stages of the turbo-supercharger deter-

mines the practical limits of air compression.

Range
where K may have a value from 105 to 120 for
1. Brequet's formula is the customary range formula used for re-

~~~
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

values ranging from 45 to 55 for personal airplanes with unsupercharged


engmes.
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

~. For supercharged reciprocating engines, the formula takes the form


K
H ~ H, + 40,000 log,.(~) ( ~~)'
where H c is the critical altitude to which the engine is supercharged, and
K has a value between 215 and 230, for values for W / Pv'W/S from 40
to 90.
4. Turbo-jet-powered aircraft have a practical ceiling between 50,000
and 75,000 since the number of stages of the turbo-supercharger deter-
mines the practical limits of air compression.

Range
1. Brequet's formula is the customary range formula used for re-

Original from
Di ize b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS 477
PERFORMANCE CALCULATIONS

477
ciprocating engines. When applied for successive increments of decreas-
ciprocating engines. When applied for successive increments of decreas-

ing gross weights, it will lead to results that are quite reasonable.
ing gross weights, it will lead to results that are quite reasonable.
2. A modification of the formula for personal aircraft with fixed-pitch
2. A modification of the formula for personal aircraft with fixed-pitch
propellers reads as follows:

where W0 = initial gross weight,


propellers reads as followH:
We = weight without fuel, and

K varies from 10,500 to 12,000.

3. For aircraft employing controllable-pitch propellers and reciprocating


R= Klog10 WE
Wo,
engines:

where K\ varies from 50 to 70 and K2 varies from 12,000 to 13,000. where Wu = initial gross weight,
WE = weight without fuel, and
R = K logio j^2'

K varies from 10,500 to 12,000.


:~.
For aircraft employing controllable-pitch propellers and reciprocating
engmes:

R
= [K1 (W)
8
(W)
p
log Wo] - K2 Wo,
WE WE
where K1 varies from 50 to 70 and K2 varies from 12,000 to 13,000.
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:49 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig iz b
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
Absorbers, shock, 359-361, 362-364

dimensions, 380

energy considerations, 361-362

proportions, 380

types, 361-362

Aerodynamic twist, 319

Ailerons, 341-347, 387-388, 417-

419, 420

Air, arbitrary standard, 458

inlet systems, 281-296

movement, 222-223

requirements, 223-224

standard atmosphere, 458, 459-

Absorbers, shock,359-361,362-364 characteristics, 36, 37, 47


compressible flow, 48-49
460

upper atmosphere, 460


dimensions, 380
Air conditioning, air ducts, 227-
energy considerations, 361-362 computation table, 40
229, 281-296

air movement, 222-223


proportions, 380 construction, 45-46
air requirements, 222, 223-224
types, 361-362 criteria, 39
boilers, 229

Aerodynamic twist, 319 laminar flow, 48


Ailerons, 341-347, 387-388, 417- ordinates, 45-46
calculations, 230-232

equipment, 229-230

heat sources, 200-201, 229, 232 419, 420 power coefficient, 35


high speeds, 233-234

importance, 221-223
Air, arbitrary standard, 458 section characteristics, 41-45
physical conditions, 226-227
inlet systems, 281-296 selection, 29-49
pressure considerations, 224-225

movement, 222-223 structural considerations, 38


radiators, 229

schematic system, 223, 226


requirements, 223-224 supersonic speed, 46-48
soundproofing, 227 standard atmosphere, 458, 459- tail surfaces, 388-389
temperature limits, 226

460 thickness, 321-322


Air ducts, 227-229, 281-296 (See

also Air induction systems)


upper atmosphere, 460 thickness ratios, 38, 45
Airfoil, aspect ratio corrections, 38,
Air conditioning, air ducts, 227- Air induction systems, annular inlet,
39-41

characteristics, 36, 37, 47


229, 281-296 292
compressible flow, 48-49
air movement, 222-223 anti-icing, 284-285
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

computation table, 40

air requirements, 222, 223-224 conventional spinner, 283-284


boilers, 229 ducted spinner, 281-283
construction, 45-46
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

criteria, 39

laminar flow, 48
calculations, 230-232 flush inlet, 294- 296
ordinates, 45-46

power coefficient, 35
equipment, 229-230 inlet-velocity ratio, 284- 286, 288-
section characteristics, 41-45
heat sources, 200-201, 229, 232 289
selection, 29-49

high speeds, 233-234 losses, 286


importance, 221- 223 nose inlet, 290-292
structural considerations, 38

supersonic speed, 46-48

tail surfaces, 388-389 physical conditions, 226-227 requirements, 287-289


thickness, 321-322

pressure considerations, 224-225 scoop, 292-293


thickness ratios, 38, 45

Air induction systems, annular inlet,


radiators, 229 undercowl scoop, 286
292
schematic system, 223, 226 wing-root inlet, 289-290
anti-icing, 284-285

conventional spinner, 283-284


soundproofing, 227 Airplanes, choice, 18-25
ducted spinner, 281-283 temperature limits, 226 data, 26-28
flush inlet, 294-296

Air ducts, 227-229, 281-296 (See forces in flight, 30


also Air induction systems) front view, 120
inlet-velocity ratio, 284-286, 288-

289

losses, 286
Airfoil, aspect ratio corrections, 38, length, 118
nose inlet, 290-292

requirements, 287-289
39- 41 performance, 28
scoop, 292-293

481
undercowl scoop, 286

wing-root inlet, 289-290

Airplanes, choice, 18-25

Original from
data, 26-28

forces in flight, 30
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
front view, 120

length, 118

performance, 28
482 · AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
482

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Airplanes (Continued): fuselage, 161-164
Airplanes (Continued):

rectilinear flight, 29-36 power plant, 164


side view, 120-121 procedures, 155-157
rectilinear flight, 29-36

side view, 120-121

three-quarter view, 8 three-quarter view, 8 static, 391-392


three-view, 113-123

three-view, 113-123 wing, 164-167


top view, 120

types, 10-28
top view, 120 worksheet, 163
Airsickness, cabin provisions, 218

types, 10-28 Ballast, 169


Airsickness, cabin provisions, 218 Beading, 105
Aisle dimensions, 205

Aluminum alloy, (See Materials of

construction) Aisle dimensions, 205 Berths, cabin, 206, 217, 218


Angle, aerodynamic twist, 319

dihedral, horizontal tail, 401


Aluminum alloy, (See Materials of weights, 151
dihedral, wing, 317-319
construction) Biplane, 10-11
downwash, 399-400

Angle, aerodynamic twist, 319 Boilers, 229


dihedral, horizontal tail, 401 Bolts, 109
incidence, horizontal tail, 398-

400

incidence, wing, 319-320 dihedral, wing, 317-319 Brake, installation, 379


sweepback, horizontal tail, 400-

401
downwash, 399-400
sweepback, wing, 313-317, 318-
incidence, horizontal tail, 398- Cabin, a.irsickness, 218
319

400 aisles, 205


incidence, wing, 319-320 baggage compartment, 220
trim, 399

Anti-icing (See also De-icing)

engine inlet, 286-287


·sweepback, horizontal tail, 400- berths, 206, 217, 218
equipment, 199-201

Areas, control surfaces, 401, 407-


401 center of gravity, 216
408
sweepback, wing, 313-317, 318- comfort, 203
wing, 116-117

319 considerations, 202-203


trim, 399 dimensions, 203-205
Aspect ratio, corrections, 38-41

tail surfaces, 398, 406

wing, 320-321 Anti-icing (See als_o De-icing) doors, 217-218


Axes, reference, 59-61

Baggage compartment, 220


engine inlet, 286- 287 exits, 217-218
Balance, aerodynamic, 389-391
equipment, 199-201 flooring, 219
Areas, control surfaces, 401, 407- furnishings, 218
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

ballast, 169

408 headroom, 207-209


calculations, 163, 168-169
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

center of gravity, 157-171

clearances, 168 wing, 116-117 interior, 217


defined, 155

diagram, 155-157
Aspect ratio, corrections, 38-41 legroom, 209-213
dynamic, 392-393
tail surfaces, 398, 406 lighting, 218
fuselage, 161-164

wing, 320-321 pressurization, 224-226, 229-230,


Axes, reference, 59-61 447-448
power plant, 164

procedures, 155-157

static, 391-392
refreshments, 220
wing, 164-167

worksheet, 163
Baggage compartment, 220 seating, 206-207
Ballast, 169
Balance, aerodynamic, 389-391 seats, 205-206
Beading, 105

ballast, 169 soundproofing, 203


calculations, 163, 168-169 toilets, 219--220
Berths, cabin, 206, 217, 218

weights, 151

Biplane, 10-11 center of gravity, 157-171 vision, 203, 215


Boilers, 229

clearances, 168 windows, 216-217, 447


Bolts, 109

Brake, installation, 379


defined, 155 Cables, control system, 414-415,
Cabin, airsickness, 218

diagram, 155-157 416


dynamic, 392- 393 soundproofing, 239
aisles, 205

baggage compartment, 220

berths, 206, 217, 218

center of gravity, 216

comfort, 203

considerations, 202-203

Original from
dimensions, 203-205

doors, 217-218
Dig iz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
exits, 217-218

flooring, 219

furnishings, 218
INDEX 483
INDEX

483
Cables (Continued): adjustable stabilizer, 414, 419
Cables (Continued):

strengths, 416
strengths, 416 aileron control, 420, 421
supports, 415, 426
supports, 415, 426 boost system, 419
weights, 150, 416

weights, 150, 416 cable, 412, 414-415, 416


Canopies, 183

Castings, aluminum, 70
Canopies, 183 control travel, 425-426
magnesium, 74
Castings, aluminum, 70 engine, 427-428
Center of gravity, error, 171

estimation, 170-171
magnesium, 74 fairleads, 415
fuselage, 161
Center of gravity, error, 171 flap, 189, 420, 422
individual items, 169-170

estimation, 170-171 hinges, 422, 428, 429


fuselage, 161
movement, 160

seating, 170-216
hydraulic, 423-425
Chord, mean aerodynamic, 306-310
individual items, 169-170 irreversible, 425, 426
mean geometric, 306-310

Clearances, flap, 351


movement, 160 pneumatic, 423-425
landing gear, 369, 381
seating, 170-216 pulleys, 414, 426
propeller, 247-249

Chord, mean aerodynamic, 306-310 push-pull, 412, 413


mean geometric, 306-310 requirements, 427-428
Cockpit, canopies, 179, 183

considerations, 172-174

controls, 188-189
Clearances, flap, 351 stops, 415
design, 174-176

dimensions, 184
landing gear, 369, 381 tabs, 420, 422
exits, 186
propeller, 247-249 torque tube, 412
instrument board, 189

Cockpit, canopies, 179, 183 weights, 150


considerations, 172-174 wheels, 188
parachutes, 188

pilot dimensions, 185

prone seating, 190


controls, 188-189 Controls, cockpit, 188-189
requirements, 175-176

seating, 183-186
design, 174-176 engine, 427-428
vision and visibility, 182-183
dimensions, 184 wheel, 188
windows, (See Windshields)

exits, 186 Cooling, at high speeds, 233- 234


instrument board, 189
windshields, 176-181

Comfort, air movement (See Air


engine, 274-275
conditioning) parachutes, 188 oil) 274-275
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:50 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

factors, 203

seating (See Seats and seating)


pilot dimensions, 185 Cowling, engine, 273-275
prone seating, 190 Cuffs, propeller, 254
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Compartments, baggage, 220

soundproofing, 239

requirements, 175-176 Cut-outs, 94- 95


seating, 183-186
Compressible flow, airfoils, 48-49

Control surfaces, areas, 387-388

travel, 425 vision and visibility, 182-183


De-icing equipment, 199-201
Control systems, 412-428

windows, (See Windshields)


adjustable stabilizer, 414, 419
(See also Anti-icing)
windshields, 176-181
Design, airplane, procedures, 3-9
aileron control, 420, 421

boost system, 419

Comfort, air movement (See Air


cable, 412, 414-415, 416

conditioning) Detail design, 81-112


control travel, 425-426

engine, 427-428 factors, 203 considerations, 81- 105


fairleads, 415

seating (See Seats and seating) philosophies, 81- 83


flap, 189, 420, 422

Compartments, baggage, 220 structural behavior, 84-86


hinges, 422, 428, 429

hydraulic, 423-425
soundproofing, 239 Dihedral, tail surfaces, 401
irreversible, 425, 426

Compressible flow, airfoils, 48-49 wing, 317-319


pneumatic, 423-425

pulleys, 414, 426


Control surfaces, areas, 387-388 Doors, access, 449- 450
push-pull, 412, 413

travel, 425 cabin, 217-218, 449


requirements, 427-428

stops, 415
Control systems, 412- 428 Ducts, (See Air ducts)
tabs, 420, 422

torque tube, 412

weights, 150

Original from
wheels, 188

Controls, cockpit, 188-189

engine, 427-428
UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
wheel, 188

Cooling, at high speeds, 233-234

engine, 274-275
484 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
484

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Electrical equipment, 198-199 Fool-proof, 82
Electrical equipment, 198-199

heat sources, 229


heat sources, 229 Firewall, 272-273
Engines (See also Power plants)
Engines (See also Power plants) Fittings, 97-99
carburetor scoop, 277-278

carburetor scoop, 277-278 Flaps, (See also Lift-increase de-


controls, 427--428 vices)
controls, 427-428

cooling system, 274-275

cowling, 273-275
cooling system, 274-275 clearance, 351
firewall, 272-273

fuel consumption, 268-269


cowling, 273-275 controls, 420
fuel systems, 278-279
firewall, 272-273 wing, 422
installations, 251-253

fuel consumption, 268-269 Flight, climbing, 34-35


fuel systems, 278-279 diving, 34
jet types, 296

location, 119, 264

lubricating systems, 280-281 installations, 251-253 envelope, 58-59


manifolds, 276-277

jet types, 296 gliding, 33-34


mount, 269-272, 297

nacelles, 268
location, 119, 264 horizontal, 31-33
number, 265-267
lubricating systems, 280-281 range, 36
piston, 295

power rating, 267-268, 295


manifolds, 276-277 Floats, weights, 153
probability theory, 265-267 mount, 269-272, 297 Flooring, 1~102
pusher installation, 252-253

nacelles, 268 cabin, 219, 449


rating, 267-268

selection, 268
number, 265-267 soundproofing, 219
submerged, 264-265
piston, 295 Flutter, prevention, 355-356, 393-
tandem, 251-252

thrust ratings, 296


power rating, 267- 268, 295 394
weights, 295-296
probability theory, 265-267 Forgings, 68-70
Equipment, electrical, 198-199

pusher installation, 252-253 Frames, fabrication 439--442


spacing, 44(}-442
hydraulic, 419, 423-425

safety, 199
rating, 267-268
Exits, cabin, 217-218, 449
selection, 268 Fuel, consumption, 268- 269
cockpit, 186

Extrusions, 68, 74, 78


submerged, 264-265 pumps, 279
Fabricated components, weights,
tandem, 251-252 systems, 278-279
thrust ratings, 296 tanks, 279-280
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

145-146

weights, 295-296 Fuel systems, 278-279


Fabrication, 71-73
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

blanking, 72

cutting, 72
Equipment, electrical, 198- 199 Furnishings, cabin, 218
forming, 72-73

Fail-safe, 82
hydraulic, 419, 423--425 Fuselage, 430-453
Fairleads, 415
safety, 199 access doors, (See Doors)
Fool-proof, 82

Exits, cabin, 217-218, 449 analytical studies, 437--438


cockpit, 186 considerations, 430
Firewall, 272-273

Fittings, 97-99

Flaps, (See also Lift-increase de- Extrusions, 68, 74, 78 description, 430
vices)

doors, 449, 452


clearance, 351

controls, 420
Fabricated components, weights, floor, 449
wing, 422

145-146 frames, 439, 440-444


Flight, climbing, 34-35

diving, 34
Fabrication, 71- 73 length, 435
envelope, 58-59 blanking, 72 lines, 435--436
gliding, 33-34

cutting, 72 mass distribution, 453


horizontal, 31-33

range, 36
forming, 72-73 mockup, 436
Floats, weights, 153
Fail-safe, 82 panel, 88-92
Flooring, 100-102

cabin, 219, 449


Fairleads, 415 pressurized, 447- 448
soundproofing, 219

Flutter, prevention, 355-356, 393-

394

Forgings, 68-70

Original from
Frames, fabrication 439-442

spacing, 440-442
D I IZ b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIG N
Fuel, consumption, 268-269

pumps, 279

systems, 278-279
INDEX 485
INDEX

485
Fuselage (Continued) : location, 364-371
Fuselage (Continued):

shape, 432-435 nose-wheel type, 367-370


shape, 432-435

skin thickness, 90, 446-447


skin thickness, 90, 446-447 retraction, 376-378
stringers, 439, 442, 444-446
stringers, 439, 442, 444-446 shimmy, 373-375
structure, 451-452

tail boom, 450-451


structure, 451-452 shock absorbers, 362-364
twin, 450
tail boom, 450-451 special problems, 380
weight, 136-137, 142-143

twin, 450 speed reduction, 359-361


weight, 136-137, 142-143 tail-wheeltype,365-367
windows, 447

wing configuration, 323, 430-432

Gauges, metal sheet, 80 windows, 447 tandem, 371


tubing, 111-112

wing configuration, 323, 430-432 tire size, 152-153


Headroom, cabin, 207-209

Heating, calculations, 230-232


track type, 370-371
sources, 229
Gauges, metal sheet, 80 tread, 375
surface, 232

Hinges, 422
tubing, 111-112 weights, 138, 143-145
Hydraulic equipment, 419, 423-425
wheel position, 376
actuating cylinders weight, 154

Headroom, cabin, 207-209 wheel size, 375-376


Heating, calculations, 230-232 Legroom, cabin, 206, 209-215
bend radii, 378

Instrument board, 189, 193-194

Instruments, cockpit, 191-201


sources, 229 cockpit, 184
grouping, 194

importance, 191
surface, 232 Lift-increase devices, 347-354
location, 194
Hinges, 422 Lighting, 218
selection, 197-198

Hydraulic equipment, 419, 423-425 Lightening holes, 105


actuating cylinders weight, 154 Load factor, definition, 50-51
variety, 194-197

Jet engines (See Power plant)

Joints, bolted and riveted, 95-97 bend radii, 378 determination, 55-56
Landing gear, brakes, 359-361

empirical, 57-58
clearances, 381

considerations, 304, 357-358


Instrument board, 189, 193-194 gust, 52-55
cross-wind, 371-373
Instruments, cockpit, 191- 201 maneuver, 51- 52
description, 357

dynamic loads, 358-359


grouping, 194 Loads, 50-63
importance, 191 dynamic, 50-53
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:51 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

energy dissipation, 361-362

engine torque, 250-251

location, 194 factors, 50-58


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

selection, 197-198 generalized system, 61-63


landing contact, 364-365

location, 364-371

nose-wheel type, 367-370 variety, 194-197 gust, 52-55


retraction, 376-378

shimmy, 373-375
maneuvering, 51-52
shock absorbers, 362-364
Jet engines (See Power plant) Lubricating systems, 280-281
special problems, 380
Joints, bolted and riveted, 95-97 tanks, 281
speed reduction, 359-361

tail-wheel type, 365-367


Luggage, 220
tandem, 371
Landing gear, brakes, 359-361
tire size, 152-153

clearances, 381 Mach number corrections, 46-48


considerations, 304, 357-358 Magnesium alloy, (See Materials of
track type, 370-371

tread, 375

weights, 138, 143-145


cross-wind, 371- 373 construction)
wheel position, 376

wheel size, 375-376


description, 357 Man, average dimensions, 185
Legroom, cabin, 206, 209-215
dynamic loads, 358-359 for seating, 216
cockpit, 184

energy dissi pation, 361- 362 Manifolds, exhaust, 276-277


engine torque, 250-251 Materials of construction, alumi-
Lift-increase devices, 347-354

Lighting, 218

Lightening holes, 105 landing contact, 364-365 num, 65


Load factor, definition, 50-51

determination, 55-56

empirical, 57-58

gust, 52-55

maneuver, 51-52

Original from
Loads, 50-63

Dig IZed b
dynamic, 50-53

factors, 50-58

generalized system, 61-63


UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
-- ..
gust, 52-55
486 AIRPLANE DESIGN ltfANC.:AL
486

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Materials (Contintwi): requirements, 1i0-474
Materials (Continued):

aluminum alloys, 65-71


aluminum alloys, 65-71 service ceiling, 468, 471
application, 64-65, 76-79
application, 64-65, 76-79 stalling speed, 475
considerations, 65

considerations, 65 take-off, 470--471


fabricated, 71-73 Pilot, average dimensions, 185
fabricated, 71-73

magnesium alloys, 74

mechanical properties, 106-110


magnesium alloys, 74 ejection equipment, 187
steel, 74-75

titanium alloys, 75-76


mechanical properties, I 06-110 protection, 186-187
Mechanical properties, 106-110
steel, 74-75 seating, 183-186
Mockup, cockpit, 175

titanium alloys, 75-76 Power plants, (See also Engines)


fuselage, 436

Noise, engine, 236, 239-240


Mechanical properties, 106-110 air inlet systems, 281-296
frequency, 236-237 Mockup, cockpit, 175 defined, 263
measure, 235

fuselage, 436 fuel systems, 278-280


soundproofing, 235-240

general considerations, 263-264


Noise, engine, 236, 239--240
sources, 236, 239-240

Oxygen, requirements, 221-224


lubricating systems, 28o-281
cylinder weights, 150
frequency, 236-237 weights, 138-139, 146, 147-148
Panels, sizes, 89-92

under load, 88-89


measure, 235 Pressurization, cabin equipment,
Parachutes, 188
soundproofing, 235-240 229--230
weights, 151

sources, 236, 239--240 considerations, 224-226


Payload, 129

Performance, absolute ceiling, 468,

Oxygen, requirements, 221-224 structure, 447-448


476

altitude corrections, 459


cylinder weights, 150 Propeller, aerodynamic effects, 243
calculations, 455-459, 462, 469
asymmetrical conditions, 249-250
data, sources, 454, 460-461

Panels, sizes, 89--92 characteristics, 241-243


under load, 88-89 clearances, 247-249
empirical formulas, 474-477

engine, 461-462

landing run, 245, 359-361


Parachutes, 188 cuffs, 254
maximum speed, 466-468, 474-

weights, 151 diameter, 254-262


475

parasite resistance, 460-461


Payload, 129 gyroscopic effect, 243-244
Performance, absolute ceiling, 468, influence, 247
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

power available, 246, 462-466

power required, 455-459

476 number of blades, 245-247


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

propeller characteristics, 242-243

propeller selection, 254-260 altitude corrections, 459 pitch, 244-245


range, 268-269, 468-469, 476-477

calculations, 455-459, 462, 469 pusher installation, 252-253


rate of climb, 468, 475

requirements, 470-474
data, sources, 454, 460-461 selection, 254-258
service ceiling, 468, 471
empirical formulas, 474-477 spinners, 254
stalling speed, 475

take-off, 470-J71
engine, 461-462 tail installation, 253
Pilot, average dimensions, 185
landing run, 245, 359-361 tandem installation, 251-252
ejection equipment, 187

maximum speed, 466-468, 474- torque effect, 250-251


475 weights, 261- 262
protection, 186-187

seating, 183-186

Power plants, (See also Engines)


parasite resistance, 460-461 Pulleys, 414
air inlet systems, 281-296

defined, 263
power available, 246, 462-466 supports, 426
fuel systems, 278-280
power required, 455-459
general considerations, 263-264

propeller characteristics, 242-243 Refreshments, allowance, 220


propeller selection, 254-260 Ribs, wing, 331-334, 339-340
lubricating systems, 280-281

weights, 138-139, 146, 147-148

Pressurization, cabin equipment, range,268-269,468-469,476-477 Rivets, aluminum alloy, 70


229-230

considerations, 224-226
rate of climb, 468, 475 identification, 71
structure, 447-448

Propeller, aerodynamic effects, 243

asymmetrical conditions, 249-250

characteristics, 241-243

Original from
clearances, 247-249

cuffs, 254
Dig llze b UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN
diameter, 254-262

gyroscopic effect, 243-244

influence, 247
INDEX 487
INDEX

487
Rockets, 298 Stiffeners, 86-88, 105, 330-331
Rockets, 298

Stops, 415
Safety, design philosophy, 82 Stringers, 86-88, 330-331
Safety, design philosophy, 82

equipment, 199

margin, 81 equipment, 199 with sheet, 92-93


Scoop, carburetor, 277-278

margin, 81 Sweepback,313-316
Seating, accessibility, 215-216

arrangements, 206-207
Scoop, carburetor, 277-278 high-speed airplanes, 46-48
back-to-back, 213, 214

Seating, accessibility, 215-216 stability effects, 317


arrangements, 206-207 wing, 46
canoe, 210

cockpit, 183-186

dimensions, 204, 207 back-to-back, 213, 214


pick-a-back, 212

canoe, 210 Tabs, tail surface, 391, 420, 422, 423


prone, 190

rearward, 214-215
cockpit, 183-186 Tail surfaces, 382-411
side-by-side, 211, 213

dimensions, 204, 207 airfoils, 388-389


staggered, 213

tandem, 215
pick-a-back, 212 areas, 401,407-408
toboggan, 210-211 prone, 190 aspect ratio, 398, 406-407
Seats, dimensions, 184, 208

rearward, 214-215 balance, 389-393


passenger, 205-206

Sheet, sizes, 67, 74, 78


side-by-side, 211, 213 butterfly, 409-411
Sheet-stringer, 92-93
staggered, 213 clearances, 403
Shock absorbers (See Absorbers,

shock)
tandem, 215 construction, 394-395, 401
Soundproofing (See also Noise) toboggan, 210-211 control, 385-386, 404, 405
application, 237-239

Seats, dimensions, 184, 208 control surfaces, 387-388


choice, 237

flooring, 219
passenger, 205-206 dihedral, 401
materials, 227-230
Sheet, sizes, 67, 74, 78 dive brakes, 410
noise measure, 235

weights, 151
Sheet-stringer, 92-93 flutter prevention, 393-394
Span (See Wing)
Shock absorbers (See Absorbers, horizontal, 395-403
Spar, fittings, 334-337

shock) incidence, 398-400


Soundproofing (See also Noise) location, 395-397, 405- 406
wing, 327-331

Spinners, propeller hub, 254

application, 237-239 movement, 397-398, 406


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

Spoilers (<See Lift-increase devices)

Stability, criteria, 385

choice, 237 multiple, 397, 405


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

directional, 404-405

longitudinal, 382-386
flooring, 219 other solutions, 402-403
mass distribution, 453

materials, 227-230 planform, 120, 401-402, 408


noise measure, 235 requirements, 386-387
Stabilizer, adjustable, 419

Steel, 74-75, 77, 78, 79

Stiffeners, 86-88, 105, 330-331


weights, 151 stability, 382-386, 404-405
Stops, 415

Stringers, 86-88, 330-331


Span (See Wing) stabilizer, 397-398
with sheet, 92-93
Spar, fittings, 334-337 sweepback,400-401,408
Sweepback, 313-316

wing, 327-331 tabs, 391, 420, 422,423


Spinners, propeller hub, 254 tail length, 395-409
high-speed airplanes, 46-48

stability effects, 317

wing, 46 Spoilers (See Lift-increase devices) vertical tail surfaces, 403-408


Tabs, tail surface, 391, 420, 422, 423

Tail surfaces, 382-411


Stability, criteria, 385 weights, 141-142
airfoils, 388-389
directional, 404- 405 Tanks, fuel system, 279-280
areas, 401, 407-408

longitudinal, 382-386 lubricating system, 281


mass distribution, 453 Temperature limits (See Air con-
aspect ratio, 398, 406-407

balance, 389-393

butterfly, 409-411 Stabilizer, adjustable, 419 ditioning)


clearances, 403

construction, 394-395, 401


Steel, 74- 75, 77, 78, 79 Thermal problems, 102- 103
control, 385-386, 404, 405

control surfaces, 387-388

dihedral, 401

dive brakes, 410

Original from
flutter prevention, 393-394

Dig iz b
horizontal, 395-403
UNIVERSITYOFMICHIG N
incidence, 398-400

location, 395-397, 405-406

movement, 397-398, 406


488 AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL
488

AIRPLANE DESIGN MANUAL


Three-view, engineering studies, 122 variables, 132-139
Three-view, engineering studies, 122
final, 122-123 wheels, 152-153
final, 122-123

front view, 121


front view, 121 wing, 132-136, 139-141
general notes, 121
general notes, 121 worksheets, 129-131
side view, 121

side view, 121 Wheels, camber, 376


steps in assembly, 114-116

top view, 120


steps in assembly, 114-116 position, 376
Tires, weights, 152-153
top view, 120 size, 375-376
Toilets, 219

Tubing, round, 111-112


Tires, weights, 152-153 toe-in, 376
weights, 111-112
Toilets, 219 weights, 152-153
Ventilation (See Air conditioning)

Tubing, round, 111-112 Windows, 176-181,216-217, 447


weights, 111-112
Vision and visibility, cabin, 215

cockpit, 182-183
Windshields, 176-181
Weights, actual, 127
Wing (See also Airfoil)
alternate, 127

calculated, 126
Ventilation (See Air conditioning) aerodynamic twist, 319
control surfaces, 137-138
Vision and visibility, cabin, 215 aero-isoclinic, 316
empty, 146

cockpit, 182-183 ailerons, 341-347, 387-388


area, 116-117
engines (See Power plant), 295-

296

estimates, 114-116, 126, 128-132


Weights, actual, 127 balance calculations, 164-167
fabricated components, 145-146

floats, 154
alternate, 127 bending moments, 301
fuel, 147
calculated, 126 construction, 327
fuselage, 136-137, 142-143

control surfaces, 137-138 cranked, 316


empty, 146 crescent, 315-316
general procedure, 124-126

gross, 127, 148-149

hydraulic equipment, 154 engines (See Power plant), 295- design, 299-356
landing gear, 138, 143-145

miscellaneous, 150-154
296 dihedral, 317- 319
nacelles, 146-147
estimates, 114-116, 126, 128-132 fabric-covered, 337-341
oil, 147

fabricated components, 145-146 fences, 354


floats, 154 flap construction, 353- 422
oil coolers, 148

power plants, 138-139, 146-148

fuel, 147 flutter prevention, 355-356


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895

propeller, 261-262

sources, 139

fuselage, 136-137, 142- 143 fuselage configuration, 3Q3, 430--


Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

spinners, 254

structural, 128
general procedure, 124-126 432
tail surfaces, 141-142
gross, 127, 148- 149 general considerations, 303-304
tires, 152-153

variables, 132-139
hydraulic equipment, 154 gust factor, 52-54
wheels, 152-153 landing gear, 138, 143-145 incidence, 319-322
wing, 132-136, 139-141

miscellaneous, 150-154 landing-gear influence, 304


worksheets, 129-131

Wheels, camber, 376


nacelles, 146-147 lay-out procedure, 304-306
position, 376
oil, 147 lift-increase devices, 347- 354
size, 375-376

toe-in, 376
oil coolers, 148 loading, 320-355
weights, 152-153
power plants, 138-139, 146-148 loads, 299-303
Windows, 176-181,216-217, 447

propeller, 261-262 mass distribution, 354, 355


mean aerodynamic chord, 118
Windshields, 176-181

Wing (See also Airfoil)


sources, 139
aerodynamic twist, 319
spinners, 254 mean geometric chord, 306-310
aero-isoclinic, 316

ailerons, 341-347, 387-388


structural, 128 moment of inertia, 302
area, 116-117
tail surfaces, 141- 142 planform, 118, 310-313
balance calculations, 164-167

tires, 152- 153 rib lacing, 340


bending moments, 301

construction, 327

cranked, 316

crescent, 315-316

design, 299-356

Original from
dihedral, 317-319

Dig iz b
fabric-covered, 337-341
UNIVERSITY OF MICHIG N
fences, 354

flap construction, 353-422

flutter prevention, 355-356


INDEX 489
INDEX

489 Wing (Continued): spoilers, 347-354


Wing (Continued):

ribs, 331-334, 339 stringers, 330-331


ribs, 331-334, 339

rib spacing, 332, 341


rib spacing, 332, 341 structural considerations, 327
skin thickness, 90
skin thickness, 90 sweepback,313-317, 318-319
span, 117

spar construction, 327-331


span, 117 taper ratio, 310-317
spar fittings, 334-337
spar construction, 327-331 torsion, 301-302
spoilers, 347-354

spar fittings, 334-337 weight, 132-136, 139-141


stringers, 330-331

structural considerations, 327

sweepback, 313-317, 318-319

taper ratio, 310-317

torsion, 301-302

weight, 132-136, 139-141


Generated on 2012-05-30 05:52 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Original from
Dig tiz b UNIVERSITY OF ICHIGAN
Generated on 2012-05-30 05:54 GMT / http://hdl.handle.net/2027/mdp.39015000500895
Public Domain, Google-digitized / http://www.hathitrust.org/access_use#pd-google

Potrebbero piacerti anche